Quarterlytics / Beverages - Alcoholic / C&C Group

C&C Group

ccr · LSE
Claim this profile
Ticker ccr
Exchange LSE
Sector
Industry Beverages - Alcoholic
Employees 1001-5000
← All annual reports
FY2024 Annual Report · C&C Group
Sign in to download
Loading PDF…
Annual Report 2024

C&C Group plc is a leading, vertically 
integrated premium drinks company which 
manufactures, markets and distributes 
branded beer, cider, wine, spirits and soft 
drinks across the UK and Ireland.
“In what was a challenging environment for the Group we 
stabilised customer service following the implementation of 
our complex ERP system upgrade, continued to invest in our 
brands, people and distribution platforms. We can look forward 
to advancing our growth objectives in FY2025 and beyond 
from a solid foundation. Our decision to re-instate dividends 
and return capital in the form of a share buyback programme 
reflects both the strength of our capital structure and our on-
going free cash flow conversion.”
Ralph Findlay
Chair & Chief Executive Officer 
C&C Group’s portfolio of owned/exclusive 
brands include: Bulmers, the leading 
Irish cider brand; Tennent’s, the leading 
Scottish beer brand; Magners, the premium 
international cider brand; as well as a range 
of fast-growing, premium and craft ciders 
and beers, such as Heverlee, Menabrea, 
Five Lamps and Orchard Pig. 
C&C exports its Magners and Tennent’s 
brands to over 40 countries worldwide. 
C&C has owned brand and contract 
manufacturing/packing operations in Co. 
Tipperary, Ireland and Glasgow, Scotland. 
C&C is the No. 1 drinks distributor to 
the UK and Ireland hospitality sectors. 
Operating through the Matthew Clark, 
Bibendum, Tennent’s and Bulmers Ireland 
brands, the Group has a market leading 
range, scale and reach including an 
intimate understanding of the markets it 
serves. Together this provides a key route-
to-market for major international beverage 
companies.
C&C Group plc is headquartered in 
Dublin and is listed on the London Stock 
Exchange.
bulmers.ie
matthewclark.co.uk
tennents.co.uk

Contents
Strategic Report
2
Chair’s Statement
6
Vision, Purpose and Values
7
Divisional Structure
8
Our Engagement with Stakeholders
10
Chief Executive Officer’s Review
14
Operating Review
20
Group Strategy
22
Business Model
25
How we create sustainable value
30
Key Performance Indicators
32
Management of Risks and Uncertainties
42
Task Force for Climate Related Financial Disclosures
53
Chief Financial Officer’s Review
59
Sustainability Report
Governance Report
91
Governance at a Glance
92
Directors and Officers
94
Corporate Governance Report
108
Directors’ Report
114
Audit Committee Report
123
Environmental, Social and Governance Committee Report
127
Nomination Committee Report
136
Directors’ Remuneration Committee Report
164
Statement of Directors’ Responsibilities
Financial Statements
166
Independent Auditor’s Report
182
Consolidated Income Statement
183
Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income
184
Consolidated Balance Sheet
185
Consolidated Cash Flow Statement
186
Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity
187
Company Balance Sheet
188
Company Statement of Changes In Equity
189
Statement of Accounting Policies
205
Notes Forming Part of the Financial Statements
272
Financial Definitions
Additional Information
275
Shareholder and Other Information
Financial Highlights
Results
Net Revenue
€1,652.5m
Decrease of 1.5% on a constant currency basis
Operating Profit before Exceptional Items
€60.0m
Operating Loss after Exceptional Items
€84.4m
Balance Sheet
Liquidity
€390.1m 
Net Debt/Adjusted EBITDA Including Leases
1.8x
Net Debt Including Leases
€168.0m
Cash
Free cash flow conversion excluding Exceptional 
items
91.4% 
Free cash flow conversion
68.1% 
1
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Chair’s Statement 
 
For the financial year ended 29 February 2024 net revenue was 
€1,652.5m, broadly in line with last year (i)(ii). Profit before taxation 
and exceptional items was €38.8m (FY2023: €65.9m (i)). After 
taxation and exceptional items, the loss for the year was €113.5m 
(FY2023: profit of €40.3m (i)), with a net loss per share(iii) of 29.0 cent 
(FY2023: profit of 10.3 cent per share (i)(iii)). 
The Group has incurred significant Exceptional operating costs 
of €144.4m. Of the total, €125.0m relates to a non-cash reduction 
in intangible assets (goodwill) associated with the Magners brand 
in the C&C Brands Cash Generating Unit in the UK. Magners 
contributes modest profit and is distributed in the UK through a 
third party. Other exceptional costs include €7.6m of restructuring 
costs associated with the exit from Park Royal depot in London 
and the opening of a larger, more efficient new London depot, 
together with redundancy and other costs associated with 
restructuring the business to be more focused, efficient, and 
responsive to our customers’ needs. Also included is €10.4m 
of costs relating to the implementation of the ERP (Enterprise 
Resource Planning) system within Mathew Clark in February 2023.
The Board regret the impact of the accounting issues highlighted 
in this report and have moved swiftly and decisively to address this 
serious matter. With my colleagues on the Board, we are working 
to significantly improve standards of corporate governance and 
ethical leadership.
The challenges of the ERP implementation were described in 
detail last year. I am pleased to report that the service-related 
issues have been addressed and that service is fully restored to 
at least pre-EPR implementation levels. Customer feedback over 
the key Christmas and New Year trading period was very positive, 
indicating that we are now achieving industry-leading service 
levels. The overall cost of the ERP recovery was material with lost 
business accounted for within pre-exceptional operating profit. 
Customer retention and gains remain priorities for Mathew Clark.
Operationally, our key objectives have been to restore service and 
margins in Mathew Clark, and to continue to make progress in our 
key brands, Bulmers Irish Cider and Tennent’s lager. Branded net 
revenue increased by 4.1%(i)(ii) to €312.7m, and branded operating 
profit by 12.3% (i)(ii)(iv) to €44.6m. Bulmers and Tennent’s performed 
strongly in their respective markets, with both brands gaining 
market share (v)(vi). Volumes of other premium beers including 
Menabrea, Five Lamps and Heverlee were up 18%. 
"We are a highly 
cash generative 
business and are 
well-positioned to 
execute our long-term 
strategy."
Ralph Findlay 
Chair & Chief Executive Officer
2
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Leverage and capital allocation 
Leverage(vii) was 1.8x at the year-end, within 
our target range of 1.5x-2.0x, reflecting the 
strong underlying cash flow of the business 
and despite the one-off costs of the ERP 
implementation and restructuring costs. 
Capital investment during FY2024 
continued to be focused on our brands, 
our systems, and in ensuring that our 
supply chain operates to high standards of 
legislative compliance and efficiency, and 
that they meet rigorous environmental and 
sustainability targets.
The business generates surplus cash after 
appropriate levels of brand marketing, 
capital investment and other necessary 
uses of funds. We have previously 
communicated our intention to deliver 
€150m to Shareholders over the next three 
years ending in February 2025, 2026 and 
2027 through an appropriate mix of share 
buybacks, dividends and special dividends 
depending upon circumstances at the time. 
We commenced a €15m share buyback 
programme on 1 March 2024 and subject 
to Shareholder approval, the Directors 
have proposed a final dividend of 3.97 
cent per share to be paid on 23 August 
2024 to ordinary Shareholders registered 
at the close of business on 19 July 2024. 
An interim dividend of 1.89 cent per share 
was paid in December, making a full year 
dividend of 5.86 cent per share. 
Our current intention is to return €50m to 
shareholders in the current financial year 
ending February 2025. At the same time, 
we remain alert to the potential for other 
organic or acquisitive growth opportunities 
which strengthen our market position, 
improve performance and create value for 
Shareholders. 
Governance 
During the year, we made several key 
appointments to the Board.
Andrew Andrea joined as Chief Financial 
Officer and Executive Director on 1 
March 2024, and Angela Bromfield, Chris 
Browne OBE and Sarah Newbitt joined 
as independent Non-Executive Directors 
in July 2023; August 2023, and October 
2023 respectively. Their backgrounds and 
experience are described in detail on pages 
92 to 93 of this report. I am delighted that 
we have been able to strengthen the Board 
with these key appointments.
After serving almost nine years on the 
Board Vincent Crowley, Non-Executive 
Director, will step down from the Board 
at the conclusion of the Company’s 2024 
Annual General Meeting. Vincent stepped 
down from his role as Senior Independent 
Director with effect from 15 February 2024 
and was succeeded by Chris Browne OBE 
with effect from the same date. I would like 
to thank Vincent for his dedication to C&C 
and his significant contribution to the Board 
over that period, and for his support to me 
as Chair over the last two years.
In addition, we made several changes to 
the composition of Board Committees, with 
effect from 6 December 2023, as outlined in 
detail in the Directors and Officers report on 
pages 108 to 113.
During the year I served as Executive 
Chair, reverting to Non-Executive Chair 
following Andrew Andrea’s appointment 
to the Board on 1 March 2024. On 6 June 
this year, Patrick McMahon stepped down 
as CEO and I was appointed as CEO with 
immediate effect.  It is expected that I will 
perform the role of CEO for between 12 
to 18 months to ensure stability within the 
senior leadership team and execution of 
strategy, while remaining as Chair of the 
Board. On 6 June 2024 I stepped down 
as Chair of the Nomination Committee 
and Chris Browne was appointed to this 
position.
Andrew Andrea 
joined as Chief 
Financial Officer 
and Executive 
Director on 1 March 
2024, and Angela 
Bromfield, Chris 
Browne OBE and 
Sarah Newbitt joined 
as independent 
Non-Executive 
Directors in July 
2023; August 2023, 
and October 2023 
respectively.
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
3

Chair’s Statement
(continued)
We remain committed to supporting our 
colleagues’ physical and mental wellbeing 
and initiated several developments. This 
year we reached our target number of 
colleagues who have trained as Mental 
Health First Aiders to support each other, 
and proudly have 120 who can offer 
confidential support and advice across our 
business. In May 2023, C&C participated in 
Learning at Work week, designed to foster 
a culture of continuous learning, empower 
employees, and drive innovation. We 
continue to focus on developing the skills 
and capabilities of our colleagues, through 
broadening the number of apprenticeship 
level development programmes available 
and offering professional development. 
This year, this has been supported by 
the launch of our Management Academy 
which provides a group-wide approach to 
developing all our line managers.
 
Our two-year Diversity, Equity and 
Inclusion plan, launched this year, is 
set to champion gender diversity and 
employment opportunities for people from 
underrepresented and disadvantaged 
backgrounds, as well as creating 
opportunities for all our colleagues to fulfil 
their potential and take responsibility for 
their careers. To help inform our actions we 
are working in partnership with Diversity 
in Grocery and WiHTL, both external 
organisations, which support companies in 
creating inclusive environments.
The Board recognises the need to take 
regular temperature checks of employee 
engagement to continue to develop our 
people, culture, and values. At least two 
employee engagement surveys take place 
each year with the support of engagement 
specialists, Workday Peakon. Employee 
feedback and comments are reviewed by 
managers, and our Executive Committee 
and Board respond to the key areas of 
focus in order to improve our employees’ 
experience and to ensure we channel 
resources into the most significant areas.
This year has been a challenging one for 
our colleagues, and I thank each of them 
for their commitment, dedication, and 
enthusiasm for the business.
 
Environmental and Social 
Responsibility Commitments 
We recognise the important role that 
our industry plays in wider society but 
acknowledge and understand the key 
role we play in social responsibility within 
the local communities we serve. We take 
our responsibility seriously. In terms of 
strategic oversight, the Board has an ESG 
(Environment, Social and Governance) 
Committee that works alongside our 
ESG team to develop and execute our 
ESG strategy. Our ESG team includes 
representation from colleagues at all levels 
across the business to ensure varied and 
diverse inputs and a balanced strategy. This 
year’s Sustainability Report is set out on 
pages 59 to 89.
We are members of the Portman Group 
and Drinkaware, organisations which raise 
awareness of the potential for alcohol 
harm and to promote the responsible 
consumption of alcohol both with our 
customers and colleagues. We utilise both 
charities’ training resources to educate 
our colleagues through online and virtual 
group training sessions. We also produce 
a range of ‘no and low’ alcohol variants of 
our leading brands which we continue to 
develop.
Our work with communities continues 
through our partnership with The Big Issue 
Group and in line with our commitment we 
have made ten offers of employment to 
those Vendors who are ready to return to 
employment. We have also provided several 
Sheltered Pitch opportunities at our sites, 
providing a safe and warm place to sell the 
Big Issue whilst supporting vendors to hone 
their selling skills and build relationships 
with our colleagues.
 
It is important that the performance of 
the Board, its committees and individual 
Directors is rigorously reviewed. This year, 
an internal Board Performance Review was 
conducted by the Company Secretary, 
following on from last year’s external review 
and the results were encouraging. Key 
areas of Board strength continue to be its 
strong composition, shared passion, and 
the open and collaborative culture within 
the Board. Our progress against last year’s 
areas of focus, as well as the outcome 
of this year’s effectiveness review can be 
found on pages 105 and 106.
We believe that your Board has the 
necessary skills, experience, and diversity 
to support the management of the business 
as it executes our strategy, and we are 
committed to maintaining the highest 
standards of governance principles and 
practice, an overview of which is included 
on pages 94 to 107. 
People and Culture 
We are a business with a manufacturing 
footprint and depot network close to the 
customers and consumers we serve. We 
have world-class facilities and a network 
that is unrivalled in terms of reach and scale 
across the UK and Ireland. Undoubtedly, 
our people are at the very heart of our 
success, and I reiterate my sincere thanks 
to every one of my colleagues for their 
dedication and support in navigating the 
many challenges that we faced in FY2024. 
We have recently made several key 
leadership appointments who will each 
bring necessary experience and expertise 
to C&C in their respective areas. A Chief 
Technology Officer, a Chief Marketing 
Officer, a Chief Human Resources Officer 
and a Director of Health & Safety have 
recently joined our business. All are external 
appointments and are key leadership roles. I 
welcome them to the business.
 
4
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Care for the environment remains an 
integral part of the Group’s strategy. For 
this reason, ESG considerations are now 
part of our Executive remuneration policy, 
with an environmental target being included 
in the performance conditions of the 2023 
Long Term Incentive Plan (‘LTIP’). More 
details can be found in the Remuneration 
Committee Report on pages 136 to 163. 
We are committed to transitioning our 
operations to clean energy sources in line 
with our carbon reduction targets. 100% 
of the electricity across the Group’s main 
sites in the UK and Ireland comes from 
renewable sources., covering 95% of the 
Group’s total electricity use. In 2023 we 
installed Ireland’s largest rooftop solar array 
at our manufacturing facility in Clonmel and 
confirmed a Corporate Purchase Power 
Agreement (‘PPA’) obtaining electricity from 
the Cronalaght Wind Farm in Donegal. 
Whilst most of our electricity consumption 
is renewable; the Group recognises that 
this only constitutes a proportion of its 
operational emissions. To mitigate our 
Scope 1 emissions, the Group has invested 
heavily in decarbonisation projects including 
the implementation of electric Forklift Trucks 
(‘FLTs’) to our fleet, anaerobic digestion and 
biogas projects at our Wellpark Brewery, 
and the commissioning of a 1MW heat 
pump at our Clonmel manufacturing facility. 
At Wellpark, Boiler house Energy Recovery 
and Anaerobic Digestion Heat Recovery 
delivered a c.1,000 tonne CO2 reduction 
per annum. The Group’s waste reduction 
programme across our operations includes 
recycling and reducing packaging waste. 
This year we again met our target of 
sending zero waste to landfill. 100% of our 
products are sold in containers that can be 
recycled and 28% is already in returnable 
units.
 
Looking Forward 
We look forward to putting FY2024 
behind us and building on the foundations 
for growth that we have laid down. 
The improvements to systems and the 
enhanced capability of our teams will 
benefit our customers and performance. 
We target further development building on 
the inherent strength of our brands and 
distribution network and have a clear view 
of strategy and capital allocation.
Trading in the first quarter of FY2025 has 
been encouraging and in line with our 
expectations. Whilst we remain cautious 
about the consumer outlook for the 
year, the market dynamics indicate that 
consumers are seeking affordable treats 
including visits to pubs and restaurants. At 
this stage therefore there is no change to 
our expected earnings for FY25 and future 
years. We are a highly cash generative 
business and are well-positioned to execute 
our long-term strategy. 
Ralph Findlay 
Chair & Chief Executive Officer
Notes 
(i)	 FY2023 numbers have been restated to 
reflect the impact of a number of prior period 
adjustments as outlined in Note 31 of the 
Financial Statements.
(ii)	 FY2023 comparatives have been represented 
to be on a constant currency basis (FY2023 
translated at FY2024 FX rates).
(iii)	 Adjusted basic/diluted earnings per share (‘EPS’) 
excludes exceptional items. Please also see note 
9 of the financial statements.
(iv)	 Underlying numbers exclude the impact of 
exceptional items
(v)	 CGA OPM 52 w/e 24.02.24; IRI Circana, Total 
Grocery - Scotland, 52 w/e 24.02.24.
(vi)	 ROI CGA OPM 29.02.23; Nielson IQ Total off-
trade including Dunnes & Discounters 52 weeks 
to week ended 25.02.24 vs 52 weeks to end Feb 
2023.
(vii)	Leverage is Net Debt/Adjusted EBITDA.
(viii)	Net debt comprises borrowings (net of issue 
costs) less cash plus lease liabilities capitalised 
under IFRS 16 Leases. Net debt excluding 
leases comprises borrowings (net of issue costs) 
less cash.
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
5

Vision, Purpose and Values
We are committed to building a 
company that delivers long-term value, 
an organisation that has an affinity to 
the markets in which it operates, with 
sustainability and social responsibility at 
its forefront. 
 
With our Bulmers and Tennent’s brands, 
as well as our Matthew Clark business, 
C&C has a long and rich history at the 
core of the Company, augmented by 
continually evolving our offer to meet the 
demand of our consumers, customers 
and partner suppliers. 
Competitive
Respectful
Humble
Open
We put  
safety first
We keep it simple 
and remain agile
We are customer 
centric 
We are fact based, 
data and insight 
driven
We collaborate 
through trust
We learn to 
improve
Vision
To be the pre-eminent brand-led drinks 
distribution platform, serving the UK and 
Ireland drinks markets, generating stable 
margins, delivering strong free cash flow and 
returns for our Shareholders.  
Purpose
Play a role in every drinking occasion, 
delivering joy to our customers and 
consumers with remarkable brands and 
service. 
Our Values 
To respect people and our planet and 
aim to bring joy to life, ensuring quality is 
at the core of everything we do.
Our Culture
Our Behaviours
6
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

This segment includes the financial results 
from sale of the Group’s own branded 
products in Scotland, with Tennent’s, 
Caledonia Best, Heverlee and Magners 
the main brands. This division includes 
the sale of the Group’s portfolio of owned 
cider brands across the rest of GB, 
including Magners, Orchard Pig, K Cider 
and Blackthorn which are distributed in 
partnership with Budweiser Brewing Group. 
Our primary manufacturing plant is the 
Wellpark Brewery in Glasgow, with major 
distribution and administration centres in 
Glasgow, Bristol and London.
The division includes Tennent’s Direct, 
Scotland’s leading drinks distributor which 
serves the Scottish on-trade with an 
unrivalled range of drinks led by beer and 
cider, and includes exclusive distribution of 
Moët Hennessy products, such as Moët 
and Glenmorangie, and UK distribution 
of international brands Tsingtao and 
Menabrea. 
The segment includes the financial 
results from Matthew Clark, the largest 
independent distributor to the GB on-trade 
drinks sector. Matthew Clark delivers a 
market leading composite drinks range 
across Wine, Spirits, beer, cider, and soft 
drinks including a number of exclusive 
distribution agreements with wine 
producers and third-party brands.
Ireland
In addition, it includes Bibendum, 
the UK’s leading independent wine 
specialist servicing customers across 
the on-trade, independent retail (through 
Walker & Wodehouse) and off-trade 
nationwide. Delivering a market leading 
range of premium wine, a selection of 
exclusive globally recognised artisan and 
innovative wine producers.
The Group’s Tennent’s Direct, Matthew 
Clark and Bibendum distribution 
businesses operate a nationwide 
distribution network serving the 
independent free trade, national 
accounts, independent retail and off-
trade customers.
This segment also includes the financial 
results from the sale and distribution 
of the Group’s own branded products, 
principally Magners and Tennent’s 
outside of the UK and Ireland. The 
Group exports to over 40 countries 
globally, notably in continental Europe, 
North America, Asia and Australia. 
The Group operates mainly through 
local distributors in these markets and 
regions. This segment also includes 
the sale of the Group’s cider and beer 
products in the US and Canada.
Divisional Structure
Great Britain (GB)
C&C’s Ireland division includes the financial 
results from the sale of the Group’s own 
branded products across the Island of 
Ireland, principally Bulmers, Magners, 
Tennent’s, Five Lamps, Clonmel 1650 
and Heverlee. The Group also operates 
the Bulmers Ireland drinks distribution 
business, a leading distributor of third-party 
drinks to the licensed on and off-trades 
in Ireland. The Group distributes San 
Miguel and Budweiser Brewing Group’s 
portfolio of beer brands across the Island 
of Ireland on an exclusive basis. Our 
primary manufacturing plant is located 
in Clonmel, Co. Tipperary, with major 
distribution and administration centres in 
Dublin and Culcavy, Northern Ireland.
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
7

Our Engagement with Stakeholders
We aim to maintain open and positive dialogue with all our 
stakeholders. Our stakeholders are a critical part of our operations 
and are referenced throughout this report. We have set out below 
details of who our key stakeholders are, and how we engage with 
them. For our Section 172 Statement, please see page 100. 
Area of Focus
Why we engage 
How we engage
Employees
Our colleagues and contractors who work in our business
Health, safety, and wellbeing
Investment in learning and 
development
Promotion of equality, 
diversity, and inclusion 
Recognition and careers
C&C strategy, culture, and 
values
Sustainability
Our people sit at the heart of 
our business. Without them we 
would not succeed. We want 
our people to thrive in a fair and 
inclusive work environment, to 
ensure that C&C has the most 
engaged, inspired and committed 
colleagues.
Employee communications - weekly and monthly online and face 
to face briefings, Regular site visits and roadshows with Senior 
Management, Employee engagement surveys, Employee forums with 
Non-Executive Directors, Focus on Health and Wellbeing via healthcare 
benefits and Employee Resource Groups. Promote Diversity, Equity, 
and Inclusion (‘DE&I’) via a Group wide Advisory Group, Remote and 
Hybrid working and Right to Disconnect policies, Employee Assistance 
Programmes including Whistleblowing Helpline, Annual Reviews, 
Learning and Talent Development programmes, Board level ESG 
Committee to develop strategy and Group wide ESG Champions to 
advocate sustainability.
Communities
The people who live in the local communities around  
our sites and operations
Fair employment and equal 
opportunities
Local causes and issues
To build trust by operating 
responsibly and sustainably 
and investing in people and 
addressing issues that are 
material to our communities. 
We support local and national charities and community groups to raise 
awareness and funds to help deserving causes. Building on our existing 
outreach work and initiatives which have empowered people from 
marginalised communities, in September 2022 the Group announced 
a three-year partnership with the Big Issue Group. This tie up is with 
a social enterprise that aims to change lives through enterprise and 
is aligned to C&C’s charitable agenda around tackling the complex 
social issues of homelessness, addiction, poverty, and mental health. 
We have also introduced a Group wide volunteering policy, allowing 
all colleagues time off to volunteer, whether it be for our Big Issue 
Community Partnership, or local charities, community initiatives and 
causes that are of personal interest or relevant to our brands and 
Business Units.
Consumers
The people who drink our products
Create joyful moments as 
consumers enjoy one of our 
drinks with family, friends and 
loved ones
Staying ahead of changing 
consumer lifestyles and habits 
which impact how people 
want to drink 
Making sure that our beverage 
offer is sustainable and good 
for the planet
Safe products and 
environments
We strive to build lasting bonds 
with consumers built on quality, 
relevance, authenticity, and trust.
On occasions when consumers 
choose alcohol, we want them to 
“drink better, not more.”
Using our in-house data and insight capabilities, we develop powerful 
and unique brand positions that engage consumers.
We invest in and nurture our brands, to develop campaigns, 
experiences and associations that resonate with consumers. 
We utilise the appropriate experiences and channels to reach our 
consumers. 
Our brands are available and visible in the correct outlets and in the 
correct formats to meet every drinking occasion.
We are committed to responsible advertising and marketing. By training 
staff and via active engagement and education of consumers, C&C 
promotes moderation to reduce the harmful use of alcohol.
C&C’s core brands are rooted in their communities, and we adopt the 
highest Ethical and Sustainable standards in sourcing our products and 
services.
The Group continuously innovates by sourcing and developing new 
products that meet consumer needs and preferences.
8
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Suppliers
Our partners who supply products and services
Product quality and 
authenticity
Workplace health and safety
Ethical and sustainable 
supply chain reducing our 
environmental impact and 
making positive contributions 
to society
Innovation in creation of new 
brands
Working collaboratively to ensure 
resilience and availability in 
our supply chain to deliver the 
best possible service and value 
for money for customers and 
consumers.
Identify opportunities for 
profitable, sustainable growth.
Collaborate to improve ethical 
and sustainable approach. 
Suppliers must sign up to our Code of Conduct and Anti Modern 
Slavery policies as well as provide detailed information on their Ethical 
and Sustainable approach.
The Group has received validation from the Science Based Targets 
initiative of our target of ensuring that suppliers and customers making 
up 67% of our Scope 3 emissions, will have science-based targets in 
place by 2026. The Company, by participating in the CDP Supply Chain 
Screening programme, will continuously collaborate with suppliers and 
customers to support them to set science-based targets for their own 
emissions by 2026.
Conduct formal supplier surveys, reviews, and audits.
Focus on learning and development to build Ethical and Sustainable 
procurement capability across the Group. 
Investments in third-party innovative and new brands.
Shareholders  
and Lenders
Individuals or institutions that own shares in C&C Group plc  
or provide financing
Financial performance
Strategic priorities
Corporate governance
Leadership and succession 
planning
Executive remuneration policy
Shareholder returns
Environmental and social 
commitments and progress
Our philosophy is to engage in 
regular, open, and transparent 
dialogue with our existing and 
prospective Shareholders and 
lenders. We value their thoughts 
and opinions which are shared 
with the Board. The Board 
reviews the feedback and takes 
appropriate actions where 
necessary.
We engage with our existing investors through one-to-one and group 
meetings, webcasts, presentations, conference calls and at our AGM. 
The Group Finance and Investor Relations Director holds responsibility 
for the investor relations programme, and the Group CEO and Group 
CFO dedicate significant time to engaging with our major Shareholders. 
The Executive Chair, other Board members and the Group General 
Counsel and Company Secretary also engage with our Shareholders 
on other matters, such as Environmental, Social and Governance (ESG) 
topics. We engage with lenders primarily through Group Finance and 
the Group CFO.
The Group has built ESG KPI’s into its most recent Debtor Securitisation 
and Refinancing programmes.
Customers
Our customers, who are experts in the products they buy and sell,  
as well as in the experience they create and deliver
Identification of opportunities 
that offer profitable 
sustainable growth insights 
into consumer behaviour 
and trends, innovation, 
promotional support and 
merchandising and technical 
expertise
Our passion is to ensure we 
nurture mutually beneficial 
relationships that deliver joint 
value and the best outcome for 
all our consumers.
Collaborate to improve ethical 
and sustainable performance.
We engage through the use of best practice sales analytics and 
technology to support our retailers, ongoing dialogue and account 
management support and physical and virtual sales calls.
Our award-winning market insight capability identifies product range 
based on occasionality, consumer demand and market trends.
The three distinct pillars of C&C’s growth strategy; brand strength, 
distribution strength and sustainability provide a comprehensive “one-
stop shop” for licensed premises owners. 
These pillars are underpinned by our offer: dedicated and passionate 
people, enhanced customer service and value.
Governments 
and Regulators
Regional and national government bodies and agencies  
which implement and enforce applicable laws across our industry
Positive drinking programmes 
and impacts
Wider sustainability agenda 
including human rights, 
environmental impacts
Legal and regulatory 
compliance
To communicate our views to 
those who have responsibility 
for implementing policy, laws, 
and regulations relevant to our 
businesses.
Ongoing dialogue, collaboration on responsible drinking initiatives 
and promotion of moderation, strengthening industry standards and 
participation in governments’ business and industry advisory groups.
Supporting the introduction of Deposit Return Schemes in the Republic 
of Ireland.
Contributing to UK Governments’ consultations including Alcohol Duty 
Review (UK) and Alcohol Marketing Restrictions and Minimum Unit 
Pricing Review (Scotland).
Adopting globally recognised emission reporting standards including 
CDP and Science Based Targets Initiative. 
Reporting on climate impacts via Taskforce on Climate-Related 
Financial Disclosures (‘TCFD’).
Engaging openly with UK and Ireland tax authorities.
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
9

Chief Executive Officer’s Review
Set against a challenging market backdrop, we are pleased with 
the performance of our core brands in FY2024 with Tennent’s and 
Bulmers gaining share in Scotland and the Republic of Ireland(i)(ii). 
Premiumisation remains a key strategic focus for the Group with our 
Premium beer brands in GB delivering volume growth of 24% in the 
year. Premium beer in the year now represents 9% of total branded 
revenue.
During the period the Group has faced significant internal 
challenges and has carried out detailed independent and internal 
reviews of inventory control and accounting across the Group 
balance sheet. The results of that review were disclosed in 
June and disappointingly highlighted a number of items which 
have resulted in the restatement of past results. The path to 
understanding and resolving these issues started with the early 
steps outlined in this Report, which will continue and accelerate 
during FY2025.
As previously communicated, the implementation of a complex 
ERP system upgrade in our Matthew Clark and Bibendum GB 
distribution business had a material impact in FY2024. However, 
service levels, defined as On-Time-In-Full (“OTIF”) have been 
restored back to pre-ERP implementation levels and we believe 
our service levels were industry leading over the key Christmas 
trading period. The ERP system upgrade is a key step in our 
digital transformation and optimisation program in GB. While 
acknowledging the implementation did not go as planned initially, 
the system upgrade will enhance the service we provide to our 
customers, improve efficiency and capacity utilisation through more 
“In a challenging environment and year for the Group, we 
have stabilised the business and continue to make good 
strategic progress. We continue to simplify the Group; 
enhance operating efficiency; maintain balance sheet 
strength; and, to focus on rebuilding profitability. Our 
decision to re-instate a progressive dividend stream reflects 
our commitment to provide Shareholders with certainty of 
value. Equally, our decision to return capital in the form of 
a share buyback programme reflects both the strength of 
our capital structure and our ongoing free cash generation. 
It also reflects the Board’s belief that it represents the most 
effective use of capital.”
Ralph Findlay 
Chair & Chief Executive Officer
10
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

automated processes. The investment 
reflects the Group’s commitment to deliver 
market leading customer service through 
GB’s preeminent distribution platform.
Despite these challenges, we have 
continued to execute our strategy by: 
strengthening our portfolio and distribution 
businesses; premiumising our portfolio; 
enhancing our customer offering; investing 
in technology; driving efficiencies in our 
network and support office functions; 
improving capability in key management 
roles, and, ensuring we continue to meet 
our ambitious sustainability commitments. 
Our Team & Partners
Our people are passionate about our 
brands and delivering outstanding service 
to our valued customers and supplier 
partners. I’m extremely grateful to each one 
of my colleagues for their dedication and 
support in navigating the challenges we 
faced in FY2024. 
The simplification of the business includes 
the strengthening of the capability of the 
Group Executive Committee comprising 
the creation of Group functional roles rather 
than geography specific management 
teams.  In recent months we have had 
external appointments in Finance (Industry 
Veteran Andrew Andrea, CFO), Marketing 
(Cara Chambers, CMO), Human Resource 
(Lynette Eastman, CHRO) and Technology 
(Carole Kingsbury, CTO), together with the 
retention of our very experienced Chief 
Commercial Officer (Barry Sheehan) and 
Chief Operating Officer (Andrea Pozzi).
The health and safety of our colleagues is 
our utmost priority and one which we will 
continue to invest in to ensure we continue 
to provide a safe workplace for all. We 
recognise that the needs of employees have 
evolved post the COVID-19 pandemic, and 
we continue to respond to those needs, 
actively engaging with our employees, 
implementing initiatives such as flexible 
working policies and employee resource 
groups, as well as enhancements to our 
employee healthcare provision. In addition, 
we have 120 trained mental health first 
aiders across all our operations. 
We have established a Diversity, Equity, 
and Inclusion Group made up of employees 
from across our business, who are 
passionate about fostering a welcoming 
culture where everyone feels comfortable 
to be themselves. We are pleased that 
our 2023 Mean and Median Gender Pay 
Gap metrics for the UK and Ireland are in 
favour of female employees, indicating that 
the average pay for female employees is 
higher compared to male employees. We 
have also strengthened our efforts to recruit 
women into Leadership roles and have 
achieved a noticeable change, 42% of our 
Group Executive Committee and 57% of all 
CEO direct reports are female. As part of 
our commitment in this important area, we 
have recently launched our enriched Family 
Leave policies to ensure that everyone at 
C&C is enabled to balance their working 
responsibilities with their personal priorities 
and the important people in their lives.  
 
Alongside many of our customers and 
partner suppliers, we are active members 
of both the Portman Group and Drinkaware 
organisations to raise awareness of alcohol 
harm and to promote the responsible 
consumption of alcohol. We continually 
utilise training resources to educate our 
colleagues through online and virtual group 
training sessions.
Shareholder Returns
Leverage was 1.8x(iii) at the year-end, within 
our target range of 1.5x-2.0x, which reflects 
the strong cash generation capabilities.  
We announced in October 2023 our 
intention to deliver €150m to Shareholders 
over the next three financial years (FY2025 
– FY2027) through an appropriate mix of 
share buybacks, dividends and special 
dividends depending upon circumstances 
at the time.  We commenced a €15m share 
buyback programme on 1 March 2024 
and subject to Shareholder approval, the 
Directors have proposed a final dividend 
of 3.97 cent per share to be paid on 23 
August 2024 to ordinary shareholders 
registered at the close of business on 19 
July 2024. An interim dividend of 1.89 cent 
Our brands are key 
to the success of our 
business. We have 
continued to invest in 
our branded portfolio, 
with direct brand 
marketing equating 
to 9% of branded net 
revenue. 
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
11

per share was paid in December 2023, 
resulting in a full year dividend of 5.86 
cents per share.  Our current intention is to 
return €50m to Shareholders in the current 
financial year ending February 2025. At the 
same time, we remain alert to the potential 
for other organic or acquisitive growth 
opportunities which would strengthen our 
market position, improve performance and 
create value for Shareholders. We would 
benchmark any such opportunity against 
the value implied by the Group’s prevailing 
market multiple.
Brand Strength 
Our brands are key to the success of our 
business. We have continued to invest in 
our branded portfolio, with direct brand 
marketing equating to 9% of branded net 
revenue. While this investment is 1ppts 
lower than last year it is a significant 
increase from pre COVID-19 levels of 5.8% 
in FY2020. This, together with our strong 
distribution business in Scotland and Ireland 
has resulted in increased visibility for our 
brands with enhanced levels of activity, both 
in advertising as well as in-outlet activation. 
Tennent’s, the leading beer brand in 
Scotland, continues to perform strongly. 
Net Sales Revenue within GB was up 13% 
on volumes that were down 1%. Across 
combined on- and off-trade in Scotland, 
Tennent's gained 0.3%ppts volume 
share of beer, to 29.0%(i). We continue to 
successfully and efficiently invest in the 
Brand. A new brand platform of "Raised 
in Scotland" led to an investment in an 
"OOOFT!" campaign which launched in 
July, across TV, Out of home & digital 
medial channels, conveying the emotional 
triumph in the first sip of Tennent's. OOOFT! 
breakthrough communication platform 
connected with consumers, delivering 
the Brand's best ever recorded brand 
health score- growing from an index of 
14 to 19 (with Quality seeing the greatest 
improvement) whilst lager competitors 
declined year on year(iv). We also continued 
our partnership with Scottish Rugby Union, 
in the lead up to and during the Rugby 
World Cup. OOOFT! and Rugby World Cup 
campaign delivered combined reach to all 
Scottish adults of 97% at a frequency of 17 
times(v).
We were pleased with the performance 
of our iconic Bulmers brand in Ireland 
with Net Revenue growth of 8% relative 
to the prior period. Between the on and 
off-trade, Bulmers remains the largest and 
most popular cider brand in the Republic 
of Ireland ("ROI")(ii). Aided by our marketing 
campaign, Bulmers total ROI market share, 
from a volume perspective, increased by 
0.2ppt to 59.5% at the end of Feb 2024(ii) 
while the Bulmers brand index (equity 
measure) increased by 10% over the same 
period(vi).   
Premiumisation remains a strategic focus 
for our business and in GB our premium 
beer brands delivered volume growth of 
24% and net revenue growth of 27% in 
the period. Menebrea’s volumes and net 
sales revenue in GB were up 30% relative 
to the prior financial year. A number of 
new national listings for Menebrea were 
secured this year including Loungers & 
Cosy Club in the On-trade and Waitrose 
in the Off-trade. Heverlee also performed 
strongly with volumes in GB up 22% and 
net sales revenue up 34%. Growing our 
premium portfolio, anchored by our iconic 
Tennent’s and Bulmers brands is important 
as premiumisation across almost all drinks 
categories for consumers remains evident 
and is the focus of much investment by the 
industry.
Distribution Strength 
The implementation of a complex ERP 
system upgrade in our GB distribution 
business had a material impact on 
performance in FY2024. Net Revenue for 
the Group’s GB distribution business was 
down 3.6% on the prior financial year with 
operating profit down €29.5m primarily 
as a consequence of the ERP system 
upgrade issues (vii)(viii). Adverse mix, both 
from a customer and product perspective, 
continue to impact performance.
 
Our clear priority for FY2024 was to restore 
service levels, defined as OTIF. Thankfully 
service levels have been fully restored to 
pre-ERP implementation levels and we 
believe they were industry leading in the GB 
distribution business over the key Christmas 
trading period, reflecting the Group’s 
commitment to deliver market leading 
customer service through GB’s preeminent 
distribution platform. In February 2024 we 
also successfully transitioned to a new 
London Distribution depot ‘Orbital West’ 
Group Chief Executive Officer’s Review
(continued)
12
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

which will enhance the service we provide 
our customers in London and the wider 
region. Situated near Heathrow Airport, our 
113,600 sq. ft facility is 40% larger than our 
previous London depot and underlines the 
Group’s significant investment in increased 
capacity in growth areas and ongoing 
commitment to industry-leading customer 
service.
In Ireland, the Distribution business had 
net revenue growth of 7.8% in the year on 
volumes that were down 2.4%. We were 
particularly pleased with the performance of 
Corona where net revenue was up 17.8% on 
volumes that were up 5.2%, and San Miguel 
where volumes increased 27.2% in the 
period. Corona is now the No 1 Premium 
Lager in the ROI off-trade with a market 
share of 17.3% (ix). Within the ROI on-trade 
we are seeing positive impact from the 
rollout of Corona Draught(x). 
Sustainability 
The Group has put in place various 
decarbonisation initiatives in the last year, 
aimed at reducing our Scope 1 and 2 
emissions. In FY2024 the Group exceeded 
its carbon reduction target of 4.0% mp.a., 
to deliver our validated science-based 
target, with Scope 1 and 2 (Location Based) 
carbon emissions down 3.0ktCo2e (-10%) 
vs FY2023. This brings our total Scope 
1 and 2 carbon reduction (vs our 2020 
baseline year) to 8.9 ktC02e (-24%). C&C 
retains a “AA” rating (placing us in the top 
c30% in beverage sector) from leading ESG 
Ratings Agency, MSCI.
We acknowledge the positive role our 
industry plays in society and our position 
within it as a producer and distributor of 
alcoholic beverages. We are passionate 
about ensuring the safe and responsible 
consumption of alcohol in society. In that 
context, we use our marketing assets to 
promote responsible consumption and are 
active members of both the Portman Group 
and Drinkaware. 
Our sustainability commitments and 
achievements are disclosed in more detail 
on in the Sustainability Report on pages 59 
to 89.
Summary and Outlook
Trading in the first quarter of FY2025 
has been encouraging and is in line with 
our expectations. The Group is well 
placed to take advantage of the critical 
summer period ahead, including the 
Euro '24 tournament which includes the 
participation of the Scottish and English 
football teams. Whilst we remain cautious 
about the consumer outlook for the 
year, the market dynamics indicate that 
consumers are seeking affordable treats 
including visits to pubs and restaurants.  
At this stage therefore there is no change 
to our expected earnings for FY25 and 
future years.
Our focus for the year ahead will remain:
•	 The health, safety and wellbeing and 
success of our colleagues;
•	 Simplifying our business and allocating 
resources to ensure that C&C is the 
partner of choice for customers and 
suppliers alike.
•	 Improving our operational effectiveness, 
enhancing core brands, building our 
premium beer portfolio and rebuilding 
profitability.
•	 Deliver value to Shareholders through 
dividends, share buybacks and other 
organic or acquisition growth initiatives.
Ralph Findlay 
Chair & Chief Executive Officer 
Notes 
(i)	 CGA OPM 52 w/e 24.02.24; IRI Circana, Total 
Grocery - Scotland, 52 w/e 24.02.24.
(ii)	 ROI CGA OPM 29.02.23; Nielson IQ Total off-
trade including Dunnes & Discounters 52 weeks 
to week ended 25.02.24 vs 52 weeks to end Feb 
2023.
(iii)	 Leverage is Net Debt/Adjusted EBITDA.
(iv)	 You Gov to end of 2023.  
(v)	 Media post campaign analysis - Clear Decisions 
run across campaign period.
(vi)	 YouGov, period Feb'23 to Feb'24.
(vii)	FY2023 numbers have been restated to 
reflect the impact of a number of prior period 
adjustments as outlined in Note 31 of the 
Group’s financial statements.
(viii)	FY2023 comparatives have been represented 
to be on a constant currency basis (FY2023 
translated at FY2024 FX rates).
(ix)	 Nielson IQ Total off-trade including Dunnes & 
Discounters 52 weeks to week ending 25.02.24 
vs 52 weeks to end Feb 2023
	
ROI CGA OPM 29.02.23
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
13

Great Britain
€m Great Britain 
Constant currency(i)(ii)
FY2024 
 FY2023
Change %
Net revenue
1,366.2
1,406.4
(2.9%)
of which Branded
202.8
192.9
5.1%
of which Distribution
1,143.8
1,186.5
(3.6%)
of which Co-pack / Other 
19.6
27.0
(27.4%)
Operating profit (iii) 
33.7
57.9
(41.8%)
of which Branded
27.8
22.5
23.6%
of which Distribution 
5.9
35.4
(83.3%)
Operating margin
2.5%
4.1%
(1.6ppts)
Volume – (kHL)
4,444
4,479
(0.8%)
 
Operating Review
As previously communicated, the 
implementation of a complex ERP system 
upgrade in our Matthew Clark and 
Bibendum (‘MCB’) business had a material 
impact on the performance of the GB 
distribution business in FY2024. Service 
levels, defined as On-Time-In-Full (‘OTIF’), 
have fully recovered and we believe they 
were industry leading in the GB distribution 
business over the key Christmas trading 
period reflecting the Group’s commitment 
to deliver market leading customer service 
through GB’s preeminent distribution 
platform. In February 2024 we also 
successfully transitioned to a new London 
Distribution depot, with no impact to 
customer service.
Net revenue of the Group’s GB business 
was down 2.9% compared to the prior 
period, with operating profit down €24.5m 
principally reflecting the ERP disruption.  
14
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Branded
Branded Revenue was up 5.1% in the 
year with Branded Margins improving by 
2.0ppts(i)(ii). Tennent’s, the leading beer 
brand in Scotland, continues to perform 
strongly. Net Sales Revenue within GB 
was up 13% on volumes that were down 
1%. Across combined on- and off-trade 
in Scotland, Tennent's gained 0.3%ppts 
volume share of beer, to 29.0%(iv). We 
continue to successfully and efficiently 
invest in the Brand. A new brand platform 
of "Raised in Scotland" led to an investment 
in an "OOOFT!" campaign which launched 
in July, across TV, Out of home & digital 
medial channels, conveying the emotional 
triumph in the first sip of Tennent's. OOOFT! 
breakthrough communication platform 
connected with consumers, delivering 
the Brand's best ever recorded brand 
health score- growing from an index of 
14 to 19 (with Quality seeing the greatest 
improvement) whilst lager competitors 
declined year on year(v). We also continued 
our partnership with Scottish Rugby Union, 
in the lead up to and during the Rugby 
World Cup. OOOFT! and Rugby World Cup 
campaign delivered combined reach to all 
Scottish adults of 97% at a frequency of 17 
times(vi).
Our Premium beer brands delivered volume 
growth of 24% and net revenue growth of 
27% in the period. Menebrea’s volumes and 
net sales revenue were up 30% relative to 
the prior financial year. A number of new 
national listings for Menebrea were secured 
this year including Loungers & Cosy Club in 
the On-trade and Waitrose in the Off-trade. 
Heverlee also performed strongly with 
volumes up 22% and net sales revenue up 
34%. 
Magners, which is distributed in the UK 
through a third-party, volumes in GB were 
down 18% in the period with net revenue 
down 10%. Magners contributes modest 
profit to the Group. At 29 February 2024, 
reflective of the performance of the Magners 
brand in the UK we booked an exceptional 
charge of €125.0m relating to a non-cash 
reduction in intangible assets (goodwill) 
associated with the Magners brand in the 
C&C Brands Cash Generating Unit in the 
UK. 
The Group put in place various 
decarbonisation initiatives in FY2024, aimed 
at tackling our Scope 1 and 2 emissions. 
In Wellpark, the Group’s Glasgow based 
manufacturing facility, these included 
re-insulation of hot liquor tanks, steam 
network rationalisation and Brewhouse CIP 
reduction at Wellpark. Overall, the Group 
exceeded its carbon reduction target in 
FY2024.
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
15

Distribution
The implementation of a complex ERP 
system upgrade in our Matthew Clark 
and Bibendum (“MCB”) business had a 
material impact on the performance of the 
GB distribution business in FY2024. Net 
Revenue of the Group’s GB distribution 
business was down 3.6% relative to the 
prior financial year with operating profit 
down €29.5m, primarily as a consequence 
of the ERP system upgrade issues. 
Adverse mix, both from a customer and 
product perspective, continue to impact 
performance. 
Service levels, defined as On-Time-In-Full 
(“OTIF”), have been fully restored to pre-ERP 
implementation levels and we believe they 
were industry leading in the GB distribution 
business over the key Christmas trading 
period reflecting the Group’s commitment 
to deliver market leading customer service 
through GB’s preeminent distribution 
platform. In February 2024 we also 
successfully transitioned to a new London 
Distribution depot “Orbital West” with no 
impact to customer service. This flagship 
facility underlines the Group’s significant 
investment in increased capacity and 
ongoing commitment to industry-leading 
customer service, as well as significantly 
contributing to our wider carbon reduction 
programme and sustainability agenda.  
From a market perspective(vii), while spend/
value was down 0.8% in FY2024 compared 
to the previous 12 months, volumes 
were down 2.2% with consumers buying 
fewer drinks. Beer and cider sales values 
have seen modest increases and have 
outperformed wine, spirits and RTDs, driven 
by a combination of occasionality towards 
lower-tempo and drinks-only occasions. 
This is reflected in the types of outlets 
where spend has been better protected 
(i.e. pubs), versus outlets that are more 
challenged (i.e. restaurants, nightclubs). 
Spirits sales eased after a bumper year 
last year, when the return to trade drove 
consumers to cocktails and shots for their 
up-tempo occasions. The decline in wine 
sales has also slowed with declines of 
0.6% value and 4.5% volume. Demand 
has been impacted by consumers cutting 
back on meals out and the subsequent 
underperformance of restaurants.
Operating Review (continued)
16
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Ireland
€m Ireland 
Constant currency(i)(ii)
FY2024
 FY2023
Change %
Net revenue
286.3
271.7
5.4%
of which Branded
109.9
107.4
2.3%
of which Distribution
174.9
162.2
7.8%
 of which Co-pack / other 
1.5
2.1
(28.6%)
Operating profit(ii) 
26.3
23.9
10.0%
of which Branded
16.8
17.2
(2.3%)
of which Distribution 
9.5
6.7
 41.8%
Operating margin
9.2%
8.8%
0.4pts
Volume – (kHL)
1,397
1,450
(3.7%)
Completely unaffected by the ERP issues 
in GB, our Ireland division’s net revenue 
increased by 5.4%(i)(ii) in the year to €286.3m. 
Operating profit(i)(ii)(iii) increased to €26.3m 
equating to a 10.0% increase year on 
year. Operating profit in the prior year has 
been restated as outlined in Note 31 on 
page 266. Total Ireland operating margin 
of 9.2% with Branded Margin at 15.3% as 
the cumulative inflationary cost pressures 
outweigh the benefit of pricing actions in 
the branded business. Distribution margins 
were up 1.3ppts relative to the prior year.
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
17

Branded
We were pleased with the performance 
of our iconic Bulmers brand in Ireland 
with Net Revenue growth of 8% relative 
to the prior period. Between the on and 
off-trade, Bulmers remains the largest and 
most popular cider brand in the Republic 
of Ireland ("ROI")(vii). Aided by our marketing 
campaign, Bulmers total ROI market share, 
from a volume perspective, increased by 
0.2ppt to 59.5% at the end of Feb 2024(vii) 
while the Bulmers brand index (equity 
measure) increased by 10% over the same 
period(ix).    
Five Lamps had a decent performance 
in the year with volume and net revenue 
growth of 4% and 17% respectively, albeit 
from a low base. 
Building on the work undertaken in previous 
years to reduce our Clonmel manufacturing 
site’s energy usage, a 1 MW heat pump 
system was installed in our Clonmel site in 
H1 FY2024. This and other site initiatives 
have reduced the sites carbon footprint year 
on year. 
Operating Review (continued)
18
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Distribution 
Delivering market-leading customer service 
is core to the Group’s success as a brand-
led distributor and we are pleased that OTIF 
levels remained at c.98% across the Island 
of Ireland.
The Distribution business had net revenue 
growth of 7.8% in the year on volumes that 
were down 2.4%. We were particularly 
pleased with the performance of Corona 
where net revenue was up 17.8% on 
volumes that were up 5.2%, and San Miguel 
where volumes increased 27.2% in the 
period. Corona is now the No 1 Premium 
Lager in the ROI off-trade with a market 
share of 17.3%(x). Within the ROI on-trade we 
are seeing positive impact from the rollout 
of Corona Draught(xi). 
Footnotes:
(i)	 FY2023 numbers have been restated to 
reflect the impact of a number of prior period 
adjustments as outlined on page 266.
(ii)	 FY2023 comparatives have been represented 
to be on a constant currency basis (FY2023 
translated at FY2024 FX rates).
(iii)	 Underlying numbers exclude the impact of 
exceptional items.
(iv)	 CGA OPM 52 w/e 24.02.24; IRI Circana, Total 
Grocery - Scotland, 52 w/e 24.02.24.
(v)	 You Gov to end of 2023.  
(vi)	 Media post campaign analysis - Clear Decisions 
run across campaign period.
(vii)	CGA OPM, 52 weeks to 24.02.24.
(viii)	ROI CGA OPM 29.02.23; Nielson IQ Total off-
trade including Dunnes & Discounters 52 weeks 
to week ended 25.02.24 vs 52 weeks to end Feb 
2023.
(ix)	 YouGov, period Feb'23 to Feb'24.
(x)	 Nielson IQ Total off-trade including Dunnes & 
Discounters 52 weeks to week ending 25.02.24 
vs 52 weeks to end Feb 2023
(xi)	 ROI CGA OPM 29.02.23
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
19

Our ambition is to be the pre-eminent integrated 
brands and drinks distribution business serving 
the UK and Ireland drinks markets 
Group Strategy
Strategic Pillars
Medium-term strategic goals
Measurement
Invest and grow 
our portfolio of 
leading local, 
premium beer 
and cider brands.
•	 Brand and product investment to build value of 
key brands over the long-term
•	 Leverage key brand strength and market position 
to grow our portfolio of premium brands
•	 Successful brand development and launches to 
meet changes in consumer demand
•	 Build on “partnership for equity” brand 
relationships to provide route to market access
•	 Cash generation and 
conversion
•	 Revenue growth
•	 Enhanced margins 
•	 Share growth and 
brand health scores
Strengthen our 
position as the 
No.1 drinks 
distribution 
platform in the 
UK and Ireland.
•	 Continue the optimisation of network and wider 
system
•	 Deliver unrivalled portfolio strength, value and 
service to the UK and Ireland hospitality sectors
•	 Commercialising the unrivalled data and insight on 
the hospitality sector 
•	 Margin expansion in our 
distribution business
Capital allocation 
to enhance 
growth and 
Shareholder 
returns.
•	 Target leverage of between 1.5x and 2.0x net debt 
/ EBITDA 
•	 Inorganic opportunities that strengthen our brands 
and distribution businesses 
•	 Invest in sustainability & technology
•	 Return capital to Shareholders
•	 Net Debt/EBITDA
•	 EPS growth
•	 ROCE
•	 Total Shareholder 
Returns
Strategic priorities 
Our core strategic objective is 
to deliver earnings growth.
Existing Businesses
•	 Create an environment that ensures the health 
and safety of our colleagues. Further, establish a 
business culture that nurtures engaged, inspired and 
committed colleagues, investing in key capabilities for 
the future.
•	 Grow and strengthen our portfolio: growing cider 
share and building momentum in our premium beer 
portfolio as consumer preferences evolve. 
•	 Leverage our scale and reach to drive operational 
efficiencies in our distribution infrastructure, 
optimising our capacity and ensure a market leading 
cost to serve.
•	 Enhance our offer: commercialising the data and 
insight that is available; continuing to develop 
our ecommerce offering; and building stronger 
partnerships with ‘equity for growth’ investments or 
complimentary agencies.
Capital Allocation
•	 Maintain the strong cash 
conversion characteristics of 
the business.
•	 Deleverage the balance 
sheet, medium-term target of 
between 1.5x and 2.0x Net 
Debt/EBITDA. 
•	 Invest in our brands; review 
inorganic opportunities and 
return excess capital to 
Shareholders.
Environmental, Social 
and Governance
•	 Execute a credible 
sustainability strategy focused 
on people and planet. 
Provide a range of local and 
core brands, premium, craft 
and third-party brands that is 
unrivalled. 
Our distribution infrastructure 
provides market leading national 
scale, reach and efficiencies. 
20
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Achievements during FY2024
•	 Investment across our core branded portfolio with multi-channel advertising campaigns and promotional activity. 
•	 Across combined on- and off-trade in Scotland, Tennent's gained 0.3%ppts volume share of beer, to 29.0%.
•	 Bulmers total ROI market share, from a volume perspective, increased by 0.2ppt to 59.5% at the end of Feb 2024 while the 
Bulmers brand index (equity measure) increased by 10% over the same period. Bulmers remains the largest and most popular 
cider brand in the Republic of Ireland.
•	 Premium beer portfolio has continued to progress with volume growth of 18% in the year.
•	 Net Revenue of the Group’s GB distribution business was down 2.9% in FY2024 relative to the prior financial year (on a constant 
currency basis) primarily because of the ERP system upgrade issues. 
•	 Service levels, defined as On-Time-In-Full ("OTIF"), have been fully restored to pre-ERP implementation levels and we believe they 
were industry leading in the GB distribution business over the key Christmas trading period reflecting the Group's commitment to 
deliver market leading customer service through GB's preeminent distribution platform.  
•	 In February 2024 we successfully transitioned to a new London Distribution depot "Orbital West" with no impact to customer 
service. This flagship facility underlines the Group's significant investment in increased capacity and ongoing commitment to 
industry-leading customer service.
•	 Net Revenue of the Group’s Irish distribution business was up 7.8% with OTIF remaining at c.98% across the Island of Ireland 
business.
•	 Strong liquidity position of €390.1m and Net debt/EBITDA of 1.8x. Our strong underlying cash generating characteristics have 
been reflected in an encouraging performance with FCF conversion in FY2024 of 68.1% and 91.4% before exceptional items. 
•	 Increasing confidence in the medium-term outlook for the business and its strong cash generation capabilities, the Board reaffirms 
its intention to distribute up to €150m to Shareholders over the next three fiscal years (FY2025 – FY2027) while maintaining 
leverage target of 1.5x to 2.0x. Of which a €15m share buyback programme is currently in progress and a final dividend per share 
of 3.97 cents has been declared subject to approval at the Group’s Annual General Meeting.
Execute a credible ESG strategy focused on people and planet. FY2024 highlights include:
•	 Our 2023 Mean and Median Gender Pay Gap metrics for the UK and Ireland are in favour of female employees, indicating that the 
average pay for female employees is higher compared to male
•	 The Group reduced Scope 1 and 2 (Location Based) carbon emissions by 10% V FY2023 (v target of 4% reduction). This brings 
our total Scope 1 and 2 (Location Based) carbon reduction (v FY2020 baseline) to 24% 
•	 95% of the electricity used at our sites is generated from renewable sources. 
•	 In January 2023, the Group’s greenhouse gas reduction targets were formally validated by the Science Based Targets initiative 
(SBTi). 
•	 The Group has made positive progress on our Scope 3 Supplier Engagement target.  This sees C&C commit that 67% of its 
suppliers and customers by emissions (measured via a spend-based approach as set out in GHG Protocol for calculating Scope 3 
Emissions), covering 77% of purchased goods and services emissions, 65% of upstream transportation and distribution emissions 
and 50% of downstream transportation and distribution emissions, will have science-based targets by 2026.  In FY2024, 48% of 
our suppliers and customers have science based targets in place V target 45%) 
•	 In FY2024, Tennent Caledonian Breweries were awarded the Best Large Business Winner at the 2023 VIBES Scottish 
Environmental Business Awards. 
•	 In September 2023, C&C announced an extension of our partnership with Inner City Enterprise (ICE), our valued community 
partner in Ireland
These brands and asset base are 
underpinned by our offer: dedicated and 
passionate people; enhanced customer 
service; market insight and value. 
The Group has sustainability 
at its core – with the target of 
delivering to a better world. 
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
21

Business Model
Brand Strength
An attractive portfolio of 
Owned and Agency brands 
leveraging C&C’s existing 
strengths and market 
opportunities.
Distribution  Strength
Strategy to position the 
Group as the most efficient, 
technology & sustainability 
driven drinks distribution 
platform in the UK & Ireland.
Sustainability
A structured and ambitious 
programme of continuous 
improvement ensuring C&C 
delivers to a better world!
The execution of our Group strategy is underpinned by three core 
pillars, together these create a market leading platform which 
ensures C&C’s position as the pre-eminent brand-led distributor for 
the UK and Ireland drinks market.
See Operating Review
see pages 14 - 19
See Operating Review
see pages 14 - 19
See Sustainability Report
see pages 59 - 89
22
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Brand Strength
Scotland’s 
favourite beer
Tennent’s is Scotland’s favourite 
beer. Tennent’s has been brewed 
since 1885 at our Wellpark 
manufacturing site in Glasgow, 
where a brewery has stood since 
the 16th century. 
Belgian beer 
Heverlee is a premium 
Belgian Beer, which is 
endorsed by the Abbey of 
the order of Prémontré, in the 
town of Heverlee in Leuven.
Craft beer
A range of craft beer brands 
which includes Innis & 
Gunn, Scotland’s craft 
beer brand into which C&C 
has an ‘equity for growth’ 
investment. 
Ireland’s  
No.1 cider
Bulmers is Ireland’s No.1 cider, made 
at our manufacturing site Clonmel, 
Co. Tipperary.
Dublin lager
The Five Lamps Dublin 
Brewery was originally set up 
in early 2012 beside Dublin’s 
iconic Five Lamps. Its first 
beer, Five Lamps Dublin 
Lager, was launched in 
September 2012.
Premium cider
Orchard Pig craft ciders are 
full of Somerset character and 
scrumptious tanins found in 
West Country cider apples.
Italian lager
Menabrea is from Northern 
Italy and is matured gently 
in the perfect temperature 
of cave cellars for a taste 
of superior clarity. This 
pale lager is well-balanced 
between citrus, bitter tones 
and floral, fruity undertones 
giving a consistent and 
refined flavour.
Other Owned 
& Agency
Local, niche and speciality 
brands as well as world 
premium brands such 
as Stella Artois, Becks, 
Budweiser and Corona.
Complemented by premiumbrands 
The premium market segment continues to grow structurally as consumer demands evolve 
although this space is fragmented with the number of brands. C&C deploys a portfolio 
of premium beers which meet this demand and,coupled with our local and core brands, 
provide a comprehensive range to meet customer and consumer preferences. Further 
innovation will strengthen these brands and will be complemented by exclusive distribution 
agreements and ‘equity for growth’ investments in leading craft brands. 
Core Brands
Our core brands of Bulmers and Tennent’s are intrinsically linked to the communities and 
manufacturing locations where they are produced and where their heritage was born. These 
brands form part of the fabric of the respective drinks markets they occupy, with their lasting 
appeal underpinned by continued brand and marketing investment, alongside new product 
development. Together they deliver strong margins and are highly cash generative. 
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
23

Business Model
Route-to-market
C&C’s route-to-market platform occupies a fundamental role in the infrastructure of the UK 
and Ireland hospitality sectors. The Group provides a route to market for international and 
local brands alike. 
Distribution  
Strength
Customer 
benefit 
C&C provide access to 
an unrivalled range of 
products, offering expert 
knowledge and insight.
Nationwide network with 
market leading reach and 
scale.
Resilience of C&C’s in-
house operated network.
C&C’s financial strength 
provides security of 
supply and access to 
credit.
C&C
A drinks portfolio which is 
market-leading.
Ensures the Group 
participates in evolving 
consumer trends across 
multiple drinks categories.
C&C’s distribution platform 
enhances market access 
and visibility for its brands.
Supplier brands which 
compliment our own 
branded portfolio.
Supplier 
benefit 
C&C provide access to 
an unrivalled range of 
customers across all areas 
of the on and off-trades. 
C&C has an intimate 
understanding of the 
markets they serve.
C&C’s access to data 
ensures it has unparalleled 
insight into the hospitality 
sector.
C&C’s financial strength 
and creditworthiness.
Southampton
Crayford
Bedford
Grantham
Wetherby
Cambuslang
Edinburgh
Glasgow and Wellpark
Dumfries
Inverness
Kintore
Runcorn
Birmingham
Owned, stocked
Owned, not stocked
Third party
Owned, third party 
operated
Orbital West 
Bristol
Fosse  
Launceston
Boldon
Cork
Clonmel
Borrisoleigh
Kilkenny
Galway
Dublin
Kells
Donegal
Culcavy
Scale and Reach
C&C has unrivalled size, scale and distribution reach 
across attractive on-trade drinks markets in Ireland 
and UK. We operate two well invested and state-of-
the-art manufacturing sites. Our operational footprint 
can reach over 99% of the UK population on a next 
day delivery basis. 
No.1 
Drinks distributor  
on Island of Ireland
No.1  
Drinks distributor  
in Scotland and GB
(continued)
24
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

ESG /Sustainability
Delivering to a better world…
We recognise the important role that sustainability plays in the decision-making of 
all our stakeholders. C&C has proven track record of investing and delivering against 
sustainability targets and a clear strategy anchored in three pillars. 
Environmental
Reduce  
our carbon 
footprint
Sustainably 
source our 
products & 
services
Social
Ensure alcohol 
is consumed 
responsibly
Enhance health, 
wellbeing & 
capability of 
colleagues
Governance
Build a more 
inclusive, diverse 
& engaged C&C
Collaborate with 
Government & 
NGOs
25
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

How we create sustainable value
C&C Group plc is a leading 
drinks manufacturer, 
marketer and distributor of 
premium branded cider, 
beer, wine, spirits and soft 
drinks across the UK and 
Ireland. The Group also plays 
a fundamental role in the 
infrastructure of the UK and 
Ireland drinks markets as a 
key route-to-market partner 
for local and international 
beverage brand owners.
Our purpose is to play 
a role in every drinking 
occasion, delivering joy to our 
customers and consumers 
with remarkable brands and 
service. 
Our vision is to be the first-
choice brand-led distribution 
partner for customers in 
hospitality and retail in the UK 
and Ireland. 
Our values are: 
To respect people and our 
planet and to bring joy to life, 
ensuring quality is at the core 
of everything we do.
We focus on the most 
material areas to guide our 
actions around sustainability 
and support the UN 
Sustainable Development 
Goals. 
Manufacture
Embrace sustainable sourcing 
We are committed to sourcing our raw 
materials from local sustainable sources. 
All apples crushed at the Clonmel site 
to produce Bulmers and Magners cider 
are sourced from the island of Ireland. 
As well as having 165 acres of our own 
orchards in Co. Tipperary, there are over 
50 partner growers on the island with 
whom we work closely. Tennent’s Lager 
is only ever brewed using the finest 
Scottish malted barley.
At C&C Group, integration of ethical and 
sustainable practices to our procurement 
processes contribute to the delivery 
of our three core values.   Analysing 
procurement processes through the 
lens of ESG identifies risks (modern 
slavery, human rights violations and 
corruption) and opportunities (ethical 
practices, supply chain resilience and 
waste reduction) enabling optimisation 
of systems.  Our Ethical and Sustainable 
Procurement (E&SP) Strategy is 
underpinned by our E&SP Policy, to 
ensure supplier alignment proactive 
engagement with our supply chain is 
priority.  We ask that suppliers comply 
with C&C Group’s Code of Conduct and 
Modern Slavery policy as a pre-requisite 
of trade.  To support delivery C&C Group 
have created a E&SP Steerco comprising 
cross departmental collaboration and 
the expertise of an external consultant to 
generate a five-year roadmap designed to 
enable C&C Group to be a leader in this 
field by 2029., and potential to support and 
guide our supply chain to align with our 
practices and values. As part of our Science 
Based Target initiative (‘SBTi’) validation, 
we will collaborate with those suppliers and 
customers making up 67% of C&C’s Scope 
3 emissions to have science-based targets 
in place by 2026. At year end FY2024, we 
have achieved a 48% sign up (V’s a KPI of 
45%).
Optimising production and 
manufacturing
We are committed to transitioning our 
operations to clean energy sources in line 
with our carbon reduction targets. 100% 
of the electricity across the Group’s main 
sites in the UK and Ireland comes from 
renewable sources.. The Group continues 
to utilise renewable energy where possible, 
for example in FY2023 we installed 
Ireland’s largest rooftop solar array at 
our manufacturing facility in Clonmel and 
confirmed a Corporate Purchase Power 
Agreement (‘PPA’) obtaining electricity from 
the Cronalaght Wind Farm in Donegal. In 
ESG Pillars
see pages 60-61
1
2
4
5
26
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

FY2024, 95% of our total electricity use 
for the Group was renewably sourced. 
Our manufacturing facility in Clonmel 
generated 1.13MWh of renewable 
electricity from its solar panels in FY24. 
Whilst the majority of our electricity 
consumption is renewable; the Group 
recognises that this only constitutes a 
proportion of its operational emissions. 
To mitigate our Scope 1 emissions, 
the Group has invested heavily in 
decarbonisation projects throughout 
the past years. This includes, but is 
not limited to, the implementation of 
electric Forklift Trucks (‘FLTs’) to our 
fleet, anaerobic digestion and biogas 
projects at our Wellpark Brewery, the 
commissioning of a 1MW heat pump at 
our Clonmel manufacturing facility. At 
Wellpark, Boiler house Energy Recovery 
and Anaerobic Digestion Heat Recovery 
delivers a c.1,000 tonne CO2 reduction 
per annum. The Group’s waste reduction 
program across our operations includes 
recycling and reducing packaging waste. 
Again, in FY2024, we met our target of 
sending zero waste to landfill. 100% of 
our products are sold in containers that 
can be recycled and 28% is already in 
returnable units.
Improve sustainable packaging
The Group continues to meet its 
commitment to be out of single-
use plastics (shrink wrap and hi and 
mid cone rings) in the packaging of 
our canned products, reducing the 
environmental impact and ecological 
footprint of our products. All of the 
Group’s canned product continues to be 
packaged in fully recyclable cardboard, 
which removes more than 200 million 
plastic rings form the environment per 
annum. The investment in our more 
sustainable packaging recognises 
the future market changes including 
the Deposit Return Scheme (‘DRS’) 
introduction in Ireland on 1 February 
2024 and, planned for the UK in October 
2027 alongside new fees associated 
with Extended Producer Responsibility 
regulations due in 2025. 
Market
Data
Our unrivalled scale and reach into the 
on-trade markets of the UK and Ireland 
ensures that we have superior access 
to data and great insight into macro and 
regional trends. We have approximately 
100 international and domestic drinks 
brand owners and operators whom 
they work with either directly or who 
subscribe to our data  assets.
Promoting responsible 
consumption of alcohol
At C&C Group plc we acknowledge the 
key role we play in social responsibility 
in the local communities we serve. We 
are 100% committed to the responsible 
marketing of alcohol and promoting the 
moderate consumption of the products 
we manufacture and distribute, to ensure 
they are enjoyed safely by consumers.
 
In March 2024, the C&C Board 
approved the Group’s Responsible 
Marketing Code (RMC). This sets 
out our commitment to responsible 
marketing, guiding every aspect of our 
marketing activities including but not 
limited to research and development, 
communications, promotion, 
ESG Pillars
see pages 60-61
3
6
sponsorship, experiential, sampling and 
packaging. Central to the RMC is ensuring 
that all our marketing activities are only ever 
directed at adults over the legal purchasing 
age (LPA) in the relevant territory, and to 
encourage the moderate consumption of 
our products. 
 
The RMC is mandatory for all our marketing, 
sales, promotion, and communications 
activities for both the brands which we 
own, but also for third-party brands where 
we control (and are responsible for) the 
marketing of such brands. 
All C&C colleagues working in marketing 
and communications undertake mandatory 
training on the CAP/BCAP and the Portman 
Group Codes of Practice in the UK and 
CopyClear in Ireland, every two years. This 
builds colleague capability, protects our 
license to operate, our brands’ reputation 
and, most importantly, our consumers and 
society.  All new colleagues, in marketing, 
communications, corporate affairs and 
legal functions, should undertake the 
training within three months of starting their 
role. During FY2024, all c120 Marketing, 
Communications and Group Legal 
colleagues at C&C completed this training. 
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
27

Updated responsible marketing training will 
be rolled out to all relevant colleagues again 
in FY2025.
The Group also partners with leading 
alcohol charity, Drinkaware, to provide 
our colleagues with access to e-learning 
resources to improve alcohol awareness 
and understanding. The training is designed 
to support colleagues’ health and wellbeing 
and ensure a safe working environment.
Colleague engagement
Colleague engagement is a key priority for 
C&C Group and is an agenda item at each 
Board and Group Executive Committee 
meeting.  
  
We are committed to creating an inclusive 
culture at C&C, where everyone feels 
valued, safe, respected, and comfortable 
to be themselves. Our aim will always be 
to make C&C a great place to work for all 
colleagues, with the Peakon survey being 
a key channel to capture their views. In 
FY2024, all C&C colleagues were surveyed 
via Peakon in May 2023 and January 2024. 
These surveys, submitted anonymously, 
look to identify where we are as a business 
and how our values reflect colleagues’ 
experience working at C&C. 
   
The May 2023 survey told us that we need 
to remain focused on three consistent 
areas: Strategy, Organisational Fit and 
Reward.  
Colleagues told us that they would value 
more insights on our company progress 
and strategy to ensure everyone is regularly 
updated. In September 2023, we launched 
Group-wide Executive Committee led 
quarterly all-colleague briefing sessions, 
providing regular content covering Our 
Customers; Our Brands; and Our People 
aligned to our Strategy. In the run up to 
our business trading announcements, 
colleagues will receive updates covering 
Performance; Strategic Priorities; Customer 
Service; Employee Proposition; Focus 
Areas; and Recognition.
As part of our learnings and advancements 
we have made across diversity, equity and 
inclusion, we have enhanced our suite of 
Family Leave policies. Our Family Leave 
policies ensure that everyone is enabled to 
balance their working responsibilities with 
their personal priorities and the important 
people in their lives. 
 
In January 2024, 78% (V’s KPI of 75%) of 
colleagues completed the Peakon survey, 
an increase of 5% since May, with an 
Engagement Score of 7.1, (V’s KPI of 7.5), 
which also shows a slight increase on May. 
Colleagues also provided almost 15,000 
individual comments – adding further depth 
and insight into their views. 
Our two newly appointed Designated 
Employee Non-Executive Directors hosted 
employee engagement sessions in FY2024, 
and a full year plan is in place for FY2025 
across the group locations These “listening 
sessions” allow our Non-Executive Directors 
to bring colleagues' voices into Board 
discussions so that these can be considered 
in Board decision-making. These sessions 
build on existing employee engagement 
opportunities and the Group’s continuing 
efforts to develop a culture of informality, 
transparency, and trust. The aim is to 
provide a further opportunity to increase 
two-way dialogue between the Board and all 
employees
Gender Pay Gap Reporting
The Group are pleased that our 2023 Mean 
and Median Gender Pay Gap metrics for 
the UK and Ireland are in favour of female 
employees, indicating that the average pay 
for female employees is higher compared to 
male employees. Gender Pay Gap metrics 
continue to be lower than the national 
averages across the UK and the Republic 
of Ireland. Whilst this is positive, only 26% 
of our UK-based workforce and 14% of our 
Irish-based workforce are female. However, 
we have strengthened our efforts to recruit 
women into Leadership roles and have 
achieved a noticeable change, 42% of our 
Executive Committee and 57% of all CEO 
direct reports, are female. We acknowledge 
that there is still more to do to increase 
the representation of women across our 
business.
Communities
The Group is committed to the communities 
in which we operate and undertakes a 
range of initiatives that benefit our local 
communities, in particular supporting 
charitable activities. We are now in 
How we create sustainable value
(continued)
28
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

the second year of our three-year 
partnership with The Big Issue 
Group, who aim to change lives 
through enterprise for marginalised 
communities across Great Britain. All 
C&C colleagues are now offered time 
off to volunteer, whether it be for our 
Big Issue partnership, or local charities, 
community initiatives and causes that 
are of personal interest or relevant to our 
brands and Business Units.
In September 2023, C&C Group 
announced an extension of our 
partnership with ICE, our valued 
community partner in Ireland.  ICE is 
a not-for-profit charity established in 
1992 and relaunched in 2012 to help 
unemployed individuals to establish 
their own businesses in Dublin’s Inner 
City supporting over 4000 businesses 
in this timeframe.  Our partnership 
strives to benefit both parties, C&C 
Group partaking in mentoring roles for 
enterprise participants and delivering 
training sessions covering important 
business requirements to attain 
success. C&C Group employees 
volunteering their time will be given 
the opportunity to share their skills 
and experience with ICE participants 
benefiting their own career and personal 
development.
 
We know that volunteering creates 
mutual benefit for C&C, our local 
communities, and our colleagues. 
Alongside a positive contribution to 
the local economy, volunteering also 
enhances the health, wellbeing, and 
capability of colleagues.
Stakeholder engagement
We aim to maintain open and positive 
dialogue with all our stakeholders. Our 
stakeholders are an important part 
of our operations and are referenced 
throughout this report.
Distribution
C&C is the UK & Ireland’s largest 
independent on-trade drinks distributor. 
Our final mile distribution strength means 
we are well-placed to serve our On Trade 
customers, with 29 nationwide depots 
and our owned fleet delivering in excess 
of 700,000 orders per year. 
One-stop shop 
With an unrivalled range of beers, 
ciders, wines, spirits and soft drinks, 
C&C’s distribution platform provides 
a comprehensive “one-stop shop” for 
licensed premises owners.
Final Mile distribution 
The Group continues to assess low 
carbon distribution options as the 
leading final mile delivery partner to the 
on trade in the UK and Ireland. 
Piloting Alternative Fuel 
Vehicles
C&C Group is committed to transitioning 
to a low-carbon world. Operating as a 
distributor, as well as a manufacturer 
and marketer, a significant amount of our 
emissions are fuel-based. The Group 
understands the negative impact fossil fuels 
have on our climate and is committed to 
transitioning to lower carbon alternatives 
where feasible. The delivery vehicles at 
two of our major depots, in Bedford and 
Runcorn, are powered by HVO. This has 
saved over 1,000 tCO2e in FY24 alone. 
During FY24 we began transitioning 
more of our delivery vehicles, at our 
Thornliebank depot, to run on HVO. The 
Group also has four 18-tonne electric 
HGVs in operation, following successful 
trials across our distribution network in 
FY23. We are adopting a phased approach 
to the implementation of EVs (Electric 
Vehicles), shifting delivery vehicles to 
HVO in the interim as the technology and 
cost competitiveness of electric vehicles 
improves. 
Our new flagship depot in London, Orbital 
West, will use a mixture of Electric HGVs 
and HGVs powered by HVO. This will 
ensure sustainable deliveries in the heart 
of the country. Our planned rollout of 
Electric HGVs and HVO-powered HGVs will 
continue into FY25.
ESG Pillar
see page 60
1
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
29

Key Performance Indicators
We have financial and non-financial metrics to measure our performance.
Financial KPIs
Strategic Priority
KPI
Definition (see also financial 
definitions on pages 272 and 273)
FY2024 Performance
FY2024 Focus
Links to other 
Disclosures
To enhance 
earnings 
growth
Operating 
profit
Operating profit/(loss) (before 
exceptional items)
FY2021
FY2022
FY2023
FY2024
(€59.6m)*
€47.9m
€82.6m**
€60.0m
To deliver market 
leading customer 
service through 
our distribution 
platforms; revenue 
enhancement 
through pricing 
actions and cost 
control.
CFO Review
page 53
Operating 
margin
Operating profit/(loss) (before 
exceptional items), as a 
percentage of net revenue
FY2021
FY2022
FY2023
FY2024
(8.1%)*
3.3%
4.9%**
3.6%
Adjusted 
diluted 
earnings per 
share
Attributable earnings before 
exceptional items divided 
by the average number of 
shares in issue as adjusted 
for the dilutive impact of 
equity share awards
FY2021
FY2022
FY2023
FY2024
(21.1c)***
7.5c
13.1c**
8.1c
CFO Review
page 54
Basic 
earnings per 
share 
Attributable earnings divided 
by the average number of 
shares in issue
FY2021
FY2022
FY2023
FY2024
(31.1c)***
9.9c
10.3c**
(29.0)c
CFO Review
page 54
To generate 
strong cash 
flows
Free Cash 
Flow
Free Cash Flow is a 
non-GAAP measure that 
comprises cash flow from 
operating activities net of 
capital investment cash 
outflows which form part of 
investing activities (before 
exceptional items)
FY2021
FY2022
FY2023
FY2024
(€91.2m)*
€28.4m
€75.8m**
€85.6m
To generate 
improved operating 
cash flows
CFO Review
page 55
Free Cash 
Flow 
Conversion 
Ratio
The conversion ratio is the 
ratio of free cash flow as 
a percentage of Adjusted 
EBITDA 
FY2021
FY2022
FY2023
FY2024
NM*
35.6%
65.3%**
91.4%
To ensure the 
appropriate 
level of 
financial 
gearing and 
profits to 
service debt
Net debt: 
Adjusted 
EBITDA 
The ratio of net debt (net debt 
comprises borrowings (net 
of issue costs) less cash plus 
lease liabilities) to Adjusted 
EBITDA 
FY2021
FY2022
FY2023
FY2024
NM*
3.4x
1.3x
1.8x
Within medium-term 
target of 1.5x to 2.0x 
Net Debt/adjusted 
EBITDA
CFO Review 
page 53
30
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Strategic Priority
KPI
Definition (see also financial 
definitions on pages 272 and 273)
FY2024 Performance
FY2024 Focus
Links to other 
Disclosures
To ensure the 
appropriate 
level of 
liquidity 
Liquidity 
Liquidity comprises cash 
on hand plus headroom 
available in the Group’s 
revolving credit facility)
FY2021
FY2022
FY2023
FY2024
€314.6m
€438.7m
€470.3m
€390.1m
Ensure sufficient 
liquidity to meet 
the on-going 
requirements of 
the business and 
execute its strategy
CFO Review
page 53
To ensure the 
appropriate 
level of 
financial 
gearing 
Net debt 
Net debt (net debt comprises 
borrowings (net of issue 
costs) less cash plus lease 
liabilities
FY2021
FY2022
FY2023
FY2024
€362.3m
€191.3m
€155.5m**
€168.0m
CFO Review
page 53
To deliver 
sustainable 
Shareholder 
returns
Progressive 
dividend/
return to 
Shareholders
Total dividend per share paid 
and proposed in respect of 
the financial year in question
FY2021
FY2022
FY2023
FY2024	
-
-
3.79c
5.86c
The Group will 
continue to seek 
to enhance 
Shareholder returns
Dividend 
Payout Ratio
Dividend cover is Dividend/
Adjusted diluted EPS
FY2021
FY2022
FY2023
FY2024
-
-
28.3%
72.3%
Non Financial KPI’s
To achieve 
the highest 
standards of 
environmental 
management
Reduction in 
CO2 emissions
Tonnes of CO2 emissions****
FY2021
FY2022
FY2023
FY2024
26,865t
24,196t
22,578t
20,425t
To achieve best 
practice across the 
Group, including 
acquired businesses
Sustainability 
Report
page 66
Waste 
recycling
Tonnes of waste sent to 
landfill
FY2021
FY2022
FY2023
FY2024
0t
0t
0t
0t
To achieve best 
practice across the 
Group, including 
acquired businesses
Sustainability 
Report
page 72
To ensure 
safe and 
healthy 
working 
conditions
Lost Time 
Injury 
Frequency 
Rate.
Number of lost time  
injuries x 200,000  
Number of hours worked
FY2021
FY2022
FY2023
FY2024
-
-
-
3.69
To achieve best 
practice across the 
Group
Sustainability 
Report
page 77
Reportable 
Injury 
Frequency 
Rate
Number of reportable injuries 
x 200,000  
Number of hours worked
FY2021
FY2022
FY2023
FY2024
-
-
-
1.83
To achieve best 
practice across the 
Group
* 	
COVID-19 had a material impact on KPIs in FY2021.
** 	
FY2023 Operating profit has been restated to rectify the incorrect application of Group Accounting Policies and errors of judgement as outlined in Note 31 to the Group’s 
financial statements on page 260.
***	
During FY2022, the Group completed a Rights Issue at a discounted price of £1.86. As the rights price was issued at a discount, this was equivalent to a bonus issue of 
shares combined with a full market price. As such, IAS 33 Earnings Per Share required an adjustment to the number of shares outstanding before the Rights Issue to reflect 
the bonus element inherent in it and also for this to be included in the EPS calculation for the FY2021 period presented so as to provide a comparable result.
****	 Market based scope 1 and 2 emissions as stated in annual Carbon Disclosure Project return.
***** C&C Group has adopted the GRI standard for FY2024 Occupational Health and safety reporting (above) across all business areas including manufacturing, logistics and 
support functions. Historical data is not available using this methodology	
	
	
	
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
31

Management of Risks and Uncertainties
The Board has overall responsibility for 
the Group’s system of internal control, 
for reviewing its effectiveness and for 
confirming that there is a process for 
identifying, evaluating and managing the 
principal risks affecting the achievement of 
the Group’s strategic objectives. 
The Group has established a risk 
management process to ensure effective 
and timely identification, reporting and 
management of risk events that could 
materially impact the achievement of the 
Group’s strategic objectives and financial 
targets. This involves the Board considering 
the following:
•	 the nature and extent of the principal risks 
facing the Group;
•	 the likelihood of these risks occurring;
•	 the impact on the Group should these 
risks occur; and
•	 the actions being taken to manage these 
risks to the desired level.
The Audit Committee oversees the 
effectiveness of the risk management 
procedures in place and the steps being 
taken to mitigate the Group’s risks. 
Internal Controls and Risk 
Management
The key features of the Group’s system 
of internal control and risk management 
include:
•	 review, discussion and approval of the 
Group’s strategy by the Board;
•	 clearly defined organisational structures, 
authority limits and authorisation 
process for the operational and financial 
management of the Group and its 
businesses;
•	 corporate policies for financial reporting, 
treasury and financial risk management, 
information technology and security, 
project appraisal and corporate 
governance;
•	 review and approval by the Board of 
annual budgets and brand plans for all 
business units, identifying key risks and 
opportunities;
•	 monitoring of performance against 
budgets on a weekly basis and reporting 
thereon to the Board on a periodic basis;
•	 an internal audit function which reviews 
key business processes and controls; 
and
•	 review by senior management and the 
Audit Committee of internal audit findings, 
recommendations and follow up actions.
The preparation and issue of financial 
reports, including consolidated annual 
financial statements is managed by the 
Group Finance function, led by the CFO, 
with oversight from the Audit Committee. 
The key features of the Group’s internal 
control procedures with regard to the 
preparation of consolidated financial 
statements are as follows:
•	 the review of each operating division’s 
period end reporting package by the 
Group Finance function; 
•	 the review of each operating division’s 
quarterly financial reporting package by 
the Group Finance function;
•	 the challenge and review of the financial 
results of each operating division with the 
management of that division by the Chief 
Financial Officer; 
•	 the review of any internal control 
weaknesses highlighted by the external 
auditor, the CFO, Head of Internal Audit, 
Company Secretary and Group General 
Counsel and the Audit Committee; and
•	 the follow up of any critical weaknesses 
by internal audit to ensure issues 
highlighted to the Executive Committee 
and Audit Committee are addressed. 
The Directors confirm that, in addition to 
the monitoring carried out by the Audit 
Committee under its terms of reference, 
they have reviewed the effectiveness of 
the Group’s risk management and internal 
control systems up to and including the 
date of approval of the FY2024 financial 
statements. This review had regard to 
all material controls, including financial, 
operational and compliance controls that 
could affect the Group’s business. The 
review included the extensive internal 
and independent external investigative 
work which was conducted post year end 
following the notification of accounting 
discrepancies to the Audit Committee 
and the External Auditors. Further details 
relating to the underlying issues and the 
consequent actions and improvements to 
the controls and governance frameworks 
that have been, and are being taken, to 
ensure that there is no repetition of these 
issues are set out in the Audit Committee 
Report on pages 114 to 122. The Directors 
considered the outcome of this review and 
continue to monitor the implementation 
of the proposed changes to internal 
reporting processes, risk management 
and monitoring frameworks to ensure the 
Group’s internal controls are operating 
effectively. 
Identifying and Monitoring 
Principal and Emerging risks 
A process for identifying, evaluating 
and managing significant risks faced by 
the Group, in accordance with the UK 
Corporate Governance Code 2018 and 
the FRC Guidance on Risk Management, 
Internal Control and Related Financial and 
Business Reporting 2014, has been in place 
for the entire period and up to the date the 
financial statements were approved. These 
risks are reviewed by the Audit Committee 
and the Board, who will consider any 
emerging risks (internal and external) for 
inclusion in the Group Risk Register.
The risks facing the Group are reviewed 
and challenged regularly by the Audit 
Committee and the executive management 
team. Each of the Group’s principal risks 
is assigned an executive owner who, with 
the assistance of the risk committee for 
that specific risk, is responsible for ensuring 
mitigating actions are sufficient to bring 
risks to within the agreed risk appetite. The 
risk management governance framework 
ensures that these mitigations and internal 
controls are embedded and operate 
effectively throughout the organisation.
The annual Board and Audit Committee 
agendas include a series of updates from 
executive risk owners in relation to the 
Group’s principal risks. These updates 
32
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Principal Risk Matrix
High
7
11
13
8
1
2
14
6
4
9
3
5
12
Low
Low
High
Impact
Likelihood
1.  Regulatory / Social Attitude Changes to Alcohol
2.  Economic & Geopolitical
3.  Sustainability & Climate Change
4.  Change in Customer Dynamics &
 
Group Performance
5.  People & Culture
6.  Health & Safety
7.  Product Quality & Safety
8.  Supply Chain Operations, Costs and Inflation
9.  Information Technology
10.  Cyber Security & Data Protection
11.  Business Growth, Integration and 
 
Change Management
12.  Compliance with Laws & Regulations
13.  Brand & Reputation
14.  Financial & Credit
10
include a history of the risk to date, key 
mitigating actions and controls, an outline 
of the residual risk and any future actions 
planned to address control weaknesses. 
The Audit Committee also receives regular 
updates on risk management and internal 
control effectiveness from the Head of 
Internal Audit along with agreed mitigating 
actions to resolve any weaknesses 
identified.
Changes to the Principal Risks
Although there have been no new principal 
risks added, we have considered the impact 
of the investigation on the overall FY2024 
risk assessment process. This resulted in a 
review of risk definitions and financial impact 
measurement and subsequent changes to 
a number of risks, namely:
•	 Compliance with Laws, Regulations 
and Taxation  
where the impact was moved from 
moderate to significant to reflect 
increased compliance requirements and 
the addition of taxation;
•	 Change in Customer Dynamics and 
Group Performance  
where the impact was reduced to 
significant from intolerable; and
•	 Business Integration and Change 
Management  
where the risk descriptor was updated to 
remove growth as a risk and the impact 
reduced to significant from intolerable.  
Emerging Risks
As part of our overall risk assessment 
process and in line with the UK Corporate 
Governance Code 2018 (the ‘Code’), 
the Group captures and monitors areas 
of uncertainty which, while not having a 
significant impact on the business currently, 
have the potential to adversely impact the 
Group in the future. These are considered 
to be emerging risks.
Following the FY2024 risk assessment no 
new emerging risks were identified.
The monitoring of existing and identification 
of new emerging risks are an ongoing focus 
for the Group. 
Risk Appetite
The FRC Guidance on Risk Management, 
Internal Control and Related Financial and 
Business Reporting requires companies 
to determine their risk appetite. This 
is the amount of risk that the Group is 
willing to accept to achieve its strategic 
and operational objectives. Risk appetite 
promotes consistent, “risk-informed” 
decision-making aligned with strategic 
aims, and it also supports robust corporate 
governance by setting clear risk-taking 
boundaries.
For each of the principal risks, the Group’s 
risk appetite has been considered when 
determining the nature and extent of the 
key control mechanisms in place and the 
level of assurance required. The Board 
and the Audit Committee receive regular 
reports from key functions such as health 
and safety, finance, legal, IT, internal audit, 
HR and ESG. Where the level of assurance 
obtained is not considered to adequately 
reflect the stated risk appetite, then 
increased assurance activity is introduced.
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
33

Management of Risks and Uncertainties
(continued)
Principal Risks and Uncertainties
During the year, the Audit Committee and the Board carried out a robust assessment of the principal risks facing the Group, including 
those that would threaten its business model, future performance, solvency or liquidity. The principal risks and uncertainties set out on 
pages 34 to 40 represent the principal uncertainties that the Board believes may impact the Group’s ability to effectively deliver its strategy 
and future performance. The list does not include all risks that the Group faces and it does not list the risks in any order of priority. These 
principal risks are incorporated into the modelling activity performed to assess the ability of the Group to continue in operation and meet its 
liabilities as they fall due for the purposes of the viability statement on page 41. 
Risk and Uncertainties
Impact
Mitigation
Risk Trend
Regulatory and Social Attitude Changes to Alcohol
The Group may be adversely affected by changes 
in government regulations affecting alcohol pricing 
(including duty), sponsorship or advertising, particularly 
as health wellbeing becomes a greater focus of society 
and governments post pandemic.
The Group is actively involved with key trade bodies in UK and Ireland. We are 
members of Drinkaware in UK and Ireland and also comply with all alcohol 
marketing regulations and codes including Portman Group guidance. 
Within the context of supporting responsible drinking initiatives, the Group 
supports the work of its trade associations to present the industry’s case to 
government. C&C also adheres to the responsible promotion of alcohol and 
all legislation, and the self- and co-regulatory codes in the UK and Ireland 
(Portman, CAP/BPAC and CopyClear). 
The Group has developed low and zero alcohol variants for its core brands, 
alongside reducing the alcohol by volume (‘ABV’) of certain brands in order to 
meet changing consumer trends around health and moderation and possible 
duty increases. 
Economic and Geopolitical Events
Our business, financial results and operations may 
be adversely affected by economic or geopolitical 
instability and/or uncertainty, such as the continuing 
conflict and humanitarian crisis in Ukraine. 
The Group’s performance is also impacted by potential 
recessions, inflation, exchange rates, taxation rates and 
social unrest.
The Board and management will continue to consider the impact on the 
Group’s businesses, monitor developments and engage with the UK, Irish 
and Scottish governments to help ensure a manageable outcome for our 
businesses. 
Group businesses are active members in respected industry trade bodies in 
the UK and Ireland including being a steering committee member of the UK 
all-party Parliamentary Beer Group. 
On an ongoing basis, the Group seeks, where appropriate, to mitigate 
currency risk through hedging and structured financial contracts and take 
appropriate action to help mitigate the consequences of any decline in 
demand within its markets.
We have implemented action plans to protect the profitability and liquidity of 
the Group and mitigate a significant proportion of our cost base. We continue 
to review our cost base for additional savings.
We remain vigilant to changes in local jurisdictions and retain the flexibility to 
take appropriate mitigating action as necessary.
34
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Risk Movement
	 New
	 No change
	 Increasing
	 Decreased
Impact
Mitigation
Risk Trend
Sustainability and Climate Change
The Group recognises the significant environmental 
challenges the world faces due to a changing climate 
and the implications that this can have for our business 
and supply chains.
Physical climate impacts and related policy and/or 
market changes may disrupt our operations or impact 
demand for our products. 
Failure to implement policies and meet required 
sustainability and ethical standards and social 
perceptions could significantly impact C&C’s reputation 
as well as potentially impact future growth. 
As a UK premium listed company, C&C Group is 
required to disclose its second mandatory Task Force 
on Climate-related Financial Disclosure (‘TCFD’) report 
in its Annual Report & Accounts (‘ARA’) for the year 
ended 29 February 2024.
One of the requirements of the TCFD framework is 
to assess the resilience of an organisations’ strategy, 
taking into consideration different climate-related 
scenarios. To achieve this, and to appropriately 
incorporate the potential effects of climate change into 
planning processes and business strategy, C&C needs 
to consider how climate risks and opportunities may 
evolve and the potential business implications under 
different conditions.
Aligned with the TCFD guidance, a range of three 
scenarios, 1.5°C, 2.5°C and 4°C, have been selected 
for quantitative scenario analysis of:
•	 Physical Risk: The reduction of water available 
for production due to water scarcity.
•	 Physical Risk: The production and distribution 
disrupted at key facilities by flood events.
•	 Physical Risk: Disruption to the supply chain & 
distribution network due to extreme weather.
•	 Physical Risk: Effects on ingredient production 
due to chronic climate change on hops, barley, 
wine grapes, sugar and apples.
•	 Transition Risk: Increased costs from Climate 
Change Levy / Carbon Tax on C&C emissions.
•	 Opportunity: Increased market opportunity from 
consumer preference transitions to low-carbon 
products.
The Group has established a strong governance model which includes both 
a Board level and a new management level ESG Committee responsible for 
the delivery of our ESG strategy and programmes. This ESG Management 
Committee (‘ESGMC’) is composed of executives and various levels of 
management from functions across the Group and will be responsible for 
sustainability & climate risk and opportunities. The ESGMC will report to the 
ESG Board Committee and Group Executive Committee. 
An impact materiality assessment exercise, in line with the Global Reporting 
Initiative, was completed during the year to ensure that the Group’s ESG 
priorities remain aligned with the views of our key stakeholders. In 2024, we 
will perform a comprehensive double materiality assessment, complying 
with our reporting obligations under the Corporate Sustainability Reporting 
Directive (‘CSRD’). The assessment will consider both our material impacts 
on our stakeholders and also material sustainability related risks and 
opportunities for C&C. 
The Group has pledged to be a carbon-neutral business by 2050 at the 
latest. We set our emissions reduction targets which are grounded in climate 
science and validated by the Science Based Targets initiative (‘SBTi’) in 
January 2023. We are committed to reduce our absolute Scope 1 and Scope 
2 greenhouse gas emissions by 35% by 2030 (versus a FY2020 base year). 
To achieve our target of reducing our Scope 3 emissions by 25% by 2030 
(versus a FY2020 base year), we have also committed that suppliers and 
customers making up 67% of our Scope 3 emissions, will have science-
based targets in place by 2026.
Sustainability and climate related metrics were included as part of the Long-
Term Incentive Plan (‘LTIP’) for Executive Directors in FY2022, FY2023 and 
FY2024. 
Our Clonmel and Bristol sites continue to be ISO 14001 accredited for an 
effective environmental management system. 
The Group has established an Ethical and Sustainable Procurement Steering 
Committee to ensure that suppliers adopt a strong approach to corporate 
social responsibility. Suppliers are reviewed and assessed both on an 
ongoing basis and as part of new tenders to ensure they adhere to C&C’s 
Code of Conduct and Modern Slavery Statement and that sustainability and 
ethical practices are a fundamental part of their operations. 
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
35

Management of Risks and Uncertainties
(continued)
Impact
Mitigation
Risk Trend
Changes in Customer Dynamics and Group Performance 
Consumer preference may change, new competing 
brands may be launched, and competitors may 
increase their marketing or change their pricing policies. 
Failure to respond to competition and/or changes in 
customer preferences could have an adverse impact on 
sales, profits and cash flow within the Group.
In the post pandemic environment there is a smaller 
on-trade universe and possible reduced value pool for 
the on-trade.
The rapid increase in interest rates to counter inflation 
may adversely affect customer behaviour and reduce 
profitability.  
A UK wide deposit return scheme (‘DRS’) is now due for 
introduction in October 2027 with Extended Producer 
Responsibility fees planned for 2025. 
Through diversification, innovation and strategic partnerships, we are 
developing our product portfolio to enhance our offering of niche and 
premium products to satisfy changing consumer requirements including the 
production of low alcohol and non-alcoholic variants of our brands.
The Group has a programme of brand investment, innovation and product 
diversification to maintain and enhance the relevance of its products in the 
market.
Brand health surveys, which provide an understanding of consumer and 
customer perception of our brands, are used to inform and enhance our 
market offerings. 
Contracts may be renegotiated. We continue to focus on retention and new 
sales opportunities as customers move to more resilient and “best in class” 
operations.
The Group has established a cross-functional working group to engage with 
industry and all stakeholders to plan effectively for the implementation of 
new Extended Producer Responsibility (‘EPR’) fees in 2025 and DRS, now 
planned for October 2027.  We continue to work with our trade bodies and 
other stakeholders to flag to all UK Governments that, to avoid cost and 
complexity and have best chance of meeting recycling targets, there must be 
one fully interoperable DRS introduced across the UK at the same time. 
People and Culture
The Group’s ability to attract, develop, engage and 
retain a diverse, talented and capable workforce is 
critical if the Group is to continue to compete and grow 
effectively. 
Failure to continue to evolve our culture, diversity and 
inclusion could impact our reputation and delivery of 
our strategy. 
The Group seeks to mitigate this risk through employment policies and 
procedures, as well as ongoing enhancements of pay and conditions, 
including benchmarking remuneration packages to ensure market 
competitiveness, broadening the scope of variable elements of remuneration 
and the development of retention and succession plans for critical roles.
The Group’s approach to talent management and executive succession 
planning is regularly reviewed by the Group Executive Committee and is 
overseen by the ESG Committee, Nomination Committee and the Board.
The Board and the Executive team have a vital role in shaping and 
embedding a healthy corporate culture, which continues to be a focus. 
Culture is monitored and assessed by the ESG Committee and the Board.
A key focus of the Group’s sustainability agenda is to build a purpose led, 
culturally diverse, engaged and inclusive workforce, where our people can 
be at their best, contribute to the Group’s success and realise their career 
ambitions. Progress is monitored through KPIs and a six-monthly Group 
wide employee engagement survey. Our Employee Representative Groups 
(‘ERGs’) remain key in evolving our culture, with each group having an 
Executive sponsor. Our Diversity, Equity and Inclusivity group continues to 
champion greater diversity throughout the Group. In FY2025, we will conduct 
a review of our ERGs as part of the new two-year DE&I Plan and feedback 
from our employee engagement survey.
36
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Impact
Mitigation
Risk Trend
Health and Safety
A health and safety related incident could result in 
serious injury to the Group’s employees, contractors, 
customers and visitors, which could adversely affect 
our operations and result in criminal prosecution, civil 
litigation and damage to the reputation of the Group 
and its brands.
.
The Group has a Health, Safety and Environmental (‘HSE’) team who work 
closely with management to ensure that the Group complies with all health, 
safety and environmental laws and regulations with ongoing monitoring, 
reporting and training.
The Group has established protocols and procedures for incident 
management and product recall and mitigates the financial impact by 
appropriate insurance cover.
Management meetings throughout the Group feature a health and safety 
update as one of their first substantive agenda items. The Group has 
policies, procedures and standards in place to ensure compliance with legal 
obligations and industry standards.
Our support for mental health and wellbeing has further increased this year, 
with a significant further expansion of our Mental Health First Aider population 
and investment in a range of resources in addition to the adoption and 
approval by the Board of a Mental Health First Aider Policy in FY2024. C&C 
Group will provide MHFA refresher training in 2024 for those who feel they 
would benefit. 
Product Quality and Safety
The quality and safety of our products is of critical 
importance and any failure in this regard could result 
in a recall of the Group’s products, damage to brand 
image and civil or criminal liability.
 
The Group has implemented quality control and technical guidelines which 
are adhered to across all sites. Group Technical continually monitor quality 
standards and compliance with technical guidelines. 
The Group also has quality agreements with all raw material suppliers, setting 
out our minimum acceptable standards. Any supplies which do not meet the 
defined standards are rejected and returned.
The Group has enacted specific business continuity plans and a range of 
measures to protect the business in line with the advice of governments and 
local health authorities to ensure the safe production and distribution of the 
Group’s products.
Our Clonmel and Bristol sites continue to be ISO14001 accredited for an 
effective environmental management system. Our Clonmel and Wellpark 
manufacturing sites have the highest standard of BRC accreditation of AA+ 
achieved in February 2024 and March 2023 respectively.
Supply Chain Operations, Operations and Costs
Circumstances such as the prolonged loss of a 
production or storage facility, disruptions to supply 
chains or critical IT systems and reduced supply of 
raw materials may interrupt the supply of the Group’s 
products, adversely impacting results and reputation.
An increased number of disruptive events have 
posed the risk of an interruption to the supply of raw 
materials or to the effective operation of the Group’s 
manufacturing facilities.
Also, there is a risk of increased input costs due to poor 
harvests and price of inputs. The continuing conflict in 
Ukraine has contributed to heightened uncertainty and 
inflationary pressures.
The Group seeks to mitigate the operational impact of such events 
through business continuity plans, which are tested regularly to ensure 
that interruptions to the business are prevented or minimised and that data 
is protected from unauthorised access, contingency planning, including 
involving the utilisation of third-party sites and the adoption of fire safety 
standards and disaster recovery protocols. The Group seeks to mitigate the 
financial impact of such an event through business interruption and other 
insurance covers.
Enhancement of business continuity planning launched to enhance the 
visibility of our key dependencies, our key threats and solution design.  The 
Group works closely with its suppliers to protect the integrity and consistency 
of supply of raw materials.
The Group seeks to minimise input risks through long-term or fixed price 
supply agreements. The Group continues to assess inflationary and other 
supply chain pressures and impacts on product pricing and will continue 
to work with our suppliers to identify opportunities to improve supply chain 
resilience and to selectively pre-purchase products in order to ensure 
continuity of supply.
The Group does not seek to hedge its exposure to commodity prices by 
entering into derivative financial instruments.
Risk Movement
	 New
	 No change
	 Increasing
	 Decreased
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
37

Management of Risks and Uncertainties
(continued)
Impact
Mitigation
Risk Trend
Information Technology
The Group relies on robust IT systems and supporting 
infrastructure to manufacture and trade effectively. Any 
significant disruption or failure of key systems could 
result in business disruption and revenue loss, accident 
or misappropriation of confidential information. 
Failure to properly manage existing systems, or the 
implementation of new IT systems may result in 
increased costs and/or lost revenue, and reputational 
damage.
Monitoring and alerting of availability of critical technologies and their inter-
dependencies.
IT change management process is embedded to assess risk of all changes 
to technology including changes made by third-party providers. Critical IT 
Technologies are either cloud-hosted, hosted across two data centres or at 
third-party provider locations with necessary fall over protocols and security 
perimeters in place. 
Incident management teams are in place 24/7 to manage low level IT 
incidents. If there is a major incident or an escalation of an incident that has 
a wider impact on other parts of the business and stakeholders, then it can 
be escalated into the IT major incident management team to respond rapidly, 
with defined escalation and communication with the crisis management 
framework, via the network duty manager.
Cyber Security and Data Protection
Failure or compromise of our IT infrastructure or key IT 
systems may result in theft, loss of information, inability 
to operate effectively, financial or regulatory penalties, 
loss of financial control and a negative impact on our 
reputation. Failure to comply with legal or regulatory 
requirements relating to data security (including cyber 
security) or data privacy in the course of our business 
activities, may result in reputational damage, fines 
or other adverse consequences, including criminal 
penalties and consequential litigation, adverse impact 
on our financial results or unfavourable effects on our 
ability to do business.
There is a constant threat of significant and 
sophisticated cyber-attacks including phishing, ransom 
ware, malware and social engineering.
Using personal data in a non-compliant manner 
(whether deliberately or inadvertently) may exacerbate 
the impact of security incidents.
Geopolitical uncertainty has increased the probability of 
state sponsored attacks.
The Group undertakes a regular security assurance programme, testing 
controls, identifying weaknesses and prioritising remediation activities where 
necessary. This includes periodic best practice specialist security testing by 
a leading third-party provider and regular system scanning to identify security 
weaknesses. Issues are assessed for risk and are comprehensively managed 
as part of the Group’s risk management programme. The Board and Audit 
Committee is presented with regular detailed Information Security Reports 
by the Group Head of IT, which includes recommendations for further 
reinforcements, and a roadmap for further risk reduction. As a demonstration 
of our commitment to tackling cyber security we are currently pursuing Cyber 
Essentials Plus accreditation from the National Cyber Security Centre. 
A data and cyber risk governance structure exists including an IT and 
data protection risk committee to regularly review the data and cyber risk 
landscape and determine required action to take place to manage risk 
effectively. Cyber security is a major focus area for the Board and Audit 
Committee who receive regular updates from the Group Transformation and 
Technology Director.
A specialist external IT security team undertake a 24/7 security monitoring 
service, a vulnerability management programme, a software review process, 
supply chain partner audits, a data loss prevention programme and identity 
governance controls amongst other initiatives including asset management, a 
comprehensive patching schedule and consolidation of our IT Infrastructure.
During FY2024 we continued our ongoing programme of investment in cyber 
security controls which included Endpoint Detect and Respond, Cloud 
Access Security Broker, Domain based Message authentication, Reporting 
and Conformance, email authentication and enhanced data loss prevention 
controls.
Business continuity, disaster recovery and crisis management plans are in 
place and tested on a regular basis.
We continue to prioritise several initiatives to further minimise the risk profile, 
including employees receiving regular online cyber security training and 
ongoing awareness is promoted through monthly phishing training and other 
initiatives to keep employees abreast of new and emerging threats.
Policies are in place regarding the protection of both business and personal 
information, with support from the Group Data Protection Officer.
38
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Impact
Mitigation
Risk Trend
Business Integration and Change Management
Successful digital transformation and optimisation of 
the business is reliant on robust change management 
processes and confidence in our underlying data.
The breadth and pace of change can present strategic 
and operational challenges. Business integration and 
change that are not managed effectively could result 
in unrealised synergies, poor project governance, poor 
project delivery, increased staff turnover, erosion of 
value and failure to deliver growth.
Data quality and integrity issues could negatively impact 
digital transformation strategies, result in poor decision 
making, inaccurate analytics and reporting, and poor 
outcomes for customers, consumers and suppliers.
Significant projects and acquisitions have formal leadership and 
project management teams to deliver integration. 
Regular Group communications ensure effective information, 
engagement and feedback flow to support cultural change. 
The Executive Management team oversees change management 
and integration risks through regular people, planning and 
products meetings.
Compliance with Laws, Regulations and Taxes
The Group operates in an environment governed by 
strict and extensive regulations to ensure the safety and 
protection of customers, Shareholders, employees and 
other stakeholders. These laws and regulations include 
hygiene, health and safety, the rules of the London 
Stock Exchange and competition law. Changing laws 
and regulation may impact our ability to market or sell 
certain products or could cause the Group to incur 
additional costs or liabilities that could adversely affect 
its business. Moreover, breach of our internal global 
policies and standards could result in severe damage 
to our corporate reputation and/or significant financial 
penalty. 
Changes to the global tax environment is resulting in 
significant changes to the UK and Ireland tax regimes. 
Such changes will require a new way of compiling tax 
charges.
The Company Secretary and Group General Counsel is a member of the 
Group Executive Committee and is supported by appropriately skilled in-
house legal, data protection and company secretarial resource, with further 
support provided by external lawyers and advisors.
Changes in laws and regulations are monitored, with policies and procedures 
being updated as required to ensure compliance with regulations and 
legislation, providing updated documentation, training and communication 
across the Group.
The Group’s Code of Conduct and supporting policies, clearly define the 
standards and expectations for all employees and third parties.
A mandatory online employee compliance programme is in place to embed 
employees’ understanding of key compliance risks. 
The Group’s Vault whistleblowing service, managed and facilitated by an 
independent third-party, is available to all employees to raise concerns 
regarding suspected wrongdoings or unethical behaviours. All calls are 
followed up and investigated fully with all findings reported to the Board. 
The Group maintains appropriate internal controls and procedures to guard 
against economic crime and imposes appropriate monitoring and controls on 
subsidiary management.
Brand Reputation
The Group faces considerable risk if we are unable to 
uphold high levels of consumer awareness service, 
retain and attract key associates and sponsorships 
for our brands, or if we have inadequate marketing 
investment to support our brands. 
Maintaining and enhancing brand image and reputation 
through the creation of strong brand identities is crucial 
for sustaining and driving revenue and profit growth. 
Capability in digital marketing means there is a risk of 
losing voice and ultimately brand awareness/advocacy 
with target consumers and trade customers.
The introduction of DRS in Ireland on 1 February 2024 
presents a reputational risk if not implemented correctly.
To mitigate this risk, C&C has defined values and goals for all our brands. 
These form the foundation of our product and brand communication 
strategies. 
Central to all our brand image initiatives is ensuring clear and consistent 
messaging to our targeted consumer audience.
Executive Management, Group Legal and internal and external PR 
consultants work together to ensure that all sponsorship and affiliations are 
appropriate and protect the position of our brands.
The Group is monitoring the impact of the rapidly changing trading 
environment on the Group’s brands and will make necessary investment 
decisions to protect the Group’s brand health scores and reputation.
On-Time-in-Full rates are tracked weekly as a measure of customer service in 
our distribution business.
Risk Movement
	 New
	 No change
	 Increasing
	 Decreased
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
39

Management of Risks and Uncertainties
(continued)
Impact
Mitigation
Risk Trend
Financial and Credit 
The Group is subject to a number of financial and 
credit risks such as adverse exchange and interest 
rate fluctuations, availability of supplier credit, credit 
management of customers and possible increase to 
pension funds deficits and cash contributions.
Government and Central Bank policy can also 
adversely impact Group results and re-financing. 
Economic instability may increase the risk of bad debts.
Non-conformities of accounting and financial 
controls could impair the accuracy of the data used 
for internal reporting, decision-making and external 
communication.
The Group seeks to mitigate currency risks, where appropriate, through 
hedging and structured financial contracts to hedge a portion of its foreign 
currency transaction exposure. It has not entered into structured financial 
contracts to hedge its translation exposure on its foreign acquisitions.
The Group manages pension risk through continuous monitoring, taking 
professional advice on the optimisation of asset returns within agreed 
acceptable risk tolerances and implementing liability‐management initiatives.
A range of credit management controls are in place which are regularly 
monitored by management to minimise the risk and exposure. Credit limits 
are regularly reviewed in response to changing market conditions. 
A range of key internal financial controls, such as segregation of duties, 
authorisations and detailed reviews are in place with regular monitoring by 
management to ensure the accuracy of the data for reporting purposes.
Assessment of the Group’s 
Prospects
Going Concern
In adopting the going concern basis for 
preparing these financial statements, the 
Directors have considered the Group’s 
business activities, together with factors 
likely to affect its future development 
and performance, as well as the Group’s 
principal risks and uncertainties. 
The Directors assessed the Group’s 
cash flow forecasts for the period ending 
31 August 2025 (the going concern 
“assessment period”). The cash flows 
included various stress testing scenarios. 
These scenarios stress volume and working 
capital outflows to reflect the potential 
impact, to varying degrees, of a deepening 
recessionary environment including the 
impact of further inflation and interest rate 
increases on customer and consumer 
spending. The Group is satisfied that there 
is sufficient headroom in the financial 
covenants under current facilities under 
each scenario. 
The Group’s scenarios assume:
•	 A base case projection using internally 
approved forecast and strategic plans, 
which reflect the external economic 
environment; 
•	 A downside and a severe downside 
scenario which assesses the potential 
impact on volume and working capital of 
a continuing recessionary environment 
including the impact of further inflation 
and interest rate increases on customer 
and consumer spending.
Overall conclusion
Having considered these scenarios, the 
Group’s banking facilities, the ongoing 
inflationary pressures within the macro 
economy and the funding requirements 
of the Group, the Directors are confident 
that headroom under our banking facilities 
remains adequate, future covenant tests 
can be met, and there is a reasonable 
expectation that the business can meet 
its liabilities as they fall due for a period 
of greater than 12 months (being an 
assessment period of 14 months) from the 
date of approval of the Group Financial 
Statements. For these reasons the Directors 
continue to adopt the going concern basis 
of accounting in preparing the Group’s 
financial statements and no material 
uncertainty has been identified.
40
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Viability Statement
In accordance with provision 31 of the UK 
Corporate Governance Code, the Directors 
set out how they have assessed the Group’s 
prospects, the period covered by the 
assessment and the Group’s formal viability 
statement.
The Directors have assessed the prospects 
of the Group by considering the Group’s 
current financial position, its recent and 
historic financial performance and forecasts, 
its business model and strategy, the Board’s 
risk appetite and the Group’s Principal Risks 
and Uncertainties as set out above and how 
these are identified, managed and mitigated. 
Based on this assessment, which includes 
a robust assessment of the potential impact 
that these risks would have on the Group’s 
business model, future performance, 
solvency and liquidity, the Directors have a 
reasonable expectation that the Group will 
be able to continue in operation and meet its 
liabilities as they fall due over the three-year 
period to February 2027. 
Group’s strategic planning process
The Board considers annually a three-
year, bottom-up strategic plan and a more 
detailed budget which is prepared for 
the following year. Current-year business 
performance is reforecast during the 
year. The most recent financial plan was 
approved by the Board in March 2024. The 
plan is reviewed and approved by the Board, 
with involvement from the CEO, CFO and 
the management team. Part of the Board’s 
role is to consider the appropriateness of 
key assumptions, considering the external 
environment, business strategy and model.
Period of Assessment
The Directors have reviewed the period 
used for the assessment and determined 
that the three-year period to February 2027 
is and remains an appropriate period over 
which to provide its viability statement. This 
period has been considered for the following 
reasons:
•	 The business model can be evolved for 
significant changes in market structure 
or government policy over the three-year 
period;
•	 For major investment projects three 
years is considered by the Board to 
be a reasonable time horizon for an 
assessment of the outcome;
•	 The Group’s strategic planning horizon 
covers a three-year period; and
•	 The Directors believe that this presents 
the Board and readers of the Annual 
Report with a reasonable degree of 
confidence over this longer-term outlook.
Viability Assessment 
The Directors’ assessment of the Group’s 
viability has been made with reference to 
FY2024 performance and the budget for 
FY2025. 
The Board reviewed the assessment of the 
Group’s prospects made by management, 
including:
•	 The development of a rigorous 
planning process, the outputs of which 
are comprised of a strategic plan, a 
consolidated financial forecast for the 
current year and financial projections for 
future years covering the period of the 
plan;
•	 A comprehensive review of the strategic 
plan as part of its annual strategy 
review, with regular monitoring of the 
achievement of strategic objectives taking 
place at each Board meeting;
•	 Assumptions are built at both Group 
and business unit levels and are subject 
to detailed examination, challenge and 
sensitivity analysis by management and 
the Directors;
•	 A consideration of how the impact of one 
or more of the Group’s Principal Risks 
and Uncertainties, could materially impact 
the Group’s performance, solvency or 
liquidity; and
•	 The impact of climate change on the 
Financial Statements. The strategic 
plan for the Group includes the best 
estimate of the impacts of climate change 
on financial performance as well as 
the corresponding investment in risk 
mitigations. An in-depth assessment of 
climate risk has been conducted in the 
past 12 months, with further analysis 
of the key risks to be conducted in the 
upcoming 12 months. See pages 42 to 
52 for an overview of our work on TCFD. 
These considerations include external factors 
such as the impacts of inflation including fuel 
and energy prices and their impact on the 
Group’s manufacturing and distribution cost 
base, lower economic growth, particularly 
in our key areas of operation, unfavourable 
currency exchange rate movements, increased 
regulations and internal factors such as the 
strategic plan under-delivering, the loss of 
a key production site or a health and safety 
related event. These considerations also 
considered additional mitigating measures 
available to the Group, including reducing 
advertising and promotional spend or reducing 
capital expenditure and the potential availability 
of additional debt facilities. The Directors have 
considered only controllable mitigating actions 
and no action model would materially impact 
business delivery. As at 29 February 2024, the 
Group had total undrawn committed credit 
facilities of €230.0m which mature in January 
2029 and €160.1m cash, net of overdrafts.
The Audit Committee reviews the output of 
the viability assessment in advance of final 
evaluation by the Board. Having reviewed 
these elements, current performance, 
forecasts, debt servicing requirements, total 
facilities and risks, the Board has a reasonable 
expectation that the Group has adequate 
resources to continue in operation, meet its 
liabilities as they fall due and retain sufficient 
available cash across the assessment period.
The Board therefore has a reasonable 
expectation that the Group will remain viable 
over the period of assessment. 
Strategic Report Approval
The Strategic Report, outlined on pages 2 to 
90, (including the assessment of the Group’s 
prospects as set out above) incorporates 
the Highlights, the Business Profile and Key 
Performance Indicators, the Chair’s Statement, 
the Chief Executive Officer’s report, Chief 
Financial Officer’s report, the Sustainability 
Report and the Management of Risks and 
Uncertainties section of this document.
This report was approved by the Board of 
Directors on 27 June 2024.
Mark Chilton
Company Secretary
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
41

Task Force for Climate Related Financial Disclosures (TCFD)
Response to Climate Change 
This constitutes the Group’s third disclosure 
utilising the TCFD Recommendations 
and Recommended Disclosures (“TCFD 
Recommendations”). Consideration of these 
recommendations supports the Group 
in factoring climate change into strategic 
decisions in a formalised and robust manner 
and supports our climate reporting and the 
development of our transition plan. We are 
committed to ensuring that we continue to 
improve our climate-related disclosures over 
the coming years.
In accordance with LR 9.8.6R(8), we 
are required to include a statement 
in this Annual Report and Financial 
Statements setting out whether the Group 
has included climate-related financial 
disclosures consistent with the TCFD 
Recommendations. 
We have included climate-related financial 
disclosures in this Annual Report and 
Financial Statements consistent with the 
TCFD Recommendations, except for the 
following:
•	 Formally embedding climate-related 
risks and opportunities (‘CROs’) within 
our strategy and financial planning 
(Recommendations Strategy (b))
•	 Identifying and monitoring metrics 
and targets aligned to all the climate-
related risks and opportunities that were 
identified as part of our scenario analysis 
(Recommendation Metrics & Targets (a) 
and (c)).
Governance
C&C’s Board of Directors has the ultimate 
responsibility for overseeing the Group’s 
climate-related risks and opportunities and 
for ensuring that climate change matters 
are considered when reviewing and guiding 
the Group’s strategy, including undertaking 
major plans of action and capital 
expenditures. Moreover, climate change 
is also integrated into decisions regarding 
C&C’s annual budgets, business plans and 
performance objectives (refer to the Strategy 
section below which discusses how we are 
using the results of our quantitative scenario 
analysis for financial planning, for example). 
Board members attend ESG Board 
Committee meetings and are therefore kept 
abreast of key climate developments, such 
as the Group’s Transition Plan which is a 
standing agenda item.
Training
During FY2023, the Board received 
training on climate scenario analysis and 
the strategic considerations for C&C. A 
quantitative scenario analysis was carried 
out starting in Q4 of FY2023 and into Q1 
of FY2024 (see strategy section on page 
44 ) and the results were presented to the 
Board in March 2023 and the ESG Board 
Committee in May 2023.The Board will 
be undertaking training sessions in Q2 
of FY2025 to increase our leadership’s 
knowledge, understanding and awareness 
of sustainability-related issues (including 
climate). The training sessions will 
include sessions focusing on particular 
sustainability topics, as well as broader 
sessions which will focus on integrating 
material sustainability topics into Board 
decisions.
Additional training across relevant 
management functions and teams will be 
rolled out in Q2 of FY2025. These training 
sessions will focus on items such as target 
setting, action plans, data management 
and metrics, and the implementation 
and monitoring of the same to ensure 
performance is improving.
During FY2024, to support our Supply 
Chain Screening approach, CDP delivered 
training to C&C Procurement and 
Commercial functional colleagues, and 
key suppliers, as well as for relationship 
managers and buyers on how supply chain 
screening and collaborating with suppliers 
and customers can play a vital role in 
tackling environmental harm and achieving 
global climate goals.
Group Executive Committee
ESG Management Committee
ESG Board Committee
C&C Board of Directors
Governance structure
42
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Governance structure
The ESG Board Committee has delegated 
responsibility from C&C’s Board of Directors 
over some elements of oversight of climate 
change. Please see pages 123-126 for 
the ESG Board Committee report which 
contains its responsibilities and matters 
considered during the year. The Chair of 
the ESG Board Committee is responsible 
for providing the Board of Directors with an 
update on all ESG matters, including climate 
change.
Recognising the importance of climate 
change and sustainability matters for the 
Group, all Board members participate in 
the ESG Board Committee meetings, such 
that the entire leadership is made aware of 
relevant ESG and climate-related matters, 
so that these can be further considered 
for wider strategic purposes and business 
decisions.
Furthermore, Group policy is to assign a 
Group Executive Committee owner for each 
principal risk on the Group Risk Register. 
Starting from FY2021, Sustainability and 
Climate Change has been identified as a 
principal risk for C&C, therefore climate risks 
are continuously reviewed and considered 
in Risk functions and at an executive level. 
Please see page 35 for more details about 
the Group’s Risk Management. In response 
to the identification of Climate Change 
as a principal risk, a Risk Committee for 
Sustainability and Climate Change was set 
up to monitor and manage climate change, 
including reviewing, on an annual basis, the 
climate-risks and opportunities identified.
During FY2024, the Risk Committee for 
Sustainability and Climate Change met 
once.
During FY2024 the Group re-assessed the 
governance structure over sustainability 
topics more broadly and established a 
new Management-level ESG Committee 
in March 2024. The Climate Committee 
previously in place will be subsumed by 
the new ESG Management Committee. 
The ESG Management Committee has 
been established to oversee and enhance 
the embedding of ESG at C&C. The ESG 
Management Committee is set to meet 
monthly and reports directly to the ESG 
Board Committee. 
The roles and responsibilities of the ESG 
Management Committee are as follows:
•	 Take a Materiality approach to define and 
implement ESG policies and practices 
that align with the Company’s overall 
strategy and industry best practices.
•	 Identify and assess ESG risks 
and opportunities, providing 
recommendations to mitigate risks and 
capitalise on opportunities.
•	 Monitor and report on the Company’s 
ESG performance against established 
goals and benchmarks.
•	 Engage with stakeholders, including 
Shareholders, employees, customers, 
suppliers, and communities, to ensure 
a comprehensive understanding of ESG 
concerns and expectations.
•	 Regularly review and update the ESG 
policy framework in response to evolving 
regulatory stakeholder requirements. 
•	 Establish and oversee initiatives aimed 
at reducing the environmental impact, 
promoting diversity and inclusion, and 
ensuring ethical business conduct.
Chair of ESG Management Committee
Company Secretary and General Counsel
Secretary of ESG Management Committee
Governance, Materiality, Risk, Data, Reporting & Communications
Head of ESG
Head of
Procurement
Senior 
Legal Counsel
HR
Business Partner
CEO and 
member of 
ESG Board 
Committee
Head of Group 
Engineering
Deputy
Company
Secretary
Group Director 
of Finance
ESG management committee structure
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
43

Separate from this, C&C has an Ethical and Sustainable Procurement Committee which seeks to embed climate considerations, as well 
as other sustainability considerations into the Group’s procurement practices. This Committee also meets monthly and reports to the ESG 
Board Committee.
The work of the management committees is supported by the ESG Working group. This is a core working group focused on initiating and 
overseeing projects related to ESG matters. Supporting the ESG working group are a core group of ESG Champions across the business. 
The responsibilities of the Champion role focuses on providing upward feedback on ESG initiatives to the ESG Management Committee. In 
FY2025, the role of the ESG Champions will be reviewed to ensure they continue to contribute effectively to C&C’s sustainability agenda.
The Remuneration Report on pages 136-163 contains details on the ESG related metrics considered by the ESG Board Committee. In 
relation to climate change, these remain unchanged from FY2023 and include the following metrics:
Metric
Target
Relevant to
Carbon reduction for the Group
The Group has set a target to reduce its 
Scope 1 emissions and Scope 2 emissions1 
over the three financial years ending with 
FY2024 as follows:
•	 Threshold - 6% reduction
•	 Maximum - 12% reduction
Executive Directors 
1.	 Scope 1: direct emissions from owned or controlled sources, which includes emissions from Group-owned or operated facilities and vehicles. 
Scope 2: indirect emissions from the generation of purchased energy e.g., electricity, steam, heat, and cooling.
Strategy
The Group has pledged to be a carbon-
neutral business by 2050. We have 
grounded our emissions reduction targets 
in climate science through the Science 
Based Targets initiative (‘SBTi’), which were 
validated during FY2023.
Our Approach to Identifying 
Climate-related Risks and 
Opportunities
In FY2023, we collaborated with external 
consultants to support us in carrying out 
a quantitative scenario analysis on the 
climate-related risks and opportunities 
(CROs) previously identified, to further 
understand and to quantify the impact that 
climate-related risks and opportunities 
could have on the Group. This quantitative 
scenario analysis exercise was finalised in 
Q1 of FY2024. The ESG Board Committee 
reviewed the CROs, during FY2024, and 
determined that they are still relevant to the 
business, and that no further changes were 
required for FY2024.
These CROs were identified in FY2022 
through workshop sessions involving 
external consultants and a range of key 
stakeholders within C&C and applied to 
the existing Risk Management framework 
(as described on page 35 of the annual 
report) to assess the impact and the 
likelihood associated with each CRO. The 
time horizons were reviewed to take into 
account the fact that climate change will 
manifest itself over a longer period of time. 
The time frames, which focus on when the 
identified CRO is likely to begin having a 
significant impact on the business’ goals 
and objectives, were approved for use by 
the ESG Board Committee:
Task Force for Climate Related Financial Disclosures
(continued)
Time Frame
Description
Short-term
Present day to 
2026
Medium-term
2026 to 2031
Long-term
2031 to 2050
During FY2024 we began to integrate 
the results of our quantitative scenario 
analysis into strategy and financial planning. 
For example, forecasted carbon taxes 
were utilised in the financial analysis of 
a proposed sustainability project that is 
part of our Transition Plan. Also, as part 
of wider strategic goals to decarbonise 
the Group’s operations, in February 2024, 
C&C launched operations from our new 
and improved distribution depot in London, 
Orbital West which utilises twenty-six 
vehicles which have HVO as a primary fuel, 
solar panels and electric vehicle charging 
points. 
44
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

TCFD CRO Category
Time Horizon
Value Chain Impact and 
divisional impact
Description of impact prior to 
any mitigating activities being 
considered
Management of risks and 
opportunities
Link to relevant Metric(s) and 
Targets
1. Climate Change Levy / Carbon Tax
Transition risk 
- policy & legal
Transition risk 
- technology
Short 
term
Upstream, 
Production & 
distribution
Branded 
Wholesale
The Group’s primary 
production sites are in 
geographical locations 
either with a Carbon Tax 
(Ireland) or Carbon Levy 
(UK). These costs are due 
to increase substantially 
between now and 2030. 
Moreover, the increased 
pricing of GHG emissions 
means that The Group’s 
operational costs will 
increase (e.g. heating).
The Group will reduce our 
carbon emissions in line 
with our SBTi target.
The Group continues to 
explore avenues to invest 
in low carbon intensity 
supply chains and in 
cleaner technologies, for 
example, electric vehicles 
were introduced into 
the Group’s fleet during 
FY2024.
Scope 1, Scope 
2 and Scope 3 
emission and 
emission reduction 
targets.
2. Effects on ingredient production due to climate change
Physical risk – 
chronic
Long-
term
Raw materials
Branded 
Wholesale
Changes in precipitation 
patterns and extreme 
variability in weather 
patterns will adversely 
affect barley, maize, 
wheat, malt, apple and 
apple juice, and wine 
production therefore 
affecting The Group’s 
supply chain and 
production capabilities.
The Group has assessed 
the climate related risk 
to each ingredient on 
an individual basis. The 
results will be incorporated 
into our supply chain 
strategy.
CDP Supplier 
Screening 
programme / 
Science Based 
Target Scope 3 
Engagement Target.
Heatmap  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Minor
Moderate
Significant
Major
Intolerable*
Remote
Unlikely
Possible
Likely
Highly Likely*
Transition risk
1.  Climate Change Levy / Carbon Tax
Physical Risk
2.  Effects on ingredient production 
 
due to climate change
3.  Water scarcity reduces availability 
 
of water for production
6.  Floods disrupt production and distribution  
 
at Clonmel facility
7. Disruption to supply chain & distribution  
 
network due to extreme weather
Opportunity
4.  Invest in low carbon intensity supply  
 
chains and distribution networks
5.  Sustainable trends in consumer demand
*As defined in our Group Risk Register.
Our Identified CROs
Please find below the CROs that are 
most relevant for the Group, which were 
determined based on the methodology 
described above. 
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
45

TCFD CRO Category
Time Horizon
Value Chain Impact and 
divisional impact
Description of impact prior to 
any mitigating activities being 
considered
Management of risks and 
opportunities
Link to relevant Metric(s) and 
Targets
3. Water scarcity reduces availability of water for production
Physical risk – 
chronic
Long-
term
Raw materials & 
Production
Branded 
Wholesale
Potential for long-term 
changes in ground water 
levels due to reduced 
precipitation may affect 
the availability of water for 
production (The Group 
uses water as both a 
product ingredient and as 
a plant cleaning medium) 
and enhance regulatory 
controls over seasonal 
water extraction activities, 
disrupting The Group’s 
production.
Each of The Group’s 
sites has an active water 
management programme. 
This includes an ongoing 
assessment of the water 
scarcity risk to each 
production site. 
In relation to raw materials, 
during FY2024 the Group 
extended its assessment 
to collect more detailed 
responses to water-related 
queries from suppliers.
The Group will engage 
with our suppliers on 
their water management 
policies and establish if 
they have conducted a 
risk assessment which 
covers climate related 
water stress.
Monitoring of water 
usage in C&C’s 
facilities. 
At the Clonmel 
facility, well levels 
are monitored on 
a continuous basis 
– using the SCADA 
(Industrial automation 
system). The 
production volume 
and associated water 
usage has decreased 
by 20% over the past 
five years, thereby 
contributing to the 
mitigation of this risk. 
Targets to manage 
this risk are currently 
being developed by 
the Group.
6. Floods disrupt production and distribution at Clonmel facility
Long-term
Physical risk – 
acute
Long-
term
Production & 
Distribution
Branded 
Increased heavy 
precipitation leading 
to floods in Clonmel 
facility. The occurrence 
of flooding could also 
cause damage to property 
and halt production in 
these facilities, impacting 
outputs and revenue.
As a significant employer 
in Tipperary in Ireland, 
the Group will work with 
the local authorities to 
foresee and mitigate any 
associated risk.
A flood risk assessment 
will be conducted on the 
Clonmel site in Tipperary 
based on an RCP 8.5 
scenario followed by the 
development of flood 
management plan to 
minimise any potential 
business disruption.
Metrics and targets 
to manage this risk 
are currently being 
developed by the 
Group.
7. Disruption to supply chain & distribution network due to extreme weather
Physical risk – 
acute
Long-
term
Upstream, 
Distribution
Branded 
Wholesale
Distribution channels are 
exposed to more extreme 
weather events leading to 
financial losses through 
lost revenue due to our 
suppliers being unable 
to deliver goods to us or 
The Group being unable 
to deliver goods to our 
customers.
The Group will work 
with our partners in our 
recently launched Supply 
Chain engagement 
programme to review 
risks and mitigations on a 
longer-term time horizon.
The Group will mitigate 
the operational impact 
of extreme weather 
events through business 
continuity plans, which will 
be tested regularly against 
the latest IPCC scenarios.
The Group will mitigate the 
financial impact of such 
events through business 
interruption insurance 
cover.
Metrics and targets 
to manage this risk 
are currently being 
developed by the 
Group.
Task Force for Climate Related Financial Disclosures
(continued)
46
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

TCFD CRO Category
Time Horizon
Value Chain Impact and 
divisional impact
Description of impact prior to 
any mitigating activities being 
considered
Management of risks and 
opportunities
Link to relevant Metric(s) and 
Targets
4. Invest in low carbon intensity supply chains and distribution networks
Transition 
Opportunity 
(Resource 
Efficiency)
Long-
term
Distribution
Branded 
Wholesale
Opportunity to mitigate 
the increase in production, 
transportation, and 
distribution cost due to the 
increase in energy prices 
by transitioning to lower 
carbon options. This could 
allow The Group to lower 
costs with respect to our 
competitors. 
The Group actively 
assesses low carbon 
distribution options as 
the leading final mile 
delivery partner to the 
on trade in the UK and 
Ireland. Electric vehicles 
were introduced into 
the Group’s fleet during 
FY2024.
The Group will work 
with our partners in our 
recently launched Supply 
Chain engagement 
programme to help 
them lower their 
carbon emissions from 
distribution. During 
FY2024 the Group 
directly engaged to check 
on the status of target 
setting activities of select 
suppliers as part of the 
ongoing CDP Supplier 
Engagement Programme, 
48% of target suppliers 
have SBTi in place (V 
Target of 45%).
Metrics and targets 
to manage this 
opportunity are 
currently being 
developed by the 
Group.
5. Sustainable trends in consumer demand
Transition 
Opportunity 
(Resilience and 
Market)
Short 
term
Sales & consumers
Branded 
Strong corporate climate 
change management 
enhances credibility and 
strengthens relationships 
with stakeholders leading 
to potential new revenue 
opportunities. Additionally, 
given that The Group’s 
production, distribution, 
and crop sites are 
relatively close to each 
other, this could have a 
positive impact on carbon 
labelling and reputation as 
consumers increasingly 
look for locally sourced, 
low carbon products. 
The Group will continue to 
utilise in-house consumer 
insight and external 
sources to develop / 
execute meaningful brand 
sustainability campaigns 
(Life is Bigger than Beer 
– Tennents and Save the 
Bees – Bulmers).
Metrics and targets 
to manage this 
opportunity are 
currently being 
developed by the 
Group.
While the above represents the risks and opportunities that we have identified as being the most relevant to C&C currently, we continue to 
monitor the risks and consider emerging CROs as new climate data and policies emerge. We expect this list to evolve over time. We also 
continue to actively monitor and respond to the changing landscape of sustainability reporting requirements to ensure that we are meeting 
the reporting expectations of our key stakeholders including regulators, investors, and customers. The Corporate Sustainability Reporting 
Directive (CSRD) requires the Group to report on material sustainability impacts, risks, and opportunities, with an expected period start date 
for C&C of 1 March 2025. We began our reporting preparation for this regulation in FY2024.
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
47

Transition Plan
 The Group’s emission reduction targets 
were validated by the Science Based 
Targets initiative (SBTi) in FY2023, in line 
with a well below 2°C trajectory. C&C is 
committed to reducing absolute Scope 1 
and Scope 2 GHG emissions by 35% by 
2030 (vs FY2020 baseline). In addition, to 
achieve the target of reducing Scope 3 
emissions by 25% (vs FY2020 baseline) by 
2030, the Group has also committed that 
suppliers and customers making up 67% 
of Scope 3 emissions (Purchased Goods, 
Downstream Transport and Use of Sold 
Goods) will have science-based targets in 
place by 2026. During FY2024, the Group 
directly engaged to check on the status of 
target setting activities of select suppliers, 
as part of the ongoing CDP Supplier 
Engagement Programme, finding that 48% 
of target suppliers have SBTi in place (V 
Target of 45%). 
The Group set out a transition plan in 
FY2024 to deliver on these targets, that also 
considered the Net Zero commitments set 
by the jurisdictions in which we operate, 
as well as our own pledge to be carbon-
neutral business by 2050. The Executive 
Committee approved the transition plan 
annually as part of 3-year planning cycle, 
and the progress towards it is now a 
standing agenda item for the ESG Board 
Committee. The initiatives and projects to 
decarbonise are also reviewed annually, and 
£2 million in capital expenditure is ring-
fenced to implement these decarbonisation 
projects each year. 
As part of setting the transition plan, we 
referred to: industry specific guidance from 
the European Greens Brewers Association, 
the Zero Carbon Roadmap for Brewing 
developed by the BBPA (British Beer & Pub 
Association) and engaged with wholesalers' 
associations and providers of modern 
technologies for the industry. We identified 
and analysed the viability of various 
projects to help us to achieve the 3% to 
4% reduction in Carbon Emissions (Co2e) 
required each year to meet our validated 
SBTi target for 2030. 
At FY2024, C&C has achieved a 24% 
reduction in Scope 1 and 2 (Location 
Based) emissions (v’s a FY2020 baseline)
During FY2024 the following 
decarbonisation projects were 
implemented, resulting in a reduction in 
Scope 1 and 2 (Location Based) CO2e of 
3,017 tonnes:
•	 Anaerobic Digestion Heat Recovery - 
Wellpark 
•	 Boiler Energy Recovery - Wellpark
•	 HVO (Hydrotreated Vegetable Oil) Transition 
Fuel 
•	 Air compressor Wellpark
•	 LED Lighting 
•	 Electric vehicles were introduced into the 
Group's fleet.
•	 Heat Pump - Clonmel
•	 Brewhouse Energy
•	 Boilerhouse Energy 
Other projects that are being implemented to 
achieve our Scope 1 & 2 and decarbonisation 
2030 target include the following:
•	 The electrification of heat for manufacturing 
process loads (via heat pumps)
•	 Continued heat recovery/ heat reuse 
opportunities
•	 Phased roll out the HVO fuel in the 
“transition period” to depots with bulk tanks. 
•	 Fuel tanks (this optimises the cost vs carbon 
reduction)
•	 Transition to Electric Vehicle fleet
•	 Movement of FLTs from LPG to Electricity, at 
lease renewal stage
•	 Electrical infrastructure phased into depot 
network
While we believe significant work has been 
completed in the current period on our 
transition plan and the progress against it, we 
also recognise that the plan will have to be 
further operationalised going forward.
Understanding the impact on our 
CROs through Scenario Analysis
The following CROs were selected for 
quantitative scenario analysis during FY2023 
and evaluated across a range of scenarios to 
understand how they may evolve under certain 
hypothetical situations:
•	 Increased costs from a climate change levy 
/ carbon tax.
•	 The reduction of water available for 
production due to water stress.
•	 Disruption of production and distribution at 
key facilities due to flood events and extreme 
weather. 
•	 Effects of chronic climate change on 
ingredient production of five key crops 
(apples, barley, sugar, wine grapes, and 
hops).
•	 Increased market opportunity for low carbon 
products due to sustainable trends in 
consumer demand. 
37,508
Scope 1 & 2 Emissions 
FY 20 Base Line
FY23 Actual CarbonUsage
AD Heat Recovery 
Boiler Energy Recovery 
HVO Transition Fuel 
Air compressor Wellpark
LED Lighting 
Heat Pump Clonmel
Brewhouse Energy
Boilerhouse Energy 
Solar Panels 
Electrify FLTs
Fleet Electric Vehicles 
Heat Pump Wellpark
Electrical supply grid
FY30 Carbon Forecast
FY30 Carbon Target
31,594
-300
-300
-3,036 -118
-40
-300 -100
-50
-250 -100
-1,406
-700
23,544
24,380
-1,350
Task Force for Climate Related Financial Disclosures
(continued)
48
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

These CROs were selected for quantitative scenario analysis based on their assessed potential to have a significant impact. This analysis 
has allowed us to understand and improve the resilience of our business model and strategy to climate change. 
Several factors were considered during the selection of scenarios for this quantitative analysis (as outlined in the table below). This analysis 
made use of publicly available scenarios from the Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change (IPCC). The range of scenarios was selected 
to consider the impacts of the selected CROs across the widest range of outcomes, to best prepare for all eventualities. The scenarios are 
broadly aligned with the qualitative analysis conducted in FY2022, however, to adhere with the latest science and IPCC findings, a 1.5°C 
scenario was prioritised over the previously selected <2°C scenario. 
Climate scenarios selected for analysis
Warming trajectory by 2100
Data source
Key assumptions, outputs, and sensitivities
1.5°C (Paris Ambition)
IPCC SSP11-1.92
•	 The financial analysis is based on the forecasted financial position up to 
FY2027. Climate risks and opportunities were assessed over the short, 
medium, and long-time horizons based on this forecasted position. 
•	 Analysis of acute physical risks is limited to 27 of our key distribution and 
manufacturing sites. The vulnerability of each of these sites is based on a 
typical manufacturing or distribution facility.
•	 Analysis is based on existing sites, products, and market share. 
•	 The results represent the gross risk position of our business strategy. 
2.5°C (Stated Policy)
IPCC SSP2-4.5
>4°C (No policy)
IPCC SSP5-8.5
1.	 SSPs - Shared Socio-economic Pathways outline different economic, social, and technological contexts, in the absence of further climate policy, that accompany the RCPs. 
2.	 RCP - The IPCC’s Representative Concentration Pathways outline different greenhouse gas concentration trajectories. RCP 8.5 indicates that GHG concentrations will result in 
global temperatures warming by >4°C on average, and therefore is associated with higher physical climate impacts. 
The relative impact of each of the CROs, 
without any current or future mitigating 
action was considered under each of the 
scenarios. The results are presented in the 
table below. 
We believe our business, with its strategic 
focus on local brands and distribution 
capability, is shown to be resilient to climate 
change. Sustainability forms a core part 
of our strategy, and we will continue to 
focus on reducing our Scope 1, 2 and 3 
emissions, thereby reducing our potential 
exposure to increasing costs from direct 
or indirect carbon taxation and improving 
our position to capitalise on the market 
opportunity of low carbon products. 
Going forward, as recommended by the 
TCFD, we will look to reassess our business 
strategy and model against these CROs 
under different scenarios where there is a 
significant change to the business.
Impact scale
 
Low Risk
Medium 
Risk
High Risk 
High 
Opportunity
Medium 
Opportunity
Low 
Opportunity
Scenario
Assumptions
Potential Impact
Summary of results
Short
Medium
Long
1. Climate Change Levy / Carbon Tax
1.5°C
All countries apply an average 
carbon price of $80/tCO2. This 
carbon price varies by country and 
over time. 
The application of a carbon tax to our Scope 1, 2 
and 3 emissions may have the potential to result in a 
significant cost to the business under the 2.5°C and 
1.5°C scenarios. As our scope 3 emissions account 
for the majority of our exposure, these costs are 
anticipated to be realised through indirect costs via 
our supply chain. The size of this cost will depend on 
the extent to which suppliers reflect their own carbon 
tax expenditure within their prices and the extent 
to which we ourselves are able to absorb this cost 
instead of passing the cost on to our customers.
To mitigate this risk, we are engaging with our 
suppliers, encouraging them to publish a CDP 
disclosure, and share their full carbon footprint. We 
are also looking to reduce emissions from our own 
operations.
2.5°C
$40/tCO2 is applied in all advanced 
economies. This carbon price varies 
by country and over time. 
>4°C
All carbon pricing is repealed ($2/
tCO2) 
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
49

Scenario
Assumptions
Potential Impact
Summary of results
Short
Medium
Long
2. The reduction of water available for production due to water stress
1.5°C
This analysis examined 27 of our 
own manufacturing and distribution 
sites. 
The vulnerability curve assumes 
~4 days disruption for offices and 
manufacturing sites (for a severe 
water stress event) and ~2 days 
disruption for warehouse/distribution 
sites.
Water stress was examined for each of the 27 priority 
sites. Overall, while the probability of this risk is 
expected to increase under all scenarios between 
2025-2050, even doubling in this period under 
the >4°C scenario, it is not estimated to result in a 
significant potential impact on revenue. 
2.5°C
>4°C
3. Disruption of production and distribution at key facilities due to flooding
1.5°C
This analysis examined 27 of our 
own manufacturing and distribution 
sites. The analysis examines both 
riverine and coastal flood events. 
Flash floods, however, are not 
included within this analysis.
The vulnerability curve assumes ~8 
days disruption for manufacturing 
sites, ~1 for offices and ~7 for 
warehouse/distribution sites (for a 
0.5m flood)
Both coastal and riverine flooding were examined 
under this analysis. It was found that the risk of both 
coastal and riverine flooding was found to increase 
over time for all scenarios, although it was not found 
to present a significant risk to the overall business
2.5°C
>4°C
4. Disruption of production and distribution at key facilities due to extreme weather events
1.5°C
This analysis examined 27 of our 
own manufacturing and distribution 
sites. The vulnerability curve 
assumes ~0.1 days disruption for 
offices, ~1.1 days for manufacturing 
sites and warehouse/distribution 
sites (for a major temperate 
windstorm).
Analysis is limited to the impacts of heatwaves 
and temperate windstorms at 27 key distribution 
and manufacturing sites. Heatwaves are expected 
to present a minimal risk, whereas temperate 
windstorms have the potential to result in significant 
impacts in the form of asset damage and revenue 
disruption. However, the baseline risk for windstorms 
is currently high. The potential financial impact of 
this risk under a >4°C scenario, in terms of revenue 
disruption and property damage, is expected to 
increase by 6% between 2025 and 2050.
2.5°C
>4°C
5. Effects of chronic climate change on ingredient production
1.5°C
The optimal growing conditions 
for five key crops were examined 
(apples, wine grapes, barley, sugar 
beet, and hops) for our sourcing 
locations for both our distribution 
and own-branded products). It was 
assumed that these products were 
not substitutable. 
Overall, wine grapes and sugar beet were found to be 
the most impacted crops with the greatest potential 
for significant impacts expected in the longer term 
under the 2.5°C and >4°C scenarios. Conversely, 
under the same scenarios, some crops, particularly 
those sourced locally, are estimated to experience 
a net increase in yields. We will continue to monitor 
risk at key sourcing locations and use the outputs to 
inform procurement decisions.
Where our sourcing locations may experience lower 
yields as a result of climate change, we may see 
an increase in the cost of products purchased for 
distribution in these areas. Going forward we will 
monitor these areas and factor this risk into our 
buying decisions.
2.5°C
>4°C
Task Force for Climate Related Financial Disclosures
(continued)
50
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Risk Management
In FY2021, Sustainability & Climate 
Change was identified as being a 
principal risk for C&C. Therefore, the 
identification, prioritisation, assessment, 
and management of our ‘Sustainability 
and Climate Change’ risk is carried out in a 
manner consistent with the Group’s other 
principal risks apart from the timeframe 
used (please refer to the Strategy section of 
the TCFD report on page 44). 
C&C adopts a standard risk management 
framework which is discussed in detail 
on page 32. Given the increasing focus 
on climate, in FY2022 we completed a 
detailed review on CROs as described in 
the strategy section above, which were 
validated by the ESG Board Committee in 
FY2023 and reviewed in FY2024. We have 
integrated the results of this assessment 
into our overall risk management system. 
For additional information regarding the 
climate-related risks identified and our 
activities to mitigate these risks, please refer 
to the Strategy section of the TCFD report 
on pages 44-48. Climate change mitigation 
is a current and ongoing responsibility for 
the ESG Board Committee as highlighted 
as part of the Governance section of this 
report on pages 42-44.
Further, as noted in the governance section, 
Group policy is to assign an Executive 
Committee owner for each principal risk 
identified, meaning there is Committee 
level oversight and management of the 
Sustainability & Climate Change risk. 
The owner of the Sustainability & Climate 
Change risk reviews all the other principal 
risks on the Group’s risk register to 
assess them under a sustainability and 
climate change lens, thus reflecting the 
commitment of the Group in ensuring that 
sustainability and climate-related risks be 
considered and integrated into the business 
in a holistic manner.
To be able to better manage the projected 
impacts of climate change, we are 
committed to the continuous improvement 
of our processes for identifying and 
assessing our climate-related risks and have 
identified the importance of implementing a 
bottom-up risk assessment process, which 
is currently being structured.
Any changes to climate-regulation, or 
the emergence of new climate-related 
regulation is considered as part of our 
normal regulation assessment for the 
Group.
Metrics & Targets
The Board recognises the importance of 
ensuring that we monitor our performance 
with respect to the CROs identified with 
tailored KPIs.
To oversee our progress against our 
Group’s climate-related goals and targets 
we have set a number of climate-related 
KPIs in line with our sustainability strategy. 
These KPIs have been selected to monitor 
our progress against our targets and to help 
us manage the identified CROs. The metrics 
adopted are monitored using a financial 
control boundary, and were developed in 
alignment with international environmental 
frameworks, namely CDP and SBTI, as 
well as with guidance provided by GHG 
Protocol. 
However, we acknowledge that more 
work needs to be done and the Group is 
currently working on developing additional 
metrics that are more tailored to the 
identified CROs, following the output and 
the learnings from the quantitative scenario 
analysis which began in Q4 of FY2023 and 
completed in Q1 of FY2024.
Carbon reduction progress made during 
FY2024 means we are on track in relation 
to the Group’s Carbon reduction targets 
validated by SBTi in FY2023. Further, the 
Group received limited assurance from EY 
during FY2024 over the following metrics: 
our scope 1 and 2 emissions and our 
water ratio. For further information on how 
our metrics currently map to the identified 
CROs, please refer to the Strategy section 
of the TCFD report on pages 44-48. For 
more information on our performance and 
our historical progress around wider ESG 
matters please refer to the Sustainability 
Report on pages 59-89.
Scenario
Assumptions
Potential Impact
Summary of results
Short
Medium
Long
6. Increased market opportunity for low carbon products due to sustainable trends in consumer demand.
1.5°C
Rapidly growing demand for 
sustainable products in all markets
The market opportunity for low carbon products may 
be significant under – 2.5°C - 1.5°C scenario. 
There is potential for a significant increase in revenue 
as consumer preferences shift towards low carbon 
alternatives.
Further prioritising the production and distribution of 
low carbon products could also limit our exposure to 
carbon taxes and their associated costs. 
2.5°C
Limited consumer demand for 
sustainable products within both 
leading and emerging markets
>4°C
Little consumer demand for 
sustainable products
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
51

TCFD Index and Focus areas for FY2025
Disclosure Requirement
TCFD 
disclosure met
Page 
Reference
Actions Undertaken 
Next Steps
Governance
(a) Describe the board’s oversight of 
climate-related risks and opportunities.
Yes
42-44
	• Additional reporting lines to 
the ESG Board Committee 
established, specifically the 
ESG Management-level 
Committee.
	• The Board, Management 
and Functional level teams 
undertook further training on 
ESG and climate change.
	• Board, Management and 
Functional-level ESG training.
(b) Describe management’s role in 
assessing and managing climate-related 
risks and opportunities.
Yes
42-44
Strategy
(a) Describe the climate-related risks and 
opportunities the organisation has identified 
over the short, medium, and long-term.
Yes
44-48
	• Began to integrate the 
results from the detailed 
quantitative climate 
change risk assessment 
and scenario analysis 
into strategy and financial 
planning.
	• Continue to monitor the risks 
that we have identified and 
consider emerging CROs 
as new climate data and 
policies emerge. 
	• Continue to actively monitor 
the changing landscape 
of sustainability reporting 
requirements, especially in 
relation to the Corporate 
Sustainability Reporting 
Directive (CSRD).
	• Continue to work towards 
our validated SBTi targets.
(b) Describe the impact of climate-
related risks and opportunities on the 
organisation’s businesses, strategy, and 
financial planning.
 Partial 
44-48
(c) Describe the resilience of the 
organisation’s strategy, taking into 
consideration different climate-related 
scenarios, including a 2°C or lower 
scenario.
Yes
44-48
Risk Management
(a) Describe the organisation’s processes 
for identifying and assessing climate-related 
risks.
Yes
51
	• Started to develop a 
bottom-up risk assessment 
process.
	• Develop bottom-up risk 
assessment process relevant 
to CROs.
	• Management and Functional 
level teams to undertake 
training that will include 
climate risk topics.
(b) Describe the organisation’s processes 
for managing climate-related risks.
Yes
51
(c) Describe how processes for identifying, 
assessing, and managing climate-related 
risks are integrated into the organisation’s 
overall risk management.
Yes
51
Metrics & Targets
(a) Disclose the metrics used by the 
organisation to assess climate-related risks 
and opportunities in line with its strategy 
and risk management process.
Partially
51
	• Carbon reduction progress 
made in line with the 
Group’s Carbon reduction 
targets validated by SBTi in 
FY2023.
	• Further assessed our 
current metrics in relation to 
the identified CROs.
	• Evaluate and develop, where 
applicable, additional metrics 
and targets to support us 
in managing the identified 
climate-related risks and 
opportunities.
	• Achieve our SBTi objectives
	• In FY2025, extend assurance 
over emission metrics to 
include scope 3 Supplier 
Engagement target.
(b) Disclose Scope 1, Scope 2, and, if 
appropriate, Scope 3 greenhouse gas 
(GHG) emissions, and the related risks.
Yes
51
(c) Describe the targets used by the 
organisation to manage climate related 
risks and opportunities and performance 
against targets.
Partially
51
Task Force for Climate Related Financial Disclosures
(continued)
52
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

prior year (restated)(vii), This reflects a number of factors, including 
the ERP System implementation issues noted above and a high-
inflation environment for the majority of the financial year with the 
related impact on consumers’ discretionary spending. In response 
to this challenging and evolving inflationary backdrop and uncertain 
macro environment, the Group has implemented a series of price 
increases and cost-efficiency measures and remains committed to 
its transformation programme to maintain profitability in the short 
and medium term. 
Managing liquidity(ii) and net debt(iii) have been focus areas for the 
Group throughout FY2024, including mitigating the working capital 
impact of the ERP System implementation, and the Group maintains 
a robust liquidity position with available liquidity(ii) of €390.1m at 
29 February 2024 and at year end achieved net debt(iii)/adjusted 
EBITDA(v) of 1.8x. The Group’s target net debt(iii)/adjusted EBITDA(v) 
level is between 1.5x and 2.0x.
Accounting Policies
As required by European Union (‘EU’) law, the Group’s financial 
statements have been prepared in accordance with International 
Financial Reporting Standards (‘IFRS’) as adopted by the EU, and 
as applied in accordance with the Companies Act 2014, applicable 
Irish law and the Listing Rules of the UK Listing Authority. Details of 
the basis of preparation and the accounting policies are outlined on 
pages 189 to 204. 
Finance Costs, Income Tax and Shareholder Returns
Net finance costs before exceptional items of €21.2m were incurred 
in the financial year (FY2023 (restated): €16.7mvii)). The Group has 
incurred exceptional finance expense of €2.9m (FY2023: €2.6m) 
as a consequence of increased utilisation of the Group’s debtor’s 
securitisation facility as a consequence of the ERP System 
implementation which has a significant impact on working capital 
and also from double-running of leased depots in London in 
respect of the transition from Park Royal to Orbital West for the 
MCB business. Of the €21.2m net finance cost, €5.0m relates to the 
Group’s debtor securitisation facility, €3.7m relates to USPP notes, 
€5.6m relates to the Group’s main bank lending facilities, €4.8m 
relates to lease interest, €1.0m relates to amortisation of prepaid 
issue costs, €0.2m of income relates to interest received and €1.3m 
relates to other interest costs. 
Results For the Year
Whilst the Group’s performance in FY2024 has been 
significantly impacted by one-off charges arising from the ERP 
System implementation in the Matthew Clark and Bibendum 
(‘MCB’) business, as well as by other macro-economic 
operating environment challenges, the Group’s brands 
performance has been resilient and cash generation has been 
strong, and significant work has been undertaken to restore 
MCB’s service levels. 
C&C is reporting net revenue of €1,652.5m, operating profit(i) of 
€60.0m, liquidity(ii) of €390.1m and net debt(iii) of €168.0m. Net 
debt excluding IFRS 16 Leases was €57.9m. Adjusted diluted 
EPS for FY2024 is 8.1 cent. The Group’s operating profit(i) of 
€60.0m is down from an operating profit(i) of €82.6m in the 
Andrew Andrea
Chief Financial Officer
Chief Financial Officer’s Review
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
53

In FY2024, the UK trading group continued 
its significant contribution to overall Group 
profits and this impacted the Group’s 
effective adjusted tax rate(i) for FY2024 of 
17.8%, as UK-generated profits are taxed a 
rate of 25% as compared to that of 15.0% 
in Ireland. The base rate of corporate tax in 
Ireland is 12.5% however from 01 January 
2024, groups with a turnover in excess of 
€750m in two of the previous four financial 
years are subject to the global minimum tax 
rate of 15%. Given that the Group will be in 
scope of these rules, this could potentially 
put further pressure on its effective tax 
rate in future periods (although, based 
on current projections, we do not expect 
these rules to have a material impact on 
the Group’s total tax charge in the short 
term). The Group continues to manage its 
effective tax rate in line with its published 
tax strategy. 
Subject to Shareholder approval, the 
Directors have proposed a final dividend 
of 3.97 cent per share to be paid on 23 
August 2024 to ordinary Shareholders 
registered at the close of business on 19 
July 2024. An interim dividend of 1.89 cent 
per share was paid with respect to FY2024; 
therefore, the Group’s full year dividend 
will amount to 5.86 cent per share. The 
proposed full year dividend per share will 
represent a pay-out of 72.3% of the full 
year reported adjusted diluted earnings per 
share. Using the number of shares in issue 
at 29 February 2024 and excluding those 
shares for which it is assumed that the 
right to dividend will be waived, this would 
equate to a distribution of €15.6m. There is 
no scrip dividend alternative proposed. Total 
dividends for the prior financial year were 
€14.9m. 
The Group commenced a share buyback 
programme on 1 March 2024 to repurchase 
ordinary shares of the Group up to a 
maximum aggregate consideration of €15 
million. The programme is progressing as 
planned and will be completed by 30 June 
2024. As of 21 June 2024, the Group has 
repurchased 7,653,323 shares at a cost of 
€14.6m. 
 
The Programme forms part of the Group's 
plan to return up to €150 million to 
Shareholders over the next three fiscal years 
as announced in October 2023 through 
a combination of dividends and share 
buybacks and follows the reinstatement 
of dividend payments last year. The 
Programme is underpinned by the Board's 
confidence in the medium-term outlook for 
the business and its strong cash generation 
capabilities. The Board also believes that the 
Programme represents the most effective 
use of capital in the current environment.
Exceptional Items
A total exceptional charge, before tax 
of €150.4m, was incurred in the current 
financial year and in the opinion of the 
Board the presentation of these items as 
exceptional provides a more useful analysis 
of the underlying performance of the Group. 
Full details of Exceptional Items are set 
out in detail in note 5 to the consolidated 
financial statements, but the majority of 
this net charge is from a decision to impair 
the goodwill on the Magners brand in the 
C&C Brands Cash Generating Unit by 
€125.0m, restructuring costs of €7.6m and 
costs of €10.4m associated with the ERP 
implementation. 
Balance Sheet Strength and Debt 
Management 
Balance sheet strength provides the Group 
with the financial flexibility to pursue its 
strategic objectives. It is the Group’s policy 
to ensure that a medium/long-term debt 
funding structure is in place to provide the 
Group with the financial capacity to promote 
the future development of the business and 
to achieve its strategic objectives. 
The Group manages its borrowing 
requirements by entering into committed 
loan facility agreements and also holds 
USPP notes which diversifies the Group’s 
sources of debt finance.
In December 2023, the Group exercised the 
option to extend the maturity of the multi-
currency facility that started in May 2023, 
and maturity is now extended to January 
2029. 
The Group maintains a £150.0m receivables 
securitisation facility (£120.0m committed, 
£30.0m uncommitted), renewable annually 
in May. As at 29 February 2024, €105.9m of 
this facility was drawn (FY2023: €94.1m).
Cash Generation
Summary cash flow for the year ended 
29 February 2024 is set out in the table 
below. Overall liquidity remains robust. 
The increase in the Group’s receivables 
purchase programme was driven by the 
ERP System implementation effects and 
the related impact on working capital. The 
contribution to year end Group cash from 
the receivables purchase programme was 
€105.9m compared to €94.1m (€95.2m on 
a constant currency basis(iv)) at 28 February 
2023 - a cash inflow of €10.7m(iv). 
Capital expenditure in FY2024 amounted to 
€20.0m, with €3.2m relating to investment 
in technology as the Group continues the 
digital transformation and optimisation of 
the business and €2.3m directly related to 
ESG initiatives and investments, including 
returnable bottles as part of the Irish 
Deposit Return Scheme initiative and the 
heat pump project at Clonmel.
Chief Financial Officer’s Review
(continued)
54
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Table 1 – Reconciliation of Operating profit to Adjusted EBITDA(v) 
2024 
2023 
(restated)(vii)
€m
€m
Operating profit
(84.4)
70.2
Exceptional items
144.4
12.4
Operating profit before exceptional items 
60.0
82.6
Amortisation and depreciation charge
33.7
33.4
Adjusted EBITDA(v)
93.7
116.0
 
Table 2 – Cash flow summary
2024 
 
2023 
(restated)(vii)
€m
€m
Adjusted EBITDA(v) 
93.7
116.0
Working capital
30.4
5.0
Advances to customers
3.5
(3.6)
Net finance costs excluding exceptional finance costs
(17.6)
(16.8)
Tax paid 
(4.1)
(12.0)
Pension contributions paid
(0.4)
(0.5)
Tangible/intangible expenditure
(20.0)
(15.2)
Net proceeds on disposal of property plant & equipment
0.1
-
Exceptional items paid
(21.8)
(4.5)
Other*
-
2.4
Free cash flow(vi)
63.8
70.8
Free cash flow(vi)
63.8
70.8
Net exceptional cash outflow 
21.8
4.5
Free cash flow(vi) excluding net exceptional cash outflow
85.6
75.3
Reconciliation to Group Cash Flow Statement
Free cash flow(vi)
63.8
70.8
Dividends paid 
(22.3)
-
Drawdown of debt
130.0
48.5
Payment of debt issue costs
(3.4)
-
Repayment of debt
(105.0)
(108.5)
Payment of lease liabilities
(20.2)
(22.5)
Payment of Rights Issue costs
-
(0.7)
Disposal of asset held for sale
-
63.6
Disposal of subsidiary/equity investment
-
0.7
Net increase in cash 
42.9
51.9
* 	
Other relates to the add back of share options, pension contributions and adjustments from charge to payment. 
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
55

Prior Year Restatements
During the year accounting discrepancies 
were discovered and notified to the Audit 
Committee. Detailed internal and external 
reviews of inventory and balance sheet 
reconciliations were undertaken and an 
independent accounting firm was appointed 
to investigate the relevant issues and to 
determine contributing factors, any potential 
financial impact and the time period over 
which the issues extended. Following the 
findings in the Investigative Accountants’ 
Report, management’s further reviews, 
and EY’s audit procedures, the Group have 
recorded adjustments in the current year 
financial statements in respect of the current 
year, and restatements to prior period 
financial statements for the year ended 28 
February 2023 and opening balances at 1 
March 2022.  The accounting adjustments in 
aggregate represent an underlying operating 
profit adjustments charge of €6.1m. By 
year, the restatements comprised a €1.5m 
adjustment charge in FY2023, a €3.1m 
adjustment credit in FY2022 and a €7.7m 
adjustment charge in FY2021. In addition, 
the Group has recorded an exceptional 
charge in FY2023 of €12.2m in respect of 
onerous apple contracts.  The total value 
of the pre-tax adjustments, including the 
exceptional items charge is €18.3m and the 
impact on the Group’s retained earnings 
position at FY2023 is €15.6m. There will 
also be an impact on the unaudited FY2024 
Interim Results, details of which will be set 
out in the FY2025 Interim Results to be 
released in October.
The adjustments to underlying operating 
profit related principally to five items, 
inventory related matters (€11.1m charge), 
incorrect accounting treatment of inventory 
of branded glassware (€1.1m charge), goods 
received not invoiced ("GRNI") (€2.9m 
credit), the timing of release of customer 
discount liabilities (€3.7m credit), together 
with additional items (€0.5m charge), over 
the three-year period in question.  
The adjustments were made following 
detailed internal and external reviews of 
inventory and balance sheet reconciliations 
after discrepancies were notified to the 
Audit Committee earlier this year. An 
independent accounting firm was appointed 
to investigate the relevant issues and to 
determine any potential financial impact 
and the time period over which the issues 
extended. The issues that were identified 
were then considered in detail by both the 
Group's Audit Committee (the 'Committee') 
and the Board, as part of the finalisation 
of the Group's FY2024 Annual Report and 
Accounts.
The Board and Audit Committee have 
considered the background to these items 
in detail, including representations and 
accuracy of information provided to the 
external auditors and to the Committee 
and the Board at the time the items arose 
and in subsequent financial years. In 
addition to accounting mistakes and errors 
of judgement underlying these issues, 
it is clear from the reviews undertaken 
that there were failures in the Group's 
reporting framework and that in parts 
of the organisation behaviours fell short 
of the levels of transparency demanded 
and required such that opportunities 
were missed to identify and appropriately 
address the relevant issues. Further details 
relating to the underlying issues and the 
consequent actions and improvements to 
the controls and governance frameworks 
that have been and are being taken to 
ensure that there is no repetition of these 
issues are set out in the Audit Committee 
report. 
Retirement Benefits
In compliance with IFRS, the net assets 
and actuarial liabilities of the various 
defined benefit pension schemes operated 
by the Group companies, computed in 
accordance with IAS 19 Employee Benefits, 
are included on the face of the Consolidated 
Balance Sheet as retirement benefits.
Independent actuarial valuations of the 
defined benefit pension schemes are 
carried out on a triennial basis using the 
attained age method. An actuarial valuation 
process is currently ongoing. The most 
recently completed actuarial valuations of 
the ROI defined benefit pension schemes 
were carried out with an effective date of 
1 January 2021 while the date of the most 
recent actuarial valuation of the NI defined 
benefit pension scheme was 31 December 
2020. As a result of these valuations the 
Group has committed to contributions 
of 27.5% of pensionable salaries for the 
Group’s staff defined benefit scheme. There 
is no funding requirement with respect 
to the Group’s executive defined benefit 
pension scheme or the Group’s NI defined 
benefit pension scheme, both of which are 
in surplus. The Group has an unconditional 
right to these surpluses when the scheme 
concludes. The Trustees of the C&C Group 
Executive Pension and Life Assurance 
Scheme entered into an annuity buy in 
contract with effect from 27 February 2024 
in respect of current pensioners in payment. 
While the obligation to provide pensions 
to these members remains a liability of the 
Scheme, the insurance contract provides 
a matching cash flow and longevity hedge. 
The Group was supportive of the Trustees 
actions as it further reduces risk within that 
Scheme. 
Chief Financial Officer’s Review
(continued)
56
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

There are two active members in the NI 
scheme and 49 active members (less than 
10% of total membership) in the ROI staff 
defined benefit pension scheme and no 
active members in the executive defined 
benefit pension scheme. 
At 29 February 2024, the retirement 
benefits computed in accordance with IAS 
19 Employee Benefits amounted to a net 
surplus of €34.3m gross of deferred tax 
(€25.4m surplus with respect to the Group’s 
staff defined benefit pension scheme, 
€5.8m surplus with respect to the Group’s 
executive defined benefit pension scheme 
and a €3.1m surplus with respect to the 
Group’s NI defined benefit pension scheme) 
and a net surplus of €29.7m net of deferred 
tax. 
The key factors influencing the change in 
valuation of the Group’s defined benefit 
pension scheme obligations gross of 
deferred tax are as outlined below:
€m
Net surplus at 1 March 2023
42.2
Translation adjustment 
0.2
Employer contributions paid 
0.4
Charge to Other 
Comprehensive Income
(9.9)
Credit to Income Statement
1.4
Net surplus at 29 February 
2024
34.3
The decrease in the surplus from €42.2m 
at 28 February 2023 to a surplus of €34.3m 
at 29 February 2024 is primarily due to an 
actuarial loss of €9.9m over the year. The 
decrease in the net surplus of the Group’s 
defined benefit pension schemes from the 
28 February 2023 to 29 February 2024, 
as computed in accordance with IAS 19 
Employee Benefits, is primarily due to 
an increase in liabilities as a result of the 
decrease in corporate bond yields over the 
year somewhat offset by reduced benefit 
inflation expectation.
Financial Risk Management
The main financial market risks facing the 
Group continue to include commodity price 
fluctuations, foreign currency exchange 
rate risk, interest rate risk, counterparty 
creditworthiness and liquidity risk. 
The Board of Directors set the treasury 
policies and objectives of the Group, the 
implementation of which are monitored by 
the Audit Committee. Details of both the 
policies and control procedures adopted to 
manage these financial risks are set out in 
detail in note 24 to the consolidated financial 
statements. 
Currency Risk Management
The reporting currency and the currency 
used for all planning and budgetary 
purposes is Euro. However, as the 
Group transacts in foreign currencies 
and consolidates the results of non-Euro 
reporting foreign operations, it is exposed 
to both transaction and translation currency 
risk. 
Currency transaction exposures primarily 
arise on the Sterling, US, Canadian and 
Australian Dollar denominated sales of 
the Group’s Euro subsidiaries and Euro 
purchases in the Group’s Great Britain 
(GB) business. The Group seeks to 
minimise this exposure, when possible, 
by offsetting the foreign currency input 
costs against the same foreign currency 
receipts, creating a natural hedge. When 
the remaining net currency exposure is 
material, the Group enters into foreign 
currency forward contracts to mitigate 
and protect against adverse movements 
in currency risk and remove uncertainty 
over the foreign currency equivalent cash 
flows. Forward foreign currency contracts 
are used to manage this risk in a non-
speculative manner when the Group’s net 
exposure exceeds certain limits as set 
out in the Group’s treasury policy. In the 
current financial year, the Group had €11.5m 
forward foreign currency cash flow hedges 
outstanding.
The average rate for the translation of 
results from Sterling currency operations 
was €1:£0.8653 (year ended 28 February 
2023: €1:£0.8604) and from US Dollar 
operations was €1:$1.0831 (year ended 28 
February 2023: €1:$1.0438). 
Comparisons for revenue, net revenue and 
operating profit before exceptional items 
for each of the Group’s reporting segments 
are shown at constant exchange rates for 
transactions by subsidiary undertakings 
in currencies other than their functional 
currency and for translation in relation 
to the Group’s Sterling and US Dollar 
denominated subsidiaries by restating the 
prior year at current year average rates.
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
57

Applying the realised FY2024 foreign currency rates to the reported FY2023 revenue, net 
revenue and operating profit(i) are shown in the table below:
Table 3 – Constant currency comparatives
Year ended 
28 February 2023 
(restated)(vii)
FX transaction
FX translation
Year ended 
28 February 2023 
€m
€m
€m
€m
Revenue
 
Ireland
389.6
- 
(0.4) 
389.2
Branded
154.9
- 
(0.2)
154.7
Distribution
231.2
- 
(0.2)
231.0
Co-pack/Other
3.5
-
-
3.5
Great Britain
1,674.2
-
(9.4)
1,664.8
Branded
310.9
-
(1.6)
309.3
Distribution
1,332.2
-
(7.6)
1,324.6
Co-pack/Other
31.1
-
(0.2)
30.9
Total
2,063.8
- 
(9.8)
2,054.0 
Net revenue
Ireland
272.0
-
(0.3)
271.7
Branded
107.6
-
(0.2)
107.4
Distribution
162.4
-
(0.2)
162.2
Co-pack/Other
2.0
-
0.1
2.1
Great Britain
1,414.2
-
(7.8)
1,406.4
Branded
193.8
-
(0.9)
192.9
Distribution
1,193.3
-
(6.8)
1,186.5
Co-pack/Other
27.1
-
(0.1)
27.0
Total
1,686.2
- 
(8.1)
1,678.1
Operating profit(i)
Ireland
24.9
-
-
23.9
Branded
18.2
(1.0)
-
17.2
Distribution
6.7
-
-
6.7
Great Britain
57.7
-
(0.3)
57.9
Branded
22.7
-
(0.2) 
22.5
Distribution
35.0
0.5
(0.1)
35.4
Total
82.6
(0.5)
(0.3)
81.8
 
Notes to the Group Chief Financial Officer’s Review
(i) 	 Before exceptional items.
(ii) 	 Liquidity is defined as cash plus undrawn amounts under the Group’s revolving credit facility. 
(iii) 	Net debt comprises borrowings (net of issue costs) less cash plus lease liabilities capitalised under IFRS 16 
Leases.
(iv) 	FY2023 comparative adjusted for constant currency (FY2023 translated at FY2024 F/X rates).
(v) 	 Adjusted EBITDA is earnings before exceptional items, finance income, finance expense, tax, depreciation, 
amortisation charges and equity accounted investments’ profit/(loss) after tax. A reconciliation of the Group’s 
operating profit to EBITDA is set out on page 55. 
(vi) 	Free Cash Flow (‘FCF’) that comprises cash flow from operating activities net of capital investment cash outflows 
which form part of investing activities. FCF highlights the underlying cash generating performance of the ongoing 
business. FCF benefits from the Group’s purchase receivables programme which contributed €105.9m (FY2023: 
€94.1m reported/€95.2m on a constant currency basis) of cash as at 29 February 2024. A reconciliation of FCF to 
net movement in cash per the Group’s Cash Flow Statement is set out above.
(vii) C&C restated prior year information in the year ended 29 February 2024. Full details of this are included in note 31 
to the consolidated financial statements.
Chief Financial Officer’s Review
(continued)
Commodity Price and Other Risk 
Management
The Group is exposed to commodity 
price fluctuations, and manages this risk, 
where economically viable, by entering 
into fixed price supply contracts with 
suppliers. The Group does not directly 
enter into commodity hedge contracts. 
The cost of production is also sensitive to 
variability in the price of energy, primarily 
gas and electricity. The Group’s policy is 
to fix the cost of a certain level of energy 
requirement through fixed price contractual 
arrangements directly with the Group’s 
energy suppliers. 
The Group seeks to mitigate risks in relation 
to the continuity of supply of key raw 
materials and ingredients by developing 
trade relationships with key suppliers and 
an agreement with farmers in Scotland for 
the supply of malted barley. 
In addition, the Group enters into insurance 
arrangements to cover certain insurable 
risks where external insurance is considered 
by management to be an economic means 
of mitigating these risks.
Andrew Andrea
Chief Financial Officer
58
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Sustainability Report
Our Environmental, Social and 
Governance (ESG) strategy is integral 
to C&C Group’s purpose and our three 
core values: ‘Respect people and the 
planet;’ ‘We bring joy to life;’ and ‘Quality 
is at our core.’ 
FY2024 ESG KPIs / Highlights
-24% (vs target -12%)
Scope 1&2 Emissions Reduction (Location Based) V’s FY2020 
(Baseline)
95% 
Electricity used at our sites is generated from renewable 
sources. This is 100% for Wellpark and Clonmel
 
-26% (vs target -9%)
Scope 3 Emissions Reduction V’s FY2020 (Baseline)
 
48% (vs target 45%) 
Suppliers making up 67% of Scope 3 emissions will have 
science-based targets in place by 2026. 
 
3.2:1 (vs target 3.4:1)
Water Efficiency Ratio - (hectolitres extracted / hectolitres 
produced)
 
2 (vs target ZERO) 
Number of incidences of non-compliance with industry and 
regulatory marketing codes. 
 
0.18 (vs target 0.14) 
Health and Safety - Lost Time Incident Rate (incidents per one 
hundred employees) 
 
Eliminating our Gender Pay Gap 
- average pay for female employees is now higher compared to 
male employees. C&C Group plc Gender Pay Gap Report 2023
7.1 (vs target 7.5) 
Employee Engagement Score from Peakon Survey
Accreditations 
Well below 2°C.
Science Based Target Validation received in Jan-23
 
AA 
MSCI ESG Rating – Mar-24
 
Best Large Business Winner
Tennent Caledonian Breweries were recognised as the 
Best Large Business at the VIBES (VISION IN BUSINESS 
ENVIRONMENT SCOTLAND) Scottish Environment Business 
Awards – Nov-23
 
AA+ 
BRCGS Accreditation – Wellpark – Mar-23
 
AA+ 
BRCGS Accreditation – Clonmel – Oct-23
ISO14001
Matthew Clark / Bibendum – September 2022  
(Expiry September 2024) 
Operates an environmental management system that complies 
with the requirements of ISO 14001:2015
Clonmel – January 2022 (Expiry January 2025)  
Operates an environmental management system that complies 
with the requirements of ISO 14001:2015
B 
CDP – Climate – Dec-23
C
CDP – Water – Dec-23
With Board level commitment to ESG, a dedicated ESG Team and 
a group of ESG Champions advocating sustainability across the 
business, we are delivering on our promise of embedding ESG into 
everything we do at C&C. 
Building on the above, in FY2024, a new ESG Management 
Committee, was established to review sustainability initiatives and 
reporting. Delegating those responsibilities which originally sat 
with the ESG Board Committee and therefore allowing for the ESG 
Board Committee to provide additional focus and scrutiny and to 
identify areas where C&C can really make a difference, as well as 
ensuring high standards of governance and reporting in this area. 
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
59

ESG Strategy: 
‘Delivering to a 
Better World!’
Our impact materiality assessment and six ESG pillars ensure that we focus on the most 
material areas to guide our actions around sustainability and support the UN Sustainable 
Development Goals (‘SDGs’). In FY2023, C&C Group carried out an impact materiality 
assessment, engaging a wide range of stakeholders, which has further strengthened our 
focused priorities. 
Reduce Our Carbon 
Footprint
Focus Areas
•	 Carbon Neutral by 2050 at the latest 
•	 Energy and Water Conservation
•	 Fleet Decarbonisation
•	 Waste Minimisation
Sustainably Source 
Our Products & 
Services
Focus Areas
•	 Supply Chain Engagement
•	 Enhanced Ethical Sourcing
Alignment to UN SDGs 
Alignment to UN SDGs 
Environment 
 
Ensure Alcohol 
Is Consumed 
Responsibly
Focus Areas
•	 Support for Minimum Unit Pricing
•	 Promoting 0%, Low Alcohol & Low-
Calorie Brands
•	 Alcohol Awareness Training
•	 Compliance with industry and 
regulatory marketing codes
Social 
Alignment to UN SDGs 
Sustainability Report
(continued)
60
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Enhance Health, 
Wellbeing & Capability 
of Colleagues
Focus Areas
•	 Health & Safety 
•	 Health & Wellbeing 
•	 Training and Development
Alignment to UN SDGs 
Governance 
Build A More 
Inclusive, Diverse, and 
Engaged C&C
Focus Areas
•	 Diversification of Board
•	 Diversity, Equity & Inclusion (DE&I) 
•	 Eliminating the Gender Pay Gap
•	 Employee Engagement 
Alignment to UN SDGs 
Collaborate With 
Government, Non-
Governmental 
Organisations 
(‘NGOs’), and Industry 
Programmes.
Focus Areas:
•	 Building Meaningful Charity Partnerships
•	 Deposit Return Scheme Implementation
•	 Review of Minimum Unit Pricing in 
Scotland 
Alignment to UN SDGs 
61
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Sustainability Report
(continued)
Our materiality process
Future Reporting
We understand that external stakeholders’ 
inputs are very valuable, especially 
when conducting an impact materiality 
assessment and gauging perspective from 
an external point of view. It familiarises us 
with the sustainable topics that are most 
material to our stakeholders and provides 
an opportunity to share information about 
our strategy and focus areas, aiding in 
creating a transparent relationship between 
us. In future reporting periods, engaging 
directly with external stakeholders shall 
remain a key focus area. In 2024 we 
will perform a comprehensive double 
materiality assessment, complying with our 
reporting obligations under the Corporate 
Sustainability Reporting Directive (‘CSRD’). 
The assessment will consider both our 
material impacts on our stakeholders and 
material sustainability related risks and 
opportunities for C&C.
C&C significantly improved the formality 
of the process supporting our materiality 
assessment in FY2023 by carrying out an 
impact materiality assessment, drawing 
on elements of guidance contained in the 
Global Reporting Initiative (GRI) framework. 
We structured our materiality approach as 
follows:
Developing a 
comprehensive  
list of ESG topics
Stakeholder 
mapping
Stakeholder 
consultation
Impact 
assessment
Collation and 
analysis of results
1
2
3
4
5
Figure 1: Broad approach to materiality assessment
 
1. Developing a comprehensive list of 
ESG topics
C&C carried out a preliminary desktop 
review to identify the existing and emerging 
trends and business risks in the alcoholic 
beverage sector. This was followed by 
a thorough analysis of material topics 
suggested within relevant reporting 
frameworks along with topics disclosed 
by industry peers. These inputs were 
used to identify eighty-nine potentially 
relevant topics which were further reviewed 
and grouped into twenty-six key topics, 
and sub-topics of Environment, Social, 
Governance and Economic.
2. Stakeholder mapping
We identified key stakeholder groups across 
our value chain and prioritised them through 
a comprehensive stakeholder mapping 
exercise, analysing the influence and 
dependency we have on each stakeholder 
group. Those with high influence and 
dependency scores, as summarised in 
the table below, were considered to be 
significant for the purposes of engagement 
in the impact materiality assessment 
process.
3. Stakeholder consultation
As this was the first year completing 
an impact materiality assessment, we 
consulted with internal stakeholder 
representatives through one-to-one 
interviews to understand C&C’s impact 
on the stakeholder group. We also 
distributed surveys to employees on a 
sample basis. Through the consultation 
process, we incorporated our stakeholders’ 
perspectives, concerns, and expectations 
into our materiality assessment process. 
4. Impact assessment
For further prioritisation of material topics, 
we conducted workshops with internal 
topic experts to score the impact of each 
topic in terms of scale, scope, irremediable 
character, and likelihood to determine the 
significance of the impacts.
5. Collation and analysis of results
Based on the results from stakeholder 
consultation and impact assessment 
exercise a list of twenty-one topics and their 
associated impacts was generated. The 
below material topic list was approved by 
the ESG Board Committee in May 2023. 
Table 1: List of prioritised stakeholders
Employees
Community/Community Representatives
Consumers
Suppliers – Branded third-party Drinks 
Business Partners 
Suppliers – Raw Materials / Finished 
Goods
Shareholders and Lenders
Customers
Business Partners/Joint Ventures 
including Agency and Invested brands
Workers in the value chain 
Industry Associations
Trade Union Representatives
62
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Figure 2: List of material topics
Topic
Impact generated
Direction 
of impact
Impact  
type
Impact 
materiality 
level
Value chain 
mapping
Time  
horizon
Strategy &  
performance*
1. Human Rights 
and sustainable 
sourcing across 
our Value Chain
Sourcing responsibly and having appropriate oversight 
and controls across our value chain, engaging with 
suppliers and distributors, understanding their 
expectations, and working with them to mitigate ESG 
risks creates a shared economic value for society and 
the environment. 
+
Potential
Medium
Upstream 
and 
Downstream
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
Pillar 2 – Sustainably Source 
Our Products & Services 
Appropriate controls around responsible sourcing 
are not in place or these standards are not upheld 
by our suppliers, there is potential for impact on the 
biodiversity of an area and/or human rights of workers 
in the supply chain.
-
Potential
High
Upstream 
and 
Downstream
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
2. Employee 
health, safety & 
wellbeing
Appropriate processes and controls around 
employees’ health and safety can create a safe working 
environment.
+
Potential
Medium
Operations
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
Pillar 4 – Enhance Health, 
Wellbeing & Capability of 
Colleagues
Appropriate processes and controls around employees’ 
health and safety are not in place or are not properly 
operating, leading to health & safety risks.
-
Potential
High
Operations
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
3. Product 
Quality, 
Customer 
Health, and 
Safety
Appropriate controls around product safety and 
quality are not in place, hindering the quality of C&C’s 
products.
-
Potential
High
Downstream
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
Pillar 2 – Sustainably Source 
Our Products & Services  
Pillar 4 – Enhance Health, 
Wellbeing & Capability of 
Colleagues
Appropriate controls around product safety and quality 
are in place allowing C&C to produce and deliver quality 
products. 
+
Potential
Medium
Downstream
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
4. Consumer 
Engagement 
and Responsible 
Drinking
Excessive consumption of alcohol can impact 
consumers’ health.
-
Potential
High
Downstream
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
Pillar 3 – Ensure Alcohol Is 
Consumed Responsibly 
Impact created on consumers as products and 
associated communications are presented to them in 
an ethical and socially responsible manner and they 
are able to understand the impacts on their health from 
the consumption of alcohol use and the importance of 
drinking responsibly.
+
Potential
Medium
Downstream
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
5. Water
Use of water in our production processes as well as 
for cleaning or water withdrawal from high stress areas 
or areas with low precipitation can impact biodiversity, 
local communities, and future generations.
-
Potential
High
Upstream 
and 
Operations
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
Pillar 1 – Reduce Our Carbon 
Footprint 
Production processes lead to the generation of 
wastewater – disposal of poor quality or untreated 
wastewater results in contamination of biodiversity and 
fresh water sources impacting the environment and the 
local communities.
-
Potential
Medium
Upstream 
and 
Operations
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
6. Climate 
change 
and carbon 
emissions
GHG emissions in our value chain (Scope 1, 2 and 3) 
have adverse impacts on the environment.
-
Potential
Medium
Upstream, 
Operations 
and 
Downstream
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
Pillar 1 – Reduce Our Carbon 
Footprint 
Usage of fossil fuel-based energy contributes to climate 
change and pollution impacting the environment and 
people. 
-
Potential
Medium
Upstream, 
Operations 
and 
Downstream
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
Usage of renewable energy sources and improving 
energy efficiency in the operations results in lower 
pollution and impacts on the environment. 
+
Potential
Medium
Upstream, 
Operations 
and 
Downstream
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
Achieving carbon neutrality/net zero shall significantly 
reduce the amount of harmful emissions that contribute 
to global warming.
+
Potential
Medium
Upstream, 
Operations 
and 
Downstream
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
7. Data privacy
If data privacy is not safeguarded, potential impact 
on those whose data we hold such as employees, 
customers, and vendors in the event of a data breach or 
cyber-attacks and their privacy is impacted.
-
Potential
Medium
Upstream, 
Operations 
and 
Downstream
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
Pillar 2 – Sustainably Source 
Our Products & Services  
Pillar 4 – Enhance Health, 
Wellbeing & Capability of 
Colleagues
8. Chemical 
and Hazardous 
material 
management
Improper management of chemical and hazardous 
material can cause contamination of the environment 
and a safety/health hazard if not stored, managed, or 
disposed properly. 
-
Potential
Medium
Operations 
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
Pillar 2 – Sustainably Source 
Our Products & Services 
9. Air pollution
Direct release of pollutants such as Sox, Nox and 
particulate matter generated from our manufacturing 
process deteriorates the ambient air quality impacting 
public health and the environment.
-
Potential
Medium
Upstream, 
Operations 
and 
Downstream
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
Pillar 1 – Reduce Our Carbon 
Footprint 
Pillar 2 – Sustainably Source 
Our Products & Services 
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
63

Topic
Impact generated
Direction 
of impact
Impact  
type
Impact 
materiality 
level
Value chain 
mapping
Time  
horizon
Strategy &  
performance*
10. Clean 
labelling and 
responsible 
marketing
Products and associated communications are 
presented to consumers in an ethical and socially 
responsible manner to allow consumers to make an 
informed choice based on accurate and fact-based 
information which is not misleading.
+
Potential
Medium
Downstream
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
Pillar 3 – Ensure Alcohol Is 
Consumed Responsibly 
Excessive consumption of alcohol can impact 
consumer health.
-
Potential
Low
Downstream
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
11. Biodiversity 
and Land
The impact on natural ecosystems due to poorly 
managed agricultural land and using pesticides/
herbicides and poor cultivation practices leads to 
habitat loss and degradation, erosion, species loss, air 
and water pollution, soil, and water contamination.
-
Potential
Low
Upstream 
and 
Operations
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
Pillar 1 – Reduce Our Carbon 
Footprint  
Pillar 2 – Sustainably Source 
Our Products & Services 
Carbon negative farming, e.g., cover cropping and 
carbon sequestration, can support the creation of well 
managed agricultural land, leading to healthier and 
more productive ecosystems.
+
Potential
Low
Upstream 
and 
Operations
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
12. Packaging 
and Circular 
Economy
Technological innovations in sustainable packaging 
solutions contributes to the reduction of packaging 
waste and lowers carbon and the overall environmental 
impact. 
+
Potential
Medium
Upstream, 
Operations 
and 
Downstream
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
Pillar 1 – Reduce Our Carbon 
Footprint 
Pillar 2 – Sustainably Source 
Our Products & Services 
Creating impact on the society and environment by 
encouraging consumers to dispose of their finished 
products responsibly.
+
Potential
Medium
Downstream
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
Improper controls around the disposal of materials 
and ineffective use of alternative waste management 
techniques (e.g. recycle, recover and reuse) can 
generate waste and if not disposed properly can 
contaminate the environment and lead to wasteful use 
of resources. 
-
Potential
Low
Upstream, 
Operations 
and 
Downstream
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
13. Diversity, 
Equity & 
Inclusion
Promoting equality, creating unbiased working 
conditions, and creating equal opportunities for our 
employees.
+
Actual
Medium
Operations
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
Pillar 5 – Build A More Inclusive, 
Diverse, and Engaged C&C
14. Economic 
Performance & 
Contributions
The direct and indirect impact of an organisation’s 
operations on its stakeholders and the environment 
through its economic activities and monetary impact.
+
Actual
Medium
Upstream, 
Operations 
and 
Downstream
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
Pillar 2 – Sustainably Source 
Our Products & Services 
Pillar 6 – Collaborate With 
Government, NGOs, and 
Industry Programmes
15. Community 
engagement
Engaging and supporting communities through 
investment programmes, charities and partnerships 
which uplifts and positively impacts local communities. 
+
Actual
Medium
Operations
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
Pillar 6 – Collaborate With 
Government, NGOs, and 
Industry Programmes
16. 
Transparency 
and Reporting
The impact of applying transparency and best 
practice reporting principles on ESG performance to 
how we report to our stakeholders and meeting their 
expectations.
+
Potential
Medium
Upstream, 
Operations 
and 
Downstream
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
All ESG Pillars
17. Input Raw 
Materials
Procurement practices that take into account the 
quantity and quality of materials used in manufacturing 
leads to more efficient use of materials and reduces the 
wasteful use of resources.
+
Potential
Medium
Operations
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
Pillar 2 – Sustainably 
Source Our Products & 
Services 
18. Ethical 
Business and 
Resilience
Impact created on all stakeholders as a result of ethical 
business practices and sustainable and resilient 
business structures.
+
Potential
Medium
Upstream, 
Operations 
and 
Downstream
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
Pillar 2 – Sustainably 
Source Our Products & 
Services 
19. Employee 
Engagement 
and 
Relationships
Increased employee productivity and trust due to 
consistent engagement with employees.
+
Potential
Medium
Operations
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
Pillar 5 – Build A More 
Inclusive, Diverse, and 
Engaged C&C
20. Worker 
Rights, 
Collective 
Bargaining and 
Freedom of 
Association
Supporting, engaging, and fostering good relationships 
with Employees so that they are able to practice 
freedom of association and expression leading to better 
working conditions.
+
Potential
Medium
Operations
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
Pillar 5 – Build A More 
Inclusive, Diverse, and 
Engaged C&C
21. Employee 
Benefits and 
Development
Rewarding talent and retaining employees by offering 
competitive remuneration and through measures 
that promote professional development, long-term 
employability, job satisfaction and healthy working 
culture.
+
Potential
Medium
Operations
Short, 
medium, and 
long-term
Pillar 4 – Enhance Health, 
Wellbeing & Capability of 
Colleagues
 
Sustainability Report
(continued)
64
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Reduce Our 
Carbon Footprint
 
Reducing carbon emissions
Science Based Targets Initiative (‘SBTi’)
In January 2023, the Group had its carbon 
emission reduction targets validated 
by the Science Based Targets initiative 
(‘SBTi’). C&C is committed to reducing its 
Scope 1 and Scope 2 Green House Gas 
(‘GHG’) emissions 35% by 2030 from a 
2020 baseline year. To achieve our Scope 
3 emissions target of 25% reduction by 
2030 we have been working with our key 
suppliers and customers, to ensure that 
67% of our suppliers (by spend) will have a 
validated science-based target by 2026.
Limited Assurance Statement
The Group is committed to reducing its 
carbon emissions and, whilst it makes every 
effort to ensure emissions are accurately 
reported, recognises the need for its 
performance to be externally assured. The 
Group was granted limited assurance, 
as defined by International Standards on 
Assurance Engagements, for our FY2023 
reporting of: Scope 1 and 2 GHG emissions 
(tCO2e); Water efficiency by water 
ratio (hectolitres extracted / hectolitres 
produced); and Lost Time Incident Rate 
(LTIR, incidents per 100 employees). 
In FY2025, the Group will extend this limited 
assurance to its Scope 3 engagement 
target that is validated by the SBTi. This 
target sees C&C Group plc commit that 
67% of its suppliers and customers by 
emissions (measured via a spend-based 
approach as set out in GHG Protocol for 
calculating Scope 3 Emissions), covering 
77% of purchased goods and services 
Environmental
emissions, 65% of upstream transportation 
and distribution emissions and 50% of 
downstream transportation and distribution 
emissions, will have science-based targets 
by 2026.
Further emphasising the Group’s 
commitment to ‘Delivering to a better world’ 
the Scope 1 & 2 carbon emission related 
Long-Term Incentive Plan will be extended. 
This was originally rolled out for three 
years (FY2022, 2023 and 2024) and will be 
extended to cover FY2025, 2026 and 2027. 
(More information can be found on pages 
136-163 of the Remuneration Committee 
Report).
Environmental Policy
Continuing our commitment to 
sustainability, in March 2023 our ESG 
Board Committee recommended, a 
new Environmental Policy for the Group. 
This policy was approved by the Group 
Executive Committee (Please see 
CCGroup-EnvironmentalPolicy-FINAL). This 
policy sets out and reaffirms the Group’s 
commitment to reducing GHG emissions 
across our operations and supply chain, as 
well as our commitment to producing and 
sourcing resources sustainably to play our 
part in reducing the negative impacts of 
climate change and biodiversity loss.
The Environmental Policy applies across 
all Group internal operations, and to 
management and employees. To ensure 
continuous progress, and for the purpose 
of maintaining relevance and effectiveness, 
this policy is subject to review by the ESG 
Board Committee every two years.
Target
KPI
Reduce direct operations location-based 
emissions by 35% by 2030 (Scope 1 
and 2)
24% location-based reduction from 
FY2020 (base year)
35% market-based reduction from 
FY2020 (base year)
Reduce value chain emissions by 25% 
by 2030 (Scope 3)
26%% reduction from FY2020 (base 
year)
C&C’s targeted supply chain partners 
will have science-based targets by 2026
67% of supply chain by emissions 
committed to science-based targets. 
At YE2024, we have achieved SBTi 
commitment covering 48% of our Scope 
3 emissions (V’s KPI of 45%)
Notes. All emissions are calculated using Scope boundaries as defined by The GHG Protocol. The targets and 
boundaries were validated via the SBTi in December 2022. C&C has not been directly involved in, or contributed to, 
carbon removals or carbon storage projects within its own operations nor within its supply chain. Emissions figures 
disclosed to not include any impact from carbon removals or carbon storage.
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
65

Conservation of Energy
We are committed to transitioning our 
operations to clean energy sources in line 
with our carbon reduction targets. The 
Group continues to utilise renewable energy 
where possible, in FY2023 we installed 
Ireland’s largest rooftop solar array at 
our manufacturing facility in Clonmel and 
confirmed a Corporate Purchase Power 
Agreement (‘PPA’) obtaining electricity from 
the Cronalaght Wind Farm in Donegal. In 
FY2024, 95% of our total electricity use for 
the Group was renewably sourced. The 
electricity used at our main manufacturing 
sites, Clonmel and Wellpark, comes from 
renewable sources. Our manufacturing 
facility in Clonmel generated 1.13MWh of 
renewable electricity from its solar panels 
in FY2024. Whilst most of our electricity 
consumption is renewable; the Group 
recognises that this only constitutes a 
proportion of its operational emissions. To 
mitigate our Scope 1 emissions, the Group 
has invested heavily in decarbonisation 
projects in recent years. This includes, 
but is not limited to, the implementation 
of electric Forklift Trucks (‘FLTs’) to our 
fleet, anaerobic digestion and biogas 
projects at our Wellpark Brewery, the 
commissioning of a 1MW heat pump at 
our Clonmel manufacturing facility, as well 
as the successful transition of a number of 
our key depots from diesel to Hydrotreated 
Vegetable Oil (‘HVO’). 
Scope 1, 2 and 3 emissions
The charts and tables below outline the 
Group’s carbon performance in FY2024. 
This includes a breakdown of our Scope 1 
and Scope 2 (location and market-based) 
emissions, as well as a breakdown of Scope 
3 emissions by category, as defined by the 
GHG Protocol. The tables also breakdown 
the source of our emissions, by commodity 
and location, and present our performance 
vs FY2023 and FY2020 (Baseline). 
Our Scope 3 emissions (including 
Purchased Goods, Use of Sold Product, 
End of Life Treatment, and other indirect 
emissions) account for 95% of C&C’s total 
emissions. 
The Group recognises the challenges in 
reducing its indirect emissions and has 
been working hard to mitigate these. C&C is 
part of the CDP (Carbon Disclosure Project) 
Supply Chain Screening Programme, 
where we work closely with key supply 
chain partners, requesting them to disclose 
climate-related information, allowing us 
to better understand the environmental 
impacts of our supply chain. We are 
strongly encouraging our supply chain 
partners to disclose their carbon footprint 
via CDP as C&C has done since 2010.
Below is a selection of charts and tables 
which present a breakdown of the Group’s 
carbon emissions and Energy Consumption 
for FY2024.
Sustainability Report, Table 1: Scope 1,2 & 3 Carbon Emissions (tCO2e)
Environment
FY2020 (Baseline)
FY2023
FY2024 Change vs FY2023
Change vs 
Baseline
Tons of CO2e
Tons of CO2e
Tons of CO2e
%
%
Carbon Emissions
Scope 1
25,079 
21,990
20,159
-8%
-20%
Scope 2 (Location-Based)
12,429 
9,605
8,419
-12%
-32% 
Scope 2 (Market-Based)
6,238 
588
266
-55%
-96%
Scope 3
705,000 
555,847
518,545
-7%
-26%
Scope 1 & 2 (Location-Based)
37,508 
31,595
28,578
-10%
-24% 
Scope 1 & 2 (Market -Based)
31,317 
22,578
20,425
-10%
-35% 
Total Carbon Footprint (Location-Based)
742,508 
587,442
547,123
-7%
-26% 
Total Carbon Footprint (Market-Based)
736,317 
578,425
538,970
-7%
-27% 
Note. The Location-based Scope 2 emissions figure is calculated using standard grid electricity factors for each country where we operate. The Market-based emissions 
calculations reflect the carbon avoidance impact of using electricity from certified renewable sources and from our own solar generation.
Definitions:  
Scope 1: Direct emissions from our own operations.  
Scope 2: Indirect emissions from our purchased energy (mainly electricity).  
Scope 3: Including supply chain, customer use of our products, and other indirect emissions.
Sustainability Report
(continued)
FY2024 Carbon Footprint (tCO2e)
Scope 1 and 2 Emissions (Location Based) tCO2e
Scope 3
Scope 1
Scope 2
Scope 1
Scope 2
3.7%
1.5%
94.8%
5.2%
2020
2023
2024
2020
2023
2024
 25,079 
 21,990 
 20,159 
 12,429 
 9,605 
 8,419 
66
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Sustainability Report, Table 2: Emissions Intensity
Environment
FY2020 (Baseline)
FY2023
FY2024 Change vs FY2023 Change vs Baseline
Intensity
Net Revenue (Eu Million)
1,719
1,689
1,661
-2%
-3%
Scope 1 and 2 tCO2e per M EURO (Location Based)
21.82
18.71
17.21
-8%
-21% 
Total Carbon Footprint (Location-Based)
431.94 
347.80
329.39
-5%
-24% 
Scope 1 and 2 tCO2e per M EURO (Market Based)
18.22 
13.37
12.30
-8%
-33% 
Total Carbon Footprint (Market-Based)
428.34 
342.47
324.49
-5%
-24% 
Sustainability Report, Table 3: Scope 1 & 2 Carbon Emissions per site (tCO2e)
 
Ireland
Scotland
Matthew 
Clark
Frutissima
Group Fleet 
& Offices
Total C&C 
FY2024
Total C&C 
FY2023
Total C&C
FY2020 
(Baseline)
Change vs 
FY2023
Change vs 
Baseline
Scope 1 (Tons of CO2e)
 4,504 
 10,506 
 3,558 
 1,591 
 - 
 20,159 
 21,990 
 25,079 
-8%
-20% 
Scope 2 – Location  
based figure (Tons of CO2e)
 3,975 
 3,379 
 857 
 208 
 - 
 8,419 
 9,605 
 12,429 
-12%
-32% 
Scope 2 – Market based figure 
(Tons of CO2e)
 54 
 - 
 4 
 208 
 - 
 266 
 588 
 6,238 
-55%
-96%
Scope 1&2 – Location Based 
(Tons of CO2e)
 8,479 
 13,885 
 4,415 
 1,799 
 - 
 28,578 
 31,595 
 37,508 
-10%
-24% 
Scope 1&2 – Market Based 
(Tons of CO2e)
 4,558 
 10,506 
 3,562 
 1,799 
 - 
 20,425 
 22,578 
 31,317 
-10%
-35% 
Sustainability Report, Table 4: Scope 3 Emissions Breakdown
Environment
FY2020 (Baseline)
FY2023
FY2024
Change vs 
FY2023
Change vs  
FY2020
Breakdown of Scope 3 emissions:
 
Scope 3 – Tons of 
CO2e
%
%
Purchased Goods (Total for CDP)
 473,903 
 383,186 
 361,034 
-6%
-24%
Agriculture
 39,066 
 33,750 
 30,436 
-10%
-22% 
Brewing Ingredients
 31,034 
 20,088 
 19,344 
-4%
-38% 
Packaging
 59,730 
 53,270 
 47,796 
-10%
-20% 
Distributed Product
344,073 
 276,078 
 263,458 
-5%
-23% 
Capital Goods
 
 10,047 
 8,879 
-12%
-
Investments
 
 555 
 518 
-7%
-
Fuel (Not in S1&S2)
 6,954 
 7,164 
 5,823 
-19%
-16% 
Upstream Transport
 16,819 
 48,698 
 40,075 
-18%
138%
Waste
 2,880 
 1,411 
 1,327 
-6%
-54%
Business Travel
 1,845 
 1,100 
 1,162 
6%
-37% 
Employee Commuting
 2,559 
 2,225 
 2,194 
-1%
-14% 
Downstream Transport
 26,776 
 37,819 
 37,150 
-2%
39% 
Total – Use of Sold products
 135,843 
 51,756 
 49,268 
-5%
-64%
Use – Own Products
 34,347 
 10,733 
 10,614 
-1%
-69% 
Use – Distributed Products
 101,496 
 41,023 
 38,654 
-6%
-62% 
Total – End of Life Treatment
 37,422 
 11,886 
 11,115 
-6%
-70% 
End of Life – Own Products
 8,372 
 1,631 
 1,451 
-11%
-83%
End of Life – Distributed
29,051 
 10,255 
 9,664 
-6%
-67%
Full Group Emissions
Total Scope 3 Emissions
705,000 
 555,847
 518,545 
-7%
-26% 
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
67

Sustainability Report, Table 5: Streamlined Energy and Carbon Reporting (SECR)
Current reporting year
Previous reporting year
Tonnes CO2e (FY2024)
Tonnes CO2e (FY2023)
Total Full Group Emissions
 UK 
 Non-UK 
 Total 
 UK 
 Non-UK 
 Total 
Scope 1
14,064 
 6,095 
20,159 
 14,336 
7,654 
21,990 
Scope 2 (Location-based)
4,236 
 4,183 
 8,419 
 4,494 
 5,111 
9,605 
Scope 2 (Market-based)
4 
262 
266 
162 
426 
588 
Energy Consumption Breakdown 
Sustainability Report, Table 6: Energy Consumption Breakdown (MWh (megawatt hours))
Environment
FY2020 (Baseline)
FY2023
FY2024 Change vs FY2023
Change vs Baseline
MWh
MWh
MWh
%
%
Energy Consumption Breakdown
Natural Gas
88,630
79,232
67,861
-14%
-23%
Liquefied Natural Gas
5.591
0
0
-
-
Liquefied Petroleum Gas
2,332
3,844
4,047
5%
74%
Diesel
33,257
25,675
26,739
4%
-20%
Petroleum
450
1,303
1,171
-10%
160%
HVO
0
3,635
4,435
22%
-
Kerosene / Fuel Oil
65
209
204
-2%
214%
Biogas
83
4,778
3,641
-24%
4,287%
Non-Renewable Electricity
26,664
3,623
2,849
-21%
-89%
Renewable Electricity
14,737
36,844
33,623
-9%
128%
Total Non-Renewable Energy Consumption
156,989
117,521
107,257
-9%
-29%
Total Renewable Energy Consumption
14,737
36,844
33,623
-9%
128%
Total Energy Consumption
171,726
154,365
140,880
-9%
-15%
Total Scope 1
130,325
113,898
104,408
-8%
-20%
Total Scope 2
41,401
40,467
36,473
-10%
-12%
Out of Scope (Biogas)
83
4,778
3,641
-24%
4,287%
Sustainability Report, Table 7: Summary of Energy Mix
Energy Consumption & Mix
FY2024 (MWh)
1. Coal
 - 
2. Crude oil/petroleum products
 32,162 
3. Natural gas
 67,861 
4. Other non-renewable sources
 - 
5. Nuclear products
 - 
6. Acquired electricity, heat, or steam from non-renewable sources
 1,718 
7. Total non-renewable sources (MWh) sum of 1-6 above
 101,741 
Share of non-renewable sources in total energy consumption (%)
70%
8. Fuel consumption from renewable sources (e.g. biogas, HVO)
 8,026 
9. Consumption of acquired electricity, heat, or steam from renewable sources
 33,623 
10. Consumption of self-generated electricity from renewable sources
 1,131 
11. Total renewable energy consumption (MWh) sum of 8-10 above
 42,780 
Share of renewable sources in total energy consumption (%)
30%
Total energy consumption (MWh) sum of 7 & 11
 144,521
Sustainability Report
(continued)
68
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Carbon Commentary
Initiatives – developed and implemented
Initiative
Progress
Targets
Science Based 
Target Initiative 
(‘SBTi’)
C&C Group’s emissions reduction targets received independent validation and 
approval by the SBTi in January 2023. 
The Group has put in place various decarbonisation initiatives in the last FY, 
aimed at tackling our Scope 1 and 2 emissions. This includes, reinsulation 
of hot liquor tanks, steam network rationalisation and Brewhouse “Clean in 
Place” (CIP) reduction. In FY2024 the Group exceeded its Scope 1 and 2 
(location based) carbon reduction target of 4.0%p.a., in line with our validated 
science-based target, with carbon emissions down 10% vs FY2023. This 
brings our total Scope 1 and 2 carbon reduction (vs our FY2020 baseline 
year) to 24%. The Group is on track to meet its Scope 3 science-based 
supplier engagement target. C&C has been working hard with its key suppliers 
to encourage them to set science-based targets. C&C has held webinars 
with key suppliers, in partnership with CDP, as well as held collaborative 
discussions with suppliers sharing best practices around sustainability. Our 
key partners operate at all stages of the supply chain, from raw materials to 
finished goods.
 48%% of the Group’s suppliers currently have a science-based target in 
place. (v FY2024 Target of 45%) We understand the scale of the challenge in 
converting the remaining 19%, to achieving our science-based target.
C&C is committed to reducing 
absolute Scope 1 and Scope 
2 GHG emissions by 35% by 
2030 (versus FY2020 base 
year). To achieve the target of 
reducing Scope 3 emissions by 
25% (versus FY2020 base year) 
by 2030, the Group has also 
committed that suppliers and 
customers making up 67% of 
Scope 3 emissions (Purchased 
Goods, Downstream Transport 
and Use of Sold Goods) will 
have science-based targets 
in place by 2026. C&C will 
continue to engage with its key 
suppliers throughout the course 
of FY2025 to progress this 
commitment.
Energy 
Conservation
Summary of Energy Conservation Projects implemented in FY2024: 
•	 Heat Pump installed at our Clonmel manufacturing facility
•	 Air compressor with variable speed drive
•	 Spent grain transfer – smart air injection
•	 Steam network rationalisation
•	 Brewhouse “Clean in Place” (CIP) reduction
•	 Reinsulating of hot liquor tanks
We will continue to install 
energy conservation projects at 
sites across C&C Group in the 
next financial year. 
Fleet 
Decarbonisation
C&C Group is committed to transitioning to a low-carbon world. Operating as 
a distributor, as well as a manufacturer and marketer, a significant amount of 
our emissions are fuel-based. The Group understands the negative impact 
fossil fuels have on our climate and is committed to transitioning to lower 
carbon alternatives where feasible. The delivery vehicles at two of our major 
depots, in Bedford and Runcorn, are powered by HVO. This has saved over 
1,000 tCO2e in FY2024 alone. During FY2024 we began transitioning more 
of our delivery vehicles, at our Thornliebank depot, to run on HVO. The 
Group also has four 18-tonne electric HGVs in operation, following successful 
trials across our distribution network in FY2023. We are adopting a phased 
approach to the implementation of EVs (Electric Vehicles), shifting delivery 
vehicles to HVO in the interim as the technology and cost competitiveness of 
electric vehicles improves. 
Our new flagship depot in London, Orbital West, will use a mixture of Electric 
HGVs and HGVs powered by HVO. This will ensure sustainable deliveries in the 
heart of the country. Our planned rollout of Electric HGVs and HVO-powered 
HGVs will continue into FY2025.
Continue to transition depots 
from diesel to HVO, combining 
this with the purchase of 
electric delivery vehicles as 
the technology develops 
and becomes more cost 
competitive.
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
69

Initiative
Progress
Targets
Out of Plastics
All the Group’s canned product continues to be packaged in fully recyclable 
cardboard, which removes more than two hundred million plastic rings 
form the environment per annum. The investment in our more sustainable 
packaging recognises the future market changes including the Deposit Return 
Scheme (‘DRS’) introduction in Ireland on 1 February 2024 and, planned 
for the UK in October 2027 alongside new fees associated with Extended 
Producer Responsibility. (EPR) from 1 January 2025.
Continued commitment to 
sustainable packaging and 
exploration of circular economy 
opportunities to improve reuse 
and recycling across the Group.
FT Europe’s 
Climate Leaders 
2024
For the fourth year in succession, C&C has been identified, by the Financial 
Times and leading research agency Statista, as being one of the most 
ambitious European companies in reducing their greenhouse gas emissions 
relative to their revenue.
Maintain position as an 
ambitious Climate Leader in 
Food and Beverage category of 
FT’s Climate Leaders 2025. 
Morgan 
Stanley Capital 
International 
(‘MSCI) ESG 
Ratings
C&C has retained its ‘AA’ rating for the second year in a row. The Group is 
categorised in the top 30% of beverage companies and scored particularly 
strongly for our initiatives to reduce carbon intensity across our value chain.
Maintain MSCI ESG rating of 
‘AA’ in FY2025.
VIBES – Best 
Large Business 
Winner
Tennent Caledonian Breweries were the Best Large Business Winner at the 
2023 VIBES (VISION IN BUSINESS ENVIRONMENT SCOTLAND) Scottish 
Environment Business Awards. The award recognises businesses that best 
demonstrate what is good for the environment and business.
Continue to seek opportunities 
to evidence our leadership in 
sustainability by identifying 
and entering relevant, credible 
sustainability awards.
Sustainable Logistics As we provide 
our customers with a complete drinks 
distribution service with our own fleet, 
transportation makes up a significant part 
of the Group’s Scope 1 and 2 emissions. 
In addition to the initiatives the Group has 
implemented over the past years, e.g. 
our Group-wide logistics forum which is 
used to share best practice and our fleet 
management platform Microlise which 
helps reduce fuel consumption and 
drive efficiency, the Group continues to 
make considerable efforts to reduce its 
transport related emissions. Our ‘Fleet 
Decarbonisation Transition Plan’ focusses 
on utilising a range of technologies and 
processes to meet our ambitious carbon 
reduction targets. The ten-year plan 
prioritises measures including Continuous 
Improvement initiatives, alternative and 
decarbonising fuels, as well as a transition 
to battery electric vehicles (BEVs) and 
hydrogen vehicles (HVs) when infrastructure 
and equipment is commercially available. 
As a Group, we are exploring all tools and 
technologies available to reach our carbon 
reduction targets in fleet decarbonisation. 
We continue to require all new vehicles, 
leased, or purchased, to meet the EURO 
6 standard – 93% of our fleet are currently 
EURO 6. We also amended vehicle 
specification (by for example, applying the 
Direct Vision Standard for heavy goods 
vehicles which assesses and rates how 
much the driver can see directly from their 
cab in relation to other road users). We have 
four electric heavy goods vehicles currently 
and plan to add a further four in FY2025.
In the next five years our plan is to convert 
our depots with bulk tanks to Hydrotreated 
Vegetable Oil (HVO) – this will reduce diesel 
consumption/carbon emissions by c.60% 
from the fleet. To date, our Runcorn and 
Bedford depots have been successfully 
transitioned to HVO, completely removing 
diesel from the sites, and reducing 
emissions by c.90% (1,000 tonnes).
Sustainability Report
(continued)
70
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Case Study:
Orbital West
In February 2024, C&C launched 
operations from our new and improved 
distribution depot in London, Orbital 
West. The project demonstrates 
action taken to embed our core 
values identifying employee inclusion, 
health and safety, environmental 
considerations, and operational 
excellence as fundamental components. 
 
This flagship facility underlines the 
Group’s significant investment in 
increased capacity and ongoing 
commitment to industry-leading 
customer service for London and 
the surrounding areas, as well as 
significantly contributing to our wider 
carbon reduction programme and 
sustainability agenda.
 
Situated near Heathrow Airport, our 
113,600 sq. ft facility is 40% larger 
than our previous London depot and 
is set to create a number of local job 
opportunities. We are continuing our 
powerful partnership with Big Issue 
Recruit to place people who may have 
previously faced barriers in joining 
sustainable employment into C&C 
transport and warehouse roles. 
Accommodating our diverse workforce 
which constitutes many nationalities 
and religious beliefs, Orbital West 
offers a private multi faith room, where 
employees can pray in a dedicated area, 
complete with Wudu facilities. The toilets, 
showers and changing areas have been 
designed to ensure the environments are 
welcoming and inclusive for all.
The site’s environmental credentials 
directly support our ESG strategy 
of ‘Delivering to a Better World’ and 
include:
•	 Roof solar panels to provide 185,000 
kwh per annum, equivalent to 30% 
of the consumption of the previous 
London depot
•	 Twenty-six internal combustion engine 
vehicles transitioning to HVO as a 
primary fuel, resulting in a reduction 
of over 350 tonnes of CO2 emissions 
from London operations
•	 The introduction of 4 18-tonne electric 
HGVs zero emission vehicles in 
FY2025 
•	 Electric charging stations for both 
HGVs and employee cars
Product Quality and Safety
As part of our commitment to “Respect 
people and the planet,” the safety, 
authenticity, legality, and quality of our 
products, is fundamental to our ongoing 
business operations. From our use of the 
finest Scottish malted barley and fresh 
highland water from Loch Katrine to our 
sourcing of apples from across Ireland, 
and working with the finest wine suppliers 
globally, quality is at our core.
 
Supported by a Group Technical function, 
in line with global best practice, C&C have 
implemented quality control and technical 
systems across all manufacturing sites. 
Compliance monitoring ensures adherence 
and identifies areas for improvement 
achieved through objective setting that 
supports the overall business strategy.
We actively and consciously source and 
procure raw materials, third-party products, 
and services in an ethical, sustainable, 
and socially conscious way, with quality 
agreements in place that set out minimum 
acceptable standards. 
We continue to track product safety and 
quality and strive to make improvements 
to working conditions and environmental 
performance across the group and our 
supply chain. We audit compliance against 
our standards and monitor the ethical and 
environmental compliance of our suppliers 
using the SEDEX (Sedex Members Ethical 
Trade Audit – SMETA) and Qadex systems. 
Our manufacturing sites undergo routine 
ethical audits in accordance with the 
Ethical Trading Initiative (ETI) code, as a 
requirement of our SEDEX membership. 
Audit reports are shared on the SEDEX 
platform, which includes data on labour 
rights, health and safety, environmental 
practices, and business ethics.
The Group annually tests business 
continuity processes and procedures, 
to protect customers, consumers, and 
the communities in which we operate. 
Our processes and procedures meet 
global best practice guidelines, regulatory 
requirements, and the advice of local 
health authorities to ensure the quality, safe 
production, and distribution of the Group’s 
products. 
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
71

In February 2024, the Group worked with 
RQA, a leading product risk consultancy, to 
undertake a mock product recall exercise 
across our Wellpark and Clonmel sites. 
This demonstrated that our processes are 
sound and provided insights into how we 
can further improve our approach. These 
improvements are being incorporated 
into our ways of working. Our Clonmel 
and Matthew Clark sites continue to 
be ISO14001 accredited for effective 
environmental management systems. 
Wellpark is currently going through the 
process to secure ISO14001. 
Our Wellpark and Clonmel manufacturing 
sites have the highest standard of BRCGS 
accreditation of AA+ achieved in March 
and October 2023, respectively. During 
the year, the Group were audited by the 
Soil Association to maintain our licence 
to import and sell organic products and 
passed with zero-non-conformances. 
Further retailer audits were carried out at 
Clonmel and Wellpark to ensure that we 
maintain the highest standard in systems 
and processes. The sites also undergo 
retailer audits for manufactured products, as 
well as FEMAS (Feed Materials Assurance 
Scheme) (animal feed) and AOECS (Gluten 
Free products) certification. 
Water Optimisation and 
Conservation
As part of our sustainability commitment, 
we remain committed to reducing our water 
usage. C&C Group has a water efficiency 
target of 3.4:1 (Water Ratio of hectolitres 
extracted versus hectolitres produced). In 
FY2024, via a combination of continuous 
improvement activity to engage team 
members and projects that reduce our 
carbon footprint that also support water 
reduction (less process steam used = less 
water required), the Group achieved a 
water-efficiency ratio of 3.2:1. Since 2020 
(base year), water usage at both Wellpark 
and Clonmel has reduced (21% and 23% 
respectively).
Initiatives that have contributed to our 
strong water ratio performance include 
condensate recovery, rinse recovery and 
the introduction of air rinsing to the Wellpark 
can line, as we have already installed in 
Clonmel.
In addition, Anaerobic Digestion (water 
treatment) plants are fully operational at 
both Wellpark and Clonmel and have 
reduced our sites’ wastewater emissions 
and improved the quality of our wastewater 
discharged by c. 90%.
In FY2024, C&C again participated in the 
CDP Water Security questionnaire and 
achieved a C rating.
Sustainability Report
(continued)
Waste Minimisation and 
Circularity
Across our manufacturing sites, C&C 
Group has maintained a commitment 
to Zero Waste to Landfill. Our waste 
management policy is guided by a waste 
hierarchy approach, prioritising prevention, 
reuse, and recycling where possible. In our 
manufacturing sites, waste materials are 
source-segregated, and in all operations 
waste minimisation and prevention is 
prioritised. We routinely monitor our waste 
streams for contamination and target 
improvement through our waste KPIs.
100% of our manufacturing by-products are 
recycled for use as animal feed or organic 
compost. Over 20,000 tonnes of spent 
grain and apple pomace were used as 
animal feed, with the remainder of our waste 
either recycled or sent for energy recovery. 
100% of our products are sold in containers 
that can be recycled and 28% is already in 
returnable formats.
In 2022, as part of a Scottish Government 
funded initiative, Tennent’s conducted 
a Circular Economy Assessment with 
Zero Waste Scotland (‘ZWS’) and leading 
environmental consultancy, Eunomia. The 
results of this assessment have shaped 
our Group approach and as part of our 
continued commitment to circular economy 
principles, the Group is exploring further 
circular opportunities in our operations and 
to develop a pathway towards adoption 
and implementation of those opportunities. 
ZWS profiled a case study of the work with 
Tennent’s on their website in February 2024.
72
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Sustainably Source  
Our Products & 
Services
Collaboration with our Apple and 
Barley Growers
C&C Group is committed to sourcing 
our raw materials from local sustainable 
sources. All apples crushed at the Clonmel 
site to produce Bulmers and Magners 
cider are sourced from the Island of 
Ireland. As well as having 165 acres 
of our own orchards in Co. Tipperary, 
there are over fifty partner growers on 
the Island, with whom we work closely. 
The health and sustainability of the Irish 
apple growing sector is therefore central 
to C&C’s strategy. A key aspect of apple 
orcharding is the health of the population 
of bees and other pollinating insects. As 
part of our commitment to protect the 
biodiversity of bees, C&C is a patron of the 
All-Ireland Pollinator plan and patron of the 
South Tipperary Bee-Keepers Association 
who carry out activity on the protection 
and promotion of the species in our 
Redmonstown Orchard, where we maintain 
over 13km of healthy hedgerows to support 
the bee and pollinator population and 
maintain strong biodiversity in the area.
We also recognise that, since our products 
are based around agricultural inputs, 
investment in techniques which increase 
yields for our apple growers also serves 
to provide greater resilience in our supply 
chain – for example, diversification of crop 
varieties helps to minimise risks relating to 
variable weather patterns and harvests.
In Scotland, our Tennent’s beers are 
brewed using 100% Scottish malt. We 
seek to support the growers of our key 
raw materials such as barley and wheat 
through long-term supply arrangements, 
with sustainability a key consideration. 
Malting barley is only purchased from farms 
with current and up-to-date, independently 
audited farm assurance schemes. 75% 
supply of malt is Food Standard Agency 
(FSA) Gold accredited and the balance is 
Red Tractor assured, which ensures the 
best environmental practices are adhered 
to.
Supply Chain Engagement
At C&C Group, integration of ethical and 
sustainable practices to our procurement 
processes contribute to the delivery of our 
three core values. Analysing procurement 
processes through the lens of ESG 
identifies risks (modern slavery, human 
rights violations, and corruption) and 
opportunities (ethical practices, supply 
chain resilience and waste reduction) 
enabling optimisation of systems. Our 
Ethical and Sustainable Procurement 
(‘E&SP’) Strategy is underpinned by our 
E&SP Policy, to ensure supplier alignment, 
with proactive engagement with our supply 
chain a priority. We ask that suppliers 
comply with C&C Group’s Code of Conduct 
and Modern Slavery policy as a prerequisite 
of trade. To support delivery C&C Group 
have created a E&SP Steerco comprising 
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
73

cross departmental collaboration and the expertise of an external consultant to generate a 
five-year roadmap designed to enable C&C Group to be a leader in this field by 2029, and 
support and guide our supply chain to align with our practices and values.  
Initiative
Progress
Targets
Ethical and 
Sustainable 
Procurement 
(‘E&SP’) 
Strategy
Code of Conduct / Modern 
Slavery compliance.
Undertake E&SP benchmarking 
review with external consultants 
to create organisational roadmap 
to move beyond compliance to 
leadership by 2029. 
E&SP KPIs: 
•	 Code of Conduct / Modern 
Slavery compliance – 93% 
achieved versus 100% target 
•	 CDP Supplier Screening 67 
suppliers signed up versus a 
target of 55. (48% of Scope 
3 emissions versus target of 
45%)
CDP Supply 
Chain 
Engagement 
Programme
CDP awarded C&C Group 
plc an A- rating for Supplier 
Engagement, acknowledging 
our performance on 
governance, targets, 
scope 3 emissions, and 
value chain engagement 
in the CDP climate change 
questionnaire.
Engage strategic supply chain 
partners in CDP and request 
that they disclose climate-related 
information to allow us to use 
the reported data to measure 
supplier environmental impacts 
and collaborate with them to 
track progress of sustainability 
goals and/or commitments.
The Group will again deliver a 
CDP Supplier Webinar in FY2025 
to support suppliers in their 
disclosure.
ISO 14001
The Group has achieved the 
ISO 14001 certification for 
its Clonmel, Matthew Clark 
(Whitchurch, although scope 
covers all vehicle emissions 
including commercial fleet 
and all waste and packaging 
requirements) and Bibendum 
sites. 
Maintain ISO 14001 certification 
and extend to additional sites. 
Wellpark are in the process of 
attaining accreditation.
MSCI ESG 
Ratings
Progression in ranking to 
AA (Jan 2023) versus A (Feb 
2022)
Maintain AA rating in FY2025.
Bibendum Wine 
At Bibendum, furthering our sustainability 
agenda is a question of culture – ensuring 
the right decisions are made at every big 
and small step of the way. Bibendum’s Vivid 
charter was founded in 2008, and we are 
one of the few UK drinks businesses with 
ISO 14001 accreditation, first awarded in 
2011.
 
Bibendum partners with mindful producers, 
while pursuing a positive impact on the 
planet and communities. Collaboration 
focuses on practices such as organic 
and biodynamic viticulture, ISO 14001 
certification, carbon emission reduction, 
water management, waste reduction and 
recycling, and ethical working conditions.
There is a consistent focus on sustainability 
throughout our events and communications 
in the year. Bibendum has recently 
joined the Harpers Sustainability Charter 
as a Sustainability Champion, and the 
Sustainable Wine Roundtable. Both 
membership organisations provide a greater 
opportunity for knowledge sharing and 
collaboration across the wine producing 
supply chain. 
Sustainability Report
(continued)
74
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Ensure Alcohol 
Is Consumed 
Responsibly
Alcohol Awareness
At C&C Group plc we acknowledge the 
key role we play in social responsibility 
in the local communities we serve. We 
are 100% committed to the responsible 
marketing of alcohol and promoting the 
moderate consumption of the products we 
manufacture and distribute, to ensure they 
are enjoyed safely by consumers.
 
In March 2024, the C&C Board approved 
the Group’s Responsible Marketing Code 
(RMC). (Please see www. Policies & 
Terms – CC (candcgroupplc.com)). This 
sets out our commitment to responsible 
marketing, guiding every aspect of our 
marketing activities including but not 
limited to research and development, 
communications, promotion, sponsorship, 
experiential, sampling, and packaging. 
Central to the RMC is ensuring that all our 
marketing activities are only ever directed at 
adults over the legal purchasing age (LPA) in 
the relevant territory, and to encourage the 
moderate consumption of our products. 
 
The RMC is mandatory for all our marketing, 
sales, promotion, and communications 
activities for both the brands which we 
own, but also for third-party brands where 
we control (and are responsible for) the 
marketing of such brands. 
Minimum Unit Pricing (‘MUP’) 
C&C Group plc are committed to the 
responsible promotion of alcohol. We have 
been strong supporters of Minimum Unit 
Pricing since proposals were first raised in 
2011. We believe that minimum unit pricing, 
as part of a range of health measures, is 
an important step in tackling the availability 
of strong cheap alcohol, irresponsible 
consumption among a minority of drinkers, 
and alcohol harm. In FY2024, the Group 
participated in the Scottish Government’s 
review of MUP and advocated its 
continuation post sunset clause. We 
continue to support the introduction of MUP 
in all the territories where we operate. 
Promoting 0%, Low Alcohol & 
Low-Calorie Variants
Recognising the evolving trends around 
consumer moderation and reduced 
consumption, C&C has introduced low/
no alcohol and low-calorie variants of its 
core brands. This is supplemented by the 
Group offering a broad range of third-party 
low/no alcohol and low-calorie variants to 
meet increasing customer and consumer 
demand. 
Social
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
75

Reductions in Alcoholic strength 
By Volume (‘ABV’)
The Group recognises that consumers are 
increasingly choosing lower ABV beers and 
ciders as part of a healthy lifestyle and, as 
a result, has taken the decision to reduce 
the ABV of some of its brands: Tennent’s 
Light (3.5%-3.4%), Tennent’s Special (3.5%-
3.4%) and Heverlee (4.8%-4.4%). Reducing 
the alcohol content of some of our brands 
will also help remove tens of thousands of 
alcohol units across the UK and Ireland, 
aligned to our long-held commitment to 
promoting moderation.
Alcohol Labelling
Consistent with our commitment towards 
responsible alcohol consumption, and to 
ensure that consumers are provided with 
the full information on our products, we 
continue to work to display Portman Group 
Best Practice Labelling on the primary 
packaging of our major beer and cider 
brands in the UK, including. 
•	 Unit alcohol content per container 
•	 Pregnancy logo/message
•	 Active signposting to Drinkaware.co.uk
•	 Chief Medical Officers’ Low Risk Drinking 
Guidelines 2016 
•	 Calorie information 
•	 18+
•	 Drink drive warning
•	 Pregnancy warning
In Ireland, the Group continues to work 
to meet the labelling requirements of the 
Public Health (Alcohol) Act requirements by 
2026. 
Alcohol Awareness Training
C&C is 100% committed to the responsible 
promotion of alcohol and adherence 
to all legislation, and the self- and co-
regulatory codes in the UK and Ireland. 
All C&C colleagues working in marketing, 
communications, corporate affairs, and 
legal functions undertake mandatory 
training on the CAP/BCAP and the Portman 
Group Codes of Practice in the UK and 
CopyClear in Ireland, every two years. This 
builds colleague capability, protects our 
license to operate, our brands’ reputation 
and, most importantly, our consumers and 
society. All new colleagues, in marketing, 
communications, corporate affairs and 
legal functions, should undertake the 
training within three months of starting their 
role. During FY2024, all c120 Marketing, 
Communications and Group Legal 
colleagues at C&C completed this training. 
Updated responsible marketing training will 
be rolled out to all relevant colleagues again 
in FY2025.
The Group also partners with leading 
alcohol charity, Drinkaware, to provide 
our colleagues with access to e-learning 
resources to improve alcohol awareness 
and understanding. The training is designed 
to support colleagues’ health and wellbeing 
and ensure a safe working environment. 
Sustainability Report
(continued)
Target zero instances of non-
compliance with industry and 
regulatory marketing codes.
In November 2023, following an audit at 
Clonmel, the Health and Safety Executive 
(HSE) Ireland found C&C in breach of 
regulations around claims on Magners 
bottle labelling that our Irish Ciders are 
made with apples "Harvested from our 
sun-drenched orchards in the heart of 
Co. Tipperary". HSE also questioned our 
communications stating that our ciders 
are “Suitable for Celiacs.” The Group has 
worked with HSE on actions and timings to 
resolve this non-compliance. 
Supporting Drinkaware and 
Drinkaware.ie
We include “Drinkaware” & “Drinkaware.
ie” and responsible drinking referencing 
prominently on all our owned brand 
communications (including TV, out of home, 
social media and on our sponsorship media 
assets) in the UK and Ireland.
Portman Group 
C&C continue to support Portman 
Group, the social responsibility body and 
regulator for alcohol labelling, packaging 
and promotion in the UK, whose aim is to 
deliver higher standards of best practice 
and ensure the responsible marketing and 
promotion of alcoholic products. 
The Group accesses Portman Group 
services including training and advice 
on how to market in line with Codes of 
Practice and research into alcohol trends. 
C&C participates fully in all Portman 
forums including Council and Public Affairs 
Directors meetings and supports their work 
on key industry initiatives including launch 
of Alcohol Alternatives Guidance – publicly 
welcomed by Public Health Minister Dame 
Andrea Leadsom MP and responses 
to Government consultations including 
Scottish Government Alcohol Marketing 
Restrictions, Minimum Unit Pricing Price 
Review and UK Government low and no 
product descriptors consultation. 
76
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Enhance Health and 
Safety, Wellbeing 
& Capability of 
Colleagues
Our main priority will always be the health, 
safety, and wellbeing of our employees; 
recognising the key importance of delivering 
better safety standards and improving the 
wellbeing of our colleagues. C&C Group 
prioritise the continual improvement of 
occupational health and safety standards. 
Establishing a positive health, safety and 
wellbeing culture is essential to protect 
workers and uphold productivity.  
Safety First 
At C&C Group, our Health and safety vision 
is that all colleagues are ‘safe home every 
day.’
To help improve Health and Safety across 
the Group, we set KPIs to reduce both 
Reporting of Injuries, Diseases and 
Dangerous Occurrences Regulations 
(‘RIDDOR’) and Lost Time Incident Rate 
(‘LTIR’), for employees, agency staff and 
contractors, by 10% (versus FY2023). We 
failed to achieve these KPIs in FY2024. 
Tracking shows that the highest incidence 
of C&C RIDDOR and LTIRs again occurs in 
Warehousing and Distribution sites across 
the Group, and we have seen an increase 
in both RIDDORs and LTIRs at Clonmel, 
however Wellpark Brewery has set a record 
number of days since having an LTIR..
To restore service levels across our depot 
network following the significant challenges 
and disruption associated with the 
implementation of our Enterprise Resource 
Planning ('ERP’) transformation in February 
2023 in the Matthew Clark and Bibendum 
(‘MCB’) business, has seen a continued 
overreliance on agency colleagues, 
contributing to C&C again missing to hit our 
RIDDOR and LTIR KPIs.  
 
FY2023 Base
Restated KPI 
(10% reduction)
 Performance 
FY2024
Reduce by 10% YOY (Year Ove– Year) -–
RIDDOR - Reporting of Injuries, Diseases 
and Dangerous Occurrences Regulations 
(incidents per 100,000 hrs)
0.65
0.59
1.10
Reduce by 10% YOY–- LTIR - Lost Time 
Incident Rate (incidents per 100 employees) 
0.15
0.14
0.18
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
77

In FY2024, across the Group we reported 
62 RIDDORs and 61 LTIRs. C&C has 
experienced no work-related fatalities 
during FY2024.
To drive improvement in our Safety Culture 
to ensure safety always comes first, 
in FY2024 a number of initiatives were 
introduced including Group H&S Committee 
is now held monthly, implementation of 
Safety Champions within logistics network, 
working to ensure compliance with ISO 
45001 standard, Toolbox Talks and Safety 
Hours.
The Group continues to review and 
implement H&S Standard Operational 
Procedures (SOP) across all sites. These 
mandate regular health and safety risk 
assessments to systematically identify and 
evaluate potential impact of operational 
tasks or conditions on employees' health 
and safety. Elements of risk assessment to 
be credited include:
1.	
description of hazards or risk factors 
identified to have the potential to cause 
harm and determining the significance 
of the risks.
2.	
periodic review of risks to reflect the 
latest risks and health and safety 
environment in the business.
3.	 presence of a preventive and corrective 
action plan in the form of steps and/or 
recommendations that an organization 
needs to take to effectively prevent and 
address the risks identified, mapped & 
evaluated in risk assessments.
Each site has a documented Emergency 
Evacuation plan, which is trained to each 
team member (during induction and 
throughout the year), emailed to all team 
members who may visit sites and displayed 
in communal areas. A training matrix is in 
place for all roles. 
Accident, hazard and near miss reporting 
is trained across the sites, with QR 
codes available to capture incidents. A 
Compliance Schedule (detailing audits and 
checks completed) is in place across Group 
sites, outlining what is required weekly, 
monthly, six-monthly, and annually, for the 
site to remain compliant. 
A contractor management process is 
currently being developed for roll out 
in FY2025. Safety team hold insurance 
documents, job and location specific risk 
assessment and method statements. This 
process will include a contractor and visitor 
induction to be delivered to each individual 
contractor annually.
To achieve our “safe home every day” vision 
across the Group, a monthly Group H&S 
Committee is in place, chaired by the Chief 
Executive Officer and attended by Group 
Executive Committee members including 
Chief Operating Officer, Chief Commercial 
Officer, Chief Financial Officer and the 
Group Company Secretary together with 
the Group Director of H&S, Head of Internal 
Audit, CS&L Director and Manufacturing 
Director. 
Each C&C site has their own Safety 
Committee, which feeds into the Group 
H&S Committee.
A new Group Director of H&S joined C&C 
in April 2024. This role reports directly to 
the CEO and attends Group Executive 
Committee meetings, where H&S is a 
standing agenda item.
With our continued focus on ensuring 
consistency and rigor in our sustainability 
reporting processes, C&C Group has 
adopted the GRI standard for Occupational 
Health and Safety reporting across all 
business areas including manufacturing, 
logistics and support functions.
During FY2024, using this methodology, the 
group lost time injury frequency rate was 
3.69 based on 200,000 hours worked. The 
reportable injury frequency rate was 1.83 
based on 200,000 hours worked.
Health and safety continues to be the first 
priority of the Group and with this new 
baseline in reporting and our ongoing 
focus and initiatives, we aim to achieve at 
least a 10% reduction in both lost time and 
reportable injuries in the coming year.
Sustainability Report
(continued)
78
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Health & Wellbeing 
Health and wellbeing external support 
systems
Colleagues across the Group have 
ongoing access to Employee Assistance 
and Occupational Health programmes. In 
addition, colleagues have 365, 24/7 access 
to free and confidential mental health 
wellbeing support programmes via external 
specialist providers. 
In Ireland, colleagues can access Health 
Screening Plus which offers on site 
employee health screening and lifestyle 
assessments. In the UK, we have launched 
C&C’s Aviva DigiCare+ Workplace, a free 
employee healthcare benefit. Accessed via 
an app, colleagues can access five different 
services: an annual Health Check, Digital 
GP, Second Medical Opinion, Mental Health 
Consultation and Nutritional Consultation.
During the year, free ‘flu and Covid jabs 
were again offered to all colleagues across 
the Group.
Employee Resource Groups (‘ERG’)
C&C has two Group Executive Committee-sponsored Employee Resource Groups, to enhance our Health and Wellbeing efforts in key 
areas identified by colleagues: 
Physical–Health - how we prioritise our physical wellbeing 
during times of stress and different ways of working.
Mental–Health - to ensure no colleague faces a mental 
health problem alone.
These employee-led, voluntary groups 
aim to foster a diverse, inclusive, and 
equitable workplace. The ERGs also aim 
to create a sense of belonging by inspiring 
conversations, while bringing new ways 
to look at issues and deliver innovative 
solutions. Each ERG is sponsored by a 
Group Executive Committee member, to 
create and deliver these critical areas with 
their ERG Members. In FY2025, we will 
conduct a review of our ERGs as part of 
the new two-year DE&I (Diversity, Equity, 
and Inclusion) Plan and feedback from our 
employee engagement survey.
Mental Health First Aiders (MHFA)
 C&C Group collaborated with JB Partners, 
accredited Instructor Members with 
MHFA England to introduce MHFA into 
the business. Our previous target to train 
150 employees has been attained with 
a retention of c.120. Recognising our 
dedicated MHFA require continual support, 
C&C Group will provide MHFA refresher 
training in 2024 for those who feel they 
would benefit. 
 
Our MHFA volunteers provide initial help to 
any colleague who is developing a mental 
health problem or experiencing a worsening 
of an existing mental health problem. 
This first aid is given until appropriate 
professional support is received or until the 
crisis resolves. 
 
The role of our MHFA is to: 
•	 Raise awareness of wellbeing activities 
and initiatives.
•	 Challenge the stigma around mental 
wellbeing. 
•	 Actively listen and signpost support to 
colleagues.
•	 Build trust, demonstrate compassion, 
and respect confidentiality. 
•	 Collaborate with other First Aiders (and 
networks) to share best practice. 
•	 Be open and lead the charge in sharing 
stories about mental health awareness. 
 
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
79

The MHFA training aims to support 
colleagues in how to identify, understand 
and help someone who may be 
experiencing a mental health issue. 
 
Supporting our MHFA with the skills, 
knowledge, and confidence to assist 
employees, their family, friends, and 
community is a key differentiator in our 
business. To foster a culture of trust and 
normalising employees seeking support 
when required, C&C Group introduced their 
Mental Health First Aid policy which aligns 
with the training provided to MHFA and is 
available to all employees.
To ensure the programme continues 
to thrive and evolve, focus on how the 
community of MHFA support each other 
will be celebrated. The MHFA programme 
is a colleague-led initiative, and we are in 
the process of establishing a coordinating 
committee of MHFAs to organise and lead 
activities. 
Employee Assistance Programme 
(EAP)
Our EAP services are always available 
to colleagues to help with many of life’s 
challenges. They also offer short-term 
counselling if required, which is free of 
charge and can be via phone, video, or 
face to face. Colleagues will be offered 
a selection of available and suitable 
counsellors for up to eight sessions. 
THRIVE App
Included as part of the EAP, this app is 
approved by the NHS (National Health 
Service) to help manage common mental 
health conditions. The app helps colleagues 
to detect early signs of conditions and 
helps to prevent these from escalating. 
Colleagues can also use the app to track 
and record their feelings and explore 
different ways of thinking.
Stronger Minds 
If colleagues feel anxious, worried or down 
the Stronger Minds team will listen and 
ensure fast access to appropriate care if 
it is needed. Support includes telephone, 
email or face-to-face counselling and 
includes support for complex and longer-
term conditions. There is no requirement 
to get a GP referral first. Counselling via 
Stronger Minds is more specialised than 
through EAP.
 
Remote working 
In FY2022, C&C Group introduced our 
Right to Disconnect Policy and our 
Agile Working Guidelines, to ensure 
that all employees' rights are preserved, 
statutory obligations are met (in Ireland), 
work is carried out safely and that the 
working relationship between employer 
and employee is balanced and the right 
to maintain clear boundaries between 
work and leisure is respected. Our 
Right to Disconnect policy outlines an 
employee’s right to disengage from work 
and refrain from engaging in work-related 
communications, such as emails, telephone 
calls or other messages, outside normal 
working hours. Our aim is to cultivate a 
culture of hard work within normal hours 
while fully respecting personal life and 
time outside of work. Managers play a key 
role in implementing these policies and 
must act when an ’employees' inability or 
reluctance to disconnect appears to be 
linked to excessive workload, performance 
issues, or whether organisational culture 
is a contributing factor. If action is not 
taken C&C Group have established a 
formal complaint procedure and commit 
that employees will be safeguarded from 
victimisation during and following this 
process. Complaints can also be raised 
under the C&C Group ' Whistleblowing' 
Policy. Whistleblower-Policy-v-6.pdf 
(candcgroupplc.com)
 
Our Agile Working Guidelines provide a 
clear steer on our approach to agile working 
for colleagues who have flexibility in their 
work location or working pattern to balance 
business needs with individual preferences. 
Agile Working is an informal arrangement 
that may enable a better work-life balance 
for our people, where job roles within C&C 
Group do not require attendance at a 
specific workplace at a particular time.
C&C4Me Platform
In FY2023 the Group launched C&C4Me, 
allowing colleagues’ access to hundreds 
of offers to help them save money on 
purchases across hundreds of retailers. 
In FY2024, the Group extended the use 
of C&C4Me as a Benefits platform, with 
all things relating to Employee Benefits 
now housed here. Eligible colleagues can 
now sign up for Private Medical Insurance 
within two months of joining or at the 
renewal date via the platform. Cycle to 
Work (UK) launched on the platform in 
August 2023 along with a Wellbeing Centre 
highlighting a variety of workout videos, 
recipes and mindfulness audios and a 
Wellness Area housing details of all available 
employee wellness tools. Approximately 
400 colleagues per month are accessing 
C&C4Me and have made savings of c. 
€35,000 (£31,000) in FY2024. Design 
updates and a relaunch are scheduled for 
FY2025, and demonstrations of the site will 
be provided at upcoming Benefit Fairs.
In the January 2024 Employee Engagement 
Survey, colleagues scored our efforts 
around Health and Wellbeing at 7.6.
Performance Reviews / 
Succession Planning
To enhance alignment, engagement, and 
productivity, as well as promote greater 
opportunities for personal growth and 
career development, our colleagues 
undertake performance conversations 
during the year including regular check-ins 
with their line manager. 
Sustainability Report
(continued)
80
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

As part of our focus on talent development 
and retention, we have implemented a talent 
review process across the Group, which 
has been implemented to Exco -3. This has 
enabled us to understand our leadership 
talent profile and develop our succession 
pipeline. For our Exco -1, we implemented 
a talent development programme to identify 
personal development insights and enable 
the creation of personal career development 
plans.
Learning and Development 
Programmes
We are committed to growing our 
colleagues’ skills and capabilities and 
developing their careers through investing 
in personal development, we aspire to have 
the most talented, engaged, and inspired 
colleagues in our industry. 
 
Our vision is to be a purpose-led employer 
of choice that enables, supports, engages, 
and develops great leaders and colleagues 
by delivering an outstanding employee 
experience.
 
Career development is facilitated through a 
variety of structured processes, including 
performance development reviews, career 
conversations, and talent development 
planning, colleagues are supported with 
career planning toolkits to enable informed 
discussions. These initiatives provide 
employees with opportunities to set goals, 
receive feedback, and create personalised 
development plans to support their 
professional growth within the business. 
Our business has a leadership development 
team dedicated to designing and executing 
programs aimed at enhancing the skills, 
capabilities, and effectiveness of both 
current and prospective leaders across the 
business. We also offer a range of individual 
or group training programmes available 
to colleagues based on training needs 
and individual development plans. With a 
diverse range of initiatives and resources, 
we ensure that all colleagues have the tools 
necessary for personal and professional 
growth. This includes providing access to 
a wealth of resources, documents, events, 
and news updates tailored to support 
colleague development, such as carefully 
curated industry articles, e-books, videos, 
and tutorials easily accessible through our 
company intranet platform. 
Learning at Work Week 2023
In May 2023, C&C Group participated 
in Learning at Work week to: foster a 
culture of continuous learning, empower 
employees, and drive innovation. Through 
an array of engaging workshops, webinars, 
and interactive activities, C&C colleagues 
delved into various topics such as personal 
development, professional skills, and 
emerging trends. The activities highlighted 
that to truly flourish, learning must 
become a part of our everyday lives, each 
colleague should reflect upon how they can 
incorporate learning into their roles, with the 
support of their managers. By encouraging 
a growth mindset and prioritising ongoing 
development not only will colleagues 
benefit but also contribute to our collective 
success.
The Management Academy – 
Manager Fundamental Series
In February 2024, C&C Group launched our 
Management Academy, providing all our 
people managers a host of learning and 
development opportunities designed to 
drive a performance focused, people driven 
culture 
 
The Management Academy was launched 
with our ‘Manager Fundamentals’ 
programme, which focuses on the key 
components of a great manager based on 
the six fundamental skills that we believe are 
essential for all people-managers to master 
to drive high performance through creating 
a people centric culture.
Our ‘Fundamental Skills’ series is focused 
on building sustainable habits. Through 
listening sessions with managers across 
C&C Group, we identified the fundamental 
skills and capabilities that our management 
community feel they need to develop. 
The six modules covered in the “Manager 
Fundamentals” programme are 
Communicating Like a Leader, Performance 
Management, Maximising Team Potential, 
Understanding People, Developing Team 
Culture, Authentic Leadership. 
Behavioural Enablers
Communication
Removing 
ambiguity, and 
facilitating clear 
expectations
Performance
Linking action to 
goals, and driving 
accountability
People
Understanding your 
team, to get the 
most out of them
Potential
Optimising 
capability of teams 
& higlighting 
strengths
Culture
Positive work 
environment based 
on trust and 
teamwork
Authenticity
Leading by example 
and instilling learnt 
behaviours
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
81

Sustainability Report
(continued)
Professional Development
C&C is committed to professional 
development across all functions, including 
Finance, Marketing, Sales, Operations 
and HR. Support covers further education 
and professional exams including SVQs 
(Scottish Vocational Qualifications) 
in Management, MBAs, CIMA, CIPD 
(Chartered Institute of Personnel and 
Development) and IBD (Institute of Brewing 
and Distilling) qualifications. Alongside 
the professional training programmes, 
we also have an increased the number of 
our colleagues studying Apprenticeship 
programmes by 40% building our 
functional and leadership capabilities 
across Accountancy, Leadership, Sales, 
Operations and Project Management.
Climate Change and the 
Environment (Anti-Greenwashing) 
eLearning 
For 2024, to support development of 
marketing capability and commitment to 
responsible marketing, C&C Group have 
partnered with the Advertising Standards 
Authority (ASA) to deliver “Climate Change 
and the Environment” (Anti-Greenwashing) 
eLearning to ensure promotion of our 
sustainability credentials aligns with 
regulations. Training, which carries 
accreditation by the ASA, is mandatory for 
all C&C Group Marketing, Communications 
and Legal colleagues. 
Cyber Training 
Our Security training programme comprises 
two components: annual mandatory 
security awareness training and monthly 
phish tests. All colleagues with computer 
accounts are automatically enrolled in both.
 
We track the number of phish tests a user 
clicks on with the training increasing in 
length and detail for those who fall foul of 
multiple phish test over the course of the 
year. Over the course of the year 319 users 
clicked on one test, fifty-one clicked on two 
tests and only seven clicked on all three 
tests.
 
2023 saw our highest level of voluntary 
completion of the security awareness 
training at 1,715 users up from 1,464 the 
previous year.
Embed key codes 
The Group continues to roll out online policy 
compliance training to all Commercial. 
Procurement, Marketing and Legal 
colleagues created by legal specialists, 
ZING on:
•	 Anti-Bribery and Corruption
•	 C&C General Data Protection Regulation
•	 C&C Modern Slavery
•	 Competition Law - C&C Group
•	 Fraud Prevention
•	 Information Security C&C
•	 Other C&C Group Policies
During FY2024, 1,011 colleagues across 
Group Executive Committee, Commercial, 
Procurement, HR, Finance, Marketing, 
Operations and Legal functions have 
completed 2,773 courses, which equates to 
1,386.5 hours of training.
82
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Build A More Inclusive, 
Diverse, and Engaged 
C&C 
Diversity, Equity, and Inclusion 
With each review of its composition, and 
when considering any appointment, the 
Board has particular regard for diversity 
of gender, social and ethnic backgrounds, 
nationality, and cognitive and personal 
strengths.
Our Board Diversity Policy sets out 
the approach to Diversity of the Board 
of Directors of C&C Group plc, Board 
Committees and Senior Management. The 
Board recognises the importance and value 
of diversity and inclusion in driving good 
decision making and the role of the Board 
and Senior Management in ensuring that 
equity, diversity, and inclusion is embedded 
in our culture, and reflected in our people 
and their behaviours in support of the long-
term sustainable success of the business. 
The Policy is intended to assist the Board, 
through the work of the Nomination 
Committee, by setting objectives for 
achieving Board and Senior Management 
diversity in support of the long-term 
sustainable success of C&C Group plc for 
the benefit of its stakeholders. 
While incorporating all aspects of diversity, 
we support the FTSE for Women Leaders 
and place a particular focus on gender 
and ethnic diversity considering the Parker 
Review. More information can be found on 
page 128 of the Nomination Committee 
Report.
Diversity, Equity & Inclusion 
(‘DE&I’) Group 
In July 2022, the Group established our 
DE&I Group, represented by colleagues 
across business areas and locations, to 
drive our DE&I Strategy. 
 
To inform our DE&I strategy and guide our 
actions we are collaborating on the industry 
Diversity in Grocery Partnership and Withal 
Partnership.
In December 2023, C&C’s Group Executive 
Committee, approved a new two-year DE&I 
plan with three key areas of focus
•	 Champion gender diversity with a plan to 
achieve 30% representation of women in 
leadership roles by 2026. 
•	 Championing employment opportunities 
for those from underrepresented and 
disadvantaged backgrounds at C&C by 
the end of 2026.
•	 Create opportunities for all employees to 
fulfil their potential and take responsibility 
for their career. 
Progress on this plan is now a standing 
agenda item at the monthly Group 
Executive Committee meeting. 
 
As part of our commitment to DE&I, 
we have initiated DE&I training for 
colleagues. This training covers topics 
such as harassment prevention, inclusive 
behaviours, and unconscious bias. The 
rollout began in October 2023 and will 
continue in phases throughout 2024. 
Gender Pay Group Reporting 
At C&C, we are committed to equality and 
building a culture around inclusion and 
fairness. We recognise the importance of 
monitoring the Gender Pay Gap and while 
this is something that we report on by law, 
we believe that using the Gender Pay Gap 
metrics alongside other data, initiatives and 
programmes will enable us to continue our 
DE&I progression. 
 
Governance
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
83

Our Gender Pay Gap Report provides 
metrics for our business units across the 
UK and Ireland, as part of C&C. This sets 
out the combined Gender Pay Gap metrics 
for all 2,326 UK employees (covering Great 
Britain and Northern Ireland) and all 518 
Irish employees, as we believe this provides 
a more meaningful and transparent 
disclosure. We have not published 
combined Gender Pay Gap metrics for all 
employees across the Group, given the 
differences in calculation methodology 
between the GB Regulations and Irish 
Regulations.
The Group are pleased that our 2023 Mean 
and Median Gender Pay Gap metrics for 
the UK and Ireland are in favour of female 
employees, indicating that the average pay 
for female employees is higher compared to 
male employees. Gender Pay Gap metrics 
continue to be lower than the national 
averages across the UK and Ireland. Whilst 
this is a positive step, only 26% of our UK-
based workforce and 14% of our Irish based 
workforce are female. However, we have 
strengthened our efforts to recruit women 
into Leadership roles and have achieved 
a noticeable change, 42% of our Group 
Executive Committee and 57% of all CEO 
direct reports, are female. 
We acknowledge there is still more to do 
to increase the representation of women 
across our business.
In the medium-term, we will be focusing on 
two priorities to continue to drive progress 
in this important area: 
•	 Aim to attract female talent into our 
organisation into roles and business 
areas that have previously been less 
gender balanced. 
•	 Aim to retain female talent in our 
organisation by identifying personal 
growth and development opportunities 
and embedding clear succession 
planning. 
 
We also recognise that gender parity is just 
one measure of an inclusive workplace. We 
are continuously focused on progressing 
DE&I across the Group and during 2023 we 
completed a number of initiatives relating 
to talent attraction and talent development, 
including 
 	
Talent Attraction 
 Our ambition is to build our female talent 
pipeline both internally and externally. 
•	 We are rolling out Recruitment and 
Selection training for Managers focused 
on unconscious biases to ensure fair and 
objective evaluation of candidates. 
•	 We will introduce diverse interview 
panels. 
Talent Development 
•	 We have developed the C&C Leadership 
Behavioural Framework to guide our 
leaders in demonstrating our core values 
of Joy, Quality and Respect. These 
values will be integrated within our people 
practices, including our recruitment and 
talent development policies. 
•	 We continue to invest in our people 
providing training and development 
opportunities focused on building 
leadership capabilities and we are 
supporting our talent through individual 
development plans. 
•	 We have introduced regular site briefings 
and dedicated sessions at team meetings 
to raise awareness of DE&I. 
•	 In FY2024, our Employee Resource 
Groups across Mental Wellbeing, 
Physical Wellbeing, Working Parents 
and Menopause continued to guide our 
programmes in these areas. In FY2025, 
we will conduct a review of our ERGs as 
part of our new two-year DE&I Plan and 
employee engagement survey feedback. 
With the support of our colleague DE&I 
Group, we will continue to develop and 
deliver against our DE&I strategy, a core 
part of which is focused on increasing the 
representation of women across the Group. 
Colleagues acknowledge our efforts 
around DE&I, scoring our initiatives 7.5 in 
the January 2024 Employee Engagement 
Survey.
 
Family Leave Policies 
At C&C, we foster a welcoming culture 
where everyone feels comfortable to be 
themselves, with people’s wellbeing a key 
priority for us. 
Sustainability Report
(continued)
84
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

As part of our commitment to diversity, 
equity, and inclusion, we have enhanced 
our Family Leave policies to ensure that 
everyone at C&C is enabled to balance their 
working responsibilities with their personal 
priorities and the important people in their 
lives. 
We are proud that our suite of Family Leave 
policies – a significant element of our C&C 
Reward & Benefits offering – are in line or 
are more generous than current market 
practice. 
 
Maternity and Adoption Leave 
All colleagues taking Maternity and 
Adoption leave to receive 26 weeks’ paid 
leave. 
 
Paternity Leave 
All colleagues taking Paternity leave to 
receive two weeks’ paid leave. 
 
Parents Leave 
Colleagues are entitled to seven weeks’ 
paid leave during the first two years of the 
child’s life or, in adoption cases, within two 
years of the placement of the child. 
Parents leave can be taken as a seven-
week block or separate periods of minimum 
one whole week block, agreed in advance 
with line managers, with a minimum of six 
weeks’ notice. 
 
Parental Leave 
Colleagues are entitled to 26 weeks’ unpaid 
leave for each child and adopted child, up 
to specific birthdays.
Compensation for extra or atypical 
working hours 
Local arrangements for compensation for 
extra or atypical working hours have been 
established, and where relevant, these 
have been agreed upon with trade unions. 
These arrangements are customised to suit 
the specific requirements and regulations 
of each local area, ensuring adherence 
to relevant labour laws and collective 
bargaining agreements.
Communication to all employees 
of remuneration process
At C&C, remuneration practices receive 
thorough consideration throughout the 
organisation. The HR Officer regularly 
updates the Board on remuneration 
structures, salary reviews, and benefits. 
Executive Director pay is overseen and 
decided by the Remuneration Committee, 
informed by a Group-wide annual salary 
review. Additionally, our Chair of the 
Remuneration Committee provides regular 
updates to the Committee on Company-
wide remuneration policy, pay matters, 
and our commitment to equitable rewards, 
including discussions on the growing 
use of ESG measures in goal setting and 
Shareholder expectations.
Employee representatives or 
employee representative body 
(e.g. works council)
Maintaining trade union recognition across 
our manufacturing and logistics network, 
we have also established both local and 
national employee forums attended by 
staff representatives and members of the 
management team. Approximately 53% 
of our workforce across all locations are 
covered by formal collective agreements 
concerning working conditions and formally 
elected employee representatives.
Employee Engagement Tracking 
Colleague engagement is a key priority for 
C&C Group and is an agenda item at each 
Board and Group Executive Committee 
meeting. 
 
We are committed to creating an inclusive 
culture at C&C, where everyone feels 
valued, safe, respected, and comfortable 
to be themselves. Our aim will always be 
to make C&C a great place to work for all 
colleagues, with the Peakon survey being 
a key channel to capture their views. In 
FY2024, all C&C colleagues were surveyed 
via Peakon in May 2023 and January 2024. 
These surveys, submitted anonymously, 
look to identify where we are as a business 
and how our values reflect colleagues’ 
experience working at C&C.
The May 2023 survey told us that we need 
to remain focused on three key areas: 
Strategy, Organisational Fit and Reward.
 
Colleagues told us that they would value 
more insights on our company progress 
and strategy to ensure everyone is regularly 
updated. In September 2023, we launched 
Group-wide Executive Committee led 
quarterly colleague briefing sessions, 
providing regular content covering Our 
Customers; Our Brands; and Our People 
aligned to our Strategy. In the run up to 
our business trading announcements, 
colleagues will receive updates covering 
Performance; Strategic Priorities; Customer 
Service; Employee Proposition; Focus 
Areas; and Recognition.
In October, we announced a revised 
Operating Business Model and Group 
Executive Committee alignment, signalling 
positive changes in the way we operate as 
a business to set ourselves up for success, 
leveraging best practice, streamlining 
processes, and investing in the right areas 
to drive growth, including technology 
enablers. The Group continues to make 
great progress to ensure that each Group 
Executive Committee member aligns 
with delivering our strategy including the 
appointment of our Chief Financial Officer, 
Chief People Officer, Chief Marketing 
Officer, and Chief Technology Officer roles. 
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
85

As part of our learnings and advancements 
we have made across DE&I, we have 
enhanced our suite of Family Leave 
policies. Our Family Leave policies ensure 
that everyone is enabled to balance their 
working responsibilities with their personal 
priorities and the important people in their 
lives. 
 
In January 2024, 78% of colleagues 
completed the Peakon survey, an increase 
of 5% since May, with an Engagement 
Score of 7.1, which also shows a slight 
increase on May. Colleagues also provided 
almost 15,000 individual comments – 
adding further depth and insight into 
their views, helping the Group Executive 
Committee and leadership teams identify 
priority areas to progress. The Group is 
committed to improving Engagement and 
recognises that there is work to do. In 
April, the C&C Executive team reviewed 
the January survey results to identify key 
themes and develop a group-wide action 
plan. In addition, each Group Executive 
Committee member will be reviewing their 
function’s results with their leadership 
teams, to communicate results and build 
functional, team and individual actions 
plans to deliver improvement. To improve 
engagement, on-line resources are 
provided to all line-managers to review, 
respond, and action Peakon Data feedback 
from their teams.  
Non-Executive Director (NED) / 
Employee Engagement 
Our two newly appointed Designated 
Employee Non-Executive Directors 
hosted employee engagement sessions in 
FY2024, and a full year plan is in place for 
FY2025 across the group locations These 
“listening sessions” allow our Non-Executive 
Directors to bring colleagues' voices into 
Board discussions so that these can be 
considered in Board decision-making. 
These sessions build on existing employee 
engagement opportunities and the Group’s 
continuing efforts to develop a culture of 
informality, transparency, and trust. The 
aim is to provide a further opportunity to 
increase two-way dialogue between the 
Board and all employees.
Whistleblowing with confidence
At C&C, we work hard to foster a safe, 
inclusive working environment. We have 
a zero-tolerance policy for all forms of 
bullying, harassment, and discrimination, 
and we want to ensure that everyone at 
C&C can speak up about injustices they 
experience or witness. 
Colleagues can raise any concerns they 
may have about themselves, a colleague 
or our working environment via the HR 
Advice Team and Vault, a simple, safe, and 
confidential digital application. 
There were 5 instances of “concern or 
suspicion related to ethical or compliance 
related wrongdoing in the Group” raised 
via Vault in FY2024 (out of 142 instances of 
concerns raised across the Group).
Human Rights
We do not condone and will not knowingly 
participate in any form of human 
exploitation, including child, forced or 
compulsory labour, slavery and people 
trafficking. We refuse to work with any 
suppliers or service providers who 
knowingly participate in such practices or 
who cannot demonstrate to us sufficient 
controls to ensure that such practices are 
not taking place in their supply chains. 
Our approach is reflected in our Code of 
Conduct and Modern Slavery Statement, 
which we ask suppliers to comply with 
as a condition of trade. We also carry 
Sustainability Report
(continued)
out diligence audits and checks on our 
suppliers to ensure that they have in place 
and adhere to appropriate ethical policies, 
with KPIs for those areas where we believe 
the potential impact on the Group is 
material. A process is in place internally to 
address and remediate any instances of 
non-conformance. A copy of our Code of 
Conduct and Modern Slavery Statements 
are available on our website.
Anti-Bribery and Corruption
Our Anti-Bribery and Corruption Policy 
and accompanying training materials are 
designed to be straightforward and direct 
so that it is clear to all employees what 
they may or may not do as part of normal 
business transactions. The Policy applies 
to all colleagues in the Group equally. It is 
written to ensure that legitimate and honest 
business transactions can be distinguished 
from improper and dishonest transactions. 
This Policy and the accompanying training 
will be tracked to monitor understanding 
and adherence to the Policy. KPIs have 
been established for those areas where we 
believe the potential impact on the Group 
is material. During FY2024, no incidences 
of bribery or corruption were uncovered 
across the Group. 
86
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Collaborate With 
Government, 
NGOs, and Industry 
Programmes
Building Meaningful Charity 
Partnerships
The C&C Group is committed to the 
communities in which it operates and 
undertakes a range of initiatives that benefit 
our local communities. 
Big Issue Group 
C&C Group are now in the second year of 
a three-year partnership with the Big Issue 
Group (‘BIG’), whose aim is to change 
lives through enterprise for marginalised 
communities across Great Britain. This 
partnership is aligned with our charitable 
agenda across homelessness, addiction, 
mental health, and poverty. Working with 
C&C colleagues and the brilliant team at the 
BIG, we are looking to play a meaningful 
part in tackling these complex social issues.
The partnership focuses on four priorities – 
Year One Highlights: 
•	 Big Issue Foundation and Big Issue Pitch 
Supporting vendors with immersion and 
education opportunities, allowing them 
to access C&C sites and facilities and to 
engage and sell magazines to colleagues 
through Sheltered Pitches. C&C hosted 
seven Sheltered Pitches across our sites 
in FY2024.
•	 Employability Programme – Big 
Issue Recruit Offering opportunities 
for vulnerable people into work and 
mainstream living. We have committed 
to placing 15 Vendors each year in 
employment across the Group. During 
the first year of our partnership, we 
welcomed six vendors to C&C Group. 
•	 Big Issue Invest Mentoring opportunities 
between C&C colleagues and Big Issue 
vendors, offering practical training, 
support, and skills development. Three 
C&C colleagues mentored in first cohort 
of the Big Issue and Power Up London 
Accelerator Programme. Additional C&C 
colleagues will join the second cohort of 
Power Up London due to launch in April 
2024.
•	 Cause Related Marketing Campaigns 
Collaborate on joint campaigns including 
colleague fundraising. In the first year of 
our partnership, C&C colleagues raised 
over £8,000 for the Big Issue through 
a number of initiatives including, ten 
colleagues who participated in the Three 
Peaks Challenge, an iconic 24-hour hiking 
adventure, taking in around 26 miles of 
stunning UK National Park scenery and 
some of the best views across Great 
Britain. 
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
87

Colleague Volunteering & Charity 
Policy
We know that volunteering creates mutual 
benefit for C&C, our local communities, 
and our colleagues. Alongside a positive 
contribution to the local economy, 
volunteering also enhances the health, 
wellbeing, and capability of colleagues. To 
support this, C&C has in place a Colleague 
Volunteering & Charity Policy, which offers 
colleagues time off to volunteer, whether 
it be through Big Issue Group, Inner City 
Enterprise (ICE) partnerships, or local 
charities, community initiatives and causes 
that are of personal interest or relevant to 
our brands and Business Units. 
Inter City Enterprise (ICE) - Ireland
In September 2023, C&C Group announced 
an extension of our partnership with ICE, 
our valued community partner in Ireland. 
ICE is a not-for-profit charity established 
in 1992 and relaunched in 2012 to help 
unemployed individuals to establish their 
own businesses in Dublin’s Inner City 
supporting over 4,000 businesses in this 
period. Our partnership strives to benefit 
both parties, C&C Group partaking in 
mentoring roles for enterprise participants 
and delivering training sessions covering 
important business requirements to 
attain success. C&C Group employees 
volunteering their time will be given the 
opportunity to share their skills and 
experience with ICE participants benefiting 
their own career and personal development. 
C&C Group further supports ICE by 
arranging fundraising events including 
the Four Peak Challenge completed by 
colleagues in 2023. Four Peaks is an iconic 
48-hour endurance hiking adventure, 
climbing the highest peaks in each of the 
four provinces of Ireland. The event raised 
over €2000 for ICE to support projects and 
participants.
Big Issue Big Recruit 
As part of our thriving three-year 
partnership with The Big Issue, a key 
priority for C&C Group was to build 
on our legacy of existing outreach 
initiatives which have empowered people 
from marginalised communities into 
work. Working with Big Issue Recruit, 
a specialist recruitment service from 
the Big Issue Group, we have made a 
commitment to provide at least 45forty-
five employment opportunities with 
the C&C Group by September 2025. 
Having set up our employment pathway, 
we have recently welcomed six new 
colleagues into roles across our Wellpark 
and Park Royal (now Orbital West) sites.
Mokhammed, pictured, is one of our six 
new colleagues who has recently joined 
us just 12 months after leaving Ukraine 
and fleeing with his young family when 
the war broke out in early 2022.
Mokhammed’s first thought was his 
family when he heard gunfire and tanks 
rumbling through his home city Kyiv, as 
Russia launched its attack on Ukraine. 
He feared for his young children and 
pregnant wife, he knew they had to flee. 
Mokhammed had been a salesperson 
in a bazaar in Kyiv before the war broke 
out. 
With his family, Mokhammed initially fled 
to Germany, where they applied online 
for Ukraine Family Scheme visa in the 
UK. “We know a little bit of English,” he 
says. “That’s why we came here. It was 
my dream country when I was a child.” 
 
Mokhammed met Shak Dean, a Big 
Issue Recruit Job Coach at a job fare 
for Ukrainian refugees at Hounslow 
Job Centre who offered to support 
Mokhammed into work. Just over 
12 months after leaving Kyiv and 
fleeing to the UK, Mokhammed has 
now embarked on a new career as a 
warehouse operative with C&C Group.
Sustainability Report
(continued)
Case Study
C&C Group and The Big Issue Partnership 
88
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Other Community Partnerships
C&C Group continues to support a range 
of charitable organisations across GB and 
Ireland. 
In 2024, Matthew Clark again partnered 
with PubAid and the All-Party Parliamentary 
Beer Group to support the Community 
Pub Hero Awards, recognising the critical 
role that hospitality plays across the UK in 
helping communities.
Tennent’s has a longstanding partnership 
with The Benevolent Society of Scotland 
(‘The Ben’), which aids people of all ages 
who have worked in the licensed trade for 
at least three years full-time. Beneficiaries 
receive annual financial assistance as well 
as discretionary grants for emergency 
situations.
Now in its third year, the “SpotLight Project” 
sees Tennent’s Light invest 3.4% from every 
pint and bottle sold to support Scotland’s 
up-and-coming creative talent. In FY2024, 
this saw Tennent’s Light has partner with 
Scotland’s festival for music discovery, 
Tenement Trail in October in Glasgow. C&C 
Group is a funder and active member of 
Drinkaware and Drinkaware.ie, who lead on 
educating consumers about responsible 
alcohol consumption. In addition, we 
support Best Bar None in Scotland, a 
national accreditation and award scheme 
for licensed premises. Participants are given 
support and advice to improve the safety of 
their staff, premises, and customers and to 
adopt high management standards.
We are members of the UK’s National 
Association of Cider Makers (‘NACM’), 
which works closely with apple growers and 
the agricultural communities in cider regions 
in the UK. This working relationship puts 
us at the heart of many UK Government 
discussions relating to the responsible use 
of alcohol. The NACM is also engaged 
with tax and regulatory departments and 
opinion-forming bodies having an interest 
in cider and alcohol generally. We are 
also members of the British Beer and 
Pub Association, Wine and Spirit Trade 
Association and the European Cider and 
Fruit Wine Association.
In Ireland, C&C are members and actively 
support the work of Drinkaware.ie, the 
Licensed Vintners Association, the Vintners 
Federation of Ireland, and Hospitality Ulster.
In FY2024, the Group has responded to UK 
Governments consultations including low 
and no product descriptors and Extended 
Producer Responsibility (EPR) Regulations 
(UK) and Alcohol Marketing Restrictions, 
Minimum Unit Pricing Price Review. 
(Scotland).
Deposit Return Scheme 
UK
C&C Group supports the aims around the 
introduction of an efficient and effective 
Deposit Return Scheme (DRS). Our stated 
preference since proposals were fist 
announced back in 2017, is that, to minimise 
cost and complexity and offer the best 
chance of achieving the stated objectives, 
there must be one fully interoperable 
scheme, introduced at the same time, 
across the four nations of the UK.
We continue to work with all Governments, 
officials, industry, and Trade Bodies to meet 
the new go-live target date of October 2027. 
Ireland 
C&C worked with Re-turn, the scheme 
administrator in Ireland, customers, and 
suppliers on the implementation of DRS on 
1st February 2024.
Minimum Unit Pricing (‘MUP’)
Scotland
From late 2017, C&C have participated 
directly in an advisory group supporting 
the portfolio of studies to assess this 
ground-breaking legislation. C&C supported 
Public Health Scotland, which was tasked 
with evaluating the implementation by 
the Scottish Government, by regularly 
contributing to improving the studies and 
assessments of the economic impacts of 
MUP, via the Economic Advisory Group 
(‘EAG’).
C&C offered analytical expertise, 
introductions to research agencies, and 
expert assistance to testing and interpreting 
some of the observed findings. Our 
objective was, and remains, to ensure the 
best possible evaluation of this pioneering 
legislation. 
In the recent consultations on the 
continuation and level of pricing to be 
applied from 2024, C&C Group again 
highlighted that we have supported 
Minimum Unit Pricing since proposals 
were first raised in 2011. A cross functional 
working group is working alongside our off-
trade partners, to prepare for the new 65p / 
unit level (from 50p / unit) to be introduced 
on 30 September 2024.
We continue to believe that minimum 
unit pricing, as part of a range of health 
measures, is an important step in tackling 
the availability of strong cheap alcohol, 
irresponsible consumption among a 
minority of drinkers, and alcohol harm. We 
continue to support the introduction of MUP 
in all the territories where we operate. 
Tax
The Group takes its responsibilities as a 
corporate citizen seriously. This includes 
respecting and complying with local 
tax laws and paying the required and 
appropriate levels of tax in the different 
countries where we operate. We claim the 
allowances and deductions that we are 
properly entitled to, for instance, on the 
investment and employment that we bring 
to our communities. We benefit from having 
always been an Irish company, established 
in the Republic of Ireland’s corporate 
tax environment, with our major cider 
production unit located in Clonmel and 
the Group is headquartered in Dublin. The 
majority of the Group’s profits are earned 
in Ireland and the UK, which both have 
competitive corporation tax rates compared 
with the European average. In Ireland and 
the UK, we remit substantial amounts of 
duty on alcohol production, as well as VAT 
and employment taxes. 
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information
89

90
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024
Governance
Report
91
Governance at a Glance
92
Directors and Officers
94
Corporate Governance Report
108
Directors’ Report
114
Audit Committee Report
123
Environmental, Social and  
Governance Committee Report
127
Nomination Committee Report
136
Directors’ Remuneration  
Committee Report
164
Statement of Directors’ 
Responsibilities

Board Leadership and Company Purpose 
This can be found on pages 98 to 99
Division of Responsibilities 
This can be found on page 101
Composition, Succession and Evaluation 
This can be found on pages 103 to 104
Audit, Risk and Internal Control 
This can be found on page 106
Remuneration 
This can be found on page 107
Governance at a Glance
Purpose
Play a role in every drinking 
occasion, delivering joy to our 
customers and consumers with 
remarkable brands and service.
UK Corporate Governance Code 
The Board continues to assess its approach 
to corporate governance through application 
of the FRC’s UK Corporate Governance 
Code 2018 (the Code) and reports against 
the 2018 Code for the year ended 29 
February 2024. A copy can be found at 
www.frc.org.uk.
For the year ended 29 February 2024, the 
Board confirms compliance against the 
Code provisions. 
Board Diversity
% of female representation on the Board and 
its Committees as at 29 February 2024; 
Key Board Activities during FY2024
•	Reviewed Board and Board Committee 
Composition
•	Implemented Board Diversity Policy
•	Reviewed Non-Executive Director Employee 
Engagement mechanism
•	Share Buyback Programme
•	Payment of Dividend
44%
50% 
50% 
50% 
33% 
 Board
Remuneration 
Committee
 Nomination 
Committee
ESG Committee
Audit Committee
Appointment of female SID
New Board Diversity Policy
91
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

1. Ralph Findlay OBE (63)
Chair and Chief Executive Officer
Board Tenure: 2 years as Non-Executive 
Director and Chair; 1 year as Executive Chair, 
1 month as Chair and Chief Executive Officer
Ethnicity: White British
Nationality: British
Ralph was appointed a Non-Executive Director 
of the Company in March 2022, Chair on 7 
July 2022, Executive Chair on 18 May 2023 
and CEO on 6 June 2024. Ralph, a Chartered 
Accountant and qualified member of the 
Association of Corporate Treasurers, served 
as Chief Executive Officer of Marston’s, the UK 
pub group, for 20 years. Ralph served on the 
Marston’s Board from 1996, having previously 
held the role of Finance Director before being 
appointed Chief Executive Officer in 2001. 
Ralph was appointed Non-Executive Chair of 
Vistry Group plc in May 2022, having served 
as a Non-Executive Director since 2015 and 
Senior Independent Director from January 
2020. He also previously served as Chair of 
the British Beer and Pub Association. Ralph 
was awarded an OBE for services to the 
hospitality sector in 2022. Ralph’s contribution 
is, and continues to be, important to the 
Company’s long-term sustainable success. 
2. Andrew Andrea (55)
Chief Financial Officer
Board Tenure: 3 months
Ethnicity: White English
Nationality: British
Andrew is a drinks industry veteran having 
served in senior roles at Marston’s plc, 
a leading independent brewing and pub 
retailing business in the UK, for over 20 
years. He joined Marston’s in 2002 and was 
appointed to the Board as Finance Director 
in 2009. He served in a variety of senior 
roles in the business including 12 years as 
CFO & Corporate Development Officer and, 
subsequently, as CEO during which time he 
navigated the business out of the COVID-19 
pandemic and the subsequent challenging 
macroeconomic environment. Andrew 
previously held roles with Guinness Brewing 
Worldwide and Bass Brewers Limited. 
Andrew, a qualified Chartered Accountant, is 
also a Non-Executive Director at Portmeirion 
Group plc.
5. Chris Browne OBE (64)
Senior Independent Non-Executive 
Director and Designated Employee 
Engagement Non-Executive Director
Board Tenure: 8 months
Ethnicity: White
Nationality: Irish
Chris was appointed as a Non-Executive 
Director of the Company in October 2023, 
Non-Executive Director Employee Engagement 
in December 2023 and as Senior Independent 
Non-Executive Director in February 2024. Chris 
is Chair of the Nomination Committee and a 
member of the ESG Board Committee. Chris 
is also Non-Executive Director of Vistry plc 
and Kier plc and previously served as a Non-
Executive Director of Constellium SE (NYSE). 
She has held a number of senior leadership 
and executive roles within the aviation and 
travel industries. Chris first served as Managing 
Director of First Choice Airways, which included 
overseeing a customer-focused transformation 
programme. She subsequently directed and 
managed a successful merger with Thomson 
Airways before being appointed to execute 
a similar project for parent company, TUI 
Group plc. In 2016, Chris joined EasyJet plc 
and served as Chief Operating Officer until 
2019. Chris brings vast experience managing 
complex consumer-facing operations to C&C. 
She has a Doctorate of Science (Honorary) for 
Leadership in Management and was awarded 
an OBE in 2013 for services to aviation.
3. Angela Bromfield (61)
Independent Non-Executive Director
Board Tenure: 11 months
Ethnicity: White English
Nationality: British
Angela was appointed a Non-Executive 
Director of the Company in July 2023 and 
Chair of the Remuneration Committee in July 
2023. Angela is an experienced Non-Executive 
Director and business strategist, with a broad-
based international career in manufacturing, 
distribution, construction and infrastructure 
that includes P&L leadership experience. 
Throughout her career, with the likes of 
Premier Farnell, Anglo American and later, 
Morgan Sindall plc, as Strategy, Marketing 
and Communications Director, Angela has 
been at the heart of significant transformation 
programmes which have put the customer first 
and driven growth and profitability.
4. Vineet Bhalla (51)
Independent Non-Executive Director
Board Tenure: 3 years 2 months
Ethnicity: Asian Indian
Nationality: British
Vineet was appointed a Non-Executive 
Director of the Company in April 2021. Vineet 
is a highly experienced digital professional, 
with 30 years of experience across defence, 
consumer goods, health, charity and retail 
sectors. Vineet is currently Chief Technology 
Officer (CTO) at Cancer Research UK. He was 
previously CTO and Senior Vice President 
at Burberry plc and has held global roles 
for Unilever as Head of IT for their digital 
marketing and research and development 
divisions and had led data-driven and digital 
transformations at scale. Prior to Unilever, 
Vineet held global technology positions at 
Diageo enabling data driven transformation of 
their UK and Ireland Customer Development 
Teams. Vineet has also recently held a Non-
Executive Director position at Moorfields Eye 
Hospital NHS Foundation Trust and served 
as Chair of the Trust’s People and Culture 
Committee. Vineet brings strong digital 
transformation skills to the Board.
1
3
5
2
4
Directors and Officers as at 27 June 2024
 N 
 N
 R 
 R
 E
 N
 E
92
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

6. Jill Caseberry (59)
Independent Non-Executive Director
Board Tenure: 5 years 4 months
Ethnicity: White English
Nationality: British
Jill was appointed a Non-Executive Director of 
the Company in February 2019, a member of 
the Remuneration Committee in March 2019, a 
member of the Audit Committee in December 
2023, and a member of the ESG Committee 
in September 2020 until December 2023. Jill 
has extensive sales, marketing and general 
management experience across a number of 
blue-chip companies including Mars, PepsiCo 
and Premier Foods. Jill is a Non-Executive 
Director, Chair of the Remuneration Committee 
and member of the Audit and Nomination 
Committee at Bellway plc and at Halfords plc. 
Jill is also Senior Independent Director, Chair of 
the Remuneration Committee and a member 
of the Nomination Committee at Bakkavor 
plc and Senior Independent Director, Chair of 
the Remuneration Committee and member of 
the Audit and Nomination Committees of St. 
Austell Brewery Company Limited. Jill brings 
considerable experience of brand management 
and marketing to the Board.
7. Vincent Crowley (69)
Independent Non-Executive Director
Board Tenure: 8 years 5 months
Ethnicity: White
Nationality: Irish
Vincent was appointed as a Non-Executive 
Director of the Company in January 2016 
and as Senior Independent Director in June 
2019 to February 2024. He is a member of 
the Audit Committee and the Nomination 
Committee. Vincent was previously both 
Chief Operating Officer and Chief Executive 
Officer of Independent News and Media plc, 
a leading media company. He also served 
as Chief Executive Officer and subsequently 
as a Non-Executive Director of APN News & 
Media, a media company listed in Australia and 
New Zealand. He initially worked with KPMG 
in Ireland. Vincent is currently Chair of Altas 
Investments plc and a Non-Executive Director 
of Grafton Group plc. Vincent was appointed 
Chair of Davy Stockbrokers in December 
2022 and is also Chair of the charity, Inner 
City Enterprise. Vincent brings considerable 
domestic and international business 
experience across a number of sectors to the 
Board.
8. John Gibney (63)
Independent Non-Executive Director
Board Tenure: 1 year 8 months
Ethnicity: White English
Nationality: British
John was appointed as a Non-Executive Director 
of the Company in October 2022 and as Chair 
of the Audit Committee in February 2023. John 
served for 17 years as Chief Financial Officer and 
Board member of Britvic plc, the international soft 
drinks business, where he was responsible for 
finance, legal, estates, risk management, quality, 
safety and environment, and procurement. Prior 
to joining Britvic plc, John was Senior Corporate 
Finance and Planning Manager for Bass plc and, 
before that, Finance Director and subsequently, 
Deputy Managing Director of Gala Clubs. John 
was appointed a Non-Executive Director of 
4imprint Group plc in 2021 and serves as Chair 
of their Audit Committee. He previously served as 
a Non-Executive Director and Chair of the Audit 
Committee at Pure Circle PLC and Dairy Crest plc 
(now Saputo Dairy UK).
9. Sarah Newbitt (55)
Independent Non-Executive Director and 
Designated Employee Engagement Non-
Executive Director 
Board Tenure: 10 months
Ethnicity: White English
Nationality: British
Sarah was appointed a Non-Executive Director of 
the Company in August 2023 and Non-Executive 
Director Employee Engagement in December 
2023. Sarah is a member of the ESG Committee. 
Sarah is also a Non-Executive Director of 
Campden BRI, High Value Manufacturing 
Catapult. The majority of Sarah’s executive 
career has been spent with Unilever, one of the 
world’s largest consumer goods companies. 
Over the course of 25 years in Unilever, Sarah 
held various international roles across operations 
and general management and gained substantial 
M&A integration experience. Her final role was 
as Vice President Supply Chain of Unilever UK & 
Ireland, a £2bn turnover business employing over 
6,000 people. Sarah brings significant consumer 
goods sector insight and manufacturing and 
supply chain experience to the Board, together 
with expertise in developing and implementing 
sustainability strategies. Sarah is a Chartered 
Engineer, who studied Engineering at Oxford 
University and also holds a Professional 
Certificate in Coaching from Henley Business 
School. 
Mark Chilton
Company Secretary & 
Group General Counsel
Mark Chilton (61) joined the 
Group in January 2019 as 
Company Secretary and 
Group General Counsel. 
Mark was Company 
Secretary and General 
Counsel of Booker Group plc 
from 2006 until 2018. Mark 
qualified as a solicitor in 1987. 
For information on 
independence of the 
Directors, please see pages 
94 to 95.
Outgoing Directors
David Forde, Emer Finnan, 
Jim Thompson and Helen 
Pitcher all stepped down 
from the Board during 
FY2024 and Patrick 
McMahon stepped down 
from the Board on 6 June 
2024.
Board Committee 
Membership Key
 A
 N
 R
 E
6
8
7
9
Audit  
Committee 
Nomination  
Committee
Remuneration  
Committee
ESG  
Committee
Committee 
Chair
 E 
 R
 A
 A
 N
 R
 A 
93
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

This report sets out our approach to 
Corporate Governance and summarises 
the role of the Board in providing effective 
leadership to promote the long-term 
sustainable success of C&C and outlines 
the key areas of focus of the Board and its 
activities undertaken during the year. My 
introductory letter on pages 2 to 5 of this 
Annual Report sets out some of the Group’s 
key challenges and achievements during the 
year and my expectations on the outlook for 
2025. The ongoing engagement with our 
key stakeholders, is essential to ensure that 
I can lead the Board effectively and create 
the right conditions to enable us to deliver 
on our strategy.
During FY2024 after accounting 
discrepancies were discovered and notified 
to the Audit Committee an independent 
accounting firm was appointed to 
investigate the relevant issues, determine 
any potential financial impact and establish 
the time period over which the issues 
extended. The most significant accounting 
issues related to the Group’s cider 
production facility in Clonmel, together 
with further adjustments to current assets 
and liabilities at a number of the Group’s 
other sites, and amendments to provisions 
for onerous apple contracts. The issues 
identified were then considered in detail 
by both the Group's Audit Committee 
and the Board as part of the finalisation of 
the Group's FY2024 Annual Report and 
Accounts.
As a consequence, accounting adjustments 
have been made to the financial statements 
relating to FY2021, 2022 and 2023. The 
accounting adjustments in aggregate 
represent an underlying operating profit 
adjustments charge of €6.1m. By year, 
the restatements comprised a €1.5m 
adjustment charge in FY2023, a €3.1m 
adjustment credit in FY2022 and a €7.7m 
adjustment charge in FY2021. These 
adjustments relate principally to five items, 
inventory related matters (€11.1m charge), 
incorrect accounting treatment of inventory 
of branded glassware (€1.1m charge), goods 
received not invoiced (‘GRNI’) (€2.9m credit), 
the timing of release of customer discount 
liabilities (€3.7m credit), together with 
additional items (net €0.5m charge) over the 
three-year period in question. In addition, 
the Group has recorded an exceptional 
prior year (FY2023) charge with respect 
to onerous apple contracts of €12.2m. 
The total value of the pre-tax adjustments 
(including exceptional) is €18.3m and the 
impact on the Group’s retained earnings 
position at FY2023 is €15.6m. There will 
also be an impact on the unaudited FY2024 
interim results, the details of which will be 
provided in the FY2025 Interim results to be 
announced in October.
The need to make these prior year 
adjustments is deeply disappointing to 
the Board. It is clear that in parts of the 
organisation, our governance and internal 
controls framework did not perform as 
required and behaviours fell short of 
the levels of accuracy and transparency 
expected by the Board. Importantly, as set 
out below, on 1 March 2024 we welcomed 
Andrew Andrea, a highly experienced 
Chief Financial Officer (‘CFO’) to C&C, who 
has overseen the 2024 Annual Report 
and Accounts process to its conclusion. 
Resulting from the robust internal and 
external reviews undertaken, we have 
already implemented a number of the 
proposed remedial actions to our internal 
controls and reporting framework. I set out 
later in this report specific changes and 
improvements we have made to Board 
governance, financial controls, the internal 
audit process and the reporting culture 
which make us confident that the issues 
identified will not be repeated. An additional 
key focus of the Board for going forward is 
our commitment to ensuring a transparent 
organisational culture and renewed 
engagement behind our independent and 
confidential reporting programme called 
‘Speak Up’. 
Dear Shareholder
On behalf of the Board, 
I present the Corporate 
Governance Report for the 
financial year ended 29 
February 2024 (‘FY2024’). 
Corporate Governance Report
94
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Board Composition and 
Succession
As detailed on page 3, on 6 June 2024 
Patrick McMahon stepped down as CEO 
and from the Board with immediate effect. I 
was appointed by the Board to serve in the 
role of CEO in addition to my role as Chair 
of the Board. I recused myself from this 
decision process and also stepped down 
as Chair of the Nomination Committee on 
taking up the role of CEO.  It is expected 
that I will act as CEO for the next 12-18 
months, though the Nomination Committee 
has committed to keep this under review 
as the recruitment process for a new 
CEO progresses.  The rationale for my 
appointment to the position of CEO is to 
ensure stability within the senior leadership 
team and to execute on the Group’s 
strategic objectives following a challenging 
trading period, in part reflecting the ERP 
implementation issues of the past year, 
together with a series of new appointments 
to the leadership team, the creation of a 
new reporting structure and the impact of 
the recent accounting and internal control 
issues. My existing relationships with key 
stakeholders; in particular with employees, 
shareholders, customers and suppliers, 
was also considered by the Board as an 
important factor in my appointment. The 
detailed rationale for my appointment is 
set out on page 98 and also within the 
Nomination Committee Report on page 127.
A search for Patrick McMahon’s long-
term successor will commence in the 
autumn. It will be a rigorous process and 
will be undertaken with the support of an 
independent executive search firm. Upon 
the appointment of a new CEO, I will revert 
to my position as Non-Executive Chair 
of the Board. The Board recognises that 
one-individual holding the posts of Chair 
and CEO is a departure from governance 
best-practice, however, the unanimous 
view of the Board is that the interests 
of C&C’s employees, shareholders and 
wider stakeholders is best served by this 
leadership structure through the near term.
As outlined in last year’s report, at the 
conclusion of the Annual General Meeting 
in July 2023, Jim Thompson and Helen 
Pitcher stepped down from the Board, 
David Forde stepped down as CEO in 
May 2023, and consequently Patrick 
McMahon, then CFO, was appointed CEO 
with immediate effect. I was appointed as 
Executive Chair to support the management 
transition as Patrick McMahon retained his 
responsibilities as CFO until a new CFO 
was appointed. On 1 March 2024, we 
were pleased to welcome Andrew Andrea 
as CFO, an experienced public company 
Executive who brings a rare depth of 
expertise within our industry to C&C.
In July 2023, we were pleased to welcome 
Angela Bromfield as Non-Executive Director 
and Remuneration Committee Chair. As 
part of our ongoing succession planning 
process, our Non-Executive Director 
search successfully concluded with the 
appointment of Sarah Newbitt and Chris 
Browne as Independent Non-Executive 
Directors, bringing significant Executive 
and Non-Executive experience, and further 
strengthening the Board as well as adding 
new perspectives and insight from their 
respective careers. You can find Angela’s, 
Sarah’s and Chris’s biographies on pages 
92 and 93.
We also announced in February 2024, that 
Vincent Crowley, Non-Executive Director 
will be stepping down from the Board at 
the conclusion of the 2024 AGM, after 
almost nine years of service. The Board 
would like to thank Vincent for his significant 
contributions and service to the Group 
during his tenure on the Board.
I am committed to ensuring that C&C’s 
Board composition reflects a diverse mix 
of skills, experience, personal attributes 
as well as broader aspects of diversity 
which includes gender, ethnicity, skillset, 
educational experience and tenure. In line 
with our succession planning, I look forward 
to announcing progress on the appointment 
of a further Non-Executive Director in the 
near future.
Our People, Diversity and Culture
As a people focused business, our strength 
comes from an inclusive and welcoming 
environment, where we recognise that the 
experiences and perspectives which make 
us unique come together in our shared 
values and vision. We strongly believe that 
the more our people reflect the diversity 
of our society, the better equipped we are 
to meet the needs of our customers and 
consumers.
Ensuring that we have a culture which 
promotes and values diversity, and one 
which is maintained throughout the 
business, is a continual prime focus and is 
underpinned by our Diversity, Inclusion and 
Wellbeing (‘DI&W’) Policy, which sets out 
our objectives across the organisation. The 
importance of this area also forms the basis 
for Board diversity and succession planning 
as we consider the best constitution of 
the Board to successfully take the Group 
forward to deliver the Group’s strategy. 
Further details about our overall approach 
to Diversity, Equity and Inclusion (‘DE&I) 
can be found in the Sustainability Report 
on pages 59 to 89 and the Nomination 
Committee Report on pages 127 to 135. 
You can also read about our Gender Pay 
Gap on page 28.
Throughout FY2024, DE&I has remained 
a key focus. While acknowledging that 
there is still work to be done, we’re pleased 
with our progress over the past year, with 
highlights including: the launch of our DE&I 
two-year strategic plan, supporting and 
listening to our employees' voice, complying 
with FCA Listing rule diversity targets and 
the launch of our Working Parents Policy.
As detailed further within this report, we 
recognise that we need to review our 
processes around transparency and 
openness following the internal accounting 
and control issues which were identified 
recently. As a Board we are fully engaged 
in a campaign to refresh our healthy 
workplace ‘Speak up’ programme as part of 
the many actions we are taking to promote 
our culture of openness and trust, which 
ensures the integrity of our internal financial 
reporting and controls environment. 
95
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Sustainability
Building on our strong governance 
framework to ensure that ESG is embedded 
into everything that we do at C&C, a 
new ESG Management Committee 
was established to review sustainability 
initiatives and regulatory reporting. These 
responsibilities, previously sat with the 
ESG Board Committee, allowing the ESG 
Board Committee the opportunity to 
provide additional focus and scrutiny and 
to identify areas where C&C’s approach to 
sustainability can make the most material 
impact, while ensuring high standards of 
governance and reporting in this area.
 
An impact materiality assessment 
exercise, in line with the Global Reporting 
Initiative, was completed during the year 
to ensure that the Group’s ESG priorities 
remain aligned with the views of our key 
stakeholders. We have commenced work 
on a Double Materiality assessment to 
further strengthen the Group’s response to 
ESG regulations, including the Corporate 
Sustainability Reporting Directive (‘CSRD’) 
and our reporting efforts in line with the 
Task Force on Climate-Related Financial 
Disclosures (‘TCFD’). The assessment will 
consider both the material impacts on our 
stakeholders and also material sustainability 
related risks and opportunities for C&C. 
Stakeholders
We have sought to balance the needs of 
our numerous stakeholders throughout 
the year, be they employees, communities, 
consumers, customers, suppliers, 
Shareholders or regulators, while taking 
steps to secure the Group’s longer-term 
success. There has been a continued 
dialogue with all of the main stakeholder 
groups, and on behalf of the Board, I would 
like to take this opportunity to thank them 
all for their partnership during this period. 
Working together has been vital and will 
continue to be so as we seek to deliver our 
sustainability strategy.
Details of the methods we have used to 
engage with stakeholders to understand 
their views can be found on pages 8 to 9. 
A statement on how the Directors have had 
regard to the matters set out in section 172 
of the Companies Act 2006 can be found 
on page 100. 
Key changes since 1 March 2024 
to address issues identified by 
investigation into the inventory 
and balance sheet reconciliations 
and controls by our Finance 
Teams
As described in my opening paragraphs, 
the Board has made a number of 
enhancements to its corporate governance 
and internal controls structure to address 
the issues identified by the investigation 
into the Clonmel inventory issue and related 
accounting adjustments.  We had already 
refreshed the Board, most notably the 
appointment of the new CFO prior to these 
issues being notified to the Audit Committee 
and Board. Since the appointment of the 
new CFO, we have additionally focused on 
re-organising the Group’s finance team, 
significantly uprating its experience and 
technical capabilities. We have performed 
an in-depth balance sheet review and 
have put in place new controls in the two 
areas which gave rise to the most material 
prior year matters thereby providing a high 
degree of confidence that there are no 
material issues as at FY2024 balance sheet 
date. What is also clear is that a significant 
overhaul of the internal audit process and 
risk management and monitoring is required 
to ensure the efficient functioning of the 
Group’s financial reporting framework 
going forward. This review will take place 
quickly after the completion of the 2024 
process. Other actions identified following 
this investigation – many of which are either 
completed or in hand are set out in the 
Audit Committee Report on pages 114 to 
122 below.
Patrick McMahon was CFO during 
the periods to which these prior year 
adjustments relate. Whilst these issues in 
aggregate represent less than 1% of total 
group assets, Patrick has acknowledged 
that the relevant shortcomings occurred at 
a time when he had overall responsibility for 
the Group's finance function. Accordingly, 
he informed the Board that he would step 
down as CEO and as a Director on 6 June 
2024. The Board, with regret, agreed that it 
would be in the best interests of the Group 
for Patrick to do so. It has been agreed 
that he will remain as an employee until the 
end of September to facilitate a smooth 
transition. On behalf of the Board and 
the wider Group, we thank Patrick for his 
contribution and service to C&C over many 
years.
As outlined above, consequent on 
Patrick McMahon leaving the business, 
the Board has appointed me to hold the 
position of Chair and CEO for a period 
of 12 to 18 months. As detailed in the 
Nomination Committee Report, I was 
not part of the discussions relating to 
the final appointment. Recognising that 
combining the roles of Chair and CEO 
is a departure from best-practice, the 
rationale for the decision reflects a number 
of factors including: my experience in the 
role of Executive Chair; my tenure and 
experience in the beverage sector more 
broadly; my existing relationships with 
stakeholders, in particular employees, 
shareholders, customers and suppliers. My 
appointment is temporary and serves to 
ensure continuity of leadership at a time of 
significant change for the business.
Corporate Governance Report
(continued)
96
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

The changes underway in the business 
which require continuity of leadership and 
industry experience include:
•	 Ensuring the continued performance of 
the business in the aftermath of the ERP 
implementation issues of the past year;
•	 Managing the change associated with a 
number of new external appointments 
to key management functions including 
Finance, Marketing, Human Resource 
and Technology;
•	 Changing the reporting structures to 
reflect C&C’s position as a brand and 
distribution businesses rather than 
the historical geographical reporting 
structure; and
•	 Overseeing the changes required to 
address the accounting and financial 
control issues recently identified.
Board Performance
It is very important that the performance 
of the Board, its committees and individual 
Directors is rigorously reviewed. This year, 
an internal Board Performance review was 
conducted in accordance with the UK 
Corporate Governance Code 2018 (‘the 
Code’) and supported by the Company 
Secretary and Group General Counsel. 
The results were encouraging, and I 
am pleased to report that key areas of 
Board strength continue to be its strong 
composition, shared passion, and the open 
and collaborative culture within the Board. 
Leveraging on our strengths, we want 
to ensure that we work as effectively as 
possible. There are five areas of continued 
improvement that will form part of the 
Board’s action plan for FY2025. 
Priority areas for FY2025 are as follows: 
Board oversight of and input into strategy, 
succession planning for Executive Directors, 
Group Executive Committee members 
and senior management, risk and control 
oversight, Board meeting dynamics, and 
understanding of culture and promotion of 
our ‘Speak Up’ reporting programme.
Our progress against last year’s areas of 
focus, as well as the outcome of this year’s 
effectiveness review can be found on pages 
105 to 106.
Looking forward
As a Board, our commitment is to maintain 
the highest standards of Corporate 
Governance across the Group and 
continue to promote and enhance the 
inclusive culture we are building at C&C; 
and a culture which fosters an open 
and transparent environment where any 
concerns may be raised with the confidence 
they will be addressed without retribution. 
We will also focus on the delivery of our 
strategy, financial and operational targets, 
and build on the foundations for growth that 
we have laid down. I would like to thank my 
Board colleagues and the Group Executive 
Committee for their support, as well as for 
their continued leadership as we continue 
to build a business which delivers on the 
interests of all our stakeholders and the 
communities and wider society in which we 
operate.
I encourage all stakeholders to take every 
opportunity presented to engage with 
the Company and I would welcome you 
to attend, and in any case vote at, the 
forthcoming Annual General Meeting on 15 
August 2024.
UK Corporate Governance Code 
2018 
The Corporate Governance Report, which 
incorporates by reference the Nomination 
Committee, Audit Committee, ESG and 
Directors’ Remuneration Committee 
Reports and Sustainability Report, 
describes how the Company has complied 
with the provisions of the Code. Further 
details on the Company’s compliance with 
the Code during FY2024 can be found 
below.
The following pages set out details of the 
composition of our Board, its Corporate 
Governance arrangements, processes and 
activities during the year, and reports from 
each of the Board’s Committees.
Ralph Findlay 
Chair & Chief Executive Officer
97
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Corporate Governance Report
(continued)
Compliance with the UK 
Corporate Governance Code 2018
The Board considers that the Company 
has, throughout the year ended 29 February 
2024 complied with the provisions of the 
UK Corporate Governance Code 2018. 
Subsequent to the end of the year under 
review, the appointment of Ralph Findlay 
as CEO in addition to his role as Chair of 
the Board means that, going forward, the 
Company will not comply with provision 9 
of the Code by virtue of the roles of Chair 
and CEO being exercised by the same 
individual. The Board believes however 
that this is appropriate in the short term in 
order to ensure stability within the senior 
leadership team as a consequence of the 
previous CEO stepping down on 6 June 
2024. It is anticipated that the roles will be 
combined for a period of 12 to 18 months, 
with the search for a long-term successor 
as CEO due to commence in the autumn. 
Following the appointment of a new CEO, 
it is intended that Ralph Findlay will revert 
to being Non-Executive Chair. The rationale 
for the combination or roles is set out above 
and also within the Nomination Committee 
Report on page 98.
Board Leadership and Company 
Purpose
Role of the Board 
The Group is led and controlled by the 
Board of Directors (‘the Board’) and chaired 
by Ralph Findlay. 
The core responsibility of the Board is to 
ensure the Group is appropriately managed 
to achieve its long-term objectives, 
generating value for Shareholders 
and contributing to wider society. The 
Board’s objective is to do this in a way 
that is supported by the right culture and 
behaviours. 
The Board has adopted a formal schedule 
of matters specifically reserved for decision 
by it, thus ensuring that it exercises control 
over appropriate strategic, financial, 
operational and regulatory issues (a copy 
of the Matters Reserved to the Board 
can be found at candcgroupplc.com/
corporate-governance/. Matters not 
specifically reserved for the Board and its 
Committees under its schedule of matters 
and the Committees’ terms of reference, 
or for Shareholders in general meeting, 
are delegated to members of the Group 
Executive Committee.
The balance of skills, background and 
diversity of the Board contributes to the 
effective leadership of the business and 
the development of strategy. The Board’s 
composition is central to ensuring all 
Directors contribute to discussions. As a 
means to foster challenge and Director 
engagement, led by the Senior Independent 
Director, the Non-Executive Directors 
meet without the Chair present at least 
annually. Likewise, the Chair holds meetings 
with the Non-Executive Directors without 
the Executives present. In each of these 
settings, there is a collaborative atmosphere 
that also lends itself to the appropriate level 
of scrutiny, discussion and challenge. 
The Company has procedures whereby 
Directors (including Non-Executive 
Directors) receive a formal induction and 
familiarisation with the Group’s business 
operations and systems on appointment, 
including trips to manufacturing sites with 
in-depth explanations of the processes 
involved at the sites and meetings with 
Executive Committee members and senior 
management.
Our Purpose
To play a role in every drinking occasion, 
delivering joy to our customers and 
consumers with remarkable brands and 
service. Information on our strategy is set 
out on pages 20 to 21.
Our Culture 
C&C has an open, humble, respectful, but 
competitive culture, underpinned by certain 
values and behaviours, namely:
Our Values
•	 We respect people and the planet
•	 We bring joy to life
•	 Quality is at our core
Our Behaviours
•	 We put safety first
•	 We are customer centric
•	 We collaborate through trust
•	 We keep it simple and remain agile
•	 We are fact based, data and insight 
driven
•	 We learn to improve
The Board recognises the importance of 
a strong corporate culture and the role it 
plays in delivering the long-term success 
of the Company. C&C colleagues want to 
work for a company that values them and 
allows them to be themselves and to thrive 
both personally and professionally. The 
Board, Executive Committee and senior 
leadership team, strive to create a positive 
culture at C&C, providing colleagues with 
the opportunity to grow, and develop in an 
inclusive environment. A strong culture also 
ensures that individuals have the confidence 
to speak up where they have concerns in 
the knowledge that those concerns will be 
heard and responded to. To create the right 
culture, it is important that colleagues live 
and breathe C&C’s values, and this starts 
with our leadership team. The Board sets 
the tone from the top to demonstrate and 
promote these values, which are a critical 
element to creating a working environment 
so everyone can thrive. The Board uses a 
variety of mechanisms, cultural indicators 
and reporting lines to monitor the culture, 
listen to colleagues and act on what they 
say. The table below highlights some of 
those indicators.
98
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Cultural Indicators
Health and Safety
Employees
Ethics and Compliance
Customers and Suppliers
Sustainability
•	 Lost time frequency 
rates
•	 Workplace safety 
accident rates
•	 Reporting of injuries, 
diseases and 
dangerous occurrences 
•	 Near miss reporting
•	 Employee ‘town hall’ 
meetings/face-to-face 
meetings
•	 CEO’s quarterly ‘All-
colleagues’ call
•	 Results of ‘Peakon’ employee 
engagement surveys
•	 Employee turnover rates
•	 Gender pay gap disclosures 
•	 Reports on progress on 
diversity, equity, and inclusion
•	 Employee Engagement 
sessions with the designated 
Non-Executive Directors
•	 Internal audit reports 
and findings
•	 Fraud and 
misconduct statistics
•	 Annual confirmation of 
compliance with our 
anti-financial crime 
policies
•	 Whistle blower 
statistics
•	 Compliance with 
supply chain 
standards
•	 Customer retention 
rates
•	 Supplier audits
•	 Brand satisfaction 
ratings
•	 On time in full rates 
•	 Tracking of ESG 
targets in line with 
the Company’s ESG 
strategy
•	 Collaboration with 
Governments, 
NGOs and Industry 
Programmes
•	 Engagement with 
stakeholder groups 
such as suppliers and 
the community 
Engagement with Shareholders
Information on relations with Shareholders 
is provided as part of the Stakeholder 
engagement section of the Strategic Report 
on pages 8 to 9.
In fulfilling their responsibilities, the Directors 
believe that they govern the Group in the 
best interests of Shareholders, whilst 
having due regard to the interests of 
other stakeholders in the Group including 
customers, employees and suppliers. 
In addition to our formal AGM, the Chair 
has regular engagement with major 
Shareholders in order to understand their 
views on governance and performance 
against the strategy. More details can be 
found on page 100. Our Remuneration 
Committee Chair has also engaged with 
major Shareholders in March and May 2024 
in relation to the proposed Remuneration 
Policy. 
The Chair ensures that the Board has 
a clear understanding of the views of 
Shareholders. The Executive Directors 
have regular and ongoing communication 
with major Shareholders throughout 
the year, by participating in investor 
roadshows and presentations to 
Shareholders. Feedback from these visits 
is reported to the Board. The Executive 
Directors also have regular contact with 
the Company’s analysts and corporate 
brokers. The Chair, Senior Independent 
Non-Executive Director as well as other 
Non-Executive Directors, particularly as 
part of their Committee responsibilities, 
receive feedback on matters raised at the 
meetings with Shareholders and are offered 
the opportunity to attend meetings with 
major Shareholders. As a result of these 
procedures, the Non-Executive Directors 
believe that they are aware of Shareholders’ 
views across a range of topics that are 
material to C&C. In addition, Chris Browne, 
the Senior Independent Non-Executive 
Director, and the Committee Chairs are 
available to meet with major Shareholders. 
Arrangements can also be made through 
the Company Secretary and Group General 
Counsel for major Shareholders to meet 
with newly appointed Directors.
The Group maintains a website at www.
candcgroup.com which is regularly updated 
and contains information about the Group. 
Stakeholders
The Code provides that the Board should 
understand the views of the Company’s key 
stakeholders other than Shareholders and 
describe how their interests and the matters 
set out in section 172 of the UK Companies 
Act 2006 (‘s.172’) have been considered in 
Board discussions and decision making.
Whilst s.172 is a provision of UK company 
law, the Board acknowledges that as 
a premium listed issuer, it is important 
to address the spirit intended by these 
provisions. 
99
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Section 172 Statement
A director of a company must act in a way they consider, in good faith, would most likely promote the success of the company for the 
benefit of its members as a whole, taking into account the factors as listed in s. 172. This is not a new requirement, and the Board has 
always considered the impact of its decisions on stakeholders. We set out below some examples of how the Board has done so in relation 
to three decisions during the year. Details of who the Board considers the main stakeholders are, how we have engaged with them during 
the year and the outcomes of the process are set out on page 8 to 9 and forms part of the s.172 statement.
Key decision
Stakeholders
 Board Composition Review
The Board reviewed the Board and Committee composition, in line with their succession plan, to ensure that the 
Board was future fit for long-term sustainable success.  The Board also considered the FTSE for Women Review, 
the Parker Review and FCA Listing Rules on Diversity.  The skills matrix on page 135 confirms the attributes we 
identify as key in the Board’s leadership role.
•	 Shareholders
•	 Employees
•	 Customers
Share Buyback Programme
As part of creating Shareholder value, the Board announced during the year that it would launch a share buyback 
programme. The programme formed part of the Group's plan to return up to €150 million to Shareholders over the 
next three fiscal years as announced in October 2023, through a combination of dividends and share buybacks 
The Programme is underpinned by the Board's confidence in the medium-term outlook for the business and its 
strong cash generation capabilities. 
•	 Employees
•	 Shareholders
Payment of Dividend
The Board reinstated the payment of dividends last year and paid an interim dividend of 1.89 cents in December 
2023 and is proposing to pay a final dividend of 3.97 cents subject to Shareholder approval at the AGM on 15 
August 2024.  
•	 Employees
•	 Customers
•	 Suppliers
•	 Shareholders
Governance Framework
Corporate Governance Report
(continued)
C&C Group plc Board of Directors
Board Committees
Nomination Committee
(see pages 127 to 135)
Audit Committee
(see pages 114 to 122)
Remuneration Committee
(see pages 136 to 163)
ESG Committee
(see pages 123 to 126)
Group Executive Committee
Management Committees
Health and Safety
Committee
IS&T 
Committee
Risk and Compliance  
Climate Change
Committee
Operations 
Committee
Commercial
Committee
ESG 
Committee
100
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Division of Responsibilities
It is the Company’s policy that the roles of the Chair and CEO are separate, with their roles and responsibilities clearly defined and set 
out in writing.  As described above, in June 2024, the Chair became the CEO. Upon the appointment of a new CEO, the Chair will revert 
to a Non-Executive Chair role. The functions and duties of the Senior Independent Director are also set out in a separate statement and 
available on our website at candcgroupplc.com/corporate-governance.
Chair
The Chair, Ralph Findlay is responsible for the leadership of the Board and ensuring effectiveness in all aspects of its role. The Chair 
is responsible for ensuring, through the Company Secretary and Group General Counsel that Directors receive accurate, timely and 
clear information. He is responsible for setting the Board’s agenda and ensuring adequate time is available for Board discussion and 
to enable informed decision making. He is responsible for promoting a culture of openness and debate by encouraging and facilitating 
the effective contribution of all Non-Executive Directors and constructive relations between Executive and Non-Executive Directors. The 
Chair ensures high standards of Corporate Governance and ethical behaviour and oversees the culture of the Group. 
Senior Independent Director
Chris Browne, Senior Independent Non-Executive Director. In addition to her role and responsibilities as an Independent Non-Executive 
Director, Employee Engagement Non-Executive Director and Nomination Committee Chair from 7 June 2024, the Senior Independent 
Director is available to Shareholders where concerns have not been resolved through the normal channels of communication and for 
when such contact would be inappropriate. Chris acts as a sounding board for the Chair and acts as an intermediary for the Directors 
when necessary. She is responsible for annually evaluating the performance of the Chair in consultation with the other Non-Executive 
Directors. 
Non-Executive Directors
Vineet Bhalla, Angela Bromfield, Chris Browne, Jill Caseberry, Vincent Crowley, John Gibney and Sarah Newbitt; the Non-Executive 
Directors provide an external perspective, sound judgement and objectivity to the Board’s deliberations and decision making. With their 
diverse range of skills and expertise, they support and constructively challenge the Executive Directors and monitor and scrutinise the 
Group’s performance against agreed goals and objectives. The Non-Executive Directors together with the Chair meet regularly without 
any Executive Directors being present. The Non-Executive Directors provide a conduit from the workforce to the Board for workforce 
engagement and have sufficient time to meet their board responsibilities.
Chief Executive Officer (CEO)
Ralph Findlay, Chief Executive Officer is responsible for the leadership and day-to-day management of the Group. This includes 
formulating and recommending the Group’s strategy for Board approval in addition to executing the approved strategy. As outlined 
above, the roles of Chair and CEO will be held by Ralph Findlay on a temporary basis for the next 12 to 18 months.
Chief Financial Officer (CFO)
Andrew Andrea, Chief Financial Officer, is responsible for the management of the day-to-day operations of the Group, in accordance 
with authority delegated by the Board and together with the Chief Executive Officer, leads the relationship with institutional 
Shareholders.
Company Secretary
Mark Chilton, Company Secretary, supports the Chair, Chief Executive Officer and the Board Committee Chairs in setting Agendas for 
meetings of the Board and its Committees. He is available to all Directors for advice and support. He is responsible for information flows 
to and from the Board and the Board Committees and between Directors and senior management. In addition, he supports the Chair 
in respect of training and the Board and Committee performance reviews. He also advises the Board on regulatory compliance and 
Corporate Governance matters. 
Board Committees
The Board has established a Nomination Committee, Audit Committee, ESG Committee and Remuneration Committee to oversee 
and debate relevant issues and policies outside main Board meetings. Throughout the year, the Chair of each Committee provided 
the Board with a summary of key issues considered at the Committee meetings. Board Committees are authorised to make enquiries 
of the Executive Directors and senior management across the Group as they feel appropriate and to engage the services of external 
advisers as they deem necessary in the furtherance of their duties at the Company’s expense. 
101
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Employee Engagement
During the year the Board assessed our 
current Employee Engagement mechanism 
whereby each Non-Executive Director was 
appointed to a business unit, to understand 
employee’s views and provide feedback 
to the Board. Having undertaken a review 
to assess if this method was effective, 
the Board felt that this process could 
be improved by reducing the number of 
Employee Engagement Non-Executive 
Directors from seven to two designated 
Employee Engagement Non-Executive 
Directors. The Nomination Committee 
approved the appointment of the two newly 
appointed Non-Executive Directors, Chris 
Browne and Sarah Newbitt, as designated 
Employee Engagement Non-Executive 
Directors, given their people skills and 
that they were new to the Board. The 
Board also adopted Terms of Reference 
for the role, and these can be found that 
on our website at candcgroupplc.com/
corporate-governance/terms-of-reference. 
Employee Engagement is now a standing 
item on the Board Agenda, and we have 
a programme of listening sessions for the 
full year, with an action plan detailing what 
our colleagues are telling us to ensure the 
Board are considering this feedback in their 
decision making. We also as part of our 
Board Induction Programme and Non-
Executive Director site visits, have taken the 
opportunity to follow these with informal 
listening sessions, to allow deeper dialogue 
on matters of importance to our employees. 
The Board will continue to enhance 
and improve the process and keep the 
effectiveness of this approach under review.
During the year the Employee Engagement 
Non-Executive Directors visited Wellpark 
Brewery and Cambuslang Depot in 
Glasgow and the Depot in Belfast. They also 
attended one of our DE&I advisory group 
sessions and one of the CEO’s quarterly ‘All 
Colleague’ sessions. These are an essential 
part of our Governance, and it allows the 
Directors to better understand the business, 
engage with local management and, more 
importantly, hear directly from employees.
These quarterly ‘All Colleague’ sessions 
are hosted by the CEO and Executive 
Committee members and provide a short 
business update, with the key focus being 
Directors are invited to attend all Board 
Committee meetings, irrespective of 
whether they are a committee member. This 
is subject only to recusal regarding matters 
concerning the individual(s) or any conflicts 
of interests. 
All Directors holding office at the time 
attended the 2023 AGM. 
Director
Number of 
Scheduled 
Board 
Meetings 
Attended
Number of 
Unscheduled 
Board 
Meetings 
Attended
Executive 
Ralph Findlay
8/8
1/1
Patrick McMahon
8/8
1/1
Non-Executive
Vineet Bhalla
8/8
1/1
Angela Bromfield 1
5/5
1/1
Chris Browne 2
2/3
1/1
Jill Caseberry
8/8
1/1
Vincent Crowley
8/8
1/1
John Gibney 
8/8
1/1
Sarah Newbitt 3
3/3
1/1
David Forde 4
2/3
-
Helen Pitcher 5
4/4
-
Jim Thompson 6
4/4
-
1.	 Meetings attended by Angela Bromfield from the 
date of her appointment on 13 July 2023. 
2.	 Meetings attended by Chris Browne from the date 
of her appointment on 2 October 2023. Due to 
other commitments that we were aware of prior to 
Chris’s appointment she was unable to attend the 
December Board meeting, however, was provided 
with an update from the Chair.
3.   Meetings attended by Sarah Newbitt from the date of 
her appointment on 31 August 2023. 
4.	 Meetings attended by David Forde until the date of 
his stepping down from the Board on 18 May 2023.
5.	 Meetings attended by Helen Pitcher until the date of 
her stepping down from the Board on 13 July 2023.
6.	 Meetings attended by Jim Thompson until the date 
of his stepping down from the Board on 13 July 
2023.
Board activity during FY2024
Each Board meeting follows a carefully 
tailored agenda agreed in advance by the 
Chair, CEO and Company Secretary. A 
typical meeting will comprise reports on 
current trading and financial performance 
from the CEO and CFO, investor relations 
updates, monitoring strategy, examining 
investment and acquisition opportunities 
and presentations/reports on specific 
subject areas. A summary of the key 
activities covered during FY2024 is set 
overleaf.
Corporate Governance Report
(continued)
to answer any questions that colleagues 
have about C&C. These meetings build 
on existing employee engagement 
opportunities and the Group’s continuing 
efforts to develop a culture of informality, 
transparency and trust. The aim is to 
provide a further opportunity to increase 
two-way dialogue between the Company 
and all colleagues. They also allow our 
Non-Executive Directors to hear directly 
from colleagues and then feed back to the 
Board. 
Post the year-end audit and internal control 
issues identified, we are also engaged 
in a campaign to refresh and re-enforce 
our healthy workplace ‘speak up’ culture 
to ensure that any of our employees who 
have concerns are comfortable to raise 
those through the appropriate channels 
and that those concerns will be actioned 
appropriately and confidentially.
Board Meetings in FY2024
The Directors’ attendance at Board 
meetings during the year ended 29 
February 2024 is shown in the table below. 
The core activities of the Board and its 
Committees are covered in scheduled 
meetings held during the year. Additional 
unscheduled meetings are also held to 
consider and decide matters outside 
scheduled meetings. 
Board and Committee members are 
expected to attend each scheduled 
meeting, and, wherever possible, any 
unscheduled meetings. If a Director 
is unable to attend a meeting due to 
exceptional circumstances, or pre-existing 
commitments, they are encouraged to 
provide comments and observations on 
the relevant Board and Committee papers, 
to the Chair of the Board or Committee 
so that they may be shared with Directors 
at the meeting. The Board aims to hold at 
least two meetings in different operating 
locations each year. When visiting operating 
locations, Directors can meet with a 
diverse group of senior business leaders 
and colleagues, which allows them to gain 
further insight into how the business works 
and the opportunity to listen to colleagues’ 
views and ask questions. 
102
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Safety 
•	 Safety is a standing item on every Board 
Agenda.
•	 Received and discussed six monthly 
safety performance reports and updates 
presented by the Group Health and 
Safety Manager.
Internal Control and Risk Management 
•	 Reviewed the Group’s risk management 
framework and principal risks and 
uncertainties and emerging risks;
•	 Reviewed and confirmed the Group’s 
Viability Statement and going concern 
status;
•	 Reviewed and evaluated the effectiveness 
of the Group’s systems of internal controls 
and risk management and recommended 
additional actions to be taken; and
•	 Reviewed updates on the information and 
cyber security control environment.
Governance and Legal
•	 Reviewed regular briefings on Corporate 
Governance developments and legal and 
regulatory issues;
•	 Approved the Group’s Modern Slavery 
Statement for publication;
•	 Received reports on engagement with 
institutional Shareholders, investors and 
other stakeholders throughout the year;
•	 Reviewed progress against the 2023 
external Board Performance Review 
action plan;
•	 Conducted an internal Board 
Performance review, with the outcome 
discussed by the Board; 
•	 Approved the Board Diversity Policy; 
•	 Received and reviewed whistleblowing 
reports and activities; 
•	 Received and discussed six monthly 
reports and updates presented by the 
Group Data Protection Officer;
•	 Received updates from the Chairs of the 
Audit, Nomination, Remuneration and 
ESG Committees; 
•	 Reviewed the Remuneration and ESG 
Committees Terms of Reference; and
•	 Implemented Terms of Reference for the 
role of Employee Engagement Non-
Executive Director.
Objectives and Controls
The Group’s strategic objectives are set 
out on pages 20 to 21 and a summary of 
performance against the Group’s KPIs is 
at pages 30 to 31. The Board also receives 
regular updates across a broad range of 
internal KPIs and performance metrics. 
The Group has a clear risk management 
framework in place, as set out on pages 
32 to 41, to manage the key risks to the 
Group’s business.
Business Model and Risks
The Group’s Business model is set out on 
pages 22 to 24. The Risk Management 
Report on pages 32 to 40 contains an 
overview of the principal risks facing the 
Group and a description of how they are 
managed.
Whistleblowing
All employees have access to a confidential 
whistleblowing service which provides an 
effective channel to raise concerns. The 
Audit Committee and the Board receives 
updates detailing all notifications and 
subsequent action taken. You can read 
more about this on page 86.
Post the year-end audit and internal control 
issues identified, we are also engaged in 
a campaign to refresh and re-enforce a 
healthy workplace ‘speak up’ culture to 
ensure that any of our employees who 
have concerns are comfortable to raise 
those through the appropriate channels 
and that those concerns will be actioned 
appropriately and confidentially.
Composition, Succession and 
Evaluation
As at 29 February 2024, the Board 
consisted of an Executive Chair, one 
Executive Director and seven independent 
Non-Executive Directors. As at 27 June 
2024, the date of this Report, following 
Patrick McMahon stepping down as CEO 
and the appointment of Ralph Findlay as 
CEO in addition to his role as Chair, the 
Board consists of two Executive Directors 
and seven independent Non-Executive 
Directors. Upon the appointment of a new 
Chief Executive Officer in due course, Ralph 
Findlay will revert to a Non-Executive Chair 
role.
Strategy, Operations and Finance
•	 Approved the Group’s Viability Statement;
•	 Received presentations from 
management on brand marketing plans;
•	 Received presentations from the CEO 
and CFO and senior management 
on strategic initiatives and trading 
performance;
•	 Approved the annual budget plan and 
KPIs;
•	 Reviewed and approved the Group’s full 
year FY2023 and half year FY2024 results 
as well as trading updates;
•	 Approved the Group’s FY2024 Annual 
Report (including a fair, balanced and 
understandable assessment) and 2024 
AGM Notice;
•	 Received and reviewed updates from 
senior management on the Group’s 
sustainability strategy including ESG 
frameworks, climate change risks and 
TCFD reporting;
•	 Received and discussed presentations 
from the GB Head of Logistics and the 
Manufacturing Director; 
•	 Received Investor relations updates; and
•	 Received updates from the Technology 
and Transformation Director on the 
Company’s ERP system in our MCB 
business. 
People and Culture
•	 Review of succession planning;
•	 Continued focus on the composition, 
balance and performance of the Board, 
including the appointment of a Chair of 
the Remuneration Committee, Senior 
Independent Director, CEO, CFO and 
three Non-Executive Directors;
•	 Reviewed our workforce engagement 
method and as a result of revising our 
approach, appointed two designated 
Employee Engagement Non-Executive 
Directors;
•	 Reviewed and discussed six monthly 
“Peakon” employee satisfaction survey 
results and monitored culture throughout 
the Group;
•	 Considered progress towards greater 
diversity in the workforce;
•	 Received reports on engagements with 
colleagues; and
•	 Received and discussed a presentation 
on the Group Remuneration policy and 
reward strategy.
103
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Over half of the Board comprises 
independent Non-Executive Directors and 
the composition of all Board Committees 
complies with the Code, while also 
including longer serving and more recently 
appointed Directors. Additionally, the 
Chair was considered independent on 
his appointment. Details of the skills and 
experience of the Directors are contained in 
the Directors’ biographies on pages 92 to 
93 and also on page 127 of the Nomination 
Committee Report.
The independence of Non-Executive 
Directors is considered by the Board and 
reviewed at least annually, based on the 
criteria suggested in the Code. Non-
Executive Directors do not participate in any 
of the Company’s share option or bonus 
schemes.
Following this year’s review, the Board 
concluded that all the Non-Executive 
Directors continue to remain independent in 
character and judgement and are free from 
any business or other relationship that could 
materially interfere with the exercise of their 
independent judgement in accordance with 
the Code. 
Appointments to the Board
Recommendations for appointments to 
the Board are made by the Nomination 
Committee. In accordance with the Matters 
Reserved to the Board and the Nomination 
Committee Terms of Reference, which 
provide a framework for the different 
types of Board appointments on which 
the Committee may be expected to make 
recommendations. Appointments are made 
on merit and against objective criteria with 
due regard to diversity (including skills, 
knowledge, experience and gender). 
All Board appointments are subject to 
continued satisfactory performance 
followings the Board’s annual performance 
review. The Nomination Committee, chaired 
by Chris Browne from 7 June 2024, leads 
the process for Board appointments and 
makes recommendations to the Board. 
The activities of the Nomination Committee 
and a description of the Board’s policy on 
diversity are on pages 127 to 135.
Time Commitment and external 
appointments
Following the Board Performance Review 
process, detailed further on pages 105 
to 106, the Board has considered the 
individual Directors attendance, their 
contribution and their external appointments 
and is satisfied that each of the Directors 
is able to allocate sufficient time to the 
Group to discharge their responsibilities 
effectively.  As evidenced by the attendance 
table earlier in the report, the attendance 
remained high and demonstrates the 
Directors’ ability to devote sufficient time.
In line with the Code, Directors are required 
to seek Board approval prior to taking 
on any additional significant external 
appointments and explain the reason for 
permitting these appointments.  Prior to 
these appointments, the Board considers 
the time required, including whether it would 
impact their ability to devote sufficient time 
to their current role. 
Development 
On appointment, a comprehensive tailored 
Board induction programme is arranged 
for each new Director. The aim of the 
programme is to provide the Director 
with a detailed insight into the Group. 
The programme involves meetings with 
the Chair, Chief Executive Officer, Chief 
Financial Officer, Company Secretary, 
Group Executive Committee members, key 
senior management, legal advisors, and 
brokers. It covers areas such as:
•	 the business of the Group;
•	 their legal and regulatory responsibilities 
as Directors of the Company;
•	 briefings and presentations from 
Executive Directors and other senior 
management; and
•	 opportunities to visit business operations.
To update the Directors’ skills, knowledge 
and familiarity with the Group and its 
stakeholders, visits to Group business 
locations are organised for the Board 
periodically, as well as trade visits with 
members of senior management to assist 
Directors’ understanding of the operational 
issues that the business faces. Non-
Executive Directors are also encouraged to 
visit Group operations throughout their tenure 
to increase their exposure to the business. 
Directors are continually updated on the 
Group’s businesses, the markets in which 
they operate and changes to the competitive 
and regulatory environment through briefings 
to the Board and meetings with senior 
management.
Training opportunities are provided through 
internal meetings, presentations and briefings 
by internal advisers and business heads, as 
well as external advisers.  During the year 
the Board completed ESG training, and 
more details can be found on page 82 of the 
Sustainability Report.
Information and Support
All members of the Board are supplied with 
appropriate, clear and accurate information in 
a timely manner covering matters which are 
to be considered at forthcoming Board and 
Committee meetings.
Should Directors judge it necessary to 
seek independent legal advice about the 
performance of their duties with the Group, 
they are entitled to do so at the Group’s 
expense. Directors also have access to 
the advice and services of the Company 
Secretary, who is responsible for advising 
the Board on all governance matters and 
ensuring that Board procedures are followed.
The appointment and removal of the 
Company Secretary is a matter requiring 
Board approval.
Re-election of Directors 
All Directors are required by the Company’s 
Articles of Association to submit themselves 
to Shareholders for election at the first Annual 
General Meeting after their appointment and 
thereafter for re-election by rotation at least 
once every three years. In accordance with 
the Code, all Directors will, however, stand for 
re-election annually.
Corporate Governance Report
(continued)
104
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Key areas of focus identified in FY2023 and progress achieved in FY2024
Area of Focus 
Detailed Feedback
Progress
Culture 
The evaluation found a strong desire from the Board 
to develop a deeper understanding of organisational 
culture. As part of this focus Directors are eager to 
develop employee engagement and greater oversight of 
reward practices throughout the organisation. 
Progress was being made by the Board in better 
understanding how far desired cultures and values 
were embedded in the Group, as evidenced by Non-
Executive Director engagement. The review of our 
employee engagement mechanism and subsequent 
appointment of two designated Employee Engagement 
NEDs holding employee listening sessions with a range 
of employees and the CEO’s quarterly ‘All Colleague’ 
sessions have provided invaluable insight into the 
evolution of our culture and values and their link to 
strategy. Subsequent to year-end we are engaged in 
campaign to refresh and re-enforce a healthy workplace 
‘Speak Up’ culture to ensure that any of our employees 
who have concerns are comfortable to raise those 
through the appropriate channels and that those 
concerns will be actioned appropriately.
Board logistics 
and information
In light of the challenges of remote Board meetings, 
Directors communicated that there may need to be 
refinement to Board agendas, including ensuring there 
is a balance struck between insight and excessive 
detail. 
The Board is focused on evolving ways of working to 
ensure Board time is used in a way that is strategic, 
appropriate and effective. The agenda has moved to a 
more focused, specific and strategic footing to reflect 
this way of working. 
Risk Picture 
The Directors voiced satisfaction with the strength 
of work done on developing and communicating the 
updated risk framework in recent years. Feedback 
indicated that this risk picture needs to be further 
developed, particularly in relation to emerging non-
financial risks and wider economic developments.
The annual board and the audit committee meeting 
agendas have included a series of updates from 
executive risk owners in relation to both the Group’s 
principal risks and emerging risks having regard to the 
fact that the Group operates in a dynamic environment 
where risks continue to evolve, and the Group continues 
to develop mitigation measures to address them.
Board Performance Review
FY2024 Board and Committee 
performance review
Each year, the Board undertakes a rigorous 
review of its own effectiveness and 
performance, and that of its committees 
and individual Directors. At least every three 
years, the evaluation is externally facilitated. 
In FY2024, an internal performance review 
was undertaken by the Company Secretary 
and General Counsel.
The Board Performance Review was 
conducted according to the guidance 
provided in the Code. It was a 
comprehensive review of all aspects of the 
Board’s effectiveness. 
The Board considered the results of the 
performance review and has separately 
assessed the independence and time 
commitment of each Director. It concluded 
that each Director’s performance 
continues to be effective and that they 
demonstrate commitment to their roles. 
These findings are fully considered when 
making recommendations in respect of their 
election or re-election to the Board.
Board Performance Review Process
In February 2024, the Board members, the 
Company Secretary, the Deputy Company 
Secretary, our remuneration advisors and 
the senior management that participate in 
Board and Committee meetings completed 
an internal online questionnaire. 
The findings of the evaluation were 
discussed with the Chair and the Company 
Secretary and finalised into a report. 
The Company Secretary presented 
the findings of the Board Performance 
Review at the May 2024 Board meeting, 
discussed the outcomes and answered 
Directors’ questions. A report on the 
Chair’s performance was presented to 
the Senior Independent Director and the 
results discussed at a meeting of the 
Non-Executive Directors without the Chair 
present. The Chair received feedback on 
individual Directors’ performance, which 
was followed by one-to-one meetings 
between the Chair and each individual 
Director to discuss the findings. Feedback 
on each Committee was presented to each 
Committee Chair and was discussed at the 
relevant Committee meeting.
The Board considered the findings of 
the Board Performance Review and 
agreed on the priority areas noting that 
the action plans would be built into the 
Board’s objectives, meeting agendas and 
engagement activities for FY2025, and 
progress against these will be monitored 
and reported in the FY2025 Annual Report.
105
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Corporate Governance Report
(continued)
FY2024 Internal Board Performance Review Board observations
Based on the review the Board concluded that it has a number of important strengths including good cohesion as a Board, an appropriate 
balance of experience, skills and knowledge, and Board meetings operating in a spirit of openness and collaboration, fostered by the Chair.
The Board, and the Chair and CEO in particular are committed in retaining this dynamic and cohesive environment, particularly in light of 
the recent changes to the Board.
FY2025 key areas of focus 
Area of Focus 
Detailed Feedback
Strategy 
The evaluation found enthusiasm for having greater Board input into the strategy development process, as well as 
more focus on monitoring of strategic progress. Directors are keen to spend more time on assessing the resilience 
of the business model, the role of technology in driving the strategy, and the strategic risks and opportunities that 
may come from big market shifts. 
 
Succession 
Planning
Participants in the evaluation communicated a need to continue to make progress on Group Executive Committee 
and management succession and development planning, including by giving the Board greater exposure 
to potential successors, and having regular sessions on talent management at the Board and Nomination 
Committee. 
Risk and 
Control 
Feedback indicated that Board oversight of risk could be enhanced, particularly in relation to major projects, crisis 
preparation and ESG risks. Directors are pleased to see progress on cyber and health and safety risk and would 
like to see further progress on legacy control issues in the finance area. In addition, the Board will oversee the 
actions outlined in the Audit Committee Report as part of the steps taken and being taken to address the issues 
that have given rise to the need to make the prior year adjustments reflected in the Group's financial statements.
Dynamics and 
Meetings
The evaluation suggested the Board could be enabled to provide more value in meetings through a variety of 
mechanisms including increasing time allocated for discussion, more timely information, and changes to the 
structure of agendas.
People and 
Culture
There is a desire to increase the focus on people, particularly regarding the skills that will be needed to underpin 
the strategy, and in terms of fair reward for management. Additionally, feedback suggests board oversight of 
culture has improved but the area needs further development.
Audit, Risk and Internal Control
Financial and Business Reporting 
The Strategic Report on pages 2 to 89 
explains the Group’s business model and 
the strategy for delivering the objectives 
of the Group. 
A Statement on Directors’ Responsibilities 
on the Annual Report can be found on page 
164, a Statement on the Accounts being 
fair, balanced and understandable can be 
found on page 119 and a statement on the 
Group as a going concern and the Viability 
Statement are set out on pages 40 to 41. 
Risk Management
Please refer to pages 32 to 41 for 
information on the risk management 
process and the Group’s principal risks and 
uncertainties. 
Internal Control
Details on the Group’s internal control 
systems are set out on pages 119 to 120.
Internal Audit
Details of the Internal Audit function are 
provided within the Audit Committee report 
on page 120.
Audit Committee and Auditors
For further information on the Group’s 
compliance with the Code and provisions 
relating to the Audit Committee and 
auditors, please refer to the Audit 
Committee Report on pages 114 to 122.
106
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Remuneration
For further information on the Group’s compliance with the Code provisions relating to remuneration, please refer to the Directors’ 
Remuneration Committee Report on pages 136 to 163 for the level and components of remuneration. Shareholders approved the Group’s 
current Remuneration Policy at the 2021 AGM. The Policy is designed to promote the long-term success of the Group. 
The following is a table of reference that provides an overview of where to find disclosures relating to the sections of the Code:
Section
Disclosure Locations
Board Leadership 
and Purpose
Details on how the Board promotes the long-term success of the Company are set out in our Strategic Report 
on pages 2 to 89 and throughout this Corporate Governance Report on pages 94 to 107. Our purpose and 
values are set out on page 6. Relations with Shareholders are described on page 8. Our whistleblowing 
programme is described on page 86.
Division of 
Responsibilities 
Pages 92 to 93 gives details of the Board and Management Team. The Board governance framework is 
detailed on pages 94 to 107.
Composition, 
Succession and 
Evaluation
Details on appointments and our approach to succession are set out in the Nomination Committee Report on 
pages 127 to 135. Details on evaluation are set out on pages 105 to 106.
Audit, Risk and 
Internal Control
The Audit Committee Report can be found on pages 114 to 122, with further detail on the principal risks to the 
business on pages 32 to 41. 
Remuneration 
The Company’s Remuneration Policy and the Directors’ Remuneration Committee Report can be found on 
pages 136 to 163.
Annual General Meeting
The AGM provides a valuable opportunity 
for the Board to engage with our 
Shareholders and listen to their feedback. 
In 2023, Shareholders were invited to join 
the AGM in person, to listen, vote and 
ask questions. Shareholders were also 
provided with an opportunity to submit 
their questions about the business or any 
matter pertaining to the AGM, in advance 
of the meeting. All Directors attended the 
AGM, together with the external auditor. All 
resolutions at the 2023 AGM were voted 
on a poll. Shareholders who were unable 
to attend the meeting, were asked to 
register their vote in advance of the AGM by 
appointing the Chair of the AGM as proxy 
and providing their voting instructions. All 
resolutions were passed with over 92% cast 
in favour.
In compliance with the Code, at the 
Annual General Meeting, the voting results 
will be announced to the London Stock 
Exchange and placed on the Group’s 
website following the meeting.  A separate 
resolution will be proposed at the Annual 
General Meeting in respect of each 
substantially separate issue. 
This report was approved by the Board of 
Directors on 27 June 2024.
Mark Chilton
Company Secretary
107
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Directors’ Report
The Directors present the Annual Report and audited Consolidated Financial Statements of the Group for the financial year ended 29 
February 2024. 
Principal Activities
The Group’s principal trading activity is the manufacturing, marketing and distribution of branded beer, cider, wine, spirits and soft drinks.
Non-Financial Reporting Statement
In compliance with the European Union (Disclosure of Non-Financial and Diversity Information by certain large undertakings and groups) 
Regulations 2017, the table below is designed to help stakeholders navigate to the relevant sections in this Annual Report to understand 
the Group’s approach to these non-financial matters:
Reporting Requirements
Our Policies
Section in Annual Report or
Page References
Risks
Environmental 
matters
Environmental Sustainability
Sustainability Report
Sustainability and Climate Change is one of our 
principal risks. Please refer to page 35 for more 
details.
Social and 
Employee matters
Diversity, Equity and Inclusion 
Health and Safety 
Speak Up
Conflicts of Interest
Sustainability Report
For employee matters, retention and recruitment of 
employees is one of our principal risks. Please refer 
to page 36, the ESG Board Committee Report on 
pages 123 to 126 and the Nomination Committee 
Report on pages 127 to 135 for more details. 
Human Rights
Modern Slavery Statement
Sustainability Report
Although the risks associated with human rights 
abuses are actively monitored, the Group does not 
believe these risks meet the threshold of a principal 
risk for our business.
Anti-Bribery and 
Corruption
Code of Conduct 
Compliance 
Anti-Bribery 
Sustainability Report
Although the risks associated with bribery and 
corruption are actively monitored, the Group does 
not believe these risks meet the threshold of a 
principal risk for our business. 
Description of the 
business model
Please refer to pages 
22 to 24
Non-Financial 
key performance 
indicators
Please refer to  
page 31
 
Results and Dividends
The Group’s results and performance highlights for the year are set out on pages 14 to 19 of the Annual Report. An interim dividend of 
1.89 cents per Ordinary Share was paid to Shareholders in December 2023. Subject to approval at the 2024 Annual General Meeting, 
the Directors propose to pay a final ordinary dividend of 3.97 cents per Ordinary Share for the financial year ended 29 February 2024 to 
Shareholders on the Register of Members at close of business on 19 July 2024. 
108
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Board of Directors
The names, functions and date of appointment of the Directors as at the date of this Report are as follows:
Director
Function
Appointment
Ralph Findlay
Chair & Chief Executive Officer
2024
Executive Chair
2023
Independent Non-Executive Chair
2022
Independent Non-Executive Director
2022
Andrew Andrea
Chief Financial Officer 
2024
Vineet Bhalla
Independent Non-Executive Director
2021
Jill Caseberry
Independent Non-Executive Director
2019
Vincent Crowley
Independent Non-Executive Director
2016
John Gibney
Independent Non-Executive Director
2022
Angela Bromfield 
Independent Non-Executive Director
2023
Chris Browne OBE
Independent Non-Executive Director – Employee Engagement
Senior Independent Director
2023
2024
Sarah Newbitt
Independent Non-Executive Director – Employee Engagement
2023
Research and Development
Certain Group undertakings are engaged in ongoing research and development aimed at improving processes and expanding product 
ranges.
Listing Arrangements
In order to facilitate entry into the FTSE UK Index Series, the Group cancelled the listing and trading of C&C shares on Euronext Dublin with 
effect from 8 October 2019. The Group is listed on the premium segment of The London Stock Exchange and was included in the FTSE All-
Share Index and the FTSE 250 indices in December 2019.
The Group remains domiciled and tax resident in Ireland, with its registered and corporate head office located in Dublin. The Group also 
retains a significant manufacturing, commercial and brand presence in Ireland.
Share Price
The price of the Company’s Ordinary Shares as quoted on the London Stock Exchange at the close of business on 29 February 2024 was 
£1.43 (28 February 2023: £1.49). The price of the Company’s Ordinary Shares ranged between £1.23 and £1.59 during the year. 
Further Information on the Group
The information required by section 327 of the Companies Act 2014 to be included in this report with respect to:
1.	
The review of the development and performance of the business and future developments is set out in the CEO’s Review on pages 10 
to 13 and the Strategic Report on pages 2 to 89.
2.	
The principal risks and uncertainties which the Company and the Group face are set out in the Strategic Report on pages 32 to 41.
3.	 The key performance indicators relevant to the business of the Group, including environmental and employee matters, are set out in the 
Strategic Report on pages 30 to 31 and in the CFO’s Review on pages 53 to 58; and further information in respect of environmental and 
employee matters is set out in the Sustainability Report on pages 59 to 89.
4.	 The financial risk management objectives and policies of the Company and the Group, including the exposure of the Company and the 
Group to financial risk, are set out in the CFO’s Review on pages 53 to 58 and note 24 to the financial statements.
The Group’s Viability Statement is contained in the Strategic Report on page 41.
Corporate Governance
In accordance with the Companies Act 2014, the Corporate Governance statement of the Company for the financial year ended 29 February 
2024, including the main features of the internal control and risk management systems of the Group, is contained in the Strategic Report and 
the Corporate Governance Report on pages 94 to 107. 
109
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Substantial Interests
At 29 February 2024, the following percentage interests in the Ordinary Share capital of the Company, had been notified under Rule 5 of 
the Disclosure Guidance and Transparency Rules, (‘DTR 5’). The Company is not aware of any changes in the interests disclosed under 
DTR 5 between 29 February 2024 and 20 June 2024.
No. of Ordinary 
Shares held as 
notified at  
29 February 2024
% at  
29 February 2024
No. of Ordinary 
Shares held as 
notified at  
20 June 2024
% at 
20 June 2024
Artemis Investment Management LLP
54,579,724
13.86%
54,579,724
13.86% 
FIL Limited
38,182,496
9.72%
38,188,301 
 9.82%
Brandes Investment Partners, L.P.
31,580,195
8.02%
34,975,218
9.03%
Magallanes Value Investors SA SGIIC
 12,271,597
3.12%
20,116,718
5.11%
Aberforth Partners LLP
19,739,135
5.02%
 19,739,135
5.02%
BlackRock, Inc.
14,405,937
3.66%
14,405,937
3.66%
Utah State Retirement Systems
12,231,013
3.11%
12,231,013
3.11%
Silchester International Investors LLP
12,341,061
3.96%
12,341,061
3.96%
Setanta Asset Management Limited
11,904,120
3.16%
11,904,120
3.16%
 Issue of Shares and Purchase of 
Own Shares
At the Annual General Meeting held on 7 
July 2023, the Directors received a general 
authority to allot shares. A limited authority 
was also granted to Directors to allot shares 
for cash otherwise than in accordance with 
statutory pre-emption rights. Resolutions 
will be proposed at the 2024 Annual General 
Meeting to allot shares to a nominal amount 
which is equal to approximately one-third 
of the issued Ordinary Share capital of 
the Company. In addition, resolutions will 
also be proposed to allow the Directors 
to allot shares for cash otherwise than in 
accordance with statutory pre-emption 
rights up to an aggregate nominal value 
which is equal to approximately 5% of the 
nominal value of the issued share capital of 
the Company and, in the event of a rights 
issue, and a further 5% of the nominal value 
of the issued share capital of the Company 
for the purposes of an acquisition or a 
specified capital investment. If granted, 
these authorities will expire at the conclusion 
of the Annual General Meeting in 2025 and 
the date 18 months after the passing of the 
resolution, whichever is earlier.
At the Annual General Meeting held on 
7 July 2023 authority was granted to 
purchase up to 10% of the Company’s 
Ordinary Shares (the “Repurchase 
Authority”). The Group has commenced 
its previously announced share buyback 
programme and from 1 March 2024 to 
21 June 2024 has purchased 7,653,323 
shares in the open market at an average 
price of 190.16 cent per share, with the total 
buyback therefore amounting to €14.6m.
Special resolutions will be proposed at the 
2024 Annual General Meeting to renew 
the authority of the Company, or any of its 
subsidiaries, to purchase up to 10% of the 
Company’s Ordinary Shares in issue at the 
date of the Annual General Meeting and 
in relation to the maximum and minimum 
prices at which treasury shares (effectively 
shares purchased and not cancelled) may 
be re-issued off-market by the Company. 
If granted, the authorities will expire on the 
earlier of the date of the Annual General 
Meeting in 2025 and the date 18 months 
after the passing of the resolution. The 
minimum price which may be paid for 
shares purchased by the Company shall not 
be less than the nominal value of the shares 
and the maximum price will be 105% of the 
average market price of such shares over 
the preceding five days. The Directors will 
only exercise the power to purchase shares 
if they consider it to be in the best interests 
of the Company and its Shareholders.
As at 20 June 2024, being the latest 
practicable date, options to subscribe 
for a total of 3,839,893 Ordinary Shares 
(excluding Recruitment and Retention 
Awards) are outstanding, representing 
0.97% of the Company’s total voting 
rights. If the authority to purchase Ordinary 
Shares were used in full, the options would 
represent 1.07% of the Company’s total 
voting rights.
Dilution Limits and Time Limits
All employee share plans contain the share 
dilution limits recommended in institutional 
guidance, namely that no awards shall be 
granted which would cause the number 
of Shares issued or issuable pursuant to 
awards granted in the ten years ending with 
the date of grant (a) under any discretionary 
or executive share scheme adopted by the 
Company to exceed 5%, and (b) under any 
employees’ share scheme adopted by the 
Company to exceed 10%, of the Ordinary 
Share capital of the Company in issue at 
that time. 
Directors’ Report
(continued)
110
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

The European Communities 
(Takeover Bids (Directive 2004/25/
EC)) Regulations 2006
Structure of the Company’s share capital
At 20 June 2024, being the latest 
practicable date, the Company has an 
issued share capital of 395,760,194 
Ordinary Shares of €0.01 each and an 
authorised share capital of 800,000,000 
Ordinary Shares of €0.01 each.
At 29 February 2024, the trustee of the C&C 
Employee Trust held 1,133,822 Ordinary 
Shares of €0.01 each in the capital of the 
Company. Shares held by the trustee of the 
C&C Employee Trust are accounted for as 
if they were treasury shares. These shares 
are, however, included in the calculation 
of Total Voting Rights for the purposes of 
Regulation 20 of the Transparency (Directive 
2004/109/EC) Regulations 2007 (“TVR 
Calculation”).
At 29 February 2024, a subsidiary of 
the Group held 9,025,000 shares in the 
Company, which were acquired under 
the authority granted to the Company. 
These shares are not included in the TVR 
calculation and are accounted for as 
treasury shares. Treasury shares represent 
2.24% of issued share capital at 29 
February 2024. Further details can be found 
in Note 26 (Share Capital and Reserves) on 
pages 256 to 257.
Details of employee share schemes, 
and the rights attaching to shares held 
in these schemes, can be found in 
Note 4 (Share-Based Payments) to the 
financial statements and the Report of the 
Remuneration Committee on Directors’ 
Remuneration on pages 209 to 213. 
The Company has no securities in issue 
conferring special rights with regard to 
control of the Company.
Details of persons with a significant holding 
of securities in the Company are set out on 
page 110.
Rights and obligations attaching to the 
Ordinary Shares
All Ordinary Shares rank pari-passu, and 
the rights attaching to the Ordinary Shares 
(including as to voting and transfer) are 
as set out in the Company’s Articles of 
Association (“Articles”). A copy of the 
Articles may be obtained upon request to 
the Company Secretary, or they can be 
found on our website at candcgroupplc.
com.
Holders of Ordinary Shares are entitled to 
receive duly declared dividends in cash or, 
when offered, additional Ordinary Shares. 
In the event of any surplus arising on the 
occasion of the liquidation of the Company, 
Shareholders would be entitled to a share 
in that surplus pro rata to their holdings of 
Ordinary Shares.
Holders of Ordinary Shares are entitled 
to receive notice of and to attend, speak 
and vote in person or by proxy, at general 
meetings on a show of hands, one vote, 
and, on a poll, one vote for each Ordinary 
Share held. Procedures and deadlines 
for entitlement to exercise, and exercise 
of, voting rights are specified in the notice 
convening the general meeting in question. 
There are no restrictions on voting rights 
except in the circumstances where a 
‘Specified Event’ (as defined in the Articles) 
shall have occurred and the Directors 
have served a restriction notice on the 
Shareholder. Upon the service of such 
restriction notice, no holder of the shares 
specified in the notice shall, for so long as 
such notice shall remain in force, be entitled 
to attend or vote at any general meeting, 
either personally or by proxy.
Holding and transfer of Ordinary 
Shares
Following the migration in March 2021 of 
securities settlement in the securities of 
Irish registered companies listed on the 
London Stock Exchange (such as the 
Company) and/or Euronext Dublin from 
the current settlement system, CREST, 
to the replacement system, Euroclear 
Bank, the Ordinary Shares can be held in 
certificated form (that is, represented by a 
share certificate) or indirectly through the 
Euroclear System or through CREST in CDI 
(CREST Depository Interest) form. 
Save as set out below, there is no 
requirement to obtain the approval of the 
Company, or of other Shareholders, for a 
transfer of Ordinary Shares. The Directors 
may decline to register (a) any transfer of 
a partly-paid share to a person of whom 
they do not approve, (b) any transfer of 
a share to more than four joint holders, 
and (c) any transfer of a certificated share 
unless accompanied by the share certificate 
and such other evidence of title as may 
reasonably be required. The registration 
of transfers of shares may be suspended 
at such times and for such periods (not 
exceeding 30 days in each year) as the 
Directors may determine.
Transfer instruments for certificated 
shares are executed by or on behalf of the 
transferor and, in cases where the share 
is not fully paid, by or on behalf of the 
transferee. 
The Articles contain provisions designed 
to facilitate the Company’s participation 
in the Euroclear Bank settlement system 
and to facilitate the exercise of rights in the 
Company by holders of interests in Ordinary 
shares that are held through the Euroclear 
Bank system. The holding and transfer of 
Ordinary Shares through the Euroclear 
Bank system is additionally subject to the 
rules and procedures of Euroclear Bank 
and applicable Belgian law and (for interests 
in Ordinary Shares held in CDI form) those 
of CREST.
Rules concerning the appointment 
and replacement of the Directors 
and amendment of the Company’s 
Articles
Unless otherwise determined by ordinary 
resolution of the Company, the number 
of Directors shall not be less than two or 
more than 14. Subject to that limit, the 
Shareholders in general meeting may 
appoint any person to be a director either 
to fill a vacancy or as an additional director. 
The Directors also have the power to co-opt 
additional persons as Directors, but any 
director so co-opted is under the Articles 
required to be submitted to Shareholders 
for re-election at the first Annual General 
Meeting following their co-option.
111
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

The Articles require that at each Annual 
General Meeting of the Company one-third 
of the Directors retire by rotation. However, 
in accordance with the recommendations of 
the UK Corporate Governance Code 2018, 
the Directors have resolved they will all retire 
and submit themselves for re-election by 
the Shareholders at the Annual General 
Meeting on 15 August 2024.
The Company’s Articles may be amended 
by special resolution (75% majority of votes 
cast) passed at a general meeting.
Powers of Directors
Under its Articles, the business of the 
Company shall be managed by the 
Directors, who exercise all powers of the 
Company as are not, by the Companies 
Acts or the Articles, required to be 
exercised by the Company in general 
meeting.
The powers of Directors in relation to 
issuing or buying back by the Company of 
its shares are set out above under “Issue of 
Shares and Purchase of Own Shares”.
Change of control and related 
matters
Certain of the Group’s borrowing facilities 
include provisions that, in the event of a 
change of control of the Company, could 
oblige the Group to repay the facilities. 
Certain of the Company’s customer 
and supplier contracts and joint venture 
arrangements also contain provisions that 
would allow the counterparty to terminate 
the agreement in the event of a change of 
control of the Company. The Company’s 
Executive Share Option Scheme and 
Long-Term Incentive Plan each contain 
change of control provisions which allow 
for the acceleration of the exercise of share 
options/awards in the event of a change of 
control of the Company. 
There are no agreements between the 
Company and its Directors or employees 
providing for compensation for loss of 
office or employment (whether through 
resignation, purported redundancy or 
otherwise) that occurs because of a 
takeover bid in excess of their normal 
contractual entitlement. 
Shareholder Rights Directive II
On 20 March 2020, the provisions of the 
Shareholders’ Rights Directive II (SRD II) 
became law in Ireland with the publication of 
the European Union (Shareholders’ Rights) 
Regulations 2020 (‘SRD II Regulations’). The 
SRD II Regulations apply with effect from 30 
March 2020.
SRD II Regulations codify that Irish 
companies must seek Shareholder approval 
of a remuneration report annually; and, an 
advisory remuneration policy once every 
four years. The Group is, in effect, already 
in compliance with this requirement having 
provided Shareholders with the opportunity 
to opine on the Group’s remuneration report 
annually since 2010; and also in providing 
Shareholders with an advisory vote on 
the Group’s Remuneration Policy. The 
Remuneration Policy (‘Policy’) was last put 
to our Shareholders on an advisory basis 
at the 2021 AGM and is being put to our 
Shareholders again this year at our AGM on 
15 August 2024.
Political Donations
No political donations were made by 
the Group during the year that require 
disclosure in accordance with the Electoral 
Acts, 1997 to 2002.
Accounting Records
The measures taken by the Directors to 
secure compliance with the requirements 
of Sections 281 to 285 of the Companies 
Act 2014 with regard to the keeping of 
adequate accounting records are to employ 
accounting personnel with appropriate 
qualifications, experience and expertise 
and to provide adequate resources to the 
finance function. The books of account of 
the Company are maintained at the Group’s 
office in Bulmers House, Keeper Road, 
Crumlin, Dublin 12, D12 K702.
Auditor
In accordance with Section 383(2) of the 
Companies Act 2014, the auditor, Ernst 
& Young, Chartered Accountants, will 
continue in office. Ernst & Young were first 
appointed as the Company’s auditor during 
the financial year ending 28 February 2018 
following a tender process. The Company 
is committed to mandatory tendering every 
ten years. Further details are set on page 
121.
Disclosure of Information to the Auditor
In accordance with Section 330 of the 
Companies Act 2014, the Directors confirm 
that, so far as they are each aware, there 
is no relevant audit information, being 
information needed by the auditor in 
connection with preparing their report, of 
which the Company’s auditor is unaware. 
Having made enquiries with fellow 
Directors and the Company’s auditor, 
each Director has taken all the steps that 
they ought to have taken as a Director to 
make themselves aware of any relevant 
audit information and to establish that 
the Company’s auditor is aware of that 
information.
Directors’ Compliance Statement 
(Made in Accordance with Section 
225 of the Companies Act 2014)
The Directors acknowledge that they are 
responsible for securing compliance by the 
Company with its relevant obligations as 
are defined in the Companies Act 2014 (the 
‘Relevant Obligations’). 
The Directors confirm that they have drawn 
up and adopted a compliance policy 
statement setting out the Company’s 
policies that, in the Directors’ opinion, are 
appropriate to the Company with respect 
to compliance by the Company with its 
relevant obligations. 
The Directors further confirm the Company 
has put in place appropriate arrangements 
or structures that are, in the Directors’ 
opinion, designed to secure material 
compliance with its relevant obligations 
including reliance on the advice of persons 
employed by the Company and external 
legal and tax advisers as considered 
appropriate from time to time and that they 
have reviewed the effectiveness of these 
arrangements or structures during the 
financial year to which this report relates.
Directors’ Report
(continued)
112
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Financial Instruments
In the normal course of business, the Group 
has exposure to a variety of financial risks, 
including foreign currency risk, interest 
rate risk, liquidity risk and credit risk. The 
Company’s financial risk objectives and 
policies are set out in Note 24 of the financial 
statements.
Post Balance Sheet Events
On 6 June 2024, Patrick McMahon, stepped 
down from the Board and Ralph Findlay, 
Chair of the Board was appointed to the role 
of CEO with immediate effect.
 
The Group has commenced its previously 
announced share buyback programme and 
from 1 March 2024 to 21 June 2024 has 
purchased 7,653,323 shares in the open 
market at an average price of €190.16 pence 
per share, with the total buyback therefore 
amounting to €14.6m.
2024 Annual General Meeting
The Annual General Meeting will be held in 
Ireland on 15 August 2024 at 2.00 p.m. The 
Notice of Meeting, along with an explanation 
of the proposed resolutions, are set out in a 
separate document which accompanies this 
Annual Report and can be downloaded from 
the Company’s website that will provide 
details of the Meeting. The Company 
conducts the vote at the AGM by poll and 
the result of the votes, including proxies, is 
published on the Company’s website after 
the meeting.
Other Information 
Other information relevant to the Directors’ 
Report may be found in the following 
sections of the Annual Report:
Information
Location in the Annual Report
Results
Financial Statements – pages 166 to 274.
Principal risks & uncertainties including 
risks associated with recent emergence of 
COVID-19
Principal Risks and Uncertainties – pages 
32 to 41.
Directors’ remuneration, including the 
interests of the Directors and secretary in the 
share capital of the Company
Directors’ Remuneration Committee Report 
– pages 136 to 163.
Long-Term Incentive Plan, share options and 
equity settled incentive schemes
Directors’ Remuneration Committee Report 
– pages 136 to 163.
Significant subsidiary undertakings
Financial Statements – Note 29.
Director biographies and Board composition
Directors and Officers – pages 92 to 93.
Audit Committee Report
Pages 114 to 122.
 
The Directors’ Report for the financial year 
ended 29 February 2024 comprises these 
pages and the sections of the Annual 
Report referred to under ‘Other information’ 
above, which are incorporated into the 
Directors’ Report by reference.
Signed
On behalf of the Board
Ralph Findlay
Chair & Chief Executive Officer
27 June 2024
113
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Dear Shareholder
This annual Report of the 
Audit Committee (‘the 
Committee’) outlines the 
work undertaken by the 
Committee during FY2024. 
In addition to providing an 
overview of the Committee’s 
activities in the year under 
review, it also looks forward 
to our expected activities in 
the coming year. 
Year in Review
FY2024 has been a challenging year for 
the business. As reported last year, the 
implementation of a complex Enterprise 
Resource Planning ("ERP") system upgrade 
in Matthew Clark and Bibendum ("MCB") 
contributed to significant delays leading 
to service disruption and intense pressure 
on our colleagues who worked tirelessly to 
address these issues. As a result of their 
efforts, customer service levels have been 
successfully restored and service issues 
addressed. 
During the year accounting discrepancies 
were discovered and notified to the Audit 
Committee. The most significant of these 
related to the Group’s cider production 
facility in Clonmel, together with further 
adjustments to current assets and liabilities 
at a number of the Groups other sites, and 
amendments to provisions for onerous 
apple contracts. Detailed internal and 
external reviews of inventory and balance 
sheet reconciliations were undertaken 
and an independent accounting firm was 
appointed to investigate the relevant issues 
and to determine contributing factors, any 
potential financial impact and the time 
period over which the issues extended. 
The objective and scope of the internal and 
external reviews were as follows:
•	 To understand how the errors identified 
have accumulated over time, how they 
have affected prior year results and to 
consider whether the impact on past 
period results was such as to require them 
to be restated.
•	 To satisfy the Committee, in discussions 
with senior management and the Group’s 
internal audit function, that the remedial 
steps proposed to the Group’s financial 
systems and internal controls and the 
interim measures to be applied until these 
new steps are fully implemented, are 
sufficient to avoid any repetition of the 
issues that have emerged. This will include 
comprehensive internal audit reviews 
across the relevant areas.
The issues that were identified were then 
considered in detail by both the Group's 
Audit Committee and the Board, as part of 
the finalisation of the Group's FY2024 Annual 
Report and Accounts. Disappointingly, 
a number of prior year adjustments have 
been reflected in the financial statements 
relating to FY2021, FY2022 and FY2023. 
The impact on previously reported annual 
financial statements are summarised below, 
which have resulted in robust internal and 
independent external reviews, resulting in 
significant proposed changes to internal 
reporting processes, risk management and 
monitoring frameworks and the internal 
control environment. There will also be an 
impact on the unaudited FY2024 interim 
results, the details of which will be provided in 
the FY2025 Interim results to be announced 
in October. 
Audit Committee Report
Membership and Attendance
The following Non-Executive Directors served on the Committee during the year:
Member
Member Since
Number of Meetings 
Attended
John Gibney (Chair) 
26 October 2022
8/8
Vincent Crowley
22 March 2016
8/8
Jim Thompson1
1 March 2019
4/4
Jill Caseberry2
6 December 2023
1/1
Vineet Bhalla3
8 February 2023
7/7
1.	 Jim Thompson stepped down from the Board on 13 July 2023. 
2.	 Jill Caseberry was appointed as a member of the Committee on 6 December 2023.
3.   Vineet Bhalla stepped down as a member of the Audit Committee on 6 December 2023.
114
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

The accounting adjustments in aggregate 
represent an underlying operating profit 
adjustments charge of €6.1m. By year, 
the restatements comprised a €1.5m 
adjustment charge in FY2023, a €3.1m 
adjustment credit in FY2022 and a €7.7m 
adjustment charge in FY2021. These 
adjustments relate principally to five items, 
inventory related matters (€11.1m charge), 
incorrect accounting treatment of inventory 
of branded glassware (€1.1m charge), goods 
received not invoiced ("GRNI") (€2.9m 
credit), the timing of release of customer 
discount liabilities (€3.7m credit), together 
with additional items (€0.5m charge) over 
the three-year period in question.
In addition, the Group has recorded an 
exceptional prior year (FY2023) charge 
with respect to onerous apple contracts 
of €12.2m. The total value of the pre-tax 
adjustments, including the exceptional 
onerous apple contracts charge, is €18.3m.
The Board and Audit Committee have 
considered the background to these items 
in detail, including representations and 
accuracy of information provided to the 
External Auditors, the Committee and the 
Board at the time the items arose and in 
subsequent financial years. In addition 
to accounting mistakes and errors of 
judgement underlying these issues, it 
is clear from the reviews undertaken 
that there were failures in the Group's 
reporting framework and that in parts 
of the organisation behaviours fell short 
of the levels of transparency demanded 
and required such that opportunities 
were missed to identify and appropriately 
address the relevant issues. Further details 
relating to the underlying issues and the 
consequent actions and improvements to 
the controls and governance frameworks 
that have been and are being taken to 
ensure that there is no repetition of these 
issues are set out below. 
It is clear from both our internal reviews 
and independent external investigative 
work that the shortcomings related to 
certain of the Group’s inventory and 
balance sheet reconciliations, inadequate 
accounting systems suitable to manage the 
complexities in the manufacturing process, 
and the internal control environment not 
operating effectively in certain parts of the 
Group. In summary:
•	 Accounting mistakes and errors of 
judgement were made in periods before 
the FY2023 group annual report and 
accounts were finalised and during the 
FY2024 period.
•	 At the FY2023 year-end there were 
material issues that had arisen that 
were not appropriately escalated and/
or addressed in the FY2023 financial 
statements and were inappropriately 
deferred to be resolved in the FY2024 
year.
•	 Inadequate inventory controls and 
accounting systems at the Clonmel 
facility and reporting structures within the 
Group’s wider finance function.
•	 Adjustments to current assets and 
liabilities across other sites were made in 
response to the issues noted in Clonmel, 
the majority of which related to changes 
in accounting estimates and judgements. 
In light of the findings, significant changes 
have already been implemented to the 
finance team and reporting structure as 
highlighted below. At a management and 
oversight level, both the Audit Committee 
and Board believe these matters reflect 
under-investment in our people, systems 
and a lack of transparency in disclosures, 
which have hindered the financial reporting 
and review process, across the business. 
The substantial extra workload for 
management, the Committee and EY as 
a result of the investigation, caused us to 
defer the publication of our preliminary full 
year results from 23 May 2024 until such 
time as the impact and underlying causes 
could be determined. The Committee and 
wider Board agreed to prioritise a robust 
review over speed to ensure that findings 
would be accurate, transparent and of 
the quality needed to restore trust and 
confidence in our corporate reporting. 
The need for careful consideration of the 
additional matters by management, our 
auditor and the Committee resulted in 
5 extra meetings of the Committee and 
the publication of details of the findings 
and summary FY2024 unaudited financial 
performance on 7 June 2024. 
I highlighted in my report last year, that 
the Audit Committee would continue to 
focus on the internal control environment. 
Following the appointment of Andrew 
Andrea as Group CFO on 1 March 2024, he 
has quickly overseen the in-depth review 
of inventory and balance sheet controls 
together with the appointment of additional 
experienced technical resources and 
capabilities into the finance function. This 
process was aided by the robust review 
undertaken by an independent accounting 
firm, and which has contributed to a number 
of changes in process and reporting which 
are detailed below. The Audit Committee is 
satisfied that the process undertaken, and 
changes being implemented are sufficient 
to ensure that the failings encountered 
cannot arise in future and a strong culture of 
reporting potential errors or misstatements 
as quickly and transparently as possible will 
be achieved. Whilst immediate remediation 
steps have been taken, as noted above, the 
Audit Committee, in conjunction with the 
CFO, is overseeing the implementation of 
the following recommendations arising from 
the report of the independent accountants.
•	 Systems capabilities across all sites to be 
reviewed and standardised;
•	 Robust review and improvement of all key 
controls and a process of ongoing review 
put in place;
•	 Physical inventory review procedures and 
assessment of roles and responsibilities 
of internal audit and how it is managed 
and resourced. 
•	 GRNI reconciliations to be performed on 
a minimum monthly basis;
•	 Manual adjusting journal entries to be 
reviewed with entries over a certain limit 
to require review and approval;
•	 A refreshed campaign to ensure a healthy 
workplace ‘speak up’ culture, so that 
errors and misstatements are raised 
in a timely manner and then dealt with 
appropriately; and
•	 Further consideration of the findings of 
the independent accountant's report in 
terms of the upcoming changes to the UK 
Corporate Governance Code and what 
additional changes may be appropriate to 
ensure that the Board will be comfortable 
in providing the proposed confirmations 
in relation to internal controls going 
forward.
115
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

The improvements being achieved in our 
internal financial control environment are 
already evident and I wish to thank our 
finance team for the effort, tenacity and 
skill they have demonstrated during such a 
challenging period. Likewise, following the 
review into the implementation of the 2023 
ERP upgrade, significant improvements are 
already underway in our management of 
major systems and process change. 
While much has been achieved in a short 
space of time, there is still work to be done 
to achieve the standard of risk and control 
environment which our business requires. 
We have already made improvements, and 
this will continue to be the main focus of 
the Audit Committee in the coming year. 
The Audit Committee recognises the huge 
commitment and efforts of our colleagues in 
Finance, IT, Risk and Project Management 
in helping to address these issues. 
During the year, the Committee oversaw 
the Group’s financial reporting, risk 
management and internal control 
procedures and the work of internal auditors 
to ensure the Annual Report and financial 
statements provide a true and fair view of 
the Group’s performance, focusing on the 
accuracy, integrity and communication of 
our financial reporting. Given the internal 
shortcomings identified above, it is clear 
to the Committee that an overhaul of the 
internal audit process and risk management 
and monitoring is required to ensure the 
efficient functioning of the Group’s financial 
reporting framework going forward. This 
review will commence quickly after the 
completion of the FY2024 Annual Report 
and Accounts. 
The Committee is committed to 
transparency and continuous improvement 
to ensure absolute integrity in the Group’s 
internal and external reporting processes, 
risk management framework and controls 
environment. To improve the quality of 
financial reporting and oversight provided 
by the Committee, we are focused on:
•	 Expanding and improving the scope and 
delivery of management and internal audit 
reports reviewed by the Audit Committee
•	 Assess the roles and responsibilities of 
internal audit and how this is managed 
and resourced
•	 Overseeing the implementation of the 
recommendations identified above, in 
conjunction with the CFO
•	 Engaging with shareholders regarding the 
Audit Committee’s work
 
During the year, the Committee’s 
performance was subject to an internal 
Board performance review with responses 
being received from the Committee’s 
members as well as other regular 
attendees. The internal review, shared with 
both the Chair of the Board and the Chair of 
the Committee, supported the performance 
and effectiveness of the Committee but 
noted that greater transparency and 
accuracy of information is required going 
forward.
In discharging its responsibilities in the 
year and subsequently in light of the 
issues referred to above, the Committee 
reviewed and challenged management 
on the significant accounting judgements 
and disclosures made in our financial 
reporting in relation to inventory existence 
and valuation matters, accounting for GRNI 
and other balance sheet items, deficiencies 
in the internal control environment and 
management override of controls, lack 
of transparency over representations 
and accuracy of information presented 
to the Committee. Other areas reviewed 
included recoverability of trade receivables 
and advances to customers, the carrying 
value of goodwill and intangibles, revenue 
recognition, as well as reviewing the 
analysis behind our going concern and 
viability statements and considering the 
processes that underpinned the production 
of the Annual Report and Accounts. 
The Committee also undertook a thorough 
review of the implementation, system fixes 
and mitigation plans associated with the 
implementation of the complex ERP system 
upgrade in our MCB business, culminating 
in a series of recommendations to ensure 
the Group has the required level of planning, 
capability and resilience in its systems 
to avoid any reoccurrence of the issues 
encountered in the future.
As is usual, the Committee considered the 
Group’s Principal Risk disclosures for the 
financial year ended 29 February 2024. The 
Committee is satisfied that the statements 
made by the Directors on pages 32 to 41 
of this Annual Report in respect of the 
Principal Risks are appropriate based on 
what is currently known to management as 
at the date of this Report.
The Committee’s work was supported 
by the Group’s established risk and 
financial management structures, which 
in light of the matters identified, are being 
strengthened to improve our financial 
reporting and the quality of the Audit 
Committee’s oversight for the benefit of 
shareholders and other stakeholders. The 
Committee has continued to be greatly 
assisted by the commitment, energy and 
experience of the finance team, which has 
enabled the Committee to fulfil its role in 
providing effective scrutiny and challenge. 
As Chair, I regularly engage with the Head 
of Internal Audit and the External Auditor 
both ahead of Committee meetings and 
also as part of a regular dialogue we have 
on issues relevant to the Committee, in 
each case in order to ensure that each 
of their independent views, opinions and 
comments are reflected in the Committee’s 
deliberations and dealings. Following the 
issues identified concerning the prior year 
accounting adjustments and the remedial 
actions underway, as Chair, I will be 
increasing the level of engagement across 
the finance function and with the External 
Auditors in FY2025.
There were eight meetings of the 
Committee during the year. The meetings of 
the Committee were generally scheduled to 
take place in advance of Board meetings. 
This allowed me, to provide the Board 
with a detailed update on the key items 
discussed during our meetings. The Board 
also received copies of the minutes of the 
Committee meetings. As noted above, 5 
additional meetings of the Committee have 
taken place following the end of the year 
under review.
In my capacity as Audit Chair, I am available 
to all Board members to discuss any audit 
or risk related concerns they may have, 
either on a collective or individual basis. 
Audit Committee Report
(continued)
116
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

During FY2024 I met with the external audit 
partner and the Head of Internal Audit, 
without management on a regular basis. I 
have also had a number of further meetings 
following the end of the year under review 
with representatives of the External 
Auditors in light of the issues that have been 
identified and which have given rise to the 
prior year adjustments and control failings 
mentioned above. 
More information about the Committee’s 
activities during the year can be found in the 
pages which follow.
The Year Ahead 
Looking forward, the main focus of the 
Committee will be on continuing to improve 
the financial control and risk management 
framework of the business including 
the implementation of the actions noted 
above, in particular the organisational 
culture and commitment to speaking up. 
We will continue to review the financial 
reporting of the Group and its accounting 
policies and any major accounting issues 
of a subjective nature will be considered 
and discussed by the Committee. The 
Committee will also consider any additional 
requirements resulting from the upcoming 
UK Corporate Governance Code changes. 
The Committee fulfils a key role in assisting 
the Board in ensuring that the integrity 
of the Group’s financial statements and 
the effectiveness of the Group’s internal 
financial controls and risk management 
systems are maintained. Through the 
Committee’s composition, resources and 
the commitment of its members, I believe 
that it remains well placed to meet those 
challenges and to discharge its duties 
effectively in the year ahead notwithstanding 
the deeply disappointing issues that have 
been identified and have necessitated 
the restatements reflected in our FY2024 
financial statements.
On behalf of the Board
John Gibney
Audit Committee Chair
27 June 2024
Role and Responsibilities of the 
Committee
The Committee supports the Board 
in fulfilling its responsibilities in relation 
to financial reporting, monitoring the 
integrity of the financial statements and 
other announcements of financial results 
published by the Group; and reviewing 
and challenging any significant financial 
reporting issues, judgements and 
actions of management in relation to the 
financial statements. The Committee 
reviews the effectiveness of the Group’s 
internal controls and risk management 
systems and the effectiveness of the 
Group’s Internal Audit function. On behalf 
of the Board, the Committee manages 
the appointment and remuneration of 
the External Auditor and monitors its 
performance and independence. The 
Group supports an independent and 
confidential whistleblowing procedure, 
and the Committee monitors the 
operation of this facility.
In accordance with the Code, the Board 
requested that the Committee advise it 
whether it believes the Annual Report 
and Accounts, taken as a whole, is 
fair, balanced and understandable and 
provides the information necessary for 
Shareholders to assess the Group’s 
position and performance, business 
model and strategy.
The Committee’s Terms of Reference 
reflect this requirement and can be 
found in the Investor Centre section of 
the Group’s website. A copy may be 
obtained from the Company Secretary. 
All members of the Committee are and 
were considered by the Board to be 
independent throughout the year under 
review. 
The Committee members have been 
selected to provide the wide range of 
financial and commercial expertise 
necessary to fulfil the Committee’s 
duties and responsibilities and provide 
effective governance. As a qualified 
chartered accountant, I am considered 
by the Board to have recent and relevant 
financial experience, as required by the 
Code. The Committee is considered by the 
Board to have the necessary competence 
and broad experience relevant to the sector 
in which the Group operates. Details of the 
skills and experience of the Directors are 
contained in the Directors’ biographies on 
pages 86 and 87 of the Annual Report and 
Accounts.
The Committee has access to the Group’s 
finance team, to its Internal Audit function 
and to its External Auditor and can seek 
further professional training and advice, at 
the Group’s cost, as appropriate. 
Meeting Frequency and Main 
Activities in the Year
The Committee met on eight scheduled 
occasions during FY2024. The quorum 
necessary for the transaction of business 
by the Committee is two, each of whom 
must be a Non-Executive Director. Regular 
attendees by invitation include the Chair 
of the Board, the Chief Executive Officer, 
the Chief Financial Officer, the Head of 
Internal Audit and, Ernst & Young ("EY"), the 
External Auditor. 
The Company Secretary and Group General 
Counsel is Secretary to the Committee.
Going Concern
The Committee and the Board reviewed 
and challenged management’s assessment 
of base case and downside forecast cash 
flows for the period to 31 August 2025 
including sensitivity to macro-economic 
uncertainties such as a sustained downturn 
in demand, higher input costs and interest 
rates, combined with significant operational 
disruption, along with the Group’s own 
mitigating actions on costs and cash 
flows. The Committee also considered 
the Group’s financing facilities, the level of 
available liquidity and covenant compliance 
over the forecast period. Based on this, the 
Committee confirmed that the application of 
the going concern basis for the preparation 
of the financial statements continued to be 
appropriate with no material uncertainties. 
For further information on the work 
undertaken by the Committee, the Board 
and management in relation to the going 
117
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

concern basis of preparation for the 
FY2024 financial statements, please see 
‘Going Concern’ on page 40 and ‘Viability 
Statement’ on page 41. The Directors’ Going 
Concern statement is set out on page 164.
Significant Judgemental Areas
The key matters reviewed and evaluated 
by the Committee during the year are set 
out below. Each of these areas received 
particular focus from the External Auditor, 
who provided detailed analysis and 
assessment of the matters in their report to 
the Committee.
Recoverability of On-Trade 
Receivables and Advances to 
Customers
The Group has a recoverability risk 
through exposure to on-trade receivable 
balances and advances to customers 
who may experience financial difficulties. 
The Committee’s focus on this area was 
heightened this year as a result of issues 
associated with the implementation of a 
complex ERP system upgrade in our MCB 
business, in addition to the cost-of-living 
crisis, and the consequential impact on 
some of our customers. The Committee 
considered the basis used by management 
in calculating the expected credit losses, 
whether it adequately captured the risks 
in the current environment and the level 
of security in respect of those loans. As a 
result of the review process, the Committee 
concluded that the expected credit loss on 
trade receivables and loans was prudent but 
appropriate and were properly reflected in 
the consolidated financial statements.
Carrying value of goodwill and 
intangible brand assets, including 
related impairment charges
The Committee considered management’s 
conclusion that an impairment of the 
carrying value of goodwill and intangible 
assets held by the Group should be made. 
Indicators of impairment were identified 
around the continuing challenging trading 
conditions in the crowded and competitive 
UK cider market. This has resulted in 
uncertainty in the longer-term outlook 
for Magners cider in the Great Britain 
operating segment, which together with 
other macroeconomic factors, is restricting 
the Group’s ability to innovate and trade 
its way back to sustainable profit growth. 
In particular, the Committee considered 
and challenged the valuation financial 
models, including sensitivity analysis, 
used to support the valuation and the key 
assumptions and judgements used by 
management underlying these models. 
The key assumptions used in the financial 
models and consequently the key focus 
areas for the Committee relate to future 
volume, net revenue and operating profit, 
the growth rate in perpetuity and the 
discount rate applied to the resulting cash 
flows. The Committee considered the 
outcome of the financial models and found 
the methodology to be robust, and agreed 
with management’s conclusion that an 
impairment of goodwill should be made. 
Revenue recognition
The Committee considered the Group’s 
revenue recognition policy and is satisfied 
it is appropriate and in line with IFRS 15 
Revenue from Contracts with Customers. 
Management Override of internal 
controls and related prior period 
adjustments
The adjustments previously noted in respect 
of current assets and liabilities included 
amounts in respect of goods received, not 
yet invoiced (GRNI), customer discount 
liabilities, incorrect accounting treatment of 
glassware, together with amounts in respect 
of supply and packaging arrangements and 
prepayments. The Committee has identified 
that some material releases of these items 
were incorrectly made by management 
during FY2024 without the expected and 
required level of diligence and analysis to 
support these releases. These write off 
and releases in current assets and liabilities 
were subsequently corrected and allocated 
to the correct financial years, as outlined in 
our RNS "Summary of FY2024 unaudited 
financial performance" on 7 June 2024 and 
noted below in the prior year adjustments 
section.
During the current financial year, the Group 
identified in conjunction with the external 
auditors, and subsequently with the 
assistance of an independent accounting 
firm, prior period accounting errors in 
inventory and other balance sheet accounts 
within current assets and liabilities, across a 
number of areas of the Group’s operations. 
Following constructive engagement with 
EY and review by the Committee, the 
Committee approved the items to be 
restated, which arose from accounting 
mistakes, errors of judgement and a lack 
of transparency in disclosures. These 
adjustments related principally to five items, 
inventory existence and valuation matters 
(€11.1m charge), incorrect accounting 
treatment of inventory of branded glassware 
(€1.1m charge) GRNI (€2.9m credit), the 
timing of release of customer discount 
liabilities (€3.7m credit), together with 
additional items (net €0.5m charge) over 
the three-year period in question. These 
adjustments in aggregate represent an 
underlying operating profit adjustment 
charge of €6.1m. By year, the restatements 
comprised a €1.5m adjustment charge 
in FY2023, a €3.1m adjustment credit in 
FY2022 and a €7.7m adjustment charge in 
FY2021. 
In addition, the Group has recorded an 
exceptional prior year (FY2023) charge 
with respect to onerous apple contracts 
of €12.2m. The total value of the pre-tax 
adjustments, including the exceptional 
onerous apple contracts charge is €18.3m. 
The Committee, and the Board, believes 
these failures stemmed from under-
investment in our people, systems and a 
lack of transparency in disclosures, which 
have hindered the financial reporting and 
review process, through the business. 
Whilst these issues in aggregate represent 
less than 1% of total group assets, it is 
nevertheless disappointing and appropriate 
steps are being taken to ensure such 
failings cannot happen in future.
Audit Committee Report
(continued)
118
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Inventory existence and valuation
During the year issues were identified 
relating to the existence and valuation of 
cider concentrate at the Group’s cider 
production facility in Clonmel. Following 
internal review and in conjunction 
with work performed by EY and the 
Independent Investigative accountant’s, 
it was determined that a shortfall in the 
cider concentrate volume existed and that 
accounting errors had occurred in respect 
of the recording of these concentrate 
values. The Committee considered 
the review work undertaken and the 
Investigative Accountants Report and 
agreed with managements conclusion that 
there was a failure of the internal control 
system and the adjustments required should 
form part of the prior period restatement 
noted above. 
Carrying Value of Investment 
in subsidiary undertakings in 
the parent company financial 
statements and related 
impairment charges
The Committee considered management’s 
conclusion that an impairment of the 
carrying value of the investment in 
subsidiary undertakings held by the 
Company should be made. Indicators of 
impairment were identified around dividends 
paid by the subsidiary undertakings to the 
Company. In particular, the Committee 
considered and challenged the valuation 
financial models, including sensitivity 
analysis, used to support the valuation 
and the key assumptions and judgements 
used by management underlying these 
models. The key assumptions used in the 
financial models and consequently the key 
focus areas for the Committee relate to 
future volume, net revenue and operating 
profit, the growth rate in perpetuity and 
the discount rate applied to the resulting 
cash flows. The Committee considered the 
outcome of the financial models and found 
the methodology to be robust, and agreed 
with management’s conclusion that an 
impairment of the investment carrying value 
should be made. 
Adjusting Items
Adjusting items are not reported as part of 
the financial statements but are used in the 
Annual Report and Accounts to provide 
clarity on underlying performance for 
users of the accounts. The classification of 
adjusting items is defined by a Group policy, 
as approved by the Committee. It includes 
items of significant income and expense 
which, due to their size, nature or frequency, 
merit separate presentation to allow the 
reader to understand better the elements of 
financial performance during the year. The 
Committee reviewed and challenged items 
to be included throughout the year in order 
to confirm appropriateness. 
Other Areas of Focus
The Committee also during the year:
•	 approved the Internal Audit plan and 
agreed the External Auditor’s work plans 
for the Group;
•	 considered regular reports from the Head 
of Internal Audit on their findings;
•	 considered the process for review and 
approval of the FY2024 Annual Report 
and Accounts;
•	 considered the Investigative Accountant’s 
Report and findings and risk of 
management bias;
•	 reviewed and recommended revisions to 
the Board to the Group Risk Register and 
the Principal Risks and Uncertainties; and
•	 reviewed the External Auditor’s 
independence and objectivity, the 
effectiveness of the audit process, the 
re-appointment of the External Auditor 
and approved the External Auditor’s 
remuneration.
Following discussions with the External 
Auditor, and the deliberations set out above, 
we are satisfied that the financial statements 
are fairly stated and consistent with the 
information presented for each of the areas 
of significant judgement, including inventory 
valuation and existence, onerous contracts, 
exceptional items and parent company 
investment impairment. 
Fair, Balanced and 
Understandable Assessment
One of the key compliance requirements 
of the Group’s financial statements is for 
the Annual Report and Accounts to be 
fair, balanced and understandable. The 
coordination and review of Group wide 
contributions into the Annual Report and 
Accounts follows a well-established and 
documented process, which is performed in 
parallel with the formal process undertaken 
by the External Auditor.
The Committee received a summary of 
the approach taken by management in 
the preparation of the FY2024 Annual 
Report and Accounts to ensure that it met 
the requirements of the UK Corporate 
Governance Code. This, and our own 
scrutiny of the document, enabled the 
Committee, and then the Board, to 
confirm that the FY2024 Annual Report 
and Accounts taken as a whole, was fair, 
balanced and understandable and provided 
the information necessary for Shareholders 
to assess the Group’s position and 
performance, business model and strategy.
Reporting Process Improvements 
since 1 March 2024
Led by the new CFO and overseen by the 
Committee, with the oversight of the Board, 
the Company is taking action to prevent the 
incidents that resulted in the accounting 
misstatements relating to inventory, goods 
received not invoiced related matters, 
together with accruals and prepayment 
reconciliations. These measures, which 
are being implemented across the Group, 
include:
•	 Enhancing the technical capability 
within the finance team through adding 
additional resources with appropriate 
qualifications for the complexities of the 
manufacturing process;
•	 Performed an in-depth balance sheet 
review, giving a high degree of confidence 
that there are no material issues as at the 
FY2024 balance sheet date;
•	 Re-organising the Group’s central finance 
function to include Group financial 
control, financial analysis, treasury and 
internal audit;
•	 Creating standard accounting policies 
and procedures to be applied consistently 
across all companies in the Group;
•	 Implementing a unified accounting and 
forecasting platform to be deployed 
across the Group, replacing the many 
different accounting systems currently in 
use across the Group; and
119
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Audit Committee Report
(continued)
•	 A review of the internal audit processes 
to ensure a more effective and efficient 
execution in future years.
These measures will contribute to the 
transparency of reporting and the process 
of continuous improvement to ensure the 
integrity of the Group’s internal and external 
reporting processes as noted earlier in the 
report.
Internal Controls and Risk 
Management Systems
While the Board retains ultimate 
responsibility for risk management and the 
internal control environment, the Committee 
is responsible for reviewing the robustness 
and effectiveness of the Group’s risk 
management and internal control systems, 
including financial, operational, regulatory 
and compliance controls.
A critical element of the Group’s risk 
management review is the determination 
of the extent to which the Group is willing 
to “accept” a level of net risk as part of the 
cost of delivering against its strategy. To this 
end, during the year the Board’s individual 
and collective risk appetite was reviewed, 
considering changes in the business and 
external environment, as well as emerging 
trends and developing risks. Our risk 
appetite differs across the respective 
principal and emerging risks, with a lower 
acceptance appetite (seeking to reduce the 
risk profile and mitigating its impact where 
possible) for high impact/high likelihood 
risks and with a higher acceptance 
level (potentially accepting the risk, with 
limited impact mitigation) for low impact/
low likelihood risks. For further details, 
please see the Group’s Principal Risks and 
Uncertainties on pages 34 to 40.
In line with our usual procedures, the 
Committee reviewed the principal risks at 
the half and full year, and the associated 
risk appetites and metrics considering 
business changes and performance, 
challenging and confirming their alignment 
to the achievement of the Group’s strategic 
objectives. This review was supported 
through consideration of risk dashboards 
outlining both principal risks and any 
escalated or emerging risks. Changes to 
our risk profile were then approved by the 
Board. 
In addition, the Committee reviewed 
reports issued by both Internal Audit upon 
matters including accounting manuals and 
KPI reporting, employee relations, keg 
management and tax, as well as from the 
Investigative Accountant for the matters 
noted in this report and the External Auditor 
and held regular discussions with the Chief 
Financial Officer, the Head of Internal Audit 
and representatives of the External Auditor. 
IT Systems and Cyber Security
The Group implemented a complex ERP 
transformation in February 2023 in the 
Matthew Clark and Bibendum (‘MCB’) 
business, further aligning and streamlining 
our technology infrastructure across 
the Group. This is a key step in our 
digital transformation and optimisation 
of the business which will enable further 
automation and simplification of our 
business processes. 
The implementation of the ERP took longer 
and was significantly more challenging and 
disruptive than originally envisaged. Once 
successfully completed, a thorough review 
was undertaken of the implementation, 
system fixes and mitigation plans, 
culminating in a series of recommendations 
to ensure the Group has the required level 
of planning, capability and resilience in its 
systems to avoid any reoccurrence in the 
future.
We continued to review our information 
security and cyber preparedness policies 
and procedures and further enhanced 
our Information Technology systems 
and controls. In the field of information 
technology and security, the Group 
undertakes a regular security assurance 
programme, testing controls, identifying 
weaknesses, and prioritising remediation 
activities where necessary. This includes 
periodic best practice specialist security 
testing by a leading third-party provider 
and regular system scanning to identify 
security weaknesses. Issues are assessed 
for risk and are comprehensively managed 
as part of the Group’s risk management 
programme. We continue to pursue Cyber 
Essentials Plus accreditation from the 
National Cyber Security Centre ("NCSC"). 
Internal Audit
The Committee is responsible for 
monitoring and reviewing the operation and 
effectiveness of the Internal Audit function 
including its focus, work plan, activities, and 
resources. During each financial year, the 
Committee completes its annual review of 
the effectiveness of the Group’s system of 
internal controls and internal audit function, 
including financial, operational, compliance 
and risk management systems.
The annual internal audit plan is approved 
by the Committee and is kept under regular 
review, in order to reflect the changing 
business needs and to ensure new and 
emerging risks are considered. The 
Committee is informed of any amendments 
made to the internal audit plan on a 
quarterly basis. The FY2024 internal audit 
plan was developed through a review of 
the Group’s principal risks together with 
consideration of the Group’s key business 
processes and functions that could be 
subject to audit. While the Group's reporting 
framework failed in respect of certain 
inventory and balance sheet items, partially 
due to management override of the Group’s 
internal controls and reporting framework, 
we note that these issues were identified 
during FY2024, in conjunction with the 
Group’s External Auditors. The Committee 
is confident that the remedial actions 
being taken, monitoring of effectiveness of 
measures implemented by Internal Audit, 
improved oversight and cultural change, 
will ensure the accuracy and integrity of the 
Group's reporting framework going forward.
In relation to the FY2025 internal audit 
plan, the principal objectives are to provide 
confidence that existing and emerging key 
risks are being managed effectively, to 
confirm that controls over core business 
functions and processes are operating 
as intended, and to confirm that major 
projects and significant business change 
programmes are being adequately 
controlled. Additional oversight will be 
120
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

provided by the Committee to review in 
detail the FY2025 internal audit plans in the 
Clonmel facility and across the Group.
Findings from all audit reports issued by 
the internal audit function are reviewed 
by the Committee. Internal audit 
recommendations are closely monitored 
from implementation through to closure, 
to ensure these are implemented in a 
timely manner. A summary of the status 
of the implementation of internal audit 
recommendations is made quarterly to the 
Committee. 
Following the appointment of the CFO, the 
Committee is confident that the Internal 
Audit function will have the necessary 
direction and resources to fulfil its mandate 
in FY2025. It is also satisfied that the Internal 
Audit function has adequate standing and 
is free from management influence or other 
restrictions.
External Audit
The Committee is responsible for 
monitoring the performance, objectivity 
and independence of Ernst & Young ("EY"), 
the External Auditor. In December 2023, 
we met with EY to review and approve 
the audit plan for the year end, to gauge 
whether it was appropriately focused. EY 
presented to the Committee its proposed 
plan of work, which was designed to ensure 
there are no material misstatements in 
the financial statements. The Committee 
considered the accounting, financial control 
and audit issues reported by the External 
Auditor that flowed from their audit work. 
In addition, EY’s letter of engagement 
and independence was reviewed by the 
Committee in advance of the audit. 
In June 2024, in advance of the finalisation 
of the financial statements, we received a 
report from EY on their key audit findings, 
which included the key areas of risk and 
significant judgements referred to above 
and discussed the issues with them for 
the Committee to form a judgement on 
the financial statements. In addition, we 
considered the Letter of Representation 
that the External Auditor requires from the 
Board. 
The Committee meets with the External 
Auditor privately at least once a year to 
discuss any matters they may wish to raise 
without management being present and 
has held a number of additional meetings 
to consider the matters discussed in this 
report.
Assessment of Effectiveness of 
External Audit
The Committee carried out an assessment 
of the external audit process during the 
year, including EY’s role in that process. 
The Committee also considered the 
robustness of the audit process including, 
the level of challenge given by EY to 
critical management judgements and 
assumptions and the extent to which 
professional scepticism was shown by 
EY. This took account of the Committee’s 
own discussions with the External Auditor 
on the work performed around areas of 
higher audit risk. It also took account of 
the External Auditor’s conclusions on 
those areas, and the depth of the External 
Auditor’s understanding of the Group’s 
businesses.
The review of audit effectiveness was 
supported by the results of discussions 
with individual Committee members and 
the completion of a short questionnaire by 
each member of the Committee, the Chief 
Financial Officer, the Director of Group 
Finance and applicable senior finance 
personnel across the business. 
On the basis of the Committee’s evaluation 
and considering the views of other key 
internal stakeholders, the Committee 
concluded that both the audit and the audit 
process were largely effective, having been 
carried out in an independent, professional, 
organised and constructive manner, with 
an appropriate level of challenge and 
scepticism over management’s treatment 
of significant reporting and accounting 
matters.
The Committee has worked constructively 
with the External Auditors to assess and 
resolve the prior year adjustments and 
the other areas of focus discussed in this 
report. 
Audit Tender
EY was originally appointed as External 
Auditor for the year ended 28 February 
2018. The Group’s lead audit engagement 
partner for the FY2024 audit was Dermot 
Quinn. This is his second year in the role 
following partner rotation. The External 
Auditor is required to rotate the audit 
partner every five years and therefore the 
original partner was required to rotate after 
the 2022 AGM. 
There are no contractual obligations 
restricting the Group’s choice of External 
Auditor. The Committee will continue to 
review the auditor appointment and the 
need to tender the audit, ensuring the 
Group’s compliance with the Code and any 
related regulations.
The Group complied on a voluntary basis 
with the Statutory Audit Services for Large 
Companies Market Investigation (mandatory 
Use of Competitive Tender Processes and 
Audit Committee Responsibilities) Order 
2014, having last carried out a competitive 
tender for audit services in 2017.
Non-Audit Services
The Group has a policy in place governing 
the provision of non-audit services by 
the External Auditor in order to ensure 
that the External Auditor’s objectivity and 
independence is safeguarded. This policy 
has been in place throughout the year.
Under this policy the auditor is prohibited 
from providing non-audit services if the 
auditor:
•	 may, as a result, be required to audit its 
own firm’s work; 
•	 would participate in activities that would 
normally be undertaken by management;
•	 would be remunerated through a 
“success fee” structure or have some 
other mutual financial interest with the 
Group; and
•	 would be acting in an advocacy role for 
the Group.
Other than above, the Group does not 
impose an automatic ban on the External 
Auditor providing non-audit services. 
121
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

However, the External Auditor is only 
permitted to provide non-audit services 
that are not, or are not perceived to be, 
in conflict with auditor independence and 
objectivity, if it has the skill, competence 
and integrity to carry out the work and it 
is considered by the Audit Committee to 
be the most appropriate firm to undertake 
such work in the best interests of the 
Group. The engagement of the External 
Auditor to provide non-audit services 
must be approved in advance by the Audit 
Committee or entered into pursuant to 
pre-approved policies and procedures 
established by the Audit Committee and 
approved by the Board.
The nature, extent and scope of non-
audit services provided to the Group by 
the External Auditor and the economic 
importance of the Group to the External 
Auditor are also monitored to ensure 
that the External Auditor’s independence 
and objectivity is not impaired. The Audit 
Committee has adopted a policy that, 
except in exceptional circumstances with 
the prior approval of the Audit Committee, 
non-audit fees paid to the Group’s auditor 
should not exceed 100% of audit fees in any 
one financial year.
 
In FY2024, EY undertook non-audit services 
in connection with the audit of the Group’s 
pension schemes, limited assurance 
reporting on climate related matters and 
the liquidation of a non-trading subsidiary 
undertaking, which were subject to the 
Committee’s prior approval and were 
undertaken for fees of €116,000.
Confidential Reporting 
Programme
The Group has an independent and 
confidential reporting programme called 
“Speak Up” in all its operations whereby 
employees can, in confidence, report on 
matters where they feel a malpractice 
has taken or is taking place, or if health 
and safety standards have been or are 
being compromised. Additional areas that 
are addressed by this procedure include 
criminal activities, improper or unethical 
behaviour and risks to the environment.
The programme allows employees to raise 
their concerns with their line manager or, 
if that is inappropriate, to raise them on a 
confidential basis. An externally facilitated 
confidential helpline and confidential email 
facility are provided to protect the identity 
of employees in these circumstances. Any 
concerns are investigated on a confidential 
basis by the Human Resources Department 
and/or the Company Secretary and Group 
General Counsel and feedback is given 
to the person making the complaint as 
appropriate via the confidential email facility. 
An official written record is kept of each 
stage of the procedure and results are 
summarised for the Committee. 
The Committee is also responsible for 
ensuring that arrangements are in place for 
the proportionate independent investigation 
and appropriate follow up of any concerns 
which might be raised. The Committee 
receives regular reports on all whistleblowing 
incidents. The Board also receives a 
report on whistleblowing, in the Company 
Secretary and Group General Counsel’s 
regular report to Board meetings. In FY2024, 
5 incidences of concern were uncovered.
We encourage employees to report genuine 
issues and concerns as they arise. Those 
concerns are taken seriously. Employees 
can be assured they are investigated where 
appropriate and confidentiality is respected 
at all times. The Committee, the Board 
and the management team are committed 
Find out more 
The full responsibilities of the Committee are set out in its 
Terms of Reference, which are available on our website 
candcgroupplc.com/corporate-governance/terms-of-reference/.
Audit Committee Report
(continued)
to a renewed focus on our “Speak Up” 
programme across the business in 
FY2025. We want to promote our culture 
of transparency, integrity and trust so that 
collectively issues or concerns are reported 
as they arise and dealt with accordingly. 
Evaluation of the Committee
The evaluation of the Committee was 
completed as part of the 2024 internal 
board performance review process. 
The overall conclusion from this year’s 
Board performance review was that the 
Committee continues to operate effectively 
but that greater transparency and accuracy 
of information is required going forward 
and the improvements currently being 
enacted within the controls and governance 
frameworks will meet the required 
standards of performance. An explanation 
of how this process was conducted, the 
conclusions arising from it and the action 
items identified is set out on page 97. The 
Committee has considered this in the 
context of the matters that are applicable to 
the Committee.
This report was approved by the Board of 
Directors on 27 June 2024.
John Gibney
Audit Committee Chair
122
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Environmental, Social and Governance Committee Report
Dear Shareholder
On behalf of the Board, I 
am pleased to present my 
first Environmental, Social 
and Governance Committee 
report to you as Chair of 
the ESG Board Committee, 
which is intended to provide 
Shareholders with an 
understanding of the work 
of the Committee during 
FY2024. 
This report provides an 
overview of the Committee’s 
activities in the year under 
review and previews our 
expected areas of focus in 
the coming year. 
Key Activities in FY2024 
•	 Reviewed and updated the Terms of 
Reference.
•	 Provided ESG training to all Board 
members.
•	 Undertook annual Committee Performance 
Review.
•	 Appointment of Chair of ESG Board 
Committee.
•	 Appointment of two Committee members; 
Non-Executive Directors, Chris Browne 
and myself, (I was subsequently appointed 
as Chair of the Committee on 22 May 
2024).
•	 Received updates on DE&I two-year 
strategic plan.
•	 Approved the TCFD.
•	 Approved the Sustainability Report.
•	 Reviewed the Ethical and Sustainable 
Procurement Roadmap.
•	 Implemented Health and Safety Strategy – 
Vision Zero.
•	 Recommended Environmental Policy for 
Board approval.
•	 Recommended Mental Health First Aider 
Policy for Board approval.
•	 Review ESG KPI Dashboard.
Key Priorities for next year
•	 Drive further progress on DE&I across 
senior leadership roles.
•	 Keep under review the ESG strategy 
and how environment and sustainability 
principles are being embedded into the 
Company strategy, culture and working 
practices. 
•	 Refresh of Code of Conduct.
•	 Continue to focus on horizon scanning 
and preparedness for regulatory reporting 
requirements.
Year in Review
The Board established an ESG Board 
Committee in 2020 to reflect C&C’s ongoing 
commitment to operating a sustainable 
business and provide the Company with 
rigour, support and challenge on ESG 
matters. The ESG Board Committee has 
primary responsibility for the oversight of 
sustainability and climate change issues 
and provides regular updates to the Board 
on these matters. 
In July 2023, Jim Thompson stepped 
down from the Board and Vineet Bhalla 
succeeded Jim as Chair of the ESG Board 
Committee. As part of the Board’s annual 
review of Board and Board Committee 
composition, another newly appointed 
Membership and Attendance
The following directors served on the Environmental Social and Governance (‘ESG’) 
Committee during the year.
Member 
Member Since
Number of Meetings 
Attended
Sarah Newbitt1 (Chair)
6 December 2023
1/1
Vineet Bhalla2
9 February 2023
4/4
Chris Browne
6 December 2023
1/1
Patrick McMahon3
24 September 2020
4/4
Jill Caseberry4
24 September 2020
4/4
Jim Thompson5
24 September 2020
2/2
Helen Pitcher6
24 September 2020
2/2
1. 	 Sarah Newbitt was appointed Chair with effect from 22 May 2024.
2.	 Vineet Bhalla was appointed Chair with effect from 14 July 2023 until 22 May 2024 where he reverted to a member 
of the ESG Board Committee.
3.	 Patrick McMahon stepped down from the Board and the ESG Board Committee with effect from 6 June 2024.
4. 	 Jill Caseberry stepped down as a member of the ESG Board Committee on 6 December 2023.
5. 	 Jim Thompson was Chair of the ESG Board Committee until he stepped down from the Board following the 
conclusion of the AGM on 13 July 2023.
6. 	 Helen Pitcher stepped from the Board and the ESG Board Committee following the conclusion of the AGM on 13 
July 2023.
123
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Non-Executive Director, Chris Browne, and 
myself were appointed as members of the 
ESG Board Committee on 6 December 
2023. I was subsequently appointed Chair 
of the ESG Committee on 22 May 2024, 
with Vineet Bhalla reverting to being a 
member of the ESG Committee, having 
taken the decision to step down as Chair 
of the ESG Board Committee due to time 
constraints since starting a new role last 
year. 
To ensure alignment with the other 
Board Committees meetings were held 
throughout the year, outside the regular 
ESG Board Committee cycle, with each 
of the Committee Chairs, Head of ESG 
and Deputy Company Secretary to seek 
alignment on the ESG Board Committee 
Terms of Reference and to ensure alignment 
and responsibility as delegated by the 
Board. 
Also, during the year, an ESG Management 
Committee was established to review 
sustainability initiatives and reporting 
requirements. Delegating those 
responsibilities which originally sat with 
the ESG Board Committee to the ESG 
Management Committee and therefore 
allowing for the ESG Board Committee to 
provide additional focus and scrutiny. It is 
intended that the ESG Board Committee 
will look to identify areas where C&C 
can really make a difference, and further 
embed sustainability across all functions 
and business operations, as well as 
ensuring high standards of governance 
and reporting in this area. The Chair of the 
ESG Management Committee, Company 
Secretary and Group General Counsel, 
will provide an update to each ESG Board 
Committee and all Board members are 
invited to attend all ESG Board Committee 
meetings.
Throughout the course of FY2024, the 
priority for the Committee has been the 
continuous progression of the Company’s 
ESG strategy, as detailed on pages 59 to 
89, and ensuring ESG remains at the heart 
of the Company’s strategy and an integral 
component of its operations.
C&C’s Head of ESG and team continue to 
lead the Company towards our vision of 
“Delivering to a better world!” relating to 
ESG targets. Our ESG Champions from 
across the business provide additional 
support by analysing and appraising 
the ESG strategy, its six pillars and the 
KPIs and initiatives underpinning it. Our 
ESG Champions provide invaluable input 
as we continue to implement the ESG 
Strategy. ESG Champions are appointed 
on an 18-month term, allowing them to 
be involved in the setting of long-term, 
meaningful targets and providing an 
opportunity to help shape the future of 
the business at a strategic level on ESG 
matters. The ESG Champions report back 
to their respective teams which ensures 
an element of alignment on ESG related 
issues throughout the business. The ESG 
Champions were invited to participate at the 
four Committee meetings held during the 
financial year ended 29 February 2024. 
By strengthening our governance, 
we continue to accelerate efforts to 
mitigate climate change risks and identify 
opportunities for transitioning to be a 
carbon neutral business by 2050. Full 
details on the work undertaken on TCFD 
during FY2024 can be found on pages 42 
to 52.
Protecting our environment remains an 
integral part of the Company’s strategy. 
For this reason, an environmental target 
was put forward to the Committee during 
FY2024 and approved by the Remuneration 
Committee. An environmental target also 
forms part of the performance conditions 
of the Awards granted in 2023 under the 
Long-Term Incentive Plan (‘LTIP’). More 
details can be found in the Remuneration 
Committee Report on pages 136 to 163. 
An impact materiality assessment 
exercise, in line with the Global Reporting 
Initiative, was completed in 2022/2023 to 
ensure that the Company’s ESG priorities 
remain aligned with the views of our 
key stakeholders. During 2024, we will 
conduct a Double Materiality Assessment 
to strengthen the Company’s response to 
ESG regulations, such as the Corporate 
Sustainability Reporting Directive, our 
reporting efforts in line with TCFD, while 
ensuring that the ESG matters of most 
importance to stakeholders are captured 
accurately and part of the Committee’s 
deliberations. Third-party ratings, including 
the Group’s current AA rating under the 
MSCI Index, were taken into account to 
determine impact materiality. 
The Committee review ESG KPIs as a 
standing agenda item at each meeting. 
In FY2024 the Group was granted limited 
assurance, as defined by International 
Standards on Assurance Engagements 
on 3 of our ESG KPIs, Scope 1 and 2 
Emissions, Water Intensity Ratio and H&S 
Lost Time Incidents, as included in two 
financial exercises. This limited assurance 
exercise will be repeated and extended to 
include our Scope 3 Supplier Engagement 
Target in FY2025.
A key element of our ESG strategy is to 
enhance the wellbeing of our employees 
and foster a diverse, inclusive and equitable 
workforce. You can read more about 
this and the work of the ERGs in our 
Sustainability Report on page 79 as well 
as the details on the Board’s engagement 
with the workforce on page 8. The strength 
of our team is our most valuable asset and 
we are committed to creating an open and 
inclusive culture, which enables all of our 
people to thrive, and to promote diversity, 
equity and inclusion (‘DE&I’) to ensure we 
have a balanced pipeline of talent for the 
future. 
We continue to embed our DE&I agenda 
and our Head of Talent Management 
and Employee Engagement presented 
our two-year strategic plan to the ESG 
Board Committee during the year. You can 
read more about this in our Sustainability 
Environmental, Social and Governance Committee Report
(continued)
124
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Report on pages 59 to 89 and in our 
Nomination Committee Report on pages 
127 to 135. You can also read more about 
our new people policies that have been 
implemented in relation to parental leave on 
page 85 of the Sustainability Report and 
the policies can be found on our website at 
candcgroupplc.com.
In terms of community engagement, in 
August 2023, the Group announced an 
extension of our long running association 
with Inner City Enterprise (ICE), the 
Dublin-based not-for-profit charity which 
champions unemployed people to set up 
their own business, social enterprises and 
entrepreneurship. The partnership aims to 
support the delivery of specialised training 
and mentorship programmes, through 
one-to-one sessions and group workshops, 
enabling young people, refugees and 
migrants across Ireland to gain valuable 
personal development, business set-up and 
entrepreneurial skills. 
The Board is committed to treating all 
stakeholders in every area of our business 
with honesty, fairness, openness, 
engagement and respect, and to 
conducting all business ethically and safely. 
The Group will only work with parties that 
share these values. Our Code of Conduct 
(‘our Code’) sets out our expectations 
for how we do business, clarifying our 
commitments to ethical, social and 
environmental performance. Our ESG 
policies support our Code and it can be 
found at candcgroupplc.com.
The Roles and Responsibilities of the 
Committee were reviewed this year in light 
of the new ESG Management Committee 
and these can be found below. 
The Group’s reporting under TCFD in 
respect of the financial year ended 29 
February 2024 can be found on pages 
42 to 52. The ESG Board Committee will 
receive updates from the ESG Management 
Committee on how the outputs from 
the TCFD review process are being 
implemented across the business as well as 
the development of TCFD reporting in the 
future.
Year Ahead
Looking forward, the Committee will 
continue to challenge the business 
proactively to tackle the sustainability 
topics relevant to our stakeholders and 
ensure the right processes are in place to 
mitigate climate-related risks and identify 
opportunities, as we journey towards 
becoming a carbon neutral business. In 
recognising the importance of keeping 
abreast of new developments, further 
training will be delivered to the Board during 
FY2025 via the delivery of virtual workshops 
on ESG matters from an external provider. 
Roles and Responsibilities of the 
Committee
Role of the Committee 
The Committee is required to:-
•	 Provide oversight on behalf of the Board 
in relation to the Group’s ESG matters, 
and ensure that they are aligned with and 
integrated into broader business purpose 
and strategy;
•	 Review the policies, programmes, 
practices and initiatives of the Group 
relating to ESG matters, including 
environmental concerns, ensuring they 
remain effective and up to date;
•	 Provide oversight of the Group’s 
management of compliance with legal 
and regulatory requirements, including 
applicable rules and principles of 
corporate governance, and applicable 
industry standards;
•	 Report on these matters to the 
Board and, where appropriate, make 
recommendations to the Board; and
•	 Report as required to Shareholders of the 
Company on the activities and remit of 
the Committee. 
No member of the Committee nor any other 
Director participates in discussions or votes 
concerning their own election/re-election or 
evaluation of their own performance. Details 
of the skills and experience of the Directors 
are contained in the Directors’ biographies 
on pages 92 and 93. Their remuneration is 
set out in the Remuneration Report.
The quorum necessary for the transaction 
of business by the Committee is two, 
of whom one must be a Non-Executive 
Director. Only members of the Committee 
have the right to attend Committee 
meetings. The Committee Secretary is the 
Deputy Company Secretary.
Meeting Frequency 
The Committee met on four occasions 
during the financial year ended 29 February 
2024. All members of the Committee 
attended each meeting. At the invitation 
of the Committee, all Board members, the 
Company Secretary and Group General 
Counsel, Deputy Company Secretary, Head 
of ESG, Group Engineering Manager, ESG 
Analyst, and ESG Champions were invited 
to attend all meetings. 
External ESG ratings 
The Committee was pleased to note the 
positive ratings from independent analysts.
MSCI
AA
CDP
B Climate / C Water
Sustainalytics
27.3 (Medium)
Committee Performance Review
The performance review of the Committee 
was completed as part of the FY2024 
Board Performance Review. Based on the 
review the Committee concluded that it was 
operating effectively in line with its Term 
of Reference. An explanation of how this 
process was conducted, the conclusions 
arising from it and the action items 
identified is set out on pages 105 to 106. 
The Committee has considered this in the 
context of the matters that are applicable to 
the Committee.
125
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Outputs from Committee 
Performance Review for 2023/24 
•	 Continue to improve how the Committee 
keeps what it does under review and 
have an annual refresh in light of internal 
and external developments.
•	 Provide more data. 
Actions from 2022/23 Committee 
Performance Review
•	 Committee reviewed the work of the ESG 
Committee and streamlined the Terms of 
Reference in light of the implementation 
of an ESG Management Committee and 
working collaboratively with the Chairs of 
the other Committees.
•	 Increased DE&I data received.
With Board level commitment to ESG, an 
ESG Management Committee made up of 
colleagues across all functions, a dedicated 
ESG team, and a group of ESG Champions 
advocating across the business, we are 
delivering on our promise of embedding 
ESG into everything we do. I am very much 
looking forward to helping drive forward 
our ESG strategic goals in my role Chair of 
the ESG Board Committee and with C&C’s 
leadership and governance framework I am 
confident this will ensure the business is 
well equipped to continue on our journey of 
delivering on our sustainability strategy. 
If you wish to discuss any aspects of the 
ESG Board Committee activities with me 
then please do so either at the forthcoming 
AGM, on 15 August 2024 or via the email 
that we have for engagement with our 
Shareholders at AGM2024@candcgroup.
com
This report was approved by the Board of 
Directors on 27 June 2024.
Find out more 
The full responsibilities of the Committee are set out in its 
Terms of Reference, which are available on our website 
candcgroupplc.com/corporate-governance/terms-of-reference/.
Environmental, Social and Governance Committee Report
(continued)
Sarah Newbitt
Chair of the ESG Board Committee
126
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Dear Shareholder
On behalf of the Board, 
I present the Nomination 
Committee (‘the Committee’) 
Report covering the work 
of the Committee during 
FY2024 and post year end. 
This report provides an 
overview of the Committee’s 
activities in the year under 
review and looks ahead to 
our anticipated activities in 
the coming year.
Year in Review
The last 18 months have been marked by 
a number of changes to the composition of 
the Board and our Executive Management 
team. The Committee’s major areas of 
focus in FY2023 were related to succession 
planning for its Executive and Non-
Executive Directors, alongside the ongoing 
focus on ensuring the effectiveness of 
the Board through the appointment of 
Directors with the appropriate balance of 
skills, gender, diversity and experiences. 
In May 2023, the Board announced the 
appointment of Patrick McMahon to the role 
of Chief Executive Officer (‘CEO’), following 
his four-year tenure as CFO of the Group. 
On 6 June this year, Patrick McMahon 
stepped down as CEO and as a Director 
with immediate effect. The Board and 
the Committee triggered its contingency 
succession plan to ensure continuity of 
leadership, recommended for approval 
Ralph Findlay’s appointment as CEO with 
immediate effect.  It is expected that Ralph 
will perform the role of CEO for 12 to 18 
months to ensure stability within the senior 
leadership team and execution of strategy, 
while combining this role with his position 
as Chair of the Board. The precise duration 
of Ralph’s tenure as CEO will depend on 
the timing of the recruitment of a long-term 
successor as CEO.  On 6 June 2024 Ralph 
stepped down as Chair of the Nomination 
Committee and I was appointed to this 
position.  As Chair of the Committee, I will 
lead the process to recruit a new long-term 
CEO which will commence in the autumn.
On behalf of the Committee, I would like to 
thank Patrick for his significant contribution 
to the Company over many years. While 
we regret to see a long-standing member 
of our leadership team leave the business, 
we believe the Company is well positioned 
to continue to implement its established 
strategy and deliver value for Shareholders. 
Board and Committee changes
Alongside the appointment of the new CEO, 
the Committee has been focused on the 
refreshment of the Board. During the year, we 
were pleased to announce the appointments 
of Angela Bromfield and Sarah Newbitt, 
who joined us in July 2023 and August 2023 
respectively. I was delighted to be appointed 
to the Board in October 2023. These 
Directors are strong additions to the Board, 
bringing diverse thoughts, experience, 
alternative perspectives, and complimentary 
experience to the Board and its discussions.
At the conclusion of the 2023 AGM, 
Angela took on the role of Chair of the 
Remuneration Committee following Helen 
Pitcher’s decision to step down from the 
Board at the conclusion of the 2023 AGM. 
Angela’s appointment followed a thorough 
evaluation and succession process led 
by the Committee in conjunction with an 
independent search firm, Warren & Partners. 
Angela brings wide business strategy, 
communications, and marketing experience 
to the Board, together with significant 
experience as an Independent Director and 
as Remuneration Committee Chair at several 
UK listed companies. 
Nomination Committee Report
Membership and Attendance
The following Non-Executive Directors served on the Nomination Committee during 
FY2024.
Member
Member Since
Number of 
Scheduled
Meetings 
Attended
Number of 
Unscheduled 
Meetings 
Attended
Chris Browne (Chair) 1
5 December 2023
1/1
1/1
Ralph Findlay2
7 July 2022
6/6
1/1
Angela Bromfield
5 December 2023
1/1
1/1
Vincent Crowley3
1 June 2019
5/6
0/1
Helen Pitcher4
23 October 2019
2/2
n/a
1. 	 Chris Browne was appointed Chair of the Nomination Committee on 6 June 2024.
2.	 Ralph Findlay stepped down as Chair of the Nomination Committee on 6 June 2024.
3.	 Vincent Crowley did not attend the scheduled Nomination Committee meeting on 7 February 2024 and the 
unscheduled Nomination Committee meeting on 14 February 2024 where SID succession was discussed.
4.	 Helen Pitcher stepped down from the Board and Nomination Committee on 13 July 2023.
127
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Sarah’s, and my own, appointment to the 
Board followed a thorough evaluation and 
succession process led by the Committee 
in conjunction with an independent 
search firm, Odgers Berndtson. Sarah 
has extensive consumer goods sector 
and supply chain expertise, together with 
developing and implementing sustainability 
strategies, while I bring vast experience 
managing complex consumer-facing 
operations to C&C. It was in this context, 
the Committee announced on 22 May 2024, 
that Sarah would be replacing Vineet Bhalla 
as Chair of the ESG Committee effective 
from 22 May 2024. 
In summary, as at December 2023, the 
Committee had recommended the following 
changes to the composition of the Board 
and its Committees:
•	 Angela Bromfield was appointed as a 
member of the Nomination Committee 
and Chair of the Remuneration 
Committee
•	 I was appointed as a member of the 
Nomination and ESG Committees;
•	 Sarah Newbitt was appointed as a 
member of the ESG Committee;
•	 Vineet Bhalla, stepped down as a 
member of the Audit Committee;
•	 John Gibney, was appointed as a 
member of the Remuneration Committee; 
and
•	 Jill Caseberry, was appointed as a 
member of the Audit Committee and 
stepped down as a member of the ESG 
Committee. 
During the year, an internal search for a 
new Senior Independent Director was 
initiated by the Committee as Vincent 
Crowley announced, on 14 February 
2024, his decision to step down from the 
Board at the 2024 AGM, having served 
for almost nine years on the Board and as 
Senior Independent Director. As Chair of 
the Board and the Nomination Committee 
at the time, Ralph Findlay consulted 
with all Board members to understand 
their views on potential candidates, and 
following a thorough internal process, with 
due consideration to my other external 
commitments, independence, expertise, 
and personal attributes the Committee 
was delighted to recommend to the Board 
my appointment as Senior Independent 
Director and Employee Engagement 
Non-Executive Director with effect from 
15 February 2024.  The Board would like 
to thank Vincent for his dedication to C&C 
and his significant contribution to the Board 
as a Non-Executive Director and as Senior 
Independent Director has been invaluable. 
On behalf of the Company and the Board, 
we wish Vincent all the best for the future.
Succession and leadership capability
The Committee consistently reviews the 
composition of the Company’s Executive 
Management team, its development and 
succession planning. The Committee has 
overseen the significant changes across 
its Executive Management team that have 
taken place since May 2023, with the 
appointment of Patrick McMahon as CEO 
of the Group, followed by the appointment 
of our new CFO Andrew Andrea. On 7 
June 2024, it was announced that Patrick 
stepped down from this role and from 
the Board of Directors on 6 June 2024. 
To ensure continuity and stability of the 
Executive Management team, Ralph Findlay 
was immediately appointed as CEO of the 
Group. Ralph will remain in post until the 
appointment of a new Executive Director, 
while continuing his work as Chair of the 
Board. To avoid any potential conflict of 
interests, Ralph did not participate in the 
Committee’s deliberations regarding his 
appointment as CEO. The unanimous 
view of the Board was that the interests of 
C&C’s employees, Shareholders and wider 
stakeholders would be best served by this 
leadership structure through the near- term. 
The Board, under the leadership of the 
Committee and its new Chair, and with the 
support of the appropriate external advisors 
will be commencing a recruitment process 
for Patrick’s replacement in the autumn. He 
has agreed to remain with the Group until 
the end of September 2024, to ensure a 
smooth transition and support the Board 
during this period of change. Upon the 
appointment of a new CEO, Ralph will revert 
to his position as Non-Executive Chair of 
the Board.
On 1 March 2024, we were delighted to 
announce the appointment of Andrew 
Andrea as CFO of the Group. Andrew’s 
appointment followed the completion of a 
rigorous recruitment process undertaken 
by the Committee in conjunction with 
an independent executive search firm, 
Spencer Stuart. Andrew brings a rare 
depth of experience within our industry to 
the business and to our Board, and we are 
delighted to welcome him to C&C. As we 
continue to focus on building C&C as the 
premium drinks and distribution business in 
the UK and Irish markets, Andrew will bring 
invaluable expertise and insight to our team 
and to help us deliver on that ambition. 
The changes to our Board reflect the 
importance of an ongoing focus on 
succession planning for the Board and 
throughout the organisation. This includes 
understanding the steps taken to develop 
talent from within C&C, as well as overseeing 
promotions and changes made within 
the Group Executive Committee towards 
ensuring the most appropriate balance 
of skills to support the execution of our 
strategy. In the last two years, we have seen 
a significant number of changes across our 
leadership team. While we understand these 
changes constitute natural occurrences 
to the management of a business, as we 
prepare for the recruitment of our new 
CEO, the Board and the Committee remain 
focused on appointing an Executive who will 
drive the business forward, aligned with our 
long-term objectives. 
Board Diversity, Skills and Effectiveness
As a global business, serving a diverse 
client base, diversity and inclusion are 
central to how we operate. The Board, 
and the Committee recognise the 
importance of diversity at all levels of the 
organisation, as they promote balanced 
decision-making with consideration to 
the wider strategy of the business. When 
reviewing the composition of the Board, 
the Committee will consider all aspects 
of diversity, including, but not limited to 
gender, ethnicity, background, skills and 
experiences. The Committee also ensures 
that all appointments are made on a shared 
understanding of merit, with consideration to 
the Board’s diversity objectives. 
I am pleased to confirm that the current 
composition of the Board meets the 
expectations of the FCA’s Listing Rules. 
Gender diversity on the Board is currently at 
44%, whereby four of the nine directors on 
Nomination Committee Report
(continued)
128
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

the Board are women. My appointment 
to the role of Senior Independent Director 
and Employee Engagement Non-
Executive Director earlier this year, has 
improved the gender balance across 
the senior Board positions (Chair, CEO, 
CFO, or Senior Independent Director), a 
key expectation of the FCA rules. We are 
also in line with the expectations of the 
Parker Review and the FCA guidance, 
regarding the appointment of at least 
one Board member from a minority 
ethnic background. We are also mindful 
of the additional voluntary expectations 
of the Parker Review to set a target for 
the representation on ethnic diversity 
for the Executive Management team for 
December 2027. 
Board effectiveness
The performance review of the 
Committee was completed as part of 
the 2024 internal Board Performance 
Review. The overall conclusion from this 
year’s Performance Review was that the 
Committee continues to work effectively 
and is operating appropriately in line with 
its Terms of Reference. 
An explanation of how this process was 
conducted, the conclusions arising from 
it and the action items identified is set out 
on pages 105 to 106. The Committee 
has considered this in the context of 
the matters that are applicable to the 
Committee.
Since joining the C&C Board, I continue 
to be impressed by the strength and 
resilience of our business, and the 
commitment to the long-term strategy 
across all levels of the organisation. The 
agility and resilience of our employees 
has been impressive, as they continue 
to deliver for all our customers in spite of 
challenges and changes impacting our 
business. 
Chris Browne, OBE
Nomination Committee Chair
27 June 2024
Roles and Responsibilities of the 
Committee
Role of the Committee 
The Committee is responsible for Board 
recruitment and conducts a continuous 
and proactive process of planning and 
assessment, considering the Board’s 
composition against the Group’s strategic 
priorities and the main trends and factors 
affecting the long-term success and future 
viability of the Group. The Committee’s 
key objective is to ensure that the Board 
comprises individuals with the necessary 
skills, knowledge, experience and diversity 
to ensure that the Board is effective in 
discharging its responsibilities and that 
appropriate succession arrangements 
are in place. The Committee has defined 
Terms of Reference which can be found in 
the Investor Centre section of the Group’s 
website at candcgroupplc.com/corporate-
governance/terms-of-reference.
The Committee is responsible for leading 
a formal, rigorous and transparent process 
for the appointment of new Directors to the 
Board and ensuring that plans are in place 
for orderly succession to the Board and 
senior management positions.
The process for making new appointments 
to the Board is usually led by the Chair, 
except when the Committee is dealing with 
the Board Chair succession. Given that 
the Chair has also been appointed as CEO 
until a long-term successor is appointed, 
the search for that successor will be led by 
myself, Chair of the Nomination Committee, 
and Senior Independent Director of 
the Board.  When considering new 
appointments, all recommendations to the 
Board are made on merit against objective 
criteria which take into account experience, 
skills and ensuring an appropriate 
diversity, in the broadest sense, in the 
resulting membership of the Board. Time 
commitment, independence and potential 
conflicts of interest are considered before 
any recommendation is made to the Board. 
Any candidates who are shortlisted are 
interviewed by the Board Chair, Committee 
Chair and members, other Directors 
and the Company Secretary and Group 
General Counsel. The Board is updated 
on the progress of the selection process 
and receives recommendations from the 
Committee for appointment.
Board Independence
Having undertaken a performance 
evaluation of both the Board and individual 
Directors, the Committee considered the 
independence of each of the Non-Executive 
Directors, each of them having confirmed 
their willingness to stand for election or re-
election at the forthcoming AGM, with the 
exception of Vincent Crowley. In assessing 
their independence, the Committee has 
had due regard to various matters which 
might affect, or appear to affect, the 
independence of certain of the Directors. 
The Committee had particular regard to 
the products purchased from St Austell 
Brewery Company Limited, where Jill 
Caseberry is also a Non-Executive Director. 
The Committee remains fully satisfied this 
relationship is not material and has in no 
way impaired her independence. Except 
for the Board Chair, all members of the 
Committee are and were, throughout the 
year under review, considered by the Board 
to be wholly independent. 
No member of the Committee nor any 
other Director participates in discussions 
concerning or votes on their own re-election 
or evaluation of their own performance. 
Details of the skills and experience of the 
Directors are contained in the Directors’ 
biographies on pages 92 and 93. Their 
remuneration is set out in the Directors’ 
Remuneration Committee Report on pages 
136 to 163.
The quorum necessary for the transaction 
of business by the Committee is two, each 
of whom must be a Non-Executive Director. 
Only members of the Committee have the 
right to attend Committee meetings. The 
Company Secretary and Group General 
Counsel is Secretary to the Committee.
Meeting Frequency and Main 
Activities during the year
The Committee met on seven occasions, 
one meeting was unscheduled, during the 
year ended 29 February 2024. All members 
of the Committee attended each meeting. 
At the invitation of the Committee, Board 
members were invited to all meetings, 
129
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

as well as the Group Director of Human 
Resources, the Deputy Company Secretary 
and the Senior Assistant Company 
Secretary were invited to attend meetings.
Set out below is a summary of the main 
activities of the Committee in the year.
Remuneration Committee Chair 
Appointment
The previous Chair of the Remuneration 
Committee stepped down from her role at 
the conclusion of the 2023 AGM following 
her appointment as chair of the Judicial 
Appointments Commission. A selection 
process for a new Remuneration Chair was 
led by the Chair, and the Committee, with 
assistance from the Company Secretary 
and Group General Counsel. 
The services of an Executive search firm 
were used to identify potential candidates. 
The Committee considered the credentials 
of several search consultants before 
recommending the appointment of Warren 
& Partners, which is a signatory to the 
voluntary code of conduct for executive 
search firms. Warren & Partners does not 
have any connection to the Group or with 
individual Directors. 
The Company did not use open advertising 
to search for suitable candidates for the 
role as we believe that the optimal way 
of recruiting for this position is to use 
targeted recruitment based on the skills and 
experience required. 
As an initial step, the Committee agreed a 
role profile with Warren & Partners, which 
referred to the following characteristics and 
experience:
•	 Experience as a Remuneration 
Committee Chair;
•	 Plc experience and an understanding 
of the UK corporate governance 
environment;
•	 Broad sector experience; and
•	 A positive match with the culture of the 
Group and the members of the Board.
The search from Warren & Partners 
was rigorous in its scope, given the 
significant importance of remuneration-
related considerations in the success 
and reputation of our business, and 
its importance to shareholders. The 
Committee considered an extensive list 
of potential candidates, both internally 
and externally, with the skills, knowledge 
and experience required. The candidates 
included in the initial list for the Committee 
were of diverse backgrounds in its widest 
sense (gender, nationality, age, experience 
and social backgrounds). The Committee 
unanimously selected Angela Bromfield 
as its preferred candidate. Angela brings 
wide business strategy, communications, 
and marketing experience to the Board, 
together with significant experience as an 
Independent Director and as Remuneration 
Committee Chair at several UK listed 
companies. 
Following the Committee’s recommendation 
and due consideration by the Board, 
Angela Bromfield was appointed our new 
Remuneration Chair and joined the Board at 
the conclusion of the 2023 AGM. The Board 
is pleased to have recruited an individual 
with her experience and expertise to chair 
the Remuneration Committee.
Other Board Changes
At the conclusion of the 2023 AGM, Jim 
Thompson stepped down from his position 
as a Non-Executive Director and Vineet 
Bhalla succeeded Jim Thompson as Chair 
of the ESG Committee in July 2023 and 
due to time constraints related to external 
commitments, Vineet subsequently stepped 
down as Chair of the ESG Committee and 
Sarah Newbitt succeeded him as Chair of 
the ESG Committee in May 2024. 
A second recruitment process was 
launched to facilitate the appointment 
of additional Non-Executive Directors 
in support of the Board’s succession 
plans and the Group’s strategic aims. 
The Committee was also mindful of the 
FCA’s Listing Rule which sets a target of 
40% female Board membership of listed 
companies. The selection process was 
led by the Chair of the Board, and the 
Committee, with assistance from the 
Company Secretary and Group General 
Counsel.
 
The services of an Executive search firm 
were used to identify potential candidates. 
The Committee considered the credentials 
of several search consultants before 
recommending the appointment of Odgers 
Berndtson, which is a signatory to the 
Enhanced Voluntary Code of Conduct for 
Executive search firms. Odgers Berndtson 
does not have any connection to the Group 
or with individual Directors. 
The Company did not use open advertising 
to search for suitable candidates for the 
role as we believe that the optimal way 
of recruiting for this position is to use 
targeted recruitment based on the skills and 
experience required. 
As an initial step, the Committee agreed a 
role profile with Odgers Berndtson, which 
referred to the following characteristics and 
experience:
•	 Experience managing complex 
distribution operations, whether gained 
within a logistics operator or running 
a significant distribution network for a 
consumer business;
•	 Experience of building premium brands 
within the food and drinks industry was 
highly relevant; and
•	 Familiarity with the governance 
requirements of a listed business, ideally 
with prior plc board exposure. 
This opportunity applied equally to those 
seeking their first complementary Non-
Executive board role, as well as someone 
established in a plural career.
The search from Odgers Berndston was 
rigorous in its scope. The Committee 
considered an extensive list of potential 
candidates, both internally and externally, 
with the skills, knowledge and experience 
required. The candidates included in 
the initial list for the Committee were of 
diverse backgrounds in its widest sense 
(gender, nationality, age, experience and 
social backgrounds). The Committee 
unanimously selected Sarah Newbitt and 
myself as its preferred candidates. Sarah 
brings extensive consumer goods sector 
and supply chain expertise, together with 
developing and implementing sustainability 
strategies. Chris brings vast experience 
Nomination Committee Report
(continued)
130
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

managing complex consumer-facing 
operations to C&C.
Following the Committee’s recommendation 
and due consideration by the Board, 
Sarah Newbitt and I were appointed Non-
Executive Directors and joined the Board in 
August 2023 and October 2023 respectively 
and undertook a full Board induction 
programme following our appointments. 
Following the Non-Executive Director 
appointments, in December 2023 the 
Committee led a review of the membership 
of the Board’s Committees. Board 
Committee membership is reviewed 
regularly to maintain an optimum 
combination of skills, experience, 
knowledge and diversity to enable effective 
governance and decision making. The 
Committee recommended changes to each 
Committee’s composition.
Additionally, the Committee recommended 
that Sarah Newbitt and I be appointed as 
Employee Engagement Non-Executive 
Directors to understand and communicate 
employee’s views back to the Board, which 
are then considered in our decision-making.
Finally, during the year under review, 
an internal search for a new Senior 
Independent Director was initiated by the 
Committee, with Vincent Crowley having 
decided to step down from the Board at the 
2024 AGM after serving almost nine years 
on the Board. Following a thorough internal 
process, the Committee was delighted to 
recommend to the Board my appointment 
as Senior Independent Director with effect 
from 15 February 2024. As previously noted, 
following the end of FY2024, further Board 
changes were announced on 7 June 2024 
as described in more detail above.
CFO Appointment
In December we announced the 
appointment of Andrew Andrea as Chief 
Financial Officer (‘CFO’). Andrew joined C&C 
as CFO and Executive Director on 1 March 
2024.
Andrew’s appointment followed the 
completion of a rigorous recruitment 
process undertaken by the Committee 
in conjunction with an independent 
search firm, Spencer Stuart. Andrew is 
a drinks industry veteran having served 
in senior roles at Marston’s plc, a leading 
independent brewing and pub retailing 
business in the UK, for over 20 years. 
Andrew brings a rare depth of experience 
within our industry to C&C and we are 
delighted to welcome him to the business. 
We continue to focus on building C&C 
as the premium drinks and distribution 
business in the UK and Irish markets. 
Andrew brings invaluable expertise and 
insight to our team and this will help us 
deliver on that ambition.
Since appointment, Andrew has undertaken 
a full Board induction programme. The 
induction programme for Andrew Andrea 
has included meetings with senior 
management and operational and functional 
teams around the Group and has been 
structured to help Andrew gain an insight 
into how the business works on a day-to-
day basis and to understand its strategic 
priorities, purpose, culture, values and 
people. 
Since joining, Andrew has held a series of 
meetings including one-to-one sessions 
with Board colleagues, senior management, 
business unit and functional heads and 
has also undertaken visits to key locations 
in the Group. These visits gave Andrew an 
opportunity to meet with local management 
teams and other colleagues and to speak 
with them first hand and to listen to their 
views. Following the year end, Andrew has 
also overseen the 2024 Annual Report and 
Accounts process to its conclusion and 
the appointment of additional experienced 
technical resources and capabilities into the 
finance function. 
Succession Planning
The Board plans for its own succession, 
with the support of the Committee. The 
Committee remains focused, on behalf of 
the Board, on succession planning for both 
Executive and Non-Executive Directors.
The Committee aims to ensure that:
•	 the succession pipeline for senior 
executive and business critical roles in 
the organisation is strong and diverse;
•	 processes are in place to identify 
potential successors and manage 
succession actively;
•	 there is a structured approach to 
developing and preparing possible 
successors; and
•	 processes are in place to identify “at risk” 
posts.
In order to ensure that there are effective 
succession plans in place for the 
Group Executive Committee and senior 
management, the Board has visibility of 
a wide range of colleagues who have 
been identified as potential succession 
candidates in the short, medium and long-
term. In light of Patrick McMahon stepping 
down from his role the Board determined 
that the appointment of the Chair of the 
Board as CEO for an expected period 
of 12-18 months represented the most 
appropriate move to ensure stability and 
continuity at the leadership level through the 
near-term.
Developing C&C’s diverse pipeline of 
internal talent, and the organisation’s ability 
to attract, retain and develop skilled, high 
potential individuals is a focus of discussion. 
To that end, individuals identified in the 
talent pipeline are provided with the 
opportunity to interact with Board members 
both informally and through attendance at 
Board and Committee meetings to present 
on specialist topics. This not only provides 
valuable experience and exposure for 
those individuals to the Board, but also 
assists the Board when assessing the 
strength of succession plans in place and 
areas of development needed for relevant 
individuals. In FY2024, a number of Group 
Executive Committee members and senior 
management were invited to present to 
the Board and its Committees on topics 
pertaining to C&C’s strategic priorities, 
financials and ESG. Opportunities for 
interactions outside of the Board meeting 
calendar were also pursued and developed. 
This will continue to be an area of focus 
during FY2025 and beyond. 
131
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Separately, on at least an annual basis, 
each Director’s intentions are discussed 
regarding continued service on the Board 
and their succession is considered in the 
context of the composition of the overall 
Board and the corporate governance 
guidance on Non-Executive tenure. This 
transparency allows for an open discussion 
about succession for each individual, both 
for short term emergency absences as well 
as longer term plans.
As in previous years, we conducted an 
analysis of the balance of experience, 
skills, gender and diversity on the Board 
as a whole, taking account of the future 
needs of the business in the light of the 
business strategy, the Board changes set 
out above, and the knowledge, experience, 
length of service and performance of the 
Directors, including their ability to continue 
to contribute effectively to the Board. In 
accordance with our policy, we also had 
regard to the requirement to achieve a 
diversity of characters, backgrounds, 
experience and gender amongst Board 
members. The Board skills matrix can be 
found on page 135.
Board Induction
When a new Board member joins 
the Company, they receive a formal, 
comprehensive and tailored induction 
designed to suit their individual needs 
and their role. The induction programme 
includes activities and meetings with key 
members of the senior management team, 
technical meetings and site visits. This is 
an effective way of introducing them to the 
Group’s culture and of ensuring that they 
have the information and support they need 
to understand the business and to enable 
them to be productive in their role.
Following their appointments, Angela, 
Sarah, Andrew and I, each completed 
an extensive induction programme, 
designed to help us understand the role 
and responsibilities of a Director at C&C, 
enabling us to provide an effective and 
constructive challenge to the Board and 
develop a thorough understanding of the 
C&C business.
Nomination Committee Report
(continued)
Diversity
As a people focused business, our strength comes from an inclusive and welcoming 
environment, where we recognise that the experiences and perspectives which make us 
unique come together in our shared values and vision. We strongly believe that the more 
our colleagues reflect the diversity of our clients and consumers, the better equipped we 
are to service their needs.
In FY2024, the Board adopted a Board Diversity Policy. The Board Diversity Policy applies 
to the Board and its Committees and acknowledges the importance of diversity in its 
broadest sense as a key element of Board effectiveness, it can be found on our website at 
candcgroupplc.com/policies-and-terms/corporate-governance-documents/.
The purpose of the Board Diversity Policy is to set out the approach to diversity for the 
Board itself and for its Committees with the intention of supporting the succession planning 
work of the Committee in creating and maintaining the appropriate Board and Committee 
composition. The Board and senior management believe diversity is key to providing the 
right blend of perspectives and insights required to meet our purpose and strategy.
Board Diversity Policy Measurable Targets as at 29 February 2024
Board Diversity Policy Measurable Targets
Target Achieved
At least 40% of the Board are women.
Yes 
As at 29 February 2024, 
four out of nine Directors 
(44%) are women.
The Board should have female representation across 
at least one of the roles of Chair, Senior Independent 
Director, Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial 
Officer.
Yes 
One position is held by a 
woman (SID). 
The Board should have at least one person from an 
ethnic minority background. 
Yes
As at 29 February 2024, 
one out of nine Directors 
(11%) is from a minority 
ethnic background.
The Board should consider candidates for appointments 
as Non-Executive Directors from a wider pool, including 
those with little or no previous FTSE Board experience.
Yes
One Non-Executive Director 
was appointed with no 
previous FTSE Board 
experience.
Engage only Executive search firms who understand 
C&C’s values and approach to diversity and are best 
placed to deliver a diverse pool of candidates that 
are aligned with our strategy. This will be achieved by 
engaging only with firms that have signed up to the 
Voluntary Code of Conduct and Enhanced Voluntary 
Code of Conduct.
Yes
The Board engaged with 
Odgers Berndtson, Warren 
& Partners and Spencer 
Stuart.
In line with new Listing Rule disclosure requirements, more detailed information relating to 
the gender and ethnic diversity of C&C Group’s Board and Group Executive Committee 
members can be found in the table below. The data is provided in the form specified under 
Listing Rule 9.8.6I(10) and was collected directly from the individuals concerned in line 
with our Data Protection Policy and approval was given for it to be published in the Annual 
Report.
132
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

As at 29 February 2024, the Board 
complied with the aforementioned Listing 
Rule, the FTSE for Women Review and met 
the Parker Review recommendations, as it 
has done since 2021. In addition, three of 
the Board Committees now comprise 50% 
female Board Directors and the position 
of Chair of each of the Remuneration, 
Nomination and ESG Committee is held by 
a woman. 
As at the date of this Report we have also 
improved the gender diversity balance 
across the Group Executive Committee, 
having recently appointed women to the 
roles of Chief Marketing Officer, Chief 
People Officer and Chief Technology 
Officer.
The Board leads in fostering a healthy and 
supportive corporate culture by setting 
the tone from the top. The Board Diversity 
Policy sits alongside the C&C Group wide 
Diversity, Inclusion and Wellbeing Policy, 
Code of Conduct, and associated policies, 
which set out our broader commitment to 
DE&I.
We aim to ensure our inclusivity applies 
to all aspects of their careers, including 
recruitment, selection, benefits and 
opportunities for training and promotion. 
Our vision is to be an employer of choice, 
with a rich and diverse mix of people who 
reflect the societies and communities in 
which we work and operate. C&C is a great 
place to work and our policy reinforces 
our commitment to equity, diversity and 
inclusion and to having a truly representative 
workforce where every member feels 
respected, valued and able to be their best. 
We want to ensure that equity, diversity and 
inclusion is a core part of how we operate, 
it’s embedded in our culture, and reflected 
in our people and their behaviours. 
Diversity across the wider workforce
In FY2023 we established Employee 
Resource Groups (‘ERGs’), the DE&I ERG 
is one of a number of intended concrete 
and meaningful steps to reinforce our 
commitment to diversity and inclusion. The 
DE&I, ERG consists of employees from 
across the Group and it met regularly during 
FY2024, gave a presentation to the Group 
Executive Committee on progress to-date 
and engaged with our employees to mark 
cultural and diversity related events during 
the year. The work of the DE&I ERG is 
reported to the ESG Board Committee. 
We are committed to:-
•	 Reviewing and adapting our policies and 
procedures to ensure workforce diversity 
and equal opportunities;
•	 Implementing initiatives that drive an 
inclusive culture where all employees feel 
accepted and valued;
•	 Promoting a more inclusive environment, 
which attracts all candidates and signals 
our commitment to celebrate and 
promote diversity;
•	 Taking an inclusive approach to ensure 
we attract a diverse pool of talent and 
experience;
•	 The use of clear statements which 
promote equality and inclusion within the 
recruitment process;
•	 Training our managers and wider teams 
to increase cultural diversity, awareness, 
knowledge and skills;
•	 Encouraging our people to share their 
experiences and help each other to 
understand more about what diversity 
and inclusion means; and
In line with Listing Rule 9.8.6(10), as at the reference date of 29 February 2024, the composition of the Board and Executive 
Management was as follows.
Gender Identity / Sex of Board and Group Executive members as at the reference date of 29 February 2024 
Number of Board 
Members
Percentage of the 
Board
Number of senior 
positions on the Board 
(CEO, CFO, SID and 
Chair)
Number in Executive 
Management
Percentage of Executive 
Management
Men
5
56%
3
5
100%
Women
4
44%
1
-
-
Not Specified/ Preferred not to say
-
-
-
-
-
Ethnic Background of Board and Group Executive Committee members as at the reference date of 29 February 2024
Number of Board 
Members
Percentage of the 
Board
Number of senior 
positions on the Board 
(CEO, CFO, SID and 
Chair)
Number in Executive 
Management
Percentage of Executive 
Management
White British or other White (including 
minority-white groups)
8
89%
4
5
100%
Mixed/Multiple Ethnic Groups
-
-
-
-
-
Asian/Asian British
1
11%
-
-
-
Black/African/Caribbean/Black British
-
-
-
-
-
Other ethnic group, including Arab
-
-
-
-
-
Not Specified/ Preferred not to say
-
-
-
-
-
133
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

•	 Authentically telling our diversity and 
inclusion story and celebrating our 
approach, both inside and outside our 
organisation.
Statistical gender diversity employment 
data for the Company as at 29 February 
2024 and 28 February 2023 is as follows: 
29 Feb 2024
Male 
Number/
Percentage
Female 
Number/
Percentage
Directors
5/56%
4/44%
Senior Managers
34/67%
16/33%
Other employees
2,169/75% 715/25%
28 Feb 2023
Male 
Number/
Percentage
Female 
Number/
Percentage
Directors
7/78%
2/22%
Senior Managers
58/64%
32/36%
Other employees
1,913/75%
647/25%
We support the objectives of the FTSE 
Women Leaders Review and the Parker 
Review, to increase representation of 
women and people from an ethnic minority 
on Boards and in senior management. We 
are pleased to have met these targets in 
relation to our Board composition. We are 
now working to determine an appropriate 
target for the percentage of senior 
management who self-identify as being in 
an ethnic minority. We want to ensure that 
the target we set, appropriately reflects 
the diversity of the countries our senior 
management work in and that we have 
robust and accurate data with which to 
monitor our progress against these targets, 
whilst respecting our colleagues right to 
privacy and freedom of expression.
Re-appointment of Directors
The Committee considers the selection 
and reappointment of Directors carefully 
before making a recommendation to the 
Board. The Board is conscious of the 
length of tenure of Non-Executive Directors 
when formulating its succession planning 
process. Non-Executive Directors and the 
Chair are generally appointed for a period 
of three years, which may be renewed for 
a further two terms. Notwithstanding the 
appointment of three years, in line with 
good governance practice, all Directors are 
put forward for re-election by Shareholders 
annually at the AGM providing Shareholders 
with the opportunity to express their 
confidence and support for the Board as a 
whole and each Director individually.
Balance of Skills and 
Effectiveness of the Board 
During the year, the Committee also 
considered the composition of the 
Board and each of its Committees’. The 
Committee continues to actively review the 
long-term succession planning process for 
Directors to ensure the structure, size and 
composition (including the balance of skills, 
experience, independence, knowledge 
and diversity (including gender, ethnic and 
social backgrounds)) of the Board and 
its Committees continues to be effective, 
promoting the Group’s ability to deliver its 
strategy and long-term success.  You can 
find the details on the Board skills matrix on 
page 135.
The Committee is satisfied that the Board 
has the appropriate balance of relevant 
skills, experience, independence and 
knowledge of the Group to enable it to 
discharge its duties to lead and steward the 
business. 
Directors’ Time Commitments
In line with its Terms of Reference, the 
Committee performs an annual review of 
the time required from the Chair, Senior 
Independent Director and Non-Executive 
Directors to perform their duties. As part 
of this process, the Committee reflects 
on a Director’s attendance at scheduled 
meetings and their availability at other times 
during the year. In the year under review, 
the Directors were available, often at short 
notice and outside regular working hours, 
to discuss matters that required a prompt 
decision.
During this process it was agreed that in light 
of Vineet’s other Executive role, he would 
step down as Chair of the ESG Committee 
on 22 May 2024. but would remain a member 
of the ESG and Remuneration Committees. 
As recommended by the Nomination 
Committee, the Board appointed Sarah 
Newbitt as Chair of the ESG Committee with 
effect from 22 May 2024. The Nomination 
Committee was satisfied that I was also able 
to devote sufficient time to my role as Chair 
of Nomination, Senior Independent Director 
and Employee Engagement Non-Executive 
Director notwithstanding my other external 
commitments.
The Committee is also satisfied that each 
Director continues to be able to devote 
sufficient time to their role.
Performance Review of the 
Committee and the Board
The Board is committed to transparency and 
conducts a formal and rigorous evaluation of 
its performance including the performance 
of its Committees’, individual Directors and 
the Chair annually. In accordance with the 
provisions of the UK Corporate Governance 
Code 2018, the Board also conducts an 
externally facilitated evaluation at least once 
every three years. This year the performance 
review was internally facilitated. The 
Committee’s last external performance review 
was conducted in FY2023. The Committee 
discusses the outcome of the review of its 
effectiveness annually.
For further information on the Performance 
Review of the Board, its Committees and 
individual Directors, including details of the 
performance review process, outcome and 
next steps, please refer to pages 105 and 
106.
Find out more 
The full responsibilities of the Committee are set out in its Terms 
of Reference, which are available on our website candcgroupplc.
com/corporate-governance/terms-of-reference. 
Nomination Committee Report
(continued)
134
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Diverse and 
Effective Board
The Board as at 27 June 2024, 
comprises nine Directors, with 
a broad and complementary 
range of technical skills, 
educational and professional 
experience, nationalities, 
personalities, cultures and 
perspectives to support the 
long-term success.
Board Skills Matrix
Director
Independence
Governance
Core Industry
Finance / Audit & Risk
Manufacturing / Supply Chain 
Communications / Marketing / 
Customer Service / Brands
Strategy
UK & Ireland Pubs Experience
M&A / Capital Markets
Digital / Technology AI
Sustainability / ESG
People Process and Culture Transformation
H&S
Technical / Engineering
Ralph Findlay
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Andrew Andrea
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Vineet Bhalla
•
•
•
•
•
Angela Bromfield
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Chris Browne
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Jill Caseberry
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Vincent Crowley
•
•
•
•
•
John Gibney
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Sarah Newbitt
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Board balance
Independence
Gender
diversity
Ethnicity
Age Range
51-60 
4
61-70 
5
0-3 years 
6
4-7 years 
2
8-10 years 
1
Irish 
2
British 
7
Male 
5
Female 
4
White 
8
Indian 
1
Tenure
Nationality
Chair 
1
Independent 
7
Non-independent 
1
135
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Directors’ Remuneration Committee Report
Dear Shareholder,
On behalf of the Board, the 
Directors’ Remuneration 
Committee Report for the 
year ended 29 February 
2024, my first report as Chair 
of the Committee following 
my appointment in July 2023, 
is set out below. 
Membership and Attendance
The following Non-Executive Directors served on the Remuneration Committee during the 
year:
Member
Member since
Number of meetings 
attended
Angela Bromfield (Chair)
13 July 2023
4/4
Vineet Bhalla
27 October 2021
6/6
Jill Caseberry
1 March 2019
6/6
John Gibney
6 December 2023
1/1
Helen Pitcher1
1 March 2019
2/2
1. 	 Helen Pitcher was Chair of the Committee until she stepped down from the Board following the conclusion of the 
AGM on 13 July 2023.
Business Performance FY2024
The Group’s overall performance in FY2024 
is described in the Strategic Report on 
pages 2 to 89. 
Board changes
Patrick McMahon was appointed 
CEO with effect from 19 May 2023, at 
which point his salary was increased to 
€675,000. Patrick’s salary was set c.7% 
below his predecessor’s. This reflected 
that notwithstanding Patrick’s significant 
experience, skillset and knowledge of the 
business, this was his first CEO role. Details 
of his remuneration earned in respect of 
FY2024 are included in the table on page 
137. Patrick’s salary was increased by 4% 
for FY2025, an increase in line with the 
majority of colleagues. 
As detailed on page 127, on 6 June 2024 
Patrick McMahon stepped down as the 
CEO and from the Board with immediate 
effect. Patrick's remuneration and 
severance terms are in line with his service 
agreement and the Directors' Remuneration 
Policy approved by Shareholders at the 
AGM in July 2021. Further details will be 
disclosed in the FY2025 Remuneration 
Report.  
Ralph Findlay was appointed Executive 
Chair on 19 May 2023 to support the 
management transition as Patrick retained his 
responsibilities as CFO until a new CFO was 
appointed. Ralph was paid a fee of €660,000 
for this role. As detailed on page 127, Ralph 
Findlay was subsequently appointed CEO 
with effect from 6 June 2024 in addition to 
his role as Chair of the Board at which point 
his salary was increased to €702,000 in line 
with that paid to Patrick. This salary remains 
below that of Patrick’s predecessor as CEO. 
Upon the appointment of a new CEO, Ralph 
will revert to his position as Non-Executive 
Chair of the Board. 
Andrew Andrea was appointed as CFO on 1 
March 2024. We are delighted to have been 
able to appoint someone of Andrew’s calibre 
who brings a rare depth of experience in our 
industry along with invaluable expertise and 
insight. Andrew was appointed on a salary 
of £400,000 (c. €461,000 using an FX rate 
of 0.8675 being the closing rate on 29 Feb 
2024). Further details of his remuneration 
package are summarised in the table 
overleaf. The package is in line with the 
current and new Remuneration Policies and 
takes into account his significant experience.  
There was no additional buy-out award in 
respect of forfeited remuneration in relation to 
Andrew’s recruitment.
136
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Executive remuneration outcomes 
FY2024
The FY2024 remuneration outcomes for 
the Executive Directors are set out in the 
table overleaf. In considering the outturns 
in respect of the FY2024 bonus and the 
vesting of the Long Term Incentive Plan 
(LTIP) awards granted in FY2022, in line with 
our usual practice we considered not just 
the extent to which the targets had been 
achieved on a formulaic basis, but also the 
overall experience of our stakeholders. The 
annual bonus plan for FY2024 was based 
on two financial performance measures: 
Group Operating Profit (‘GOP’) (65% of 
the opportunity); and Free Cash Flow 
Conversion (‘FCF’) (35% of the opportunity). 
On target performance for the Group 
Operating Profit target was set at €61m after 
taking into account the one-off impact of 
the ERP system disruption in FY2024. This 
was to ensure that we retained colleagues 
and that they were incentivised to achieve 
Performance Measures
Out-turn
Annual Bonus
(opportunity of up to 
125% of salary)
The annual bonus plan for FY2024 was based on two 
financial performance measures:
•	 Group Operating Profit (‘GOP’) (65% of the 
opportunity); and
•	 Free Cash Flow Conversion (‘FCF’) (35% of the 
opportunity).
Details of the bonus targets are set out on page 154.
Actual performance, as detailed on page 154 was:
•	 GOP: €60m
•	 FCF: 91%
Notwithstanding this performance, the Committee 
exercised its discretion to adjust the formulaic 
outcome of the bonus, resulting in Patrick McMahon 
earning no bonus.
LTIP awards 
vesting in respect 
of performance in 
FY2024
(granted at 150% of 
salary)
The LTIP awards granted to Executive Directors in 
FY2022 were based on three performance measures:
•	 Earnings Per Share (‘EPS’) (45% of the awards); 
•	 Free Cash Flow Conversion (‘FCF’) (35% of the 
awards); and
•	 Environmental target (20% of the awards).
Details of the FY2022 LTIP targets are set out on page 
154.
Actual performance against the targets set is 
described on page 154. In summary:
•	 EPS: The threshold level of performance was not 
achieved and this part of the awards has lapsed.
•	 FCF: The maximum level of performance was 
achieved and this part of the awards has vested in 
full.
•	 Environmental target: The maximum level of 
performance was achieved and this part of the 
awards has vested in full.
Therefore, in aggregate, the awards will vest at 55% 
of the maximum. The vested awards are subject to a 
two-year holding period following vesting.
Information in relation to the remuneration arrangements associated with David Forde and Patrick McMahon leaving the business are 
described on page 155, with all the arrangements in line with the Policy and their respective service agreements. 
The Committee has also considered the impact of the prior year accounting adjustments discussed on page 56 on the variable pay 
awarded in respect of FY2021, FY2022 and FY2023 which did not impact the vesting. 
appropriately stretching targets during 
FY2024. In determining the final outturn 
under the annual bonus, the Committee 
was mindful of the experience of a range of 
stakeholders.  Despite the strength of Cash 
Flow Conversion performance in FY2024, 
the Committee considered it appropriate to 
exercise discretion to adjust the formulaic 
outcome of the bonus from 62% of 
maximum to 0%. 
In the FY2022 report, we explained that 
the performance measures and targets for 
the FY2022 LTIP awards (granted in June 
2021) were determined having regard to the 
uncertain and unprecedented economic 
environment associated with COVID-19, 
its already significant and disproportionate 
impact on the business and the industry 
compared to the broader economy and 
the associated forward looking continued 
potential for disruption. As set out on 
page 154, the awards will vest at 55% 
of maximum. Reflecting that Patrick 
McMahon was employed throughout 
the three-year performance period, he 
will retain his FY2022 LTIP award, which 
will remain subject to a two-year holding 
period post-vesting and will be subject to 
standard malus and clawback terms as 
described in the Report. The vesting level 
reflects the strong performance in respect 
of cash, along with our delivery against 
our environmental targets. The threshold 
target under the EPS measure was not 
achieved, in part reflecting the challenging 
macro-economic backdrop over the 
performance period as a whole. The prior 
year accounting adjustments discussed on 
page 56, have not impacted vesting under 
the FY2022 LTIP awards.  
The Committee has considered the outturns 
against the targets set for the FY2022 LTIP 
awards and believe these to be appropriate 
in light of overall performance and 
Shareholder experience over the relevant 
performance period.
137
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Our new Directors’ Remuneration 
Policy
C&C is incorporated in Ireland and is, 
therefore, not subject to the UK company 
law requirement to submit its Directors’ 
Remuneration Policy to a binding 
Shareholder vote. Our current Policy was 
approved by Shareholders on an advisory 
basis at the 2021 AGM, with a vote in 
favour of over 90%. In line with our previous 
practice and the typical three-year period 
that applies to UK incorporated companies, 
at the 2024 AGM we will be putting our new 
Policy to Shareholders for an advisory vote. 
I have described our approach to the new 
Policy below. 
During the course of FY2024, the 
Committee reviewed the Policy approved 
in 2021, which had introduced a number 
of best practice features such as aligning 
Executive Director pension / cash in lieu of 
pension with the rate available for the wider 
workforce, introducing a post-employment 
shareholding policy and enhanced malus 
and clawback provisions. The conclusion 
of that review was that the Policy approved 
in 2021 remains largely fit-for-purpose. 
Therefore, and having explored alternative 
incentive mechanisms, our new Policy 
includes only a small number of changes 
that the Committee believes are important 
to simplify the Policy and ensure we can 
offer appropriate remuneration to our 
Executive Directors over the new Policy’s 
three-year life.
During the second half of FY2024 we 
consulted with our largest Shareholders in 
relation to our proposed approach to the 
Policy. We were pleased that the feedback 
from the consultation was positive. 
Feedback provided by Shareholders was 
valuable to us in finalising our proposals, 
and the approach set out in this report 
takes that feedback into account. 
Specifically, our approach to bonus 
deferral represents a strengthening of the 
deferral arrangements when compared 
to our original proposal. We confirmed to 
Shareholders (and have committed in the 
new Policy) that the additional incentive 
headroom which I describe below will 
not be applied for FY2025. If we were to 
use any of that headroom in the future, 
we would engage with Shareholders 
before doing so and would not expect to 
increase both the annual bonus and LTIP 
opportunities at the same time. 
Business context for our Policy 
review
The Committee’s review of the Policy 
approved in 2021 was undertaken in the 
context of the following factors. 
•	 The reinstatement of the dividend and 
the announcement in October 2023 of 
our intention to distribute up to €150m 
to Shareholders over the next three 
fiscal years, through dividends and other 
capital returns as deemed appropriate 
at the time, while maintaining leverage target 
of 1.5x to 2.0x. We commenced our share 
buyback programme on 1 March 2024.
•	 The drive to deliver the Group’s strategy 
and continued focus on building C&C as the 
premium drinks and distribution business 
in the UK and Irish markets. The Group’s 
iconic brands and market-leading distribution 
capability provide unique opportunities 
for the business to generate value for all 
stakeholders.
•	 The need to ensure that our remuneration 
arrangements are competitive. The 
Committee is cognisant of the fact that the 
lack of pay-out on our incentives over multiple 
years presents challenges when attracting 
and retaining talent.
•	 Remuneration and reward across the 
organisation. Our aim is to provide 
remuneration that motivates and rewards our 
people without encouraging excessive risk 
taking, with incentives aligned to strategy 
that encourage enhanced and sustainable 
performance.
•	 Market practice and Shareholder 
expectations for a UK listed company, 
reflecting that C&C is a FTSE250 company, 
headquartered in Dublin and listed on the 
London Stock Exchange. 
Directors’ Remuneration Committee Report
(continued)
138
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Remuneration Policy
Our approach to the new Policy is summarised below. Later in this letter I have included information on how the Policy will be applied in 
FY2025.
Structure
No changes. Annual bonus plus performance based long term incentive structure retained.
Incentive quantum
The Policy approved in 2021 allows for a maximum bonus opportunity of 125% of salary and a maximum LTIP 
award of 150% of salary.
Taking the market competitiveness of the overall packages into account and our strategy, the headroom in the 
new Policy is increased to 150% of salary for the bonus and 200% of salary for the LTIP.
However, no changes will be made to the maximum incentive opportunities for the Executive Directors for 
FY2025. Any future increases would be subject to progress on the delivery of results to Shareholders. Any 
increase in quantum would be accompanied by a review of the level of stretch in the targets. 
Performance 
measures
The new Policy retains flexibility to set bonus measures and targets annually reflecting C&C’s strategy and 
alignment with key financial, operational, strategic and/or individual objectives.
At least 75% of the LTIP will continue to be subject to performance measures based on financial measures and/
or total Shareholder return.
The measures for FY2025 are described below, with more information on the LTIP targets set out on page 145. 
Principle-based 
approach to 
shareholding 
guidelines and 
bonus deferral
Under the Policy approved in 2021, for Executive Directors up to 50% of any bonus earned is ordinarily paid in 
cash with the remainder deferred into shares for three years.
In our sector, the level of deferral is typically between 25% and 33% of the bonus earned and there is mixed 
practice on the deferral period. In a number of our sector peers the deferral period is two years.
Taking a principle-based approach to ensuring the new Policy supports the attraction (and retention) of high-
quality talent, whilst ensuring that Executive Directors’ interests are aligned with those of Shareholders, under 
the new Policy deferral is linked to the meeting the shareholding guideline (equal to 200% of the Executive 
Director’s salary):
•	 Until half of the in-service shareholding guideline is met, the deferral requirement remains at 50% of any 
bonus earned. Deferral will continue to be for a period of three years.
•	 Once half the in-service shareholding guideline is met (100% of salary), the level of bonus deferred will reduce 
to 25% of any bonus earned. This 25% deferral will continue after the in-service shareholding guideline is met 
in full. Deferral will continue to be for a period of three years.
We believe this is a proportionate and principle-based approach that will provide C&C with a competitive 
edge to attracting and retaining executive talent whilst still having a clear emphasis on Shareholder alignment 
across the arrangements as a whole. This also reflects that C&C already operates a number of best practice 
features that enhance Shareholder alignment. This includes in-employment and post-employment shareholding 
guidelines and an LTIP with an overall time horizon of five years.
Other changes
Other minor changes have been made to take account of the practical operation of the new Policy and changes 
in practice since the Policy was approved in 2021. 
Application of the new Policy for FY2025, including the wider workforce context
The key principles of our approach to the FY2025 salary review for the general workforce are (i) to put in place meaningful salary increases 
for all colleagues in the context of continued cost of living challenges; and (ii) to allocate a portion of the budget to focus increases on 
colleagues whose salaries are positioned at the lower end of the market. For FY2025, the majority of colleagues received a base salary 
increase of 4%, with a small but significant number of colleagues receiving a larger increase where considered appropriate to better align 
with the market as we begin a programme of implementation of our Reward Policy to support the delivery of the strategy. 
139
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Our approach to the implementation of the new Policy in FY2025 is set out on pages 143 to 147 and summarised below.
CEO
Patrick McMahon up to 5 June 2024 and 
Ralph Findlay 
with effect from 6 June 2024
CFO 
Andrew Andrea with effect from 1 March 2024
Base salary
€702k (a 4% increase to Patrick 
McMahon’s salary in line with the 
majority of colleagues).
£400k (c.€461k) (taking into account the market benchmarks and his 
experience).
Pension
Pension allowance of 5% of salary in line with the contribution available for the Group’s employees.
Benefit Allowance
Benefit allowance of 7.5% of salary.
Maximum annual 
bonus
Maximum annual bonus opportunity of 125% of salary, with up to 50% of the bonus earned deferred into shares 
for three years, depending on the extent to which the shareholding guideline has been met in line with the new 
Policy.
Performance targets will be based on:
•	 Operating profit, with a 65% weighting;
•	 Free Cash Flow, with a 20% weighting; and
•	 Progress against our Health & Safety priorities for the Group, with a 15% weighting.
For Patrick McMahon, Ralph Findlay and Andrew Andrea, the FY2025 annual bonus will be pro-rated for time in 
active employment in the year. Ralph Findlay will not receive a bonus for the period prior to his appointment as 
CEO on 6 June 2024. 
Maximum LTIP
Maximum LTIP opportunity of 150% of salary for the CFO. Neither Patrick McMahon nor Ralph Findlay will 
receive an LTIP award for FY2025.
Performance targets will be consistent with those for the FY2024 grant and based on:
•	 EPS, with a 45% weighting;
•	 Relative TSR, with a 35% weighting; and
•	 Environmental targets, with a 20% weighting.
Details of the anticipated targets are set out below.
Measure
Weighting
Targets
EPS1
45%
Threshold (25% vesting): 15.2c 
Maximum: 16.4c
Relative TSR
35%
Threshold (25% vesting): The Company’s TSR performance over the 
performance period2 is at the median of the comparator group3 
Maximum: The Company’s TSR performance over the performance period2 is 
at the upper quartile of the comparator group3
Environmental
20%
The Company has set a target to reduce its Scope 1 and Scope 2 emissions 
over the next three financial years ending FY2027. 
Threshold - 6% reduction 
Maximum - 12% reduction
1. 	 EPS will be measured excluding the impact of share buy backs.
2. 	 The performance period for the relative TSR measure will be the three financial years FY2025, FY2026 and FY2027, with TSR performance 
assessed by reference to a three-month average TSR measurement before the start of the performance period and at the end of the 
performance period.
3. 	 The comparator group for the relative TSR measure will be Domino’s Pizza Group, JD Wetherspoon, Mitchells & Butlers, SSP, Fullers, Gym 
Group, Hollywood Bowl, Marston’s, Britvic, Cranswick, Hilton Food Group, Premier Foods, Tate & Lyle, AG Barr, Bakkavor, Greencore and 
FeverTree.
Chair and Non-Executive Directors
For FY2025, the Chair’s fee has been increased to €260,000, a 4% increase, in line with the salary increase awarded to the majority of 
colleagues. However, Ralph Findlay will not receive this fee in respect of his role as Chair of the Board in addition to his base salary as CEO. 
There have been no increases to either the base fees or the fees for additional duties for the Non-Executive Directors other than the Chair of 
the Nomination Committee. This will only be payable where the Nomination Committee is not chaired by the Chair of the Board. 
Directors’ Remuneration Committee Report
(continued)
140
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Membership of the Committee
John Gibney joined the Remuneration 
Committee on 6 December 2023. John 
has extensive industry experience and a 
deep understanding of the beverage and 
hospitality sector and chairs the Audit 
Committee. His experience is welcomed.
LTIP rules renewal
To coincide with the renewal of the Policy 
we will be seeking Shareholder approval 
for a new LTIP at the 2024 AGM, reflecting 
that our current LTIP rules were adopted in 
2015 and expire, for the purposes of new 
grants, in 2025. The new rules reflect the 
new Policy and typical practice. A summary 
of the principal terms of the new rules is 
included in the Notice of AGM. 
Conclusion
We greatly appreciate the feedback and 
the level of support we have received from 
our Shareholders regarding our approach 
to remuneration and the changes outlined 
above, which have been valuable to us 
finalising our approach. We are firmly of the 
view they are in the best interests of the 
business and its Shareholders. 
I hope that Shareholders will agree that 
our decisions in respect of FY2024, our 
approach to the new Policy, and our 
proposed implementation of the new Policy 
in FY2025 demonstrate our continuing 
reasonable and balanced approach to 
remuneration. I hope that you will support 
the resolutions to approve the new Policy, 
the Directors’ Remuneration Report and 
the new LTIP at the AGM, where I will be 
available to answer any questions you 
may have or via the email that we have 
for engagement with our Shareholders at 
AGM2024@candcgroup.com.
FY2024 Remuneration at a glance –  
how the Policy was implemented in FY2024
Remuneration Outcomes for FY2024
Element
Patrick McMahon
Base salary
€675,000*
Pension (% of base salary)
5%
Benefits (% of base salary)
7.5%
Annual Bonus earned (% of max)
0%
LTIP vesting (% of max)
55%
*	
The base salary is that applying with effect from 19 May 2023 on his appointment as CEO.
Long-Term Incentives Awarded in FY2024
In June 2023, Patrick McMahon was granted an award under the LTIP at 150% of 
salary. Recognising his contribution to C&C over many years, the Committee exercised 
discretion to allow Patrick to retain the LTIP award granted to him in respect of FY2024 
which will vest following the assessment of the performance conditions following the end 
of FY2026 and be subject to a reduction to reflect his period of service. The performance 
conditions to which the award is subject are as set out below. To the extent the award 
vests, subject to standard malus and clawback terms as described in the Report, it will 
be subject to a two-year holding period post-vesting.
Weighting
Measure
Further details
45%
Earnings per share1
Threshold (25% vesting) – 15.2c 
Maximum – 16.0c
35%
Relative TSR
Threshold (25% vesting) - Median of the 
comparator group2 
Maximum – Upper quartile of the comparator 
group2 
20%
Environmental 
target
To reduce Scope 1 emissions and Scope 2 
emissions3 over the three financial years ending 
with FY2026 as follows: 
•	 Threshold (25% vesting) – 6% reduction 
•	 Maximum – 12% reduction
1. 	 Measured in the final year of the three-year performance period (i.e. end of FY2026)
2. 	 The comparator group for the relative TSR measure is Domino’s Pizza Group, JD Wetherspoon, Mitchells & 
Butlers, SSP, Fullers, Gym Group, Hollywood Bowl, Marston’s, Restaurant Group, Ten Entertainment Group, 
Britvic, Cranswick, Hilton Food Group, Premier Foods, Tate & Lyle, AG Barr, Bakkavor, Greencore and 
FeverTree
3. 	 Scope 1 – direct emissions from owned or controlled sources, which includes emissions from company-owned 
or operated facilities and vehicles. Scope 2 – Indirect emissions from the generation of purchased energy e.g. 
electricity, steam, heat and cooling
Governance
The Committee has defined Terms of Reference which can be found on our website at 
(candcgroup.com/terms-of-reference) and which we reviewed during FY2024. A copy 
may be obtained from the Company Secretary.
Angela Bromfield
Chair of the Remuneration Committee
141
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Remuneration Committee 
Membership and Meeting 
Attendance 
All members of the Committee are and were 
considered by the Board to be independent.
The quorum necessary for the transaction 
of business is two, each of whom must be 
a Non-Executive Director. Only members 
of the Committee have the right to attend 
committee meetings. However, during 
the year, Board members, Group Director 
of Human Resources, Head of Reward, 
Deputy Company Secretary, along 
with representatives from Deloitte, our 
remuneration advisers, were invited to 
attend meetings (although never during the 
discussion of any item affecting their own 
remuneration or employment). 
The Company Secretary and Group General 
Counsel is Secretary to the Committee.
FY2024 Key activities
•	 Agreed remuneration arrangements in 
relation to the changes to the Board 
during the year. This included the 
remuneration package for Patrick 
McMahon on his taking on the role of 
CEO, the remuneration arrangements 
for Ralph Findlay in connection with his 
taking on the role of Executive Chair, the 
terms of David Forde’s departure and 
the remuneration package applying to 
Andrew Andrea on his appointment as 
CFO with effect from the start of FY2025.
•	 Agreed the remuneration packages for a 
number of roles in the restructured Group 
Executive Committee, below Board.
•	 Undertook a comprehensive review 
of the Remuneration Policy including 
engagement with Shareholders in 
readiness for the Policy to be put 
to Shareholders for approval at the 
Company’s 2024 AGM.
•	 As part of the Policy review the 
Committee also reviewed a revised set of 
Reward Principles which will apply to the 
rest of the workforce and will support the 
implementation of the strategy.
•	 Approval of the FY2024 bonus and 
LTIP measures and targets, taking into 
account external expectation and market 
uncertainty.
•	 As part of the externally facilitated Board 
effectiveness review, we undertook a 
review of the Committee’s effectiveness. 
The areas for development were built into 
the Committee’s forward agenda.
•	 Agreed that the FY2025 salary review for 
Patrick McMahon would be in line with 
that of the general workforce.
•	 Agreed the incentive plan targets for 
FY2025, continuing to use the same 
robust financial and non-financial 
measures designed to align with the 
strategic objectives and stakeholder 
interests.
External Advisers
The Committee seeks and considers advice 
from independent remuneration advisers 
where appropriate. During the year ended 
29 February 2024, the Committee obtained 
advice from Deloitte LLP. Deloitte’s fees for 
this advice amounted to £41,675 (excluding 
VAT) charged on a time or fixed fee basis. 
Deloitte is one of the founding members of 
the Remuneration Consultants’ Group and 
adheres to that Group’s Code of Conduct 
in its dealings. The Committee is satisfied 
that the advice provided by Deloitte is 
objective and independent. The Committee 
is comfortable that the Deloitte engagement 
team who provide remuneration advice to 
the Committee do not have connections 
with the Company that may impair their 
independence.
Directors’ Remuneration Policy 
The current Directors’ Remuneration 
Policy applied from the date of the 2021 
AGM (the 2021 Policy). In line with typical 
UK practice, we are seeking approval 
for a new Remuneration Policy (the 2024 
Policy) at the 2024 AGM. The 2024 Policy 
is set out below. The approach taken 
by the Remuneration Committee to the 
determination of the 2024 Policy and the 
differences between the 2024 Policy and 
the 2021 Policy are described in the Chair’s 
letter on pages 136 to 141. 
When designing the 2024 Policy, having 
regard to the UK Corporate Governance 
Code 2018, the Committee has applied the 
following principles:
•	 clarity – remuneration arrangements will 
be transparent and promote effective 
engagement with Shareholders and the 
workforce;
•	 simplicity – remuneration structures will 
avoid complexity and their rationale and 
operation should be easy to understand;
•	 risk – remuneration arrangements will 
ensure reputational and other risks from 
excessive rewards, and behavioural risks 
that can arise from target-based incentive 
plans, are identified and mitigated;
•	 predictability – the range of possible 
values of rewards to individuals and other 
limits or discretions will be identified and 
explained;
•	 proportionality – the link between 
individual awards, the delivery of strategy 
and the long-term performance of the 
company will be clear; and,
•	 alignment to culture – incentive plans 
will drive behaviours consistent with 
company purpose, values and strategy.
The 2024 Policy
If the 2024 Policy is approved at the 2024 
AGM, it will apply from that date.
Directors’ Remuneration Committee Report
(continued)
142
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Future Policy Table
Executive Directors
The table below sets out the Company’s Remuneration Policy for Executive Directors.
Purpose and link to strategy
Operation
Maximum opportunity
Performance metrics
Salary
Reflects the individual’s 
role, experience and 
contribution. Set at 
levels to attract, recruit 
and retain Directors of 
the necessary calibre.
Salaries are set by the Committee 
taking into account factors including, 
but not limited to:
•	 scope and responsibilities of the 
role;
•	 experience and individual 
performance;
•	 overall business performance;
•	 prevailing market conditions;
•	 pay in comparable companies; and
•	 overall risk of non-retention.
Typically, salaries are reviewed 
annually, with any changes normally 
taking effect from 1 March.
Whilst there is no prescribed formulaic 
maximum, any increases will take into 
account the outcome of pay reviews for 
employees as a whole. Larger increases 
may be awarded where the Committee 
considers it appropriate to reflect, for 
example: increases or changes in scope 
and responsibility; to reflect the Executive 
Director’s development and performance 
in the role; or alignment to market level. 
Increases may be implemented over such 
time period as the Committee determines 
appropriate.
None.
Benefits/cash allowance in lieu
Ensures that benefits 
are sufficient to recruit 
and retain individuals of 
the necessary calibre.
The Group seeks to bring transparency 
to Directors’ reward structures 
through the use of cash allowances 
in place of benefits in kind. The cash 
allowance can be applied to benefits 
such as a company car and health 
benefits. Group benefits such as 
death in service insurance are also 
made available. Other benefits may 
be provided based on individual 
circumstances including housing or 
relocation allowances, travel allowance 
or other expatriate benefits. Benefits 
and allowances are reviewed alongside 
salary.
There is no prescribed maximum monetary 
value of benefits.
Benefit provision is set at a level which the 
Committee considers appropriate against 
the market and relative to internal benefit 
provision in the Group and which provides 
sufficient level of benefit based on individual 
circumstances.
None.
Pension/cash allowance in lieu
Contributes towards 
funding later life cost of 
living.
Executive Directors may participate in 
the Company’s defined contribution 
pension scheme or take a cash 
allowance in lieu of pension entitlement 
(or a combination thereof).
A contribution and/or cash allowance not 
exceeding the level available to the majority 
of the Group’s workforce. The Committee 
retains discretion to determine the 
approach and calculation of the workforce 
pension level, including if relevant, taking 
into account the location of the Executive 
Director.
None.
143
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Purpose and link to strategy
Operation
Maximum opportunity
Performance metrics
Annual bonus
Motivates employees 
and incentivises 
delivery of performance 
targets which support 
the strategic direction 
of the Company.
Bonus levels are determined after 
the year end based on performance 
against targets set by the Committee.
The Committee has discretion to 
vary the bonus pay out should any 
formulaic output not reflect the 
Committee’s assessment of overall 
business performance, or if the 
Committee considers the pay-out to 
be inappropriate in the context of other 
relevant factors including to avoid 
outcomes which could be seen as 
contrary to Shareholder expectations.
Bonus deferral
The extent of the deferral of bonus 
will ordinarily depend upon the 
achievement against the Company’s 
In-Service Shareholding Requirement, 
as set out below this table. 
Malus and clawback provisions will 
apply to the annual bonus. See the 
'Malus and clawback' section below 
for more details.
Maximum opportunity is 
150% of base salary (125% in 
FY2025).
Performance is ordinarily 
measured over the financial year. 
The Committee has flexibility to 
set performance measures and 
targets annually, reflecting the 
Company’s strategy and aligned 
with key financial, operational, 
strategic and/or individual 
objectives.
The majority of the bonus will be 
based on financial measures, such 
as profit and cash. The balance 
of the bonus will be based on 
financial or strategic targets such 
as brand equity and our ESG 
goals (which may include health 
and safety objectives).
In the case of financial measures, 
up to 20% of the bonus will be 
earned for threshold performance 
increasing to up to 50% for on-
target performance and 100% for 
maximum performance.
For non-financial measures, the 
amount of bonus earned will be 
determined by the Committee 
between 0% and 100% by 
reference to its assessment of the 
extent to which the relevant metric 
or objective has been met.
Directors’ Remuneration Committee Report
(continued)
144
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Purpose and link to strategy
Operation
Maximum opportunity
Performance metrics
LTIP
Incentivises Executive 
Directors to execute 
the Group’s business 
strategy over the longer 
term and aligns their 
interests with those 
of Shareholders to 
achieve a sustained 
increase in Shareholder 
value.
Awards are made in the form of 
nil-cost options or conditional share 
awards, the vesting of which is 
conditional on the achievement of 
performance targets (as determined by 
the Committee).
Vested awards must be held for a 
further two-year period after the end of 
the performance period before sale of 
the shares (other than to pay tax). This 
holding period can be operated on the 
basis that:
•	 awards vest following the 
assessment of the applicable 
performance conditions but will not 
be released (so that the participant 
is entitled to acquire shares) until the 
end of a holding period of two years 
beginning on the vesting date; or
•	 the participant is entitled to acquire 
shares following the assessment 
of the applicable performance 
conditions but that (other than as 
regards sales to cover tax liabilities) 
the award is not released (so that 
the participant is able to dispose of 
those shares) until the end of the 
holding period. 
The Committee retains discretion to 
adjust the outturn of an LTIP award, 
including to override the formulaic 
outcome of the award, in the event 
that performance against targets does 
not properly reflect the underlying 
performance of the Company, or if 
the Committee considers the pay-out 
to be inappropriate in the context of 
other relevant factors including to avoid 
outcomes which could be seen as 
contrary to Shareholder expectations.
Additional shares may be delivered in 
respect of vested LTIP award shares 
to reflect dividends over the vesting 
period and, if relevant, the holding 
period. The number of additional 
shares may be calculated assuming 
the reinvestment of dividends on such 
basis as the Committee determines.
Awards may be made up to 
200% of salary in respect of 
any financial year (150% of 
salary in respect of FY2025).
In exceptional circumstances 
the maximum award is 300% 
of salary in respect of any 
financial year.
Vesting is based on the 
achievement of challenging 
performance targets, typically 
measured over a period of 
three years. 
Performance may be assessed 
against financial measures 
(including, but not limited 
to, EPS, cash conversion or 
other cash based measure) 
and / or return measures 
and operational or strategic 
measures (which may include 
ESG measures) aligned with 
the Company’s strategy, 
provided that at least 75% of 
the award is based on financial 
and/or return measures.
For the achievement of 
threshold performance against 
a financial measure, no more 
than 25% of the award will 
vest, rising, ordinarily on a 
straight-line basis, to 100% for 
maximum performance; below 
threshold performance, none 
of the award will vest.
For non-financial measures, 
the amount of the award that 
vests will be determined by 
the Committee between 0% 
and 100% by reference to its 
assessment of the extent to 
which the relevant metric or 
objective has been met.
145
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Purpose and link to strategy
Operation
Maximum opportunity
Performance metrics
Share-based rewards – all-employee plans
Align the interests of 
eligible employees with 
those of Shareholders 
through share 
ownership.
The C&C Profit Sharing Scheme is an 
all-employee share scheme and has 
two parts.
Part A relates to employees in Ireland 
and has been approved by the Irish 
Revenue Commissioners (the Irish 
APSS). Part B relates to employees 
in the UK and is a HMRC qualifying 
plan of free, partnership, matching or 
dividend shares (or cash dividends) 
with a minimum three-year vesting 
period for matching shares (the UK 
SIP). UK resident Executive Directors 
are eligible to participate in Part B only.
There is currently no equivalent plan 
for Directors resident outside of Ireland 
or the UK.
Under the Company’s 
Irish APSS, the maximum 
value of shares that may be 
allocated each year is as 
permitted in accordance with 
the relevant tax legislation 
(currently €12,700, which 
is the combined value for 
the employer funded and 
employee foregone elements). 
Under the Company’s UK SIP 
the maximum values are those 
permitted by the applicable 
legislation (£1,800 in respect 
of partnership shares, £3,600 
in respect of matching shares 
and £3,600 in respect of 
free shares, or in any case 
such greater limit as may be 
specified by the tax legislation 
from time to time).
No performance conditions 
would usually be required in 
tax-advantaged plans.
Bonus Deferral
If an Executive Director has not met 
at least half the Company’s In-Service 
Shareholding Requirement as determined 
by the Committee, up to 50% of any bonus 
earned will ordinarily be paid in cash with 
the remainder deferred into shares, for up to 
three years.
If an Executive Director has met as to 
at least half the Company’s In-Service 
Shareholding Requirement as determined 
by the Committee, up to 75% of any bonus 
earned will ordinarily be paid in cash with 
the remainder deferred into shares, for up to 
three years.
Additional shares may be delivered in 
respect of deferred bonus award shares to 
reflect dividends over the deferral period. 
The number of additional shares may be 
calculated assuming the reinvestment of 
dividends on such basis as the Committee 
determines.
Shareholding guidelines
To align Executive Directors with 
Shareholders, the Committee has adopted 
formal share ownership guidelines, which 
apply both during and after employment. 
The Committee retains discretion to 
vary these provisions in appropriate 
circumstances.
In-service requirement
Executive Directors are required to build 
and maintain a personal shareholding of at 
least two times’ salary.
Executive Directors are required to retain 
50% of the after-tax value of vested share 
awards until the shareholding guideline is 
met.
Shares subject to awards which have 
vested but which remain unexercised, 
shares subject to LTIP awards which have 
vested but not been released (i.e. which 
are in a holding period) and shares subject 
to deferred bonus awards count towards 
the shareholding requirement on a net of 
assumed tax basis.
Post-employment requirement
The Committee has adopted a post-
employment guideline. Shares are subject 
to this requirement only if they are acquired 
from LTIP or deferred bonus awards 
granted after 1 March 2021. For the first 
year after the Executive Director steps down 
from the Board they are required to retain 
such of those shares as have a value equal 
to the 'in-service' guideline, or their actual 
shareholding, if lower, and for a further year 
such of those shares as have a value equal 
to half of the 'in-service' guideline or their 
actual shareholding, if lower.
Explanation of performance 
measures
Performance measures for the LTIP 
and annual bonus are selected by the 
Committee to reflect the Company’s 
strategy. The Committee has discretion to 
set performance measures (and weightings 
where there is more than one measure) 
on an annual basis to take account of the 
prevailing circumstances. Measures and 
weightings may vary depending upon an 
Executive Director’s area of responsibility.
Directors’ Remuneration Committee Report
(continued)
146
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Targets are set annually by the Committee 
having regard to the circumstances at the 
time and taking into account a number of 
different factors.
To the extent provided for in accordance 
with any relevant amendment power 
under the rules of the share plans 
or in the terms of any performance 
condition, the Committee may alter 
the performance conditions relating to 
an award or option already granted in 
appropriate circumstances (such as in 
the event of a material acquisition or 
divestment or an unexpected event) if the 
Committee reasonably considers that 
the performance conditions would not, 
without alteration, achieve their original 
purpose. The Committee will act fairly and 
reasonably in making the alteration so that 
the performance conditions achieve their 
original purpose, and the thresholds remain 
as challenging as originally imposed. The 
Committee will explain and disclose any 
such alteration in the next remuneration 
report.
Malus and clawback
In line with the UK Corporate Governance 
Code, malus and clawback provisions 
apply to all elements of performance-based 
variable remuneration (i.e. annual bonus, 
and LTIP) for the Executive Directors. 
The circumstances in which malus and 
clawback will be applied are if there has 
been, in the opinion of the Committee, 
a material mis-statement of the Group’s 
published accounts, material corporate 
failure, significant reputational damage, 
error in assessing a performance condition 
or the information or assumptions on 
which the award vests, or the Committee 
reasonably determines that a participant 
has been guilty of gross misconduct. 
The clawback provisions will apply for a 
period of two years following the end of 
the performance period; in the case of any 
deferred bonus award or LTIP award which 
is not released until the end of a holding 
period, clawback may be implemented 
by cancelling the award before it vests/is 
released.
Share plans and other incentives
The Committee may operate the 
Company’s share plans in accordance with 
their terms and exercise any discretions 
available to them under the plans, including 
that awards may be adjusted in the event 
of a variation of capital, demerger, special 
dividend or other relevant event. Awards 
may be settled, in whole or in part, in cash, 
although the Committee would only settle 
an Executive Director’s award in cash 
in appropriate circumstances, such as 
where there is a regulatory restriction on 
the delivery of shares or as regards the tax 
liability arising in respect of the award.
In the event of a change of control or other 
relevant event, awards under the share 
plans will vest to the extent determined 
in accordance with the rules of the plans, 
after the exercise, where relevant, of any 
applicable discretion.
•	 Unvested LTIP awards will vest taking 
into account the performance conditions 
and pro-rating for time, although the 
Committee has discretion not to apply 
time pro-rating.
•	 Vested LTIP awards which are in a 
holding period will be released to the 
extent already determined.
•	 Deferred bonus awards will vest in full.
•	 Awards under the all-employee plans 
will vest in accordance with the rules of 
those plans, which do not provide for any 
discretionary treatment.
Legacy payments
The Committee reserves the right to 
make any remuneration payment or 
any payment for loss of office (including 
exercise any discretion in respect of any 
such payment) without the need to consult 
with Shareholders or seek their approval, 
notwithstanding that it is not in line with 
the 2024 Policy, where the terms of the 
payment were agreed either:
•	 before the policy came into effect 
(provided that, in the case of any payment 
agreed after the Company’s 2015 Annual 
General Meeting, it is in line with the 
policy in effect at the time the payment 
was agreed); or
•	 at a time when the relevant individual was 
not a Director of the Company and, in the 
opinion of the Committee, the payment 
was not in consideration for the individual 
becoming a Director of the Company. 
For these purposes: the term ‘payment’ 
includes any award of variable 
remuneration; in relation to an award over 
shares, the terms of the payment are 
‘agreed’ at the time the award is granted.
Minor changes
The Committee may, without the need to 
consult with Shareholders or seek their 
approval, make minor changes to this Policy 
to aid in its operation or implementation 
taking into account the interests of 
Shareholders.
Comparison with remuneration 
policy for employees generally
Remuneration packages for Executive 
Directors and for employees as a whole 
reflect the same general remuneration 
principle that individuals should be 
rewarded for their contribution to the Group 
and its success, and the reward they 
receive should be competitive in the market 
in which they operate without paying more 
than is necessary to recruit and retain them.
The remuneration package for Executive 
Directors reflects their role of leading 
the strategic development of the Group. 
Accordingly, there is a strong alignment with 
Shareholders’ interests, through long term 
performance-based share rewards. Senior 
management are similarly rewarded.
These rewards are not appropriate for 
all employees, but it is the Committee’s 
policy that employees in general should be 
afforded an opportunity to participate in the 
Group’s success through holding shares in 
the Company through all-employee plans.
Executive Directors are incentivised through 
an annual cash bonus to achieve shorter 
term objectives and all employees are 
similarly incentivised. The deferral of bonus 
for the Executive Directors increases their 
alignment with the longer-term interests of 
Shareholders.
147
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

For Executive Directors the remuneration 
package reflects the demands of a 
global market. For employees generally, 
remuneration and reward are tailored to 
the local market in which they work. It is 
the Committee’s policy that all employees 
should share in the success of the business 
divisions to which they have contributed.
Consideration of employment 
conditions generally and 
consultation with employees
As described above, when setting the policy 
for Executive Directors’ remuneration, the 
Committee applies the same core principle 
as applied for the pay and employment 
conditions of other Group employees. 
When reviewing Directors’ remuneration, 
the Committee has regard to the outcome 
of pay reviews for employees as a whole. 
During FY2024, Patrick McMahon and 
the Head of Reward presented to the 
Committee a revised set of Reward 
Principles for the wider workforce which 
were developed during the year. These 
Reward Principles are aligned with the 
overall aim of building a reward proposition 
that will support the implementation of the 
strategy and our reward journey. They are 
taken into account by the Committee when 
taking decisions in relation to remuneration 
for Executive Directors and other members 
of the Group Executive Committee. 
There was no direct consultation with 
the wider workforce in relation to the 
new Policy. However, with effect from 
6 December 2024, Chris Browne and 
Sarah Newbitt were appointed Employee 
Engagement Non-Executive Directors. 
During the course of FY2025 they will 
continue to engage with the workforce 
which will include addressing any broader 
reward matters raised.
CEO quarterly ‘All Colleague’ sessions were 
held during FY2024 hosted by the CEO 
and Group Executive Committee members 
and the designated Employee Engagement 
Non-Executive Directors also attended, with 
the aim of providing a further opportunity 
to increase two-way dialogue between the 
Company and all staff and to allow our Non-
Executive Directors to hear directly from 
colleagues and feed back to the Board. 
Remuneration more generally is always a 
topic for discussion during these sessions 
and feedback provided was taken into 
account by the Committee when finalising 
the 2024 Policy. 
The Group has regular contact with 
employee representatives on matters of pay 
and remuneration for employees covered 
by collective bargaining or consultation 
arrangements.
Illustration of remuneration policy
The following charts show the level of 
remuneration and the relative split of 
remuneration between fixed pay (base 
salary, benefits and cash allowance in 
lieu of pension) and variable pay (annual 
bonus and LTIP) for each Executive Director 
on the basis of minimum remuneration, 
remuneration receivable for performance 
in line with the Company’s expectations, 
maximum remuneration (not allowing for 
any share price appreciation) and maximum 
remuneration assuming a 50% increase in 
the share price for the purposes of the LTIP 
element.
Bases and Assumptions
For the purposes of the above charts, the 
following assumptions have been made:
•	 The UK regulations only require these charts 
to be prepared in respect of an Executive 
Director, the chart in respect of Ralph Findlay 
reflects his remuneration for the period from 
6 June 2024 to the end of FY2025 only.
•	 Base salary is the salary as at 1 March 2024 
(or 6 June 2024 in the case of Ralph Findlay).
•	 Benefits at the level of 7.5% of salary (based 
on salary with effect from 1 March 2024 or 
6 June 2024 in the case of Ralph Findlay) 
reflecting the core benefits for each Executive 
Director.
•	 Cash allowance in lieu of pension for 
Executive Directors at the level of 5% of 
salary (based on salary with effect from 1 
March 2024 or 6 June 2024 in the case of 
Ralph Findlay).
•	 An annual bonus opportunity of 125% of 
salary.
•	 An LTIP award of 150% of salary for the CFO, 
Andrew Andrea only.
In the case of Andrew Andrea, the base salary 
is converted to € using the closing exchange 
rate at 29 February 2024 of 0.8675, for ease of 
comparison.
Minimum
performance
Performance in line
with expectations
Maximum
performance
Maximum performance
 plus share price increase
Minimum
performance
Performance in line
with expectations
Maximum
performance
Maximum performance
 plus share price increase
Fixed pay
Annual Bonus
LTIP
Ralph Findlay
Andrew Andrea
100%
64%
47%
47%
36%
53%
53%
18%
39%
49%
29%
32%
27%
100%
53%
29%
24%
€580k
€525k
€992k
€902k
€1,224k
€1,224k
€1,809k
€2,160k
Directors’ Remuneration Committee Report
(continued)
148
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Minimum performance
Performance in line with expectations 
Maximum performance
Maximum performance plus share price 
increase
Fixed pay
Fixed elements of remuneration 
(base salary, benefits 
allowance and pension 
allowance).
Fixed elements of remuneration 
(base salary, benefits 
allowance and pension 
allowance).
Fixed elements of remuneration 
(base salary, benefits 
allowance and pension 
allowance).
Fixed elements of remuneration 
(base salary, benefits allowance 
and pension allowance).
Annual bonus
No bonus.
50% of bonus (62.5% of salary) 
earned for achieving target 
performance.
100% of bonus (125% of salary) 
earned for achieving maximum 
performance.
100% of bonus (125% of salary) 
earned for achieving maximum 
performance.
LTIP (for the CFO Andrew Andrea only)
No vesting.
25% of the award (37.5% of 
salary) for achieving threshold 
performance.
150% of salary for achieving 
maximum performance.
150% of salary for achieving 
maximum performance plus an 
assumed 50% increase in the 
share price giving an overall value 
of 225% of salary.
Recruitment remuneration policy
When recruiting an Executive Director, 
the Committee will typically seek to use 
the Policy detailed in the table above to 
determine the appropriate remuneration 
package to be offered. To facilitate the hiring 
of candidates of the appropriate calibre 
required to implement the Group’s strategy, 
the Committee retains the discretion to 
make payments or awards which are 
outside the Policy subject to the principles 
and limits set out below.
In determining appropriate remuneration, 
the Committee will take into consideration 
all relevant factors (including the quantum 
and nature of remuneration) to ensure the 
arrangements are in the best interests of the 
Group and its Shareholders. This may, for 
example, include (but is not limited to) the 
following circumstances:
•	 an interim appointment is made to fill an 
Executive Director role on a short-term 
basis;
•	 exceptional circumstances require that 
the Chair or a Non-Executive Director 
takes on an executive function on a short-
term basis;
•	 an Executive Director is recruited at 
a time in the year when it would be 
inappropriate to provide a bonus or 
long-term incentive award for that year 
as there would not be sufficient time 
to assess performance. Subject to the 
limit on variable remuneration set out 
below, the quantum in respect of the 
months employed during the year may 
be transferred to the subsequent year 
so that reward is provided on a fair and 
appropriate basis; 
•	 the Executive Director received benefits 
at their previous employer which the 
Committee considers it appropriate to 
offer.
The Committee may also alter the 
performance measures, performance 
period, vesting period, deferral period and 
holding period of the annual bonus or long-
term incentive if the Committee determines 
that the circumstances of the recruitment 
merit such alteration. The rationale will be 
clearly explained.
The Committee may make an award to 
compensate the prospective employee 
for remuneration arrangements forfeited 
on leaving a previous employment or 
engagement. In doing so, the Committee 
will take account of relevant factors 
regarding the forfeited arrangements which 
may include the form of any forfeited awards 
(e.g. cash or shares), any performance 
conditions attached to those awards (and 
the likelihood of meeting those conditions) 
and the time over which they would have 
vested. These awards or payments are 
excluded from the maximum level of 
variable remuneration referred to below; the 
Committee’s intention, however, is that the 
value awarded or paid would be no higher 
than the expected value of the forfeited 
arrangements.
Any share awards referred to in this section 
will be granted as far as possible under the 
Group’s employee share plans. If necessary, 
and subject to the limits referred to below, 
recruitment awards may be granted outside 
of these plans.
Recruitment awards will normally be 
liable to forfeiture or 'clawback' on early 
departure (i.e. within the first 12 months of 
employment).
It would be the Committee’s policy that 
a significant portion of the remuneration 
package (including any introductory awards) 
would be variable and linked to stretching 
performance targets and continued 
employment. The maximum level of variable 
remuneration that may be granted to new 
Directors (excluding buy-out arrangements) 
is 450% of base salary.
Where a position is filled internally, any pre-
appointment remuneration entitlements or 
outstanding variable pay elements shall be 
allowed to continue according to the original 
terms.
Fees payable to a newly-appointed Chair 
or Non-Executive Director will be in line 
with the fee policy in place at the time of 
appointment.
149
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Policy on payment for loss of office
Executive Directors
Service Contracts
Details of the service contracts of the Executive Directors are as follows:
Name
Contract date
Notice period
Unexpired term of 
contract
Ralph Findlay (Chief Executive Officer)
6 June 2024
3 months
n/a
Andrew Andrea (Chief Financial Officer)
1 March 2024
12 months
n/a
Compensation on Termination
The service contracts of the Executive Directors do not contain any pre-determined compensation payments in the event of termination of 
office or employment other than payment in lieu of notice.
The principles on which the compensation for loss of office would be approached are summarised below:
Policy
Notice period
None of the Executive Directors has a service contract with a notice period in excess of one year. Service 
contracts for new Directors will generally be limited to 12 months’ notice by the Company.
Termination 
payment/ payment 
in lieu of notice
The Company has retained the right to make payment to the Executive Director of up to 12 months’ fixed 
remuneration in lieu of the notice period. Discretionary benefits may also include, but are not limited to, 
outplacement and legal fees.
Annual bonus
Payment of the annual bonus would be at the discretion of the Committee on an individual basis and would 
be dependent upon the circumstances of their departure and their contribution to the business during the 
bonus period in question, such that a bonus would be paid only in circumstances the Committee considers 
amount to 'good leaver' circumstances. in such circumstances, a departing Director may be eligible, subject to 
performance, for payment of a bonus pro-rata to the period of employment during the year, to be payable at the 
usual time.
Share based 
awards
The vesting of share-based awards is governed by the rules of the relevant incentive plan.
LTIP
Unvested awards
‘Good leavers’ typically include leavers due to death, injury, ill-health, disability, redundancy and retirement with 
the consent of the Company or business disposal or any other reason as determined by the Committee.
The provisions for ‘good leavers’ provide that unvested awards will vest at the normal vesting point taking 
account of the performance over the period and subject to pro-rating for time, although the Committee has 
discretion to waive pro-rating for time. Any holding period would typically continue to apply. The Committee 
has the discretion to accelerate vesting (and release) to the date of cessation of employment (and to assess 
performance accordingly) or to determine vesting at the end of the performance period and to release the 
award then.
LTIP
Vested but 
unreleased 
awards
Under the LTIP, if a participant ceases employment during a holding period, their award will continue unless 
they are summarily dismissed, in which case the award will lapse. Awards which are retained will typically be 
released at the originally anticipated release date. However, the Committee has discretion to release the award 
at the date of cessation.
Deferred bonus 
awards
In the event of cessation due to death, ill-health, injury or disability, the deferred bonus share award would 
ordinarily be released as soon as practicable following termination. In the event of cessation for any other reason 
(unless the participant is summarily dismissed, in which case the award will lapse), the award will be released at 
the normal time, although the Committee has discretion to release at cessation.
Directors’ Remuneration Committee Report
(continued)
150
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Policy
Mitigation
Executive Directors’ service contracts contain no contractual provision for reduction in payments for mitigation 
or for early payment, and accordingly any payment during the notice period will not be reduced by any amount 
earned in that period from alternative employment obtained as a result of being released from employment with 
the Group before the end of the contractual notice period.
Other payments 
Payments may be made under the Company’s all-employee share plans which are governed by the Irish 
Revenue Commissioners and HMRC tax-advantaged plan rules and which cover leaver provisions. There is no 
discretionary treatment of leavers under these plans.
Payments may also be made in respect of accrued but untaken holiday and for fees for any outplacement 
services and legal and professional advice in connection with the termination.
Where on recruitment a buy-out award had been made, then the applicable leaver provisions would be 
specified at the time of the award.
The Committee reserves the right to make additional exit payments where such payments are made in good faith in discharge of an 
existing legal obligation (or by way of damages for breach of such an obligation) or by way of settlement or compromise of any claim 
arising in connection with the termination of a Director’s office or employment. In doing so, the Committee will recognise and balance the 
interests of Shareholders and the departing Executive Director, as well as the interests of the remaining Directors. Where the Committee 
retains discretion, it will be used to provide flexibility in certain situations, taking into account the particular circumstances of the Director’s 
departure and performance.
Non-Executive Directors
The table below sets out the Company’s Remuneration Policy for Non-Executive Directors
Purpose and link to strategy
Operation
Opportunity
Performance metrics
Non-Executive Director fees
Attract and retain high 
calibre individuals with 
appropriate knowledge and 
experience.
Fees paid to Non-Executive Directors 
are determined and approved by the 
Board as a whole. The Committee 
recommends the remuneration of the 
Chair to the Board. 
Fees are reviewed from time to time and 
adjusted to reflect market positioning 
and any change in responsibilities.
Non-Executive Directors are not eligible 
to participate in the annual bonus 
plan or share-based plans and, save 
as noted below, do not receive any 
benefits (including pension) other than 
fees in respect of their services to the 
Company.
Non-Executive Directors may be eligible 
to receive certain benefits as appropriate 
such as the use of secretarial support, 
travel costs or other benefits that may be 
appropriate. If tax is payable in respect 
of any benefit provided, the Company 
may make a further payment to cover 
the tax liability.
Fees are set taking into 
account the time commitment 
and contribution expected 
for the role and market 
competitive fee levels. The 
Articles of Association provide 
that the ordinary remuneration 
of Directors (i.e. Directors’ 
fees, not including executive 
remuneration) shall not exceed 
a fixed amount or such other 
amount as determined by 
an ordinary resolution of the 
Company. 
Not applicable.
151
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Purpose and link to strategy
Operation
Opportunity
Performance metrics
Additional Fees
Provide compensation 
to Non-Executive 
Directors taking on 
additional responsibility 
or for additional time 
commitments.
Non-Executive Directors may receive 
additional fees for further duties (for 
example Committee Chair, Senior 
Independent Director responsibilities, 
or holding the position of Designated 
Employee Engagement Non-Executive 
Director) or time commitments.
Not applicable.
Letters of appointment
Each of the Non-Executive Directors in office during the financial year was appointed by way of a letter of appointment. Each appointment 
was for an initial term of three years, renewable by agreement (but now subject to annual re-election by the members in General Meeting). 
The letters of appointment are dated as set out below, other than as regards Ralph Findlay. Details of Ralph Findlay’s service agreement 
following his appointment as Chief Executive Officer are set out on page 150.
Non-Executive Director
Date of letter of appointment
Vineet Bhalla
26 April 2021
Jill Caseberry
7 February 2019
Vincent Crowley1
23 November 2015
John Gibney
26 October 2022
Angela Bromfield
12 July 2023
Chris Browne
30 August 2023
Sarah Newbitt
30 August 2023
1. 	 As announced on 15 February 2024, Vincent Crowley will step down from the Board at the conclusion of the 2024 Annual General Meeting after serving almost nine years on 
the Board.
The letters of appointment are each agreed to be terminable by either party on one month’s notice and do not contain any pre-determined 
compensation payments in the event of termination of office or employment.
Directors’ Remuneration Committee Report
(continued)
152
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Annual Remuneration Report
Remuneration in detail for the Year ended 29 February 2024
Directors’ Remuneration (Audited)
The following table sets out the total remuneration for directors for the year ended 29 February 2024 and the prior year.
Single Total Figure of Remuneration – Executive Directors (Audited)
The table below reports the total remuneration receivable in respect of qualifying services by each Executive Director during the year 
ended 29 February 2024 and the prior year. Ralph Findlay was appointed as Executive Chair with effect from 19 May 2023. However, 
because his remuneration consisted only of a fee, consistent with his remuneration as Non-Executive Chair for the balance of FY2024 and 
with the structure of remuneration for all other Non-Executive Directors, his remuneration for the whole year is included in the Single Total 
Figure of Remuneration – Non-Executive Directors table on page 158. 
Salary/
fees
(a)
Taxable
 benefits 
(b)
Annual 
bonus
(c)
Long term 
incentives 
(d)
Pension related 
benefits
 (e)
Termination
payments 
(f)
Total fixed 
remuneration
Total variable 
remuneration
Total
Year ended 
February
2024
€’000
2023
€’000
2024
€’000
2023
€’000
2024
€’000
2023
€’000
2024
€’000
2023
€’000
2024
€’000
2023
€’000
2024
€’000
2023
€’000
2024
€’000
2023
€’000
2024
€’000
2023
€’000
2024
€’000
2023
€’000
Executive Directors
David 
Forde
153
714
14
54
-
-
266
398
9
36
1,896
-
176
804
2,162
398
2,338
1,202
Patrick 
McMahon
617
435
48
34
-
-
219
242
31
22
-
-
696
491
219
242
915
733
Total
770 1,149
62
88
-
-
485
640
40
58
1,896
-
872 1,295
2,381
640
3,253
1,935
1. 	 David Forde stepped down from the Board on 18 May 2023 and his remuneration in the table above is the remuneration he earned to this date plus certain payments made to 
him in connection with his leaving the business, further information in relation to which is set out below. Information in relation to other elements of remuneration connected with 
his departure from the Group is included on page 155.
Details of the valuation methodologies applied are set out in Notes (a) to (f) below. Where relevant, the valuation methodologies are as 
required by the Regulations and are different from those applied within the financial statements, which have been prepared in accordance 
with International Financial Reporting Standards (‘IFRS’).
Notes to Directors’ Remuneration Table
(a) Salaries and fees
The amounts shown are the amounts earned in respect of the financial year. In the case of Patrick McMahon, the amounts take into 
account his appointment as CEO with effect from 19 May 2023. 
(b) Taxable benefits 
The Executive Directors received a cash allowance of 7.5% of base salary. The Group provided death-in-service cover of four times annual 
base salary. Patrick McMahon elected to participate in the Irish APSS during the year, an ‘all-employee plan’ for employees in Ireland. 
Under that plan, the Company awarded a number of ‘free’ shares in connection with his purchase of ‘contributory’ shares, as permitted 
by the legislation. The value of those shares at the date of the awards has been included in the taxable benefit column (€1,728). For more 
details on the Profit Sharing Scheme, please see page 146.
153
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

(c) Annual bonus
The annual bonus was based on performance against Group Operating Profit (65%) and Free Cash Flow Conversion (35%). Further details 
of the bonus targets set and the performance outturn are provided in the table below.
Performance Targets
Measure
Threshold (12% of 
maximum – 15% of 
salary)
‘Target’ 
(50% of maximum
 – 62.5% of salary)
‘Maximum’ 
(100% of maximum
 – 125% of salary)
Actual Performance
Bonuses outturn
GOP (65%)
€57m
€61m
€63m
€60m
27%
Free Cash Flow Conversion (35%)
45%
55%
65%
91%
35%
As set out in the Chair’s letter, notwithstanding in particular the very strong Cash Flow Conversion performance in FY2024, the Committee 
considered it appropriate to exercise discretion to adjust the formulaic outcome of the bonus from 62% of maximum to 0%. 
David Forde was not eligible to earn a bonus for FY2024.
(d) Long term incentives 
1. The amounts shown in respect of long-term incentives are the values of awards where final vesting is determined as a result of the 
achievement of performance measures or targets relating to the financial year and is not subject to achievement of further measures 
or targets in future financial years. In the FY2023 Directors’ Remuneration Report, the LTIP value for FY2023 was based on the 
vesting value of the FY2021 LTIP awards and was calculated based on a share price of £1.487 (representing the average closing share 
price between 24 February 2023 and 28 February 2023 converted to €1.696 using an FX rate of 0.87701). In the single total figure of 
remuneration table above this has been updated to reflect the share price of £1.354 (being the closing share price on the next working 
day after the date of vesting of 4 December 2023, converted to €1.580 using an FX rate of 0.857). 
2. The performance measures and targets for the FY2022 LTIP awards were determined as discussed in the FY2022 report. As noted 
in the Chair’s letter the performance measures and targets for the FY2022 LTIP awards (granted in June 2021) were determined 
having regard to the uncertain and unprecedented economic environment associated with COVID-19, its already significant and 
disproportionate impact on the business and the industry compared to the broader economy and the associated forward looking 
continued uncertainty. The measures and targets are as set out below.
FY2022 LTIP Performance Conditions
Performance condition
Weighting
Performance 
target
% of element 
vesting
Outturn
Vesting
Earnings per share
45%
Threshold
22.0c
25%
8.1 cent
0%
(0% of total award)
Maximum
24.5c
100%
Free cash flow
35%
Threshold
65%
25%
91%
100%
(35% of total award)
Maximum
75%
100%
Environmental – reduction in Scope 1 and Scope 2 
emissions over the three financial years ending FY2024
20%
Threshold
6% reduction 
25%
24%
100%
(20% of total award)
Maximum
12% reduction
100%
Therefore, the awards vested at 55% of the maximum. 
As noted in the Chair’s letter, this reflects the strong performance in respect of cash, along with our delivery against our environmental 
targets notwithstanding that the threshold level of performance in respect of the EPS measure was not achieved reflecting the challenging 
macro-economic backdrop over the performance period as a whole. The prior year accounting adjustments discussed on page 56, do not 
impact the vesting of the FY2022 LTIP awards.
Directors’ Remuneration Committee Report
(continued)
154
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Reflecting that Patrick McMahon was employed throughout the three-year performance period, he will retain his award which will be 
released to him at the end of a two-year holding period, subject to standard malus and clawback terms.
In line with the UK Regulations the value of the LTIP awards vesting is included in the single total figure of remuneration on the following 
basis.
Shares subject to award
Vested shares
Value of shares in the  
single total figure of remuneration2
David Forde
377,953
153,3901
€265,773
Patrick McMahon
230,058
126,531
€219,236
1. 	 The number of vested shares reflects the reduction to take into account David Forde’s period of service, as set out on page 156.
2.	 Based on a share price at vesting of £1.4842 (representing the average closing price over the last quarter of FY2024) converted to €1.7327 using an FX rate of 0.8566. The 
share price used to determine the value of the shares in the single total figure table is less than the share price at grant and, accordingly, no amount of the award is attributable 
to share price appreciation.
(e) Pensions related benefits
No Executive Director accrued any benefits under a defined benefit pension scheme. Under their service contracts, the Executive Directors 
received a cash payment of 5% of base salary in order to provide their own pension benefits as disclosed in column (e) of the table.
(f) Termination payments
David Forde stepped down from the Board on 18 May 2023. The single total figure of remuneration table includes his remuneration earned 
to this date and payments made to him in connection with his leaving the business, further information in relation to which is set out below.
Information in relation to the remuneration arrangements associated with Patrick McMahon stepping down as the Group’s CEO and from 
the Board in June 2024 will be disclosed in the FY2025 Remuneration Report.
As noted above, reflecting that Patrick McMahon was employed throughout the three-year performance period he will retain the LTIP 
award granted to him in respect of FY2022 which will vest in respect of 126,531 shares, as referred to earlier in this report. Recognising his 
significant contribution to C&C over many years, the Committee exercised discretion to allow Patrick to retain the LTIP awards granted to 
him in respect of FY2023 and FY2024 which will vest following the assessment of the performance conditions following the end of FY2025 
and FY2026 respectively and be subject to a reduction to reflect his period of service. The holding period will apply to all these LTIP awards 
to the extent they vest.   The post-employment shareholding requirement will also apply to the shares acquired under the LTIP until June 
2026. The malus and clawback provisions in the Policy will continue to apply.
Additional Information
Fees from external appointments
None.
Payments to Former Directors and Payments for Loss of Office
David Forde stepped down as Chief Executive Officer with effect from 18 May 2023. 
The arrangements made in respect of David Forde leaving the Company are in line with the Remuneration Policy approved by 
Shareholders at the 2021 AGM. 
David Forde received a payment on termination of his employment of €1,895,556 to compromise any claims that he had against the 
Company and other legal obligations owed by the Company to him, and which included a payment for annual leave accrued, a contribution 
towards his professional advice costs and a payment of €723,690 in lieu of his notice period. 
David Forde retained the following LTIP awards: (1) the LTIP award granted to him in respect of FY2022 which will vest in respect of 
153,390 shares, as referred to earlier in this report after taking into account his period of service; and (2) the LTIP award granted to him in 
respect of FY2023 which will vest following the assessment of the performance conditions following the end of FY2025 and be subject to 
a reduction to reflect his period of service. The holding period will apply to the FY2022 and FY2023 LTIP awards to the extent they vest. 
David Forde retained the second Buy-Out Award granted to him on joining the Company, which vested in November 2023. 
155
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Directors’ Shareholdings and Share Interests
Shareholding guidelines
Executive Directors are required to build up (and maintain) a minimum holding of shares in the Company. Under the Policy, the Executive 
Directors are expected to maintain a personal shareholding of at least two times’ salary.
Executive Directors are expected to retain 50% of the after-tax value of vested share awards until at least the shareholding guideline has 
been met.
Executive Directors’ Interests in Share Capital of the Company (Audited)
The beneficial interests, including family interests, of the Directors and the Company Secretary in office during the year ended 29 February 
2024 in the share capital of the Company are detailed below:
29 February 2024 
(or date of leaving 
the Board if earlier)
Total
1 March 2023
Total
Directors
Patrick McMahon
116,438
94,728
David Forde
48,092
48,092
Total
164,530
142,820
Patrick McMahon’s progress towards satisfying the shareholding requirements as CEO is shown in the table below:
Director
Shareholding
Target value
Value as at 29 February 2024*
Patrick McMahon
250,816
€1,404,000
€434,580
* Based on a share price of £1.4842 (representing the average closing price over the last quarter of FY2024) converted to €1.7327 using an FX rate of 0.8566.
Company Secretary
29 February 2024
Total
1 March 2023
Total
Mark Chilton
48,892
22,693
Between 29 February 2024 and 6 June 2024, the date Patrick McMahon stepped down from the Board, Patrick McMahon acquired 448 
shares under the Irish APSS. The Company Secretary also holds 459 shares in the UK SIP as at 29 February 2024. Between 29 February 
2024 and 20 June 2024 the latest practicable date (or 6 June 2024 in the case of Patrick McMahon), there were no other changes in the 
above Directors’ or the Company Secretary’s interests between these dates. No Executive Director participates in the UK SIP.
The Directors and Company Secretary have no beneficial interests in any Group subsidiary or joint venture undertakings.
Directors’ Remuneration Committee Report
(continued)
156
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Share incentive plan interests awarded during year (Audited)
LTIP
The table below sets out the plan interests awarded to Executive Directors during the year ended 29 February 2024. Awards granted under 
the LTIP are subject to performance conditions as set out on page 141 measured over a performance period ending at the end of February 
2026.
Executive Director
Type of award
Maximum opportunity
Number of shares
Face value
(at date of grant in €)2
% of maximum opportunity 
vesting at threshold
Patrick McMahon
LTIP
150% of base salary
639,769
1,012,500
25%
1. The award was granted on 14 June 2023 in the form of a nil cost option over €0.01 Ordinary Shares in the Company.
2. The face value of the LTIP award is based on the number of shares under award multiplied by the average of the mid-market closing share price of the three working days before 
the date of grant converted into €, being £1.3587 (converted into €1.5826 using an exchange rate of £1: €1.1648).
3. The award will vest in accordance with its terms, based on the extent to which the applicable performance conditions are met and will be subject to time pro-rating (measured 
based on the period from the relevant award date up to the date of Patrick McMahon’s termination of employment.
Directors’ Interests in Options (Audited)
Interests in options over Ordinary Shares of €0.01 each in the Company
Directors
Date of grant
Exercise price
Plan
Exercise period
Total at 1 
March 2023 
Awarded in 
year
Exercised in 
year
Lapsed in 
year
Total at 29 February 
2024 (or if earlier 
date of departure 
from the Board)
David  
Forde1
03/11/20
nil
Buy-out 12
03/11/22-03/11/30
449,627
-
449,627
-
-
03/11/20
nil
Buy-out 22
03/11/22-03/11/30
449,627
-
-
449,627
02/12/20
nil
LTIP
02/12/23-02/12/30
252,052
-
252,052
-
15/06/21
nil
LTIP
15/06/24-15/06/31
377,953
-
-
224,5634
153,390
09/06/22
nil
LTIP
09/06/25-09/06/30
458,023
-
-
370,8425
87,181
Total
1,987,282
-
701,679
595,405
690,198
Patrick 
McMahon4
2/12/20
nil
LTIP
2/12/23-02/12/30
153,423
-
-
153,423
15/06/21
nil
LTIP
15/06/24-15/06/31
230,058
-
103,5274
126,531
09/06/22
nil
LTIP
09/06/25-09/06/32
278,796
-
-
- 5
278,796
14/06/23
nil
LTIP
14/06/26-14/06/33
639,769
-
-
639,769
Total
662,277
639,769
-
103,527
1,198,519
Mark  
Chilton
15/06/21
nil
R&R3
15/06/22-14/06/28
48,894
-
48,894
-
-
09/06/22
nil
R&R
09/06/25-08/06/29
50,000
-
-
50,000
14/06/23
nil
R&R
14/06/25-13/06/30
-
93,670
-
-
93,670
Total
98,894
93,670
48,984
-
143,670
Key: LTIP – Long Term Incentive Plan approved in 2015;
1. 	 The treatment of David Forde’s LTIP awards in connection with his departure from the business is described on page 156. 
2. 	 During FY2021, David Forde was granted awards ('Buy-Out Awards') to replace remuneration forfeited upon his departure from his former employer. The Buy-Out Awards were 
granted in the form of nil cost options over €0.01 Ordinary Shares in the Company. The number of shares under award was determined by reference to the value of the forfeited 
remuneration.
3.	 R&R is the C&C Group Recruitment and Retention Plan 2010. 
4.	 The FY2022 LTIP awards partially lapsed during the year.
5.	 Awards lapsed in year is only insofar as approved by the Board.
No price was paid for any award of options. The price of the Company’s Ordinary Shares as quoted on the London Stock Exchange at the 
close of business on 29 February 2024 was £1.43 (28 February 2023: £1.49). The price of the Company’s Ordinary Shares ranged between 
£1.23 and £1.59 during the year.
There was no movement in the interests of the Directors in options over the Company’s Ordinary Shares between 29 February 2024 and 
29 June 2024 (6 June 2024 for Patrick McMahon).
157
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Single Total Figure of Remuneration – Non-Executive Directors (Audited)
The table below reports the total fees receivable in respect of qualifying services by each Non-Executive Director during the year ended 29 
February 2024 and the prior year.
Year ended February
Salary/fees
2024
€’000
2023
€’000
Non-Executive Directors
Vineet Bhalla
98
76
Jill Caseberry
85
80
Vincent Crowley
98
93
Helen Pitcher1
47
100
Jim Thompson2
41
95
John Gibney3
96
26
Ralph Findlay4
571
187
Angela Bromfield5
57
-
Chris Browne6
33
-
Sarah Newbitt7
 
-
Emer Finnan8
-
98
Stuart Gilliland9
-
81
Total
1,163
836
1. 	 Helen Pitcher stepped down from the Board on 13 July 2023.
2. 	 Jim Thompson stepped down from the Board on 13 July 2023.
3. 	 John Gibney was appointed to the Board on 26 October 2022, the figures reflect his remuneration for the year from appointment.
4. 	 The fees paid to Ralph Findlay: (a) for the year ended February 2023 reflect his position as a Non-Executive Director between 1 March 2022 and 7 July 2022, and his position 
as Non-Executive Chair for the remainder of the year; and (b) for the year ended February 2024 reflect his position as a Non-Executive Chair between 1 March 2023 and 18 
May 2023, and his position as Executive Chair for the remainder of the year.
5. 	 Angela Bromfield was appointed to the Board on 13 July 2023, the figures reflect her remuneration for the year from appointment.
6. 	 Chris Browne was appointed to the Board on 2 October 2023, the figures reflect her remuneration for the year from appointment.
7. 	 Sarah Newbitt was appointed to the Board on 31 August 2023, the figures reflect her remuneration for the year from appointment.
8.   Emer Finnan stepped down from the Board on 8 February 2023.
9.   Stewart Gilliland stepped down from the Board on 7 July 2022.
Fees paid to Non-Executive Directors are determined and approved by the Board as a whole. The Committee recommends the 
remuneration of the Chair to the Board.
Fees are reviewed from time to time and adjusted to reflect market positioning and any change in responsibilities.
Non-Executive Directors receive a base fee and an additional fee for further duties as set out on in the following table:
Non-Executive Role / Position
Fees for FY2024
€
Non-Executive Chair
250,0001
Base fee
67,015
Senior Independent Director
15,000
Audit Committee Chair
25,000
Remuneration Committee Chair
20,000
ESG Committee Chair
20,000
Nomination Committee Chair (other than where this Chaired by the Chair of the Board)
12,000
Audit Committee member
5,000
ESG Committee member
5,000
Remuneration Committee member
5,000
Nomination Committee member
3,000
Designated Employee Engagement Non-Executive Director
10,000
1. 	 This is the fee for the Non-Executive Chair with effect from Ralph Findlay’s appointment to that role. As noted earlier in this report, Ralph Findlay’s fee was increased during 
FY2024 to reflect his position as Executive Chair. 
Directors’ Remuneration Committee Report
(continued)
158
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

25
50
75
100
125
150
175
200
C&C Group
FTSE 250 Index
Feb 2020
Feb 2021
Feb 2023
Feb 2024
Feb 2022
Feb 2019
Feb 2018
Feb 2017
Feb 2016
Feb 2015
Feb 2014
Non-Executive Directors’ Interests in Share Capital of the Company (Audited)
The beneficial interests, including family interests, of the Non-Executive Directors in office during the year ended 29 February 2024 in the 
share capital of the Company are detailed below:
29 February 2024
(or date of 
retirement from the 
board if earlier)
Total
1 March 2023
(or date of 
appointment if 
later)
Total
Directors
Vineet Bhalla
15,000
10,000
Jill Caseberry
6,462
6,304
Vincent Crowley
25,216
25,216
Helen Pitcher1
8,015
8,015
Jim Thompson2
-
157,780
John Gibney
-
-
Ralph Findlay
135,359
47,100
Angela Bromfield 3
-
-
Chris Browne4
-
-
Sarah Newbitt5
-
-
Total
190,052
254,415
1. 	 Helen Pitcher stepped down from the Board on 13 July 2023.
2. 	 Jim Thompson stepped down from the Board on 13 July 2023.
3. 	 Angela Bromfield was appointed to the Board on 13 July 2023.
4. 	 Chris Browne was appointed to the Board on 2 October 2023.
5. 	 Sarah Newbitt was appointed to the Board on 31 August 2023.
There were no changes in the above Non-Executive Directors’ share interests between 29 February 2024 and 20 June 2024.
Performance graph and table
This graph shows the value, at 29 February 2024, of £100 invested in the Company on 28 February 2014 compared to the value of £100 
invested in the FTSE 250 Index. The Committee believes that this is the most appropriate index against which to compare the performance 
of the Company.
Total Shareholder return
159
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Chief Executive Officer
The following table sets out information on the remuneration of the Chief Executive Officer for the ten years to 29 February 2024:
Total Remuneration
€’000
Annual Bonus
(as % of maximum opportunity)
Long term incentives vesting
(% as of maximum number of 
shares)
FY2015
Stephen Glancey
980
Nil
Nil
FY2016
Stephen Glancey
1,230
25%
Nil
FY2017
Stephen Glancey
1,052
Nil
Nil
FY2018
Stephen Glancey
994
18%
Nil
FY2019
Stephen Glancey
1,777
100%
Nil
FY2020
Stephen Glancey (to 15/01/20)
2,219
25%
100%
FY2020
Stewart Gilliland (from 16/01/20)
71
N/A
N/A
FY2021
Stewart Gilliland (to 02/11/20)
301
N/A
N/A
FY2021
David Forde (from 02/11/20)
1,731
Nil
Nil
FY2022
David Forde
776
Nil
Nil
FY2023
David Forde
804
Nil
65%
FY2024
David Forde (to 18/05/2023)
176
 Nil
41%1
FY2024
Patrick McMahon (from 19/05/2023)
533
Nil
55%
1.	 Pro rata vesting based on service in the performance period.
The amounts set out in the above table were translated from Sterling based on the average exchange rate for the relevant year.
FY2024: David Forde stepped down from the Board on 18 May 2023 and Patrick McMahon was appointed CEO with immediate effect. 
The salary, taxable benefits, annual bonus, long term incentives and pension figures are calculated for the period in office.
Notes in relation to the basis of disclosure for previous years are included in the Directors’ Remuneration Reports for those years.
Ratio of the pay of the CEO to that of the UK lower quartile, median and upper quartile employees
The table below shows the ratio of the pay of the CEO to that of the UK lower quartile, median and upper quartile full-time equivalent 
employees in FY2021, FY2022, FY2023 and FY2024. For the wider workforce, the value of benefits provided in the year has not been 
included as the data is not readily available. In the view of the Company, this does not have a meaningful impact on the pay ratios. 
For FY2024, the ratios are calculated by reference to David Forde’s remuneration for the period he was CEO, but annualised to reflect that 
this was part of the year only.
Figures for earlier years are presented on the same basis as in the Directors’ Remuneration Report for the prior year.
The UK regulations provide three methods for the calculation of the CEO Pay Ratio, A, B and C with Option A (modified) being the preferred 
method as it is the most statistically accurate. In calculating the ratio, the Company determined full time equivalent annual remuneration 
for UK employees, employed in the business as at 29 February 2024. Set out below is the remuneration and salary component of that 
remuneration for the CEO and for employees in the 25th, 50th (median) and 75th quartiles.
Directors’ Remuneration Committee Report
(continued)
160
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Year
CEO total remuneration
(salary) €
25th percentile employee 
remuneration
(salary) €
Median employee  
remuneration
(salary) €
75th percentile employee 
remuneration
(salary) €
2020
2,218,941
697,954
26,146
24,080
32,257
30,024
45,075
39,232
2021
2,031,946
531,161
23,465
22,146
29,667
27,894
42,290
38,358
2022
776,250
690,000
26,759
25,281
34,125
31,511
45,338
41,613
2023
1,201,701
714,150
28,957
27,450
35,795
33,661
47,896 
44,183
2024
1,084,742
723,960
31,070
29,220
38,135
35,526
50,660
46,542
Salary Only Ratios
Year
Method
25th percentile ratio
Median Ratio
75th percentile ratio
2020
Option A
29.0:1
23.2:1
17.8:1
2021
Option A
24.0:1
19.0:1
13.8:1
2022
Option A
27.3:1
21.9:1
16.6:1
2023
Option A
26.0:1
21.2:1
16.2:1
2024
Option A
24.8:1
20.4:1
15.6:1
Total Remuneration Ratios
Year
Method
25th percentile ratio
Median Ratio
75th percentile ratio
2020
Option A
84.9:1
68.8:1
49.2:1
2021
Option A
86.6:1
68.5:1
48.0:1
2022
Option A
29.0:1
22.7:1
17.1:1
2023
Option A
41.5:1
33.6:1
25.1:1
2024
Option A
34.9 :1
28.4 :1
21.4 :1
The Company believes that the median pay ratio for FY2024 is consistent with the pay, reward and progression policies for the UK 
employees. The change in the ratios between FY2023 and FY2024 are attributable to salary movements during the year.
161
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Annual Percentage Change in Remuneration of Directors and Employees
The table below reports the annual percentage change in salary/fees and bonus of the Directors and employees between FY2020 
and FY2024 in accordance with the UK Regulations. The UK Regulations also require that this disclosure be included in relation to 
benefits. However, due to the difficulty in obtaining this data, we have decided not to include benefits for the purpose of the calculation, 
consistent with our approach to the CEO Pay Ratio. The average employee disclosure shows the average percentage change in the 
same remuneration over the same period in respect of the Company’s UK full time equivalent employees, by reported numbers. We have 
used the Company’s UK full time equivalent employees as the comparator group for consistency with the approach to the CEO Pay Ratio 
calculation.
The average employee change has been calculated by reference to the mean of employee pay. Angela Bromfield, Chris Browne and 
Sarah Newbitt were appointed to the Board during FY2024 and, accordingly, have also been excluded. David Forde, Helen Pitcher and 
Jim Thompson left the Board during FY2024 and, accordingly, have been excluded from the table below. Notes in relation to the basis of 
disclosure for previous years are included in the Directors’ Remuneration Reports for those years.
Average  
Employee
Patrick  
McMahon1
Jill  
Caseberry
Vincent  
Crowley
Ralph 
Findlay2
John  
Gibney3
Vineet  
Bhalla3
Salary/Fees
FY2020-FY2021
(4.2%)
N/A
(7.2%)
(7.0%)
N/A
N/A
N/A
FY2021-FY2022
1.6%
0.0%
21.9%
54.4%
N/A
N/A
N/A
FY2022-FY2023
7.4%
3.5%
6.7%
(23.1%)
N/A
N/A
18.8%
FY2023-FY2024
3.59%
41.8%
6.6%
5.02%
205.35%
30.2%
32.62%
Annual 
Bonus
FY2020-FY2021
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
FY2021-FY2022
0.6%
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
FY2022-FY2023
0.0%
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
FY2023-FY2024
0%
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
1. 	 The increase in Patrick McMahon’s salary and bonus between FY2023 and FY2024 reflect his appointment as CEO during FY2024
2 	 The increase in Ralph Findlay’s fees between FY2023 and FY2024 reflect his appointment as Executive Chair during FY2024.
3. 	 John Gibney was appointed to the Board during FY2023 and Vineet Bhalla during FY2022. For the purposes of the table above, their fees for FY2023 (in the case of John 
Gibney) and for FY2022 (in the case of Vineet Bhalla) have been annualised in order to calculate the changes between FY2023 and FY2024 (in the case of John Gibney) and 
between FY2022 and FY2023 (in the case of Vineet Bhalla).
Implementation of the Remuneration Policy in FY2025
Based on the continuation of the existing approach, the Committee’s intended approach to the implementation of the Policy for FY2025 is 
set out in the Chair letter on pages 2 to 5.
Directors’ Remuneration Committee Report
(continued)
162
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Shareholder Voting on the Directors’ Remuneration Report and Directors’ Remuneration Policy
The following table sets out the votes at the 2023 AGM in respect of the Report and at the 2021 AGM the Policy
Directors’ Remuneration Report
AGM
For
Against
Withheld
2023
289,498,020
16,922,697
15,028,876
Directors’ Remuneration Policy
AGM
For
Against
Withheld
2021
273,330,524
14,729,936
4,135
The Company is committed to ongoing Shareholder dialogue and takes Shareholder views into consideration when formulating 
remuneration policy and practice. 
The Company is incorporated in Ireland and is therefore not subject to the UK company law requirement to submit its Directors’ 
Remuneration Policy to a binding vote. Nonetheless, in line with our commitment to best practice, at the AGM in July 2021, our Policy was 
approved by our Shareholders on an advisory basis.
This report was approved by the Board and signed on its behalf by
Angela Bromfield
Remuneration Committee Chair
27 June 2024
Find out more 
The full responsibilities of the Committee are set out in its 
Terms of Reference, which are available on our website 
candcgroupplc.com/corporate-governance/terms-of-reference. 
163
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Statement of Directors’ Responsibilities
The Directors are responsible for 
preparing the Annual Report and the 
Group and Company financial statements, 
in accordance with applicable law and 
regulations.
Company law requires the Directors to 
prepare Group and Company financial 
statements for each financial year. Under 
that law, the Directors are required to 
prepare the Group financial statements 
in accordance with International Financial 
Reporting Standards (‘IFRSs’) as adopted 
by the EU, and have elected to prepare 
the Company financial statements in 
accordance with Irish Law (Irish Generally 
Accepted Accounting Practice), including 
FRS 101 ‘Reduced Disclosure Framework’ 
(‘FRS 101’).
Under Irish Company law, the Directors 
must not approve the financial statements 
unless they are satisfied that they give a true 
and fair view of the assets, liabilities and 
financial position of the Group and parent 
company as at the end of the financial year, 
and the profit or loss for the Group for the 
financial year, and otherwise comply with 
Companies Act 2014.
In preparing each of the Group and 
Company financial statements the Directors 
are required to:
•	 select suitable accounting policies and 
apply them consistently;
•	 make judgements and estimates that are 
reasonable and prudent;
•	 state that the Group financial statements 
comply with IFRS as adopted by the EU 
and as regards the Company, comply with 
FRS 101 together with the requirements of 
Irish Company Law; and
•	 prepare the financial statements on 
the going concern basis, unless it is 
inappropriate to presume that the Group 
and Company will continue in business.
The Directors are also required by the 
Transparency (Directive 2004/109/EC0) 
Regulations 2007 and the Transparency 
rules of the Central Bank of Ireland to 
include a management report containing a 
fair review of the business and the position 
of the Group and the parent Company 
and a description of the principal risks and 
uncertainties facing the Group. 
The Directors are responsible for adequate 
accounting records which disclose with 
reasonable accuracy at any time the assets, 
liabilities, financial position and profit or loss 
of the Company, and which will enable them 
to ensure that the financial statements of 
the Group are prepared in accordance with 
applicable IFRS as adopted by the European 
Union and comply with the provisions of Irish 
Company Law. They are also responsible 
for safeguarding the assets of the Company 
and the Group, and hence for taking 
reasonable steps for the prevention and 
detection of fraud and other irregularities.
The Directors have appointed appropriate 
accounting personnel, including a 
professionally qualified Chief Financial 
Officer, in order to ensure that those 
requirements are met. 
The Directors are responsible for the 
maintenance and integrity of the corporate 
and financial information included on the 
Company’s website (www.candcgroupplc.
com). Legislation in Ireland concerning the 
preparation and dissemination of financial 
statements may differ from legislation in 
other jurisdictions.
Responsibility Statement as 
required by the Transparency 
Directive and UK Corporate 
Governance Code
Each of the Directors, whose names and 
functions are listed on pages 93 and 94 of 
this Annual Report, confirm that, to the best 
of each person’s knowledge and belief:
•	 So far as they are aware, there is no 
relevant audit information of which the 
Company’s statutory auditor is unaware;
•	 They have taken all steps that they ought 
to have taken as Directors in order to 
make themselves aware of any relevant 
audit information and to establish that the 
Company’s statutory auditor is aware of 
that information. 
•	 The Group Financial Statements, 
prepared in accordance with IFRS as 
adopted by the European Union and the 
Company financial statements prepared in 
accordance with FRS 101 give a true and 
fair view of the assets, liabilities, financial 
position of the Group and Company at 29 
February 2024 and of the profit or loss of 
the Group for the year then ended;
•	 The Directors’ Report contained in the 
Annual Report includes a fair review of 
the development and performance of the 
business and the position of the Group 
and Company, together with a description 
of the principal risks and uncertainties that 
they face; and
•	 The Annual Report and Financial 
Statements, taken as a whole, provides 
the information necessary to assess 
the Group’s performance, business 
model and strategy and is fair, balanced 
and understandable and provides the 
information necessary for Shareholders 
to assess the Company’s position and 
performance, business model and 
strategy.
Signed on behalf of the Board
Ralph Findlay
Chair & Chief Executive Officer
Andrew Andrea
Chief Financial Officer
27 June 2024
164
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Financial
Statements
166
Independent Auditor’s Report
182
Consolidated Income Statement
183
Consolidated Statement of 
Comprehensive Income
184
Consolidated Balance Sheet
185
Consolidated Cash Flow Statement
186
Consolidated Statement of  
Changes in Equity
187
Company Balance Sheet
188
Company Statement of  
Changes In Equity
189
Statement of Accounting Policies
205
Notes Forming Part of the Financial 
Statements
272
Financial Definitions
165
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Report on the audit of the financial statements
Opinion 
We have audited the financial statements of C&C Group plc (‘the 
Company’) and its subsidiaries (‘the Group’) for the year ended 29 
February 2024, which comprise:
•	 the Consolidated Income Statement and the Consolidated 
Statement of Comprehensive Income for the year then ended;
•	 the Consolidated Balance Sheet and the Company Balance 
Sheet as at 29 February 2024;
•	 the Consolidated Cash Flow Statement for the year then ended;
•	 the Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity and the 
Company Statement of Changes in Equity for the year then 
ended; and
•	 the notes to the financial statements, including the material 
accounting policy information set out on pages 189 to 204. 
The financial reporting framework that has been applied in their 
preparation is Irish Law and International Financial Reporting 
Standards (IFRS) as adopted by the European Union and, as 
regards the Company financial statements, Accounting Standards 
including FRS 101 Reduced Disclosure Framework issued in the 
United Kingdom by the Financial Reporting Council.  
In our opinion:
•	 the Group financial statements give a true and fair view of the 
assets, liabilities and financial position of the Group as at 29 
February 2024 and of its loss for the year then ended; 
•	 the Company financial statements give a true and fair view of the 
assets, liabilities and financial position of the Company as at 29 
February 2024; 
•	 the Group financial statements have been properly prepared in 
accordance with IFRS as adopted by the European Union;
•	 the Company financial statements have been properly prepared 
in accordance with FRS 101 Reduced Disclosure Framework; 
and 
•	 the Group financial statements and Company financial 
statements have been properly prepared in accordance with the 
requirements of the Companies Act 2014.
Basis for opinion
We conducted our audit in accordance with International Standards 
on Auditing (Ireland) (ISAs (Ireland)) and applicable law. Our 
responsibilities under those standards are further described in the 
Auditor's Responsibilities for the Audit of the Financial Statements 
section of our report. We are independent of the Group and 
Company in accordance with ethical requirements that are relevant 
to our audit of financial statements in Ireland, including the Ethical 
Standard issued by the Irish Auditing and Accounting Supervisory 
Authority (IAASA) as applied to listed entities, and we have 
fulfilled our other ethical responsibilities in accordance with these 
requirements.
We believe that the audit evidence we have obtained is sufficient 
and appropriate to provide a basis for our opinion.
Independent Auditor’s Report
to the Members of C&C Group plc
Conclusions relating to going concern  
In auditing the financial statements, we have concluded that 
the directors’ use of the going concern basis of accounting in 
the preparation of the financial statements is appropriate. Our 
evaluation of the directors’ assessment, which covered a period up 
to 31 August 2025, of the Group and parent Company’s ability to 
continue to adopt the going concern basis of accounting included: 
•	 Confirming our understanding of management’s going concern 
assessment process and also engaging with management to 
ensure all key factors were considered in their assessment;
•	 Considering whether events or conditions existed that may cast 
doubt on the Group’s ability to continue as a going concern for a 
period to 31 August 2025;
•	 Obtaining management’s board-approved going concern 
assessment, including the cash forecast and covenant 
calculations for the going concern period. The Group has 
modelled a number of adverse scenarios in their cash forecasts 
and covenant calculations in order to incorporate unexpected 
changes to the forecasted liquidity of the Group;
•	 Considering the consistency of information obtained from other 
areas of the audit such as the forecasts used for impairment 
assessments;
•	 Considering past historical accuracy of management’s forecasts;
•	 Considering the appropriateness of the methods used to 
calculate the cash forecasts and covenant calculations and 
determining through inspection and testing of the methodology 
and calculations that the methods utilised were appropriately 
sophisticated to be able to make an assessment for the Group;
•	 Considering the mitigating factors included in the cash forecasts 
and covenant calculations that are within control of the Group. 
This included our review of the Group’s non-operating cash 
outflows and evaluating the Group’s ability to control these 
outflows as mitigating actions if required. We also verified credit 
facilities available to the Group;
•	 Performing reverse stress testing in order to identify what factors 
would lead to the Group breaching financial covenants during the 
going concern period; and
•	 Reviewing the Group’s going concern disclosures included in 
the Annual Report and Accounts in order to assess that the 
disclosures were appropriate and in conformity with the reporting 
standards. 
Our key observations
We have observed that the Group has adapted to a high-inflation 
environment, generating operating cashflows of €83.3m in the year 
ended 29 February 2024. Further, the Group continues to have 
access to significant liquidity. At 29 February 2024, the Group has 
unrestricted cash and cash equivalents of €160.1m and unused 
committed debt facilities of up to €230m from a revolving bank 
credit facility expiring in January 2029. 
166
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Conclusion 
Based on the work we have performed, we have not identified any material uncertainties relating to events or conditions that, individually 
or collectively, may cast significant doubt on the Group or the parent Company’s ability to continue as a going concern for a period to 31 
August 2025.
In relation to the Group and parent Company’s reporting on how they have applied the UK Corporate Governance Code, we have 
nothing material to add or draw attention to in relation to the directors’ statement in the financial statements about whether the directors 
considered it appropriate to adopt the going concern basis of accounting.
Our responsibilities and the responsibilities of the directors with respect to going concern are described in the relevant sections of this 
report. However, because not all future events or conditions can be predicted, this statement is not a guarantee as to the Group and 
parent Company’s ability to continue as a going concern.
Overview of our audit approach
Audit 
scope
•	 We performed an audit of the financial information of 13 components and performed audit procedures on specific 
balances for a further 2 components.
•	 We performed specified procedures at a further 1 component that were determined by the Group audit team in 
response to specific risk factors. We also performed review procedures at a further 1 component.
•	 The components where we performed either full or specific audit procedures accounted for 96.4% of the Group’s 
Loss before tax, 99.6% of the Group’s Net Revenue and 98.3% of the Group’s Total Assets.
•	 Components represent business units across the Group considered for audit scoping purposes.
Key audit 
matters
•	 Management override of internal controls, and related prior period adjustments
•	 Inventory existence and valuation
•	 Carrying value of goodwill and intangible brand assets, including related impairment charges 
•	 Revenue recognition
•	 Recoverability of on-trade receivable balances and advances to customers
•	 Carrying value of investment in subsidiary undertakings in the parent Company financial statements, and related 
impairment charges
Materiality
•	 Overall Group materiality was assessed to be €3.30m which represents approximately 0.2% of the Group’s Net 
Revenue. In our prior year audit, we adopted a materiality of €3.34m which represented approximately 5% of the 
Group’s Profit before tax and before non-recurring exceptional items for the year ended 28 February 2023. Given the 
fluctuation in the Group’s results, we have chosen to base our materiality on the Group’s Net Revenue as we consider 
it to be the most relevant performance metric to the Stakeholders of the Group.
•	 We determined materiality for the Company to be €3.30m (2023: €3.34m).
What has 
changed?
•	 Following the findings in the Investigative Accountants’ Report, management’s further reviews, and our audit 
procedures, management recorded adjustments in the current year financial statements in respect of the current year, 
and restatements to prior period financial statements for the year ended 28 February 2023 and opening balances as 
at 1 March 2022.  Therefore, in the current year, our auditor’s report includes new key audit matters in relation to:
	- Management override of internal controls, and related prior period adjustments; and 
	- Inventory existence and valuation.
•	 In the current year, our auditor’s report also includes a key audit matter in relation to the Carrying value of investment 
in subsidiary undertakings in the parent Company financial statements, and related impairment charges given the 
continued differential in the market capitalisation relative to the carrying value of investment recorded on the parent 
Company balance sheet.
•	 We continued to adopt a fully substantive approach for this year’s audit.  In light of the findings in the Investigative 
Accountants’ Report over the lack of transparency in respect of representations and accuracy of information 
provided, to the External Auditors, and to the Audit Committee and the Board of Directors, at the time the items arose 
and in subsequent financial years, we considered the risk of management bias and sought further corroborative and 
third-party evidence throughout our audit procedures and evaluated our findings.  Additionally, we sought additional 
representations from the new Group CFO, the Audit Committee and the Board of Directors. We have also applied the 
lower end of testing threshold ranges in the performance of our audit procedures.
167
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Key audit matters (KAM)
Key audit matters are those matters that, in our professional judgement, were of most significance in our audit of the financial statements of 
the current period and include the most significant assessed risks of material misstatement (whether or not due to fraud) that we identified, 
including those which had the greatest effect on: the overall audit strategy, the allocation of resources in the audit; and directing the efforts of 
the engagement team. These matters were addressed in the context of our audit of the financial statements as a whole, and in forming our 
opinion thereon, and we do not provide a separate opinion on these matters. 
Risk
Our response to the risk
Key observations communicated to the Audit Committee 
Management override of internal 
controls, and related prior period 
adjustments (Group financial 
statements)
Refer to the Audit Committee Report 
(pages 114 to 122), Corporate Governance 
Report (pages 90 to 107) and the prior 
period adjustments as reflected in Note 31 
to the Consolidated Financial Statements 
(pages 266 to 271).
As described in the Corporate 
Governance Report on pages 94 to 
107, after discrepancies were notified by 
Management to the Audit Committee with 
respect to inventory related matters at 
the Clonmel plant, the Audit Committee 
appointed an independent accounting 
firm (the ‘Investigative Accountants’) to 
investigate the discrepancies to determine 
any potential financial impact and the time 
period over which the issues extended (the 
‘Investigation’).
The Investigation identified a number of 
significant findings, including:
•	 inventory existence and valuation related 
matters;
•	 other balance sheet matters (including 
accounting for Goods Received Not 
Invoiced balances (‘GRNI’), as well as 
other items); 
•	 failures in the Group’s reporting 
processes, including the breakdown 
in internal controls and governance 
frameworks during the year and in prior 
years as a result of the override of the 
Group’s internal controls; and
•	 lack of transparency over 
representations and the correctness 
and accuracy of information provided to 
the External Auditors, and to the Audit 
Committee and the Board of Directors, 
at the time the items arose and in 
subsequent financial years.
Our response to this key audit matter was 
led by the Group audit team with assistance 
from our team of forensic specialists, and 
our component audit teams.  
We evaluated the process and considered 
the design and implementation of key 
controls related to management override 
of controls.  We note that there has been a 
breakdown in related controls and in that 
context, we considered the nature and 
extent of the findings from the Investigation 
in determining our assessment of the risk 
of material misstatement to the Group 
financial statements, including the risk of 
management override of controls.  
As a result of the matters identified, we 
added additional partner and senior 
executive resources to our component 
teams and to the Group audit team, which 
was allocated to review the key judgemental 
audit areas. Lower testing thresholds were 
used on all accounts resulting in increased 
sample testing. 
We considered the overall governance 
and oversight process, including the 
independence and objectivity of those 
charged with governance, the quality and 
timeliness of the information provided 
to them; the Group’s code of conduct 
and whistle-blowing processes and the 
communication of these across the Group.
Our additional audit procedures, in 
conjunction with our forensic specialists, 
and our component teams, included:
•	 engaging our forensic specialists to 
examine the scope and results of the 
work carried out by the Investigative 
Accountants by holding discussions 
with them, reviewing their supporting 
evidence and, performing additional 
procedures which included considering 
the sufficiency, appropriateness of 
the investigation performed and the 
competency and objectivity of individuals 
undertaking it; 
In addition to the matters identified by 
the Investigative Accountants’ Report, 
and those arising from Management’s 
additional reviews, our audit procedures 
identified further errors in prior periods and 
identified material errors in the allocation 
of the correcting adjustments to financial 
periods. Following extensive discussions 
with Management, the Audit Committee 
and the Board of Directors, these further 
misstatements are now incorporated in the 
final adjustments disclosed in Note 31 to 
the Group financial statements.
We assessed the related disclosures 
included in the Group financial statements 
and consider them to be sufficient and 
appropriate to explain the amounts and 
nature of the prior period adjustments 
made.  We read all disclosures in the 
Annual Report and Accounts associated 
with these matters, including the 
description of the implications they had 
on the Board of Directors' Report on their 
review of the effectiveness of the Group's 
risk management and internal control 
systems, and assessed whether the other 
information is materially inconsistent with 
the financial statements, or our knowledge 
obtained in the audit or otherwise appears 
to be materially misstated.
Independent Auditor’s Report 
to the Members of C&C Group plc (continued)
168
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Risk
Our response to the risk
Key observations communicated to the Audit Committee 
Arising from the Investigation, Management 
performed additional reviews of various 
accounting adjustments across the 
Group’s subsidiaries throughout the 
financial year ended 29 February 2024 and 
examined the basis for changes in previous 
positions taken.  Additional balance sheet 
reconciliation reviews were performed by 
Internal Audit.
Following these subsequent reviews, and 
our audit procedures, further matters 
were identified with respect to accounting 
judgements made relating to other 
adjustments, including, customer discount 
liabilities, the accounting treatment of 
glassware and the timing of recognition 
of onerous apple contracts. As a result of 
the procedures undertaken, Management 
recorded adjustments in the current year 
financial statements, and restated prior 
period financial information for the year 
ended 28 February 2023 and opening 
balances as at 1 March 2022.
As detailed in Note 31, the correction of 
the prior period errors reduced Group 
net assets as at 1 March 2022 by €4.9m 
and decreased the profit before tax for 
the year ended 28 February 2023 by 
€13.7m; a cumulative reduction in the 
Group’s net assets as at 28 February 2023 
of €17.1m. The errors identified in the 28 
February 2023 consolidated balance sheet 
principally included the overstatement of 
inventory of €12.2m, the understatement 
of provisions of €12.2m, the overstatement 
of Trade and other payables of €5.9m, and 
various other individually smaller items.
Due to the significance of these matters, 
the judgement involved, and the audit 
effort required, we identified Management 
override of internal controls, and related 
prior period adjustments as a key audit 
matter for the current year audit. 
•	 enhancing oversight of our component 
teams with a particular focus to identify 
if there were similar issues arising 
beyond those items in the scope of the 
Investigative Accountants’ Report. This 
involved holding regular meetings with 
the component teams, reviewing journal 
entry testing around releases to the 
Consolidated Income Statement and 
understanding the trigger point for these 
releases, challenging Management’s 
judgements in respect of these releases, 
identifying additional releases and 
challenging the phasing of adjustments 
across financial periods being reflected 
in the prior period adjustments; and 
reviewing for unusual journal entries 
made during the year with a particular 
focus on manual journals, out-of-period 
adjustments recorded during the 
year and incorporating an element of 
unpredictability in our selection criteria. 
We discussed the Investigative 
Accountants’ Report with the Audit 
Committee and the Board of Directors, 
to understand their views on the matters 
identified, and their understanding of the 
background to these matters and how they 
originated. We challenged Management, 
the Audit Committee and the Board of 
Directors as to how they had satisfied 
themselves that there were not similar 
occurrences elsewhere in the Group. 
We reviewed their approach and the 
resulting findings. We challenged the Audit 
Committee and the Board of Directors on 
their process for review and approval of the 
Annual Report and Accounts. 
We performed procedures on the prior 
period adjustments determined by 
Management to assess the completeness, 
accuracy, and timing of these adjustments. 
We challenged judgements and 
assumptions used by reference to 
evidence obtained through the findings 
in the Investigative Accountants’ Report, 
our knowledge of the matters, our 
understanding of the business and from 
our other audit procedures.
169
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Risk
Our response to the risk
Key observations communicated to the Audit Committee 
The key audit matter included considering:
•	 whether internal control and governance 
matters identified extended to areas 
beyond the scope of the Investigate 
Accountants’ Report;
•	 the appropriateness of relevant 
information and explanations received 
throughout the course of the audit; and
•	 the completeness and accuracy of the 
prior period adjustments recorded, 
including whether an adjustment 
represented a change of estimate to be 
recognised in the current year or related 
to the correction of a prior period error, 
and the appropriateness of disclosures 
made. 
In light of the findings in the Investigative 
Accountants’ Report over the lack of 
transparency in respect of representations 
and the inaccuracy of information provided, 
in prior period audits, to the External 
Auditor, the Audit Committee and the 
Board of Directors, we considered the risk 
of management bias and sought further 
corroborative and third-party evidence 
throughout our audit procedures and 
evaluated our findings.  Additionally, we 
sought additional representations from the 
new Group CFO, the Audit Committee and 
the Board of Directors.
We audited the disclosures of the prior 
period adjustments as reflected in Note 
31 to the Group financial statements for 
compliance with the requirements of 
IAS 8 Accounting Policies, Changes in 
Accounting Estimates and Errors.  We read 
all disclosures in the Annual Report and 
Accounts associated with these matters, 
including the description of the implications 
they had on the Board of Directors' 
Report on their review of the effectiveness 
of the Group's risk management and 
internal control systems, and considered 
whether the other information is materially 
inconsistent with the financial statements, 
or our knowledge obtained in the audit 
or otherwise appears to be materially 
misstated.
Independent Auditor’s Report 
to the Members of C&C Group plc (continued)
170
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Risk
Our response to the risk
Key observations communicated to the Audit Committee 
Inventory existence and valuation 
(Group financial statements) (2024: 
€170.7m, 2023: €162.7m (restated))
Refer to the Audit Committee Report 
(pages 114 to 122); Statement of 
Accounting Policies (page 203); and 
Note 14 to the Consolidated Financial 
Statements (page 231).
Raw material inventories are a significant 
component of the Group’s assets and are 
often subject to frequent fluctuations. 
In addition, the investigation into the 
existence and valuation of raw material 
inventory at the Clonmel plant, (see 
separate KAM for Management override of 
internal controls, and related prior period 
adjustments).   
Given the nature of the Group’s raw 
materials (handling large volumes of liquids) 
and finished goods the following risks exist: 
a. As not all tanks have in-built measuring 
gauges, the Group’s traditional measuring 
approach may not be robust enough and 
therefore subject to risk that could impact 
the existence calculation of tank volumes.  
Also, in some instances, depending on 
the liquid in the tanks, there is a risk that a 
residual quantity in a tank may have zero 
value and therefore the business may 
experience physical loss that has not been 
factored into quantities available for use. 
There is also a risk of misrepresentation of 
related inventory quantities and estimates 
and judgements used to value inventories 
that are stored in tank farms.   
b. risk of misstatement of raw materials 
and finished goods inventory due to 
inappropriate production costs being 
applied.
c. risk that goods in transit may be 
incorrectly classified as inventory and that 
shipping terms may be applied incorrectly. 
Our audit procedures on these areas were 
performed by our component teams with 
oversight by the Group audit team.  
We evaluated the process and considered 
the design and implementation of key 
controls related to the existence and 
valuation of raw materials and finished 
goods inventory. 
All audit procedures were performed by 
and reviewed by senior team members.  
Our component teams all utilised lower 
testing thresholds for the testing of 
inventory balances.
For Raw Material inventory existence and 
valuation, our procedures included:
•	 observed physical inventory counts 
to verify the existence of inventory at 
all material inventory locations at the 
year-end, including observing the use of 
pressure gauges to assess the volume of 
liquids in the tank farms;
•	 for any residual quantity of inventory in 
a tank, we reviewed whether this loss is 
part of the normal production process; 
and
•	 reviewed and tested the standard cost 
of raw materials including inventory 
overhead allocation.
For Finished Goods valuation, our 
procedures included:
•	 understanding the impact of the ‘normal 
level of production’ which forms the 
basis for absorbing overheads into 
inventory; and
•	 testing the net realisable value of 
inventory including reviewing post year-
end sales.
For Goods In Transit, our procedures 
included:
•	 ensuring that any material inventory 
recorded as 'in transit' is adequately 
supported by documentation and 
tested the subsequent goods receipt by 
obtaining goods delivery notes.
We considered the adequacy of 
Management’s disclosures in respect of 
the inventory accounting policy and related 
inventory note in the consolidated financial 
statements.
We completed our planned audit 
procedures.  A number of prior 
period adjustments were identified by 
Management relating to inventory at 
the Clonmel plant which is referenced 
in the KAM for Management override of 
internal controls, and related prior period 
adjustments.   Management initially 
recorded these inventory adjustments 
as financial year 2024 adjustments 
notwithstanding there was evidence that 
indicated these adjustments related to 
financial year 2023 and prior periods.    
Management subsequently revised the 
recording of these adjustments into the 
correct periods.   
Other than these matters, and the 
correction of misstatements identified from 
our audit procedures, we noted that the 
methodology for calculating the standard 
cost of inventory is in accordance with IAS 
2 ‘Inventories’.  
We observed physical inventory counts in 
all components in the scope of our audit.  
We are satisfied that the methodology and 
physical inventory count processes applied 
were appropriate. 
We are also satisfied that the significant 
judgements and estimates associated 
with inventory have been appropriately 
disclosed in the consolidated financial 
statements.   
171
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Independent Auditor’s Report 
to the Members of C&C Group plc (continued)
Risk
Our response to the risk
Key observations communicated to the Audit Committee 
Carrying value of goodwill and 
intangible brand assets, including 
related impairment charges (Group 
financial statements) (Consolidated 
Balance Sheet: 2024: €521.9m, 2023: 
€644.1m) (Impairment charge: 2024 
€125.0m, 2023: Nil)
Refer to the Audit Committee Report 
(pages 114 to 122); Statement of 
Accounting Policies (pages 194 to 195); 
and Note 12 to the Consolidated Financial 
Statements (pages 225 to 229).
The Group holds significant amounts of 
goodwill and intangible assets on the 
consolidated balance sheet. In line with 
the requirements of IAS 36 ‘Impairment 
of Assets’ (IAS 36), Management tests 
goodwill and indefinite lived intangible 
balances annually for impairment, and also 
tests intangible assets where there are 
indicators of impairment.  
Management have recorded an impairment 
charge with respect to the C&C Brands 
cash generating unit (CGU) amounting to 
€125.0m in the current year.
The annual impairment testing was 
significant to our audit because of the 
financial quantum of the assets it supports 
as well as the fact that the testing relies on 
a number of critical judgements, estimates 
and assumptions used by Management.  
Judgemental aspects include CGU 
determination for goodwill purposes, 
assumptions of future profitability, revenue 
growth, margins and forecasted cash 
flows, and the selection of appropriate 
discount rates, all of which may be subject 
to management override.
Our audit procedures on this area were 
performed by the Group audit team with 
assistance from our team members with 
specialist valuation knowledge.  All audit 
procedures were performed by and 
reviewed by senior team members.  
We evaluated the process and considered 
the design and implementation of key 
controls related to the impairment 
assessment of goodwill and intangible 
assets.
Our team members with specialist 
knowledge, performed an independent 
assessment against external market data 
of key inputs used by Management in 
calculating appropriate discount rates 
– principally, risk-free rates, country risk 
premia and inflation rates.
We carefully considered the determination 
of the Group’s 6 CGUs, and flexed 
our audit approach relative to our risk 
assessment and the level of excess of 
value-in-use over the carrying amount in 
each CGU for goodwill purposes and in 
each model for the impairment assessment 
for intangible brand assets.  For all models, 
we assessed the reasonableness of 
Management’s assumptions and estimates 
by reference to historic information, 
corroborated key assumptions and 
benchmarked growth assumptions to 
external economic forecasts.
We evaluated Management’s sensitivity 
analyses and performed our own sensitivity 
calculations to assess the level of excess 
of value-in-use over the goodwill and 
intangible brand carrying amount and 
whether a reasonably possible change 
in assumptions could cause the carrying 
amount to exceed its recoverable amount. 
We considered the adequacy of 
Management’s disclosures in respect 
of impairment testing and whether the 
disclosures appropriately communicate 
the underlying sensitivities, in particular 
the requirement to disclose further 
sensitivities for the C&C Brands CGU, 
where any possible negative change in a 
key assumption would lead to an additional 
impairment.
We completed our planned audit 
procedures by challenging various inputs 
and assumptions.  The C&C Brands CGU 
model initially showed an impairment and 
following audit challenge, further iterations 
of this model resulted in the recording of an 
impairment of €125.0m. 
Our observations included our assessment 
of Management’s impairment model 
methodology and then for each CGU and 
intangible brand model: 
•	 whether the discount rates lay within an 
acceptable range; 
•	 the level of headroom of the present 
value of cash flows over the carrying 
amount of the CGU; 
•	 analysis of the growth rate contained 
in the financial projections for year one 
(which are then projected out for years 
two, three, four and five) when viewed 
against the prior year and current year 
actual growth;
•	 the results of our sensitivity analysis; and
•	 the disclosures are appropriate to the 
requirements of IAS 36.
172
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Risk
Our response to the risk
Key observations communicated to the Audit Committee 
Revenue recognition (Group 
financial statements) (2024: 
€1,652.5m, 2023: €1,686.2m 
(restated))
Refer to the Audit Committee Report 
(pages 114 to 122); Statement of 
Accounting Policies (pages 197 to 
198); and Note 1 to the Consolidated 
Financial Statements (pages 205 to 
207).
The Group’s business is derived from 
the following: 
a.  sale of the Group’s owned portfolio 
of brands such as Tennent’s, Bulmers, 
Magners as well as a range of super-
premium and craft ciders and beers; 
and 
b.  drinks distributor to the UK and 
Ireland hospitality sectors for all local 
and international beverage brand 
owners and it also exports its brands 
internationally.
As a result of the nature of revenue, we 
have identified the following risks that 
may not be accounted for correctly or 
accounted for in the correct period:
a.  variable consideration such as 
rebates;
 
b.  non-standard revenue; and 
c.  contract supply agreements.
Our audit procedures on these areas were 
performed by our component teams with 
oversight by the Group audit team.  
We evaluated the process and considered the 
design and implementation of key controls 
related to revenue recognition.  All audit 
procedures were performed by and reviewed 
by senior team members. 
We performed the following procedures 
across all of the three identified risks: 
•	 Reviewed other agreements entered into 
outside the normal course of business.
•	 Reviewed accounting for significant new 
agreements for compliance with IFRS 15 
'Revenue from contracts with customers’ 
(IFRS 15).
•	 Held discussions with operations and 
employees outside of the finance function 
to determine existence of side agreements 
or other non-standard arrangements.
In addition, we performed the following 
procedures:
a) Variable consideration such as rebates
•	 Gained an understanding of contract and 
revenue recognition, including treatment 
of retro arrangements with customers, as 
certain large contracts are non-standard 
and require specific review.
•	 Tested the recognition of variable 
consideration such as rebates using lower 
testing thresholds.
b) Non-standard revenue
•	 Gained an understanding of the terms of 
contract brewing contracts and revenue 
recognition of these.
•	 Tested the cut off of non-standard revenue 
using lower testing thresholds.
c) Contract supply agreements
•	 Gained an understanding of terms, 
conditions and resulting accounting and 
auditing implications and assessed the 
appropriateness of revenue to be recorded.
•	 Assessed whether there are additional 
commitments, obligations or onerous 
contracts.
•	 Tested the cut off of contract supply 
agreements using lower testing thresholds.
We assessed the appropriateness and 
completeness of the disclosures for 
compliance with IFRS 15 in the consolidated 
financial statements.
We completed our planned audit 
procedures.  A number of prior period 
adjustments were identified with respect to 
revenue which is referenced in the KAM for 
Management override of internal controls, 
and related prior period adjustments.  
Management initially recorded some 
of these revenue adjustments as FY24 
adjustments notwithstanding there was 
evidence that indicated these adjustments 
related to periods prior to FY23.  
Management subsequently revised the 
recording of these adjustments into the 
correct periods.    
Our observations included:
•	 an overview of the risk;
•	 an outline of the procedures performed; 
and
•	 the judgements we focused on and the 
results of our testing.
173
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Independent Auditor’s Report 
to the Members of C&C Group plc (continued)
Risk
Our response to the risk
Key observations communicated to the Audit Committee 
Recoverability of on-trade receivable 
balances and advances to customers 
(Group financial statements) (Trade 
receivables 2024: €120.3m, 2023: 
€125.3m (restated), advances to 
customers 2024: €39.1m,  
2023: €42.6m (restated)) 
Refer to the Audit Committee Report 
(pages 114 to 122); Statement of 
Accounting Policies (page 200); and 
Note 15 to the Consolidated Financial 
Statements (pages 232 to 233).
The Group has a risk through exposure 
to on-trade receivable balances and 
advances to customers who may 
experience financial difficulty given the 
current economic climate. 
Our audit procedures on these areas were 
performed by our component teams with 
oversight from the Group audit team. 
We evaluated the process and considered 
the design and implementation of key 
controls related to assessing recoverability 
of on-trade receivable balances and 
advances to customers.  All audit 
procedures were performed by and 
reviewed by senior team members.
We have reviewed the model used by 
Management in calculating the expected 
credit losses to ensure that it is compliant 
with IFRS 9 ‘Financial Instruments’ (IFRS 
9) and adequately captures the additional 
risks in the current environment. We have 
tested the consistent methodology, tailored 
for local nuances, in calculating expected 
credit losses.
We considered Management’s 
assumptions around the impact of 
the current environment on the trade 
receivable portfolios.  We developed our 
own estimate based on historical statistics 
of receivables collection and compared it 
with the actual provision. Additionally, we 
have benchmarked the expected credit 
losses using appropriate available market 
data and found these to be reasonable.
Given the inherent level of uncertainty 
and the sensitivity of judgements and 
estimates, we reviewed all related 
disclosures of the key assumptions used 
and judgements made in estimating the 
Expected Credit Loss (ECL) for compliance 
with IFRS 9.
We assessed the appropriateness 
and completeness of disclosures for 
compliance with IFRS 9 in the consolidated 
financial statements.
We completed our planned audit 
procedures with no material exceptions 
noted. 
Our observations included our assessment 
of Management’s methodology for 
calculating expected credit losses in 
accordance with IFRS 9. We focused 
on the significant judgements made 
by Management, benchmarked key 
assumptions and the appropriate 
disclosure of these in the consolidated 
financial statements.
174
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Risk
Our response to the risk
Key observations communicated to the Audit Committee 
Carrying value of investment 
in subsidiary undertakings in 
the parent Company financial 
statements, and related impairment 
charges (parent Company financial 
statements) (Company Balance 
Sheet: 2024: €985.1m, 2023: 
€1,159.2m) (Impairment charge: 
2024 €175.0m, 2023: Nil)
Refer to the Audit Committee Report 
(pages 114 to 122); Statement of 
Accounting Policies (page 197); and 
Note 13 to the Consolidated Financial 
Statements (pages 229 to 231).
The parent Company balance sheet 
included a €1,159.2m (pre impairment) 
investment in subsidiary undertakings.  
The testing of this balance for 
impairment is inherently judgemental 
as it relies on a number of estimates 
including cash flow forecasts, discount 
rates and long-term growth rates.  
These items are all subjective and 
susceptible to management bias 
and calculation risk and resulting 
impairment charges could be material. 
Management have recorded an 
impairment charge in the current year 
of €175.0m.
This risk is only relevant to the parent 
Company.
Our audit procedures on this area were 
performed by the Group audit team with 
assistance from our team members with 
specialist valuation knowledge.  All audit 
procedures were performed by and reviewed 
by senior team members.  
To consider the risk over recoverability of 
investment in subsidiary undertakings, we 
performed the following procedures:
•	 evaluated the process and considered the 
design and implementation of key controls 
related to the impairment in the carrying 
value of the investment in subsidiary 
undertakings and related impairment 
charge;
•	 evaluated Management’s assessment 
whether any indicators of impairment existed 
through comparison of market capitalisation 
to net assets and the investment, and review 
of dividends received during the year ended 
29 February 2024; 
•	 verified whether the key assumptions 
used to calculate the recoverable value of 
the investment are consistent with those 
used for goodwill impairment purposes in 
the Group and if different, verified the key 
assumptions to relevant support; 
•	 considered the impact of the current 
economic climate on the forecasts used and 
performed sensitivity analysis considering 
reasonably different potential scenarios;
•	 evaluated the difference between the 
investment carrying value (including 
receivables from subsidiaries) and the 
Group’s market capitalisation to understand 
the key reasons for the difference; and
•	 assessed the appropriateness of the 
impairment recorded.
We assessed and challenged the valuation 
approach and assumptions used by the third-
party valuer commissioned by Management.  
This included understanding and challenging 
the independence, scope of work, discount 
rate, growth rate and other cashflow 
assumptions of Management’s third-party 
valuation expert.  
We considered the adequacy of 
Management’s disclosures, in particular the 
requirement to disclose further sensitivities 
where any possible negative change in a 
key assumption would lead to an additional 
impairment.
We completed our planned audit 
procedures, challenging various inputs and 
assumptions initially indicating an excess 
of recoverable amount over carrying value, 
with further iterations resulting in the 
recording of an impairment adjustment of 
€175.0m. 
175
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Our application of materiality 
We apply the concept of materiality in planning and performing the 
audit, in evaluating the effect of identified misstatements on the 
audit and in forming our audit opinion.  
Materiality
The magnitude of an omission or misstatement that, individually 
or in the aggregate, could reasonably be expected to influence 
the economic decisions of the users of the financial statements. 
Materiality provides a basis for determining the nature and extent of 
our audit procedures.
We determined materiality for the Group to be €3.30m, which is 
approximately 0.2% of the Group’s Net Revenue (2023: €3.34m 
which represented approximately 5% of the Group’s Profit before 
tax before non-recurring exceptional items).  Given the fluctuation 
in the Group’s results, we have chosen to base our materiality on 
the Group’s Net Revenue as we consider it to be the most relevant 
performance metric to the Stakeholders of the Group.
During the course of our audit, we reassessed initial materiality and 
ultimately based our final materiality on 0.2% of the Group’s Net 
Revenue.
Performance materiality
The application of materiality at the individual account or balance 
level.  It is set at an amount to reduce to an appropriately low level 
the probability that the aggregate of uncorrected and undetected 
misstatements exceeds materiality.
On the basis of our risk assessments, together with our assessment 
of the Group’s overall control environment, our judgement 
was that performance materiality was 50% (2023: 50%) of our 
planning materiality, namely €1.65m (2023: €1.67m).  We have 
set performance materiality at this percentage based on our 
assessment of the risk of misstatements, both corrected and 
uncorrected, consistent with the prior year. 
Audit work at component locations for the purpose of obtaining 
audit coverage over significant financial statement accounts is 
undertaken based on a percentage of total performance materiality. 
The performance materiality set for each component is based on 
the relative scale and risk of the component to the Group as a whole 
and our assessment of the risk of misstatement at that component.  
In the current year, the range of performance materiality allocated to 
components was €0.31m to €1.16m (2023: €0.30m to €1.13m). 
Due to the findings contained in the Investigative Accountants' 
Report along with the results of our additional audit procedures we 
instructed component auditors to apply the lower end of testing 
threshold ranges in the performance of their audit procedures.
Reporting threshold
An amount below which identified misstatements are considered as 
being clearly trivial.
We agreed with the Audit Committee that we would report to 
them all uncorrected audit differences in excess of €0.166m 
(2023: €0.167m), which is set at 5% of planning materiality, as well 
as differences below that threshold that, in our view, warranted 
reporting on qualitative grounds. 
We evaluate any uncorrected misstatements against both the 
quantitative measures of materiality discussed above and in light of 
other relevant qualitative considerations in forming our opinion.
An overview of the scope of our audit report
Tailoring the scope
Our assessment of audit risk, our evaluation of materiality and our 
allocation of performance materiality determine our audit scope for 
each entity within the Group.  Taken together, this enables us to 
form an opinion on the consolidated financial statements. 
In assessing the risk of material misstatement to the Group financial 
statements, and to ensure we had adequate quantitative coverage 
of significant accounts in the financial statements, we selected 15 
(2023: 15) components covering entities across Ireland and the UK 
which represent the principal business units within the Group.
Of the 15 (2023: 15) components selected, we performed an audit 
of the complete financial information of 13 (2023: 13) components 
(“full scope components”) which were selected based on their size 
or risk characteristics. For the remaining 2 (2023: 2) components 
(“specific scope components”), we performed audit procedures on 
specific accounts within that component that we considered had 
the potential for the greatest impact on the significant accounts in 
the financial statements either because of the size of these accounts 
or their risk profile.  
In addition to the 15 (2023: 15) components discussed above, we 
selected a further 2 (2023: 6) components where we performed 
procedures at the component level that were specified by the Group 
audit team in response to specific risk factors.
The reporting components where we performed audit procedures 
accounted for 99.4% of the Group’s Loss before tax (2023: 99.1% of 
the Group’s Profit before tax), 99.6% (2023: 99.6%) of the Group’s 
Net Revenue and 98.3% (2023: 98.9%) of the Group’s Total Assets. 
For the current year, the full scope components contributed 95.8% 
of the Group’s Loss before tax (2023: 91.2% of the Group’s Profit 
before tax), 99.6% (2023: 99.6%) of the Group’s Net Revenue and 
98.3% (2023: 97.3%) of the Group’s Total Assets. The specific 
scope components contributed 0.6% of the Group’s Loss before 
tax  (2023: 0.3% of the Group’s Profit before tax), 0.0% (2023: 0.0%) 
of the Group’s Net Revenue and 0.0% (2023: 0.0%) of the Group’s 
Total Assets.  The components where we performed specified 
procedures that were determined by the Group audit team in 
response to specific risk factors contributed 3.0% of the Group’s 
Loss before tax (2023: 7.6% of the Group’s Profit before tax), 0.0% 
(2023: 0.0%) of the Group’s Net Revenue and 0.0% (2023: 1.6%) 
of the Group’s Total Assets. The audit scope of these components 
Independent Auditor’s Report 
to the Members of C&C Group plc (continued)
176
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

may not have included testing of all significant accounts of the 
component but will have contributed to the coverage of significant 
accounts tested for the Group.  
Of the remaining components that together represent 0.6% of 
the Group’s Loss before tax (2023: 0.9% of the Group’s Profit 
before tax), none are individually greater than 5% of the Group’s 
Loss before tax (2023: 5% of the Group’s Profit before tax).  For 
these components, we performed other procedures, including 
analytical review, testing of consolidation journals and intercompany 
eliminations and foreign currency translation recalculations to 
respond to any potential risks of material misstatement to the Group 
financial statements.
The charts below illustrate the coverage obtained from the work 
performed by our audit teams.
Involvement with component teams 
In establishing our overall approach to the Group audit, we 
determined the type of work that needed to be undertaken at each 
of the components by us, as the primary audit engagement team, or 
by component auditors from other EY global network firms operating 
under our instruction. Where the work was performed by component 
auditors, we determined the appropriate level of involvement to 
enable us to determine that sufficient audit evidence had been 
obtained as a basis for our opinion on the Group as a whole.
We issued detailed instructions to each component auditor in scope 
for the Group audit, with specific audit requirements and requests 
across key areas and maintained regular communication throughout 
the audit cycle. This included specific instructions in relation to the 
matters identified during the year, including those items identified 
in the Investigative Accountants’ Report. During the current year’s 
audit cycle, a visit was undertaken by the primary audit team to 
the Clonmel site in Ireland. For all component teams, we held a 
planning call and weekly calls during the cycle of the audit, held 
discussions with local Management and attended closing meetings.  
On these calls with our component teams, we discussed the audit 
approach, issues arising, impact of the Investigation and other 
matters identified during the year on each component and details 
of additional audit work required to address the findings in the 
Investigative Accountants’ Report. The Group audit team performed 
file reviews for all full scope components.
The Group audit team interacted regularly with the component 
teams, where appropriate, during various stages of the audit, 
reviewed and evaluated the work performed by these teams, 
including review of key reporting documents, in accordance with 
the ISAs (Ireland) and were responsible for the overall planning, 
scoping and direction of the Group audit process. Senior members 
of the Group audit team also participated in component planning, 
interim and closing meeting calls during which the planning and 
results of the audits were discussed with the component auditors, 
local Management and Group Management. This, together with 
the additional procedures performed at Group level (including 
audit procedures over material head office entities, pensions, 
share based payments, valuation of property, plant & equipment, 
leases, impairment of goodwill and intangible assets, classification 
of exceptional items, treasury, tax, financial statement disclosures 
and the forensic work performed by our team of forensic specialists) 
gave us appropriate evidence for our opinion on the Group financial 
statements.
Group’s Loss before tax
95.8%
Full scope 
components
0.6%
Specific scope 
components
3.0%
Specified
procedures
0.6%
Other 
procedures
99.6%
Full scope 
components
0.0%
Specific scope 
components
0.0%
Specified
procedures
0.4%
Other 
procedures
98.3%
Full scope 
components
0.0%
Specific scope 
components
0.0%
Specified
procedures
1.7%
Other 
procedures
Group’s Net Revenue
Group’s Total Assets
177
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Other conclusions relating to principal risks, going concern 
and viability statement
We have nothing to report in respect of the following information in 
the Annual Report, in relation to which the ISAs (Ireland) require us 
to report to you whether we have anything material to add or draw 
attention to: 
•	 the disclosures in the Annual Report (set out on pages 32 to 41) 
that describe the principal risks and explain how they are being 
managed or mitigated;
•	 the directors’ confirmation (set out on page 34) in the Annual 
Report that they have carried out a robust assessment of the 
principal risks facing the Group and the parent Company, 
including those that would threaten its business model, future 
performance, solvency or liquidity;
•	 the directors’ statement (set out on page 40) in the financial 
statements about whether the directors considered it appropriate 
to adopt the going concern basis of accounting in preparing 
the financial statements and the directors’ identification of any 
material uncertainties to the Group’s and the parent Company’s 
ability to continue to do so over a period of at least twelve months 
from the date of approval of the financial statements;
•	 whether the directors’ statement relating to going concern 
required under the Listing Rules is materially inconsistent with our 
knowledge obtained in the audit; or
•	 the directors’ explanation (set out on page 41) in the Annual 
Report as to how they have assessed the prospects of the Group 
and the parent Company, over what period they have done so 
and why they consider that period to be appropriate, and their 
statement as to whether they have a reasonable expectation that 
the Group and the parent Company will be able to continue in 
operation and meet its liabilities as they fall due over the period 
of their assessment, including any related disclosures drawing 
attention to any necessary qualifications or assumptions.
Independent Auditor’s Report 
to the Members of C&C Group plc (continued)
Other information
The directors are responsible for the other information. The other 
information comprises the information included in the Annual 
Report other than the financial statements and our auditor’s report 
thereon. Our opinion on the financial statements does not cover 
the other information and, except to the extent otherwise explicitly 
stated in our report, we do not express any form of assurance 
conclusion thereon. 
Our responsibility is to read the other information and, in doing so, 
consider whether the other information is materially inconsistent 
with the financial statements, or our knowledge obtained in the 
audit or otherwise appears to be materially misstated. If we identify 
such material inconsistencies or apparent material misstatements, 
we are required to determine whether there is a material 
misstatement in the financial statements or a material misstatement 
of the other information. If, based on the work we have performed, 
we conclude that there is a material misstatement of this other 
information, we are required to report that fact.
We have nothing to report in this regard.
In this context, we also have nothing to report in regard to our 
responsibility to specifically address the following items in the other 
information and to report as uncorrected material misstatements of 
the other information where we conclude that those items meet the 
following conditions:
•	 Fair, balanced and understandable (set out on page 119) – the 
statement given by the directors that they consider the Annual 
Report and financial statements taken as a whole is fair, balanced 
and understandable and provides the information necessary for 
shareholders to assess the Group’s and the parent Company’s 
performance, business model and strategy, is materially 
inconsistent with our knowledge obtained in the audit; or
•	 Audit committee reporting (set out on pages 114 to 122) – the 
section describing the work of the audit committee does not 
appropriately address matters communicated by us to the audit 
committee or is materially inconsistent with our knowledge 
obtained in the audit; or
•	 Directors’ statement of compliance with the UK Corporate 
Governance Code (set out on page 112) – the parts of the 
directors’ statement required under the Listing Rules relating to 
the Company’s compliance with the UK Corporate Governance 
Code containing provisions specified for review do not properly 
disclose a departure from a relevant provision of the UK 
Corporate Governance Code.
178
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Opinions on other matters prescribed by the 
Companies Act 2014
In our opinion, based solely on the work undertaken in the course 
of the audit, we report that: 
•	 the information given in the Directors’ Report, other than those 
parts dealing with the non-financial statement pursuant to the 
requirements of S.I. No. 360/2017 on which we are not required 
to report in the current year, is consistent with the financial 
statements; and 
•	 the Directors’ Report, other than those parts dealing with the 
non-financial statement pursuant to the requirements of S.I. No. 
360/2017 on which we are not required to report in the current 
year, has been prepared in accordance with the Companies Act 
2014.
We have obtained all the information and explanations which, to the 
best of our knowledge and belief, are necessary for the purposes of 
our audit.
In our opinion the accounting records of the Company were 
sufficient to permit the financial statements to be readily and 
properly audited and the Company Balance Sheet is in agreement 
with the accounting records.
Matters on which we are required to report by 
exception
Based on the knowledge and understanding of the Group and 
its environment obtained in the course of the audit, we have not 
identified material misstatements in the Directors' Report.
The Companies Act 2014 requires us to report to you if, in our 
opinion, the disclosures required by sections 305 to 312 of the 
Act, which relate to disclosures of directors’ remuneration and 
transactions, are not complied with by the Company. We have 
nothing to report in this regard. 
We have nothing to report in respect of section 13 of the European 
Union (Disclosure of Non-Financial and Diversity Information by 
certain large undertakings and groups) Regulations 2017, which 
require us to report to you if, in our opinion, the Company has not 
provided in the non-financial statement the information required by 
Section 5(2) to (7) of those Regulations, in respect of 28 February 
2023. 
Respective responsibilities
Responsibilities of directors for the financial statements 
As explained more fully in the directors’ responsibilities statement 
set out on page 164, the directors are responsible for the 
preparation of the financial statements in accordance with the 
applicable financial reporting framework that give a true and fair 
view, and for such internal control as they determine is necessary 
to enable the preparation of financial statements that are free from 
material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error. 
In preparing the financial statements, the directors are responsible 
for assessing the Group and the parent Company’s ability to 
continue as going concerns, disclosing, as applicable, matters 
related to going concern and using the going concern basis of 
accounting unless Management either intends to liquidate the 
Group or the parent Company or to cease operations, or has no 
realistic alternative but to do so.
Auditor’s responsibilities for the audit of the financial 
statements
Our objectives are to obtain reasonable assurance about whether 
the financial statements as a whole are free from material 
misstatement, whether due to fraud or error, and to issue an 
auditor's report that includes our opinion. Reasonable assurance 
is a high level of assurance but is not a guarantee that an audit 
conducted in accordance with ISAs (Ireland) will always detect 
a material misstatement when it exists. Misstatements can arise 
from fraud or error and are considered material if, individually or in 
the aggregate, they could reasonably be expected to influence the 
economic decisions of users taken on the basis of these financial 
statements. 
Explanation to what extent the audit was considered capable 
of detecting irregularities, including fraud
Irregularities, including fraud, are instances of non-compliance 
with laws and regulations. We design procedures in line with our 
responsibilities, outlined above, to detect irregularities, including 
fraud, that could reasonably be expected to have a material 
effect on the financial statements. The risk of not detecting a 
material misstatement due to fraud is higher than the risk of 
not detecting one resulting from error, as fraud may involve 
deliberate concealment by, for example, forgery or intentional 
misrepresentations, or through collusion.  In addition, the further 
removed any non-compliance is from the events and transactions 
reflected in the financial statements, the less likely it is that our 
procedures will identify such non-compliance.  The extent to which 
our procedures are capable of detecting irregularities, including 
fraud is detailed below.  However, the primary responsibility for the 
prevention and detection of fraud rests with both those charged 
with governance of the Company and Management.  
179
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Our approach was as follows:
•	 We obtained an understanding of the legal and regulatory 
frameworks that are applicable to the Group across the various 
jurisdictions globally in which the Group operates. We determined 
that the most significant are those that relate to the form and 
content of external financial and corporate governance reporting 
including company law, tax legislation, employment law and 
regulatory compliance.
•	 We understood how C&C Group plc is complying with those 
frameworks by making enquiries of Management, internal audit, 
those responsible for legal and compliance procedures and the 
Company Secretary. We corroborated our enquiries through our 
review of the Group's compliance policies, board minutes, papers 
provided to the Audit Committee and correspondence with 
regulatory bodies.
•	 We assessed the susceptibility of the Group's financial statements 
to material misstatement, including how fraud might occur, by 
meeting with Management, including within various parts of 
the business, to understand where they considered there was 
susceptibility to fraud. We also considered performance targets 
and the potential for Management to influence earnings or the 
perceptions of analysts. Where this risk was considered to be 
higher, we performed audit procedures to address each identified 
fraud risk. These procedures included testing manual journals and 
were designed to provide reasonable assurance that the financial 
statements were free from fraud or error.
•	 Based on this understanding we designed our audit procedures 
to identify non-compliance with such laws and regulations. 
Our procedures included a review of board minutes to identify 
any non-compliance with laws and regulations, a review of the 
reporting to the Audit Committee on compliance with regulations, 
enquiries of internal and external legal counsel and Management. 
•	 We have evaluated Management’s incentives and opportunities 
for fraudulent manipulation of the financial statements (including 
the risk of override of internal controls) and determined that the 
principal issues identified related to:
	- inventory existence and valuation;
	- other balance sheet matters (including accounting for Goods 
Received Not Invoiced balances (‘GRNI’), as well as other 
items); 
	- failures in the Group’s reporting processes, including the 
breakdown in internal controls and governance frameworks 
during the year and in prior years as a result of the override of 
the Group’s internal controls; and
	- lack of transparency over representations and correctness and 
accuracy of information provided to the External Auditor, and 
to the Audit Committee and Board of Directors, at the time the 
items arose and in subsequent financial years.
Independent Auditor’s Report 
to the Members of C&C Group plc (continued)
•	 Our additional audit procedures included:
	- engaging our forensic specialists to examine the scope and 
results of the work carried out by the Investigative Accountants 
by holding discussions with this team, reviewing their 
supporting evidence and, performing additional procedures 
which included considering the sufficiency, appropriateness 
of the investigation performed and the competency and 
objectivity of individuals undertaking it; 
	- enhancing oversight of our component teams with a particular 
focus to identify if there were similar issues arising beyond 
those items in the scope of the Investigative Accountants’ 
Report. This involved holding regular meetings with the 
component teams, reviewing journal entry testing around 
releases to the Consolidated Income Statement and 
understanding the trigger point for these releases, challenging 
Management’s judgements in respect of these releases, 
identifying additional releases and challenging the phasing of 
adjustments across financial periods being reflected in the prior 
period adjustments; 
	- reviewing for unusual journal entries made during the year 
with a particular focus on manual journals, out-of-period 
adjustments recorded during the year and incorporating an 
element of unpredictability in our selection criteria;
	- discussed the Investigative Accountants’ Report with the 
Audit Committee and the Board of Directors, to understand 
their views on the matters identified, and their understanding 
of the background to these matters and how they originated. 
We challenged Management, the Audit Committee and the 
Board of Directors as to how they had satisfied themselves that 
there were not similar occurrences elsewhere in the Group. 
We reviewed their approach and the resulting findings. We 
challenged the Audit Committee and the Board of Directors 
on their process for review and approval of the FY24 Annual 
Report and Accounts;
	- performed procedures on the prior period adjustments 
determined by Management to assess completeness, 
accuracy and timing of these adjustments. We challenged 
judgements and assumptions used by reference to evidence 
obtained through the findings in the Investigative Accountants’ 
Report, our knowledge of the matters, our understanding of 
the business and from our other audit procedures;
	- In light of the findings in the Investigative Accountants’ Report 
over the lack of transparency in respect of representations 
and the inaccuracy of information provided, in prior period 
audits, to the External Auditor, the Audit Committee and the 
Board of Directors, we considered the risk of management 
bias and sought further corroborative and third-party evidence 
180
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

throughout our audit procedures and evaluated our findings.  
Additionally, we sought additional representations from the 
new Group CFO, the Audit Committee and the Board of 
Directors;
	- audited the disclosures of the prior period adjustments as 
reflected in Note 31 to the Group financial statements for 
compliance with the requirements of IAS 8 ‘Accounting 
Policies, Changes in Accounting Estimates and Errors’.  We 
read all disclosures in the Annual Report and Accounts 
associated with these matters, including the description of the 
implications they had on the Board of Directors’ report on their 
review of the effectiveness of the Group's risk management 
and internal control systems, and considered whether the 
other information is materially inconsistent with the financial 
statements, or our knowledge obtained in the audit or 
otherwise appears to be materially misstated.
A further description of our responsibilities for the audit of the 
financial statements is located on the IAASA's website at: http://
www.iaasa.ie/getmedia/b2389013-1cf6-458b-9b8f-a98202dc9c3a/
Description_of_auditors_responsibilities_for_audit.pdf. 
This description forms part of our auditor's report.
The purpose of our audit work and to whom we owe 
our responsibilities
Our report is made solely to the Company’s members, as a body, 
in accordance with section 391 of the Companies Act 2014. Our 
audit work has been undertaken so that we might state to the 
Company’s members those matters we are required to state to 
them in an auditor’s report and for no other purpose. To the fullest 
extent permitted by law, we do not accept or assume responsibility 
to anyone other than the Company and the Company’s members, 
as a body, for our audit work, for this report, or for the opinions we 
have formed. 
Dermot Quinn
for and on behalf of
Ernst & Young Chartered Accountants and Statutory Audit Firm
Office: Dublin
Date: 27 June 2024
181
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Year ended 29 February 2024
Year ended 28 February 2023 (restated)
Before exceptional 
items
Exceptional items
(note 5)
Total
Before exceptional 
items
Exceptional items 
(note 5)
Total
Notes
 €m
€m
€m
 €m
 €m
€m
Revenue 
1
2,023.0
-
2,023.0
2,063.8
-
2,063.8
Excise duties 
 
(370.5)
-
(370.5)
(377.6)
-
(377.6)
Net revenue
1
1,652.5
-
1,652.5
1,686.2
-
1,686.2
Operating costs
2
(1,592.5)
(144.4)
(1,736.9)
(1,603.6)
(12.4)
(1,616.0)
Group operating (loss)/profit
1
60.0
(144.4)
(84.4)
82.6
(12.4)
70.2
Impairment of assets held for sale
5
-
(3.3)
(3.3)
-
-
-
Profit on disposal
5
-
-
-
-
1.1
1.1
Finance income
6
0.2
0.2
0.4
-
0.2
0.2
Finance expense
6
(21.4)
(2.9)
(24.3)
(16.7)
(2.6)
(19.3)
(Loss)/profit before tax
38.8
(150.4)
(111.6)
65.9
(13.7)
52.2
Income tax expense
7
(6.9)
5.0
(1.9)
(14.4)
2.5
(11.9)
Group (loss)/profit for the 
financial year
31.9
(145.4)
(113.5)
51.5
(11.2)
40.3
Basic earnings per share (cent)
9
(29.0)
10.3
Diluted earnings per share (cent)
9
(29.0)
10.3
 
All of the results are related to continuing operations.
In the year ended 29 February 2024, the Group restated the prior year financial information. Details of the restatements are contained in  
note 31.
Consolidated Income Statement
For the financial year ended 29 February 2024
182
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

2024
2023  
(restated)
Notes
€m
€m
Other Comprehensive Income:
Items that may be reclassified to Income Statement in subsequent years:
Foreign currency translation differences arising on the net investment in foreign operations
6
9.2
(19.8)
Foreign currency recycled on disposal of assets held for sale
6
-
0.4
(Loss)/gain relating to cash flow hedges
24
(0.8)
1.2
Items that will not be reclassified to Income Statement in subsequent years:
Revaluation of property, plant & equipment
11
0.2
 (0.7)
Deferred tax on revaluation of property, plant and equipment
22
(0.2)
0.3
Actuarial (loss)/gain on retirement benefits
23
(9.9)
 4.3
Deferred tax on actuarial gain
22
1.4
0.1
Net loss recognised directly within Other Comprehensive Income
(0.1)
(14.2)
Group (loss)/profit for the financial year
 
(113.5)
40.3
Total comprehensive (loss)/income for the financial year
 
(113.6)
26.1
In the year ended 29 February 2024, the Group restated the prior year financial information. Details of the restatements are contained in  
note 31.
Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income 
For the financial year ended 29 February 2024
183
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

2024
2023 
(restated)
1 March 2022 
(restated)
Notes
€m
€m
€m
ASSETS
Non-current assets
Property, plant & equipment
11
247.7
215.0
217.3
Goodwill & intangible assets
12
521.9
644.1
656.5
Equity accounted investments/financial assets
13
1.4
1.3
1.3
Retirement benefits
23
34.3
42.2
37.6
Deferred tax assets
22
29.4
26.3
27.7
Financial assets
10, 24
4.9
5.6
4.3
Trade & other receivables
15
37.0
38.0
43.0
876.6
972.5
987.7
Current assets
Inventories
14
170.7
162.7
159.7
Trade & other receivables
15
149.1
163.4
187.4
Current income tax assets
2.0
1.0
-
Financial assets
20
0.7
-
-
Cash 
 
160.1
115.3
64.7
482.6
442.4
411.8
Assets held for sale
16
8.4
-
65.8
491.0
442.4
477.6
TOTAL ASSETS
 
1,367.6
1,414.9
1,465.3
EQUITY
Capital and reserves 
Equity share capital
26
4.0
4.0
4.0
Share premium
26
347.2
347.2
347.2
Treasury shares
26
(36.3)
(36.4)
(37.9)
Other reserves
26
89.2
81.1
99.6
Retained income
 
182.9
326.2
281.2
Total Equity
587.0
722.1
694.1
LIABILITIES
Non-current liabilities
Lease liabilities
19
90.8
60.3
62.3
Interest bearing loans & borrowings
20
218.7
100.0
219.4
Other financial liabilities
25
5.8
-
-
Provisions 
18
7.9
15.3
3.9
Deferred tax liabilities
22
35.7
34.7
30.3
358.9
210.3
315.9
Current liabilities
Lease liabilities
19
19.3
16.3
20.7
Derivative financial liabilities
24
0.2
-
0.1
Other financial liabilities
25
1.0
-
-
Trade & other payables
17
397.6
364.8
383.5
Interest bearing loans & borrowings
20
-
94.2
36.6
Provisions 
18
2.2
7.2
8.2
Current income tax liabilities
 
-
-
6.2
420.3
482.5
455.3
Liabilities directly associated with the assets held for sale
16
1.4
-
-
Total liabilities
 
780.6
692.8
771.2
TOTAL EQUITY & LIABILITIES
 
1,367.6
1,414.9
1,465.3
In the year ended 29 February 2024, the Group restated the prior year financial information. Details of the restatement are contained in note 
31.
On behalf of the Board
R Findlay
A Andrea
DATE
Chair and Chief Executive Officer
Chief Financial Officer
27 June 2024
Consolidated Balance Sheet 
As at 29 February 2024
184
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

2024
2023 
(restated)
Notes
€m
€m
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES
Group (loss)/profit for the year
(113.5)
40.3
Finance income
6
(0.4)
(0.2)
Finance expense
6
24.3
19.3
Income tax expense
7
1.9
11.9
Impairment of assets held for sale
5, 12
3.3
-
Impairment of intangible assets
12
125.0
-
Depreciation of property, plant & equipment
2, 11, 19
31.3
30.9
Amortisation of intangible assets
2, 12
2.4
2.5
Net profit on disposal of property, plant & equipment
5
-
(1.1)
Rights Issue costs recorded as exceptional
                    5 
-
0.7
Charge for equity settled share-based payments
4
0.9
1.9
Pension contributions: adjustment from credit to payment  
23
(1.9)
(0.6)
73.3
105.6
Increase in inventories
(8.0)
(8.8)
Decrease in trade & other receivables
16.0
20.3
Increase/(decrease) in trade & other payables
38.9
(10.6)
Decrease in provisions
(12.3)
10.9
107.9
117.4
Interest and similar costs paid
(20.5)
(19.4)
Income taxes paid
(4.1)
(12.0)
Net cash inflow from operating activities
83.3
86.0
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES
Purchase of property, plant & equipment
11
(18.1)
(11.5)
Purchase of intangible assets
12
(1.9)
(3.7)
Net proceeds on disposal of property, plant & equipment
0.1
-
Sale of Brand IP
0.4
-
Sale of asset held for sale
16
-
63.6
Sale of business – net of cash disposed
5, 10
-
0.7
Net cash (outflow)/inflow from investing activities
(19.5)
49.1
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES
Dividends on ordinary shares 
8
(22.3)
-
Drawdown of debt
21
130.0
48.5
Payment of debt issue costs
21
(3.4)
-
Repayment of debt
21
(105.0)
(108.5)
Payment of lease liabilities
19
(20.2)
(22.5)
Payment of Rights Issue costs
5
-
(0.7)
Net cash outflow from financing activities
(20.9)
(83.2)
Net increase in cash
42.9
51.9
Reconciliation of opening to closing cash 
Cash at beginning of year
115.3
64.7
Translation adjustment
1.9
(1.3)
Net increase in cash 
42.9
51.9
Cash at end of financial year
160.1
115.3
 
A reconciliation of net debt is presented in note 21 to the financial statements.
Consolidated Cash Flow Statement
For the financial year ended 29 February 2024
185
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Equity 
share 
capital
Share 
premium
Other 
capital 
reserves*
Cash flow 
hedge 
reserve
Share-
based 
payments 
reserve
Currency 
translation 
reserve
Revaluation 
reserve
Treasury 
shares
Retained 
income
Total
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
At 28 February 2022 (previously 
stated)
4.0
347.2
25.8
(0.1)
4.4
53.3
14.9
(36.0)
285.5
699.0
Prior period restatements
-
-
-
-
1.3
-
-
(1.9)
(4.3)
(4.9)
At 1 March 2022 restated
4.0
347.2
25.8
(0.1)
5.7
53.3
14.9
(37.9)
281.2
694.1
Profit for the financial year restated 
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
40.3
40.3
Other comprehensive income/(loss)
-
-
-
1.2
-
(19.4)
(0.7)
-
4.7
(14.2)
Total comprehensive income/
(loss) restated
-
-
-
1.2
-
(19.4)
(0.7)
-
45.0
26.1
Reclassification of share-based 
payments reserve
-
-
-
-
(1.6)
-
-
-
1.6
-
Sale of treasury shares/purchase 
of shares to satisfy employee share 
entitlements (note 26)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
1.4
(1.9)
(0.5)
Transfer of Treasury Shares
-
-
-
-
(0.1)
-
-
0.1
-
-
Equity settled share-based 
payments (note 4)
-
-
-
-
2.1
-
-
-
0.3
2.4
Total transactions with owners
-
-
-
-
0.4
-
-
1.5
-
1.9
At 28 February 2023 restated
4.0
347.2
25.8
1.1
6.1
33.9
14.2
(36.4)
326.2
722.1
Loss for the financial year
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
(113.5)
(113.5)
Other comprehensive (loss)/income
-
-
-
(0.8)
-
9.2
0.2
-
(8.7)
(0.1)
Total comprehensive income/
(expense)
-
-
-
(0.8)
-
9.2
0.2
-
(122.2)
(113.6)
Dividend on ordinary shares
-
-
-
-
 -
-
-
-
(22.4)
(22.4)
Reclassification of share-based 
payments reserve
-
-
-
-
(1.7)
-
-
-
1.7
-
Sale of treasury shares/purchase 
of shares to satisfy employee share 
entitlements (note 26)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
(0.1)
(0.4)
(0.5)
Transfer of Treasury Shares
-
-
-
-
(0.2)
-
-
0.2
-
-
Equity settled share-based 
payments (note 4)
-
-
-
-
1.4
-
-
-
-
1.4
Total transactions with owners
-
-
-
-
(0.5)
-
-
0.1
(21.1)
(21.5)
At 29 February 2024
4.0
347.2
25.8
0.3
5.6
43.1
14.4
(36.3)
182.9
587.0
*Other capital reserves include Other un-denominated reserve of €0.9m and the capital reserve of €24.9m
Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity 
For the financial year ended 29 February 2024
186
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

2024
2023
(restated)
Notes
€m
€m 
ASSETS
Non-current assets
Financial assets
13
985.1
1,159.2
985.1
1,159.2
Current assets
Trade & other receivables
15
611.2
284.5
Financial assets
20
0.1
-
Cash 
0.3
0.2
 
611.6
284.7
TOTAL ASSETS
 
1,596.7
1,443.9
EQUITY
Equity share capital
26
4.0
4.0
Share premium
26
1,048.2
1,048.2
Treasury Shares
(2.6)
(2.3)
Other reserves
26
5.4
5.9
Retained income
 
388.3
233.6
Total equity
1,443.3
1,289.4
LIABILITIES
Non-current liabilities
Interest bearing loans & borrowings
20
101.1
99.7
101.1
99.7
Current liabilities
Interest bearing loans & borrowings
20
-
(0.8) 
Trade & other payables
17
52.3
55.6
52.3
54.8
Total liabilities
 
153.4
154.5
TOTAL EQUITY & LIABILITIES
 
1,596.7
1,443.9
 
As permitted by section 304 of the Companies Act 2014, the Company is availing of the exemption from presenting its separate Income 
Statement in the Financial Statements and from filing it with the Registrar of Companies. The Company’s profit for the financial year is 
€175.4m (FY2023: restated profit of €209.6m). In the current financial year, there were dividends received of €363.1m from subsidiaries 
(FY2023: €219.9m).
On behalf of the Board
R Findlay
A Andrea
DATE
Chair and Chief Executive Officer
Chief Financial Officer
27 June 2024
Company Balance Sheet
As at 29 February 2024
187
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Equity share 
capital
Share premium Treasury Shares
Other 
undenominated 
reserve
 Share-based 
payments 
reserve Retained income
Total
€m
€m
€m
 €m
 €m
€m
€m
Company
At 28 February 2022
4.0
1,048.2
0.9
3.3
21.5
1,077.9
Prior period restatements
-
-
(1.9)
-
1.3
0.9
0.3
Total comprehensive income
4.0
1,048.2
(1.9)
0.9
4.6
22.4
1,078.2
Profit for the financial year
-
-
-
-
209.6
209.6
Total comprehensive income
-
-
-
-
209.6
209.6
Purchase of Treasury Shares
(0.5)
(0.5)
Reclassification of share-based 
payments reserve
-
-
-
(1.6) 
1.6
-
Transfer of Treasury shares 
0.1
(0.1)
-
Equity settled share-based payments 
(note 4)
-
-
-
2.1
-
2.1
Total transactions with owners
-
-
(0.4)
-
0.4
1.6
1.6
At 28 February 2023 (restated)
4.0
1,048.2
(2.3)
0.9
5.0
233.6
1,289.4
Profit for the financial year
-
-
-
-
-
175.4
175.4
Total comprehensive income
175.4
175.4
Dividend on ordinary shares
-
-
-
-
(22.4)
(22.4)
Purchase of Treasury shares
-
-
(0.5)
-
-
-
(0.5)
Transfer of Treasury shares
-
0.2
(0.2)
-
-
Reclassification of share-based 
payments reserve
-
-
-
(1.7)
1.7
-
Equity settled share-based payments 
(note 4)
-
-
-
1.4
-
1.4
Total transaction with owners
-
-
(0.3)
-
(0.5)
(20.7)
(21.5)
At 29 February 2024
4.0
1,048.2
(2.6)
0.9
4.5
388.3
1,443.3
Company Statement of Changes in Equity
For the financial year ended 29 February 2024
188
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Material accounting policies
C&C Group plc (the ‘Company’) is a company incorporated and 
tax resident in Ireland. The Group’s financial statements for the 
year ended 29 February 2024 consolidate the individual financial 
statements of the Company and all subsidiary undertakings 
(together referred to as the ‘Group’) together with the Group’s share 
of the results and net assets of equity accounted investments for the 
year ended 29 February 2024.
The Company and Group financial statements, together the 
‘financial statements’, were authorised for issue by the Directors on 
27 June 2024.
The accounting policies applied in the preparation of the financial 
statements for the year ended 29 February 2024 are set out below. 
Except if mentioned otherwise these have been applied consistently 
for all periods presented in these financial statements and by all 
Group entities.
Statement of compliance
The Group financial statements have been prepared in accordance 
with International Financial Reporting Standards (‘IFRS’), as adopted 
by the EU and as applied in accordance with Companies Act 2014. 
The individual financial statements of the Company have been 
prepared in accordance with Financial Reporting Standard 101 
Reduced Disclosure Framework (‘FRS 101’). In accordance with 
Section 304 of the Companies Act 2014, the Company is availing of 
the exemption from presenting its individual Income Statement to 
the Annual General Meeting and from filing it with the Registrar of 
Companies. 
In these financial statements, the Company has applied the 
exemptions available under FRS 101 in respect of the following 
disclosures:
•	 A cash flow statement and related notes;
•	 Disclosures in respect of transactions with wholly-owned 
subsidiaries;
•	 Disclosures in respect of capital management;
•	 The effects of new but not yet effective IFRSs; and
•	 Disclosures in respect of the compensation of Key Management 
Personnel.
As the financial statements of the Group include the equivalent 
disclosures, the Company has also taken exemptions under FRS 
101 available in respect of the following disclosures:
•	 IFRS 2 Share-Based Payments in respect of Group equity settled 
share-based payments.
Changes in accounting policies and disclosures
IFRS as adopted by the EU applied by the Company and Group in 
the preparation of these financial statements are those that were 
effective for accounting periods ending on or before 29 February 
2024. The IASB have issued the following standards, policies, 
interpretations and amendments which were effective for the Group 
for the first time in the year ended 29 February 2024:
Statement of Accounting Policies
For the year ended 29 February 2024
IFRS 17 Insurance Contracts 
•	 In May 2017, the IASB issued IFRS 17 Insurance Contracts, a 
comprehensive new accounting standard for insurance contracts 
covering recognition and measurement, presentation and 
disclosure. IFRS 17 replaces IFRS 4 Insurance Contracts.
•	 In June 2020, the IASB issued amendments to IFRS 17. These 
amendments included changing the effective date to 2023.
•	 In September 2017, the Board established a Transition Resource 
Group (‘TRG’) for IFRS 17 to analyse implementation related 
questions. The TRG met four times and while no further meetings 
have been scheduled, the TRG submission process remains 
open for stakeholders to send in questions they believe meet the 
TRG submission criteria.
 
The amendments are effective for annual reporting periods 
beginning on or after 1 January 2023 with comparative figures 
required, however the amendment does not have a material impact 
on the Group.
Disclosure of Accounting Policies – Amendments to IAS 1 and 
IFRS Practice Statement 2
•	 In February 2021, the Board issued amendments to IAS 
1 Presentation of Financial Statements and IFRS Practice 
Statement 2 Making Materiality Judgements (‘the PS’), in which it 
provides guidance and examples to help entities apply materiality 
judgements to accounting policy disclosures. The amendments 
aim to help entities provide accounting policy disclosures that are 
more useful by:
	- Replacing the requirement for entities to disclose their ‘significant 
accounting policies’ with a requirement to disclose ‘material 
accounting policy information’ and;
	- Adding guidance on how entities apply the concept of materiality 
in making decisions about accounting policy disclosures. 
The amendment is effective for annual reporting periods beginning 
on or after 1 January 2023 and has been adopted in these financial 
statements. 
Definition of Accounting Estimates - Amendments to IAS 8
•	 In February 2021, the Board issued amendments to IAS 8, in 
which it introduces a new definition of ‘accounting estimates’. 
The amendments clarify the distinction between changes in 
accounting estimates and changes in accounting policies 
and the correction of errors. Also, they clarify how entities use 
measurement techniques and inputs to develop accounting 
estimates. 
The amendments are effective for annual reporting periods 
beginning on or after 1 January 2023. The amendment does not 
have a material impact on the Group. 
189
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Deferred Tax related to Assets and Liabilities arising from a 
Single Transaction – Amendments to IAS 12
•	 In May 2021, the Board issued amendments to IAS 12 Income 
Taxes, which narrow the scope of the initial recognition exception 
under IAS 12, so that it no longer applies to transactions that give 
rise to equal taxable and deductible temporary differences.
The amendments are effective for annual reporting periods 
beginning on or after 1 January 2023. The amendments do not 
have a material impact on the Group.
International Tax Reform – Pillar Two Model Rules – Amendments 
to IAS 12
•	 In May 2023, the Board issued amendments to IAS 12, which 
introduce a mandatory exception in IAS 12 from recognising and 
disclosing deferred tax assets and liabilities related to Pillar Two 
income taxes.
•	 The amendments clarify that IAS 12 applies to income 
taxes arising from tax law enacted or substantively enacted 
to implement the Pillar Two Model Rules published by the 
Organization for Economic Cooperation and Development 
(‘OECD’), including tax law that implements qualified domestic 
minimum top-up taxes. Such tax legislation, and the income 
taxes arising from it, are referred to as ‘Pillar Two legislation’ and 
‘Pillar Two income taxes’, respectively. 
The amendments are effective immediately upon issuance, but 
certain disclosure requirements are effective later. The Group has 
applied the exception in IAS 12 Income Taxes to recognising and 
disclosing information about deferred tax assets and liabilities to 
Pillar Two taxes. 
IFRS and IFRIC interpretations being adopted in subsequent 
years
A number of new standards, amendments to standards and 
interpretations are not yet effective for the year ended 29 February 
2024 and have not been applied in preparing these consolidated 
financial statements.
These following new standards, amendments and interpretations 
are either not expected to have a material impact on the 
consolidated financial statements once applied or are still under 
assessment by the Group.
Lack of exchangeability – Amendments to IAS 21
•	 In August 2023, the Board issued Lack of Exchangeability 
(Amendments to IAS 21).
•	 The amendment to IAS 21 specifies how an entity should assess 
when a currency is exchangeable into another currency and how 
it should estimate a spot exchange rate when a currency lacks 
exchangeability.
•	 A currency is considered to be exchangeable into another 
currency when an entity is able to exchange that currency for 
the other currency at the measurement date and for a specified 
purpose.
•	 If a currency is not exchangeable into another currency, an 
entity is required to estimate the spot exchange rate at the 
measurement date. An entity’s objective in estimating the spot 
exchange rate is to reflect the rate at which an orderly exchange 
transaction would take place at the measurement date between 
market participants under prevailing economic conditions. The 
amendments note that an entity can use an observable exchange 
rate without adjustment or another estimation technique. 
The amendments are effective for annual periods beginning on or 
after 1 January 2025. The impact of this standard is currently under 
assessment, but is not expected to have any material impact on the 
Group.
Classification of Liabilities as Current or Non-current and Non-
current Liabilities with Covenants – Amendments to IAS 1 
•	 In January 2020 and October 2022, the Board issued 
amendments to IAS 1 to specify the requirements for classifying 
liabilities as current or non-current. The amendments clarify:
	- What is meant by a right to defer settlement
	- That a right to defer settlement must exist at the end of the 
reporting period
	- That classification is unaffected by the likelihood that an entity will 
exercise its deferral right
	- That only if an embedded derivative in a convertible liability is 
itself an equity instrument would the terms of a liability not impact 
its classification
	- Disclosure requirements have been added where a non-current 
liability is contingent upon compliance with future covenants 
within a 12 months. 
The amendments are effective for annual reporting periods 
beginning on or after 1 January 2024. The amendment does not 
have a material impact on the Group.
Lease Liability in a Sale and Leaseback – Amendments to IFRS 
16 
•	 In September 2022, the Board issued Lease Liability in a Sale 
and Leaseback (Amendments to IFRS 16).
•	 The amendment to IFRS 16 Leases specifies the requirements 
that a seller-lessee uses in measuring the lease liability arising in a 
sale and leaseback transaction, to ensure the seller-lessee does 
not recognise any amount of the gain or loss that relates to the 
right of use it retains.
Statement of Accounting Policies
For the year ended 29 February 2024 (continued)
190
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

•	 After the commencement date in a sale and leaseback 
transaction, the seller-lessee applies paragraphs 29 to 35 of 
IFRS 16 to the right-of-set asset arising from the leaseback and 
paragraphs 36 to 46 of IFRS 16 to the lease liability arising from 
the leaseback. In applying paragraphs 36 to 46, the seller-lessee 
determines ‘lease payments’ or ‘revised lease payments’ in such 
a way that the seller-lessee would not recognise any amount of 
the gain or loss that relates to the right of use retained by the 
seller-lessee. Applying these requirements does not prevent the 
seller-lessee from recognising, in profit or loss, any gain or loss 
relating to the partial or full termination of a lease, as required by 
paragraph 46(a) of IFRS 16.
•	 The amendment does not prescribe specific measurement 
requirements for lease liabilities arising from a leaseback. The 
initial measurement of the lease liability arising from a leaseback 
may result in a seller-lessee determining ‘lease payments’ that 
are different from the general definition of lease payments in 
Appendix A of IFRS 16. The seller-lessee will need to develop 
and apply an accounting policy in accordance with IAS 8 that 
results in information that is relevant and reliable.
The amendments are effective for annual reporting periods 
beginning on or after 1 January 2024. The amendment is not 
expected to have a material impact on the Group.
 
IFRS 18 – Presentation and Disclosure in Financial Statements 
•	 In April 2024, the Board issued IFRS 18 Presentation and 
Disclosure in Financial Statements which replaces IAS 1 
Presentation of Financial Statements. 
•	 IFRS 18 introduces new requirements on presentation within 
the statement of profit or loss, including totals and subtotals. It 
also requires disclosure of management-defined performance 
measures and includes new requirements for aggregation and 
disaggregation of financial information based on the identified 
‘roles’ of the primary financial statements and the notes. These 
new requirements are expected to impact all reporting entities.
•	 Narrow scope amendments have been made to IAS 7 Statement 
of Cash Flows and some requirements previously included within 
IAS 1 have been moved to IAS 8 Accounting Policies, Changes 
in Accounting Estimates and Errors, which has also been 
renamed IAS 8 Basis of Preparation of Financial Statements. 
IAS 34 Interim Financial Reporting was amended to require 
disclosure of management-defined performance measures. 
Minor consequential amendments to other standards were also 
made.
IFRS 18, and the amendments to the other standards, is effective 
for reporting periods beginning on or after 1 January 2027, but 
earlier application is permitted and must be disclosed. The impact 
of this standard is currently under assessment and will be adopted 
at a later date.
Material accounting policies
The material accounting policies applied by the Group in the 
preparation of these financial statements are as follows:
Basis of preparation
The Group and the individual financial statements of the Company 
are prepared on the going concern and historical cost basis, except 
for, retirement benefits, the revaluation of certain items of property, 
plant & equipment, share-based payments at date of grant and 
derivative financial instruments. The accounting policies have been 
applied consistently by Group entities and for all periods presented. 
The financial statements are presented in Euro millions to one 
decimal place.
(i) Going concern basis
The Directors have adopted the going concern basis in preparing the 
financial statements after assessing the Group’s principal risks. 
Management of liquidity and net debt have been a key focus for 
the Group throughout FY2024. The Group have reported net debt 
including leases and liquidity of €168.0m and €390.1m respectively 
at 29 February 2024, compared with €155.5m and €470.3m 
respectively in FY2023. The Group delivered a leverage ratio of 1.8x 
Net Debt/EBITDA as at 29 February 2024.
The Group successfully completed a refinancing of its multi-currency 
facility and Euro term loan agreement which was repaid in a single 
instalment following the publication of the Group’s FY2023 Results 
in May 2023. The Group entered into a new five-year committed 
sustainability-linked facility comprised of a €250m multi-currency 
revolving loan facility and a €100m non-amortising Euro term loan.  
The facility offers optionality of two 1-year extensions to the maturity 
date callable within 12 months and 24 months of the initial drawdown 
date respectively. The multi-currency facility and the Euro term 
syndicate comprises six banks - ABN Amro Bank, Allied Irish Bank, 
Bank of Ireland, Barclays Bank, HSBC and Rabobank. In FY2024, 
the Group exercised the first optional extension of the facilities, 
resulting in maturity being extended to January 2029 (FY2029) on 
both the multi-currency facility and Euro term loan. 
Overall conclusion
The headroom on the covenants within the financing facilities 
have been reviewed in detail by management and assessed by 
the Directors. Given the return to unrestricted trading, revenue 
and volume growth in the Group’s core markets, the implemented 
price increases, and cost hedge positions taken; the cash flow 
forecasts demonstrate significant headroom on the covenants 
within the financing facilities. Given the quantum of headroom, the 
Directors have concluded that the covenants will be satisfied and 
therefore consider it appropriate to adopt the going concern basis of 
accounting with no material uncertainties as to the Group’s ability to 
continue to do so.
191
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Basis of consolidation 
The Group’s financial statements consolidate the financial 
statements of the Company and all subsidiary undertakings 
together with the Group’s share of the results of equity accounted 
investments for the year ended 29 February 2024. 
(i) Subsidiaries
Subsidiaries are entities controlled by the Group. The Group 
controls an entity when it is exposed to, or has rights to, variable 
returns from its involvement with the entity and has the ability to 
affect those returns through its power over the entity. The financial 
statements of subsidiaries are included in the consolidated financial 
statements from the date on which control commences until the 
date on which control ceases. 
(ii) Investments in associates and jointly controlled entities 
(equity accounted investments)
The Group’s interests in equity accounted investments comprise 
interests in associates and joint ventures. Associates are those 
entities in which the Group has significant influence, but not control 
or joint control, over the financial and operating policies. A joint 
venture is a type of joint arrangement whereby the parties that have 
joint control of the arrangement have rights to the net assets of the 
arrangement. Joint control is the contractually agreed sharing of 
control of the arrangement, which exists only when decisions about 
the relevant activities require unanimous consent of the parties 
sharing control. The Group’s investments in its joint ventures are 
accounted for using the equity method from the date joint control is 
deemed to arise until the date on which joint control ceases to exist 
or when the interest becomes classified as an asset held for sale. 
The Income Statement reflects the Group’s share of profit after tax 
of the related joint ventures. Investments in joint ventures are carried 
in the Balance Sheet at cost, adjusted in respect of post-acquisition 
changes in the Group’s share of net assets, less any impairment 
in value. If necessary, impairment losses on the carrying amount 
of an investment are reported within the Group’s share of equity 
accounted investments results in the Income Statement. 
Interests in associates are accounted for using the equity method. 
They are initially recognised at cost, which includes transaction 
costs. Subsequent to initial recognition, the consolidated financial 
statements include the Group’s share of the profit or loss and Other 
Comprehensive Income of associates, until the date on which 
significant influence ceases. Dividends receivable from associates 
reduce the carrying amount of the investment.
(iii) Transactions eliminated on consolidation
All intercompany balances and transactions, including unrealised 
gains arising from inter-group transactions, have been eliminated 
in full. Unrealised losses are eliminated in the same manner as 
unrealised gains except to the extent that they provide evidence of 
impairment. 
Unrealised gains arising from transactions with equity accounted 
investments are eliminated against the investment to the extent of 
the Group’s interest in the investment.
 
(iv) Company Financial Statements
Investments in subsidiaries are carried at cost less provision for 
impairment. Dividend income is recognised when the right to 
receive payment is established.
Property, plant and equipment (note 11)
Property (comprising freehold land & buildings) is recognised 
at estimated fair value with the changes in the value of the 
property reflected in Other Comprehensive Income in the case 
of a revaluation gain, to the extent it does not reverse previously 
recognised losses, or as an impairment loss in the Income 
Statement to the extent it does not reverse previously recognised 
revaluation gains. The fair value is based on estimated market 
value at the valuation date, being the estimated amount that would 
be received to sell the property in an orderly transaction between 
market participants at the measurement date, to the extent that 
an active market exists. Such valuations are determined based 
on benchmarking against comparable transactions for similar 
properties in similar locations as those of the Group or on the 
use of valuation techniques including the use of market yields on 
comparable properties. If no active market exists or there are no 
other observable comparative transactions, the fair value may be 
determined using a valuation technique known as a Depreciated 
Replacement Cost approach.
Plant & machinery is carried at its revalued amount. In view of the 
specialised nature of the Group’s plant & machinery and the lack 
of comparable market-based evidence of a similar plant sold, upon 
which to base a market approach of fair value, the Group uses a 
Depreciated Replacement Cost approach to determine a fair value 
for such assets. 
Depreciated Replacement Cost is assessed, firstly, by the 
identification of the gross replacement cost for each class of plant & 
machinery. A depreciation factor derived from both the physical and 
functional obsolescence of each class of asset, taking into account 
estimated residual values at the end of the life of each class of 
asset, is then applied to the gross replacement cost to determine 
the net replacement cost. An economic obsolescence factor, which 
is derived based on current and anticipated capacity or utilisation 
of each class of plant & machinery as a function of total available 
production capacity, is applied to determine the Depreciated 
Replacement Cost. 
Motor vehicles & other equipment are stated at cost less 
accumulated depreciation and impairment losses.
Statement of Accounting Policies
For the year ended 29 February 2024 (continued)
192
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Cost includes expenditure that is directly attributable to the 
acquisition of the asset. When parts of an item of property, plant 
& equipment have different useful lives, they are accounted for as 
separate items (major components) of property, plant & equipment. 
Subsequent costs are included in an asset’s carrying amount or 
recognised as a separate asset, as appropriate, only when it is 
probable that future economic benefits associated with the item will 
flow to the Group. 
 
Property, plant & equipment, other than freehold land and assets 
under construction, which are not depreciated, were depreciated 
using the following rates which are calculated to write-off the value 
of the asset, less the estimated salvage value of 5% for other plant 
& machinery and 15% for storage tanks, over its expected useful 
life: 
Land & Buildings
Land
n/a
Buildings – ROI, Portugal
2 - 6% straight-line
Buildings – UK 
2 - 3% straight-line
 
Plant & Machinery
Storage tanks
2 - 7% straight-line
Other plant & machinery 
6 - 32% reducing 
balance 
 
Motor Vehicles & Other Equipment
Motor vehicles 
15% straight-line
Other equipment incl returnable 
bottles, cases and kegs
5 - 25% straight-line
 
Judgement is involved in the depreciation policy applied to certain 
fixed assets where there is considered to be a salvage value. The 
Group considers that such assets have a salvage value equal to 
5% of cost for other plant & machinery and 15% for storage tanks, 
based on the expected scrap value of the associated assets. 
The salvage value and useful lives of property, plant & equipment 
are reviewed and adjusted if appropriate at each reporting date 
to take account of any changes that could affect prospective 
depreciation charges and asset carrying values. When determining 
useful economic lives, the principal factors the Group takes into 
account are the intensity at which the assets are expected to be 
used, expected requirements for the equipment and technological 
developments.
On disposal of property, plant & equipment, the cost or valuation 
and related accumulated depreciation and impairments are 
removed from the Balance Sheet and the net amount, less any 
proceeds, is taken to the Income Statement and any amounts 
included within the revaluation reserve transferred to the retained 
income reserve.
The carrying amounts of the Group’s property, plant & equipment 
are reviewed at each balance sheet date to determine whether there 
is any indication of impairment. An impairment loss is recognised 
when the carrying amount of an asset or its cash-generating unit 
exceeds its recoverable amount (being the greater of fair value 
less costs to sell and value in use). Impairment losses are debited 
directly to equity under the heading of revaluation reserve to the 
extent of any credit balance existing in the revaluation reserve 
account in respect of that asset with the remaining balance 
recognised in the Income Statement.
Certain property, plant & equipment is remeasured to fair value at 
regular intervals. In these cases, the revaluation surplus is credited 
directly to Other Comprehensive Income and accumulated in 
equity under the heading of revaluation reserve, unless it reverses 
a revaluation decrease on the same asset previously recognised as 
an expense, where it is first credited to the Income Statement to the 
extent of the previous write down.
Leases (note 11 and note 19)
The Group enters into leases for a range of assets, principally 
relating to land & buildings, plant & machinery and motor vehicles & 
other equipment. These leases have varying terms, renewal rights 
and escalation clauses.
A contract contains a lease if it is enforceable and conveys the 
right to control the use of a specified asset for a period of time in 
exchange for consideration, which is assessed at inception. 
Group as a lessee
(i) Right-of-use assets
The Group recognises a right-of-use asset at the commencement 
date for contracts containing a lease. The commencement date is 
the date at which the asset is made available for use by the Group.
Right-of-use assets are measured at cost, less any accumulated 
depreciation and impairment losses, and adjusted for any 
remeasurement of lease liabilities. The cost of right-of-use assets 
includes the lease liability adjusted for any payments made at or 
before the commencement date, initial direct costs incurred, lease 
incentives received and an estimate of the cost to dismantle or 
193
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

restore the underlying asset or the site on which it is located at the 
end of the lease term. The right-of-use asset is depreciated over 
the lease term or, where a purchase option is reasonably certain 
to be exercised, over the useful economic life of the asset in line 
with depreciation rates for owned property, plant & equipment. 
The right-of-use asset is tested periodically for impairment if any 
impairment indicator is considered to exist. 
(ii) Lease liabilities
At the commencement date of the lease, the Group recognises 
lease liabilities measured at the present value of lease payments 
to be made over the lease term. The commencement date is the 
date at which the asset is made available for use by the Group. 
Lease payments include fixed payments less any lease incentives 
receivable, variable payments that are dependent on a rate or 
index known at the commencement date, payments for an optional 
renewal period and purchase and termination option payments, 
if the Group is reasonably certain to exercise those options. 
Management applies judgement in determining whether it is 
reasonably certain that a renewal, termination or purchase option 
will be exercised.
The lease liability is initially measured at the present value of the 
future lease payments, discounted using the incremental borrowing 
rate or the interest rate implicit in the lease, if this is readily 
determinable, over the remaining lease term. Incremental borrowing 
rates are calculated using a portfolio approach, based on the risk 
profile of the entity holding the lease and the term and currency of 
the lease.
After initial recognition, the lease liability is measured at amortised 
cost using the effective interest method. It is remeasured when 
there is a change in future lease payments or when the Group 
changes its assessment of whether it is reasonably certain to 
exercise an option within the contract. A corresponding adjustment 
is made to the carrying amount of the right-of-use asset. 
The Group chooses whether or not to include certain non-lease 
components, such as maintenance costs, in the measurement of 
the right-of-use asset and lease liability on an underlying asset class 
as afforded by the practical expedients in the standard. Where the 
non-lease components are not included, the costs are separated 
from lease payments and are expensed as incurred.
(iii) Short-term leases and leases of low-value assets 
The Group applies the short-term lease recognition exemption to 
its short-term leases (i.e. those leases that have a lease term of 12 
months or less from the commencement date and do not contain 
a purchase option). It also applies the lease of low-value assets 
recognition exemption to leases where the underlying asset value is 
low. Lease payments on short-term leases and leases of low-value 
assets are recognised as an expense on a straight-line basis over 
the lease term.
Goodwill (note 12)
As at the date of acquisition any goodwill acquired is allocated 
to each cash-generating unit (‘CGU’) (which may comprise more 
than one cash-generating unit) expected to benefit from the 
combination’s synergies. Impairment is determined by assessing 
the recoverable amount of the CGU to which the goodwill relates. 
These CGUs represent the lowest level within the Group at which 
goodwill is monitored for internal management purposes. 
Where goodwill forms part of a CGU and part of the operation 
within that unit is disposed of, the goodwill associated with the 
operation disposed of is included in the carrying amount of the 
operation when determining the gain or loss on disposal of the 
operation. Goodwill disposed of in this circumstance is measured 
on the basis of the relative values of the operation disposed of and 
the proportion of the business segment retained. 
Goodwill relating to associates and joint ventures is included in the 
carrying amount of the investment and is neither amortised nor 
individually tested for impairment. Where indicators of impairment 
of an investment arise in accordance with the requirements of IAS 
36, the carrying amount is tested for impairment by comparing its 
recoverable amount with its carrying amount.
Intangible assets (other than goodwill) (note 12)
An intangible asset, which is a non-monetary asset without a 
physical substance, is capitalised separately from goodwill.
Subsequent to initial recognition, intangible assets are carried at 
cost less any accumulated amortisation and any accumulated 
impairment losses. The carrying values of intangible assets 
considered to have an indefinite useful economic life are 
reviewed for indicators of impairment regularly and are subject to 
impairment testing on an annual basis unless events or changes 
in circumstances indicate that the carrying values may not be 
recoverable and impairment testing is required earlier.
Statement of Accounting Policies
For the year ended 29 February 2024 (continued)
194
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Software costs incurred with respect to new systems and costs 
incurred in acquiring software and licences that will contribute to 
future period financial benefits through revenue generation and/or 
cost reduction are capitalised. Costs capitalised include external 
direct costs of materials and service and direct payroll and payroll 
related costs of employees’ time spent on the development side of 
the project. 
Cloud software license agreements to use cloud software 
are treated as service contracts and expensed in the Income 
Statement, unless the Group has both the contractual right to take 
possession of the software anytime without significant penalty, and 
the ability to run the software independently of the host vendor. In 
such cases, the license agreement is capitalised as software within 
intangible assets.
The amortisation charge on intangible assets considered to have 
finite lives is calculated to write-off the book value of the asset over 
its useful life on a straight-line basis on the assumption of zero 
residual value. 
The useful lives of the Group’s intangible assets are as follows:
Trade relationship re Tennent’s acquisition 
20 years
Trade relationship re Wallaces acquisition
10 years
Trade relationship re Gleeson acquisition
15 years
Trade relationship re Matthew Clark and 
Bibendum acquisition
15 years
Software and licence costs
5 - 8 years
 
Impairment of non-financial assets
Further disclosures relating to impairment of non-financial assets 
are also provided in the following notes: 
•	 Goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite lives: Note 12
•	 Intangible assets: Note 12
•	 Property, plant and equipment: Note 11
•	 Investments in associates and joint ventures: Note 13
The Group assesses at each reporting date, whether there is an 
indication that an asset may be impaired. If any indication exists, or 
when annual impairment testing for an asset is required, the Group 
estimates the asset’s recoverable amount. An asset’s recoverable 
amount is the higher of an asset’s or CGU’s fair value less costs of 
disposal and its value in use. The recoverable amount is determined 
for an individual asset, unless the asset does not generate cash 
inflows that are largely independent of those from other assets or 
groups of assets. When the carrying amount of an asset or CGU 
exceeds its recoverable amount, the asset is considered impaired 
and is written down to its recoverable amount.
In assessing value in use, the estimated future cash flows are 
discounted to their present value using a pre-tax discount rate that 
reflects current market assessments of the time value of money and 
the risks specific to the asset. In determining fair value less costs of 
disposal, recent market transactions are taken into account. If no 
such transactions can be identified, an appropriate valuation model 
is used. These calculations are corroborated by valuation multiples, 
quoted share prices for publicly traded companies or other available 
fair value indicators. 
Impairment losses of continuing operations are recognised in 
the Income Statement in expense categories consistent with the 
function of the impaired asset, except for properties previously 
revalued with the revaluation taken to Other Comprehensive 
Income. For such properties, the impairment is recognised in 
Other Comprehensive Income up to the amount of any previous 
revaluation. 
For assets excluding goodwill, an assessment is made at each 
reporting date to determine whether there is an indication that 
previously recognised impairment losses no longer exist or have 
decreased. If such indication exists, the Group estimates the 
asset’s or CGU’s recoverable amount. A previously recognised 
impairment loss is reversed only if there has been a change in the 
assumptions used to determine the asset’s recoverable amount 
since the last impairment loss was recognised. The reversal is 
limited so that the carrying amount of the asset does not exceed 
its recoverable amount, nor exceed the carrying amount that would 
have been determined, net of depreciation, had no impairment 
loss been recognised for the asset in prior years. Such reversal is 
recognised in the Income Statement unless the asset is carried 
at a revalued amount, in which case, the reversal is treated as a 
revaluation increase. 
Goodwill is subject to impairment testing on an annual basis and at 
any time during the year if an indicator of impairment is considered 
to exist. In the year in which a business combination is effected 
and where some or all of the goodwill allocated to a particular 
cash-generating unit arose in respect of that combination, the 
cash-generating unit is tested for impairment prior to the end of 
the relevant annual period. Where the carrying value exceeds the 
estimated recoverable amount (being the greater of the fair value 
less costs of disposal and value-in-use), an impairment loss is 
recognised by writing down goodwill to its recoverable amount. 
In assessing value in use, the estimated future cash flows are 
discounted to their present value using a pre-tax discount rate that 
reflects current market assessments of the time value of money and 
the risks specific to the asset. The recoverable amount of goodwill 
is determined by reference to the cash-generating unit to which the 
goodwill has been allocated. Impairment losses arising in respect of 
goodwill are not reversed once recognised. 
195
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Intangible assets with indefinite useful economic lives are 
reviewed for indicators of impairment regularly and are subject to 
impairment testing on an annual basis unless events or changes 
in circumstances indicate that the carrying values may not be 
recoverable and impairment testing is required earlier.
Retirement benefit obligations (note 23)
The Group operates a number of defined contribution and defined 
benefit pension schemes. 
Obligations to the defined contribution pension schemes are 
recognised as an expense in the Income Statement as the related 
employee service is received. Under these schemes, the Group 
has no obligation, either legal or constructive, to pay further 
contributions in the event that the fund does not hold sufficient 
assets to meet its benefit commitments.
The liabilities and costs associated with the Group’s defined benefit 
pension schemes, all of which are funded and administered under 
trusts which are separate from the Group, are assessed on the 
basis of the projected unit credit method by professionally qualified 
actuaries and are arrived at using actuarial assumptions based 
on market expectations at the reporting date. The discount rates 
employed in determining the present value of the schemes’ liabilities 
are determined by reference to market yields, at the reporting date, 
on high-quality corporate bonds of a currency and term consistent 
with the currency and term of the associated post-employment 
benefit obligations. The fair value of scheme assets is based on 
market price information, measured at bid value for publicly quoted 
securities. 
The resultant defined benefit pension net surplus or deficit is shown 
within either non-current assets or non-current liabilities on the face 
of the Balance Sheet and comprises the total for each plan of the 
present value of the defined benefit obligation less the fair value of 
plan assets out of which the obligations are to be settled directly. 
The assumptions (disclosed in note 23) underlying these valuations 
are updated at each reporting period date based on current 
economic conditions and expectations (discount rates, salary 
inflation and mortality rates) and reflect any changes to the terms 
and conditions of the post-retirement pension plans. The deferred 
tax liabilities and assets arising on pension scheme surpluses 
and deficits are disclosed separately within deferred tax assets or 
liabilities, as appropriate. 
When the benefits of a defined benefit scheme are improved, 
the portion of the increased benefit relating to the past service of 
employees is recognised as an expense immediately in the Income 
Statement. 
The expected increase in the present value of scheme liabilities 
arising from employee service in the current period is recognised 
in arriving at operating profit or loss together with the net 
interest expense/(income) on the net defined benefit liability/
(asset). Differences between the actual return on plan assets and 
the interest income, experience gains and losses on scheme 
liabilities, together with the effect of changes in the current or 
prior assumptions underlying the liabilities are recognised in Other 
Comprehensive Income. The amounts recognised in the Income 
Statement and Other Comprehensive Income and the valuation of 
the defined benefit pension net surplus or deficit are sensitive to the 
assumptions used.
Company
The Company has no direct employees and is not the sponsoring 
employer for any of the Group’s defined benefit pension schemes. 
Income tax (note 7 and note 22)
Current income tax
Current tax expense represents the expected tax amount to be 
paid in respect of taxable income for the current year and is based 
on reported profit and the expected statutory tax rates, reliefs, 
and allowances applicable in the jurisdictions in which the Group 
operates. Current tax for the current and prior years, to the extent 
that it is unpaid, is recognised as a liability in the Balance Sheet. 
Deferred tax
Deferred tax is provided on the basis of the Balance Sheet 
liability method on all temporary differences at the reporting date. 
Temporary differences are defined as the difference between the 
tax bases of assets and liabilities and their carrying amounts in 
the financial statements. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are not 
subject to discounting and are measured at the tax rates that are 
expected to apply in the period in which the asset is recovered or 
the liability is settled based on tax rates and tax laws that have been 
enacted or substantively enacted at the balance sheet date.
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognised for all temporary 
differences except where they arise from:
•	 The initial recognition of goodwill or an asset or a liability in a 
transaction that is not a business combination and affects neither 
the accounting profit or loss nor the taxable profit or loss at the 
time of the transaction and does not give rise to equal taxable 
and deductible temporary differences, or, 
•	 Taxable temporary differences associated with investments in 
subsidiaries where the timing of the reversal of the temporary 
difference is subject to the Group’s control and it is probable that 
a reversal will not be recognised in the foreseeable future.
Statement of Accounting Policies
For the year ended 29 February 2024 (continued)
196
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

The Group has applied the exception in IAS 12 Income Taxes to 
recognising and disclosing information about deferred tax assets 
and liabilities to Pillar Two taxes.
Deferred tax assets in respect of deductible temporary differences 
are recognised only to the extent that it is probable that taxable 
profits or taxable temporary differences will be available against 
which to offset these items. The recognition or non-recognition of 
deferred tax assets as appropriate also requires judgement as it 
involves an assessment of the future recoverability of those assets. 
The recognition of deferred tax assets is based on management’s 
judgement and estimate of the most probable amount of future 
taxable profits and taking into consideration applicable tax 
legislation in the relevant jurisdiction. The carrying amounts of 
deferred tax assets are subject to review at each reporting date and 
are reduced to the extent that future taxable profits are considered 
to be insufficient to allow all or part of the deferred tax asset to be 
utilised.
The Group offsets deferred tax assets and deferred tax liabilities 
only if it has a legally enforceable right to set off current tax assets 
and current tax liabilities and the deferred tax assets and deferred 
tax liabilities relate to income taxes levied by the same taxation 
authority on either the same taxable entity or different taxable 
entities which intend either to settle current tax liabilities and assets 
on a net basis, or to realise the assets and settle the liabilities 
simultaneously, in each future period in which significant amounts 
of deferred tax liabilities or assets are expected to be settled or 
recovered.
Deferred tax and current tax are recognised as a component of the 
tax expense in the Income Statement except to the extent that they 
relate to items recognised directly in Other Comprehensive Income 
or equity (for example, certain derivative financial instruments 
and actuarial gains and losses on defined benefit pension 
schemes), in which case the related tax is also recognised in Other 
Comprehensive Income or equity.
The Group has applied the amendment to IAS 12 Income Taxes on 
the mandatory temporary exception to recognising and disclosing 
information about deferred tax assets and liabilities that are related 
to tax law enacted or substantively enacted to implement the Pillar 
Two model rules published by the Organisation for Economic Co-
operation and Development (‘OECD’). The amendments require that 
entities shall apply the amendments immediately upon issuance. 
Pillar Two legislation is not expected to have a material impact 
on the financial statements of the Group. The Group continue to 
monitor changes in law and guidance as they apply to C&C Group 
plc.
Company financial assets
Financial assets are reviewed for impairment if there are any 
indications that the carrying value may not be recoverable. 
Share options granted to employees of subsidiary companies are 
accounted for as an increase in the carrying value of the investment 
in subsidiaries and the share-based payment reserve.
Revenue recognition
IFRS 15 Revenue from Contracts with Customers (IFRS 15) 
establishes a five-step model to account for revenue arising from 
contracts with customers. Under IFRS 15, revenue comprises an 
amount that reflects the consideration to which an entity expects 
to be entitled to in exchange for transferring goods or services 
to a customer, exclusive of value added tax, after allowing for 
discounts, rebates, allowances for customer loyalty and other 
pricing related allowances and incentives. Provision is made for 
returns where appropriate. The Group recognises revenue in the 
amount of the price expected to be received for goods and services 
supplied at a point in time or over time, as contractual performance 
obligations are fulfilled, and control of goods and services passes 
to the customer. Where revenue is earned over time as contractual 
performance obligations are satisfied, the percentage-of-completion 
method remains the primary method by which revenue recognition 
is measured.
The Group manufactures and distributes branded cider, beer, wine, 
spirits and soft drinks in which revenue is recognised at a point in 
time when control is deemed to pass to the customer upon leaving 
the Group’s premises or upon delivery to a customer depending on 
the terms of sale. Contracts do not contain multiple performance 
obligations (as defined by IFRS 15).
Across the Group, goods are often sold with discounts or 
rebates based on cumulative sales over a period. The variable 
consideration is only recognised when it is highly probable that 
it will not be subsequently reversed and is recognised using the 
most likely amount or expected value methods, depending on 
the individual contract terms. In the application of appropriate 
revenue recognition, judgement is exercised by management in the 
determination of the likelihood and quantum of items giving rise to 
variable consideration based on experience and historical trading 
patterns. 
The Group is deemed to be a principal to an arrangement when it 
controls a promised good or service before transferring them to a 
customer; and accordingly recognises the revenue on a gross basis. 
197
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

The Group is determined to be an agent in a transaction where the 
Group arranges for the provision of goods or services on behalf of 
another party and does not control the goods and services before 
being transferred to the customer; the net amount retained after any 
payments to the principal is recognised as revenue. 
Excise duty
Excise duty is levied at the point of production in the case of the 
Group’s manufactured products and at the point of importation 
in the case of imported products in the relevant jurisdictions in 
which the Group operates. As the Group’s manufacturing and 
warehousing facilities are revenue approved and registered excise 
facilities, the excise duty liability generally crystallises on transfer of 
product from duty in suspense to duty paid status which normally 
coincides with the point of sale. The duty number disclosed 
represents the cash cost of duty paid on the Group’s products. 
Where goods are bought duty paid, and subsequently sold, the 
duty element is not included in the duty line within net revenue but 
is included within the cost of goods sold.
Net revenue
Net revenue is defined by the Group as revenue less excise duty 
paid by the Group. 
Exceptional items
The Group has adopted an accounting policy and Income 
Statement format that seeks to highlight specific significant items 
of income and expense within the Group results for the year which 
the Directors believe provides a more useful analysis. Significant 
items are determined based on their size, nature and/or being 
non-recurring items. Items categorised as Exceptional are done so 
based on a qualitative and quantitative framework that considers 
these same factors: 
•	 Size: For an item to be deemed exceptional, it must have a 
material effect on C&C’s profitability and should therefore be 
separately disclosed. For the purposes of FY2024 year-end, 
the Group determined a material amount as an amount that 
would influence the economic decisions of a user of the financial 
statements.
•	 Nature: Inconsistent items – these are items which are 
inconsistent amounts year on year (where applicable) such as 
revaluation gains/losses.
•	 Non-Recurring Items: These are events/transactions that are 
infrequent and unusual, or one-off in nature. These include items 
such as restructuring and integration projects, litigation costs and 
settlements, impairment of assets, COVID-19, acquisition related 
costs, and gains/losses from the sale of assets or businesses.
The Directors exercise judgement to determine whether an item 
meets the above criteria in order to be classified as an exceptional 
item.
Finance income and expenses
Finance income comprises interest income on funds invested and 
any gains on hedging instruments that are recognised in the Income 
Statement. Interest income is recognised as it accrues in the 
Income Statement, using the effective interest method.
Finance expenses comprise interest expense on borrowings, 
finance charges on sale of trade receivables, amortisation of 
borrowing issue costs and unwinding the discount on provisions 
and leases. All borrowing costs are recognised in the Income 
Statement using the effective interest method.
Assets held for sale
Non-current assets, or disposal groups comprising of assets and 
liabilities, are classified as held-for-sale if it is highly probable that 
they will be recovered primarily through sale rather than through 
continuing use. Such assets, or disposal groups, are generally 
measured at the lower of their carrying amount and fair value less 
costs to sell. Any impairment loss on a disposal group is allocated 
first to goodwill, and then to the remaining assets and liabilities 
on a pro rata basis, except that no loss is allocated to inventories, 
financial assets, deferred tax assets or employee benefit assets, 
which continue to be measured in accordance with the Group’s 
other accounting policies as applicable. 
Impairment losses on initial classification as held-for-sale and 
subsequent gains and losses on remeasurement are recognised in 
the Income Statement. Once classified as held-for-sale, intangible 
assets and property, plant and equipment are no longer amortised 
or depreciated, and any equity accounted investee is no longer 
equity accounted.
Discontinued operations
A discontinued operation is a component of the Group’s business, 
the operations and cash flows of which can be clearly distinguished 
from the rest of the Group and which either represents a separate 
major line of business or geographic area of operations, is part 
of a single co-ordinated plan to dispose of a separate major line 
of business or geographic area of operations, or is a subsidiary 
acquired exclusively with a view to resale. 
Classification as a discontinued operation occurs at the earlier of 
disposal or when the operation meets the criteria to be classified 
as held-for-sale. When an operation is classified as a discontinued 
operation, the comparative Income Statement and Other 
Comprehensive Income is represented as if the operation had been 
discontinued from the start of the comparative year. 
Statement of Accounting Policies
For the year ended 29 February 2024 (continued)
198
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Share-based payments
The Group operates a number of Share Option Schemes, 
Performance Share Plans and cash settled award schemes, listed 
below;
•	 Executive Share Option Scheme (the ‘ESOS’),
•	 Long-Term Incentive Plan (the ‘LTIP’),
•	 Recruitment and Retention Plan,
•	 Deferred Bonus Plan (‘DBP’), and
•	 Partnership and Matching Share Schemes.
Equity settled share-based payment transactions
Group share schemes allow certain employees to acquire shares 
in the Company. The fair value of share entitlements granted is 
recognised as an employee expense in the Income Statement with 
a corresponding increase in equity.
The details of how awards vested are set out in note 4.
The expense for the share entitlements shown in the Income 
Statement is based on the fair value of the total number of 
entitlements expected to vest and is allocated to accounting 
periods on a straight-line basis over the vesting period. The 
cumulative charge to the Income Statement at each reporting date 
reflects the extent to which the vesting period has expired and the 
Group’s best estimate of the number of equity instruments that will 
ultimately vest. It is reversed only where entitlements do not vest 
because all non-market performance conditions have not been 
met or where an employee in receipt of share entitlements leaves 
the Group before the end of the vesting period and forfeits those 
options as a consequence.
The proceeds received by the Company net of any directly 
attributable transaction costs on the vesting of share entitlements 
met by the issue of new shares are credited to share capital 
and share premium when the share entitlements are exercised. 
Amounts included in the share-based payments reserve are 
transferred to retained income when vested options are exercised, 
forfeited post-vesting or lapse.
The dilutive effect of outstanding options, to the extent that they 
are to be settled by the issue of new shares and to the extent that 
the vesting conditions would have been satisfied if the end of the 
reporting period was the end of the contingency period, is reflected 
as additional share dilution in the determination of diluted earnings 
per share.
Please see details of award valuation approach in Note 4. 
Segmental reporting
Operating segments are reported in a manner consistent with the 
internal organisational and management structure of the Group and 
the internal financial information provided to the Chief Operating 
Decision-Maker (‘CODM’), the executive Directors, who are 
responsible for the allocation of resources and the monitoring and 
assessment of performance of each of the operating segments. 
Foreign currency translation 
Items included in the financial statements of each of the Group’s 
entities are measured using the currency of the primary economic 
environment in which the entity operates (“the functional currency”). 
The consolidated financial statements are presented in Euro, which 
is the presentation currency of the Group and both the presentation 
and functional currency of the Company.
Transactions in foreign currencies are translated into the functional 
currency of each entity at the foreign exchange rate ruling at the 
date of the transaction. Non-monetary assets carried at historic 
cost are not subsequently retranslated. Monetary assets and 
liabilities denominated in foreign currencies at the reporting date 
are translated into functional currencies at the foreign exchange 
rate ruling at that date. Foreign exchange movements arising 
on translation are recognised in the Income Statement with the 
exception of all monetary items designated as a hedge of a net 
investment in a foreign operation, which are recognised in the 
consolidated financial statements in Other Comprehensive Income 
until the disposal of the net investment, at which time they are 
recognised in the Income Statement for the year.
The assets and liabilities of foreign operations, including goodwill 
and fair value adjustments arising on consolidation, are translated 
to Euro at the foreign exchange rates ruling at the reporting date. 
The revenues and expenses of foreign operations are translated to 
Euro at the average exchange rate for the financial period where 
that represents a reasonable approximation of actual rates. Foreign 
exchange movements arising on translation of the net investment 
in a foreign operation, including those arising on long-term intra-
group loans for which settlement is neither planned nor likely 
to happen in the foreseeable future and as a consequence are 
deemed quasi equity in nature, are recognised directly in Other 
Comprehensive Income in the consolidated financial statements in 
the foreign currency translation reserve. The portion of exchange 
gains or losses on foreign currency borrowings or derivatives used 
to provide a hedge against a net investment in a foreign operation 
that is designated as a hedge of those investments, is recognised 
directly in Other Comprehensive Income to the extent that they are 
determined to be effective. The ineffective portion is recognised 
immediately in the Income Statement for the year.
199
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Any movements that have arisen since 1 March 2004, the date of 
transition to IFRS, are recognised in the currency translation reserve 
and are recycled through the Income Statement on disposal of the 
related business. Translation differences that arose before the date 
of transition to IFRS as adopted by the EU in respect of all non-Euro 
denominated operations are not presented separately.
Inventories 
Inventories are stated at the lower of cost and net realisable value. 
Cost includes all expenditure incurred in acquiring the inventories 
and bringing them to their present location and condition and is 
based on the first-in first-out principle.
In the case of finished goods and work in progress, cost includes 
direct production costs and the appropriate share of production 
overheads plus excise duties, where appropriate. Net realisable 
value is the estimated selling price in the ordinary course of 
business, less estimated costs necessary to complete the sale.
Provision is made for slow-moving or obsolete inventory where 
appropriate.
Provisions 
A provision is recognised in the Balance Sheet when the Group 
has a present legal or constructive obligation as a result of a past 
event, and it is probable that an outflow of economic benefits will 
be required to settle the obligation. Provisions are measured at the 
Directors’ best estimate of the expenditure required to settle the 
obligation at the balance sheet date and are discounted to present 
value at an appropriate rate if the effect of the time value of money 
is deemed material. The carrying amount of the provision increases 
in each period to reflect the passage of time and the unwinding of 
the discount. The increase in the provision due to the passage of 
time is recognised in the Income Statement within finance expense.
A contingent liability is not recognised but is disclosed where the 
existence of the obligation will only be confirmed by future events or 
where it is not probable that an outflow of resources will be required 
to settle the obligation or where the amount of the obligation cannot 
be measured with reasonable reliability. Contingent assets are not 
recognised but are disclosed where an inflow of economic benefits 
is probable. Provisions are not recognised for future operating 
losses; however, provisions are recognised for onerous contracts 
where the unavoidable cost exceeds the expected benefit.
 
Due to the inherent uncertainty with respect to such matters, 
the value of each provision is based on the best information 
available at the time, including advice obtained from third-party 
experts, and is reviewed by the Directors on a periodic basis 
with the potential financial exposure reassessed. Revisions to the 
valuation of a provision are recognised in the period in which such 
a determination is made, and such revisions could have a material 
impact on the financial performance of the Group.
Financial instruments 
Trade & other receivables 
Trade receivables are initially recognised at fair value (which 
usually equals the original invoice value) and are subsequently 
measured at amortised cost less allowance for impairment losses. 
The Group applies the simplified approach permitted by IFRS 
9 Financial Instruments to measure expected credit losses for 
trade receivables, which requires expected lifetime losses to be 
recognised from initial recognition of the receivables. The carrying 
amount of these receivables approximates their fair value as these 
are short-term in nature. The maximum exposure to credit risk at 
the reporting date is the carrying value of each class of receivable.
Trade receivables are derecognised when the rights to receive cash 
flows from the asset have expired or the Group has transferred 
its rights to receive cash flows from the asset or has assumed an 
obligation to pay the received cash flows in full without material 
delay to a third-party under a ‘pass-through’ arrangement, and 
either (a) the Group has transferred substantially all the risks and 
rewards of the asset, or (b) the Group has neither transferred nor 
retained substantially all the risks and rewards of the asset, but has 
transferred control of the asset. 
Cash 
Cash in the Balance Sheet comprises of cash at bank and in hand 
and short-term deposits with an original maturity of three months or 
less. Bank overdrafts that are repayable on demand and form part 
of the Group’s cash management are included as a component of 
cash for the purpose of the statement of cash flows. 
Advances to customers
Advances to customers, are initially recognised at fair value, 
amortised to the Income Statement (and classified within sales 
discounts as a reduction in revenue) over the relevant period to 
which the customer commitment is made, and subsequently 
carried at amortised cost less an impairment allowance. Where 
there is a volume target the amortisation of the advance is included 
in sales discounts as a reduction to revenue. Regarding advances 
to customers, the Group applies the general approach to measure 
expected credit losses which requires a loss provision to be 
recognised based on twelve month or lifetime expected credit 
losses, provided a significant increase in credit risk has occurred 
since initial recognition. The Group Credit Committee reviews debt 
collection trends and commercial market information to assess any 
significant change in credit risk.
Statement of Accounting Policies
For the year ended 29 February 2024 (continued)
200
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Trade & other payables
Trade & other payables are recognised initially at fair value and 
subsequently measured at amortised cost using the effective 
interest rate method.
Interest-bearing loans & borrowings 
Interest-bearing loans & borrowings are recognised initially at fair 
value less attributable transaction costs and are subsequently 
measured at amortised cost with any difference between the 
amount originally recognised and redemption value being 
recognised in the Income Statement over the period of the 
borrowings on an effective interest rate basis. Where the early 
refinancing of a loan results in a significant change in the present 
value of the expected cash flows, the original loan is derecognised 
and the replacement loan is recognised at fair value. The difference 
between the original loan and the fair value of the replacement loan 
is recognised in finance costs in the year. 
Derivative financial instruments
Derivatives are initially recognised at fair value on the date that 
a derivative contract is entered into, and they are subsequently 
remeasured to their fair value at the end of each reporting period. 
The accounting for subsequent changes in fair value depends on 
whether the derivative is designated as a hedging instrument and, 
if so, the nature of the item being hedged. The Group designates 
certain derivatives as hedges of a particular risk associated with the 
cash flows of recognised assets and liabilities and highly probable 
forecast transactions (cash flow hedges). The gains or losses 
related to derivatives not used as effective hedging instruments are 
recognised in the Income Statement.
At inception of the hedge relationship, the Group documents the 
economic relationship between hedging instruments and hedged 
items, including whether changes in the cash flows of the hedging 
instruments are expected to offset changes in the cash flows 
of hedged items. The Group documents its risk management 
objective and strategy for undertaking its hedge transactions. The 
fair values of derivative financial instruments designated in hedge 
relationships are disclosed in note 24. Movements in the hedging 
reserve in Shareholders’ equity are shown in note 24. The full fair 
value of a hedging derivative is classified as a non-current asset 
or liability when the remaining maturity of the hedged item is 
more than 12 months; it is classified as a current asset or liability 
when the remaining maturity of the hedged item is less than 12 
months. The Group enters into derivative contracts only for hedging 
purposes/activities. The Group documents its assessment, both 
at hedge inception and on an ongoing basis, of whether the 
derivatives that are used in hedging transactions are highly effective 
in offsetting changes in fair values or cash flows of hedged items.
Cash flow hedges that qualify for hedge accounting
The effective portion of changes in the fair value of derivatives that 
are designated and qualify as cash flow hedges is recognised in 
the cash flow hedge reserve within equity. The gain or loss relating 
to the ineffective portion is recognised immediately in the Income 
Statement as finance expenses.
The Group uses forward contracts to hedge forecast transactions, 
the Group generally designates the full change in fair value of the 
forward contract, i.e. the forward rate including forward points, as 
the hedging instrument. Gains or losses relating to the effective 
portion of the change in fair value of the entire forward contract are 
recognised in the cash flow hedge reserve within equity.
Amounts accumulated in equity are reclassified in the periods 
when the hedged item affects profit or loss. Where the hedged item 
subsequently results in the recognition of a non-financial asset (such 
as inventory), the deferred hedging gains and losses are included 
within the initial cost of the asset. The deferred amounts are 
ultimately recognised in profit or loss, when the hedged item affects 
profit or loss (for example, through operating costs).
When a hedging instrument expires, or is sold or terminated, or 
when a hedge no longer meets the criteria for hedge accounting, 
any cumulative deferred gain or loss in equity at that time remains 
in equity and recognised in profit or loss in the period the forecast 
transaction occurs and when the forecast transaction is no longer 
expected to occur, the cumulative gain or loss that were reported in 
equity are immediately reclassified to profit or loss.
Cash flow hedge reserve
The cash flow hedge reserve is used to recognise the effective 
portion of gains or losses on derivatives that are designated and 
qualify as cash flow hedges, as described in note 24. Amounts are 
subsequently either transferred to the initial cost of inventory or 
reclassified to profit or loss as appropriate.
Treasury shares
Equity share capital issued under its Joint Share Ownership Plan, 
which is held in trust by an Employee Trust is classified as treasury 
shares on consolidation until such time as the Interests lapse and 
the shares are cancelled or disposed of by the Trust.
Financial guarantee contracts
Financial guarantee contracts are recognised as a financial liability 
at the time the guarantee is issued. The liability is initially measured 
at fair value and subsequently at the higher of:
•	 The amount determined in accordance with the expected credit 
loss model under IFRS 9 Financial Instruments, and 
•	 The amount initially recognised less, where appropriate, the 
cumulative amount of income recognised in accordance with the 
principles of IFRS 15 Revenue from Contracts with Customers.
 
201
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

The fair value of financial guarantees is determined based on the 
present value of the difference in cash flows between the contractual 
payments required under the debt instrument and the payments that 
would be required without the guarantee, or the estimated amount 
that would be payable to a third party for assuming the obligations.
Where the guarantees in relation to loans or other payables of 
associates are provided for no compensation, the fair values are 
accounted for as contributions and recognised as part of the cost of 
the investment. 
Significant Judgements and Estimates
The preparation of the consolidated financial statements in 
conformity with IFRS as adopted by the EU requires management 
to make certain estimates, assumptions and judgements that affect 
the application of accounting policies and the reported amounts of 
assets, liabilities, income and expenses. The significant judgements, 
estimates and assumptions used by management may differ from 
the actual outcome of the transaction and consequently the realised 
value of the associated assets and liabilities may vary. The Group 
has considered the impact of climate change on the consolidated 
financial statements as at 29 February 2024, including the carrying 
value of assets, the useful economic life of assets, and provisions. 
The significant judgements and estimates which have been applied, 
and which are expected to have a material impact, are as follows:
Significant judgements
Income Taxes
The Group is subject to income tax in a number of jurisdictions, 
and judgement is required in determining the worldwide provision 
for taxes. There are many transactions and calculations during 
the ordinary course of business, for which the ultimate tax 
determination is uncertain and the complexity of the tax treatment 
may be such that the final tax charge may not be determined until 
a formal resolution has been reached with the relevant tax authority 
which may take extended time periods to conclude. The ultimate 
tax charge may, therefore, be different from that which initially is 
reflected in the Group’s consolidated tax charge and provision and 
any such differences could have a material impact on the Group’s 
income tax charge and consequently financial performance. 
The determination of the provision for income tax is based on 
management’s understanding of the relevant tax law and judgement 
as to the appropriate tax charge, and management believe that 
all assumptions and estimates used are reasonable and reflective 
of the tax legislation in jurisdictions in which the Group operates. 
Where the final tax charge is different from the amounts that were 
initially recorded, such differences are recognised in the income tax 
provision in the period in which such determination is made.
Deferred tax assets in respect of deductible temporary differences 
are recognised only to the extent that it is probable that taxable 
profits or taxable temporary differences will be available against 
which to offset these items. The recognition or non-recognition of 
deferred tax assets as appropriate also requires judgement as it 
involves an assessment of the future recoverability of those assets. 
The recognition of deferred tax assets is based on management’s 
judgement and estimate of the most probable amount of future 
taxable profits and taking into consideration applicable tax 
legislation in the relevant jurisdiction. 
Revenue recognition
The Group generates revenue from a variety of geographies and 
across a large number of separate legal entities spread across 
the Group’s two business segments and has contract packaging 
agreements with a number of customers, to utilise excess 
manufacturing capacity, that are non-standard and complex 
and involve judgment as to whether contracts are within scope 
of IFRS 15 Revenue from Contracts with Customers, regarding 
revenue recognition with regard to IFRS 15 (being recognised over 
time or at a point in time), and regarding significant and complex 
customer contracts, discounts and marketing contributions. The 
Group has well developed policies, systems and controls to inform 
management’s judgements and estimates with regard to revenue 
recognition, measurement and classification for its contract 
packaging agreements and complex customer contracts.
Sources of estimation uncertainty
Valuation of property, plant and equipment
The Group values its freehold land & buildings and plant & 
machinery at market value/Depreciated Replacement Cost 
and consequently, carries out an annual valuation. The Group 
engages external valuers to value the Group’s property, plant & 
machinery at a minimum every three years or as at the date of 
acquisition for assets acquired as part of a business combination. 
An external valuation was conducted at 29 February 2024 by 
PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP to value the freehold land & buildings 
and plant & machinery at the Group’s Clonmel (Tipperary), Wellpark 
(Glasgow) and Portugal sites. 
The key assumptions used to determine the fair value of the 
freehold land & buildings and plant & machinery and sensitivity 
analyses are provided in note 11.
Recoverable amount of goodwill 
The impairment testing process requires management to make 
significant estimates regarding the future cash flows expected to 
be generated by cash-generating units to which goodwill has been 
allocated. Future cash flows relating to the eventual disposal of 
these cash-generating units and other factors may also be relevant 
Statement of Accounting Policies
For the year ended 29 February 2024 (continued)
202
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

to determine the recoverable amount of goodwill. Management 
periodically evaluates and updates the estimates based on the 
conditions which influence these variables. The assumptions 
and conditions for determining impairments of goodwill reflect 
management’s best assumptions and estimates (discount rates, 
terminal growth rates, forecasted volume, net revenue, operating 
profit) but these items involve inherent uncertainties described 
above, many of which are not under management’s control. The 
Group also considered the potential impact of climate change 
as further discussed in note 12. This is an area of estimation and 
judgement. As a result, the accounting for such items could result 
in different estimates or amounts if management used different 
assumptions or if different conditions occur in future accounting 
periods. 
The inputs to the value in use calculations are disclosed in note 12.
Incremental borrowing rates on leases
Management use estimation in determining the incremental 
borrowing rates for leases which has a significant impact on the 
lease liabilities and right-of-use assets recognised. The incremental 
borrowing rates includes several key components such as, a 
reference rate (incorporating currency, economic environment and 
term of lease), a financing spread adjustment, an entity specific 
adjustment (if applicable) and a lease specific adjustment (if 
applicable, for example, a property lease compared to vehicle/other 
leases, and the term of the lease).
Please refer to note 19 for the carrying amounts of the right-of-use 
assets and the lease liability impacted.
Pension valuation
Significant estimates are used in the determination of the pension 
obligation, the amounts recognised in the Income Statement and 
Statement of Other Comprehensive Income and the valuation of 
the defined benefit pension net surplus or deficit are sensitive to 
the assumptions used. The assumptions underlying the actuarial 
valuations (including discount rates, rates of increase in future 
compensation levels, mortality rates, salary and pension increases, 
future inflation rates and healthcare cost trends), from which the 
amounts recognised in the consolidated financial statements are 
determined, are updated annually based on current economic 
conditions and for any relevant changes to the terms and conditions 
of the pension and post-retirement plans. These assumptions can 
be affected by (i) the discount rate, changes in the rates of return 
on high-quality corporate bonds; (ii) for future compensation levels, 
future labour market conditions and (iii) for healthcare cost trend 
rates, the rate of medical cost inflation in the relevant regions. 
The weighted average actuarial assumptions used and sensitivity 
analysis in relation to the significant assumptions employed in the 
determination of pension and other post-retirement liabilities are 
contained in note 23 to the consolidated financial statements. 
Whilst management believes that the assumptions used are 
appropriate, differences in actual experience or changes in 
assumptions may affect the obligations and expenses recognised 
in future accounting periods. The assets and liabilities of defined 
benefit pension schemes may exhibit significant period-on-
period volatility attributable primarily to changes in bond yields 
and longevity. In addition to future service contributions, cash 
contributions may be required to remediate past service deficits. A 
sensitivity analysis of the change in these assumptions is provided 
in note 23.
Expected credit losses
The Group applies the simplified approach permitted by IFRS 9 
Financial Instruments to measure expected credit losses for trade 
receivables and advances to customers, which requires expected 
lifetime losses to be recognised from initial recognition.
Estimates have been made around the credit losses expected 
to be incurred on the Group’s financial assets – principally being 
trade receivables and advances to customers. In determining the 
expected credit losses, the loss rates are determined based on the 
grouping of trade receivables and advances to customers sharing 
the same credit risk characteristics and past due days. 
Regarding advances to customers, the Group applies the general 
approach to measure expected credit losses which requires a 
loss provision to be recognised based on twelve month or lifetime 
expected credit losses, provided a significant increase in credit risk 
has occurred since initial recognition.
Please refer to note 15 for the impact of the expected credit loss 
approach on the Group’s trade receivables and advances to 
customers.
Valuation of inventory
Inventories are measured at the lower of cost and net realisable 
value. The Group’s policy is to hold inventories at original cost and 
create an inventory provision where evidence exists that indicates 
net realisable value is below cost for a particular item of inventory. 
Damaged, slow-moving or obsolete inventory are typical examples 
of such evidence.
203
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Share based compensation
The Company grants share-based awards, which consist of 
performance stock unit (PSU) and stock options. All of the share-
based compensation awards are classified as equity awards. The 
Company measures share-based compensation awards using fair 
value based measurement methods. This results in the recognition 
of compensation expense for all share-based compensation awards 
based on their fair value as of grant date. For performance-based 
awards, compensation expense is recognised only if it is probable 
that performance condition will be achieved. Compensation 
expense is recognised over the requisite service period for time and 
performance-based awards, net estimated forfeitures. 
Impairment of investments in subsidiaries 
Investment in subsidiary impairment testing process requires 
management to make significant estimates regarding the 
future cash flows expected to be generated by the subsidiary. 
Management periodically evaluates and updates the estimates 
based on the conditions which influence these variables. The 
assumptions and conditions for determining impairments reflect 
management’s best assumptions and estimates (discount rates, 
terminal growth rates, forecasted volume, net revenue, operating 
profit) but these items involve inherent uncertainties, many of which 
are not under management’s control. The Group also considered 
the potential impact of climate change as further discussed in note 
12. This is an area of estimation and judgement. As a result, the 
accounting for such items could result in different estimates or 
amounts if management used different assumptions or if different 
conditions occur in future accounting periods.
Statement of Accounting Policies
For the year ended 29 February 2024 (continued)
204
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

1. SEGMENTAL REPORTING
The Group’s business activity is the manufacturing, marketing and distribution of branded beer, cider, wine, spirits and soft drinks. Two 
operating segments have been identified in the current and prior financial year: Ireland and Great Britain.
The Group continually reviews and updates the manner in which it monitors and controls its financial operations resulting in changes 
in which information is classified and reported to the Chief Operating Decision Maker (‘CODM’). The CODM, identified as the Executive 
Directors, assesses and monitors the operating results of segments separately via internal management reports in order to manage the 
business and allocate resources effectively.
The identified business segments are as follows:
(i) Ireland 
This segment includes the financial results from sale of the Group’s own branded products across the island of Ireland, principally Bulmers, 
Magners, Tennent’s, Five Lamps, Clonmel 1650 and Heverlee. The Group also operates the Bulmers Ireland drinks distribution business, 
a leading distributor of third-party drinks to the licenced On and Off-trades in Ireland. The Group distributes San Miguel and Budweiser 
Brewing Group’s portfolio of beer brands across the island of Ireland on an exclusive basis. The Group’s primary manufacturing plant in this 
segment is located in Clonmel, Co. Tipperary, with major distribution and administration centres in Dublin and Culcavy, Northern Ireland.
(ii) Great Britain (“GB”)
This segment includes the financial results from the sale of the Group’s own branded products in Scotland, with Tennent’s, Caledonia Best 
and Heverlee being the main brands. This division includes the sale of the Group’s portfolio of owned cider brands across the rest of GB, 
including Magners, Orchard Pig, K Cider and Blackthorn which are distributed in partnership with Budweiser Brewing Group. The Group’s 
primary manufacturing plant in this segment is the Wellpark Brewery in Glasgow, with major distribution and administration centres in 
Glasgow, Bristol and London.
The division includes Tennent’s Direct, Scotland’s leading drinks distributor which serves the Scottish on-trade with an unrivalled range 
of drinks led by beer and cider, and includes exclusive distribution of Moët Hennessy products, such as Moët and Glenmorangie, and UK 
distribution of international brands Tsingtao and Menabrea.
The segment includes the financial results from Matthew Clark, the largest independent distributor to the GB on trade drinks sector. 
Matthew Clark delivers a market-leading composite drinks range across wine, spirits, beer, cider, and soft drinks including a number of 
exclusive distribution agreements with wine producers and third-party brands.
In addition, it includes Bibendum, the UK’s leading independent wine specialist servicing customer across the on trade, independent retail 
(through Walker & Wodehouse) and off-trade nationwide. Bibendum has a portfolio of market-leading premium wines from a selection of 
exclusive, globally recognised, artisan and innovative wine producers.
The Group’s Tennent’s Direct, Matthew Clark and Bibendum distribution businesses operate a nationwide distribution network serving the 
independent free trade, national accounts, independent retail and off-trade customers.
This segment also includes the financial results from the sale and distribution of the Group’s own branded products, principally Magners 
and Tennent’s, outside the UK and Ireland. The Group exports to over 40 countries globally, notably in continental Europe, North America, 
Asia and Australia. The Group operates mainly through local distributors in these markets and regions. This segment also includes the sale 
of the Group’s cider and beer products in the US and Canada.
The Group’s analysis by segment includes both items directly attributable to a segment and those, including central overheads, which are 
allocated on a reasonable basis in presenting information to the CODM.
Inter-segmental revenue is not material and thus not subject to separate disclosure.
In the year ended 29 February 2024, the Group restated the prior year financial information. Details of the restatement are contained in note 
31.
Notes forming part of the financial statements
205
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

(a) Analysis by reporting segment
2024 
2023 
(restated)
Revenue
Net revenue
Operating profit
Revenue 
Net revenue
Operating profit
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
Ireland
400.4
286.3
26.3
389.6
272.0
24.9
Great Britain
1,622.6
1,366.2
33.7
1,674.2
1,414.2
57.7
Total before exceptional items
2,023.0
1,652.5
60.0
2,063.8
1,686.2
82.6
Exceptional items (note 5)
-
-
(144.4)
-
-
(12.4)
Total  
2,023.0
1,652.5
(84.4)
2,063.8
1,686.2
70.2
Impairment of assets held for sale (note 5)
(3.3)
1.1
Finance income (notes 6)
0.2
-
Finance income exceptional items (notes 5, 6)
0.2
0.2
Finance expense (note 6)
(21.4)
(16.7)
Finance expense exceptional items (notes 5, 6)
(2.9)
(2.6)
(Loss)/profit before tax
(111.6)
52.2
The exceptional items in the current financial year are a €144.4m charge, of which €2.9m relates to Ireland and €141.5m relates to Great 
Britain. The exceptional items in the prior financial year are a charge of €12.4m, of which €0.2m relates to Ireland and €12.2m relates to Great 
Britain. 
Of the €1.1m profit on disposal in the prior year, €0.4m relates to Great Britain and €0.7m relates to Ireland. 
Total assets for the year ended 29 February 2024 amounted to €1,367.6m (FY2023 (restated): €1,414.9m).
(b) Other operating segment information
2024
2023 (restated)
Tangible and 
intangible 
expenditure
Lease additions
Depreciation 
/amortisation /
impairment /
revaluation
Tangible and 
intangible 
expenditure
Lease additions
Depreciation /
amortisation /
impairment/ 
revaluation
€m
€m
€m
 €m
€m
€m
Ireland
6.1
3.0
8.6
6.2
2.4
7.1
Great Britain
9.6
48.5
25.1
13.4
24.9
26.3
Total
15.7
51.5
33.7
19.6
27.3
33.4
 
(c) Geographical analysis of revenue and net revenue 
Revenue
Net revenue
2024
2023 (restated)
2024
2023 (restated)
€m
€m
€m
€m
Ireland
397.6
389.6
284.8
282.3
Great Britain
1,602.7
1,650.1
1,346.6
1,379.7
International*
22.7
24.1
21.1 
24.2
Total
2,023.0
2,063.8
1,652.5
1,686.2
*	
International as a geographic region consists of multiple countries that in aggregate represent 1% of Group revenue.
The geographical analysis of revenue and net revenue is based on the location of the third-party customers.
1. SEGMENTAL REPORTING (continued)
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
206
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

(d) Geographical analysis of non-current assets
Ireland
Great Britain
International
Total
€m
€m
€m
€m
29 February 2024
Property, plant & equipment
77.3
168.3
2.1
247.7
Goodwill & intangible assets*
156.5
343.5
21.9
521.9
Equity accounted investments/financial assets
0.5
0.7
0.2
1.4
Total
234.3
512.5
24.2
771.0
* The goodwill impairment of €3.3m disclosed in notes 5 & 12 is included in the Great Britain operating segment in the table above.
Ireland
(restated)
Great Britain
(restated)
International
Total  
(restated)
€m
€m
€m
€m
28 February 2023 (restated)
Property, plant & equipment (restated)
77.9
132.1
5.0
215.0
Goodwill & intangible assets
156.3
462.6
25.2
644.1
Equity accounted investments/financial assets
0.4
0.7
0.2
1.3
Total (restated)
234.6
595.4
30.4
860.4
The geographical analysis of non-current assets, with the exception of goodwill & intangible assets, is based on the geographical location 
of the assets. The geographical analysis of goodwill & intangible assets is allocated based on the country of destination of sales.
(e) Disaggregated net revenue
In the following table, net revenue is disaggregated by principal activities and products. Principal activities and products are a basis on 
which management reviews its businesses across the Group. To aid in more useful analysis of the Group’s business performance, the 
Group introduced Branded and Distribution in the prior year to better reflect how the business is managed commercially and the distinct 
revenue sources which drive its performance as a brand-led distributor in the UK and Ireland.
Principal activities and products
2024
Net revenue
Ireland
Great Britain
Total
€m
€m
€m
Branded* 
109.9
202.8
312.7
Distribution** 
174.9
1,143.8
1,318.7
Co pack/Other
1.5
19.6
21.1
Total Group from continuing operations
286.3
1,366.2
1,652.5
* 	
Branded defined as being brands either fully owned by C&C or sold by C&C as part of a long-term distribution deal, whereby C&C are responsible for the marketing as well as 
sale of the brand in the associated geography. 
**	 Distribution defined as third-party brands sold through the Group’s distribution businesses and brands where C&C act as an exclusive agent for a brand in a specific 
geography. 
Principal activities and products
2023
Net revenue
Ireland
Great Britain 
Total
€m
€m
€m
Branded* 
107.6
193.8
301.4
Distribution** 
162.4
1,193.3
1,355.7
Co pack/Other
2.0
27.1
29.1
Total Group from continuing operations
272.0
1,414.2
 1,686.2 
*	
Branded defined as being brands either fully owned by C&C or sold by C&C as part of a long-term distribution deal, whereby C&C are responsible for the marketing as well as 
sale of the brand in the associated geography. 
**	 Distribution defined as third-party brands sold through the Group’s distribution businesses and brands where C&C act as an exclusive agent for a brand in a specific 
geography. 
1. SEGMENTAL REPORTING (continued)
207
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

2. OPERATING COSTS
In the year ended 29 February 2024, the Group restated the prior year financial information. Details of the restatement are contained in note 
31.
2024 
2023 (restated)
Before 
exceptional 
items
Exceptional 
items
(note 5)
Total
Before 
exceptional 
items 
Exceptional 
items
(note 5)
Total
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
Raw material cost of goods sold/bought in finished 
goods
1,271.4
-
1,271.4
1,291.2
-
1,291.2
Inventory write-down/(recovered) (note 14)
-
0.2
0.2
0.2
-
0.2
Employee remuneration (note 3)
161.5
5.0
166.5
144.0
1.1
145.1
Direct brand marketing
27.0
-
27.0
28.7
-
28.7
Other operating, selling and administration costs
96.5
14.2
110.7
105.0
11.3
116.3
Foreign exchange
0.2
-
0.2
(0.4)
-
(0.4)
Depreciation (notes 11, 19)
31.3
-
31.3
30.9
-
30.9
Amortisation (note 12)
2.4
-
2.4
2.5
-
2.5
Net (profit)/loss on disposal of property, plant & 
equipment
-
-
-
-
-
-
Auditor’s remuneration (a)
1.8
-
1.8
1.5
-
1.5
Impairment of intangible assets (note 12)
-
125.0
125.0
-
-
-
Net revaluation of property, plant & machinery (note 11)
0.4
-
0.4
-
-
-
Total operating expenses
1,592.5
144.4
1,736.9
1,603.6
12.4
1,616.0
(a) Auditor’s remuneration
The remuneration of the Group’s statutory auditor, being the Irish firm of the principal auditor of the Group, Ernst & Young, Chartered 
Accountants is as follows:
EY Ireland 2024
Other EY Offices 
2024
Total 2024
EY Ireland 2023
Other EY Offices 
2023
Total 2023
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
Audit of the Group financial statements
0.7
-
0.7
0.6
-
0.6
Audit of subsidiaries 
1.0
-
1.0
0.9
-
0.9
Non-audit services*
0.1
-
0.1
-
-
-
Total
1.8
-
1.8
1.5
-
1.5
 
The audit fee for the audit of the financial statements of the Company was less than €0.1m in the current and prior financial year. 
* €116,000 of non-audit fees were paid to Group’s statutory auditor, being the Irish firm of the principal auditor of the Group, Ernst & Young, 
Chartered Accountants during the current year which were in connection with limited assurance on climate related matters the liquidation of 
a non-trading subsidiary undertaking and pensions advice. (FY2023: €nil).
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
208
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

3. EMPLOYEE NUMBERS & REMUNERATION COSTS
The average number of persons employed by the Group (including Executive Directors) during the year, analysed by category, was as 
follows:
2024
2023
Number
Number
Sales & marketing
448
445
Production & distribution
1,642
1,613
Administration
853
868
Total
2,943
2,926
 
The actual number of persons employed by the Group as at 29 February 2024 was 2,937 (FY2023: 2,897).
The aggregate remuneration costs of these employees can be analysed as follows:
2024
2023
(restated)
€m
€m
Wages, salaries and other short-term employee benefits
141.3
122.8
Restructuring costs (note 5) 
5.0
1.1
Social welfare costs
13.1
12.4
Retirement benefits – defined benefit schemes (note 23)
(1.4)
(0.1)
Retirement benefits – defined contribution schemes, including related expenses 
6.9
6.3
Equity settled share-based payments (note 4)
0.9
1.9
Other non-equity settled share-based payments and PRSI accrued with respect to share-based payments
0.7
0.7
Charged to the Income Statement    
166.5
145.1
Actuarial loss/(gain) on retirement benefits recognised in Other Comprehensive Income (note 23)
9.9
(4.3)
Total employee benefits
176.4
140.8
Directors’ remuneration
2024
2023
(restated)
€m
€m
Directors’ remuneration (note 29)
4.2
3.1
Please see note 29 for a further breakdown of Directors’ remuneration during the year.
 
4. SHARE-BASED PAYMENTS
Equity settled awards
The Group has an established equity settled Executive Share Option Scheme (‘ESOS’) in place under which options to purchase shares 
in C&C Group plc are granted to certain Executive Directors and members of management. Under the terms of the scheme, the options 
are exercisable at the market price prevailing at the date of the grant of the option.
Options were granted in June 2017 under this scheme. The vesting of these awards is based on compound annual growth in underlying 
EPS over the three-year performance period, commencing in the financial year when an award is granted. If compound annual growth in 
underlying EPS over the performance period is 2% per annum, then 25% of the awards vest. If the compound annual growth in underlying 
EPS over the performance period is 6% per annum, then 100% of the awards vest. There is straight-line vesting between both points and 
no reward for below threshold performance. Options granted in 2017 achieved their performance conditions and therefore vested in full. 
The Group also has an established Long-Term Incentive Plan (‘LTIP’) under the terms of which options to purchase shares in C&C Group 
plc are granted at nominal cost to certain Executive Directors and members of management.
Threshold vesting in respect of any year will be no more than 25%, but subject to the overriding three-year financial performance 
assessment. No award will vest until the end of the full three-year performance period, and Executive Directors’ awards will then be subject 
to a further two-year holding period. 
209
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

The vesting of LTIP awards granted in June 2021 will be subject to the following performance conditions assessed across the three-year 
performance period FY2022 - FY2024. In each case, threshold vesting will be 25% of the maximum.
•	 45% of the award is subject to certain EPS targets being met, with a minimum threshold set of 22c and a maximum of 27c. This is to be 
achieved by the end of the year three target range (end of FY2024) rather than as a cumulative target. This element was not achieved.
•	 35% of the award is subject to the performance condition that the Free Cash Flow Conversion ratio (‘FCF’) of the Group (excluding the 
impact of exceptional items) would be a minimum threshold of 65% conversion and a maximum threshold of 75% by the end of the year 
three target range (end of FY2024) rather than as a cumulative target. This element was achieved.
•	 20% of the award is subject to the performance condition that certain environmental targets are met. To give impetus to the Group's de-
carbonisation efforts, a target has been set to reduce its Scope 1 emissions (being direct emissions from owned or controlled sources, 
which includes emissions from company-owned or operated facilities and vehicles) and Scope 2 emissions (being indirect emissions 
from the generation of purchased energy e.g. electricity, steam, heat and cooling) over the three financial years ending with FY2024, with 
a threshold of a 6% reduction set and a maximum of a 12% reduction. This element was achieved. 
The vesting of LTIP awards granted in June 2022 and October 2022 will be subject to the following performance conditions assessed 
across the three-year performance period FY2023 - FY2025. All such awards granted from June 2022 to October 2022 are subject to the 
following three performance conditions:
•	 45% of the award is subject to certain EPS targets being met, with a minimum threshold set of 22.2c and a maximum of 26c. This is to 
be achieved by the end of the year three target range (end of FY2025) rather than as a cumulative target. 
•	 35% of the award is subject to the performance condition that the Free Cash Flow Conversion ratio (‘FCF’) of the Group (excluding the 
impact of exceptional items) would be a minimum threshold of 65% conversion and a maximum threshold of 75% by the end of the year 
three target range (end of FY2025) rather than as a cumulative target. 
•	 20% of the award is subject to the performance condition that certain environmental targets are met. To give impetus to the Group's de-
carbonisation efforts, a target has been set to reduce its Scope 1 emissions (being direct emissions from owned or controlled sources, 
which includes emissions from company-owned or operated facilities and vehicles) and Scope 2 emissions (being indirect emissions 
from the generation of purchased energy e.g. electricity, steam, heat and cooling) over the three financial years ending with FY2025, with 
a threshold of a 6% reduction set and a maximum of a 12% reduction. 
The vesting of LTIP awards granted in June 2023 will be subject to the following performance conditions assessed across the three-year 
performance period FY2024 - FY2026. All such awards granted from June 2023 are subject to the following three performance conditions:
•	 45% of the award is subject to certain EPS targets being met, with a minimum threshold set of 15.2c and a maximum of 16c. This is to 
be achieved by the end of the year three target range (end of FY2026) rather than as a cumulative target. 
•	 35% of the award is subject to the performance condition that the Total Shareholder Return (‘TSR’) of The Group – which is defined as 
the change in Net Return Index over the full performance period ending FY2026 – is ranked against a comparator group (which consists 
of the following members: A.G. Barr Plc, Bakkavor Group Plc, Britvic Plc, Cranswick Plc, Domino’s Pizza Group Plc, Fevertree Drinks 
Plc, Fuller, Smith & Turner Plc, Greencore Group Plc, The Gym Group Plc, Hilton Food Group Plc, Hollywood Bowl Group Plc, J D 
Wetherspoon Plc, Marston’s Plc, Mitchells & Butlers Plc, Premier Foods Plc, The Restaurant Group Plc, SSP Group Plc, Tate & Lyle Plc 
and Ten Entertainment Group Plc) with a minimum threshold of median performance in the comparator group and a maximum threshold 
of upper quartile performance in the comparator group. 
•	 20% of the award is subject to the performance condition that certain environmental targets are met. To give impetus to the Group's de-
carbonisation efforts, a target has been set to reduce its Scope 1 emissions (being direct emissions from owned or controlled sources, 
which includes emissions from company-owned or operated facilities and vehicles) and Scope 2 emissions (being indirect emissions 
from the generation of purchased energy e.g. electricity, steam, heat and cooling) over the three financial years ending with FY2026, with 
a threshold of a 6% reduction set and a maximum of a 12% reduction. 
Following the appointment of David Forde as Chief Executive Officer, the Group made an award of 842,636 shares to him on 3 November 
2020 (‘Buy-Out Awards’). These shares were to compensate him for remuneration which he forfeited from his previous employment 
upon joining the Group. Reflecting the fact that the forfeited remuneration bought out was guaranteed cash-based remuneration, the 
closing share price on the day before the date of grant was used to calculate the number of shares to ensure the value was equal to the 
remuneration forfeited. The award vested in respect of 50% of the shares in November 2022 (‘Buy-Out 1’) and 50% of the shares vested in 
November 2023 (‘Buy-Out 2’). 
In June 2010, the Group established a Recruitment and Retention Plan (‘R&R’) under the terms of which options to purchase shares in 
C&C Group plc at nominal cost are granted to certain members of management, excluding Executive Directors. 
4. SHARE-BASED PAYMENTS (continued)
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
210
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

The performance conditions and/or other terms and conditions for awards granted under this plan are specifically approved by the Board 
of Directors at the time of each individual award, following a recommendation by the Remuneration Committee. Performance conditions 
vary per award but include some or all of the following conditions: continuous employment, performance targets linked to the business unit 
to which the recipient is aligned, or a requirement to have a personal shareholding in the Company at the end of the performance period.
Obligations arising under the Recruitment and Retention Plan will be satisfied by the purchase of existing shares on the open market. Upon 
settlement, any difference between the amount included in the share-based payment reserve account and the cash paid to purchase the 
shares is recognised in retained income via the Statement of Changes in Equity.
The Group also has a Deferred Bonus Plan (‘DBP’) under the terms of which options to purchase shares in C&C Group plc at nominal 
cost are granted to certain members of management. Awards under this plan are subject to a continuous employment performance 
condition only. 
In November 2011, the Group set up Partnership and Matching Share Schemes for all ROI and UK based employees of the Group 
under the approved profit-sharing schemes referred to below. Under these schemes, employees can invest in shares in C&C Group plc 
(partnership shares) that will be matched on a 1:1 basis by the Company (matching shares) subject to tax authority approved limits. Both 
the partnership and matching shares are held on behalf of the employee by the Scheme trustee, Link Group Limited. The shares are 
purchased on the open market on a monthly basis at the market price prevailing at the date of purchase with any remaining cash amounts 
carried forward and used in the next share purchase. The shares are held in trust for the participating employee, who has full voting rights 
and dividend entitlements on both partnership and matching shares. Matching shares may be forfeited and/or tax penalties may apply if 
the employee leaves the Group or removes their partnership shares within the Revenue-stipulated vesting period. The Revenue stipulated 
vesting period for matching shares awarded under the ROI scheme is three years and under the UK scheme is up to five years. 
The Group held 1,151,959 matching shares (2,303,375 partnership and matching) in trust at 29 February 2024 (FY2023: 856,062 matching 
shares (1,845,879 partnership and matching shares held)). 
In FY2020 the Group, recognising that some employees of Matthew Clark and Bibendum (‘MCB’) (which the Group acquired in FY2019) 
had previously lost money in a share scheme operated by the previous owners of MCB and prior to MCB being acquired by the Group, 
committed to allocating to those employees C&C Group plc shares in May 2021, equivalent in value to the amount they had lost in the 
share scheme of the previous owners of MCB. The employees must also be investing in the Group’s partnership and matching share 
scheme to qualify for the award. 
Award valuation
The fair values assigned to the equity settled awards granted were computed using the Black Scholes option pricing model and Monte 
Carlo model. 
 
As per IFRS 2 Share-based Payment, non-market or performance-related conditions were not taken into account in establishing the 
fair value of equity instruments granted. Instead, these non-market vesting conditions are taken into account by adjusting the number of 
equity instruments included in the measurement of the transaction amount so that ultimately the amount recognised for time and services 
received as consideration for the equity instruments granted is based on the number of equity instruments that eventually vest, unless the 
failure to vest is due to failure to meet a market condition.
The main assumptions used in the valuations for equity settled share-based payment awards granted in the current and prior financial 
years were as follows:
LTIP options 
granted
June 23
LTIP options 
granted
October 22
LTIP options 
granted
June 22
R&R options 
granted 
 June 23
R&R options 
granted
December 22
R&R options 
granted
June 22
Fair value at date of grant
€1.26
€1.87
€2.36
€1.12
€2.05 
€2.22
Exercise price
-
-
-
-
-
-
Risk free interest rate
4.74%
3.22%
1.89%
4.74%
3.19%
1.89%
Expected volatility
39.0%
41.6%
42.9%
39.0%
37.7%
41.5%
Expected term until exercise (years)
3
3
      3
3
     2
3  
Dividend yield
-
-
-
4.2%
2.0%
2.0%
4. SHARE-BASED PAYMENTS (continued)
211
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Expected volatility is calculated by reference to historic share price movements prior to the date of grant over a period of time 
commensurate with the expected term until exercise. The dividends which would be paid on a share reduces the fair value of an award 
since, in not owning the underlying shares, a recipient does not receive the dividend income on these shares. For LTIP, DBP and the Buy-
Out awards, the participants are entitled to receive dividends, and therefore the dividend yield has been set to zero to reflect this. 
Details of the share entitlements and share options granted under these schemes together with the share option expense are as follows:
Grant date
Vesting period
Number of 
options/ equity 
Interests 
granted*
 Number 
deemed 
outstanding 
at 29 February 
2024**
Grant
price
Market
value at date
of grant
Fair value at 
date of grant*
Expense
 / (income) 
in Income 
Statement
2024
Restated
Expense /
 (income) 
in Income 
Statement
2023
(restated)
€
€
€ 
€m
€m
Executive Share Option Scheme
1 June 2017
3 years
840,568
156,699
3.40
3.364
0.307
-
-
Long-Term Incentive Plan
2 December 2020
3 years
824,888
284,126
-
2.54
2.47
0.3
0.2
15 June 2021
3 years
812,921
372,690
-
2.74
2.70
(0.2)
0.1
9 June 2022
2.72 years 
1,327,763
 521,427
- 
2.38
2.36
0.1
0.8
28 October 2022
2.34 years 
11,579
6,368
-
1.87
1.87
-
-
14 June 2023
2.71 years
1,791,823
1,496,233
-
1.59
1.26
0.5
-
Buy-Out Award
3 November 2020
2-3 years
899,254
449,627
-
1.685
1.51
0.2
0.5
Recruitment & Retention Plan
1 August 2017
1.8 years
65,585
14,826
-
2.8172
2.64
-
-
11 February 2019
2-3 years
477,081
6,008
-
3.05
2.47 – 2.77
-
0.4
12 December 2019
2.5 years
476,052
-
-
4.66
4.00
-
(0.3)
22 October 2020
2 years
17,826
8,913
-
1.98
1.85
-
-
27 May 2021****
Immediate
196,963
87,108
-
2.93
2.90
-
-
15 June 2021
1 year
170,230
79,883
-
2.74
2.70
-
0.2
9 June 2022
3 years
50,000
50,000 
-
2.38
2.22
-
-
14 June 2023
2.71 years
93,670
93,670
-
1.59
1.12
-
-
Deferred Bonus Plan
22 October 2020
2 years
17,826
8,913
-
1.98
1.85
-
-
8,074,029
3,636,491
0.9
1.9
Partnership and Matching Share 
Schemes
2,303,375***
0.5
0.2
*	
The Group completed a successful Rights Issue in June 2021 at a discounted price of £1.86. The number of options/equity Interests granted and the fair value at date of grant 
were rebased following the Rights Issue.
**	 Excludes awards that are deemed to be not capable of achieving their performance conditions as at 29 February 2024.
***	 Includes both partnership and matching shares.
**** Previously named ‘MCB compensation awards’.
The amount charged to the Income Statement includes a credit of €0.3m (FY2023: credit of €0.3m), being the reversal of previously 
expensed charges on equity settled option schemes where the non-market performance conditions were deemed no longer capable of 
being achieved or the employee has left the Group.
4. SHARE-BASED PAYMENTS (continued)
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
212
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

A summary of activity under the Group’s equity settled share option schemes with the weighted average exercise price of the share options 
is as follows:
2024
2023
Number of 
options/ equity 
Interests
Weighted average 
exercise price
Number of 
options/ equity 
Interests
Weighted average 
exercise price
€
€
Outstanding at beginning of year
4,152,756
0.13
3,577,335
0.15
Granted
1,885,493
-
1,412,691
-
Exercised
(809,569)
-
(445,236)*
-
Forfeited/lapsed
(1,592,189)
-
(392,034) 
-
Outstanding at end of year
3,636,491
0.13
4,152,756
0.15
*	
The exercised number of shares excludes previously lapsed shares of 155,495 that were reinstated due to changes in vesting assumptions on share options during FY2023, 
which were also exercised in FY2023. 
The aggregate number of share options/equity Interests exercisable at 29 February 2024 was 1,096,103 (FY2023: 941,340).
The unvested share options/equity Interests (excluding those awards which are not deemed capable of vesting) outstanding at 29 February 
2024 have a weighted average vesting period outstanding of 1.5 years (FY2023: 1.4 years). The weighted average contractual life outstanding 
of vested and unvested share options/equity Interests (excluding those which are not deemed capable of vesting) is 4.8 years (FY2023: 5.2 
years). 
The weighted average market share price at date of exercise of all share options/equity Interests exercised during the year was £1.43 or 
€1.65 euro equivalent (FY2023: €2.00 Euro equivalent); the average share price for the year was £1.43 or €1.65 euro equivalent (FY2023: 
€2.10 Euro equivalent); and the market share price as at 29 February 2024 was £1.43 or €1.67 euro equivalent (28 February 2023: €1.70 euro 
equivalent).
5. EXCEPTIONAL ITEMS
2024
2023
(restated)
€m
€m
COVID-19 (a)*
-
1.5
Restructuring costs (b)*
(7.6)
(13.3)
Impairment of goodwill (c)
(125.0)
-
Rights Issue costs (d)* 
-
(0.7)
ERP implementation costs (e)*
(10.4)
-
Deposit Return Scheme costs (f)*
(1.4)
-
Other (g)*
-
0.1
Operating profit/(loss) exceptional items
(144.4)
(12.4)
Impairment of assets held for sale (h)
(3.3)
-
Profit on disposal*
-
1.1
Finance income (i)*
0.2
0.2
Finance expense (j)*
(2.9)
(2.6)
Included in profit before tax 
(150.4)
(13.7)
Income tax credit (k)
5.0
2.5
Included in profit after tax
(145.4)
(11.2)
 * These items have been tax effected in the Consolidated Income Statement
(a) COVID-19 
The Group accounted for the COVID-19 pandemic as an exceptional item and realised an exceptional credit of €1.5m from operating 
activities in the prior financial year, broken down as follows: in FY2023 the Group reviewed the recoverability of its trade debtor and advances 
to customers and realised a credit of €0.9m with respect to its provision against trade debtors and a credit of €0.4m with respect to its 
provision for advances to customers. Also, during the prior financial year, the Group released €0.2m in relation to a provision for lost kegs. 
4. SHARE-BASED PAYMENTS (continued)
213
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

(b) Restructuring costs
A strategic review of the Group’s structure and operations was initiated during the current financial year to reduce costs and drive efficiency 
improvements in future periods. Redundancy costs of €5.0m plus associated legal and other related costs of €0.4m were incurred during 
the period relating to reorganisation of the business, including €2.0m in respect the Group’s former CEO David Forde. Cash spend in the 
current financial period totalled €7.0m in respect of these costs.
As part of this review, following the significant alcohol duty reforms in the UK during the year, the Group has reassessed its bittersweet 
cider apple requirements resulting in an €0.3m apple concentrate inventory impairment and accrual of €0.8m of costs associated with the 
exit of surplus outsourced production capacity arrangements. There was no cash impact in the current financial period in respect of these 
costs.
The Group incurred origination, transition, and dual running costs of €1.1m directly associated with the exit of the Matthew Clark and 
Bibendum depot facility at Park Royal in London, and transfer of operations and relocation of assets to the new Orbital West London 
facility. These one-off costs were incurred to ensure minimal service disruption during this rationalisation of the supply chain logistics 
operating model. In addition to these costs, the Group incurred exceptional financing charges related to interest on lease liabilities of €0.8m 
relating to dual running or the Orbital West and Park Royal depots – as described in (k) below. All these one-off costs were cash settled in 
the current financial period.
In the prior financial year, costs of €1.1m were incurred in relation to severance costs which arose as a consequence of the ongoing 
optimisation of the delivery networks and operations in England and Scotland were incurred, and a further charge of €12.2m has been 
recognised as a result of an understatement of onerous contract provisions as detailed in note 31.  
(c) Impairment of goodwill 
In accordance with IAS 36 Impairment of Assets the Group is required to assess whether goodwill and brands considered to have an 
indefinite useful economic life are carried below their recoverable amount. Accordingly, impairment reviews are performed annually, or 
more frequently if there is an indication that the carrying amount may not be recoverable. A non-cash impairment charge of €125m has 
been recognised during the year in respect of the C&C Brands cash generating unit reflecting continuing challenging trading conditions in 
the crowded and competitive UK cider market. This has resulted in uncertainty in the longer-term outlook for Magners cider in the Great 
Britain operating segment, which together with other macroeconomic factors is restricting the Group’s ability to innovate and trade its way 
back to sustainable profit growth.
(d) Rights Issue costs
In the prior financial year, costs of €0.7m were incurred as a result of the Group’s Rights Issue – this cost was in respect of a clarification of 
VAT treatment by the European Court of Justice on 8 September 2022.
(e) ERP implementation costs
The Group undertook a strategic project to introduce a new and complex enterprise resource planning (‘ERP’) system in the MCB business 
in Great Britain. The implementation took longer and was significantly more challenging and disruptive than originally envisaged, with a 
consequent material impact on service and profitability within MCB. In total, a cash cost of €10.4m has been incurred during the period 
to restore service levels to normal. Due to their size, nature and incidence, these costs have been classified as exceptional items as they 
are not reflective of the underlying performance of the business and are one-off in nature. In addition to these costs, the Group incurred 
exceptional financing charges emanating from the ERP implementation of €1.7m associated with increased utilisation of the Group’s debtor 
securitisation facility to meet working capital requirements arising from the ERP system implementation disruption in the Group’s GB 
distribution business – see (k) below.
5. EXCEPTIONAL ITEMS (continued)
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
214
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

(f) Deposit Return Scheme costs 
The Group wrote off balances paid during the period of €0.5m associated with the Deposit Return Scheme (‘DRS’) in Scotland following 
the announcement by the Scottish Government in June 2023 that the scheme would be delayed until at least October 2025. The Group 
incurred and paid a further €0.9m of one-off packaging and marketing related costs following the introduction of the DRS in Ireland during 
the period.
(g) Other 
In the prior financial year €0.1m was released in relation to a provision for legal disputes. 
(h) Impairment of assets held for sale 
As described in note 16, the Group has classified its Portuguese businesses as a disposal group at the year end, and this has resulted in a 
non-cash goodwill write-off of the remaining €3.3m being recognised during the period following the re-measurement of the fair values of 
the disposal group. 
The Group has also reached an agreement to sell certain non-core assets related to its non-alcoholic beverages business for a cash 
consideration received during the period of €0.4m, realising a net gain on disposal of €nil. Further costs in respect of the continued 
reorganisation of this business line are expected to be incurred during FY2025.
During the prior year, the Group completed the sale of its held for sale asset, Admiral Taverns, realising a profit of €0.4m on disposal and 
received contingent consideration of €0.7m in relation to the sale of its Tipperary Water Cooler business. 
(i) Finance income
The Group earned finance income of €0.2m in both the current and prior financial years relating to promissory notes issued as part of the 
disposal of the Group’s subsidiary Vermont Hard Cider Company in FY2022.
(j) Finance expense
As described in (e) above, €1.7m of finance expenses were incurred in the current year as a direct consequence of the ERP system 
implementation disruption from increased use of the Group’s debtor securitisation facility. An additional €0.8m of interest on lease liabilities 
has been classified as exceptional in the current year, as described in (b) above, arising from supply-chain restructuring activity undertaken 
during the year, together with €0.4m of discount accrual related to provisions for onerous contracts recognised in accordance with IFRS 9 
in previous periods. 
The Group incurred costs of €2.6m during the prior financial year directly associated with covenant waivers due to the impact of COVID-19. 
These costs included waiver fees, increased margins payable and other professional fees associated with covenant waivers. 
(k) Income tax credit/(charge)
The tax credit in the current financial year, with respect to exceptional items, amounted to a credit of €5.0m (FY2022: €2.5m credit).
5. EXCEPTIONAL ITEMS (continued)
215
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

6. FINANCE INCOME AND EXPENSE
In the year ended 29 February 2024, the Group restated the prior year financial information. Details of the restatement are contained in note 
31.
2024
2023
(restated)
€m
€m
Recognised in Income Statement
Finance expense:
Interest expense on borrowings
(11.6)
(8.2)
Other finance expense*
(5.8)
(4.8)
Interest on lease liabilities (note 19)
(4.0)
(3.7) 
Total finance expense
(21.4)
(16.7) 
Exceptional finance expense:
Interest expense on borrowings
(2.1)
(2.6)
Interest on lease liabilities (note 19)
(0.8)
-
Total exceptional finance expense 
(2.9)
(2.6) 
Finance income:
Interest income
0.2
-
Total finance income
0.2
-
Exceptional finance income:
Interest income
0.2
0.2
Total exceptional finance income 
0.2
0.2
Net finance expense
(23.9)
(19.1)
 
2024
2023
€m
€m
Recognised directly in Other Comprehensive Income
Foreign currency translation differences arising on the net investment in foreign operations
9.2
(19.8)
Foreign currency recycled on disposal of assets held for sale
-
0.4
Net income/(expense) recognised directly in Other Comprehensive Income
9.2
(19.4) 
*Interest expense includes debtor securitisation costs of €5.0m (FY2023 €3.0m) 
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
216
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

7. INCOME TAX 
In the year ended 29 February 2024, the Group restated the prior year financial information. Details of the restatement are contained in note 
31. 
(a) Analysis of expense in year recognised in the Income Statement
2024 
2023 
(restated)
€m
€m
Current tax: 
Irish corporation tax
2.1
3.7
Foreign corporation tax
(0.2)
1.9
Adjustments in respect of previous years
0.7
0.7
 
2.6
6.3
Deferred tax: 
Irish 
0.6
0.6
Foreign
(0.7)
4.2
Adjustments in respect of previous years
(0.6)
1.5
Rate change impact
-
(0.7)
 
(0.7)
5.6
Total income tax expense recognised in Income Statement
1.9
11.9
Relating to continuing operations 
– continuing operations before exceptional items
6.9
14.4
– continuing operations exceptional items 
(5.0)
(2.5)
Total
1.9
11.9
 
The tax assessed for the year is different from that calculated at the standard rate of corporation tax in the Republic of Ireland, as explained 
below:
2024 
2023 
(restated)
€m
€m
(Loss)/profit before tax 
(111.6)
52.2
Tax at standard rate of corporation tax in the Republic of Ireland of 12.5%
(14.0)
6.5
Actual tax expense is affected by the following:
Expenses not deductible for tax purposes*
17.7
1.3
Adjustments in respect of prior years 
0.1
2.2
Income taxed at rates other than the standard rate of tax 
1.0
2.1
Other
(2.4)
(1.2)
Non-recognition/(recognition) of deferred tax assets 
(0.5)
1.0
Total income tax expense
1.9
11.9
 * Included within expenses not deductible for tax purposes in FY24 is the €125m goodwill impairment of C&C Brands.
(b) Deferred tax recognised directly in Other Comprehensive Income 
2024
2023
€m
€m
Deferred tax arising on revaluation of property, plant & machinery reflected in revaluation reserve
0.2
(0.3)
Deferred tax arising on movement of retirement benefits
(1.4)
(0.1)
Total deferred tax credit
(1.2)
(0.4)
 
217
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

7. INCOME TAX  (continued)
(c) Factors that may affect future charges
Future income tax charges may be impacted by changes to the corporation tax rates and/or changes to corporation tax legislation in force 
in the jurisdictions in which the Group operates. Under Finance Act 2021, the current UK corporation tax of 19% increased to 25% from 1 
April 2023. Changes in the geographical mix of future earnings will also impact the total tax charge.
The Organisation for Economic Co-operation and Development (OECD)/G20 Inclusive Framework on Base Erosion and Profit Shifting 
published the Pillar Two model rules designed to address the tax challenges arising from the digitalisation of the global economy. The 
legislation will be effective for the Group’s financial year beginning 1 March 2024. The Government of Ireland, the jurisdiction in which 
C&C Group plc is incorporated, transposed the Global Minimum Tax Pillar Two rules into domestic legislation as part of the Finance (No. 
2) Act 2023 (the ‘Finance Act’). The Finance Act closely follows the EU Minimum Tax Directive and OECD Guidance released to date. The 
objective of these complex rules is to achieve minimum effective tax rates of 15% globally. 
C&C Group plc, the ultimate parent company of the Group, will be required to pay to the Irish tax authorities top-up tax on the profits of its 
subsidiaries with an effective tax rate of less than 15% for each jurisdiction in which the Group operates. Alternatively, it can elect to rely on 
safe harbour criteria to exclude qualifying subsidiaries. The Group is currently assessing the impact of these new rules, but as the Group 
already has a Pillar Two effective tax rate of greater than 15% in most of the countries in which it operates, the Group does not expect 
these rules to have a material impact on the Group’s total tax charge in future periods. 
No current tax income or expense related to Pillar Two income taxes was recognised in the tax charge for the year ended 29 February 
2024. The Group is continuing to assess the impact of the Pillar Two income taxes legislation on its future financial performance.
8. DIVIDENDS 
2024
€m
Dividends paid:
Final: paid 3.79 cent per ordinary share in July 2023
14.9
Interim: paid 1.89 cent per ordinary share in December 2023
7.5
Total equity dividends
22.4
Settled as follows:
Paid in cash
22.3
Accrued with respect to LTIP dividend entitlements
0.1
 
22.4
 
In order to achieve better alignment of the interest of share-based remuneration award recipients with the interests of Shareholders, 
Shareholder approval was given at the 2012 AGM to a proposal that awards made and that vest under the LTIP incentive programme 
should reflect the equivalent value to that which accrues to Shareholders by way of dividends during the vesting period. The Deferred 
Bonus Plan and the Buy-Out Awards also accrue dividends during the vesting period. 
Subject to Shareholder approval at the Annual General Meeting, the Directors have proposed a final dividend of 3.97 cent per share 
(FY2023: 3.79 cent per share) to be paid on 23 August 2024 to ordinary Shareholders registered at the close of business on 19 July 2024. 
An interim dividend was paid with respect to the current financial year of 1.89 cent per share (FY2023: nil cent per share); therefore, the 
Group’s proposed full year dividend will amount to 5.86 cent per share (FY2023: 3.79 cent per share). Using the number of shares in issue 
at 29 February 2024 and excluding those shares for which it is assumed that the right to dividend will be waived, this would equate to a 
distribution of €15.6m. There is no scrip dividend alternative proposed. 
Final dividends on ordinary shares are recognised as a liability in the financial statements only after they have been approved at an Annual 
General Meeting of the Company. Interim dividends on ordinary shares are recognised when they are paid.
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
218
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

9. EARNINGS PER ORDINARY SHARE
In the year ended 29 February 2024, the Group restated the prior year financial information. Details of the restatement are contained in note 
31.
Denominator computations
2024
Number
2023
Number
‘000
‘000
Number of shares at beginning of year 
402,007
401,914
Shares issued in respect of options exercised
702
93
Number of shares at end of year (note 26)
402,709
402,007
Weighted average number of ordinary shares (basic)*
391,111
390,688
Adjustment for the effect of conversion of options
2,498
2,156
Weighted average number of ordinary shares, including options (diluted)
393,609
392,844
*	
Excludes 11.2m treasury shares (FY2023: 11.0m).
Profit attributable to ordinary Shareholders
2024 
2023 
(restated)
€m
€m
Group (loss)/profit for the financial year
(113.5)
40.3
Adjustment for exceptional items, net of tax (note 5)
145.4
11.2
Earnings as adjusted for exceptional items, net of tax
31.9
51.5
Cent
Cent
Basic earnings per share 
Basic earnings per share 
(29.0)
10.3
Adjusted basic earnings per share 
8.1
13.2
Diluted earnings per share 
Diluted earnings per share 
(29.0)
10.3
Adjusted diluted earnings per share 
8.1
13.1
Basic earnings per share is calculated by dividing the Group profit for the financial year by the weighted average number of ordinary shares 
in issue during the year, excluding ordinary shares purchased/issued by the Group and accounted for as treasury shares (FY2024: 11.2m 
shares, FY2023: 11.0m shares). 
Diluted earnings per share is calculated by adjusting the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding to assume conversion 
of all potential dilutive ordinary shares. The average market value of the Company’s shares for purposes of calculating the dilutive effect of 
share options was based on quoted market prices for the period of the year that the options were outstanding.
 
Employee share awards (excluding awards which were granted under plans where the rules stipulate that obligations must be satisfied 
by the purchase of existing shares (note 4)), which are performance-based are treated as contingently issuable shares because their 
issue is contingent upon satisfaction of specified performance conditions in addition to the passage of time. In accordance with IAS 33 
Earnings per Share, these contingently issuable shares are excluded from the computation of diluted earnings per share where the vesting 
conditions would not have been satisfied as at the end of the reporting period (FY2024: 1,704,067; FY2023: 445,410). If dilutive other 
contingently issuable ordinary shares are included in diluted EPS based on the number of shares that would be issuable if the end of the 
reporting period was the end of the contingency period.
219
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

10. BUSINESS COMBINATIONS/DIVESTMENTS AND NON-CONTROLLING INTERESTS
The Group had no new business combinations or divestments during the current financial year. 
The Group continues to hold the promissory notes of USD 4.8m, which formed the non-cash consideration from the sale of Vermont Hard 
Cider Company (VHCC) as a financial asset. This has been retranslated to €4.4m in the current financial year (FY2023: €4.5m).
11. PROPERTY, PLANT & EQUIPMENT 
In the year ended 29 February 2024, the Group restated the prior year financial information. Details of the restatement are contained in note 
31.
Freehold land & 
buildings 
Plant
 & machinery
Motor vehicles & 
other equipment
Total
€m 
€m
 €m
€m
Group
Cost or valuation
At 28 February 2022 (previously stated)
94.9
214.1
59.5
368.5
Prior period restatements
-
-
0.4
0.4
At 28 February 2022 (restated)
94.9
214.1
59.9
368.9
Translation adjustment
(2.5)
(3.4)
(1.3)
(7.2)
Additions (restated)
0.4
10.9
4.7
16.0
Revaluation of property, plant & machinery
(0.6)
(0.1)
-
(0.7)
Reclassification
0.8
(0.8)
-
-
At 28 February 2023 (restated)
93.0
220.7
63.3
377.0
Translation adjustment
1.4
1.8
0.6
3.8
Additions
3.4
4.6
5.8
13.8
Assets held for sale (note 16)
(3.2)
(6.8)
-
(10.0)
Disposals
-
(2.0)
(0.2)
(2.2)
Impairment
-
-
(0.4)
(0.4)
Revaluation of property, plant & machinery
1.0
(0.4)
-
0.6
At 29 February 2024
95.6
217.9
69.1
382.6
Depreciation
At 28 February 2022 (previously stated)
20.2
150.9
51.4
222.5
Prior period restatements
-
-
0.1
0.1
At 28 February 2022 (restated)
20.2
150.9
51.5
222.6
Translation adjustment 
(0.6)
(1.8)
(1.1)
(3.5)
Charge for the year (restated)
2.3
5.3
2.7
10.3
At 28 February 2023 (restated)
21.9
154.4
53.1
229.4
Translation adjustment 
0.4
0.9
0.5
1.8
Assets held for sale (note 16)
(0.8)
(4.0)
-
(4.8)
Disposals
-
(1.9)
-
(1.9)
Charge for the year
1.5
6.1
2.8
10.4
At 29 February 2024
23.0
155.5
56.4
234.9
Net book value
At 29 February 2024
72.6
62.4
12.7
147.7
At 28 February 2023 (restated)
71.1
66.3
10.2
147.6
 
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
220
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Freehold land & buildings
Plant & machinery
Motor vehicles 
& other 
equipment
Total
€m
€m
 €m
€m
29 February 2024
Leased right-of-use assets
At 29 February 2024, net carrying amount (note 19)
54.9
5.3
39.8
100.0
Total property, plant & equipment 
127.5
67.7
52.5
247.7
28 February 2023
Leased right-of-use assets
At 28 February 2023, net carrying amount (restated) (note 19) 
31.5
2.5
33.4
67.4
Total property, plant & equipment (restated)
102.6
68.8
43.6 
215.0
Cash outflow with respect to property, plant & equipment was €18.1m (FY2023 (restated): €10.1m) primarily due to a decrease in closing 
capital accruals as at 29 February 2024. No depreciation is charged on freehold land which had a book value of €16.3m at 29 February 
2024 (FY2023: €16.1m). 
Valuation of freehold land & buildings and plant & machinery - 29 February 2024
In the current financial year, the Group engaged the Real Estate & Capital Equipment Valuation team of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP to 
value the Group’s freehold land & buildings and plant & machinery at the Group’s manufacturing facilities in Clonmel (Tipperary), Wellpark 
(Glasgow) and the Group’s facility in Castel Branco in Portugal. The valuers are members of the Royal Institution of Chartered Surveyors 
with experience of undertaking property, plant and equipment valuations on a global basis. 
For specialised assets, comprising the production facilities at Clonmel, Wellpark Brewery and Portugal the Depreciated Replacement Cost 
approach has been applied to value land & buildings. The Depreciated Replacement Cost approach was also used to derive fair value for 
the plant & machinery at the Group’s manufacturing facilities given their specialised nature. 
The result of these external valuations, as at 29 February 2024, was an increase in the value of freehold land & buildings of €1.0m of which 
€0.5m was credited to the Income Statement and €0.5m was credited to Other Comprehensive Income. Additionally, there was a decrease 
in the value of plant & machinery of €0.4m of which €0.1m was charged to the Income Statement and €0.3m was charged to Other 
Comprehensive Income.
For all other items of land & buildings and plant & machinery the Group completed an internal assessment of the appropriateness of their 
carrying value. Assisted by a market overview provided by the valuation team from PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, with respect to the 
geographic locations of the Group’s assets, the Group concluded that the carrying value was appropriate at 29 February 2024 and no 
adjustment was recorded in this regard.
Valuation of freehold land & buildings and plant & machinery - 28 February 2023
In the prior financial year, the Group engaged the Real Estate & Capital Equipment Valuation team of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP to 
value the Group’s freehold land & buildings and plant & machinery at the Group’s manufacturing facilities in Clonmel (Tipperary), Wellpark 
(Glasgow) and the Group’s facility in Castel Branco in Portugal. The valuers are members of the Royal Institution of Chartered Surveyors 
with experience of undertaking property, plant and equipment valuations on a global basis. 
For specialised assets, comprising the production facilities at Clonmel, Wellpark Brewery and Portugal the Depreciated Replacement Cost 
approach has been applied to value land & buildings. The Depreciated Replacement Cost approach was also used to derive fair value for 
the plant & machinery at the Group’s manufacturing facilities given their specialised nature. 
The result of these external valuations, as at 28 February 2023, was a decrease in the value of freehold land & buildings of €0.6m of which 
€0.4m was credited to the Income Statement and €1.0m was charged to Other Comprehensive Income. Additionally, there was a decrease 
in the value of plant & machinery of €0.1m of which €0.4m was charged to the Income Statement and €0.3m was credited to Other 
Comprehensive Income.
11. PROPERTY, PLANT & EQUIPMENT  (continued)
221
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

For all other items of land & buildings and plant & machinery the Group completed an internal assessment of the appropriateness of their 
carrying value. Assisted by a market overview provided by the valuation team from PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, with respect to the 
geographic locations of the Group’s assets, the Group concluded that the carrying value was appropriate at 28 February 2023 and no 
adjustment was recorded in this regard.
Useful Lives
The following useful lives were attributed to the assets:
Asset category
Useful life
Tanks
30 – 35 years
Process equipment 
20 – 50 years
Bottling & packaging equipment
15 – 35 years
Process automation
10 years
Buildings 
50 years
 
Freehold land & 
buildings Plant & machinery
Motor vehicles & 
other equipment 
Total
€m
 €m
 €m
€m
Net book value (pre right-of-use assets)
Carrying value at 29 February 2024 post revaluation
72.6
62.4
12.7
147.7
Carrying value at 29 February 2024 pre revaluation
71.6
62.8
12.7
147.1
Gain/(loss) on revaluation
1.0
(0.4)
-
0.6
29 February 2024 classified within:
Income statement
0.4
Other Comprehensive Income
0.2
Freehold land & 
buildings 
 
Plant & 
machinery 
Motor vehicles & 
other equipment 
(restated) 
Total 
(restated)
€m
 €m
 €m
€m
Net book value (pre right-of-use assets)
Carrying value at 28 February 2023 post revaluation (restated)
71.1
66.3
10.2
147.6
Carrying value at 28 February 2023 pre revaluation (restated)
71.7
66.4
10.2
148.3
Loss on revaluation
(0.6)
(0.1)
-
(0.7)
28 February 2023 classified within:
Income statement
0.0
Other Comprehensive Income 
(0.7)
 
11. PROPERTY, PLANT & EQUIPMENT  (continued)
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
222
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Fair value hierarchy
The valuations of freehold land & buildings and plant & machinery, excluding right-of-use assets, are derived using data from sources which 
are not widely available to the public and involve a degree of judgement. For these reasons, the valuations of the Group’s freehold land & 
buildings and plant & machinery are classified as ‘Level 3’ as defined by IFRS 13 Fair Value Measurement, and as illustrated below:
Carrying amount
Quoted prices 
Level 1
Significant 
observable 
Level 2
Significant 
unobservable 
Level 3
€m
€m
€m
€m
Recurring measurements
Freehold land & buildings measured at market value
13.5
-
-
13.5
Freehold land & buildings measured at Depreciated Replacement Cost
59.1
-
-
59.1
Plant & machinery measured at Depreciated Replacement Cost
62.4
-
-
62.4
At 29 February 2024
135.0
-
-
135.0
 
Carrying amount
Quoted prices 
Level 1
Significant 
observable 
Level 2
Significant 
unobservable 
Level 3
€m
€m
€m
€m
Recurring measurements
Freehold land & buildings measured at market value
13.5
-
-
13.5 
Freehold land & buildings measured at Depreciated Replacement Cost
57.6
-
-
57.6 
Plant & machinery measured at Depreciated Replacement Cost
66.3
-
-
66.3 
At 28 February 2023
137.4
-
-
137.4 
 
Measurement techniques
The Group used the following techniques to determine the fair value measurements categorised in Level 3:
•	 The Group’s depots are valued using a market value approach. The market value is the price that would be received to sell an asset or 
paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date.
•	 The Group’s specialised assets such as the production facilities at Clonmel, Wellpark and Portugal are valued using the Depreciated 
Replacement Cost approach. Depreciated Replacement Cost is assessed, firstly, by the identification of the gross replacement cost 
for each class of asset at each of the Group’s plants. A depreciation factor derived from both the physical and functional obsolescence 
of each class of asset, taking into account estimated residual values at the end of the life of each class of asset, is then applied to the 
gross replacement cost to determine the net replacement cost. An economic obsolescence factor, which is derived based on current 
and anticipated capacity or utilisation of each plant and machinery asset, at each of the Group’s plants, as a function of total available 
production capacity, is applied to determine the Depreciated Replacement Cost.
11. PROPERTY, PLANT & EQUIPMENT  (continued)
223
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Unobservable inputs
The significant unobservable inputs used in the market value measurement of land & buildings is as follows:
Valuation technique
Significant unobservable inputs
Range of unobservable inputs – 
Land (‘000)
Range of unobservable inputs – Buildings
Relationship of unobservable 
inputs to fair value
Comparable market 
transactions
Price per square foot/
acre
The higher the price per 
square foot/acre, the 
higher the fair value
Republic of Ireland
€50 – €150 (FY2023: 
€50 – €150) per hectare
€45 – €1,273 (FY2023: 
€54 – €1,249) per square 
metre
Portugal
€40 (FY2023: €40) per 
hectare
€105 – €600 (FY2023: €100 - 
€611) per square metre
United Kingdom
£150 – £250 (FY2023: 
£150- £250) per acre
£246 – £1,651 (FY2023: £254 
to £1,645) per square metre
 
The significant unobservable inputs used in the Depreciated Replacement Cost measurement of freehold land & buildings and plant & 
machinery are as follows:
Gross replacement cost adjustment
Increase in gross replacement cost ranging from 0% to 7% (FY2023: 12% to 20%)
Economic obsolescence adjustment factor
Economic obsolescence, considered on an asset-by-asset basis, for each 
plant, ranging from 0% to 20% (FY2023: 0% to 100%). The weighted average 
obsolescence factor by site is as follows: Cidery, Ireland – 20% (FY2023: 21%); 
Brewery Scotland – 3% (FY2023: 8%) and Cidery, Portugal – 0% (FY2023: 0%)
Physical and functional obsolescence adjustment 
factor
Adjustment for changes to physical and functional obsolescence ranging from 
65% to 87% (FY2023: 63% to 83%)
 
The carrying value of depot freehold land & buildings would increase/(decrease) by €0.6m (FY2023: €0.7m) if the comparable open market 
value increased/(decreased) by 5%.
The carrying value of freehold land & buildings which is valued on the Depreciated Replacement Cost basis, would increase by €2.3m 
(FY2023: €2.4m) if the economic obsolescence adjustment factor was decreased by 5%. If the economic obsolescence adjustment 
increased by 5% the value would decrease by €2.3m (FY2023: €2.9m). The estimated carrying value of the same land & buildings would 
increase/(decrease) by €1.1m (FY2023: €1.1m) if the gross replacement cost was increased/(decreased) by 2%.
The carrying value of plant & machinery in the Group, which is valued on the Depreciated Replacement Cost basis, would increase by 
€3.1m (FY2023: €3.2m) if the economic obsolescence adjustment factor was decreased by 5%. If the economic obsolescence adjustment 
increased by 5% the value would decrease by €3.1m (FY2023: €4.0m). If the gross replacement cost was increased by 2% the carrying 
value of the Group’s plant & machinery would increase by €0.8m (FY2023: €0.8m). If the gross replacement cost decreased by 2% the 
carrying value of the Group’s plant & machinery would decrease by €1.3m (FY2023: €1.2m).
Company
The Company has no property, plant & equipment.
11. PROPERTY, PLANT & EQUIPMENT (continued)
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
224
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

12. GOODWILL & INTANGIBLE ASSETS
Goodwill
Brands
Other intangible 
assets
Total
€m
€m
€m
€m
Cost
At 28 February 2022
606.3
326.4
43.2
975.9
Additions (restated)
-
-
3.7
3.7
Translation adjustment
(7.7)
(5.3)
(0.6)
(13.6)
At 28 February 2023 (restated)
598.6
321.1
46.3
966.0
Additions
-
-
1.9
1.9
Impairment of assets held for sale (note 5)
(3.3)
-
-
(3.3)
Translation adjustment
3.7
2.5
0.4
6.6
At 29 February 2024
599.0
323.6
48.6
971.2
Amortisation and impairment
At 28 February 2022
76.2
214.6
28.6
319.4
Amortisation charge for the year
-
-
2.5
2.5
At 28 February 2023
76.2
214.6
31.1
321.9
Impairment charge for the year
125.0
-
-
125.0
Amortisation charge for the year
-
-
2.4
2.4
At 29 February 2024
201.2
214.6
33.5
449.3
Net book value 
At 29 February 2024
397.8
109.0
15.1
521.9
At 28 February 2023 (restated)
522.4
106.5
15.2
644.1
 
Goodwill
Goodwill has been attributed to cash generating units (as identified under IAS 36 Impairment of Assets) as follows:
Ireland
Scotland
C&C Brands
North America
Export
MCB
Total
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
 €m
At 28 February 2022
154.5
60.6
181.3
9.2
16.0
108.5
530.1
Translation adjustment
-
(1.7)
(0.8)
-
-
(5.2)
(7.7)
At 28 February 2023
154.5
58.9
180.5
9.2
16.0
103.3
522.4
Impairment charge for the year
-
-
(125.0)
-
-
-
(125.0)
Impairment of assets held for sale (note 5)
-
-
-
-
(3.3)
-
(3.3)
Translation adjustment
-
0.9
0.3
(0.1)
0.1
2.5
3.7
At 29 February 2024
154.5
59.8
55.8
9.1
12.8
105.8
397.8
Goodwill consists both of goodwill capitalised under Irish GAAP, which at the transition date to IFRS was treated as deemed cost and 
goodwill that arose on the acquisition of businesses and represents the synergies arising from cost savings and the opportunity to utilise 
the extended distribution network of the Group to leverage the marketing of acquired products.
 
225
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

In line with IAS 36 Impairment of Assets goodwill is allocated to each cash generating unit which is expected to benefit from the 
combination synergies. These cash generating units represent the lowest level within the Group at which goodwill is monitored for internal 
management purposes. 
All goodwill is regarded as having an indefinite life and is not subject to amortisation under IFRS but is subject to annual impairment testing.
Brands
Brands are expected to generate positive cash flows for as long as the Group owns the brands and have been assigned indefinite lives. 
Capitalised brands include the Tennent’s beer brands and the Gaymers cider brands acquired during FY2010, Waverley wine brands 
acquired during FY2013 and the Matthew Clark and Bibendum brands acquired during FY2019.
The Tennent’s, Gaymers and Matthew Clark and Bibendum brands were valued at fair value on the date of acquisition in accordance with 
the requirements of IFRS 3 Business Combinations by independent professional valuers. The Waverley wine brands were valued at cost. 
The carrying value of the Tennent’s beer brand as at 29 February 2024 amounted to €74.7m (FY2023: €73.0m) and has an indefinite life 
which is subject to annual impairment testing. The movement in the current financial year is due to translation adjustment. 
The carrying value of brands with indefinite lives are allocated to operating segments as follows:
Ireland 
Great Britain
Total
€m
€m
€m
At 28 February 2022
-
111.8
111.8
Translation adjustment
-
(5.3)
(5.3)
At 28 February 2023
-
106.5
106.5
Translation adjustment
-
2.5
2.5
At 29 February 2024
-
109.0
109.0
 
The brands are protected by trademarks, which are renewable indefinitely in all major markets where they are sold, and it is the Group’s 
policy to support them with the appropriate level of brand advertising. In addition, there are not believed to be any legal, regulatory or 
contractual provisions that limit the useful lives of these brands. Accordingly, the Directors believe that it is appropriate that the brands be 
treated as having indefinite lives for accounting purposes.
No intangible assets were acquired by way of government grant. There are no title restrictions on any of the capitalised intangible assets 
and no intangible assets are pledged as security. There are no contractual commitments in relation to the acquisition of intangible assets at 
year end.
12. GOODWILL & INTANGIBLE ASSETS (continued)
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
226
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Other intangible assets
Other intangible assets have been attributed to operating segments (as identified under IFRS 8 Operating Segments) as follows:
Ireland
Great Britain
Total
€m
€m
€m
Cost
At 28 February 2022
7.1
36.1
43.2
Additions (restated)
0.2
3.5
3.7
Translation adjustment
-
(0.6)
(0.6)
At 28 February 2023 (restated)
7.3
39.0
46.3
Additions
-
1.9
1.9
Translation adjustment
-
0.4
0.4
At 29 February 2024
7.3
41.3
48.6
Amortisation and impairment
At 28 February 2022
4.0
24.6
28.6
Amortisation charge for the year
0.7
1.8
2.5
At 28 February 2023
4.7
26.4
31.1
Amortisation charge for the year
0.6
1.8
2.4
At 29 February 2024
5.3
28.2
33.5
Net book value 
At 29 February 2024
2.0
13.1
15.1
At 28 February 2023 (restated)
2.6
12.6
15.2
 
Other intangible assets comprise the fair value of trade relationships acquired as part of the acquisition of Matthew Clark and Bibendum 
in FY2019, trade relationships acquired as part of the acquisition of TCB Wholesale during FY2015, the Gleeson trade relationships 
acquired during FY2014 and 20-year distribution rights for third-party beer products acquired as part of the acquisition of the Tennent’s 
business during FY2010. These were valued at fair value on the date of acquisition in accordance with the requirements of IFRS 3 Business 
Combinations by independent professional valuers. The intangible assets have a finite life and are subject to amortisation on a straight-line 
basis. Also included within other intangible assets are software and licences.
The amortisation charge for the year ended 29 February 2024 with respect to intangible assets was €2.4m (FY2023: €2.5m). 
Impairment testing
To ensure that goodwill and brands that are considered to have an indefinite useful economic life are not carried at above their recoverable 
amount, impairment testing is performed to compare the carrying value of the total assets (including indefinite life assets) of the cash 
generating unit with their recoverable amount through value-in-use computations. Impairment testing is performed annually or more 
frequently if there is an indication that the carrying amount may not be recoverable. Where the value-in-use exceeds the carrying value of 
the asset, the asset is not impaired. 
As permitted by IAS 36 Impairment of Assets, the value of the Group’s goodwill has been allocated to groups of cash generating units, 
which are not larger than an operating segment determined in accordance with IFRS 8 Operating Segments. These business segments 
represent the lowest levels within the Group at which the associated goodwill is monitored for management purposes. 
 
The recoverable amount is calculated using value-in-use computations based on estimated future cash flows discounted to present value 
using a discount rate appropriate to each cash generating unit and brand. Terminal values are calculated on the assumption that cash 
flows continue in perpetuity. 
The key assumptions used are:
•	 Expected volume, net revenue and operating profit growth rates – cash flows for each cash generating unit and brand are based on 
detailed, Board-approved, financial projections for year one which are then projected out for years two, three, four and five. 
•	 Long-term growth rate – cash flows after the first five years are extrapolated using a long-term growth rate, on the assumption that cash 
flows for the first five years will increase at a nominal growth rate in perpetuity.
•	 Discount rate.
12. GOODWILL & INTANGIBLE ASSETS (continued)
227
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

12. GOODWILL & INTANGIBLE ASSETS (continued)
The key assumptions are based on management’s assessment of anticipated market conditions for each cash generating unit. Persistent 
cost inflation pressures have been mitigated by implementing a series of price increases and cost hedge positions, providing a degree of 
protection from the inflationary environment as the Group enters FY2025. Historical experience was considered, along with an analysis 
of core strengths and weaknesses in the markets of operation. External factors considered include macroeconomic conditions, inflation 
expectations by geography, regulation and anticipated regulatory changes (such as expected adjustments to duty rates and minimum 
pricing), market growth rates, sales price trends, competitor activity, market share objectives, and strategic plans and initiatives.
The impact of climate change has been incorporated into the Group’s Goodwill impairment assessment and financial forecasts for each 
cash generating unit. This includes considering the recoverability of Goodwill taking into account the Group’s sustainability initiatives, 
examples of which include the Out of Plastics project, the installation of Ireland's largest rooftop solar panel system in Clonmel, and heat 
recovery systems at the Group’s manufacturing sites. The Group recognises that sustainability is an integral part of the Group’s brands' 
growth journeys and consumers are increasingly concerned about the environmental impact of the brands they support. 
A terminal growth rate of 2.00% (FY2023: 2.00%) in perpetuity was assumed based on an assessment of the likely long-term growth 
prospects for the sectors and geographies in which the Group operates. The resulting cash flows were discounted to present value using a 
range of discount rates between 7.20%-8.20% (FY2023: 7.17%-8.74%); these rates are in line with the Group’s estimated pre-tax weighted 
average cost of capital for the two main geographies in which the Group operates (Ireland and Great Britain), arrived at using the Capital 
Asset Pricing Model as adjusted for asset and country specific factors.
The Group has performed the detailed impairment testing calculations by cash generating units with the following discount rates being 
applied:
Market
Discount rate
2024
Discount rate
2023
Terminal growth
rate 2024
Terminal growth
rate 2023
Ireland 
7.20%
8.74%
2.00%
2.00%
Scotland
8.20%
8.15%
2.00%
2.00%
C&C Brands
8.20%
8.15%
2.00%
2.00%
North America
7.60%
7.17%
2.00%
1.75%
Export
8.20%
8.15%
2.00%
2.00%
Matthew Clark Bibendum (MCB)
8.20%
8.15%
2.00%
2.00%
 
The impairment testing carried out at year end for Ireland, Scotland, North America, Export and MCB identified headroom in the 
recoverable amount of the goodwill and intangible assets. The impairment testing for C&C Brands identified a value-in-use which was 
€125.0m below the carrying value of the goodwill and intangible assets. Accordingly, an equivalent impairment loss has been recognised 
within exceptional items in the Consolidated Income Statement in the period (FY2023: €nil impairment charge). The impairment loss has 
arisen primarily due to a year-on-year reduction in the Magners cider volume and uncertainty over medium-term growth rates for the 
Group’s brands specifically within the UK cider market for the Magners brand. Whilst the Group expects long-term growth from its branded 
products, the accounting standard (IAS 36) for impairment assessments does not allow forecasts to be used where assumptions cannot 
be evidenced or have not yet been fully implemented (e.g. on-going cost savings initiatives). As a result, whilst the Group is focused on 
committing to delivering its growth strategy, the on-going cost reduction and efficiency programmes restrict the available evidence to 
demonstrate this growth at the balance sheet date. 
Significant goodwill amounts
The goodwill allocated to Ireland, Scotland and MCB cash generating units amount to 39% (FY2023: 30%), 15% (FY2023: 35%) and 27% 
(FY2023: 20%) of the total carrying amount of goodwill respectively.
Ireland
Scotland
MCB
2024
2023
2024
2023
2024
2023
Goodwill allocated to the cash generating unit 
at balance sheet date
154.5
154.5
59.8
58.9
105.8
103.3
Discount rate applied to the cash flow 
projections (real pre-tax)
7.20%
8.74%
8.20%
8.15%
8.20%
8.15%
 
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
228
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Sensitivity analysis 
In the current financial year, the impairment testing carried out as at 29 February 2024 identified headroom in the recoverable amount of 
the brands and goodwill compared to their carrying value, apart from those allocated to C&C Brands where an impairment was recognised 
as noted above.
The key sensitivities for the impairment testing are net revenue and operating profit assumptions, discount rates applied to the resulting 
cash flows and the expected long-term growth rates. As at 29 February 2024, an increase of 1% in the discount rate would increase the 
impairment by €15m to €141m. A decrease of 1% in volume growth would increase the impairment by €7.0m.
The value-in-use calculations indicate significant headroom in respect of all cash generating units, other than C&C Brands as noted above. 
Excluding C&C Brands, the cash generating unit with the least headroom is the North American cash generating unit (€10.0m) and has 
€9.1m of allocated goodwill.
The table below identifies the impact of a movement in the key inputs with respect to North America. 
2024
2023
Movement
Increase/(decrease) 
on headroom
Movement
Increase/(decrease) 
on headroom
%
€m
%
€m
Increase in operating profit
2.5 
0.1
2.5
-
Decrease in operating profit
(2.5)
(0.1)
0.25
-
Increase in discount rate
0.25
(0.9)
0.25
(1.5)
Decrease in discount rate
(0.25)
1.0
(0.25)
1.6
Increase in terminal growth rate
0.25
0.8
0.25
1.3
Decrease in terminal growth rate
(0.25)
(0.7)
(0.25)
(1.2)
 
The Group concludes that no reasonable movement in any of the underlying assumptions would result in a material impairment in any of 
the Group’s cash generating units or brands.
13. EQUITY ACCOUNTED INVESTMENTS/FINANCIAL ASSETS
(a) Equity accounted investments/financial assets – Group
Joint Ventures
Associates
Drygate Brewing 
Company Limited
Whitewater 
Brewing Company 
Limited
Other
Total
€m
€m
€m
€m
Investment in equity accounted investments/financial assets
Carrying amount at 28 February 2022
-
0.4
0.9 
1.3
Purchase price paid
-
-
-
-
Translation adjustment
-
-
-
-
Carrying amount at 28 February 2023
-
0.4
0.9 
1.3
Purchase price paid
-
-
0.1
0.1
Share of profit after tax
-
-
-
- 
Translation adjustment
-
-
-
- 
Carrying amount at 29 February 2024
-
0.4
1.0
1.4
12. GOODWILL & INTANGIBLE ASSETS (continued)
229
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Summarised financial information for the Group’s investment in joint ventures and associates which are accounted for using the equity 
method is as follows:
Joint ventures 
2024
Associates
2024
Joint ventures 
2023
Associates
2023
€m
€m
€m
€m
Non-current assets
2.0
2.8
2.0
2.8
Current assets
1.1
1.6
1.1
1.4
Non-current liabilities
(1.4)
(1.6)
(1.3)
(1.8)
Current liabilities
(2.2)
(0.5)
(2.1)
(0.5)
Net assets/(liabilities)
(0.5)
2.3
(0.3)
1.9
Revenue
2.4
1.5
2.6
2.1
(Loss)/profit before tax
(0.2)
0.3
(0.5)
0.3
Other Comprehensive Income
-
-
-
-
 
A listing of the Group’s equity accounted investments is contained in note 30.
Drygate Brewing Company Limited
In 2015, the Group entered into a joint venture arrangement with Heather Ale Limited – run by the Williams brothers, who are recognised 
as leading family craft brewers in Scotland – to form a new entity Drygate Brewing Company Limited. The joint venture, which is run 
independently of the joint venture partners’ existing businesses, operates a craft brewing and retail facility adjacent to Wellpark brewery. 
Whitewater Brewing Company Limited
On 20 December 2016, the Group acquired 25% of the equity share capital of Whitewater Brewing Company Limited, an Irish craft brewer 
for £0.3m (€0.3m). 
Other
During the prior year, the Group disposed of its 50% investment in 3 Counties Spirits Limited, for €nil consideration, which had been 
acquired for €nil consideration during FY2021.
During FY2022, the Group made an additional investment into Jubel Ltd of €0.3m (£0.2m), the additional subscription of shares in Jubel 
maintained the Group's existing percentage shareholding of 8.4%.
During FY2021, the Group made an investment in an English entity Bramerton Condiments Limited for €0.1m (£0.1m) and also acquired 
an 8% shareholding in Innis & Gunn Holdings Limited at €nil cost for which share subscription costs of €0.1m (£0.1m) were incurred in this 
regard. 
The Group has a 33.33% investment in Braxatorium Parcensis CVBA (Belgium) of €0.2m. The Group also has equity investments in 
Shanter Inns Limited (Scotland), Beck & Scott (Services) Limited (Northern Ireland) and The Irish Brewing Company Limited (Ireland). The 
value of each of these investments is less than €0.1m in the current and prior financial year.
(b) Financial Assets – Company 
2024
2023
(restated)
€m
€m
Equity investment in subsidiary undertakings at cost
At beginning of year
1,159.2
1,158.6
Impairment
(175.0)
-
Capital contribution in respect of share options granted to employees of subsidiary undertakings 
1.4
2.1
Capital contribution into subsidiary undertakings 
0.5
0.4
Reclassification of capital contribution in respect of share options granted to employees of subsidiary 
undertakings to Trade & other receivables
(1.0)
(1.9)
At end of year
985.1
1,159.2
 
13. EQUITY ACCOUNTED INVESTMENTS/FINANCIAL ASSETS (continued)
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
230
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

The total expense of €1.0m (FY2023: €1.9m) attributable to equity settled awards granted to employees of subsidiary undertakings 
has been included as a capital contribution in financial assets. In the current and prior years this has been reclassified to Trade & other 
receivables. 
Impairment Testing
The Company reviews the carrying amount of its investment when events and circumstances indicate that an asset may be impaired. 
Impairment tests are performed by comparing the carrying amount and the recoverable amount of the assets. The recoverable amount is 
the higher of the assets’ fair value less costs of disposal and its value-in-use. 
In assessing the value-in-use, the estimated future cash flows relating to the forecast usage period of the asset, or group of assets 
generated by subsidiary undertakings, are discounted to their present value using a pre-tax discount rate that reflects current market 
assessments of the time value of money and the risks. In performing this analysis, the Company’s value-in-use calculation did not support 
the recoverability of the full cost of the Company’s investment in subsidiary undertakings and therefore an impairment was recognised in 
the current period. An increase in the discount rate of 0.5% would increase the amount of the impairment by €108m.
Whilst the Group forecast and business plan as at 29 February 2024 give a comparable cash flow when compared to twelve months ago, 
debt owed by the subsidiaries to the Company has increased, resulting in a reduced value-in-use and giving rise to the impairment. 
Key assumptions used in value-in-use calculations: 
Where there are indicators of impairment, the calculation of value-in-use for the assets is most sensitive to the following assumptions:
•	 Cash flows are projected based on actual operating results and the current five-year plan.
•	 Discount rates are calculated using a weighted average cost of capital approach. They reflect the individual nature and specific risks 
relating to the business and the market in which the Group operates. The pre-tax discount rate used was 8.8% (2023: 8.9%). 
•	 A long-term growth rate of 2% (2023: 2%)
 
During the period the Directors considered there were indicators of impairment in the carrying value of the subsidiary undertakings and 
following a review an impairment of €175.0m was recognised in the period. In the opinion of the Directors the shares in the subsidiary 
undertakings are worth at least the amounts at which they are stated in the Company Balance Sheet. Details of subsidiary undertakings 
are set out in note 30.
Sensitivity Analysis
As at 29 February 2024, an increase in the discount rate of 0.5% would increase the amount of the impairment by €108m.
14. INVENTORIES
2024 
2023 
(restated)
€m
€m
Group
Raw materials & consumables 
33.8
32.4
Finished goods & goods for resale
136.9
130.3
Total inventories at lower of cost and net realisable value
170.7
162.7
 
In the year ended 29 February 2024, the Group restated the prior year financial information. Details of the restatement are contained in note 
31.
Inventory write-downs recognised within operating costs before exceptional items amounted to €nil in the current year and €0.2m in 
FY2023 and were with respect to breakages and write-offs of damaged and obsolete inventory. 
Inventory impairment allowance levels are reviewed by management and revised where appropriate, taking account of the latest available 
information on the recoverability of carrying amounts.
13. EQUITY ACCOUNTED INVESTMENTS/FINANCIAL ASSETS (continued)
231
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

15. TRADE & OTHER RECEIVABLES
                 Group
                 Company
2024 
2023  
(restated)
2024 
2023 
(restated)
€m
€m
€m
€m
Current receivables: 
Trade receivables
120.3
125.3
-
-
Amounts due from Group undertakings
-
-
611.2
284.5
Advances to customers
6.3
9.5
-
-
Prepayments and other receivables 
22.5
28.6
-
-
149.1
163.4
611.2
284.5
Non-current receivables:
Advances to customers
32.8
33.1
-
-
Prepayments and other receivables
4.2
4.9
-
-
 
37.0
38.0
-
-
Total
186.1
201.4
611.2
284.5
In the year ended 29 February 2024, the Group restated the prior year financial information. Details of the restatement are contained in note 
31.
Amounts due from Group undertakings are a combination of interest bearing and interest free receivables and are all repayable on 
demand.
The Group manages credit risk through the use of a receivables purchase arrangement for an element of its trade receivables. Under the 
terms of this arrangement, the Group transfers the credit risk, late payment risk and control of the receivables sold. This arrangement 
contributed €105.9m to Group cash as at 29 February 2024 (FY2023: €94.1m). The Group’s trade receivables programme is not 
recognised on the Group’s Consolidated Balance Sheet as it meets the de-recognition criteria under IFRS 9 Financial Instruments.
The aged analysis of trade receivables and advances to customers analysed between amounts that were not past due and amounts past 
due at 29 February 2024 and 28 February 2023 were as follows:
            Trade receivables
        Advances to customers
      Total
      Total (restated)
Gross
Impairment
Gross
Impairment
Gross
Impairment
Gross
Impairment
2024
2024
2024
2024
2024
2024
2023
2023
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
Group
Not past due
94.1
(2.3)
38.3
(3.6)
132.4
(5.9)
140.9
(5.7)
 
Past due:
Past due 0-30 days
9.7
(0.1)
0.1
-
9.8
(0.1)
16.4
(1.1)
Past due 31-120 days
11.2
(1.1)
0.7
(0.2)
11.9
(1.3)
10.5
(0.5)
Past due 121-365 days
9.0
(0.8)
0.9
(0.3)
9.9
(1.1)
5.2
(1.0)
Past due more than one year
6.7
(6.1)
4.8
(1.6)
11.5
(7.7)
9.9
(6.7)
Total
130.7
(10.4)
44.8
(5.7)
175.5
(16.1)
182.9
(15.0)
 
Trade receivables, advances to customers and other receivables are recognised initially at fair value and subsequently measured at 
amortised cost less loss allowance or impairment losses. 
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
232
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Specifically, for advances to customers, any difference between the present value and the nominal amount at inception is treated as an 
advance of discount prepaid to the customer and is recognised in the Income Statement in accordance with the terms of the agreement. 
The discount rate calculated by the Group is at least based on the risk-free rate plus a margin, which takes into account the risk profile of 
the customer. 
The Group applies the simplified approach permitted by IFRS 9 Financial Instruments to measure expected credit losses for trade 
receivables, which requires expected lifetime losses to be recognised from initial recognition of the receivables. 
To measure the expected credit losses, trade receivables are assessed collectively in groups that share similar credit risk characteristics, 
such as customer segments, historical information on payment patterns including the payment patterns over the last twelve-month 
period, terms of payment, the impact of government schemes coming to an end as markets reopened and any relevant forward-looking 
macroeconomic information. The Group recorded an exceptional credit in the prior financial year of €0.9m in this regard (note 5). 
Regarding advances to customers, the Group applies the general approach to measure expected credit losses which requires a loss 
provision to be recognised based on twelve-month or lifetime expected credit losses, provided a significant increase in credit risk 
has occurred since initial recognition. The Group assesses the expected credit losses for advances to customers based on historical 
information on repayment patterns including the repayment patterns over the last twelve-month period and any relevant forward-looking 
macroeconomic information. The credit risk on advances to customers can be reduced through the value of security and/or collateral 
given. In the prior financial year, the easing of COVID-19 restrictions had a material impact on the assessment of credit losses with regard to 
advances to customers at year end and the Group recorded an exceptional credit in the prior financial year of €0.4m in this regard (note 5).
Trade receivables are on average receivable within 24 days (FY2023: 24 days) of the balance sheet date, are unsecured and are not 
interest-bearing. For more information on the Group’s credit risk exposure refer to note 24.
The movement in the allowance for impairment in respect of trade receivables and advances to customers during the year was as follows:
Trade receivables
Advance to 
customers
Total
Total
2024
2024
2024
2023
€m
€m
€m
€m
Group
At beginning of year 
9.2
5.8
15.0
17.8 
Recovered during the year
(0.3)
-
(0.3)
(1.3)
Provided during the year
2.6
0.3
2.9
2.2
Derecognised on disposal
(0.4)
-
(0.4)
(0.9)
Written off during the year
(0.8)
(0.6)
(1.4)
(2.5)
Translation adjustment
0.1
0.2
0.3
(0.3)
At end of year
10.4
5.7
16.1
15.0
At 29 February 2024, regarding the impact of the expected credit loss model on trade receivables and advances to customers, the Group 
has provided for expected credit losses over the next twelve months of €4.4m (FY2023: €4.2m) and expected lifetime losses of €11.7m 
(FY2023: €10.8m).
15. TRADE & OTHER RECEIVABLES (continued)
233
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

16. ASSET HELD FOR SALE/DISPOSAL GROUP
Following a reassessment of the Group’s supply and logistics operations for raw materials inputs the Group classified its Portuguese 
businesses, which produce fruit concentrates, as a disposal group as at 29 February 2024. The sale is expected to complete later in the 
year subject to clearance from the Portuguese Competition Authorities. Also included in held for sale assets are 24 storage tanks at the 
Group’s Clonmel manufacturing site which are surplus to requirements and were under offer for sale at the balance sheet date. This sale 
was completed on 29 May 2024 for proceeds of €1.2m, realising a profit on disposal of €0.3m which will be recognised in FY2025.  
The major classes of assets and liabilities of the operations, classified as held for sale as at 29 February 2024, were as follows:
2024
€m
Assets held for sale
Property, plant & equipment (note 11)
5.2
Inventories
0.3
Trade & other receivables
2.9
Total assets held for sale
8.4
Liabilities directly associated with assets held for sale 
Trade & other payables 
1.0
Current income tax liabilities
0.2
Deferred tax liabilities
0.2
Total liabilities directly associated with assets held for sale
1.4
Net assets directly associated with the disposal group
7.0
As part of the fair value assessment of the disposal group, the group has impaired the remaining €3.3m of the goodwill on acquisition in the 
current financial year.
During the prior financial year, the Group completed the sale of its asset held for sale, Admiral Taverns, to Proprium Capital Partners for a 
total consideration of €63.6m (£55.0m), realising a profit on disposal of €0.4m (note 5). 
17. TRADE & OTHER PAYABLES
                   Group
                    Company
2024
2023
(restated)
2024
2023
€m
€m
€m
€m
Trade payables
267.5
237.0
-
-
Payroll taxes & social security
4.3
4.1
-
-
VAT
18.3
17.6
-
-
Excise duty
29.7
28.7
-
-
Accruals
77.8
77.4
2.1
2.0
Amounts due to Group undertakings
-
-
50.2
53.6
Total
397.6
364.8
52.3
55.6
	
In the year ended 29 February 2024, the Group restated the prior year financial information. Details of the restatement are contained in note 
31.
Amounts due to Group undertakings are a combination of interest bearing and interest free payables and are all payable on demand.
The Group’s exposure to currency and liquidity risk related to trade & other payables is disclosed in note 24.
Company
The Company has entered into financial guarantee contracts to guarantee the indebtedness of the liabilities of certain of its subsidiary 
undertakings. As at 29 February 2024, the Directors do not consider it probable that the Company will have to make a payment under 
these guarantees. 
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued) 
234
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

18. PROVISIONS
Dilapidation
Onerous 
Contracts
Other
Total Restructuring
Dilapidation
Onerous 
Contracts
Other
Total
2024
2024
2024
2024
2023 
2023 
2023 
(restated)
2023 
2023 
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
At 1 March
5.4
12.2
4.9
22.5
0.2
5.4
-
6.5
12.1
Translation adjustment
(0.1)
-
-
(0.1)
-
(0.2)
-
(0.2)
(0.4)
Charged during the year
0.9
0.4
1.3
2.6
-
2.8
12.2
0.9
15.9
Released during the year
(0.7)
-
-
(0.7)
-
(2.6)
-
(0.1)
(2.7)
Reclass to financial liabilities
-
(6.8)
-
(6.8)
-
-
-
-
-
Utilised during the year
(0.2)
(2.4)
(4.8)
(7.4)
(0.2)
-
-
(2.2)
(2.4)
At end of year
5.3
3.4
1.4
10.1
-
5.4
12.2
4.9
22.5
Classified within:
Current liabilities
2.2
7.2
Non-current liabilities
7.9
15.3
 
10.1
22.5
 
Dilapidations
The Group has a dilapidation provision of €5.3m at 29 February 2024 (FY2023: €5.4m). During the current year €0.5m was incurred in 
relation to leased depots in Scotland and €0.4m in relation to leased depots in England. An amount of €0.7m was released in relation 
to leased depots in Scotland where new assessments were conducted to update the existing provisions, as a result of which it was 
concluded that the existing provisions were in excess of what was required. The Group’s dilapidation provision at 29 February 2024 is split 
between dilapidation costs for leased depots of €5.0m (FY2023: €5.1m) and a €0.3m dilapidation provision for the leased fleet (FY2023: 
€0.3m).
Onerous Contracts
During the current financial year, the Group identified errors which resulted in the recognition of a €12.2m charge in the prior period (notes 
5 & 31) to reflect the Group’s future obligations with its bittersweet apple suppliers under existing long-term contractual arrangements in 
accordance with IAS 37 Provisions, Contingent Liabilities and Contingent Assets constituted onerous contracts. These contracts have been 
recognised at present value as the Group does not expect to receive any economic benefit from the remaining duration of the contracts, 
in accordance with IAS 37. During the current period the Group made an offer to settle these contracts and accordingly €6.8m has been 
reclassified as a financial liability and initially recognised at fair value based on the present value of the future payments, in accordance with 
IFRS 9 (note 25) – the balance of €3.4m is classified as an onerous contract since no agreement has yet been reached with the remaining 
suppliers.
These contracts with bittersweet apple suppliers have an average duration of 10 years remaining. Annual payments will be made over 
the life of the contracts. There are no significant variability or sensitivities to note, there will be fluctuation in quantities depending on 
harvests, but the fluctuation will be minimal, reducing over time as contracted acres fall out of contract. See note 27 for further details of 
commitments. 
Key assumption used in calculating the value of the onerous contracts:  
The calculation of the onerous contract value is most sensitive to the following assumption:
•	 The discount rate  used is the risk-free-rate as calculated by external advisors. The discount rate used was 4.1% and a 1% change in the 
discount rate would give rise to a €0.1m change in the value of the onerous contract.
Other 
During the current period the Group utilised €3.2m of other provisions in respect of provisions for lost kegs following agreement with 
suppliers. Additionally, a further €1.6m of other provisions were utilised following settlement of legal and insurance claims. As at 29 
February 2024, the balance of €0.8m relates to legal and other costs that the Group expects to incur over an extended period, in respect of 
past events, none of which are individually material.
235
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

19. LEASES
The Group adopted IFRS 16 Leases from 1 March 2019 and has lease contracts for various items of freehold land & buildings, plant & 
machinery and motor vehicles & other equipment. 
In the year ended 29 February 2024, the Group restated the prior year financial information. Details of the restatement are contained in note 
31.
Set out below are the carrying amounts of right-of-use assets (included under property, plant & equipment note 11) recognised and the 
movements during the year:
Freehold land & 
buildings
Plant & 
machinery
Motor vehicles & 
other equipment
Total
€m
€m
 €m
€m
Leased right-of-use assets
At 1 March 2022, net carrying amount (previously stated)
34.0
3.3
30.7
68.0
Prior period restatements (net carrying amount)
-
3.1
-
3.1
At 1 March 2022, net carrying amount (restated)
34.0
6.4
30.7
71.1
Translation adjustment
(1.4)
(0.1)
(1.4)
(2.9)
Additions (restated)
5.3
0.1
22.1
27.5
Remeasurement
(0.4)
(3.0)
3.2
(0.2)
Disposals
-
-
(7.5)
(7.5)
Depreciation charge for the year (restated)
(6.0)
(0.9)
(13.7)
(20.6)
At 28 February 2023 (restated)
31.5
2.5
33.4
67.4
Translation adjustment
1.0
0.1
0.7
1.8
Additions
29.2
4.6
17.7
51.5
Remeasurement
0.6
-
(0.4)
0.2
Depreciation charge for the year
(7.4)
(1.9)
(11.6)
(20.9)
At 29 February 2024
54.9
5.3
39.8
100.0
Freehold land & 
buildings
Plant & 
machinery
Motor vehicles & 
other equipment
Total
€m
€m
 €m
€m
Leased liabilities
At 1 March 2022, net carrying amount (previously stated)
(44.8)
(3.2)
(32.0)
(80.0)
Prior period restatements (net carrying amount)
-
(3.0)
-
(3.0)
At 1 March 2022, net carrying amount (restated)
(44.8)
(6.2)
(32.0)
(83.0)
Translation adjustment
2.0
-
1.6
3.6
Additions to lease liabilities (restated)
(5.3)
(0.1)
(21.9)
(27.3)
Remeasurement
1.4
2.3
(3.5)
0.2
Disposals
-
-
7.4
7.4
Payments (restated)*
9.6
1.4
15.2
26.2
Interest (discount unwinding) (restated)
(1.9)
(0.2)
(1.6)
(3.7)
At 28 February 2023 (restated)
(39.0)
(2.8)
(34.8)
(76.6)
Translation adjustment
(1.1)
(0.1)
(0.7)
(1.9)
Additions to lease liabilities
(29.7)
(4.6)
(17.7)
(52.0)
Remeasurement
(0.6)
-
0.8
0.2
Payments*
9.6
2.2
13.2
25.0
Interest (discount unwinding)
(2.8)
(0.3)
(1.7)
(4.8)
At 29 February 2024
(63.6)
(5.6)
(40.9)
(110.1)
*	
Payments are apportioned between finance charges €4.8m (FY2023 (restated): €3.7m) and payment of lease liabilities €20.2m (FY2023 (restated): €22.5m) in the Cash Flow 
Statement
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
236
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Lease liabilities classified within:
Total
Total
2024
2023
(restated)
€m
€m
Current liabilities
(19.3)
(16.3)
Non-current liabilities
(90.8)
(60.3)
(110.1)
(76.6)
The table below shows a maturity analysis of the discounted and undiscounted lease liability arising from the Group’s leasing activities. 
These projections are based on the foreign exchange rates at the end of the relevant financial year and on interest rates (discounted 
projections only) applicable to the lease portfolio. 
As at 29 February 2024
As at 28 February 2023
(restated)
Discounted
Undiscounted
Discounted
Undiscounted
€m
€m
€m
€m
Within one year 
(19.3)
(24.3)
 (16.3)
(20.4)
Between one and two years 
(18.4)
(22.3)
 (14.2)
(16.4)
Between two and three years
(14.9)
(18.7)
 (12.5)
(14.1)
Between three and four years 
(12.5)
(15.5)
 (8.5)
(9.7)
Between four and five years
(7.3)
(10.1)
 (6.1)
(7.0)
After five years
(37.7)
(48.0)
 (19.0)
(19.2)
Total 
(110.1)
(138.9)
 (76.6)
(86.8)
The Group avails of the exemption from capitalising lease costs for short-term leases and low-value assets where the relevant criteria for 
accounting for them under IFRS 16 Leases are met. The following lease costs have been charged to the Income Statement as incurred:
2024
2023
(restated)
€m
€m
Expense relating to short-term leases (included in operating costs)
0.7
0.5
Total 
0.7
0.5
20. INTEREST BEARING LOANS & BORROWINGS
                   Group
                   Company
2024
2023
2024
2023
(restated)
€m
€m
€m
€m
Current assets
Unsecured loans repayable by instalment - issue costs
0.6
-
-
-
Private Placement notes repayable by instalment - issue costs
0.1
-
0.1
-
0.7
-
0.1
-
19. LEASES (continued)
237
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

                   Group
                   Company
2024
2023
2024
2023
(restated)
€m
€m
€m
€m
Current liabilities
Unsecured loans repayable on maturity
-
(95.0)
-
-
Unsecured loans repayable by instalment - issue costs
-
0.7
-
0.7
Private Placement notes repayable by instalment - issue costs
-
0.1
-
0.1
-
(94.2)
-
0.8
Non-current liabilities
Unsecured loans repayable on maturity
(120.0)
- 
-
-
Unsecured loans repayable by instalment - issue costs
2.4
-
0.1
-
Private Placement notes repayable by instalment - issue costs
0.7
0.6
0.7
0.9
Private Placement notes repayable by one repayment on maturity
(101.8)
(100.6) 
(101.8)
(100.6) 
(218.7)
(100.0) 
(101.1)
(99.7)
Total borrowings
(218.7)
(194.2) 
(101.1)
(98.9)
 
Group and Company
Outstanding borrowings of the Group and Company are net of unamortised issue costs. During FY2020, the Group completed the 
successful issue of new US Private Placement (‘USPP’) notes and incurred additional issue costs of €1.4m in this regard. During FY2023, 
the Group completed the successful negotiation of a multi-currency revolving facilities and Euro term loan agreement, incurring issue 
costs of €2.8m which were capitalised at the start of the facility, which commenced in FY2024. During FY2024, the Group successfully 
negotiated a one-year extension to the multi-currency revolving facilities and Euro term loan agreement, incurring further issue costs of 
€0.7m. 
All unamortised issue costs are being amortised to the Income Statement over the remaining life of the multi-currency revolving facilities 
agreement, the Euro term loan and the US Private Placement notes to which they relate. The value of unamortised issue costs at 29 
February 2024 was €3.8m (FY2023: €1.4m) of which €0.7m (FY2023: €0.8m) is presented as a current asset and €3.1m (FY2023: €0.6m) is 
netted against non-current liabilities. 
Terms and debt repayment schedule
Currency
Nominal rates of interest at 29 
February 2024
Year of maturity
2024
Carrying value
2023
Carrying value
Group
€m
€m
Unsecured loans repayable on maturity
Multi
N/a (FY23: Euribor/Sonia + 
2.4%)
2024
-
95.0
Unsecured term loan repayable on maturity
Euro
Euribor + 1.65%1
2029
100.0
-
Unsecured RCF loan repayable on maturity
Euro
Euribor + 1.5%1
2029
20.0
-
Private Placement notes repayable by one 
repayment on maturity
Euro/GBP
1.6%-2.74%
2030/2032
101.8
100.6
 
 
221.8
195.6
 
Currency
Nominal rates of interest at 29 
February 2024
Year of maturity
2024
Carrying value
2023
Carrying value
Company
€m
€m
Private Placement notes repayable by one 
repayment on maturity
Euro/GBP
1.6%-2.74%
2030/2032
101.8
100.6
 
 
101.8
100.6
 1	 The margin rate applied to the unsecured loans repayable on maturity is subject to six-monthly covenant testing of net debt to EBITDA ratio as outlined below, and a change 
to this ratio may result in a change in the margin. The upper and lower margin rates applicable are 1.15% to 2.55% for the unsecured RCF loan and 1.3% to 2.7% for the 
unsecured term loan.
20. INTEREST BEARING LOANS & BORROWINGS (continued)
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
238
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Borrowing facilities
Group
The Group manages its borrowing requirements by entering into committed loan facility agreements. It also holds USPP notes which 
diversifies the Group’s sources of debt finance.
The Group successfully completed a refinancing of its multi-currency facility and Euro term loan agreement which was repaid in a single 
instalment following the publication of the Group’s FY2023 Results in May 2023. The Group entered into a new five-year committed 
sustainability-linked facility comprised of a €250m multi-currency revolving loan facility and a €100m non-amortising Euro term loan.  The 
facility offers optionality of two 1-year extensions to the maturity date callable within 12 months and 24 months of the initial drawdown 
date respectively. The multi-currency facility and the Euro term syndicate comprises six banks - ABN Amro Bank, Allied Irish Bank, Bank 
of Ireland, Barclays Bank, HSBC and Rabobank. In FY2024, the Group exercised the first optional extension of the facilities, resulting in 
maturity being extended to January 2029 (FY2029) on both the multi-currency facility and Euro term loan. 
In March 2020, the Group completed the successful issue of new USPP notes. The unsecured notes, denominated in both Euro and 
Sterling, have maturities of 10 and 12 years and diversify the Group’s sources of debt finance. As at 29 February 2024, the holding is valued 
at €101.8m (FY2023: €100.6m).  
Under the terms of the multi-currency facility and Euro term loan, the Group must pay a commitment fee based on 35% of the applicable 
margin on undrawn committed amounts and variable interest on drawn amounts based on variable Euribor/Sonia interest rates plus a 
margin, the level of which is dependent on the Net Debt: EBITDA ratio, plus a utilisation fee, the level of which is dependent on percentage 
utilisation. The Group may select an interest period of one, two, three or six months. 
Under the terms of the USPP, the Group pays a margin of 1.6% with respect to €13.4m (FY2023: €13.4m) USPP notes with a 10 year 
tenure; 1.73% with respect to €40.4m (FY2023: €40.4m) USPP notes with a 12 year tenure and 2.74% with respect to £41.1m (FY2023: 
£41.1m) notes with a 10 year tenure. A fee is payable where Group EBITDA is below €120.0m and a below investment grade fee payable 
when the Group’s credit rating is below investment grade. These fees will remain applicable until the conditions are met and total 1.50%. 
The current and future multi-currency revolving facilities agreement provides for a further €100m in the form of an uncommitted accordion 
facility upon approval from the Group’s banking syndicate.
All bank loans drawn are unsecured and rank pari passu. All borrowings of the Group are guaranteed by a number of the Group’s 
subsidiary undertakings. The USPP allows the early prepayment of the notes at any time subject to the payment of a make whole amount 
to compensate the note holders for the interest that would have been received on the notes had they not been prepaid early. 
All borrowings of the Group at 29 February 2024 are repayable in full on change of control of the Group.
Company 
The Company is an original borrower under the terms of the Group’s multi-currency revolving facility and Euro term loan but is not a 
borrower in relation to the Group’s multi-currency revolving facility and Euro term loan drawn debt at 29 February 2024. 
The Company is a borrower with respect to the Group’s USPP notes of €101.8m (FY2023: €100.6m) as at 29 February 2024. Under the 
terms of the USPP, the Company pays a margin of 1.6% with respect to €13.4m USPP notes (FY2023: €13.4m) with a 10 year tenure; 
1.73% with respect to €40.4m FY2023 (FY2023: €40.4m) USPP notes with a 12 year tenure and 2.74% with respect to £41.1m (FY2023: 
£41.1m) notes with a 10 year tenure. A fee is payable where Group EBITDA is below €120.0m and a below investment grade fee payable 
when the Group’s credit rating is below investment grade. These fees will remain applicable until the conditions are met and total 1.50%. 
Covenants
The Group’s multi-currency revolving facility incorporates the following financial covenants:
•	 Interest cover: The ratio of EBITDA to net interest for a period of twelve months ending on each half-year date will not be less than 3.5:1
•	 Net debt: EBITDA: The ratio of net debt on each half-year date to EBITDA for a period of twelve months ending on a half-year date will 
not exceed 3.5:1
20. INTEREST BEARING LOANS & BORROWINGS (continued)
239
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

The Company and Group also had covenants with respect to its non-bank financial indebtedness.
•	 Interest cover: The ratio of EBITDA to net interest for a period of twelve months ending on each half-year date will not be less than 3.5:1
•	 Net debt: EBITDA: The ratio of net debt on each half-year date to EBITDA for a period of twelve months ending on a half-year date will not 
exceed 3.5:1
There is no effect on the Group’s covenants as a result of implementing IFRS 16 Leases as all covenants are calculated on a pre-IFRS 16 
Leases adoption basis. 
Further information about the Group’s exposure to interest rate, foreign currency and liquidity risk is disclosed in note 24.
21. ANALYSIS OF NET DEBT
In the year ended 29 February 2024, the Group restated the prior year financial information. Details of the restatement are contained in note 
31.
1 March 2023 
(restated)
Translation 
adjustment
Additions/
disposals/
remeasurement
Cash Flow, net
Non-cash
changes
29 February 2024
€m
€m
€m
 €m
€m
€m
Group
Interest bearing loans & borrowings
(194.2)
(1.2)
-
(21.6)
(1.0)
(218.0)*
Cash 
115.3
1.9
-
42.9
-
160.1
Net debt excluding leases
(78.9)
0.7
-
21.3
(1.0)
(57.9)
Lease liabilities (note 19)
(76.6)
(1.9)
(51.8)
25.0
(4.8)
(110.1)
Net debt including leases
(155.5)
(1.2)
(51.8)
46.3
(5.8)
(168.0)
*	
Interest bearing loans & borrowings at 29 February 2024 are net of unamortised issue costs of €3.8m.
	
Unamortised borrowing costs of €0.7m are presented within financial assets, please see notes 20 & 24.
1 March 2022
(restated)
Translation 
adjustment
Additions/
disposals/ 
remeasurement
(restated)
Cash Flow, net
(restated)
Non-cash
changes 
(restated)
28 February 2023 
(restated)
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
 €m
Group
Interest bearing loans & borrowings
(256.0) 
3.3
-
60.0
(1.5)
(194.2)*
Cash 
64.7
(1.3) 
-
51.9
- 
115.3
Net debt excluding leases
(191.3)
2.0
-
111.9
(1.5)
(78.9)
Lease liabilities (restated) (note 19)
(83.0)
3.6
(19.7) 
26.2
(3.7) 
(76.6) 
Net debt including leases (restated)
(274.3)
5.6
(19.7)
138.1
(5.2)
(155.5)
*	
Interest bearing loans & borrowings at 28 February 2023 are net of unamortised issue costs of €1.4m.
1 March 2023
Translation 
adjustment
Cash Flow, net
Non-cash
changes 29 February 2024
€m
€m
 €m
€m
€m
Company
Interest bearing loans & borrowings
(98.9)
(1.1)
-
(1.0)
  (101.0)* 
Cash 
0.2
-
-
-
0.2
(98.7)
(1.1)
-
(1.0)
(100.8)
*	
Interest bearing loans & borrowings at 29 February 2024 are net of unamortised issue costs of €0.8m.
	
Unamortised borrowing costs of €0.1m are presented within financial assets, please see notes 20 & 24.
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
20. INTEREST BEARING LOANS & BORROWINGS (continued)
240
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

1 March 2022
Translation 
adjustment
Cash Flow, net
Non-cash
changes
28 February 2023
€m
€m
 €m
€m
€m
Company
Interest bearing loans & borrowings
(142.5) 
3.2
41.6
(1.8)
  (98.9)* 
Cash 
0.1
-
0.1
-
0.2
 
(142.4)
3.2
41.7
(1.8)
(98.7)
*	
Interest bearing loans & borrowings at 28 February 2023 are net of unamortised issue costs of €1.4m.
The non-cash charge to the Company and Group’s interest-bearing loans and borrowings in the current financial year relates to the 
amortisation of issue costs of €1.0m (FY2023: €1.5m). The non-cash changes for the Group’s lease liabilities in the current financial year 
relate to lease interest/discount unwinding of €4.8m (FY2023 (restated): €3.2m) – see note 19. 
As outlined in further detail in note 28, the Company, together with a number of its subsidiaries, gave a letter of guarantee to secure its 
obligations in respect of all debt drawn by the Company and Group at 29 February 2024. 
22. DEFERRED TAX ASSETS AND LIABILITIES
2024
2023 (restated)
Assets
Liabilities
Net 
(liabilities)/assets 
Assets
Liabilities
Net 
(liabilities)/assets 
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
Group
Property, plant & equipment
1.8
(17.4)
(15.6)
1.6
(15.7)
(14.1)
Intangible assets
7.1
(11.4)
(4.3)
6.9
(10.1)
(3.2)
Retirement benefits
0.4
(5.0)
(4.6)
0.4
(6.2)
(5.8)
Trade related items & losses
20.1
(1.9)
18.2
17.4
(2.7)
14.7
29.4
(35.7)
(6.3)
26.3
(34.7)
(8.4)
 
The Group has not recognised deferred tax in relation to temporary differences applicable to investments in subsidiaries on the basis 
that the Group can control the timing and the realisation of these temporary differences and it is unlikely that the temporary differences 
will reverse in the foreseeable future. The aggregate amount of temporary differences applicable to investments in subsidiaries and 
equity accounted investments, in respect of which deferred tax liabilities have not been recognised, is immaterial on the basis that the 
participation exemptions and foreign tax credits should be available such that no material temporary differences arise. There are no other 
unrecognised deferred tax liabilities.
€15.9m (FY2023: €14.9m) of deferred tax assets have been recognised at the end of FY2024 in respect of tax losses that require future 
taxable profits to arise in excess of profits arising from the reversal of existing temporary differences. Following a forecasting exercise, the 
Group is estimating sufficient future taxable profits to recognise these deferred tax assets.
In addition, no deferred tax asset has been recognised in respect of certain tax losses incurred by the Group on the basis that the recovery 
is considered unlikely in the foreseeable future or due to the complexity and uncertainty of the tax treatment in connection with certain 
items giving rise to some of the losses. The cumulative value of such tax losses is €41.5 (FY2023: €43.3m). In the event that sufficient 
taxable profits arise or the tax treatment becomes sufficiently certain in the relevant jurisdictions in future years, these losses may be 
utilised. With the sale of Vermont Hard Cider Company, the losses in connection with this business expired in 2021/2022 and the majority 
of the remaining losses are due to expire in 2035/2038.
Company
The Company had no deferred tax assets or liabilities at 29 February 2024 or at 28 February 2023.
21. ANALYSIS OF NET DEBT (continued)
241
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Analysis of movement in net deferred tax (liabilities)/assets
1 March 2023 
(restated)
Recognised in 
Income Statement
Recognised 
in Other 
Comprehensive 
Income
Translation 
adjustment
29 February 2024
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
Group
Property, plant & equipment: ROI 
(1.9)
(0.3)
-
-
(2.2)
Property, plant & equipment: other
(12.2)
(0.9)
(0.2)
(0.1)
(13.4)
Trade related items & losses
14.7
3.1
-
0.4
18.2
Intangible assets
(3.2)
(1.0)
-
(0.1)
(4.3)
Retirement benefits
(5.8)
(0.2)
1.4
-
(4.6)
 
(8.4)
0.7
1.2
0.2
(6.3)
From 1 April 2023, the UK corporation tax rate increased from 19% to 25%. UK deferred tax assets and liabilities as of 29 February 2024 
have been calculated at the 25% rate of tax. An assessment on the expected unwind of UK deferred tax assets and UK deferred liabilities 
had been calculated in prior years with the relevant debits/credits booked to the P&L in those years. 
1 March 2022 
(restated)
Recognised in 
Income Statement
Recognised in Other 
Comprehensive 
Income
Translation 
adjustment
28 February 2023
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
Group
Property, plant & equipment: ROI
(0.2)
(1.7)
-
-
(1.9)
Property, plant & equipment: other
(11.6)
(0.9) 
0.3 
-
(12.2) 
Trade related items & losses
18.5
(3.5)
-
(0.3)
14.7
Intangible assets
(3.2)
0.3
-
(0.3)
(3.2)
Retirement benefits
(6.1)
0.2
0.1
-
(5.8)
 
(2.6)
(5.6)
0.4
(0.6)
(8.4)
 
23. RETIREMENT BENEFITS
The Group operates a number of defined benefit pension schemes for certain employees, past and present, in the Republic of Ireland 
(“ROI”) and in Northern Ireland (“NI”), all of which provide pension benefits based on final salary and the assets of which are held in 
separate trustee administered funds. The Group closed its defined benefit pension schemes to new members in March 2006 and provides 
only defined contribution pension schemes for employees joining the Group since that date. The Group provides permanent health 
insurance cover for the benefit of certain employees and separately charges this to the Income Statement.
The defined benefit pension scheme assets are held in separate trustee-administered funds to meet long-term pension liabilities to past 
and present employees. The trustees of the funds are required to act in the best interest of the funds’ beneficiaries. The appointment of 
trustees to the funds is determined by the schemes’ trust documentation. The Group has a policy in relation to its principal staff pension 
fund that members of the fund should nominate half of all fund trustees.
There are no active members remaining in the executive defined benefit pension scheme (FY2023: no active members). There are 49 active 
members, representing less than 10% of total membership, in the ROI Staff defined benefit pension scheme (FY2023: 50 active members) 
and 2 active members in the NI defined benefit pension scheme (FY2023: 2 active members).
Actuarial valuations – funding requirements 
Independent actuarial valuations of the defined benefit pension schemes are carried out on a triennial basis using the attained age/
aggregate method. The most recently completed actuarial valuations of the ROI defined benefit pension schemes were carried out with 
an effective date of 1 January 2021 while the date of the most recent actuarial valuation of the NI defined benefit pension scheme was 
31 December 2020. The actuarial valuations are not available for public inspection; however the results of the valuations are advised to 
members of the various schemes. Work is underway on new triennial actuarial valuations, with completion expected in June 2024. 
22. RECOGNISED DEFERRED TAX ASSETS AND LIABILITIES (continued)
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
242
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

The funding requirements in relation to the Group’s ROI defined benefit pension schemes are assessed at each valuation date and are 
implemented in accordance with the advice of the actuaries. Arising from the formal actuarial valuations of the Group’s staff defined benefit 
pension scheme, the Group committed to contributions of €418,000 per annum commencing in calendar year 2021 and increasing at a 
rate of 1.4% each calendar year thereafter. This will be reviewed at the next actuarial valuation, which is due in the normal course of events 
in June 2024. There is no funding requirement with respect to the Group’s ROI executive defined benefit pension scheme or the Group’s 
NI defined benefit pension scheme, both of which are in surplus. The Group has an unconditional right to any surplus remaining in these 
schemes in the event the scheme concludes.
The Group is exposed to a number of risks in relation to the funding position of these schemes, namely:
Asset volatility: It is the Group’s intention to pursue a long-term investment policy that emphasises investment in secure monetary assets 
to provide for the contractual benefits payable to members. The investment portfolio has exposure to equities, other growth assets, 
insurance contracts and fixed interest investments, the returns from which are uncertain and may fluctuate significantly in line with market 
movements. Assets held are valued at fair value using bid prices where relevant. 
Discount rate: The discount rate is the rate of interest used to discount post-employment benefit obligations and is determined by reference 
to market yields at the balance sheet date on high quality corporate bonds with a currency and term consistent with the currency and 
estimated term of the Group’s post-employment benefit obligations. Movements in discount rates have a significant impact on the value of 
the schemes’ liabilities.
Longevity: The value of the defined benefit obligations is influenced by demographic factors such as mortality experience and retirement 
patterns. Changes to life expectancy have a significant impact on the value of the schemes’ liabilities. 
Method and assumptions 
The schemes’ independent actuary, Mercer (Ireland) Limited, has employed the projected unit credit method to determine the present 
value of the defined benefit obligations arising and the related current service cost. 
 
The financial assumptions that have the most significant impact on the results of the actuarial valuations are those relating to the discount 
rate used to convert future pension liabilities to current values and the rate of inflation/salary increase. These, and other assumptions used 
to determine the retirement benefits and current service cost under IAS 19 Employee Benefits, are set out below.
 
Mortality rates also have a significant impact on the actuarial valuations, as the number of deaths within the scheme have been too small to 
analyse and produce any meaningful scheme-specific estimates of future levels of mortality, the rates used have been based on the most 
up-to-date mortality tables, (the S3PMA CMI 2019 1.5% (males) and S3PFA CMI 2019 1.5% (females) for the ROI schemes and S3PMA 
CMI 2020 1.5% (males) and S3PFA CMI 2020 1.5% (females) for the NI scheme) with age ratings and loading factors to allow for future 
mortality improvements. These tables conform to best practice. The growing trend for people to live longer and the expectation that this 
will continue has been reflected in the mortality assumptions used for this valuation as indicated below. This assumption will continue to be 
monitored in light of general trends in mortality experience. Based on these tables, the assumed life expectations on retirement are:
ROI
NI
2024
2023
2024
2023
Future life expectations at age 65
No. of years
No. of years
No. of years
No. of years
Current retirees – no allowance for future improvements
Male
22.7-23.6
22.6-23.5
22.5
22.4
 
Female
24.5-25.4
24.4-25.3
24.4
24.2
Future retirees – with allowance for future improvements
Male
23.5-24.3
23.4-24.2
24.2
24.0
 
Female
25.4-26.3
25.3-26.2
26.1
26.0
 
Scheme liabilities
The average age of active members is 53 and 50 years (FY2023: 53 and 50 years) for the ROI Staff and the NI defined benefit pension 
schemes respectively (the executive defined benefit pension scheme has no active members), while the average duration of liabilities 
ranges from 11 to 16 years (FY2023: 12 to 17 years).
 
23. RETIREMENT BENEFITS (continued)
243
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

The principal long-term financial assumptions used by the Group’s actuaries in the computation of the defined benefit liabilities arising on 
pension schemes as at 29 February 2024 and 28 February 2023 are as follows:
2024
2023
ROI
NI
ROI
NI
Salary increases
0.0%-2.9%
3.6%
0.0%-2.6%
3.6%
Increases to pensions in payment
2.3%
1.9%
2.6%
1.8%
Discount rate
3.8%
5.2%
4.3%
5.0%
Inflation rate
2.3%
3.2%
2.6%
3.2%
 
A reduction in discount rate used to value the schemes’ liabilities by 0.25% would increase the valuation of liabilities by €4.9m (FY2023: 
€4.8m) while an increase in inflation/salary increase expectations of 0.25% would increase the valuation of liabilities by €4.7m (FY2023: 
€4.7m). The sensitivity is calculated by changing the individual assumption while holding all other assumptions constant.
The pension assets and liabilities have been prepared in accordance with IAS 19 Employee Benefits. 
(a) Impact on Income Statement
2024
2023
ROI
NI
Total
ROI
NI
Total
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
Analysis of defined benefit pension 
expense:
Current service cost
(0.3)
-
(0.3)
(0.6)
-
(0.6) 
Interest cost on scheme liabilities
(5.3)
(0.2)
(5.5)
(3.1) 
(0.2) 
(3.3) 
Interest income on scheme assets
7.0
0.2
7.2
3.7
0.3
4.0
Total income recognised in Income 
Statement
1.4
-
1.4
-
0.1
0.1
 
Analysis of amount recognised in Other Comprehensive Income:
2024
2023
ROI
NI
Total
ROI 
NI 
Total
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
Actual return on scheme assets
4.2
(0.3)
3.9
(24.8)
(5.1)
(29.9)
Expected interest income on scheme assets
(7.0)
(0.2)
(7.2)
(3.7) 
(0.3) 
(4.0) 
Experience gains and losses on scheme 
liabilities
(2.3)
(0.3)
(2.6)
(3.9)
(0.3)
(4.2)
Effect on changes in financial assumptions
(4.1)
0.1
(4.0)
39.3
3.1
42.4
Total (expense)/income
(9.2)
(0.7)
(9.9)
6.9
(2.6)
4.3
Scheme assets
162.9
8.3
171.2
164.3
8.5
172.8
Scheme liabilities
(131.7)
(5.2)
(136.9)
(125.7) 
(4.9)
(130.6) 
Surplus in scheme
31.2
3.1
34.3
38.6
3.6
42.2
 
23. RETIREMENT BENEFITS (continued)
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
244
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

(b) Impact on Balance Sheet
The retirement benefits surplus at 29 February 2024 and 28 February 2023 is analysed as follows:
Analysis of net pension surplus:
2024
2023
ROI
NI
Total
ROI
NI
Total
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
Investments quoted in active markets
Bid value of assets at end of year:
Equity* 
17.4
-
17.4
31.2
1.2
32.4
Bonds
84.4
8.3
92.7
111.6 
7.3
118.9
Alternatives
20.0
-
20.0
8.2
-
8.2
Insured** 
31.9
-
31.9
-
-
-
Cash
1.0
-
1.0
0.5
-
0.5
Investments unquoted
Property
8.2
-
8.2
12.8
-
12.8
162.9
8.3
171.2
164.3
8.5
172.8
Actuarial value of scheme liabilities
(131.7)
(5.2)
(136.9)
(125.7) 
(4.9) 
(130.6) 
Deficit in the scheme
-
-
-
-
-
-
Surplus in the scheme
31.2
3.1
34.3
38.6
3.6
42.2
Surplus in the scheme
31.2
3.1
34.3
38.6
3.6
42.2
Related deferred tax liability (note 22)
(3.5)
(1.1)
(4.6)
(4.5)
(1.3)
(5.8)
Net pension surplus
27.7
2.0
29.7
34.1
2.3
36.4
*The defined benefit pension schemes have a passive self-investment in C&C Group plc of €nil (FY2023: €nil).
** During the year, the Trustees of the executive defined benefit scheme entered into an annuity buy in contract with an insurer. 
The alternative investment category includes investments in various asset classes including equities, commodities, currencies and funds. 
The investments are managed by fund managers.
Reconciliation of scheme assets
2024
2023
ROI
NI
Total
ROI
NI
Total
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
Assets at beginning of year
164.3
8.5
172.8
195.1
14.4
209.5
Movement in year:
Translation adjustment
-
0.2
0.2
-
(0.6)
(0.6)
Expected interest income on scheme assets
7.0
0.2
7.2
3.7
0.3 
4.0 
Actual return less interest income on scheme assets
(2.8)
(0.5)
(3.3)
(28.5)
(5.4)
(33.9)
Employer contributions
0.4
-
0.4
0.5
-
0.5
Member contributions
0.1
-
0.1
0.1
-
0.1
Other movements 
-
-
-
0.1
-
0.1
Benefit payments
(6.1)
(0.1)
(6.2)
(6.7) 
(0.2) 
(6.9) 
Assets at end of year
162.9
8.3
171.2
164.3
8.5
172.8
 
The expected employer contributions to fund defined benefit scheme obligations for year ending 28 February 2025 is €0.4m.
23. RETIREMENT BENEFITS (continued)
245
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

The scheme assets had the following investment profile at the year end:
2024
2023
ROI
NI
ROI
NI
Investments quoted in active markets
Equities
11%
-
19%
14%
Bonds
52%
100%
68%
86%
Alternatives
12%
-
5%
-
Insured 
19%
-
-
-
Cash
1%
-
-
-
Investments unquoted
Property
5%
-
8%
-
 
100%
100%
100%
100%
 
Reconciliation of actuarial value of scheme liabilities 
2024
2023
ROI
NI
Total
ROI
NI
Total
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
Liabilities at beginning of year
125.7
4.9
130.6
164.0
7.9
171.9
Movement in year:
Translation adjustment
-
-
-
-
(0.2)
(0.2)
Current service cost
0.3
-
0.3
0.6
-
0.6
Interest cost on scheme liabilities
5.3
0.2
5.5
3.1
0.2
3.3
Member contributions
0.1
-
0.1
0.1
-
0.1
Actuarial loss/(gain) immediately recognised in equity
6.4
0.2
6.6
(35.4) 
(2.8) 
(38.2)
Benefit payments
(6.1)
(0.1)
(6.2)
(6.7) 
(0.2) 
(6.9) 
Liabilities at end of year
131.7
5.2
136.9
125.7
4.9
130.6
24. FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT
The Group’s multinational operations expose it to various financial risks in the ordinary course of business that include credit risk, liquidity 
risk, commodity price risk, currency risk and interest rate risk. This note discusses the Group’s exposure to each of these financial risks 
and summarises the risk management strategy for managing these risks. The note is presented as follows:
(a) Overview of the Group’s risk exposures and management strategy
(b) Financial assets and liabilities as at 29 February 2024/28 February 2023 and determination of fair value
(c) Market risk 
(d) Credit risk
(e) Liquidity risk
(a) Overview of the Group’s risk exposures and management strategy
The main financial market risks that the Group is exposed to include foreign currency exchange rate risk, commodity price fluctuations, 
interest rate risk and financial counterparty creditworthiness. The Board continues to monitor and manage closely these and all other 
financial risks faced by the Group. 
The Board of Directors has overall responsibility for the establishment and oversight of the Group’s risk management framework. This is 
executed through various committees to which the Board has delegated appropriate levels of authority. An essential part of this framework 
is the role undertaken by the Audit Committee, supported by the internal audit function and the Chief Financial Officer. The Board, 
through its Committees, has reviewed the internal control environment and the risk management systems and process for identifying and 
evaluating the significant risks affecting the business and the policies and procedures by which these risks will be managed effectively. The 
Board has embedded these structures and procedures throughout the Group and considers them to be a robust and efficient mechanism 
for creating a culture of risk awareness at every level of management. 
23. RETIREMENT BENEFITS (continued)
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
246
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

The Group’s risk management programme seeks to minimise the potential adverse effects, arising from fluctuations in financial markets, 
on the Group’s financial performance in a non-speculative manner at a reasonable cost when economically viable to do so. The Group 
achieves the management of these risks in part, where appropriate, through the use of derivative financial instruments. All derivative 
financial contracts entered into in this regard are in liquid markets with credit-worthy parties. Treasury activities are performed within strict 
terms of reference that have been approved by the Board. See currency risk and interest rate risk sections for further details. 
(b) Financial assets and liabilities
The carrying and fair values of financial assets and liabilities by measurement category were as follows:
Carrying value
Fair value
 €m
 €m
Group
29 February 2024
Financial assets:
Cash* 
160.1
160.1
Trade receivables*
120.3
120.3
Advances to customers*
39.1
39.1
Unamortised borrowing costs*, ***
0.7
0.7
Promissory note
4.4
4.4
Derivative contracts**
0.5
0.5
325.1
325.1
Financial liabilities:
Interest bearing loans & borrowings*
(218.7)
(221.8)
Trade & other payables* 
(345.3)
(345.3)
Provisions*
(10.1)
(10.1)
Derivative contracts**
(0.2)
(0.2)
Financial liabilities*
(6.8)
(6.8)
(581.1)
(584.2)
(256.0)
(259.1)
* 	
At amortised cost, excluding statutory balances (VAT of €18.3m, excise duty of €29.7m and payroll taxes & social security of €4.3m)
** 	 Derivatives designated as hedging instruments
*** 	Unamortised borrowing costs are presented within financial assets, please see notes 20 & 24
Carrying value
Fair value
 €m
 €m
Group
28 February 2023 (restated)
Financial assets:
Cash* 
115.3
115.3
Trade receivables*
125.3
125.3
Advances to customers*
42.6
42.6
Promissory note
4.5
4.5
Derivative contracts**
1.1
1.1
288.8
288.8
Financial liabilities:
Interest bearing loans & borrowings*
(194.2) 
(195.6) 
Trade & other payables (restated)*
(314.4)
(314.4)
Provisions*
(22.5)
(22.5)
(531.1)
(532.5)
(242.3) 
(243.7) 
* 	
At amortised cost, excluding statutory balances (VAT of €17.6m, excise duty of €28.7m and payroll taxes & social security of €4.1m)
** 	 Derivatives designated as hedging instruments
24. FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT (continued)
247
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

24. FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT (continued)
Carrying value
Fair value
 €m
 €m
Company
29 February 2024
Financial assets:
Cash*
0.3
0.3
Unamortised borrowing costs*, ***
0.1
0.1
Amounts due from Group undertakings*
611.2
611.2
611.6
611.6
Financial liabilities:
Interest bearing loans & borrowings*
(101.0)
(101.8)
Amounts due to Group undertakings*
(50.2)
(50.2)
Accruals*
(2.1)
(2.1)
(153.3)
(154.1)
458.3
457.5
* 	
At amortised cost
Carrying value
Fair value
 €m
 €m
Company
28 February 2023 (restated)
Financial assets:
Cash*
0.2
0.2
Amounts due from Group undertakings*
284.5
284.5
284.7
284.7
Financial liabilities:
Interest bearing loans & borrowings*
(98.9) 
(100.6) 
Amounts due to Group undertakings*
(53.6) 
(53.6) 
Accruals*
(2.0) 
(2.0) 
(154.5)
(156.2)
 
130.2
128.5 
* 	
At amortised cost
Determination of Fair Value
Set out below are the main methods and assumptions used in estimating the fair values of the Group’s financial assets and liabilities. There 
is no material difference between the fair value of financial assets and liabilities falling due within one year and their carrying amount as, due 
to the short-term maturity of these financial assets and liabilities, their carrying amount is deemed to approximate fair value.
Short-term bank deposits and cash 
The nominal amount of all short-term bank deposits and cash is deemed to reflect fair value at the balance sheet date.
Advances to customers
Advances to customers adjusted for advances of discount prepaid is considered to reflect fair value. 
Trade & other receivables/payables
The nominal amount of all trade & other receivables/payables after provision for impairment is deemed to reflect fair value at the balance 
sheet date with the exception of provisions which are discounted to fair value.
 
Interest bearing loans & borrowings
The fair value of all interest-bearing loans & borrowings has been calculated by discounting all future cash flows to their present value using 
a market rate reflecting the Group’s cost of borrowing at the balance sheet date (Level 2). 
Promissory note
The Group continues to hold the promissory notes of USD 4.8m, which formed the non-cash consideration from the sale of Vermont Hard 
Cider Company (‘VHCC’) as a financial asset.
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
248
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

(c) Market risk
Market risk is the risk that changes in market prices, such as commodity prices, foreign exchange rates and interest rates, will affect the 
Group’s income or the value of its holdings of financial instruments. The objective of market risk management is to manage and control 
market risk exposures within acceptable parameters, while optimising the return on risk.
 
Commodity price risk
The Group is exposed to variability in the price of commodities used in the production or in the packaging of finished products, such as 
apples, glass, barley, aluminium, polymer, wheat and sugar/glucose. Commodity price risk is managed, where economically viable, through 
fixed price contracts with suppliers incorporating appropriate commodity hedging and pricing mechanisms. The Group does not directly enter 
into commodity hedge contracts. The cost of production is also sensitive to variability in the price of energy, primarily gas and electricity. It is 
Group policy to fix the cost of a certain level of its energy requirement through fixed price contractual arrangements directly with its energy 
suppliers. 
Currency risk
The Company’s functional and reporting currency is Euro. The Euro is also the Group’s reporting currency and the currency used for all 
planning and budgetary purposes. The Group is exposed to currency risk in relation to sales and purchase transactions by Group companies 
in currencies other than their functional currency (transaction risk), and fluctuations in the Euro value of the Group’s net investment in foreign 
currency (primarily Sterling) denominated subsidiary undertakings (translation risk). Currency exposures for the entire Group are managed and 
controlled centrally. The Group seeks to minimise its foreign currency transaction exposure, when possible, by offsetting the foreign currency 
input costs against the same foreign currency receipts, creating a natural hedge. When the remaining net currency exposure is material, 
the Group enters into foreign currency forward contracts to mitigate and protect against adverse movements in currency risk and remove 
uncertainty over the foreign currency equivalent cash flows. At 29 February 2024, the Group had €13.1m of forward foreign currency cash 
flow hedges outstanding (FY2023: €11.5m).
In addition, the Group has a number of long-term intra-group loans for which settlement is neither planned nor likely to happen in the 
foreseeable future, and as a consequence of which are deemed quasi equity in nature and are therefore part of the Group’s net investment 
in its foreign operations. The Group does not hedge the translation exposure arising on the translation of the profits of foreign currency 
subsidiaries.
 
The net currency gains and losses on transactional currency exposures are recognised in the Income Statement and the changes arising 
from fluctuations in the Euro value of the Group’s net investment in foreign operations are reported separately within Other Comprehensive 
Income.
2024
€m
2023
€m
Derivatives
Cash flow hedges – currency forwards
(0.2)
0.1
Total
(0.2)
0.1
Type
Valuation Technique
Significant 
unobservable 
inputs
Inter-relationship between 
significant unobservable inputs and 
fair value measurement
Foreign 
currency 
forward 
contracts
Forward pricing: The fair value is determined using quoted forward exchange 
rates at the reporting date and present value calculations based on high credit 
quality yield curves in respective currencies. 
Not 
applicable.
Not applicable.
Interest 
rate swaps
Swap models: The fair value is calculated as the present value of the 
estimated future cash flows. 
Estimates of future floating-rate cash flows are based on quoted swap rates, 
futures prices and interbank borrowing rates. 
Estimated cash flows are discounted using a yield curve constructed from 
similar sources and which reflects the relevant benchmark interbank rate used 
by market participants for this purpose when pricing interest rate swaps. 
The fair value estimate is subject to a credit risk adjustment that reflects the 
credit risk of the Group and of the counterparty; this is calculated based on 
credit spreads derived from current credit default swap or bond prices. 
Not 
applicable.
Not applicable.
24. FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT (continued)
249
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

24. FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT (continued)
Derivatives are only used for economic hedging purposes and not as speculative investments. However, where derivatives do not meet the 
hedge accounting criteria, they are classified as “held for trading” for accounting purposes and are accounted for at fair value through the 
Income Statement. They are presented as current assets or liabilities to the extent they are expected to be settled within 12 months after the 
end of the reporting period.
2024
€m
2023
(restated)
€m
Hedging reserves – currency hedges
Opening balance 1 March 
1.1
(0.1)
Change in fair value of hedging recognised in Other Comprehensive Income for the year
(0.8)
1.2
Closing balance 29 February – continuing currency hedges
0.3
1.1
 
Hedge ineffectiveness is determined at the inception of the hedge relationship, and through periodic prospective effectiveness assessments, 
to ensure that an economic relationship exists between the hedged item and hedging instrument. 
For hedges of foreign currency purchases, the Group enters into hedge relationships where the critical terms of the hedging instrument 
match exactly with the terms of the hedged item. The Group therefore performs a qualitative assessment of effectiveness. If changes in 
circumstances affect the terms of the hedged item, such that the critical terms no longer match exactly with the critical terms of the hedging 
instrument, the Group uses the hypothetical derivative method to assess effectiveness. 
In hedges of foreign currency purchases, ineffectiveness might arise if the timing of the forecast transaction changes from what was 
originally estimated, or if a degree of forecast purchases are no longer highly probable to occur. The hedging ratio is 1:1 as the quantity of 
purchases designated matches the notional amount of the hedging instrument. 
No ineffectiveness was recognised in the Income Statement in the current or prior financial year. 
The currency profile of the Group and Company’s financial instruments subject to transactional exposure as at 29 February 2024 is as 
follows:
Euro
Sterling
USD
AUD
NZD
ZAR
Not at risk
Total
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
Group
Cash 
4.4
3.6
4.4
1.2
0.7
0.2
145.6
160.1
Trade receivables 
5.1
1.9
4.9
0.9
0.8
0.2
106.5
120.3
Advances to customers
-
-
-
-
-
-
39.1
39.1
Interest bearing loans & borrowings
(117.0)
(48.0)
-
-
-
-
(53.0)
(218.0)*
Lease liabilities 
-
(2.6)
-
-
-
-
(107.5)
(110.1)
Trade & other payables 
(17.6)
(22.9)
(5.1)
(0.4)
(1.5)
(0.2)
(349.9)
(397.6)
Financial liabilities
-
-
-
-
-
-
(6.8)
(6.8)
Provisions 
-
-
-
-
-
-
(10.1)
(10.1)
Gross currency exposure
(125.1)
(68.0)
4.2
1.7
-
0.2
(236.1)
(423.1)
Sterling
USD
Not at risk
Total
€m
€m
€m
€m
Company
Cash
0.1
-
0.2
0.3
Interest bearing loans & borrowings
(48.0)
-
(53.0)
(101.0)*
Net amounts due to Group undertakings
29.0
0.1
531.9
561.0
Accruals
(1.0)
-
(1.1)
(2.1)
Total
(19.9)
0.1
478.0
458.2
 * Unamortised borrowing costs are presented within financial assets, please see notes 20 & 24.
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
250
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

The currency profile of the Group and Company’s financial instruments subject to transactional exposure as at 28 February 2023 is as 
follows:
Euro
Sterling
(restated)
USD
CAD/AUD
NZD
SGD
Not at risk 
(restated)
Total
(restated)
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
Group
Cash 
2.5
4.7
7.1
1.6
0.2
0.1
99.1
115.3
Trade receivables 
2.4
2.4
1.2
1.0
0.1
-
118.2
125.3
Advances to customers
-
-
-
-
-
-
42.6
42.6
Interest bearing loans & borrowings
(95.0)
(46.8)
-
-
-
-
(52.4) 
(194.2) 
Lease liabilities (restated)* 
-
(2.2)
-
-
-
-
(74.4) 
(76.6) 
Trade & other payables (restated)*
(16.4)
(14.9) 
(2.5) 
(0.2) 
(1.3) 
-
(329.5) 
(364.8) 
Provisions 
-
(0.7)
-
-
-
-
(21.8)
(22.5) 
Net currency exposure (restated)*
(106.5) 
(57.5) 
5.8
2.4
(1.0)
0.1
(218.2)
(374.9) 
* In the year ended 29 February 2024, the Group restated the prior year financial information. Details of the restatement are contained in note 31.
Sterling
Not at risk
Total
€m
€m
€m
Company
Cash
-
0.2
0.2
Interest bearing loans & borrowings
(46.8)
(52.1)
(98.9) 
Net amounts due to Group undertakings
14.8
216.1
230.9
Accruals
(1.0)
(1.0)
(2.0)
Total
(33.0)
163.2
130.2
 
A 10% strengthening in the Euro against all currencies noted above, based on outstanding financial assets and liabilities at 29 February 
2024, would have a €5.6m positive impact (FY2023: €4.4m) on the Income Statement. A 10% weakening in the Euro against all currencies 
noted above would have a €6.9m negative effect (FY2023: €5.4m) on the Income Statement. This analysis assumes that all other variables, 
in particular interest rates, remain constant.
Interest rate risk 
The interest rate profile of the Group and Company’s interest-bearing financial instruments at the reporting date is summarised as follows:
Group
Company
2024
2023
2024
2023
(restated)
€m
€m
€m
€m
Variable/fixed rate instruments
Interest bearing loans & borrowings
(218.0)*
(195.6)
(101.0)*
(100.6)
Cash 
160.1
115.3
0.3
0.2
 
(57.9)
(80.3)
(100.7)
(100.4) 
 *  Unamortised borrowing costs are presented within financial assets, please see notes 20 & 24.
The Group exposure to interest rate risk arises principally from its long-term debt obligations. A 0.25% increase/decrease in Euribor and 
Sonia rates would result in a €1.2m (FY2023: €0.1m) impact on the Income Statement, over the duration of the tenure, with respect to the 
interest charge on interest bearing loans & borrowings.
The Group is exposed to interest rate risk in relation to its €350m multi-currency interest bearing revolving credit facility. With the Group’s 
USPP notes, there is a portion of long-term debt obligations where the interest is fixed for the duration of the facilities and not subject 
to changes in Euribor and Sonia rates. Interest rate exposures for the Group are managed and controlled centrally. The Group seeks to 
minimise its interest rate exposure by assessing and executing hedging strategies in a non-speculative manner, in line with Group policy 
and at a reasonable cost when economically viable to do so.  
24. FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT (continued)
251
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

24. FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT (continued)
As at 29 February 2024, C&C Group had a portion of its interest rate risk hedged with the objective to manage risk of the Group’s long-term 
exposure to interest rates and in line with C&C Group Policy. With rising interest rate environment, coming from both the European Central 
Bank and Bank of England, following recent history of modest or negative interest rates, the Group executed a €60m three-year Euro 
interest rate hedge against Euro debt facilities exposed to EURIBOR fluctuations. The hedge was executed in line with the Group guardrails 
and ensures that 73% of the Group’s interest-bearing loans and borrowings as at 29 February 2024 are now either hedged or fixed through 
the USPP notes (FY2023: 82%). The USPP notes were issued in March 2020 with a fixed interest rate for Euro and GBP notes, the notes 
have maturity dates ranging from 2030 to 2032.
2024 
€m
2023
€m
Derivatives
Cash flow hedges – interest rate 
0.5
1.2
Total
0.5
1.2
Derivatives are only used for economic hedging purposes and not as speculative investments. However, where derivatives do not meet the 
hedge accounting criteria, they are classified as “held for trading” for accounting purposes and are accounted for at fair value through the 
Income Statement. They are presented as current assets or liabilities to the extent they are expected to be settled within 12 months after 
the end of the reporting period.
2024 
€m
2023
€m
Hedging reserves – interest rate hedges
Opening balance 1 March 
1.1
(0.1)
Change in fair value of hedging recognised in Other Comprehensive Income for the year
(0.8)
1.2
Closing balance 29 February – continuing interest rate hedges
0.3
1.1
Hedge ineffectiveness is determined at the inception of the hedge relationship, and through periodic prospective effectiveness 
assessments, to ensure that an economic relationship exists between the hedged item and hedging instrument. 
For hedges of interest rates, the critical terms of the hedging instrument match exactly with the terms of the hedged item. The Group 
therefore performs a qualitative assessment of effectiveness. If changes in circumstances affect the terms of the hedged item, such that 
the critical terms no longer match exactly with the critical terms of the hedging instrument, the Group uses the hypothetical derivative 
method to assess effectiveness. 
In hedges of interest rates, ineffectiveness might arise on the sale of the business or repayment of debt which would impact hedged item. 
No ineffectiveness was recognised in the Income Statement in the current or prior financial year.
(d) Credit risk
Credit risk is the risk of financial loss to the Group if a customer or counterparty to a financial instrument fails to meet its contractual 
obligations, and arises principally from the Group’s trade receivables, its cash advances to customers, cash (including deposits with banks) 
and derivative financial instruments contracted with banks. The Group has an indirect exposure to European Sovereigns via its defined 
benefit pension scheme investment portfolio. In the context of the Group’s operations, credit risk is mainly influenced by the individual 
characteristics of individual counterparties and is not considered particularly concentrated as it primarily arises from a wide and varied 
customer base; there are no material dependencies or concentrations of individual customers which would warrant disclosure under IFRS 
8 Operating Segments.
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
252
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

The Group has detailed procedures for monitoring and managing the credit risk related to its trade receivables and advances to customers 
based on experience, customer track records and historic default rates and forward-looking information, such as concentration maturity 
and the macroeconomic circumstances within the Group’s primary trading markets. 
Generally, individual ‘risk limits’ are set on a customer-by-customer basis and risk is only accepted above such limits in defined 
circumstances. A strict credit assessment is made of all new applicants who request credit-trading terms. The utilisation and revision, 
where appropriate, of credit limits is regularly monitored. Impairment provision accounts are used to record impairment losses unless the 
Group is satisfied that no recovery of the amount owing is possible. At that point, the amount is considered irrecoverable and is written 
off directly against the trade receivable or advance to customer. The Group also manages credit risk through the use of a receivables 
purchase arrangement, for an element of its trade receivables. Under the terms of this arrangement, the Group transfers the credit risk, late 
payment risk and control of the receivables sold. As at 29 February 2024, the Group’s year end cash had benefited by €105.9m (FY2023: 
€94.1m) with respect to this purchase arrangement. The Group’s trade receivables purchase arrangement is not recognised on the 
Balance Sheet as it meets the de-recognition criteria under IFRS 9 Financial Instruments.
Advances to customers are generally secured by, amongst others, rights over property or intangible assets, such as the right to take 
possession of the premises of the customer. During the financial year, the Group did not exercise its right to take possession of any 
material collateral that would require disclosure. At 29 February 2024, the Group held collateral of €0.8m (FY2023: €0.8m) on financial 
assets that are credit impaired and recognised no expected credit loss on financial assets of €18.5m (FY2023: €7.2m) due to collateral.
Interest rates calculated on repayment/annuity advances are generally based on the risk-free rate plus a margin, which takes into account 
the risk profile of the customer and value of security given. The Group establishes an allowance for impairment of customer’s advances 
that represents its estimate of potential future losses. 
From time to time, the Group holds significant cash balances, which are invested on a short-term basis and disclosed under cash in the 
Consolidated Balance Sheet. Risk of counterparty default arising on short-term cash deposits is controlled within a framework of dealing 
primarily with banks who are members of the Group’s banking syndicate, and by limiting the credit exposure to any one of these banks or 
institutions. Management does not expect any counterparty to fail to meet its obligations.
The Company also bears credit risk in relation to amounts owed by Group undertakings and from guarantees provided in respect of the 
liabilities of wholly owned subsidiaries as disclosed in note 28.
The carrying amount of financial assets, net of impairment provisions represents the maximum credit exposure. The maximum exposure to 
credit risk at the reporting date was:
Group
Company
2024
2023
(restated)
2024
2023
(restated)
€m
€m
€m
€m
Trade receivables
120.3
125.3
-
-
Advances to customers
39.1
42.6
-
-
Amounts due from Group undertakings
-
-
611.2
284.5
Cash 
160.1
115.3
0.3
0.2
 
319.5
283.2
611.5
284.7
 
The ageing of trade receivables and advances to customers together with an analysis of movement in the Group’s impairment provisions 
against these receivables are disclosed in note 15. The Group does not have any significant concentrations of risk.
24. FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT (continued)
253
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

24. FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT (continued)
(e) Liquidity risk
Liquidity risk is the risk that the Group or Company will not be able to meet its financial obligations as they fall due. 
 
The Group’s policy is to ensure that sufficient resources are available either from cash balances, cash flows or committed bank facilities 
to meet all debt obligations as they fall due. To achieve this, the Group (a) maintains adequate cash balances; (b) prepares detailed cash 
projections; and (c) keeps refinancing options under review. In addition, the Group maintains an overdraft facility that is unsecured. 
Cash and liquidity have continued to be a key focus for the Group throughout FY2024. 
In March 2020, the Group completed the successful issue of the new USPP notes. The unsecured notes, denominated in both Euro and 
Sterling, have maturities of 10 and 12 years and diversify the Group’s sources of debt finance. 
The Group successfully negotiated and completed a refinancing of the current multi-currency facility agreement which was repayable in 
a single instalment in May 2023 following the announcement of the Group’s FY2023 Results, at which point the new facility began. The 
Group has entered into a new five-year committed sustainability-linked facility comprised of a €250m multi-currency revolving loan facility 
and a €100m non-amortising Euro term loan, both with a maturity of FY2028. The facility offers optionality of two 1-year extensions to 
the maturity date callable within 12 months and 24 months of initial drawdown respectively. The facility was successfully extended for 1 
year bringing maturity date of €250m multi-currency revolving loan facility and a €100m non-amortising Euro term loan to January 2029 
(FY2029). Both the multi-currency facility and the Euro term loan were negotiated with six banks, namely ABN Amro Bank, Allied Irish Bank, 
Bank of Ireland, Barclays Bank, HSBC and Rabobank.
The multi-currency revolving facilities agreement provides for a further €100m in the form of an uncommitted accordion facility. At 29 
February 2024 the Group had €120.0m drawn down from the term loan and multi-currency revolving facilities (FY2023: €95.0m), €101.6m 
drawn down from Private Placement notes (FY2023: €100.6m) and €nil from its non-bank financial indebtedness. 
The Company and Group had no financial indebtedness in the form of non-bank debt. 
All bank loans drawn are unsecured and rank pari passu. All borrowings of the Group are guaranteed by a number of the Group’s 
subsidiary undertakings. The Euro term loan and multi-currency facilities agreement allows the early repayment of debt without incurring 
additional charges or penalties. The USPP allows the early prepayment of the notes at any time subject to the payment of a make whole 
amount to compensate the note holders for the interest that would have been received on the notes had they not been prepaid early. 
All borrowings of the Company and Group at 29 February 2024 are repayable in full on change of control of the Group. 
The Company and the Group complied with all covenants at each reporting date in the current and prior financial year. There is no effect 
on the Group’s covenants as a result of implementing IFRS 16 Leases in FY2020 as all covenants are calculated on a pre-IFRS 16 Leases 
adoption basis. 
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
254
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

The following are the contractual maturities of financial liabilities, including interest payments:
Carrying amount
Contractual cash 
flows
6 months or less
6 – 12 months
1 – 2 years
Greater than 2 
years
€m
€m
€m
€m
 €m
€m
Group
2024
Interest bearing loans & borrowings
(218.0)**
(279.3)
(5.9)
(5.9)
(11.7)
(255.8)
Trade & other payables 
(345.3)
(345.3)
(345.3)
-
-
-
Lease liabilities
(110.1)
(138.9)
(11.3)
(13.0)
(22.3)
(92.3)
Provisions
(10.1)
(11.5)
(0.8)
(0.9)
(5.7)
(4.7)
Financial liabilities
(6.8)
(6.8)
-
(0.7)
(0.7)
(5.4)
Total contracted outflows
(690.3)
(781.8)
(363.3)
(20.5)
(40.4)
(358.2)
Group
2023
Interest bearing loans & borrowings
(194.2)
(243.4)
0.1
(4.3)
(9.3)
(229.9)
Trade & other payables (restated)*
(314.4) 
(314.4) 
(314.4)
-
-
-
Lease liabilities (restated)*
(76.6)
(86.8)
(12.0)
(8.4)
(16.4)
(50.0)
Provisions (restated)*
(22.5)
(22.5)
(3.6)
(1.7)
(0.3)
(16.9)
Total contracted outflows (restated)*
(607.7)
(667.1)
(329.9)
(14.4)
(26.0)
(296.8)
* In the year ended 29 February 2024, the Group restated the prior year financial information. Details of the restatement are contained in note 31.
** Unamortised borrowing costs of €0.7m are presented within financial assets, please see notes 20 & 24.
Company
2024
Interest bearing loans & borrowings (restated)
(101.0)*
(120.1)
(1.9)
(1.9)
(3.8)
(112.5)
Amounts due to Group undertakings
(50.2)
(50.2)
(50.2)
-
-
-
Accruals 
(2.1)
(2.1)
(2.1)
-
-
-
Total contracted outflows
(153.3)
(172.4)
(54.2)
(1.9)
(3.8)
(112.5)
2023
Interest bearing loans & borrowings
(98.9)
(121.0)
(1.9)
(1.9)
(3.7)
(113.5)
Amounts due to Group undertakings
(53.6) 
(53.6) 
(53.6) 
-
-
-
Accruals
(2.0) 
(2.0) 
(2.0) 
-
-
-
Total contracted outflows
(154.5)
(176.6)
(57.5)
(1.9)
(3.7)
(113.5)
* Unamortised borrowing costs of €0.1m are presented within financial assets, please see notes 20 & 24.
25. FINANCIAL LIABILITIES
Contractual financial liabilities
Total
2024
2024
€m
€m
Charged during the year
6.8
6.8
At end of year
6.8
6.8
Classified within:
Current liabilities
1.0
Non-current liabilities
5.8
 
6.8
24. FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT (continued)
255
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

25. FINANCIAL LIABILITIES (continued)
During the current financial year, the Group identified errors which resulted in the recognition of a €12.2m charge in the prior period (notes 
5 & 31) to reflect the decision that the Group’s future obligations with its bittersweet apple suppliers under existing long-term contractual 
arrangements in accordance with IFRS 9 Financial Instruments and IAS 37 Provisions, Contingent Liabilities and Contingent Assets 
constituted onerous contracts. These contracts have been recognised at present value in accordance with IAS 37 as the Group does not 
expect to receive any economic benefit from the remaining duration of the contracts. During the current period the Group made an offer to 
settle these contracts and accordingly €6.8m has been reclassified as a financial liability and initially recognised at fair value based on the 
present value of the future payments, in accordance with IFRS 9 – the balance of €3.4m is classified as an onerous contract (note 18).
Key assumption used in calculating the value of the financial liability:  
The calculation of the financial liability value is most sensitive to the following assumption:
•	 The discount rate is used is the risk-free-rate as calculated by external advisors. The discount rate used was 4.1% and a 1% change in 
the discount rate would give rise to a €0.3m change in the value of the financial liability.
26. SHARE CAPITAL AND RESERVES
Authorised
Allotted and 
called up
Authorised
Allotted and 
called up
Number
Number
€m
€m
At 29 February 2024
Ordinary shares of €0.01 each
800,000,000
402,708,890*
8.0
4.0
At 28 February 2023
Ordinary shares of €0.01 each
800,000,000
402,007,212**
8.0
4.0
At 28 February 2022
Ordinary shares of €0.01 each
800,000,000
401,913,690***
8.0
4.0
*	
Inclusive of 11.2m (3%) treasury shares.
**	 Inclusive of 11.0m (3%) treasury shares.
***	 Inclusive of 11.3m (3%) treasury shares.
 
All shares in issue carry equal voting and dividend rights. 
Reserves
Group
Allotted and called-up
Ordinary Shares
2024
2023
‘000
‘000
As at 1 March
402,007
401,914
Shares issued in respect of options exercised
702
93
As at 29/28 February 
402,709*
402,007*
* 	
Includes 9.025m shares bought by the Group during the financial year ended 28 February 2015 which continue to be held as Treasury Shares and Ordinary Shares held by the 
Trustee of the Employee Trust as outlined below.
Ordinary Shares held by the 
Trustee of the Employee Trust and 
Partnership and Matching Share Scheme
Other Treasury Shares
Total Treasury Shares
No. of
shares
Consideration
Total
No. of
shares
Consideration
Total
No. of
shares
Consideration
Total
€
€m
€
€m
€
€m
As at 1 March 2023
1,989,883
6.7
9,025,000
29.7
11,014,883
36.4
Shares acquired in the open 
market 
386,630
1.29
0.5
-
-
-
386,630
1.29
   0.5
Shares disposed of or transferred 
to Participants 
(198,714)
3.21
(0.6)
-
-
-
 (198,714)
3.21
 (0.6)
As at 29 February 2024 
2,177,799
6.6
9,025,000
29.7 11,202,799
36.3
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
256
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Ordinary Shares held by the 
Trustee of the Employee Trust and 
Partnership and Matching Share Scheme
Other Treasury Shares
Total Treasury Shares
No. of shares
Consideration
Total
No. of shares
Consideration
Total
No. of shares
Consideration
Total
€
€m
€
€m
€
€m
As at 1 March 2022 - restated
2,256,622
8.2
9,025,000
29.7
11,281,622
37.9
Shares acquired in the open 
market - restated
292,859
1.71
0.5
-
-
-
292,859
1.71
0.5
Shares disposed of or transferred 
to Participants - restated
(559,598)
3.57
(2.0)
-
-
-
 (559,598)
3.57
 (2.0)
As at 28 February 2023 - restated
1,989,883
6.7
9,025,000
29.7
11,014,883
36.4 
Nominal value – Treasury Shares 
2024
2023
No. of shares 
Nominal Value 
Total 
No. of shares
(Restated) 
Nominal Value 
Total 
€
€
€
€
As at 1 March
11,014,883
0.01
110,146
11,281,622
0.01
112,816
Shares acquired in the open market
386,630
0.01
3,866
292,589
0.01
2,926
Shares disposed of or transferred to 
Participants
(198,714)
0.01
(1,987)
(559,598)
0.01
(5,596)
As at 29/28 February
11,202,799
0.01
112,025
11,014,883
0.01
110,146
Movements in the year ended 29 February 2024
All shares held by Kleinwort Benson (Guernsey) Trustees Limited as trustees of the C&C Employee Trust and Link Market Services 
Trustees Limited as trustees of the Partnership and Matching Share scheme which were neither cancelled nor disposed of by the Trust 
at 29 February 2024 continue to be included in the treasury share reserve. During the financial year, 198,714 shares were either sold or 
transferred by the Trustees and are no longer accounted for as treasury shares. 
Movements in the year ended 28 February 2023 
All shares held by Kleinwort Benson (Guernsey) Trustees Limited as trustees of the C&C Employee Trust and Link Market Services Trustees 
Limited as trustees of the Partnership and Matching Share scheme which were neither cancelled nor disposed of by the Trust at 28 
February 2023 continued to be included in the treasury share reserve. During the prior financial year, 559,598 shares were either sold or 
transferred by the Trustees and are no longer accounted for as treasury shares.
Share premium – Group
The change in legal parent of the Group on 30 April 2004, as disclosed in detail in that year’s annual report, was accounted for as a reverse 
acquisition. This transaction gave rise to a reverse acquisition reserve debit of €703.9m, which, for presentational purposes in the Group 
financial statements, has been netted against the share premium in the Balance Sheet. 
Share premium – Company
The share premium, as stated in the Company Balance Sheet, represents the premium recognised on shares issued and amounts to 
€1,048.2m as at 29 February 2024 (FY2023: €1,048.2m). 
Other undenominated reserve and capital reserve
These reserves initially arose on the conversion of preference shares into share capital of the Company and other changes and 
reorganisations of the Group’s capital structure. 
Cash flow hedge reserve
The hedging reserve includes the effective portion of the cumulative net change in the fair value of cash flow hedging instruments related to 
hedged transactions that have not yet occurred.
Share-based payment reserve
The reserve relates to amounts expensed in the Income Statement in connection with share option grants falling within the scope of IFRS 
2 Share-Based Payment, less reclassifications to retained income following exercise/forfeit post vesting or lapse of such share options and 
interests, as set out in note 4.
26. SHARE CAPITAL AND RESERVES (continued)
257
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Currency translation reserve 
The translation reserve comprises all foreign exchange differences from 1 March 2004, arising from the translation of the Group’s net 
investment in its non-Euro denominated operations, including the translation of the profits of such operations from the average exchange 
rate for the year to the exchange rate at the Balance Sheet date, as adjusted for the translation of foreign currency borrowings designated 
as net investment hedges and long-term intra group loans for which settlement is neither planned nor likely to happen in the foreseeable 
future, and as a consequence are deemed quasi equity in nature and are therefore part of the Group’s net investment in foreign operations.
Revaluation reserve
Since 2009 the Group has completed a number of external and internal valuations on its property, plant and equipment. Gains arising from 
such revaluations are posted to the Group’s revaluation reserve, unless it reverses a revaluation decrease on the same asset previously 
recognised as an expense, where it is first credited to the Income Statement to the extent of the write down. Any decreases in the value 
of the Group’s property, plant and equipment as a result of external or internal valuations are recognised in the Income Statement except 
where there had been a previously recognised gain in the revaluation reserve as a result of the same asset, in which case, the gain is 
eliminated from the revaluation reserve to offset the loss in the first instance.
During the current financial year, as outlined in detail in note 11, the Group engaged external valuers to value the freehold land & buildings 
and plant & machinery at the Group’s Clonmel (Tipperary), Wellpark (Glasgow) and Portugal sites. Using the valuation methodologies, this 
resulted in a net revaluation gain of €0.2m accounted for within the revaluation reserve via Other Comprehensive Income. 
During the prior financial year, as outlined in detail in note 11, the Group engaged external valuers to value the freehold land & buildings 
and plant & machinery at the Group’s Clonmel (Tipperary), Wellpark (Glasgow) and Portugal sites. Using the valuation methodologies, this 
resulted in a net revaluation loss of €0.7m accounted for within the revaluation reserve via Other Comprehensive Income.
 
Treasury shares
Included in this reserve is where the Company issued equity share capital under its Joint Share Ownership Plan, which was held in trust 
by the Group’s Employee Trust. All interests have now vested or lapsed and all vested interests have now been exercised. Remaining in 
the Trust are shares that lapsed and shares that were withheld by the Trust in lieu of some, or all, of the consideration due with respect to 
exercised interests. Also included in the reserve is the purchase of 9,025,000 of the Company’s own shares in the financial year ended 28 
February 2015 at an average price of €3.29 per share under the Group’s share buyback programme. 
The current and prior year movement in the reserve relates to the sale of excess shares and purchases in the open market by the Trust to 
satisfy other share entitlements. 
Capital management
The Board’s policy is to maintain a strong capital base so as to safeguard the Group’s ability to: continue as a going concern for the benefit 
of Shareholders and stakeholders; maintain investor, creditor and market confidence; and sustain the future development of the business 
through the optimisation of the value of its debt and equity shareholding balance. 
 
The Board considers capital to comprise of long-term debt and equity. The Board periodically reviews the capital structure of the Group, 
considering the cost of capital and the risks associated with each class of capital. The Board approves any material adjustments to the 
capital structure in terms of the relative proportions of debt and equity. In order to maintain or adjust the capital structure, the Group may 
issue new shares, dispose of assets to reduce debt, alter dividend policy by increasing or reducing the dividend paid to Shareholders, 
return capital to Shareholders and/or buyback shares. 
Please refer to note 20 for details of the Group’s loans and borrowings. 
Subject to Shareholder approval at the Annual General Meeting, the Directors have proposed a final dividend of 3.97 cent per share to 
be paid on 23 August 2024 to ordinary Shareholders registered at the close of business on 19 July 2024. An interim dividend of 1.89 cent 
per share was paid with respect to FY2024; therefore, the Group’s full year dividend will amount to 5.86 cent per share. There is no scrip 
dividend alternative. Total dividends for the prior financial year were 3.79 cent per share. 
In the financial year ended 28 February 2015, a subsidiary of the Group invested €30.0m as part of an on-market share buyback 
programme, purchasing 9,025,000 of the Company’s shares at an average price of €3.29. All shares acquired as part of this share 
buyback programme are held as Treasury shares. 
26. SHARE CAPITAL AND RESERVES (continued)
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
258
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

27. COMMITMENTS
(a) Capital commitments
At the year end, the following capital commitments authorised by the Board had not been provided for in the consolidated financial 
statements:
2024
2023
€m
€m
Contracted
6.3
5.3
Not contracted
17.7
13.7
 
24.0
19.0
 
The contracted capital commitments at 29 February 2024 are with respect of contracts that support the Group in achieving its 
environmental targets and optimising its operational footprint. 
(b) Other commitments
At the year end, the value of contracts placed for future expenditure was:
2024
Apples
Glass
Marketing
Barley & 
Sugar
Aluminium Gas & Electricity
Total
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
Payable in less than one year
1.6
2.7
4.3
7.9
0.7
1.8
19.0
Payable between 1 and 5 years
5.3
-
4.5
-
-
-
9.8
Payable greater than 5 years
4.1
-
-
-
-
-
4.1
11.0
2.7
8.8
7.9
0.7
1.8
32.9
Contingent Liabilities and Contingent Assets as described in notes 5, 18 and 25.
2023
Apples
Glass
Marketing
Barley & 
Sugar**
Aluminium Gas & Electricity
Total*
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
€m
Payable in less than one year
3.1
3.0
3.5
-
0.4
-
10.0
Payable between 1 and 5 years
3.4
-
4.5
-
-
0.2
8.1
Payable greater than 5 years
6.7
-
-
-
-
-
6.7
13.2
3.0
8.0
-
0.4
0.2
24.8
* 	
Commitment obligations range from between 1 year to 23 years.
**	 The commitments with respect to Barley were revised downwards to nil due to the favourable change in the open market price and consequently the option for the Group to 
resell its commitment to the market.
Where the Group has hedged an input cost, but a market exists for the Group to resell that input cost in the open market, then the Group 
does not classify that as a commitment.
 
28. GUARANTEES AND CONTINGENCIES
Where the Group or subsidiaries enter into financial guarantee contracts to guarantee the indebtedness of other companies or joint 
ventures and associates within the Group, the Group/subsidiary treats the guarantee contract as a financial liability.
As outlined in note 20, the Group has US Private Placement notes and a multi-currency revolving facility in place at year end. The Company 
has US Private Placement notes in place at year end. The Company, together with a number of its subsidiaries, gave a letter of guarantee 
to secure its obligations in respect of all borrowings as at 29 February 2024. The actual loans outstanding for the Group at 29 February 
2024 amounted to €221.8m (FY2023: €195.6m). 
259
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

During the financial year ended 28 February 2015, a subsidiary of the Group entered into guarantees in favour of HSBC Bank plc, HSBC 
Asset Finance (UK) Limited and HSBC Equipment Finance Limited whereby it guaranteed drawn debt plus interest charges by Drygate 
Brewing Company Limited to HSBC Bank plc of up to £540,000 and to HSBC Asset Finance (UK) Limited and HSBC Equipment Finance 
Limited of up to £225,000 in aggregate. The guarantees reduce on a pound-for-pound basis to the extent of capital repayments in respect 
of the drawn debt and any amounts realised by the bank pursuant to any security provided in respect of the debt. The Guarantee with 
respect to HSBC Bank plc expires on the earlier of eleven years and three months from the date on which the guarantee became effective, 
the secured liabilities are repaid, or by mutual agreement with HSBC Bank plc. The Guarantees with HSBC Asset Finance (UK) Limited and 
HSBC Equipment Finance Limited expire after the secured liabilities are repaid, or by mutual agreement with HSBC Asset Finance (UK) 
Limited and HSBC Equipment Finance Limited respectively.
The resolution of uncertain tax positions, including those arising from ongoing Irish Revenue tax reviews, could vary from what the 
Company and its subsidiaries has assumed, which could have an adverse effect on the business.
Pursuant to the provisions of Section 357 of the Companies Act 2014, the Company has guaranteed commitments entered into and 
liabilities of certain of its subsidiary undertakings incorporated in the Republic of Ireland for the financial year to 29 February 2024 and as a 
result such subsidiaries are exempt from certain filing provisions. 
29. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS 
The principal related party relationships requiring disclosure in the consolidated financial statements of the Group under IAS 24 Related 
Party Disclosures pertain to the existence of subsidiary undertakings and equity accounted investments, transactions entered into by the 
Group with these subsidiary undertakings and equity accounted investments and the identification and compensation of and transactions 
with key management personnel.
(a) Group
Transactions 
Transactions between the Group and its related parties are made on terms equivalent to those that prevail in arm’s length transactions.
Subsidiary undertakings
The consolidated financial statements include the financial statements of the Company and its subsidiaries. A listing of all subsidiaries 
is provided in note 30. Sales to and purchases from subsidiary undertakings, together with outstanding payables and receivables, are 
eliminated in the preparation of the consolidated financial statements in accordance with IFRS 10 Consolidated Financial Statements. 
Equity accounted investments
See note 13 for details on equity accounted investments. 
Loans extended by the Group to equity accounted investments are considered trading in nature and are included within advances to 
customers in trade & other receivables (note 15).
Details of transactions with equity accounted investments during the year and related outstanding balances at the year end are as follows:
Joint ventures
Associates
2024
2023
2024
2023
€m
€m
€m
€m
Net revenue
1.0
0.4
0.5
0.3
Trade & other receivables
1.4
0.5
-
-
Purchases
1.5
0.7
0.7
0.6
Trade & other payables
0.1
0.1
-
0.1
Loans
1.2
1.3
0.6
0.7
 
All outstanding trading balances with equity accounted investments, which arose from arm’s length transactions, are to be settled in cash 
within 60 days of the reporting date. 
28. GUARANTEES AND CONTINGENCIES (continued)
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
260
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Key management personnel 
For the purposes of the disclosure requirements of IAS 24 Related Party Disclosures, the Group has defined the term ‘key management 
personnel’, as its Executive and Non-Executive Directors. Executive Directors participate in the Group’s equity share award schemes (note 
4) and are covered for death in service by an insurance policy. Executive Directors may also benefit from medical insurance under a Group 
policy (or the Group offers a cash alternative). No other non-cash benefits are provided. Non-Executive Directors do not receive share-
based payments nor post-employment benefits.
Details of key management remuneration, charged to the Income Statement, are as follows:
2024
2023
(restated)
Number
Number
Number of individuals
9
9
 
€m
€m
Salaries and other short-term employee benefits
3.0
2.0
Post-employment benefits
0.1
0.1
Equity settled share-based payment charge and related dividend accrual
0.4
1.0
Pay in lieu of notice* 
0.7
-
Total 
4.2
3.1
* David Forde received a payment on termination of his employment of €1,895,556 including €723,690 in lieu of notice.
During the current and prior financial year, there were no transactions or balances between the Group and its key management personnel 
or members of their close family apart from:
•	 The Group sells inventory to St Austell Brewery Company Limited, of which Jill Caseberry is a Non-Executive Director; 
All transactions with related parties involve the normal supply of goods or services and are priced on an arm’s length basis.
For the purposes of the Section 305 of the Companies Act 2014, the aggregate gains by Directors on the exercise of share options during 
FY2024 was €nil (FY2023: €nil).
(b) Company
The Company has a related party relationship with its subsidiary undertakings. Details of the transactions in the year between the 
Company and its subsidiary undertakings are as follows:
2024
2023
€m
€m
Dividend income
363.1
219.9
Expenses paid on behalf of and recharged by subsidiary undertakings to the Company 
(4.5)
(3.2) 
Equity settled share-based payments for employees of subsidiary undertakings
1.4
2.1
Injection of cash funding and other movements with subsidiary undertakings
 (25.9)
(52.8) 
 
29. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS  (continued)
261
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

30. SUBSIDIARIES AND EQUITY ACCOUNTED INVESTMENTS 
Notes
Nature of business
Class of shares held as at 29 February 2024
(100% unless stated)
Trading subsidiaries
Incorporated and registered in Republic of Ireland
Bulmers Limited
(a) (l)
Cider
Ordinary
C&C Financing DAC
(b) (l) (m)
Financing company
Ordinary
C&C Group International Holdings Limited
(a) (l) (m)
Holding company
Ordinary & Convertible 
C&C Group Irish Holdings Limited
(a) (l) 
Holding company
Ordinary
C&C Group Sterling Holdings Limited
(b) (l)
Holding company
Ordinary
C&C (Holdings) Limited
(a) (l)
Holding company
Ordinary
C&C Management Services Limited
(a) (l)
Provision of management 
services
6% Cumulative Preference, 
5% Second Non-Cumulative 
Preference & Ordinary Stock 
C&C Finco Limited
(b) (l) (m)
Financing company 
Ordinary 
Cantrell & Cochrane Limited
(a) (l)
Holding company
Ordinary
Latin American Holdings Limited
(b) (l) (k)
Holding company
Ordinary
M&J Gleeson & Co Unlimited Company
(b) (l)
Wholesale of drinks
Ordinary
M.& J. Gleeson (Investments) Limited
(b) (l)
Non-trading
Ordinary
Tennent’s Beer Limited 
(a) (l)
Beer 
Ordinary
The Annerville Financing Company Unlimited 
Company
(a) (l)
Financing company
Ordinary
The Five Lamps Dublin Beer Company Limited
(b) (l)
Beer 
Ordinary 
Wm. Magner Limited
(a) (l)
Cider
Ordinary
Wm. Magner (Trading) Limited
(a) (l)
Financing company 
Ordinary
Incorporated and registered in Northern Ireland
C&C Holdings (NI) Limited 
(c)
Holding company
Ordinary
Gleeson N.I. Limited(c)
Wholesale of drinks
Ordinary
Tennent’s NI Limited
(c)
Cider and beer 
Ordinary & 3.25% Cumulative 
Preference
Incorporated and registered in England and Wales
Bibendum Group Limited 
(j)
Holding company
Ordinary
Bibendum PLB (Topco) Limited
(i) 
Holding company
Ordinary
C&C Management Services (UK) Limited
(i)
Provision of management 
services
Ordinary
Magners GB Limited
(i)
Cider and beer 
Ordinary
Matthew Clark Bibendum (Holdings) Limited 
(i) 
Holding company 
Ordinary 
Matthew Clark Bibendum Limited 
(i)
Wholesale of drinks
Ordinary
Bibendum Off Trade Limited 
(j) 
Wholesale of drinks
Ordinary 
The Orchard Pig Limited
(i)
Cider
Ordinary 
Walker & Wodehouse Wines Limited 
(j)
Wine
Ordinary 
C&C IP UK Limited 
(i)
Licensing activity 
Ordinary
The Wondering Wine Company Limited
(i)
Wine 
Ordinary 
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
262
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Notes
Nature of business
Class of shares held as at 29 February 2024
(100% unless stated)
Incorporated and registered in Scotland
Badaboom Limited
(d)
Marketing
Ordinary 
Macrocom (1018) Limited
(d)
Investment
Ordinary 
Tennent Caledonian Breweries UK Limited
(d)
Beer and cider
Ordinary
Tennent Caledonian Breweries Wholesale Limited 
(d)
Wholesale of drinks
Ordinary
Wallaces Express Limited
(d)
Holding company
Ordinary
Wellpark Financing Limited
(d)
Financing company
Ordinary
Incorporated and registered in Luxembourg
C&C IP Sàrl
(e)
Licensing activity
Class A to J Units
C&C IP (No. 2) Sàrl
(e)
Licensing activity
Class A to J Units
C&C Luxembourg Sàrl
(e)
Holding and financing 
company
Class A to J Units
Incorporated and registered Portugal
Frutíssima - Concentrados de Frutos da Cova da 
Beira, Lda 
(f) (k)
Ingredients
Ordinary
Frontierlicious Limitada
(f) (k)
Orchard management
Ordinary
Incredible Prosperity Limitada
(f) (k)
Orchard management
Ordinary
Incorporated and registered in Delaware, US 
Vermont Hard Cider Company Holdings, Inc.
(g)
Holding company 
Common Stock
Wm. Magner, Inc.
(g)
Cider 
Common Stock
Non-trading subsidiaries
Incorporated and registered in Republic of 
Ireland
C&C Brands Limited 
(a) (l)
Non-trading
Ordinary
C&C Group Pension Trust Limited
(a) (l)
Non-trading
Ordinary
C&C Profit Sharing Trustee Limited
(a) (l)
Non-trading
Ordinary
Ciscan Net Limited
(a) (l)
Non-trading
Ordinary & A Ordinary
Cravenby Limited
(a) (l)
Non-trading
Ordinary
Dowd’s Lane Brewing Company Limited 
(a) (l)
Non-trading
Ordinary
Findlater (Wine Merchants) Limited
(a) (l)
Non-trading
Ordinary & A Ordinary
Fruit of the Vine Limited
(a) (l)
Non-trading
Ordinary
Gleeson Wines & Spirits Limited
(b) (l) (h)
Non-trading
Ordinary
30. SUBSIDIARIES AND EQUITY ACCOUNTED INVESTMENTS (continued)
263
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

30. SUBSIDIARIES AND EQUITY ACCOUNTED INVESTMENTS (continued)
Notes
Nature of business
Class of shares held as at 29 February 2024
(100% unless stated)
Greensleeves Confectionery Limited
(b) (l)
(h)
Non-trading
Ordinary, 12% Cumulative 
Convertible Redeemable 
Preference & 3% Cumulative 
Redeemable Convertible 
Preference
M&J Gleeson Nominees Limited 
(b) (l)
Non-trading
Ordinary & Preference
M and J Gleeson (Manufacturing) Company 
Holdings Limited
(b) (l)
Non-trading
Ordinary & Non-Voting Ordinary
M and J Gleeson and Company Holdings Limited
(b) (l)
Non-trading
Ordinary
Magners Irish Cider Limited
(a) (l)
Non-trading
Ordinary
Sceptis Limited (in liquidation)
(a) (l) (h)
Non-trading
Ordinary
Showerings (Ireland) Limited
(a) (l)
Non-trading
Ordinary
Thwaites Limited
(a) (l)
Non-trading
A & B Ordinary
Tipperary Natural Mineral Water Company Holdings 
Limited
(b) (l) (h)
Non-trading
Ordinary
Tipperary Natural Mineral Water (Sales) Holdings 
Limited
(b) (l)
Non-trading
Ordinary
Tipperary Pure Irish Water Unlimited Company
(a) (l) (h)
Non-trading
Ordinary
Incorporated and registered in Northern Ireland
C&C Profit Sharing Trustee (NI) Limited
(c)
Non-trading
Ordinary
Incorporated and registered in England and 
Wales
A2 Contractors Limited
(i) (n)
Non-trading
Ordinary
Bibendum Wine Limited
(j) (n)
Non-trading
Ordinary
Gaymer Cider Company Limited
(i)
Non-trading
Ordinary
Mixbury Drinks Limited
(i) (n)
Non-trading
Ordinary 
Notes (a) – (n) 
The address of the registered office of each of the above companies and notes is as follows:
(a)	 	 Annerville, Clonmel, Co. Tipperary, E91 NY79, Ireland.
(b)	 	 Bulmers House, Keeper Road, Crumlin, Dublin 12, D12 K702, Ireland.
(c)	 	 6 Aghnatrisk Road, Culcavy, Hillsborough, Co Down, BT26 6JJ, United Kingdom.
(d)	 	 Wellpark Brewery, 161 Duke Street, Glasgow, G31 1JD, United Kingdom.
(e)	 	 L-2132 Luxembourg, 18 Avenue Marie-Therese, Luxembourg.
(f)	 	 Quinta Da Ferreira De Baxio, Castelo Branco, Fundão Parish, 6230 610 Salgueiro, Portugal.
(g)	 	 2711 Centerville Road, Suite 400, Wilmington, Delaware 19808, US.
(h)	 	 Dissolved after the year ended 29 February 2024. 
(i)	 	 Pavilion 2, The Pavilions, Bridgwater Road, Bristol, BS99 6ZZ, United Kingdom.
(j)	 	 109A Regents Park Road, London, NW1 8UR, United Kingdom.
(k)	 	 Classified as held for sale at 29 February 2024. 
(l)	 	 Companies covered by Section 357, Companies Act 2014 guarantees (note 28). 
(m)	 	 Immediate subsidiary of C&C Group plc.
(n)	 	 Entities that have availed of the audit exemption set out within Section 479A of the Companies Act 2006.
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
264
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Equity accounted investments
Notes
Nature of business
Class of share held as at 29 February 2024
Joint venture
Beck & Scott (Services) Limited (Northern Ireland)
(a)
Wholesale of drinks 
Ordinary, 50%
Drygate Brewing Company Limited (Scotland)
(c)
Brewing 
B Ordinary, 49%
The Irish Brewing Company Limited (Ireland)
(d)
Non-trading
Ordinary, 45.61%
Associate
Braxatorium Parcensis CVBA (Belgium)
(f)
Brewing
33.33%
Shanter Inns Limited (Scotland)
(g)
Public houses
Ordinary, 33%
Whitewater Brewing Co. Limited (Northern Ireland)
(h)
Brewing
Ordinary, 25%
Financial asset
Jubel Limited (England and Wales)
(i)
Brewing
Ordinary, 8.4%
Innis & Gunn Holdings Limited (Scotland)
(e)
Brewing
8%
Bramerton Condiments Limited (England & Wales)
(b)
Food and beverage
Ordinary, 0.5%
Notes: (a) – (i) 
The address of the registered office of each of the above equity accounted investments is as follows:
(a)	 	 Unit 1, Ravenhill Business Park, Ravenhill Road, Belfast, BT6 8AW, United Kingdom. 
(b)	 	 25 Farringdon Street, London, EC4A 4AB, United Kingdom. 
(c) 	 	 85 Drygate, Glasgow, G4 0UT, United Kingdom.
(d) 		 Bulmers House, Keeper Road, Crumlin, DubIin 12, D12 K702, Ireland.
(e)	 	 Orchard Brae House, 30 Queensferry Road, Edinburgh, EH4 2HS, United Kingdom.
(f)	 	 3001 Leuven-Heverlee, Abdij van Park 7, Belgium.
(g)	 	 230 High Street, Ayr, KA7 1RQ, United Kingdom.
(h)	 	 3a Clarkill Road, Castlewellan, BT31 9BJ, United Kingdom.
(i)	 	 Office 311, Edinburgh House, 170 Kennington Lane, London, SE11 5DP, United Kingdom.
30. SUBSIDIARIES AND EQUITY ACCOUNTED INVESTMENTS (continued)
265
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

31. PRIOR YEAR RESTATEMENTS
In the year ended 29 February 2024, the Group restated the prior year financial information. The impact of these restatements is 
summarised below:
Impact on the Consolidated Income Statement for the year ended 28 February 2023
2023 (previously published)
Adjustments
2023 (restated)
Before 
exceptional 
items
Exceptional 
items
Total
Before 
exceptional 
items 
Exceptional 
items
Total
Before 
exceptional 
items
Exceptional 
items
Total
 
 €m
€m
€m
 €m
€m
€m
 €m
€m
€m
Revenue
2,060.7
-
2,060.7
3.1
-
3.1
2,063.8
-
2,063.8
Excise duties
(371.7)
-
(371.7)
(5.9)
- 
(5.9)
(377.6)
-
(377.6)
Net revenue
1,689.0
-
1,689.0
(2.8)
-
(2.8)
1,686.2
-
1,686.2
Operating costs
(1,604.9)
(0.2)
(1,605.1)
1.3
(12.2)
(10.9)
(1,603.6)
(12.4)
(1,616.0)
Group operating profit
84.1
(0.2)
83.9
(1.5)
(12.2)
(13.7)
82.6
(12.4)
70.2
Profit on disposal
-
1.1
1.1
-
-
-
-
1.1
1.1
Finance income
-
0.2
0.2
-
-
-
-
0.2
0.2
Finance expense
(17.3)
(2.0)
(19.3)
0.6
(0.6)
-
(16.7)
(2.6)
(19.3)
Profit before tax
66.8
(0.9)
65.9
(0.9)
(12.8)
(13.7)
65.9
(13.7)
52.2
Income tax expense
(14.2)
0.2
(14.0)
(0.2)
2.3
2.1
(14.4)
2.5
(11.9)
Group profit for the financial 
year
52.6
(0.7)
51.9
(1.1)
(10.5)
(11.6)
51.5
(11.2)
40.3
Impact on basic earnings per 
share (cent)
13.3
(3.0)
10.3
Impact on diluted earnings per 
share (cent)
13.2
(2.9)
10.3
Impact on the Consolidated Income Statement for the year ended 28 February 2023 (extract)
The table below shows the impact of the prior year restatements on the Consolidated Income Statement.
2023 (as 
published)
Adjustments 
2023 (restated)
€m
€m
€m
Group profit for the financial year
51.9
(11.6)
40.3
Total comprehensive income for the financial year*
37.7
(11.6)
26.1
*	
The table above includes only those financial statement line items which have been restated. The Total comprehensive income for the financial year does not therefore 
represent the sum of the line items presented above.
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
266
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Impact on the Consolidated Balance Sheet as at 1 March 2022 (extract)
1 March 2022  
(previously 
published)
Adjustments  
1 March 2022  
(restated)
€m
€m
€m
Non-current assets
Property, plant & equipment
214.0
3.3
217.3
Deferred tax assets
27.0
0.7
27.7
Total non-current assets*
983.7
4.0
987.7
Current assets
Inventories
168.2
(8.5)
159.7
Trade & other receivables
186.3
1.1
187.4
Total current assets*
485.0
(7.4)
477.6
TOTAL ASSETS
1,468.7
(3.4)
1,465.3
EQUITY
Capital and reserves
Treasury shares
(36.0)
(1.9)
(37.9)
Other reserves
98.3
1.3
99.6
Retained income
285.5
(4.3)
281.2
Total Equity*
699.0
(4.9)
694.1
LIABILITIES
Non-current liabilities
Lease liabilities
59.8
2.5
62.3
Deferred tax liabilities
30.2
0.1
30.3
Total non-current liabilities*
313.3
2.6
315.9
Current liabilities
Lease liabilities
20.2
0.5
20.7
Trade & other payables
386.1
(2.6)
383.5
Current income tax liabilities
5.2
1.0
6.2
 Total current liabilities*
456.4
(1.1)
455.3
Total liabilities*
769.7
1.5
771.2
TOTAL EQUITY & LIABILITIES
1,468.7
(3.4)
1,465.3
*	
The table above includes only those financial statement line items which have been restated. The total non-current assets, current assets, equity, non-current liabilities, current 
liabilities and total liabilities do not therefore represent the sum of the line items presented above.
31. PRIOR YEAR RESTATEMENTS (continued)
267
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

31. PRIOR YEAR RESTATEMENTS (continued)
Impact on the Consolidated Balance Sheet as at 28 February 2023 (extract)
28 February 2023  
(previously 
published)
Adjustments  28 February 2023 
(restated)
€m
€m
€m
Non-current assets
Property, plant & equipment
210.3
4.7
215.0
Goodwill & Intangibles
645.5
(1.4)
644.1
Deferred tax assets
25.0
1.3
26.3
Total non-current assets*
967.9
4.6
972.5
Current assets
Inventories
174.9
(12.2)
162.7
Trade & other receivables
164.1
(0.7)
163.4
Current income tax assets
0.7
0.3
1.0
Total current assets*
455.0
(12.6)
442.4
TOTAL ASSETS
1,422.9
(8.0)
1,414.9
EQUITY
Capital and reserves
Treasury shares
(34.1)
(2.3)
(36.4)
Other reserves
80.3
0.8
81.1
Retained income
341.8
(15.6)
326.2
Total Equity*
739.2
(17.1)
722.1
LIABILITIES
Non-current liabilities
Provisions
4.9
10.4
15.3
Lease liabilities
57.1
3.2
60.3
Deferred tax liabilities 
34.2
0.5
34.7
Total non-current liabilities*
196.2
14.1
210.3
Current liabilities
Lease liabilities
16.7
(0.4)
16.3
Trade & other payables
370.7
(5.9)
364.8
Provisions
5.4
1.8
7.2
Current income tax liabilities
0.5
(0.5)
-
Total current liabilities*
487.5
(5.0)
482.5
Total liabilities*
683.7
9.1
692.8
TOTAL EQUITY & LIABILITIES
1,422.9
(8.0)
1,414.9
*	
The table above includes only those financial statement line items which have been restated. The total non-current assets, current assets, equity, non-current liabilities, current 
liabilities and total liabilities do not therefore represent the sum of the line items presented above.
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
268
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Adjustments in respect of the Group
As noted earlier in this report, the Group has identified a number of accounting errors which have resulted in the restatement of results 
for the 1 March 2022 (FY2022) Consolidated Balance Sheet and 28 February 2023 (FY2023) reporting periods. These errors arose from 
mistakes and errors of judgement and an explanation of the individual items is given below:
(i)	 Property, plant and equipment (PPE) was understated by €3.3m at FY2022, of which €3.1m was in respect of leases for plant, 
machinery and equipment not capitalised correctly in accordance with IFRS 16. An additional €0.2m related to reclassification of pallets 
in Clonmel previously incorrectly recognised in inventory. At FY2023, PPE balances were understated by a cumulative €4.7m, of which 
€3.3m related to the leases and pallets noted previously for FY2022 and a further €1.4m arose from capitalised software costs that 
were misclassified as goodwill and intangibles. Accordingly, the goodwill and intangibles balances were previously overstated by an 
equivalent amount at FY2023.
(ii)	 Inventory at the Group’s Clonmel site was overstated cumulatively by €12.2m at FY2023 (FY2022: €8.5m). This overstatement arose 
from accounting errors and existence related issues in respect of cider concentrate, raw materials for use in cider production and 
pallets of €11.1m at FY2023 (FY2022: €8.5m) and the incorrect accounting treatment applied to inventory of branded glassware of 
€1.1m in FY2023 (FY2022: nil).
(iii)	 Trade and other receivable balances were understated by €1.1m at FY2022 due to incorrect accounting treatment applied to supplier 
incentive bonus payments. In FY2023, this balance was overstated by a net €0.7m which is comprised of the €1.1m understatement 
from FY2022, offset by an overstatement of prepayments, debtors and other receivables of €1.8m. In FY2023, this balance was 
overstated by a net €0.7m which is comprised of the €1.1m understatement from FY2022, offset by an overstatement of prepayments, 
debtors and other receivables of €1.8m. 
(iv)	 The Group’s Partnership and Matching Share Schemes in respect of UK and ROI employees were incorrectly accounted for as 
cash-settled schemes, whereas they should have been accounted for as equity settled schemes. This resulted in an understatement 
of Treasury shares of €2.3m at FY2023 (FY2022: €1.9m) and an understatement of other reserves of €0.8m (FY2022: €1.3m). The 
Retained income impact in FY2023 was €1.5m (FY2022: €0.6m).
(v)	 Lease liabilities were understated by €3.0m at FY2022 (non-current: €2.5m and current: €0.5m) and €2.8m at FY2023 (non-current: 
€3.2m offset by an overstatement in current: €0.4m) following the incorrect accounting treatment adopted in respect of the lease 
contracts. The Income Statement impact for FY2023 was €0.2m (FY2022: nil).   
(vi)	 Trade and other payable balances were overstated by €5.9m in FY2023 (FY2022: €2.6m). These overstatements resulted from errors of 
judgement applied in respect of accounting for goods received not invoiced (GRNI), customer discount liabilities, deferred income and 
other general accruals.  
(vii)	Provisions were understated in FY2023 by €12.2m (FY2022: nil) due to onerous contracts in respect of the Group’s suppliers of apples 
for use in cider production not being recognised in the appropriate accounting period (non-current: €10.4m and current: €1.8m). 
(viii)	Revenue was understated in FY2023 by €3.1m due to the incorrect timing of release of customer discount liabilities. 
(ix)	 Excise duties were understated by €5.9m in FY2023. This comprises a reclassification of duty charges, incorrectly included within 
operating costs, of €8.2m, offset by an over accrual of €2.3m.
(x)	 The tax impact of these adjustments at FY2023 was a credit of €2.1m. Included within this is a €1.5m credit and a reclassification of 
€0.6m to Finance expense. Deferred tax assets were understated by €1.3m at FY2023 (FY2022: €0.7m). Deferred tax liabilities were 
understated by €0.5m at FY2023 (FY2022: €0.1m). Current income tax assets were understated by €0.3m at FY2023 (FY2022: nil) and 
Current income tax liabilities were understated by €0.5m at FY2023 (FY2022: €1.0m).
(xi)	 The cumulative retained income impact of these adjustments resulted in a charge to the opening retained income position of €4.3m 
in FY2022 and a cumulative charge to retained income of €15.6m in FY2023. The impact on the consolidated Income Statement was 
€11.6m offset by €0.3m net recorded directly in Retained income.
31. PRIOR YEAR RESTATEMENTS (continued)
269
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

31. PRIOR YEAR RESTATEMENTS (continued)
Adjustments in respect of the Company
In the year ended 29 February 2024, the Company restated the prior year financial information. The impact of these restatements is 
summarised below:
Impact on the Company Balance Sheet as at 28 February 2023 (extract)
28 February 2023  
(previously 
published)
Adjustments (iii) 
28 February 2023 
(restated)
€m
€m
€m
Non-current assets
Financial assets
1,158.6
0.6
1,159.2
Total non-current assets*
1,158.6
0.6
1,159.2
Current assets
Trade & other receivables
285.1
(0.6)
284.5
Total current assets*
285.3
(0.6)
284.7
TOTAL ASSETS
1,443.9
-
1,443.9
EQUITY
Capital and reserves
Treasury Shares
-
(2.3)
(2.3)
Other Reserves
5.1
0.8
5.9
Retained income
231.8
1.8
233.6
Total Equity*
1,289.1
0.3
1,289.4
LIABILITIES
Non-current liabilities
Interest bearing loans & borrowings
100.0
(0.3)
99.7
Total non-current liabilities*
100.0
(0.3)
99.7
Total liabilities*
154.8
(0.3)
154.5
TOTAL EQUITY & LIABILITIES
1,443.9
-
1,443.9
*	
The table above includes only those financial statement line items which have been restated. The total non-current assets, current assets, equity, non-current liabilities and total 
liabilities do not therefore represent the sum of the line items presented above.
Notes forming part of the financial statements
(continued)
270
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

31. PRIOR YEAR RESTATEMENTS (continued)
Adjustments
During the current financial year the Company has identified a number of accounting errors which have resulted in the restatement of 
results for the FY2023 reporting period. These errors arose from accounting mistakes and errors of judgement and an explanation of the 
individual items is given below:
 
(i)	 The Group’s Partnership and Matching Share Schemes in respect of UK and ROI employees were incorrectly accounted for as cash-
settled schemes, whereas they should have been accounted for as equity settled schemes. This resulted in adjustments in FY2023 
of a €2.3m debit (FY2022: €1.9m debit) to correct the Treasury Share Reserve, €0.6m debit (FY2022: €0.3m debit) in Investments in 
Subsidiary as a result of capital contributions in respect of these equity settled awards and a €1.4m credit (FY2022: €1.3m credit) to 
correct the understatement of the Other Reserve. Retained earnings were credited €0.9m in respect of 1 March 2022 and operating 
costs were credited €0.6m in respect of FY2023.
(ii)	 The Group’s Long Term Incentive Plan accounted for as equity settled schemes are subject to performance conditions. The FY2023 
Other Reserve was restated to correct the component of these awards where the relevant performance condition was not achieved. 
This resulted in a €0.6m debit to Other Reserve and a credit to Trade & Other Receivables by an equivalent amount.
(iii)	  Capitalised advisory fees related to the issue of US Private Placement debt in previous periods were understated by €0.3m following 
errors made in the underlying amortisation calculations. This correction resulted in a €0.3m credit to profit and loss account in FY2023 
and a debit to Interest Bearing Loans & Borrowings (non-current) by an equivalent amount.
32. POST BALANCE SHEET EVENTS
On 7 June 2024, the Group’s Chief Executive Officer, Patrick McMahon, stepped down from the Board and Ralph Findlay, Chair of the 
Board was appointed to the role with immediate effect.
The Group has commenced its previously announced share buyback programme and from 1 March 2024 to 21 June 2024 has purchased 
7,653,323 shares in the open market at an average price of €190.16 cent per share, with the total buyback therefore amounting to €14.6m.
33. APPROVAL OF FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
These financial statements were approved by the Directors on 27 June 2024.
271
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Adjusted earnings
Profit for the year attributable to equity Shareholders as adjusted for exceptional items
CGU
Cash generating unit
CODM
Chief Operating Decision-Maker
Company
C&C Group plc
Constant Currency
Prior year revenue, net revenue and operating profit for each of the Group’s reporting segments is 
restated to constant exchange rates for transactions by subsidiary undertakings in currencies other 
than their functional currency and for translation in relation to the Group’s non-Euro denominated 
subsidiaries by revaluing the prior year figures using the current year average foreign currency rates 
DBT
Deferred Bonus Plan
DWT
Dividend Withholding Tax
EBITDA
Earnings before Interest, Tax, Depreciation and Amortisation charges excluding the Group’s share 
of equity accounted investments’ profit/(loss) after tax
Adjusted EBITDA
EBITDA as adjusted for exceptional items
EBIT
Earnings before Interest and Tax
Adjusted EBIT
EBIT as adjusted for exceptional items
Effective tax rate (%)
Income and deferred tax charges relating to continuing activities before the tax impact of 
exceptional items calculated as a percentage of profit before tax for continuing activities before 
exceptional items and excluding the Group’s share of equity accounted investments’ profit/(loss) 
after tax
EPS
Earnings per share
EU
European Union
Exceptional
Material items of income and expense within the Group results for the year which by virtue of their 
size or nature, and are non-recurring, are disclosed in the Income Statement and related notes as 
exceptional items
ESOS
Executive Share Option Scheme
Export
Sales in territories outside of Ireland, Great Britain and North America
Free Cash Flow
Free Cash Flow is a measure that comprises cash flow from operating activities net of capital
investment cash outflows which form part of investing activities. Free Cash Flow highlights the
underlying cash generating performance of the ongoing business
FRS 101
Financial Reporting Standard 101 Reduced Disclosure Framework
Functional currency
The currency of the primary economic environment in which the entity operates. The consolidated 
financial statements are presented in Euro, which is the presentation currency of the Group and 
both the presentation and functional currency of the Company
GB
Great Britain (i.e. England, Wales and Scotland).  
For the purposes of segmental reporting, GB includes all sales executed and managed outside the 
Island of Ireland.
Group
C&C Group plc and its subsidiaries
HL
Hectolitre (100 Litres)
kHL = kilo hectolitre (100,000 litres) 
mHL = millions of hectolitres (100 million litres)
IAS
International Accounting Standards
IASB
International Accounting Standards Board
IFRIC
International Financial Reporting Interpretations Committee
IFRS
International Financial Reporting Standards as adopted by the EU
Financial Definitions
272
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

Interest cover
Calculated by dividing the Group’s EBITDA excluding exceptional items and discontinued activities 
by the Group’s interest expense, excluding IFRS 16 Leases finance charges, issue cost write-offs, 
fair value movements with respect to derivative financial instruments and unwind of discounts on 
provisions, for the same period
LAD
Long Alcoholic Drinks 
Liquidity
Liquidity is defined as cash plus undrawn amounts under the Group’s revolving credit facility
LTIP
Long-Term Incentive Plan
Net debt
Net debt comprises borrowings (net of issue costs) less cash plus lease liabilities capitalised under 
IFRS 16 Leases 
Net debt/EBITDA
A measurement of leverage, calculated as the Group’s Net debt divided by its EBITDA excluding 
exceptional items and discontinued activities. The net debt to EBITDA ratio is a debt ratio that 
shows how many years it would take for the Group to pay back its debt if net debt and EBITDA are 
held constant
Net revenue
Net revenue is defined by the Group as revenue less excise duty. The duty number disclosed 
represents the cash cost of duty paid on the Group’s products. Where goods are bought duty 
paid and subsequently sold, the duty element is not included in the duty line but within the cost of 
goods sold. Net revenue therefore excludes duty relating to the brewing and packaging of certain 
products. Excise duties, which represent a significant proportion of revenue, are set by external 
regulators over which the Group has no control and are generally passed on to the consumer
NI
Northern Ireland
Non-controlling interest
Non-controlling interest is the share of ownership in a subsidiary entity that is not owned by the 
Group 
OECD
Organization for Economic Cooperation and Development
Off-trade
All venues where drinks are sold for off-premise consumption including shops, supermarkets and 
cash & carry outlets selling alcohol for consumption off the premises
On-trade
All venues where drinks are sold at retail for on-premise consumption including pubs, hotels and 
clubs selling alcohol for consumption on the premises
Operating profit
Profit earned from the Group’s core business operations before net financing and income tax costs 
and excluding the Group’s share of equity accounted investments’ profit/(loss) after tax. In line with 
the Group’s accounting policies certain items of income and expense are separately classified as 
exceptional items on the face of the Income Statement
Operating margin 
Operating margin is based on operating profit before exceptional items and is calculated as a 
percentage of net revenue
PPE
Property, plant & equipment
PS
IFRS Practice Statement 2 Making Materiality Judgements
Revenue
Revenue comprises the fair value of goods supplied to external customers exclusive of 
intercompany sales and value added tax, after allowing for discounts, rebates, allowances for 
customer loyalty and other pricing related allowances and incentives
ROI
Republic of Ireland
TRG
Transition Resource Group
TSR
Total Shareholder Return
UK
United Kingdom (Great Britain and Northern Ireland)
US 
United States of America
273
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Additional 
Information
275
Shareholder and Other Information
274
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

C&C Group plc is an Irish registered company (registered number: 
383466). Its ordinary shares are quoted on the London Stock 
Exchange (ISIN: IE00B010DT83 SEDOL: B010DT8). 
The authorised share capital of the Company at 29 February 2024 
was ordinary 800,000,000 ordinary shares at €0.01 each. The 
issued share capital at 29 February 2024 was 402,708,890 ordinary 
shares of €0.01 each. 
Euroclear Bank 
Following the migration in March 2021 of securities settlement in the 
securities of Irish registered companies listed on the London Stock 
Exchange (such as the Company) and/or Euronext Dublin from the 
CREST settlement system to the replacement system, Euroclear 
Bank, the Company’s shares are held and transferred in certificated 
form (that is, represented by a share certificate) or in electronic form 
indirectly through the Euroclear System or through CREST in CDI 
(CREST Depository Interest) form. Shareholders have the choice 
of holding their shares in electronic form or in the form of share 
certificates. Shareholders should consult their stockbroker if they 
wish to hold their shares in electronic form.
SHARE PRICE DATA
2024
2023
Share price at year end
£1.43
£1.49
2024
2023
No of Shares in issue at year end
402,708,890
 402,007,212
Market capitalisation 29/28 February
£576m
£599m
Share price movement during the financial year
 – high
£1.59
£2.16
 – low
£1.23
£1.44
Dividend Payments
The Company may, by ordinary resolution declare dividends in 
accordance with the respective rights of Shareholders, but no 
dividend shall exceed the amount recommended by the Directors. 
The Directors may also declare and pay interim dividends if they 
believe they are justified by the profits of the Company available for 
distribution.
Subject to Shareholder approval at the 2024 Annual General 
Meeting, the Directors have proposed a final dividend of 3.97 cents 
per share to be paid on 23 August 2024 to ordinary Shareholders 
registered at the close of business on 19 July 2024. An interim 
dividend was paid of 1.89 cents per share; therefore, the Group’s full 
year dividend will amount to 5.86 cents per share. There is no scrip 
dividend alternative proposed. 
Shareholder and Other Information
Dividend Withholding Tax (‘DWT’) must be deducted from dividends 
paid by an Irish resident company, unless a Shareholder is entitled 
to an exemption and has submitted a properly completed exemption 
form to the Company’s Registrar. DWT applies to dividends paid 
by way of cash or by way of shares under a scrip dividend scheme 
and is deducted at the standard rate of income tax (currently 20%). 
Non-resident Shareholders and certain Irish companies, trusts, 
pension schemes, investment undertakings, companies resident 
in any member state of the European Union and charities may be 
entitled to claim exemption from DWT. DWT exemption forms may 
be obtained from the Irish Revenue Commissioners website: http://
www.revenue.ie/en/tax/dwt/forms/index.html. Shareholders should 
note that DWT will be deducted from dividends in cases where a 
properly completed exemption form has not been received by the 
relevant record date. Shareholders who wish to have their dividend 
paid direct to a bank account, by electronic funds transfer, should 
contact Link Registrars to obtain a mandate form. Tax vouchers 
will be sent to the Shareholder’s registered address under this 
arrangement.
Dematerialisation
There is a requirement in the Central Securities Depositories 
Regulations (‘CSDR’) that all newly issued securities of quoted 
companies admitted to trading in the EU hold all shares through a 
CSD from 1 January 2023 and all existing transferrable securities 
of quoted companies admitted to trading in the EU must be 
represented in book entry from 1 January 2025. Therefore, by 1 
January 2025, all of the Company’s securities need to be held 
electronically.
While over 95% of the Company’s shares are currently held 
electronically through Euroclear, the remaining shares are held 
by certificated shareholders. From 1 January 2025 these share 
certificates will cease to represent legal title and instead your shares 
will be represented by book entry on the Register of Members. Your 
shareholding has not changed and you retain ownership of your 
shares, it’s simply that legal title is now represented by entry on the 
Register of Members rather than in physical paper form.
Further information can be found on the Company’s website at 
https://candcgroupplc.com/shareholder-centre/
275
Governance Report
Strategic Report
Financial Statements
Additional Information

Holders through Euroclear Bank
Investors who hold their shares via Euroclear Bank or (in CDI form) 
through CREST will automatically receive dividends in Euro unless 
they elect otherwise.
Certificated Shareholders 
Shareholders who hold their shares in certificated form will 
automatically receive dividends in Euro with the following 
exceptions:
•	 Shareholders with an address in the United Kingdom (UK) will 
automatically receive dividends in Sterling,
•	 Shareholders who had previously elected to receive dividends 
in a particular currency will continue to receive dividends in that 
currency.
Shareholders who wish to receive dividends in a currency other 
than that which will be automatically used should contact the 
Company’s Registrar.
E-Communication
In order to promote a more cost effective and environmentally 
friendly approach, the Company provides the Annual Report 
electronically to Shareholders via the Group’s website and only 
sends a printed copy to those who specifically request one. 
Shareholders who wish to alter the method by which they receive 
communications should contact the Company’s Registrar. All 
Shareholders will continue to receive printed proxy forms, dividend 
documentation, Shareholder circulars, and, where the Company 
deems it appropriate, other documentation by post.
Company Secretary and Registered Office
Mark Chilton, 
C&C Group plc
Bulmers House, Keeper Road, Crumlin, Dublin 12, D12 K702 
Tel: +353 1 506 3900
Registrars
Shareholders with queries concerning their holdings, dividend 
information or administrative matters should contact the Company’s 
Registrars:
Link Registrars Limited (trading as LinkGroup) 
P.O. Box 7117, Dublin 2.(if delivered by post) or;
Suite 149, The Capel Building, Mary’s Abbey, Dublin 7, D07 DP79, 
Ireland.(if delivered by hand)
Tel: +353 1 553 0050 
Fax: +353 1 224 0700 
Email: enquiries@linkgroup.ie
Website: www.linkgroup.eu
Investor Relations
FTI Consulting
10 Merrion Square, Dublin 2, D02 DW94
Principal Bankers
ABN Amro Bank
Allied Irish Bank
Bank of Ireland
Bank of Scotland
Barclays Bank
HSBC
Rabobank
Solicitors 
McCann FitzGerald
Riverside One, Sir John Rogerson’s Quay, Dublin 2, D02 X576
Stockbrokers
Davy 
Davy House, 49 Dawson Street, Dublin 2, D02 PY05
Barclays Bank plc
5 The North Colonnade, Canary Wharf, London E14 4BB
Numis Securities Limited
10 Paternoster Square, London, EC4M 7LT
Auditor
Ernst & Young Chartered Accountants
Harcourt Centre, Harcourt Street, Dublin 2, D02 YA40.
Website
Further information on C&C Group plc is available at  
www.candcgroupplc.com
Shareholder and Other Information
(continued)
276
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024

sourcedesign.ie

278
C&C Group plc 
Annual Report 2024
Bulmers House, Keeper Road, Crumlin, Dublin 12, D12 K702. 
www.candcgroupplc.com